Intel® I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10) Family Datasheet October 2008 Document Number: 319973-003 INFORMATION IN THIS DOCUMENT IS PROVIDED IN CONNECTION WITH INTEL® PRODUCTS. NO LICENSE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, BY ESTOPPEL OR OTHERWISE, TO ANY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS IS GRANTED BY THIS DOCUMENT. EXCEPT AS PROVIDED IN INTEL'S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE FOR SUCH PRODUCTS, INTEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER, AND INTEL DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY, RELATING TO SALE AND/OR USE OF INTEL PRODUCTS INCLUDING LIABILITY OR WARRANTIES RELATING TO FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, MERCHANTABILITY, OR INFRINGEMENT OF ANY PATENT, COPYRIGHT OR OTHER INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT. Legal Lines and Disclaimers UNLESS OTHERWISE AGREED IN WRITING BY INTEL, THE INTEL PRODUCTS ARE NOT DESIGNED NOR INTENDED FOR ANY APPLICATION IN WHICH THE FAILURE OF THE INTEL PRODUCT COULD CREATE A SITUATION WHERE PERSONAL INJURY OR DEATH MAY OCCUR. Intel may make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time, without notice. Designers must not rely on the absence or characteristics of any features or instructions marked "reserved" or "undefined." Intel reserves these for future definition and shall have no responsibility whatsoever for conflicts or incompatibilities arising from future changes to them. The information here is subject to change without notice. Do not finalize a design with this information. The Intel® I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10) Family chipset component may contain design defects or errors known as errata which may cause the product to deviate from published specifications. Current characterized errata are available on request. Contact your local Intel sales office or your distributor to obtain the latest specifications and before placing your product order. I2C is a two-wire communications bus/protocol developed by Philips. SMBus is a subset of the I2C bus/protocol and was developed by Intel. Implementations of the I2C bus/protocol may require licenses from various entities, including Philips Electronics N.V. and North American Philips Corporation. Intel® Active Management Technology requires the computer system to have an Intel® AMT-enabled chipset, network hardware and software, as well as connection with a power source and a corporate network connection. Setup requires configuration by the purchaser and may require scripting with the management console or further integration into existing security frameworks to enable certain functionality. It may also require modifications of implementation of new business processes. With regard to notebooks, Intel AMT may not be available or certain capabilities may be limited over a host OS-based VPN or when connecting wirelessly, on battery power, sleeping, hibernating or powered off. For more information, see www.intel.com/technology/platform-technology/intel-amt/ Intel® Virtualization Technology requires a computer system with an enabled Intel® processor, BIOS, virtual machine monitor (VMM) and, for some uses, certain computer system software enabled for it. Functionality, performance or other benefits will vary depending on hardware and software configurations and may require a BIOS update. Software applications may not be compatible with all operating systems. Please check with your application vendor. No computer system can provide absolute security under all conditions. Intel® Trusted Execution Technology (Intel® TXT) requires a computer system with Intel® Virtualization Technology, an Intel TXT-enabled processor, chipset, BIOS, Authenticated Code Modules and an Intel TXT-compatible measured launched environment (MLE). The MLE could consist of a virtual machine monitor, an OS or an application. In addition, Intel TXT requires the system to contain a TPM v1.2, as defined by the Trusted Computing Group and specific software for some uses. For more information, see http://www.intel.com/technology/security Home networking capability and many Intel® Viiv™ technology-based usage models will require additional hardware devices, software or services. Functionality of Intel® Viiv™ technology verified devices will vary; check product details for desired features. System and component performance and functionality will vary depending on your specific hardware and software configurations. See www.intel.com/go/viiv_info for more information. Intel® High Definition Audio requires a system with an appropriate Intel chipset and a motherboard with an appropriate codec and the necessary drivers installed. System sound quality will vary depending on actual implementation, controller, codec, drivers and speakers. For more information about Intel® HD audio, refer to http://www.intel.com/ Intel, Intel logo, Intel SpeedStep, Intel Viiv, and Intel vPro are trademarks of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and other countries. *Other names and brands may be claimed as the property of others. Copyright © 2008, Intel Corporation 2 Datasheet Contents 1 Introduction ............................................................................................................ 33 1.1 About This Manual ............................................................................................. 33 1.2 Overview ......................................................................................................... 37 1.2.1 Capability Overview ................................................................................ 39 1.3 Intel® ICH10 Family High-Level Component Differences ......................................... 44 2 Signal Description ................................................................................................... 45 2.1 Direct Media Interface (DMI) to Host Controller ..................................................... 47 2.2 PCI Express* Interface....................................................................................... 48 2.3 LAN Connect Interface ....................................................................................... 48 2.4 Gigabit LAN Connect Interface ............................................................................ 49 2.5 Firmware Hub Interface...................................................................................... 50 2.6 PCI Interface .................................................................................................... 50 2.7 Serial ATA Interface........................................................................................... 52 2.8 LPC Interface.................................................................................................... 55 2.9 Interrupt Interface ............................................................................................ 55 2.10 USB Interface ................................................................................................... 56 2.11 Power Management Interface.............................................................................. 58 2.12 Processor Interface............................................................................................ 61 2.13 SMBus Interface................................................................................................ 62 2.14 System Management Interface............................................................................ 63 2.15 Real Time Clock Interface ................................................................................... 64 2.16 Other Clocks..................................................................................................... 65 2.17 Miscellaneous Signals ........................................................................................ 65 2.18 Intel® High Definition Audio Link ......................................................................... 66 2.19 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) .......................................................................... 67 2.20 Controller Link .................................................................................................. 68 2.21 Intel® Quiet System Technology ......................................................................... 68 2.22 JTAG Signals (Intel® ICH10 Corporate Family Only) ............................................... 69 2.23 General Purpose I/O Signals ............................................................................... 70 2.24 Power and Ground Signals .................................................................................. 73 2.25 Pin Straps ........................................................................................................ 75 2.25.1 Functional Straps ................................................................................... 75 2.25.2 External RTC Circuitry ............................................................................. 79 3 Intel® ICH10 Pin States........................................................................................... 81 3.1 Integrated Pull-Ups and Pull-Downs ..................................................................... 81 3.2 Output and I/O Signals Planes and States............................................................. 83 3.3 Power Planes for Input Signals ............................................................................ 88 4 Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains................................................................. 91 5 Functional Description ............................................................................................. 93 5.1 DMI-to-PCI Bridge (D30:F0) ............................................................................... 93 5.1.1 PCI Bus Interface ................................................................................... 93 5.1.2 PCI Bridge As an Initiator ........................................................................ 93 5.1.3 Parity Error Detection and Generation ....................................................... 95 5.1.4 PCIRST# ............................................................................................... 96 5.1.5 Peer Cycles ........................................................................................... 96 5.1.6 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Model.......................................................................... 96 5.1.7 IDSEL to Device Number Mapping ............................................................ 97 5.1.8 Standard PCI Bus Configuration Mechanism ............................................... 97 5.2 PCI Express* Root Ports (D28:F0,F1,F2,F3,F4,F5).................................................. 97 5.2.1 Interrupt Generation............................................................................... 97 5.2.2 Power Management ................................................................................ 98 5.2.3 SERR# Generation ................................................................................. 99 5.2.4 Hot-Plug ............................................................................................. 100 5.3 Gigabit Ethernet Controller (B0:D25:F0)............................................................. 101 5.3.1 Gigabit Ethernet PCI Bus Interface.......................................................... 102 5.3.2 Error Events and Error Reporting ............................................................ 103 5.3.3 Ethernet Interface ................................................................................ 103 5.3.4 PCI Power Management ........................................................................ 104 5.3.5 Configurable LEDs ................................................................................ 105 Datasheet 3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 5.14 5.15 4 5.3.6 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) ......................................................... 106 LPC Bridge (w/ System and Management Functions) (D31:F0) ............................... 107 5.4.1 LPC Interface ....................................................................................... 107 DMA Operation (D31:F0) .................................................................................. 112 5.5.1 Channel Priority.................................................................................... 113 5.5.2 Address Compatibility Mode ................................................................... 113 5.5.3 Summary of DMA Transfer Sizes ............................................................. 114 5.5.4 Autoinitialize ........................................................................................ 114 5.5.5 Software Commands ............................................................................. 115 LPC DMA ........................................................................................................ 115 5.6.1 Asserting DMA Requests ........................................................................ 115 5.6.2 Abandoning DMA Requests..................................................................... 116 5.6.3 General Flow of DMA Transfers ............................................................... 116 5.6.4 Terminal Count..................................................................................... 116 5.6.5 Verify Mode ......................................................................................... 117 5.6.6 DMA Request Deassertion ...................................................................... 117 5.6.7 SYNC Field / LDRQ# Rules ..................................................................... 118 8254 Timers (D31:F0) ...................................................................................... 118 5.7.1 Timer Programming .............................................................................. 119 5.7.2 Reading from the Interval Timer ............................................................. 120 8259 Interrupt Controllers (PIC) (D31:F0)........................................................... 121 5.8.1 Interrupt Handling ................................................................................ 122 5.8.2 Initialization Command Words (ICWx) ..................................................... 123 5.8.3 Operation Command Words (OCW) ......................................................... 124 5.8.4 Modes of Operation ............................................................................... 124 5.8.5 Masking Interrupts................................................................................ 127 5.8.6 Steering PCI Interrupts.......................................................................... 127 Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC) (D31:F0)............................... 128 5.9.1 Interrupt Handling ................................................................................ 128 5.9.2 Interrupt Mapping................................................................................. 128 5.9.3 PCI / PCI Express* Message-Based Interrupts .......................................... 129 5.9.4 Front Side Bus Interrupt Delivery ............................................................ 129 5.9.5 IOxAPIC Address Remapping .................................................................. 131 5.9.6 External Interrupt Controller Support ...................................................... 131 Serial Interrupt (D31:F0) .................................................................................. 132 5.10.1 Start Frame ......................................................................................... 132 5.10.2 Data Frames ........................................................................................ 133 5.10.3 Stop Frame.......................................................................................... 133 5.10.4 Specific Interrupts Not Supported via SERIRQ........................................... 133 5.10.5 Data Frame Format............................................................................... 134 Real Time Clock (D31:F0) ................................................................................. 135 5.11.1 Update Cycles ...................................................................................... 135 5.11.2 Interrupts ............................................................................................ 136 5.11.3 Lockable RAM Ranges............................................................................ 136 5.11.4 Century Rollover................................................................................... 136 5.11.5 Clearing Battery-Backed RTC RAM........................................................... 136 Processor Interface (D31:F0) ............................................................................ 138 5.12.1 Processor Interface Signals .................................................................... 138 5.12.2 Dual-Processor Issues ........................................................................... 141 Power Management (D31:F0) ............................................................................ 142 5.13.1 Features .............................................................................................. 142 5.13.2 Intel® ICH10 and System Power States ................................................... 142 5.13.3 System Power Planes ............................................................................ 145 5.13.4 SMI#/SCI Generation ............................................................................ 145 5.13.5 Dynamic Processor Clock Control ............................................................ 148 5.13.6 Sleep States ........................................................................................ 151 5.13.7 Thermal Management............................................................................ 154 5.13.8 Event Input Signals and Their Usage ....................................................... 155 5.13.9 ALT Access Mode .................................................................................. 158 5.13.10System Power Supplies, Planes, and Signals............................................. 162 5.13.11Clock Generators .................................................................................. 164 5.13.12Legacy Power Management Theory of Operation ....................................... 165 5.13.13Reset Behavior ..................................................................................... 165 System Management (D31:F0) .......................................................................... 167 5.14.1 Theory of Operation .............................................................................. 167 5.14.2 TCO Modes .......................................................................................... 169 General Purpose I/O (D31:F0) ........................................................................... 173 Datasheet 5.16 5.17 5.18 5.19 5.20 5.21 5.22 5.23 Datasheet 5.15.1 Power Wells......................................................................................... 173 5.15.2 SMI# and SCI Routing .......................................................................... 173 5.15.3 Triggering ........................................................................................... 173 5.15.4 GPIO Registers Lockdown ...................................................................... 173 5.15.5 Serial POST Codes Over GPIO ................................................................ 174 5.15.6 Intel Management Engine GPIOs ............................................................ 176 SATA Host Controller (D31:F2, F5) .................................................................... 176 5.16.1 SATA Feature Support........................................................................... 177 5.16.2 Theory of Operation.............................................................................. 178 5.16.3 SATA Swap Bay Support ....................................................................... 178 5.16.4 Hot Plug Operation ............................................................................... 178 5.16.5 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) ........................................................ 179 5.16.6 Intel® Matrix Storage Technology Configuration ....................................... 180 5.16.7 Power Management Operation................................................................ 181 5.16.8 SATA Device Presence........................................................................... 183 5.16.9 SATA LED............................................................................................ 184 5.16.10AHCI Operation.................................................................................... 184 5.16.11Serial ATA Reference Clock Low Power Request (SATACLKREQ#) ................ 184 5.16.12SGPIO Signals ..................................................................................... 185 5.16.13External SATA...................................................................................... 189 High Precision Event Timers.............................................................................. 189 5.17.1 Timer Accuracy .................................................................................... 189 5.17.2 Interrupt Mapping ................................................................................ 190 5.17.3 Periodic vs. Non-Periodic Modes ............................................................. 190 5.17.4 Enabling the Timers.............................................................................. 191 5.17.5 Interrupt Levels ................................................................................... 191 5.17.6 Handling Interrupts .............................................................................. 192 5.17.7 Issues Related to 64-Bit Timers with 32-Bit Processors .............................. 192 USB UHCI Host Controllers (D29:F0, F1, F2, F3 and D26:F0, F1 and F2) ................. 192 5.18.1 Data Structures in Main Memory............................................................. 193 5.18.2 Data Transfers to/from Main Memory ...................................................... 193 5.18.3 Data Encoding and Bit Stuffing ............................................................... 193 5.18.4 Bus Protocol ........................................................................................ 193 5.18.5 Packet Formats .................................................................................... 194 5.18.6 USB Interrupts..................................................................................... 194 5.18.7 USB Power Management ....................................................................... 197 5.18.8 USB Legacy Keyboard Operation ............................................................ 197 5.18.9 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) ........................................................ 200 USB EHCI Host Controllers (D29:F7 and D26:F7)................................................. 201 5.19.1 EHC Initialization.................................................................................. 201 5.19.2 Data Structures in Main Memory............................................................. 202 5.19.3 USB 2.0 Enhanced Host Controller DMA................................................... 202 5.19.4 Data Encoding and Bit Stuffing ............................................................... 202 5.19.5 Packet Formats .................................................................................... 203 5.19.6 USB 2.0 Interrupts and Error Conditions .................................................. 203 5.19.7 USB 2.0 Power Management .................................................................. 204 5.19.8 Interaction with UHCI Host Controllers .................................................... 205 5.19.9 USB 2.0 Legacy Keyboard Operation ....................................................... 208 5.19.10USB 2.0 Based Debug Port .................................................................... 209 5.19.11USB Pre-Fetch Based Pause ................................................................... 213 5.19.12Function Level Reset Support (FLR) ........................................................ 214 SMBus Controller (D31:F3) ............................................................................... 214 5.20.1 Host Controller..................................................................................... 215 5.20.2 Bus Arbitration..................................................................................... 219 5.20.3 Bus Timing .......................................................................................... 220 5.20.4 Interrupts / SMI#................................................................................. 221 5.20.5 SMBALERT# ........................................................................................ 222 5.20.6 SMBus CRC Generation and Checking...................................................... 222 5.20.7 SMBus Slave Interface .......................................................................... 222 Intel® High Definition Audio Overview ................................................................ 228 Intel® Active Management Technology (Intel® AMT) (Corporate Only).................... 228 5.22.1 Intel® AMT Features ............................................................................. 229 5.22.2 Intel® AMT Requirements ...................................................................... 229 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ........................................................................ 229 5.23.1 SPI Supported Feature Overview ............................................................ 230 5.23.2 Flash Descriptor ................................................................................... 232 5.23.3 Flash Access ........................................................................................ 234 5 5.24 5.25 5.26 5.27 5.23.4 Serial Flash Device Compatibility Requirements ........................................ 235 5.23.5 Multiple Page Write Usage Model............................................................. 237 5.23.6 Flash Device Configurations ................................................................... 238 5.23.7 SPI Flash Device Recommended Pinout.................................................... 238 5.23.8 Serial Flash Device Package ................................................................... 239 Intel® Quiet System Technology (Intel® QST) ..................................................... 240 5.24.1 PWM Outputs ....................................................................................... 240 5.24.2 TACH Inputs ........................................................................................ 240 Thermal Sensors.............................................................................................. 240 Feature Capability Mechanism ........................................................................... 241 Integrated Trusted Platform Module (Corporate Only) ........................................... 241 5.27.1 Integrated TPM Hardware Requirements .................................................. 241 5.27.2 Enabling integrated TPM ........................................................................ 242 6 Ballout Definition ................................................................................................... 243 6.1 Intel® ICH10 Ballout ....................................................................................... 243 7 Package Information ............................................................................................. 253 7.1 Intel® ICH10 Package ...................................................................................... 253 8 Electrical Characteristics........................................................................................ 255 8.1 Thermal Specifications...................................................................................... 255 8.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................................... 255 8.3 DC Characteristics ........................................................................................... 255 8.4 AC Characteristics............................................................................................ 268 8.5 Timing Diagrams ............................................................................................. 280 9 Register and Memory Mapping ............................................................................... 293 9.1 PCI Devices and Functions ................................................................................ 294 9.2 PCI Configuration Map ...................................................................................... 295 9.3 I/O Map.......................................................................................................... 295 9.3.1 Fixed I/O Address Ranges ...................................................................... 295 9.3.2 Variable I/O Decode Ranges ................................................................... 298 9.4 Memory Map ................................................................................................... 299 9.4.1 Boot-Block Update Scheme .................................................................... 300 10 Chipset Configuration Registers ............................................................................. 303 10.1 Chipset Configuration Registers (Memory Space) ................................................. 303 10.1.1 VCH—Virtual Channel Capability Header Register ...................................... 306 10.1.2 VCAP1—Virtual Channel Capability #1 Register ......................................... 306 10.1.3 VCAP2—Virtual Channel Capability #2 Register ......................................... 307 10.1.4 PVC—Port Virtual Channel Control Register............................................... 307 10.1.5 PVS—Port Virtual Channel Status Register................................................ 307 10.1.6 V0CAP—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Capability Register.............................. 308 10.1.7 V0CTL—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Control Register ................................. 308 10.1.8 V0STS—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Status Register .................................. 309 10.1.9 V1CAP—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Capability Register.............................. 309 10.1.10V1CTL—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Control Register ................................. 310 10.1.11V1STS—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Status Register .................................. 310 10.1.12PAT—Port Arbitration Table (Consumer Only) ........................................... 311 10.1.13CIR1—Chipset Initialization Register 1 ..................................................... 311 10.1.14REC—Root Error Command Register ........................................................ 311 10.1.15RCTCL—Root Complex Topology Capabilities List Register .......................... 312 10.1.16ESD—Element Self Description Register ................................................... 312 10.1.17ULD—Upstream Link Descriptor Register .................................................. 312 10.1.18ULBA—Upstream Link Base Address Register ............................................ 313 10.1.19RP1D—Root Port 1 Descriptor Register..................................................... 313 10.1.20RP1BA—Root Port 1 Base Address Register............................................... 313 10.1.21RP2D—Root Port 2 Descriptor Register..................................................... 314 10.1.22RP2BA—Root Port 2 Base Address Register............................................... 314 10.1.23RP3D—Root Port 3 Descriptor Register..................................................... 314 10.1.24RP3BA—Root Port 3 Base Address Register............................................... 315 10.1.25RP4D—Root Port 4 Descriptor Register..................................................... 315 10.1.26RP4BA—Root Port 4 Base Address Register............................................... 315 10.1.27HDD—Intel® High Definition Audio Descriptor Register............................... 316 10.1.28HDBA—Intel® High Definition Audio Base Address Register......................... 316 10.1.29RP5D—Root Port 5 Descriptor Register..................................................... 316 10.1.30RP5BA—Root Port 5 Base Address Register............................................... 317 6 Datasheet 10.1.31RP6D—Root Port 6 Descriptor Register .................................................... 317 10.1.32RP6BA—Root Port 6 Base Address Register .............................................. 317 10.1.33ILCL—Internal Link Capabilities List Register ............................................ 318 10.1.34LCAP—Link Capabilities Register ............................................................. 318 10.1.35LCTL—Link Control Register ................................................................... 318 10.1.36LSTS—Link Status Register .................................................................... 319 10.1.37CIR2 — Chipset Initialization Register 2................................................... 319 10.1.38CIR3 — Chipset Initialization Register 3................................................... 319 10.1.39BCR — Backbone Configuration Register.................................................. 319 10.1.40RPC—Root Port Configuration Register .................................................... 320 10.1.41DMIC—DMI Control Register .................................................................. 321 10.1.42RPFN—Root Port Function Number and Hide for PCI Express* Root Ports ..... 321 10.1.43FLRSTAT—FLR Pending Status Register ................................................... 323 10.1.44CIR13—Chipset Initialization Register 13 ................................................. 324 10.1.45CIR5—Chipset Initialization Register 5..................................................... 324 10.1.46TRSR—Trap Status Register ................................................................... 324 10.1.47TRCR—Trapped Cycle Register ............................................................... 325 10.1.48TWDR—Trapped Write Data Register....................................................... 325 10.1.49IOTRn — I/O Trap Register (0-3)............................................................ 326 10.1.50DMC—DMI Miscellaneous Control Register ............................................... 327 10.1.51CIR6—Chipset Initialization Register 6..................................................... 327 10.1.52CIR7—Chipset Initialization Register 7..................................................... 327 10.1.53TCTL—TCO Configuration Register .......................................................... 328 10.1.54D31IP—Device 31 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 329 10.1.55D30IP—Device 30 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 330 10.1.56D29IP—Device 29 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 330 10.1.57D28IP—Device 28 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 331 10.1.58D27IP—Device 27 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 332 10.1.59D26IP—Device 26 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 333 10.1.60D25IP—Device 25 Interrupt Pin Register.................................................. 334 10.1.61D31IR—Device 31 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 334 10.1.62D30IR—Device 30 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 335 10.1.63D29IR—Device 29 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 336 10.1.64D28IR—Device 28 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 337 10.1.65D27IR—Device 27 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 338 10.1.66D26IR—Device 26 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 339 10.1.67D25IR—Device 25 Interrupt Route Register ............................................. 340 10.1.68OIC—Other Interrupt Control Register (Corporate Only) ............................ 341 10.1.69OIC—Other Interrupt Control Register (Consumer Only) ............................ 341 10.1.70SBEMC3—Scheduled Break Event C3 Exit Latency..................................... 342 10.1.71SBEMC4—Scheduled Break Event C4 Exit Latency..................................... 342 10.1.72PRSTS—Power and Reset Status (Corporate Only) .................................... 343 10.1.73RC—RTC Configuration Register ............................................................. 344 10.1.74HPTC—High Precision Timer Configuration Register ................................... 344 10.1.75GCS—General Control and Status Register............................................... 345 10.1.76BUC—Backed Up Control Register ........................................................... 347 10.1.77FD—Function Disable Register ................................................................ 348 10.1.78CG—Clock Gating ................................................................................. 350 10.1.79FDSW—Function Disable SUS Well .......................................................... 352 10.1.80CIR8—Chipset Initialization Register 8..................................................... 352 10.1.81CIR9—Chipset Initialization Register 9..................................................... 352 10.1.82PPO—Port Power Off ............................................................................. 352 10.1.83CIR10—Chipset Initialization Register 10 ................................................. 353 10.1.84MAP—Remap Control Register ................................................................ 353 11 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) ................................................................... 355 11.1 PCI Configuration Registers (D30:F0)................................................................. 355 11.1.1 VID— Vendor Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ............................ 356 11.1.2 DID— Device Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)............................. 356 11.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)............................................. 357 11.1.4 PSTS—PCI Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ......................................... 357 11.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ........................... 359 11.1.6 CC—Class Code Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ............................................ 359 11.1.7 PMLT—Primary Master Latency Timer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ............................................................................... 360 11.1.8 HEADTYP—Header Type Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ................................. 360 11.1.9 BNUM—Bus Number Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ...................................... 360 Datasheet 7 11.1.10SMLT—Secondary Master Latency Timer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 361 11.1.11IOBASE_LIMIT—I/O Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 361 11.1.12SECSTS—Secondary Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ............................ 362 11.1.13MEMBASE_LIMIT—Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 363 11.1.14PREF_MEM_BASE_LIMIT—Prefetchable Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ..................................................... 363 11.1.15PMBU32—Prefetchable Memory Base Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ................................................................... 364 11.1.16PMLU32—Prefetchable Memory Limit Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ................................................................... 364 11.1.17CAPP—Capability List Pointer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) .......................... 364 11.1.18INTR—Interrupt Information Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ........................... 364 11.1.19BCTRL—Bridge Control Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ................................... 365 11.1.20SPDH—Secondary PCI Device Hiding Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 366 11.1.21DTC—Delayed Transaction Control Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 367 11.1.22BPS—Bridge Proprietary Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 368 11.1.23BPC—Bridge Policy Configuration Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 369 11.1.24SVCAP—Subsystem Vendor Capability Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)................................................................................ 370 11.1.25SVID—Subsystem Vendor IDs Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) ......................... 370 12 8 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers ...................................................................... 371 12.1 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers (Gigabit LAN — D25:F0)................................. 371 12.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 372 12.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 372 12.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 373 12.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 374 12.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 375 12.1.6 CC—Class Code Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 375 12.1.7 CLS—Cache Line Size Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 375 12.1.8 PLT—Primary Latency Timer Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 375 12.1.9 HT—Header Type Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 375 12.1.10MBARA—Memory Base Address Register A (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 376 12.1.11MBARB—Memory Base Address Register B (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 376 12.1.12MBARC—Memory Base Address Register C (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 377 12.1.13SVID—Subsystem Vendor ID Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 377 12.1.14SID—Subsystem ID Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 377 12.1.15ERBA—Expansion ROM Base Address Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 377 12.1.16CAPP—Capabilities List Pointer Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 378 12.1.17INTR—Interrupt Information Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 378 12.1.18MLMG—Maximum Latency/Minimum Grant Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) .......................................................................... 378 Datasheet 12.2 13 12.1.19CLIST 1—Capabilities List Register 1 (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 378 12.1.20PMC—PCI Power Management Capabilities Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 379 12.1.21PMCS—PCI Power Management Control and Status Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) ............................................................. 380 12.1.22DR—Data Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 381 12.1.23CLIST 2—Capabilities List Register 2 (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 381 12.1.24MCTL—Message Control Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 381 12.1.25MADDL—Message Address Low Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 382 12.1.26MADDH—Message Address High Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 382 12.1.27MDAT—Message Data Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 382 12.1.28FLRCAP—Function Level Reset Capability (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 382 12.1.29FLRCLV—Function Level Reset Capability Length and Version (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0).......................................................................... 383 12.1.30DEVCTRL—Device Control (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) ..................................... 383 MBARA—Gigabit LAN Base Address A Registers ................................................... 384 12.2.1 LDR4—LAN Device Initialization Register 4 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 384 12.2.2 LDR3—LAN Device Initialization Register 3 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 384 12.2.3 LDCR2—LAN Device Control Register 2 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 385 12.2.4 LDCR4—LAN Device Control Register 4 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 385 12.2.5 LDR5—LAN Device Control Register 5 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 385 12.2.6 LDR1—LAN Device Initialization Register 1 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) ............................... 385 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) ............................................................... 387 13.1 PCI Configuration Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................................................... 387 13.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0).............................. 389 13.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .............................. 389 13.1.3 PCICMD—PCI COMMAND Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................ 389 13.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ....................................... 390 13.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................ 391 13.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................. 391 13.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0)..................................... 391 13.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................... 391 13.1.9 PLT—Primary Latency Timer Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0)............................ 391 13.1.10HEADTYP—Header Type Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................. 392 13.1.11SS—Sub System Identifiers Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................ 392 13.1.12PMBASE—ACPI Base Address Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .......................... 392 13.1.13ACPI_CNTL—ACPI Control Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0)............................. 393 13.1.14GPIOBASE—GPIO Base Address Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0)..................... 393 13.1.15GC—GPIO Control Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0)........................................ 394 13.1.16PIRQ[n]_ROUT—PIRQ[A,B,C,D] Routing Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 395 13.1.17SIRQ_CNTL—Serial IRQ Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0)....................... 396 13.1.18PIRQ[n]_ROUT—PIRQ[E,F,G,H] Routing Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 397 13.1.19LPC_IBDF—IOxAPIC Bus:Device:Function (LPC I/F—D31:F0)...................... 398 13.1.20LPC_HnBDF – HPET n Bus:Device:Function (LPC I/F—D31:F0).................... 398 13.1.21LPC_I/O_DEC—I/O Decode Ranges Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................. 399 13.1.22LPC_EN—LPC I/F Enables Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................... 400 13.1.23GEN1_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 401 13.1.24GEN2_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 401 Datasheet 9 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.5 10 13.1.25GEN3_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 402 13.1.26GEN4_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 4 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 403 13.1.27LGMR — LPC I/F Generic Memory Range (LPC I/F—D31:F0) (Corporate Only) .................................................................................. 403 13.1.28FWH_SEL1—Firmware Hub Select 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................. 404 13.1.29FWH_SEL2—Firmware Hub Select 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................. 405 13.1.30FWH_DEC_EN1—Firmware Hub Decode Enable Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 406 13.1.31BIOS_CNTL—BIOS Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .............................. 408 13.1.32FDCAP—Feature Detection Capability ID (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ........................ 409 13.1.33FDLEN—Feature Detection Capability Length (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................. 409 13.1.34FDVER—Feature Detection Version (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................... 409 13.1.35FDVCT—Feature Vector (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................................... 410 13.1.36RCBA—Root Complex Base Address Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................. 410 DMA I/O Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0)................................................................. 411 13.2.1 DMABASE_CA—DMA Base and Current Address Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0)................................................................... 412 13.2.2 DMABASE_CC—DMA Base and Current Count Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 413 13.2.3 DMAMEM_LP—DMA Memory Low Page Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 413 13.2.4 DMACMD—DMA Command Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .............................. 414 13.2.5 DMASTA—DMA Status Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................................... 414 13.2.6 DMA_WRSMSK—DMA Write Single Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 415 13.2.7 DMACH_MODE—DMA Channel Mode Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 416 13.2.8 DMA Clear Byte Pointer Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0)................................... 417 13.2.9 DMA Master Clear Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .......................................... 417 13.2.10DMA_CLMSK—DMA Clear Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ........................ 417 13.2.11DMA_WRMSK—DMA Write All Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 418 Timer I/O Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................................................... 419 13.3.1 TCW—Timer Control Word Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................... 420 13.3.2 SBYTE_FMT—Interval Timer Status Byte Format Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 422 13.3.3 Counter Access Ports Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ...................................... 423 8259 Interrupt Controller (PIC) Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ........................................................................................... 424 13.4.1 Interrupt Controller I/O MAP (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ........................................ 424 13.4.2 ICW1—Initialization Command Word 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 425 13.4.3 ICW2—Initialization Command Word 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 426 13.4.4 ICW3—Master Controller Initialization Command Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ......................................................... 427 13.4.5 ICW3—Slave Controller Initialization Command Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ......................................................... 427 13.4.6 ICW4—Initialization Command Word 4 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 428 13.4.7 OCW1—Operational Control Word 1 (Interrupt Mask) Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................................................................... 428 13.4.8 OCW2—Operational Control Word 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 429 13.4.9 OCW3—Operational Control Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 430 13.4.10ELCR1—Master Controller Edge/Level Triggered Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 431 13.4.11ELCR2—Slave Controller Edge/Level Triggered Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 432 Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC)(D31:F0)................................ 433 13.5.1 APIC Register Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0)...................................................... 433 13.5.2 IND—Index Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................... 434 13.5.3 DAT—Data Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................................................... 434 13.5.4 EOIR—EOI Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .................................................... 435 Datasheet 13.5.5 ID—Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .......................................... 436 13.5.6 VER—Version Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................ 436 13.5.7 REDIR_TBL—Redirection Table (LPC I/F—D31:F0)..................................... 437 13.6 Real Time Clock Registers................................................................................. 439 13.6.1 I/O Register Address Map ...................................................................... 439 13.6.2 Indexed Registers ................................................................................ 440 13.7 Processor Interface Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................. 444 13.7.1 NMI_SC—NMI Status and Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 444 13.7.2 NMI_EN—NMI Enable (and Real Time Clock Index) Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0).................................................................... 445 13.7.3 PORT92—Fast A20 and Init Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................. 445 13.7.4 COPROC_ERR—Coprocessor Error Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................................................................ 446 13.7.5 RST_CNT—Reset Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ................................ 446 13.8 Power Management Registers (PM—D31:F0) ....................................................... 447 13.8.1 Power Management PCI Configuration Registers (PM—D31:F0) ...................................................................................... 447 13.8.2 APM I/O Decode................................................................................... 460 13.8.3 Power Management I/O Registers ........................................................... 461 13.9 System Management TCO Registers (D31:F0) ..................................................... 483 13.9.1 TCO_RLD—TCO Timer Reload and Current Value Register .......................... 483 13.9.2 TCO_DAT_IN—TCO Data In Register ....................................................... 484 13.9.3 TCO_DAT_OUT—TCO Data Out Register .................................................. 484 13.9.4 TCO1_STS—TCO1 Status Register .......................................................... 484 13.9.5 TCO2_STS—TCO2 Status Register .......................................................... 486 13.9.6 TCO1_CNT—TCO1 Control Register ......................................................... 488 13.9.7 TCO2_CNT—TCO2 Control Register ......................................................... 489 13.9.8 TCO_MESSAGE1 and TCO_MESSAGE2 Registers ....................................... 489 13.9.9 TCO_WDCNT—TCO Watchdog Control Register ......................................... 490 13.9.10SW_IRQ_GEN—Software IRQ Generation Register .................................... 490 13.9.11TCO_TMR—TCO Timer Initial Value Register............................................. 490 13.10 General Purpose I/O Registers (D31:F0)............................................................. 491 13.10.1GPIO_USE_SEL—GPIO Use Select Register .............................................. 492 13.10.2GP_IO_SEL—GPIO Input/Output Select Register ....................................... 492 13.10.3GP_LVL—GPIO Level for Input or Output Register ..................................... 493 13.10.4GPO_BLINK—GPO Blink Enable Register .................................................. 493 13.10.5GP_SER_BLINK—GP Serial Blink ............................................................. 494 13.10.6GP_SB_CMDSTS—GP Serial Blink Command Status................................... 495 13.10.7GP_SB_DATA—GP Serial Blink Data ........................................................ 495 13.10.8GPI_INV—GPIO Signal Invert Register..................................................... 496 13.10.9GPIO_USE_SEL2—GPIO Use Select 2 Register .......................................... 497 13.10.10GP_IO_SEL2—GPIO Input/Output Select 2 Register ................................. 498 13.10.11GP_LVL2—GPIO Level for Input or Output 2 Register ............................... 498 13.10.12GPIO_USE_SEL3—GPIO Use Select 3 Register (Corporate Only) ................ 499 13.10.13GP_IO_SEL3—GPIO Input/Output Select 3 Register (Corporate Only)......... 499 13.10.14GP_LVL3—GPIO Level for Input or Output 3 Register (Corporate Only)....... 500 13.10.15GP_RST_SEL — GPIO Reset Select ........................................................ 500 14 SATA Controller Registers (D31:F2)....................................................................... 501 14.1 PCI Configuration Registers (SATA–D31:F2)........................................................ 501 14.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (SATA—D31:F2) ................................ 503 14.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (SATA—D31:F2) ................................. 503 14.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (SATA–D31:F2)..................................... 503 14.1.4 PCISTS — PCI Status Register (SATA–D31:F2) ......................................... 504 14.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (SATA—D31:F2)............................... 505 14.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (SATA–D31:F2)................................. 505 14.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (SATA–D31:F2) ........................................ 506 14.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (SATA–D31:F2) ....................................... 506 14.1.9 PMLT—Primary Master Latency Timer Register (SATA–D31:F2) ................... 507 14.1.10HTYPE—Header Type (SATA–D31:F2) ..................................................... 507 14.1.11PCMD_BAR—Primary Command Block Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F2) ....................................................................... 507 14.1.12PCNL_BAR—Primary Control Block Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F2).................................................................................... 508 14.1.13SCMD_BAR—Secondary Command Block Base Address Register (IDE D31:F1) .......................................................................... 508 Datasheet 11 14.2 14.3 14.4 15 12 14.1.14SCNL_BAR—Secondary Control Block Base Address Register (IDE D31:F1) ........................................................................... 508 14.1.15BAR — Legacy Bus Master Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F2) .................................................................................... 509 14.1.16ABAR/SIDPBA1 — AHCI Base Address Register/Serial ATA Index Data Pair Base Address (SATA–D31:F2) ................................................... 509 14.1.17SVID—Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (SATA–D31:F2) .................................................................................... 510 14.1.18SID—Subsystem Identification Register (SATA–D31:F2)............................. 510 14.1.19CAP—Capabilities Pointer Register (SATA–D31:F2) .................................... 510 14.1.20INT_LN—Interrupt Line Register (SATA–D31:F2)....................................... 511 14.1.21INT_PN—Interrupt Pin Register (SATA–D31:F2) ........................................ 511 14.1.22IDE_TIM — IDE Timing Register (SATA–D31:F2) ....................................... 511 14.1.23PID—PCI Power Management Capability Identification Register (SATA–D31:F2)........................................................................ 511 14.1.24PC—PCI Power Management Capabilities Register (SATA–D31:F2) .................................................................................... 512 14.1.25PMCS—PCI Power Management Control and Status Register (SATA–D31:F2)........................................................................ 512 14.1.26MSICI—Message Signaled Interrupt Capability Identification (SATA–D31:F2) .................................................................................... 513 14.1.27MSIMC—Message Signaled Interrupt Message Control (SATA–D31:F2) ......... 514 14.1.28MSIMA— Message Signaled Interrupt Message Address (SATA–D31:F2) ....... 515 14.1.29MSIMD—Message Signaled Interrupt Message Data (SATA–D31:F2) ............ 515 14.1.30MAP—Address Map Register (SATA–D31:F2)............................................. 516 14.1.31PCS—Port Control and Status Register (SATA–D31:F2) .............................. 516 14.1.32SCLKCG—SATA Clock Gating Control Register........................................... 519 14.1.33SCLKGC—SATA Clock General Configuration Register................................. 520 14.1.34FLRCID—FLR Capability ID (SATA–D31:F2) .............................................. 522 14.1.35FLRCLV—FLR Capability Length and Version (SATA–D31:F2)....................... 522 14.1.36FLRC—FLR Control (SATA–D31:F2) ......................................................... 523 14.1.37ATC—APM Trapping Control Register (SATA–D31:F2)................................. 523 14.1.38ATS—APM Trapping Status Register (SATA–D31:F2).................................. 524 14.1.39SP Scratch Pad Register (SATA–D31:F2) .................................................. 524 14.1.40BFCS—BIST FIS Control/Status Register (SATA–D31:F2) ........................... 525 14.1.41BFTD1—BIST FIS Transmit Data1 Register (SATA–D31:F2) ........................ 527 14.1.42BFTD2—BIST FIS Transmit Data2 Register (SATA–D31:F2) ........................ 527 Bus Master IDE I/O Registers (D31:F2)............................................................... 528 14.2.1 BMIC[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Command Register (D31:F2) .......................... 529 14.2.2 BMIS[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Status Register (D31:F2)................................ 530 14.2.3 BMID[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Descriptor Table Pointer Register (D31:F2)................................................................................. 531 14.2.4 AIR—AHCI Index Register (D31:F2) ........................................................ 531 14.2.5 AIDR—AHCI Index Data Register (D31:F2)............................................... 531 Serial ATA Index/Data Pair Superset Registers..................................................... 532 14.3.1 SINDX – Serial ATA Index (D31:F2) ........................................................ 532 14.3.2 SDATA – Serial ATA Data (D31:F2) ......................................................... 532 AHCI Registers (D31:F2) .................................................................................. 536 14.4.1 AHCI Generic Host Control Registers (D31:F2).......................................... 537 14.4.2 Vendor Specific Registers (D31:F2) ......................................................... 545 14.4.3 Port Registers (D31:F2) ......................................................................... 545 SATA Controller Registers (D31:F5) ....................................................................... 563 15.1 PCI Configuration Registers (SATA–D31:F5) ........................................................ 563 15.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (SATA—D31:F5) ................................. 564 15.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (SATA—D31:F5) ................................. 565 15.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (SATA–D31:F5) ..................................... 565 15.1.4 PCISTS — PCI Status Register (SATA–D31:F5) ......................................... 566 15.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (SATA—D31:F5) ............................... 566 15.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (SATA–D31:F5) ................................. 567 15.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (SATA–D31:F5) ......................................... 567 15.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (SATA–D31:F5)........................................ 567 15.1.9 PMLT—Primary Master Latency Timer Register (SATA–D31:F5) .................................................................................... 568 15.1.10PCMD_BAR—Primary Command Block Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F5)........................................................................ 568 Datasheet 15.2 15.3 16 15.1.11PCNL_BAR—Primary Control Block Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................................................................... 568 15.1.12SCMD_BAR—Secondary Command Block Base Address Register (IDE D31:F1) .......................................................................... 569 15.1.13SCNL_BAR—Secondary Control Block Base Address Register (IDE D31:F1) .......................................................................... 569 15.1.14BAR — Legacy Bus Master Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................................................................... 570 15.1.15SIDPBA — SATA Index/Data Pair Base Address Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................................................................... 570 15.1.16SVID—Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................................................................... 571 15.1.17SID—Subsystem Identification Register (SATA–D31:F5) ............................ 571 15.1.18CAP—Capabilities Pointer Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................... 571 15.1.19INT_LN—Interrupt Line Register (SATA–D31:F5) ...................................... 571 15.1.20INT_PN—Interrupt Pin Register (SATA–D31:F5)........................................ 571 15.1.21IDE_TIM — IDE Timing Register (SATA–D31:F5) ...................................... 572 15.1.22PID—PCI Power Management Capability Identification Register (SATA–D31:F5) ....................................................................... 572 15.1.23PC—PCI Power Management Capabilities Register (SATA–D31:F5).................................................................................... 572 15.1.24PMCS—PCI Power Management Control and Status Register (SATA–D31:F5) ....................................................................... 573 15.1.25MID—Message Signal Interrupt Identifier (SATA–D31:F5) (Consumer Only).................................................................................. 573 15.1.26MC—Message Signal Interrupt Message Control (SATA–D31:F5) (Consumer Only).................................................................................. 574 15.1.27MA—Message Signal Interrupt Message Address (SATA–D31:F5) (Consumer Only).................................................................................. 574 15.1.28MD—Message Signal Interrupt Message Data (SATA–D31:F5) (Consumer Only).................................................................................. 574 15.1.29MAP—Address Map Register (SATA–D31:F5)16......................................... 575 15.1.30PCS—Port Control and Status Register (SATA–D31:F5).............................. 576 15.1.31SATACR0— SATA Capability Register 0 (SATA–D31:F5) ............................. 577 15.1.32SATACR1— SATA Capability Register 1 (SATA–D31:F5) ............................. 577 15.1.33FLRCID— FLR Capability ID (SATA–D31:F5) ............................................. 577 15.1.34FLRCLV— FLR Capability Length and Value (SATA–D31:F5) ........................ 578 15.1.35FLRCTRL— FLR Control (SATA–D31:F5) ................................................... 578 15.1.36ATC—APM Trapping Control Register (SATA–D31:F5) ................................ 579 15.1.37ATC—APM Trapping Control (SATA–D31:F5) ............................................ 579 Bus Master IDE I/O Registers (D31:F5) .............................................................. 580 15.2.1 BMIC[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Command Register (D31:F5) .......................... 581 15.2.2 BMIS[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Status Register (D31:F5) ............................... 582 15.2.3 BMID[P,S]—Bus Master IDE Descriptor Table Pointer Register (D31:F5) ................................................................................ 582 Serial ATA Index/Data Pair Superset Registers .................................................... 583 15.3.1 SINDX—SATA Index Register (D31:F5) ................................................... 583 15.3.2 SDATA—SATA Index Data Register (D31:F5)............................................ 583 UHCI Controllers Registers .................................................................................... 589 16.1 PCI Configuration Registers (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ..................... 589 16.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 590 16.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 590 16.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 591 16.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 592 16.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 592 16.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 593 16.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 593 16.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ................................................. 593 Datasheet 13 16.2 17 14 16.1.9 MLT—Master Latency Timer Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 593 16.1.10HEADTYP—Header Type Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 594 16.1.11BASE—Base Address Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 594 16.1.12SVID — Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 594 16.1.13SID — Subsystem Identification Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 595 16.1.14CAP_PTR—Capabilities Pointer (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 595 16.1.15INT_LN—Interrupt Line Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 595 16.1.16INT_PN—Interrupt Pin Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 596 16.1.17FLRCID—Function Level Reset Capability ID (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 596 16.1.18FLRNCP—Function Level Reset Next Capability Pointer (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 596 16.1.19FLRCLV—Function Level Reset Capability Length and Version (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 597 16.1.20USB_FLRCTRL—FLR Control Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 597 16.1.21USB_FLRSTAT—FLR Status Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 598 16.1.22USB_RELNUM—Serial Bus Release Number Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 598 16.1.23USB_LEGKEY—USB Legacy Keyboard/Mouse Control Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2) ..................................... 598 16.1.24USB_RES—USB Resume Enable Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 600 16.1.25CWP—Core Well Policy Register (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 601 16.1.26UCR1—UCHI Configuration Register 1 (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2).................................................. 601 USB I/O Registers............................................................................................ 602 16.2.1 USBCMD—USB Command Register .......................................................... 603 16.2.2 USBSTS—USB Status Register ................................................................ 606 16.2.3 USBINTR—USB Interrupt Enable Register................................................. 607 16.2.4 FRNUM—Frame Number Register ............................................................ 607 16.2.5 FRBASEADD—Frame List Base Address Register........................................ 608 16.2.6 SOFMOD—Start of Frame Modify Register ................................................ 608 16.2.7 PORTSC[0,1]—Port Status and Control Register ........................................ 609 EHCI Controller Registers (D29:F7, D26:F7)........................................................... 611 17.1 USB EHCI Configuration Registers (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)............................ 611 17.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 612 17.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 612 17.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 613 17.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ........................ 614 17.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 615 17.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 615 17.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 615 17.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 615 17.1.9 PMLT—Primary Master Latency Timer Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 616 17.1.10MEM_BASE—Memory Base Address Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7)................................................................. 616 Datasheet 17.2 18 17.1.11SVID—USB EHCI Subsystem Vendor ID Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 616 17.1.12SID—USB EHCI Subsystem ID Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 617 17.1.13CAP_PTR—Capabilities Pointer Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 617 17.1.14INT_LN—Interrupt Line Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 617 17.1.15INT_PN—Interrupt Pin Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 617 17.1.16PWR_CAPID—PCI Power Management Capability ID Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) .................................................... 618 17.1.17NXT_PTR1—Next Item Pointer #1 Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 618 17.1.18PWR_CAP—Power Management Capabilities Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 619 17.1.19PWR_CNTL_STS—Power Management Control/ Status Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) .......................................... 620 17.1.20DEBUG_CAPID—Debug Port Capability ID Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 621 17.1.21NXT_PTR2—Next Item Pointer #2 Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 621 17.1.22DEBUG_BASE—Debug Port Base Offset Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 621 17.1.23USB_RELNUM—USB Release Number Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 621 17.1.24FL_ADJ—Frame Length Adjustment Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 622 17.1.25PWAKE_CAP—Port Wake Capability Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 623 17.1.26LEG_EXT_CAP—USB EHCI Legacy Support Extended Capability Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ..................................... 624 17.1.27LEG_EXT_CS—USB EHCI Legacy Support Extended Control / Status Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ............................. 624 17.1.28SPECIAL_SMI—Intel Specific USB 2.0 SMI Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 626 17.1.29ACCESS_CNTL—Access Control Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 628 17.1.30EHCIIR1—EHCI Initialization Register 1 (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 628 17.1.31FLR_CID—Function Level Reset Capability ID (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 628 17.1.32FLR_NEXT—Function Level Reset Next Capability Pointer (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 629 17.1.33FLR_CLV—Function Level Reset Capability Length and Version (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 629 17.1.34FLR_CTRL—Function Level Reset Control Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 630 17.1.35FLR_STS—Function Level Reset Status Register (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 630 17.1.36EHCIIR2—EHCI Initialization Register 2 (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) ................................................................ 630 Memory-Mapped I/O Registers .......................................................................... 631 17.2.1 Host Controller Capability Registers ........................................................ 631 17.2.2 Host Controller Operational Registers ...................................................... 635 17.2.3 USB 2.0-Based Debug Port Register........................................................ 649 Intel® High Definition Audio Controller Registers (D27:F0) ................................... 653 18.1 Intel® High Definition Audio PCI Configuration Space (Intel® High Definition Audio— D27:F0) ............................................................. 653 18.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 655 18.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 655 18.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 655 Datasheet 15 18.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 656 18.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 657 18.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 657 18.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 657 18.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 657 18.1.9 CLS—Cache Line Size Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 657 18.1.10LT—Latency Timer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 658 18.1.11HEADTYP—Header Type Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 658 18.1.12HDBARL—Intel® High Definition Audio Lower Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio—D27:F0).................................................... 658 18.1.13HDBARU—Intel® High Definition Audio Upper Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 658 18.1.14SVID—Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 659 18.1.15SID—Subsystem Identification Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 659 18.1.16CAPPTR—Capabilities Pointer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 659 18.1.17INTLN—Interrupt Line Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 660 18.1.18INTPN—Interrupt Pin Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 660 18.1.19HDCTL—Intel® High Definition Audio Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 660 18.1.20TCSEL—Traffic Class Select Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 661 18.1.21PID—PCI Power Management Capability ID Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 661 18.1.22PC—Power Management Capabilities Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 662 18.1.23PCS—Power Management Control and Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 663 18.1.24MID—MSI Capability ID Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 664 18.1.25MMC—MSI Message Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 664 18.1.26MMLA—MSI Message Lower Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 664 18.1.27MMUA—MSI Message Upper Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 664 18.1.28MMD—MSI Message Data Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 665 18.1.29PXID—PCI Express* Capability ID Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 665 18.1.30PXC—PCI Express* Capabilities Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 665 18.1.31DEVCAP—Device Capabilities Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 666 18.1.32DEVC—Device Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 667 18.1.33DEVS—Device Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 668 18.1.34VCCAP—Virtual Channel Enhanced Capability Header (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 668 18.1.35PVCCAP1—Port VC Capability Register 1 (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 669 18.1.36PVCCAP2 — Port VC Capability Register 2 (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 669 16 Datasheet 18.2 Datasheet 18.1.37PVCCTL — Port VC Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 669 18.1.38PVCSTS—Port VC Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 670 18.1.39VC0CAP—VC0 Resource Capability Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 670 18.1.40VC0CTL—VC0 Resource Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 671 18.1.41VC0STS—VC0 Resource Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 671 18.1.42VCiCAP—VCi Resource Capability Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 672 18.1.43VCiCTL—VCi Resource Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 672 18.1.44VCiSTS—VCi Resource Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 673 18.1.45RCCAP—Root Complex Link Declaration Enhanced Capability Header Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0).............. 673 18.1.46ESD—Element Self Description Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 673 18.1.47L1DESC—Link 1 Description Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 674 18.1.48L1ADDL—Link 1 Lower Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 674 18.1.49L1ADDU—Link 1 Upper Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 674 Intel® High Definition Audio Memory Mapped Configuration Registers (Intel® High Definition Audio— D27:F0) ............................................................. 675 18.2.1 GCAP—Global Capabilities Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 679 18.2.2 VMIN—Minor Version Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 679 18.2.3 VMAJ—Major Version Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 679 18.2.4 OUTPAY—Output Payload Capability Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 680 18.2.5 INPAY—Input Payload Capability Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 680 18.2.6 GCTL—Global Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 681 18.2.7 WAKEEN—Wake Enable Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 682 18.2.8 STATESTS—State Change Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 682 18.2.9 GSTS—Global Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 683 18.2.10OUTSTRMPAY—Output Stream Payload Capability (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 683 18.2.11INSTRMPAY—Input Stream Payload Capability (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 684 18.2.12INTCTL—Interrupt Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 685 18.2.13INTSTS—Interrupt Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 686 18.2.14WALCLK—Wall Clock Counter Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 686 18.2.15SSYNC—Stream Synchronization Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 687 18.2.16CORBLBASE—CORB Lower Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 687 18.2.17CORBUBASE—CORB Upper Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 688 18.2.18CORBWP—CORB Write Pointer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 688 18.2.19CORBRP—CORB Read Pointer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0)..................................... 688 17 18.2.20CORBCTL—CORB Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 689 18.2.21CORBST—CORB Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 689 18.2.22CORBSIZE—CORB Size Register Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ...................................... 689 18.2.23RIRBLBASE—RIRB Lower Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 690 18.2.24RIRBUBASE—RIRB Upper Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 690 18.2.25RIRBWP—RIRB Write Pointer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 690 18.2.26RINTCNT—Response Interrupt Count Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 691 18.2.27RIRBCTL—RIRB Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 691 18.2.28RIRBSTS—RIRB Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 692 18.2.29RIRBSIZE—RIRB Size Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 692 18.2.30IC—Immediate Command Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 692 18.2.31IR—Immediate Response Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 693 18.2.32IRS—Immediate Command Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 693 18.2.33DPLBASE—DMA Position Lower Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 694 18.2.34DPUBASE—DMA Position Upper Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 694 18.2.35SDCTL—Stream Descriptor Control Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 695 18.2.36SDSTS—Stream Descriptor Status Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 697 18.2.37SDLPIB—Stream Descriptor Link Position in Buffer Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ......................... 698 18.2.38SDCBL—Stream Descriptor Cyclic Buffer Length Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 698 18.2.39SDLVI—Stream Descriptor Last Valid Index Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 699 18.2.40SDFIFOW—Stream Descriptor FIFO Watermark Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 699 18.2.41SDFIFOS—Stream Descriptor FIFO Size Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 700 18.2.42SDFMT—Stream Descriptor Format Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..................................... 701 18.2.43SDBDPL—Stream Descriptor Buffer Descriptor List Pointer Lower Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ..... 702 18.2.44SDBDPU—Stream Descriptor Buffer Descriptor List Pointer Upper Base Address Register (Intel® High Definition Audio Controller—D27:F0) ............. 702 19 18 SMBus Controller Registers (D31:F3) ..................................................................... 703 19.1 PCI Configuration Registers (SMBus—D31:F3) ..................................................... 703 19.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............................... 703 19.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............................... 704 19.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (SMBus—D31:F3) .................................. 704 19.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ........................................ 705 19.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............................. 705 19.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (SMBus—D31:F3) .............................. 706 19.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ...................................... 706 19.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (SMBus—D31:F3)..................................... 706 19.1.9 SMBMBAR0—D31_F3_SMBus Memory Base Address 0 (SMBus—D31:F3) ................................................................................. 706 19.1.10SMBMBAR1—D31_F3_SMBus Memory Base Address 1 (SMBus—D31:F3) ................................................................................. 707 19.1.11SMB_BASE—SMBus Base Address Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ................................................................................. 707 Datasheet 19.2 20 19.1.12SVID—Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (SMBus—D31:F2/F4) ............................................................................ 707 19.1.13SID—Subsystem Identification Register (SMBus—D31:F2/F4)..................... 708 19.1.14INT_LN—Interrupt Line Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ................................... 708 19.1.15INT_PN—Interrupt Pin Register (SMBus—D31:F3)..................................... 708 19.1.16HOSTC—Host Configuration Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............................. 709 SMBus I/O and Memory Mapped I/O Registers .................................................... 710 19.2.1 HST_STS—Host Status Register (SMBus—D31:F3).................................... 711 19.2.2 HST_CNT—Host Control Register (SMBus—D31:F3) .................................. 712 19.2.3 HST_CMD—Host Command Register (SMBus—D31:F3).............................. 714 19.2.4 XMIT_SLVA—Transmit Slave Address Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ................ 714 19.2.5 HST_D0—Host Data 0 Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ..................................... 714 19.2.6 HST_D1—Host Data 1 Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ..................................... 714 19.2.7 Host_BLOCK_DB—Host Block Data Byte Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............ 715 19.2.8 PEC—Packet Error Check (PEC) Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ........................ 715 19.2.9 RCV_SLVA—Receive Slave Address Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ................... 716 19.2.10SLV_DATA—Receive Slave Data Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ....................... 716 19.2.11AUX_STS—Auxiliary Status Register (SMBus—D31:F3) .............................. 716 19.2.12AUX_CTL—Auxiliary Control Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............................. 717 19.2.13SMLINK_PIN_CTL—SMLink Pin Control Register (SMBus—D31:F3) .............. 717 19.2.14SMBus_PIN_CTL—SMBus Pin Control Register (SMBus—D31:F3)................. 718 19.2.15SLV_STS—Slave Status Register (SMBus—D31:F3)................................... 718 19.2.16SLV_CMD—Slave Command Register (SMBus—D31:F3)............................. 719 19.2.17NOTIFY_DADDR—Notify Device Address Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............ 719 19.2.18NOTIFY_DLOW—Notify Data Low Byte Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............... 720 19.2.19NOTIFY_DHIGH—Notify Data High Byte Register (SMBus—D31:F3) ............. 720 PCI Express* Configuration Registers.................................................................... 721 20.1 PCI Express* Configuration Registers (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ......... 721 20.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 724 20.1.2 DID—Device Identification Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 724 20.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 725 20.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 726 20.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 727 20.1.6 PI—Programming Interface Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 727 20.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 727 20.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 727 20.1.9 CLS—Cache Line Size Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 728 20.1.10PLT—Primary Latency Timer Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 728 20.1.11HEADTYP—Header Type Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 728 20.1.12BNUM—Bus Number Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 728 20.1.13SLT—Secondary Latency Timer (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 729 20.1.14IOBL—I/O Base and Limit Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 729 20.1.15SSTS—Secondary Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 730 20.1.16MBL—Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 731 20.1.17PMBL—Prefetchable Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 731 20.1.18PMBU32—Prefetchable Memory Base Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ...................................... 731 20.1.19PMLU32—Prefetchable Memory Limit Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ...................................... 732 Datasheet 19 20.1.20CAPP—Capabilities List Pointer Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 732 20.1.21INTR—Interrupt Information Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 732 20.1.22BCTRL—Bridge Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 733 20.1.23CLIST—Capabilities List Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 734 20.1.24XCAP—PCI Express* Capabilities Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 734 20.1.25DCAP—Device Capabilities Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 735 20.1.26DCTL—Device Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 736 20.1.27DSTS—Device Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 737 20.1.28LCAP—Link Capabilities Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 738 20.1.29LCTL—Link Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 740 20.1.30LSTS—Link Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 741 20.1.31SLCAP—Slot Capabilities Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 742 20.1.32SLCTL—Slot Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 743 20.1.33SLSTS—Slot Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 744 20.1.34RCTL—Root Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 745 20.1.35RSTS—Root Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 745 20.1.36DCAP2—Device Capabilities 2 Register (Corporate Only) (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 746 20.1.37DCTL2—Device Control 2 Register (Corporate Only) (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 746 20.1.38LCTL2—Link Control 2 Register (Corporate Only) (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 747 20.1.39MID—Message Signaled Interrupt Identifiers Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 747 20.1.40MC—Message Signaled Interrupt Message Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 747 20.1.41MA—Message Signaled Interrupt Message Address Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)....................................... 748 20.1.42MD—Message Signaled Interrupt Message Data Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 748 20.1.43SVCAP—Subsystem Vendor Capability Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 748 20.1.44SVID—Subsystem Vendor Identification Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 748 20.1.45PMCAP—Power Management Capability Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 749 20.1.46PMC—PCI Power Management Capabilities Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 749 20.1.47PMCS—PCI Power Management Control and Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)....................................... 750 20.1.48MPC2—Miscellaneous Port Configuration Register 2 (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 751 20.1.49MPC—Miscellaneous Port Configuration Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 752 20.1.50SMSCS—SMI/SCI Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 754 20.1.51RPDCGEN—Root Port Dynamic Clock Gating Enable (PCI Express-D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)..................................................... 755 20.1.52PECR1—PCI Express* Configuration Register 1 (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ................................................... 755 20 Datasheet 20.1.53VCH—Virtual Channel Capability Header Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 756 20.1.54VCAP2—Virtual Channel Capability 2 Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 756 20.1.55PVC—Port Virtual Channel Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 756 20.1.56PVS—Port Virtual Channel Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 757 20.1.57V0CAP—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Capability Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 757 20.1.58V0CTL—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 758 20.1.59V0STS—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 758 20.1.60UES—Uncorrectable Error Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 759 20.1.61UEM—Uncorrectable Error Mask (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 760 20.1.62UEV — Uncorrectable Error Severity (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 761 20.1.63CES — Correctable Error Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 762 20.1.64CEM — Correctable Error Mask Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 762 20.1.65AECC — Advanced Error Capabilities and Control Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 763 20.1.66RES — Root Error Status Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 763 20.1.67RCTCL — Root Complex Topology Capability List Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 763 20.1.68ESD—Element Self Description Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 764 20.1.69ULD — Upstream Link Description Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 764 20.1.70ULBA — Upstream Link Base Address Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 765 20.1.71PECR2 — PCI Express* Configuration Register 2 (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 765 20.1.72PEETM — PCI Express* Extended Test Mode Register (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 765 20.1.73PEC1 — PCI Express* Configuration Register 1 (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5)................................................... 766 21 High Precision Event Timer Registers .................................................................... 767 21.1 Memory Mapped Registers................................................................................ 767 21.1.1 GCAP_ID—General Capabilities and Identification Register ......................... 769 21.1.2 GEN_CONF—General Configuration Register............................................. 770 21.1.3 GINTR_STA—General Interrupt Status Register ........................................ 770 21.1.4 MAIN_CNT—Main Counter Value Register ................................................ 771 21.1.5 TIMn_CONF—Timer n Configuration and Capabilities Register ..................... 772 21.1.6 TIMn_COMP—Timer n Comparator Value Register ..................................... 775 22 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ........................................................................... 777 22.1 Serial Peripheral Interface Memory Mapped Configuration Registers ....................... 777 22.1.1 BFPR –BIOS Flash Primary Region Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 779 22.1.2 HSFS—Hardware Sequencing Flash Status Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 779 22.1.3 HSFC—Hardware Sequencing Flash Control Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 781 22.1.4 FADDR—Flash Address Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 781 22.1.5 FDATA0—Flash Data 0 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 782 22.1.6 FDATAN—Flash Data [N] Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ......................................... 782 Datasheet 21 22.2 22.3 22.4 22 22.1.7 FRAP—Flash Regions Access Permissions Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 783 22.1.8 FREG0—Flash Region 0 (Flash Descriptor) Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 784 22.1.9 FREG1—Flash Region 1 (BIOS Descriptor) Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 784 22.1.10FREG2—Flash Region 2 (ME) Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 785 22.1.11FREG3—Flash Region 3 (GbE) Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 785 22.1.12FREG4—Flash Region 4 (Platform Data) Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 786 22.1.13PR0—Protected Range 0 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 786 22.1.14PR1—Protected Range 1 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 787 22.1.15PR2—Protected Range 2 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 788 22.1.16PR3—Protected Range 3 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 788 22.1.17PR4—Protected Range 4 Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 789 22.1.18SSFS—Software Sequencing Flash Status Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 790 22.1.19SSFC—Software Sequencing Flash Control Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 791 22.1.20PREOP—Prefix Opcode Configuration Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 792 22.1.21OPTYPE—Opcode Type Configuration Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 792 22.1.22OPMENU—Opcode Menu Configuration Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 793 22.1.23BBAR—BIOS Base Address Configuration Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 794 22.1.24FDOC—Flash Descriptor Observability Control Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 794 22.1.25FDOD—Flash Descriptor Observability Data Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 795 22.1.26AFC—Additional Flash Control Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 795 22.1.27LVSCC— Host Lower Vendor Specific Component Capabilities Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 796 22.1.28UVSCC— Host Upper Vendor Specific Component Capabilities Register (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 797 22.1.29FPB — Flash Partition Boundary (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers).......................................... 799 Flash Descriptor Registers................................................................................. 800 22.2.1 Flash Descriptor Content........................................................................ 800 22.2.2 Flash Descriptor Component Section ....................................................... 802 22.2.3 Flash Descriptor Region Section .............................................................. 805 22.2.4 Flash Descriptor Master Section .............................................................. 807 22.2.5 Descriptor Upper Map Section................................................................. 810 22.2.6 Intel ME Vendor Specific Component Capabilities Table .............................. 810 OEM Section ................................................................................................... 815 GbE SPI Flash Program Registers ....................................................................... 815 22.4.1 GLFPR –Gigabit LAN Flash Primary Region Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 816 22.4.2 HSFS—Hardware Sequencing Flash Status Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 817 22.4.3 HSFC—Hardware Sequencing Flash Control Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 818 22.4.4 FADDR—Flash Address Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 818 22.4.5 FDATA0—Flash Data 0 Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 819 22.4.6 FRAP—Flash Regions Access Permissions Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 820 Datasheet 22.4.7 FREG0—Flash Region 0 (Flash Descriptor) Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 821 22.4.8 FREG1—Flash Region 1 (BIOS Descriptor) Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 821 22.4.9 FREG2—Flash Region 2 (ME) Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 821 22.4.10FREG3—Flash Region 3 (GbE) Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 822 22.4.11FPR0—Flash Protected Range 0 Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 822 22.4.12FPR1—Flash Protected Range 1 Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 823 22.4.13SSFS—Software Sequencing Flash Status Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 824 22.4.14SSFC—Software Sequencing Flash Control Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 825 22.4.15PREOP—Prefix Opcode Configuration Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 826 22.4.16OPTYPE—Opcode Type Configuration Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 826 22.4.17OPMENU—Opcode Menu Configuration Register (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) .................................. 827 23 Thermal Sensor Registers (D31:F6) ....................................................................... 829 23.1 PCI Bus Configuration Registers ........................................................................ 829 23.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification..................................................................... 830 23.1.2 DID—Device Identification ..................................................................... 830 23.1.3 CMD—Command .................................................................................. 830 23.1.4 STS—Status ........................................................................................ 831 23.1.5 RID—Revision Identification ................................................................... 831 23.1.6 PI— Programming Interface................................................................... 831 23.1.7 SCC—Sub Class Code ........................................................................... 832 23.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code .......................................................................... 832 23.1.9 CLS—Cache Line Size............................................................................ 832 23.1.10LT—Latency Timer................................................................................ 832 23.1.11BIST—Built-in Self Test ......................................................................... 833 23.1.12TBAR—Thermal Base ............................................................................ 833 23.1.13TBARH—Thermal Base High DWord......................................................... 833 23.1.14SVID—Subsystem Vendor ID ................................................................. 834 23.1.15SID—Subsystem ID .............................................................................. 834 23.1.16CAP_PTR —Capabilities Pointer............................................................... 834 23.1.17Offset 3Ch – INTLN—Interrupt Line......................................................... 834 23.1.18INTPN—Interrupt Pin ............................................................................ 835 23.1.19TBARB—BIOS Assigned Thermal Base Address ......................................... 835 23.1.20TBARBH—BIOS Assigned Thermal Base High DWord ................................. 835 23.1.21PID—PCI Power Management Capability ID .............................................. 836 23.1.22PC—Power Management Capabilities ....................................................... 836 23.1.23PCS—Power Management Control And Status ........................................... 837 23.2 Thermal Memory Mapped Configuration Registers (Thermal Sensor - D31:F26) ............................................................................. 838 23.2.1 TSxE—Thermal Sensor [1:0] Enable ....................................................... 838 23.2.2 TSxS—Thermal Sensor[1:0] Status......................................................... 839 23.2.3 TSxTTP—Thermal Sensor [1:0] Catastrophic Trip Point .............................. 839 23.2.4 TSxCO—Thermal Sensor [1:0] Catastrophic Lock-Down............................. 839 23.2.5 TSxPC—Thermal Sensor [1:0] Policy Control ............................................ 840 23.2.6 TSxLOCK—Thermal Sensor [1:0] Register Lock Control ............................. 840 Datasheet 23 Figures 2-1 2-1 4-1 5-1 5-2 5-3 5-4 5-5 5-6 5-7 5-8 5-9 5-10 5-11 5-12 5-13 5-14 5-15 5-16 5-17 6-1 6-2 7-1 7-2 7-3 8-1 8-2 8-3 8-4 8-5 8-6 8-7 8-8 8-9 8-10 8-11 8-12 8-13 8-14 8-15 8-16 8-17 8-18 8-19 8-20 8-21 8-22 8-23 8-24 8-25 24 Intel® ICH10 Interface Signals Block Diagram..........................................................46 Example External RTC Circuit.................................................................................79 ICH10 Conceptual System Clock Diagram ................................................................92 Generation of SERR# to Platform ...........................................................................99 LPC Interface Diagram ........................................................................................ 107 Intel® ICH10 DMA Controller ............................................................................... 112 DMA Request Assertion through LDRQ# ................................................................ 115 Coprocessor Error Timing Diagram ....................................................................... 140 TCO Legacy/Compatible Mode SMBus Configuration ................................................ 169 Advanced TCO Intel® ME SMBus/SMLink Configuration............................................ 171 Advanced TCO BMC Mode SMBus/SMLink Configuration ........................................... 172 Serial Post over GPIO Reference Circuit ................................................................. 174 SATA Power States ............................................................................................. 181 Flow for Port Enable / Device Present Bits.............................................................. 183 Serial Data transmitted over the SGPIO Interface ................................................... 188 USB Legacy Keyboard Flow Diagram ..................................................................... 198 Intel® ICH10-USB Port Connections Default Six and Six Configuration ...................... 206 Intel® ICH10-USB Port Connections Eight and Four Configuration ............................ 206 Flash Partition Boundary ..................................................................................... 231 Flash Descriptor Sections .................................................................................... 232 Intel® ICH10 Ballout (Top view–Left Side) ............................................................. 244 Intel® ICH10 Ballout (Top view–Right Side) ........................................................... 245 Intel® ICH10 Package (Top View)......................................................................... 253 Intel® ICH10 Package (Bottom View).................................................................... 254 Intel® ICH10 Package (Side View)........................................................................ 254 Clock Timing...................................................................................................... 280 Valid Delay from Rising Clock Edge ....................................................................... 280 Setup and Hold Times......................................................................................... 281 Float Delay........................................................................................................ 281 Pulse Width ....................................................................................................... 281 Output Enable Delay........................................................................................... 281 USB Rise and Fall Times ...................................................................................... 282 USB Jitter ......................................................................................................... 282 USB EOP Width .................................................................................................. 282 SMBus Transaction ............................................................................................. 283 SMBus Timeout.................................................................................................. 283 SPI Timings ....................................................................................................... 284 Intel® High Definition Audio Input and Output Timings ............................................ 284 Power Sequencing and Reset Signal Timings .......................................................... 285 G3 (Mechanical Off) to S0 Timings........................................................................ 286 S0 to S1 to S0 Timings ....................................................................................... 287 S0 to S5 to S0 Timings ....................................................................................... 287 C0 to C2 to C0 Timings ....................................................................................... 288 C0 to C3 to C0 Timings ....................................................................................... 288 C0 to C4 to C0 Timings ....................................................................................... 289 Sleep control signal relationship - Host boots and Intel Management Engine off .......... 290 Sleep control signal relationship - Host and Intel Management Engine boot after G3 ............................................................................................................ 290 Sleep control signal relationship - Host stays in S5 and Intel Management Engine boots after G3 ......................................................................................... 291 S4, S5/M1 to S0/M0 ........................................................................................... 291 S0 to S3/S4/S5 and G3 Timings ........................................................................... 291 Datasheet Tables 1-1 1-2 1-3 2-1 2-2 2-3 2-4 2-5 2-6 2-7 2-8 2-9 2-10 2-11 2-12 2-13 2-14 2-15 2-16 2-17 2-18 2-19 2-20 2-21 2-22 2-23 2-24 2-25 3-1 3-2 3-3 4-1 5-1 5-2 5-3 5-4 5-5 5-6 5-7 5-8 5-9 5-10 5-11 5-12 5-13 5-14 5-15 5-16 5-17 5-18 5-19 5-20 5-21 5-22 5-23 5-24 5-25 5-26 5-27 5-28 5-29 5-30 5-31 5-32 5-33 Industry Specifications ......................................................................................... 33 PCI Devices and Functions .................................................................................... 37 Intel® ICH10 Components .................................................................................... 44 Direct Media Interface Signals ............................................................................... 47 PCI Express* Signals............................................................................................ 48 LAN Connect Interface Signals ............................................................................... 48 Gigabit LAN Connect Interface Signals .................................................................... 49 Firmware Hub Interface Signals ............................................................................. 50 PCI Interface Signals............................................................................................ 50 Serial ATA Interface Signals .................................................................................. 52 LPC Interface Signals ........................................................................................... 55 Interrupt Signals ................................................................................................. 55 USB Interface Signals........................................................................................... 56 Power Management Interface Signals ..................................................................... 58 Processor Interface Signals ................................................................................... 61 SMBus Interface Signals ....................................................................................... 62 System Management Interface Signals ................................................................... 63 Real Time Clock Interface ..................................................................................... 64 Other Clocks ....................................................................................................... 65 Miscellaneous Signals ........................................................................................... 65 Intel® High Definition Audio Link Signals ................................................................ 66 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Signals.................................................................. 67 Controller Link Signals.......................................................................................... 68 Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals ................................................................ 68 JTAG Signals ....................................................................................................... 69 General Purpose I/O Signals.................................................................................. 70 Power and Ground Signals .................................................................................... 73 Functional Strap Definitions................................................................................... 75 Integrated Pull-Up and Pull-Down Resistors ............................................................. 81 Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations......................... 83 Power Plane for Input Signals for Configurations ...................................................... 88 Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains ................................................................ 91 PCI Bridge Initiator Cycle Types............................................................................. 93 Type 1 Address Format......................................................................................... 96 MSI versus PCI IRQ Actions................................................................................... 98 LAN Mode Support ............................................................................................. 103 LPC Cycle Types Supported ................................................................................. 108 Start Field Bit Definitions .................................................................................... 108 Cycle Type Bit Definitions ................................................................................... 109 Transfer Size Bit Definition.................................................................................. 109 SYNC Bit Definition ............................................................................................ 110 DMA Transfer Size ............................................................................................. 114 Address Shifting in 16-Bit I/O DMA Transfers......................................................... 114 Counter Operating Modes ................................................................................... 119 Interrupt Controller Core Connections................................................................... 121 Interrupt Status Registers................................................................................... 122 Content of Interrupt Vector Byte .......................................................................... 122 APIC Interrupt Mapping1 .................................................................................... 128 Interrupt Message Address Format....................................................................... 130 Interrupt Message Data Format ........................................................................... 131 Stop Frame Explanation...................................................................................... 133 Data Frame Format ............................................................................................ 134 Configuration Bits Reset by RTCRST# Assertion ..................................................... 137 INIT# Going Active ............................................................................................ 139 NMI Sources ..................................................................................................... 140 DP Signal Differences ......................................................................................... 141 General Power States for Systems Using Intel® ICH10............................................ 143 State Transition Rules for Intel® ICH10 ................................................................ 144 System Power Plane........................................................................................... 145 Causes of SMI# and SCI ..................................................................................... 146 Break Events..................................................................................................... 149 Sleep Types ...................................................................................................... 151 Causes of Wake Events....................................................................................... 152 GPI Wake Events ............................................................................................... 153 Transitions Due to Power Failure .......................................................................... 154 Datasheet 25 5-34 5-35 5-36 5-37 5-38 5-39 5-40 5-41 5-42 5-43 5-44 5-45 5-46 5-47 5-48 5-49 5-50 5-51 5-52 5-53 5-54 5-55 5-56 5-57 5-58 5-59 5-60 5-61 5-62 6-1 8-1 8-2 8-3 8-4 8-5 8-6 8-7 8-8 8-9 8-10 8-11 8-12 8-13 8-14 8-15 8-16 8-17 8-18 8-19 8-20 8-21 8-22 9-1 9-2 9-3 9-4 10-1 11-1 12-1 12-2 13-1 13-2 13-3 13-4 13-5 26 Transitions Due to Power Button .......................................................................... 155 Transitions Due to RI# Signal .............................................................................. 157 Write Only Registers with Read Paths in ALT Access Mode........................................ 159 PIC Reserved Bits Return Values .......................................................................... 161 Register Write Accesses in ALT Access Mode .......................................................... 161 Intel® ICH10 Clock Inputs ................................................................................... 164 Causes of Host and Global Resets ......................................................................... 166 Event Transitions that Cause Messages ................................................................. 170 Multi-activity LED message type ........................................................................... 187 Legacy Replacement Routing ............................................................................... 190 Bits Maintained in Low Power States ..................................................................... 197 USB Legacy Keyboard State Transitions ................................................................ 198 UHCI vs. EHCI ................................................................................................... 201 Debug Port Behavior........................................................................................... 210 I2C Block Read................................................................................................... 218 Enable for SMBALERT# ....................................................................................... 221 Enables for SMBus Slave Write and SMBus Host Events ........................................... 221 Enables for the Host Notify Command ................................................................... 221 Slave Write Registers.......................................................................................... 223 Command Types ................................................................................................ 223 Slave Read Cycle Format..................................................................................... 224 Data Values for Slave Read Registers.................................................................... 225 Host Notify Format ............................................................................................. 227 Region Size versus Erase Granularity of Flash Components ...................................... 231 Region Access Control Table ................................................................................ 233 Hardware Sequencing Commands and Opcode Requirements ................................... 236 Flash Protection Mechanism Summary .................................................................. 237 Recommended Pinout for 8-Pin Serial Flash Device ................................................. 238 Recommended Pinout for 16-Pin Serial Flash Device ............................................... 239 Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name ................................................................... 246 Intel® ICH10 Absolute Maximum Ratings............................................................... 255 DC Current Characteristics (Consumer Only)1 ........................................................ 255 DC Current Characteristics (Corporate Only) .......................................................... 257 DC Characteristic Input Signal Association ............................................................. 258 DC Input Characteristics ..................................................................................... 260 DC Characteristic Output Signal Association ........................................................... 262 DC Output Characteristics ................................................................................... 264 Other DC Characteristics ..................................................................................... 266 Clock Timings .................................................................................................... 268 PCI Interface Timing........................................................................................... 269 Universal Serial Bus Timing ................................................................................. 270 SATA Interface Timings....................................................................................... 271 SMBus Timing.................................................................................................... 272 Intel® High Definition Audio Timing ...................................................................... 272 LPC Timing ........................................................................................................ 273 Miscellaneous Timings......................................................................................... 273 SPI Timings (20 MHz) ......................................................................................... 273 SPI Timings (33 MHz) ......................................................................................... 274 SST Timings ...................................................................................................... 274 PECI Timings ..................................................................................................... 275 Power Sequencing and Reset Signal Timings .......................................................... 275 Power Management Timings ................................................................................ 277 PCI Devices and Functions................................................................................... 294 Fixed I/O Ranges Decoded by Intel® ICH10 ........................................................... 296 Variable I/O Decode Ranges ................................................................................ 298 Memory Decode Ranges from Processor Perspective ............................................... 299 Chipset Configuration Register Memory Map (Memory Space)................................... 303 PCI Bridge Register Address Map (PCI-PCI—D30:F0)............................................... 355 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers Address Map (Gigabit LAN —D25:F0)....................................................................................... 371 Gigabit LAN Base Address A Registers Address Map (Gigabit LAN— D25:F0)....................................................................................... 384 LPC Interface PCI Register Address Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0)...................................... 387 DMA Registers ................................................................................................... 411 PIC Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) .......................................................................... 424 APIC Direct Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................................................... 433 APIC Indirect Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0)............................................................. 433 Datasheet 13-6 13-7 13-8 13-9 13-10 13-11 13-12 13-13 14-1 14-2 14-3 14-4 14-5 15-1 15-2 16-1 16-2 23-1 23-2 RTC I/O Registers .............................................................................................. 439 RTC (Standard) RAM Bank .................................................................................. 440 Processor Interface PCI Register Address Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0) ............................. 444 Power Management PCI Register Address Map (PM—D31:F0)................................... 447 APM Register Map .............................................................................................. 460 ACPI and Legacy I/O Register Map ....................................................................... 461 TCO I/O Register Address Map............................................................................. 483 Registers to Control GPIO Address Map................................................................. 491 SATA Controller PCI Register Address Map (SATA–D31:F2)...................................... 501 Bus Master IDE I/O Register Address Map ............................................................. 528 AHCI Register Address Map ................................................................................. 536 Generic Host Controller Register Address Map........................................................ 537 Port [5:0] DMA Register Address Map ................................................................... 545 SATA Controller PCI Register Address Map (SATA–D31:F5)...................................... 563 Bus Master IDE I/O Register Address Map ............................................................. 580 UHCI Controller PCI Configuration Map ................................................................. 589 UHCI Controller PCI Register Address Map (USB—D29:F0/F1/F2/F3, D26:F0/F1/F2)............................................................... 589 USB I/O Registers.............................................................................................. 602 Run/Stop, Debug Bit Interaction SWDBG (Bit 5), Run/Stop (Bit 0) Operation ............. 605 USB EHCI PCI Register Address Map (USB EHCI—D29:F7, D26:F7) .......................... 611 Enhanced Host Controller Capability Registers ....................................................... 631 Enhanced Host Controller Operational Register Address Map .................................... 635 Debug Port Register Address Map ........................................................................ 649 Intel® High Definition Audio PCI Register Address Map (Intel® High Definition Audio D27:F0) .................................................................. 653 Intel® High Definition Audio PCI Register Address Map (Intel® High Definition Audio D27:F0) .................................................................. 675 SMBus Controller PCI Register Address Map (SMBus—D31:F3)................................. 703 SMBus I/O and Memory Mapped I/O Register Address Map...................................... 710 PCI Express* Configuration Registers Address Map (PCI Express—D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5) ............................................................... 721 Memory-Mapped Registers .................................................................................. 767 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Register Address Map (SPI Memory Mapped Configuration Registers)....................................................... 777 Gigabit LAN SPI Flash Program Register Address Map (GbE LAN Memory Mapped Configuration Registers) ............................................... 815 Thermal Sensor Register Address Map .................................................................. 829 Thermal Memory Mapped Configuration Register Address Map ................................. 838 Datasheet 27 16-3 16-4 17-1 17-2 17-3 17-4 18-1 18-2 19-1 19-2 20-1 21-1 22-1 22-2 Revision History Revision Number -001 Description • Initial release. • • Added Intel ICH10 corporate components Added Notes 12 and 13 to Table 2-23, updated signal description for VccGLAN1_5 and VccGLAN3_3 in Table 2-24, and updated GPIO33 and GPIO49 strap definitions in Table 2-25. Updated register descriptions for USBIR1 (Section 10.1.82), USBIR2 (Section 10.1.83), and EHCIIR1 (Section 17.1.30) -002 • -003 28 • Updated Intel ICH10 corporate components table Revision Date June 2008 September 2008 October 2008 Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Features Datasheet Direct Media Interface — 10 Gb/s each direction, full duplex — Transparent to software PCI Express* — 6 PCI Express root ports — Supports PCI Express 1.1 — Ports 1-4 can be statically configured as 4x1, or 1x4 — Support for full 2.5 Gb/s bandwidth in each direction per x1 lane — Module based Hot-Plug supported (e.g., ExpressCard*) PCI Bus Interface — Supports PCI Rev 2.3 Specification at 33 MHz — Four available PCI REQ/GNT pairs — Support for 64-bit addressing on PCI using DAC protocol Integrated Serial ATA Host Controller — Up to six SATA ports — Data transfer rates up to 3.0 Gb/s (300 MB/s). — Integrated AHCI controller External SATA support — Port Disable Capability Intel® Matrix Storage Technology — Configures the ICH10 SATA controller as a RAID controller supporting RAID 0/1/5/10 Intel® High Definition Audio Interface — PCI Express endpoint — Independent Bus Master logic for eight general purpose streams: four input and four output — Support four external Codecs — Supports variable length stream slots — Supports multichannel, 32-bit sample depth, 192 kHz sample rate output — Provides mic array support — Allows for non-48 kHz sampling output — Support for ACPI Device States — Low Voltage Mode Intel® Quiet System Technology — Four TACH signals and three PWM signals — Improved algorithms for better performance Simple Serial Transport (SST) 1.0 Bus and Platform Environment Control Interface (PECI) USB 2.0 — Six UHCI Host Controllers, supporting up to twelve external ports — Two EHCI Host Controllers, supporting up to twelve external ports — Two Configuration Options for EHCI Controllers 6+6 and 8+4 — Per-Port-Disable Capability — Includes up to two USB 2.0 High-speed Debug Ports — Supports wake-up from sleeping states S1-S4 Supports legacy Keyboard/Mouse software Integrated Gigabit LAN Controller — Integrated ASF Management Controller — Network security with System Defense — Supports IEEE 802.3 — LAN Connect Interface (LCI) and Gigabit LAN Connect Interface (GLCI) — 10/100/1000 Mbps Ethernet Support — Jumbo Frame Support Intel® Active Management Technology with System Defense (Corporate Only) — Network Outbreak Containment Heuristics Intel® I/O Virtualization (VT-d) Support Intel® Trusted Execution Technology (Intel TXT) Support (Corporate Only) Power Management Logic — Supports ACPI 3.0b — ACPI-defined power states (C1, C2, C3, C4, S1, S3-S5) — ACPI Power Management Timer — SMI# generation — All registers readable/restorable for proper resume from 0 V suspend states — Support for APM-based legacy power management for non-ACPI implementations External Glue Integration — Integrated Pull-up, Pull-down and Series Termination resistors on processor I/F — Integrated Pull-down and Series resistors on USB Enhanced DMA Controller — Two cascaded 8237 DMA controllers — Supports LPC DMA 29 SMBus — Faster speed, up to 100 kbps — Flexible SMBus/SMLink architecture to optimize for ASF — Provides independent manageability bus through SMLink interface — Supports SMBus 2.0 Specification — Host interface allows processor to communicate via SMBus — Slave interface allows an internal or external Microcontroller to access system resources — Compatible with most two-wire components that are also I2C compatible High Precision Event Timers — Advanced operating system interrupt scheduling Timers Based on 82C54 — System timer, Refresh request, Speaker tone output Real-Time Clock — 256 Byte battery-backed CMOS RAM — Integrated oscillator components — Lower Power DC/DC Converter implementation System TCO Reduction Circuits — Timers to generate SMI# and Reset upon detection of system hang — Timers to detect improper processor reset — Integrated processor frequency strap logic — Supports ability to disable external devices Note: 30 Interrupt Controller — Supports up to eight PCI interrupt pins — Supports PCI 2.3 Message Signaled Interrupts — Two cascaded 82C59 with 15 interrupts — Integrated I/O APIC capability with 24 interrupts — Supports Processor System Bus interrupt delivery 1.1 V operation with 1.5 and 3.3 V I/O — 5 V tolerant buffers on PCI, USB and selected Legacy signals 1.1 V Core Voltage Five Integrated Voltage Regulators for different power rails Firmware Hub I/F supports BIOS Memory size up to 8 MBytes Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) — Supports up to two SPI devices — Supports 20 MHz and 33 MHz SPI devices — NEW: Dual erase support Low Pin Count (LPC) I/F — Supports two Master/DMA devices. — Support for Security Device (Trusted Platform Module) connected to LPC. GPIO — TTL, Open-Drain, Inversion — GPIO lock down NEW: JTAG (Corporate Only) — Boundary Scan for testing during board manufacturing Package 31x31 mm 676 mBGA Not all features are available on all ICH10 components. See Section 1.3 for more details. Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Configuration DMI (To (G)MCH) USB 2.0 Power Management (Supports 12 USB ports Dual EHCI Controller) Clock Generators SATA (6 ports) System Management (TCO) Intel® ICH10 Intel® High Definition Audio Codec(s) SMBus 2.0/I2C PCI Express* x1 Intel® Gigabit Ethernet Phy GLCI SPI BIOS Flash PCI Bus LCI JTAG* (Corporate Only) GPIO LPC I/F S L O T ... S L O T Other ASICs (Optional) Super I/O TPM (Optional) Firmware Hub §§ Datasheet 31 32 Datasheet Introduction 1 Introduction This document is intended for Original Equipment Manufacturers and BIOS vendors creating Intel® I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10) Family based products. This document is for the following components: Consumer Family • Intel® 82801JIB ICH10 Consumer Base (ICH10) • Intel® 82801JIR ICH10 RAID (ICH10R) Corporate Family • Intel® 82801JD ICH10 Corporate Base (ICH10D) • Intel® 82801JDO ICH10 Digital Office (ICH10DO) Section 1.3 provides high-level feature differences for the ICH10 Family components. Note: Throughout this document, ICH10 is used as a general ICH10 term and refers to the Intel 82801JIB ICH10, Intel 82801JIR ICH10R, Intel 82801JD ICH10D, Intel 82801JDO ICH10DO components, unless specifically noted otherwise. Note: Throughout this document, the term “Consumer Only” refers to information that is for the Intel 82801JIB ICH10 and Intel 82801JIR ICH10R, unless specifically noted otherwise. The term “Corporate Only” refers to information that is for the Intel 82801JD ICH10D and 82801JDO ICH10DO, unless specifically noted otherwise. 1.1 About This Manual This manual assumes a working knowledge of the vocabulary and principles of PCI Express*, USB, AHCI, SATA, Intel® High Definition Audio (Intel® HD Audio), SMBus, PCI, ACPI, and LPC. Although some details of these features are described within this manual, refer to the individual industry specifications listed in Table 1-1 for the complete details. Table 1-1. Industry Specifications Specification Location PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.1 http://www.pcisig.com/specifications Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1 (LPC) http://developer.intel.com/design/chipsets/ industry/lpc.htm System Management Bus Specification, Version 2.0 (SMBus) http://www.smbus.org/specs/ PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3 (PCI) http://www.pcisig.com/specifications PCI Power Management Specification, Revision 1.1 http://www.pcisig.com/specifications Universal Serial Bus Specification (USB), Revision 2.0 http://www.usb.org/developers/docs Advanced Configuration and Power Interface, Version 3.0b (ACPI) http://www.acpi.info/spec.htm Universal Host Controller Interface, Revision 1.1 (UHCI) http://developer.intel.com/design/USB/ UHCI11D.htm DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 33 Introduction Table 1-1. Industry Specifications Specification Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 (EHCI) http://developer.intel.com/technology/usb/ ehcispec.htm Serial ATA Specification, Revision 2.5 http://www.serialata.org/specifications.asp Serial ATA II: Extensions to Serial ATA 1.0, Revision 1.0 http://www.serialata.org/specifications.asp Serial ATA II Cables and Connectors Volume 2 Gold http://www.serialata.org/specifications.asp Alert Standard Format Specification, Version 1.03 http://www.dmtf.org/standards/asf IEEE 802.3 Fast Ethernet http://standards.ieee.org/getieee802/ AT Attachment - 6 with Packet Interface (ATA/ ATAPI - 6) http://T13.org (T13 1410D) IA-PC HPET (High Precision Event Timers) Specification, Revision 0.98a http://www.intel.com/hardwaredesign/ hpetspec.htm TPM Specification 1.02, Level 2 Revision 103 http://www.trustedcomputinggroup.org/specs/ TPM Intel® I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10) Family Specification Update http://www.intel.com/design/chipsets/ specupdt/319974.pdf Intel® I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10) Family Thermal and Mechanical Design Guidelines http://www.intel.com/design/chipsets/ designex/319975.pdf ® Intel ICH10 EDS Spec. Update, Latest Revision Intel® ICH10 Chipset Mechanical Ballout File, Latest Revision Intel® ICH10 Family XOR Chains In-Circuit Tester Package, Revision TBD ® Intel ICH10 IBIS Model, Revision Latest Revision 34 Location Intel Users: http://esales.intel.com Search for “ICH10” External Users: http://www.intel.com/ibl Chipsets > South Bridges/IO Controller Hub > ICH Family > ICH10 > Technical Intel Users: http://esales.intel.com Search for “ICH10” External Users: http://www.intel.com/ibl Chipsets > South Bridges/IO Controller Hub > ICH Family > ICH10 > Technical DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Introduction Chapter 1. Introduction Chapter 1 introduces the ICH10 and provides information on manual organization and gives a general overview of the ICH10. Chapter 2. Signal Description Chapter 2 provides a block diagram of the ICH10 and a detailed description of each signal. Signals are arranged according to interface and details are provided as to the drive characteristics (Input/Output, Open-drain, etc.) of all signals. Chapter 3. Intel® ICH10 Pin States Chapter 3 provides a complete list of signals, their associated power well, their logic level in each suspend state, and their logic level before and after reset. Chapter 4. Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains Chapter 4 provides a list of each clock domain associated with the ICH10 in an ICH10 based system. Chapter 5. Functional Description Chapter 5 provides a detailed description of the functions in the ICH10. All PCI buses, devices and functions in this manual are abbreviated using the following nomenclature; Bus:Device:Function. This manual abbreviates buses as B0 and B1, devices as D8, D27, D28, D29, D30 and D31 and functions as F0, F1, F2, F3, F4, F5, F6 and F7. For example Device 31 Function 0 is abbreviated as D31:F0, Bus 1 Device 8 Function 0 is abbreviated as B1:D8:F0. Generally, the bus number will not be used, and can be considered to be Bus 0. Note that the ICH10’s external PCI bus is typically Bus 1, but may be assigned a different number depending upon system configuration. Chapter 6. Ballout Definition Chapter 6 provides a table of each signal and its ball assignment in the 676-mBGA package. Chapter 7. Package Information Chapter 7 provides drawings of the physical dimensions and characteristics of the 676mBGA package. Chapter 8. Electrical Characteristics Chapter 8 provides all AC and DC characteristics including detailed timing diagrams. Chapter 9. Register and Memory Mappings Chapter 9 provides an overview of the registers, fixed I/O ranges, variable I/O ranges and memory ranges decoded by the ICH10. Chapter 10. Chipset Configuration Registers Chapter 10 provides a detailed description of all registers and base functionality that is related to chipset configuration and not a specific interface (such as LPC, PCI, or PCI Express*). It contains the root complex register block, which describes the behavior of the upstream internal link. Chapter 11. PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers Chapter 11 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the PCI-to-PCI bridge. This bridge resides at Device 30, Function 0 (D30:F0). Chapter 12. Integrated LAN Controller Registers Chapter 12 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the ICH10’s integrated LAN controller. The integrated LAN Controller resides at Device 25, Function 0 (D25:F0). DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 35 Introduction Chapter 13. LPC Bridge Registers Chapter 13 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the LPC bridge. This bridge resides at Device 31, Function 0 (D31:F0). This function contains registers for many different units within the ICH10 including DMA, Timers, Interrupts, Processor Interface, GPIO, Power Management, System Management and RTC. Chapter 14. SATA Controller Registers Chapter 14 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the SATA controller #1. This controller resides at Device 31, Function 2 (D31:F2). Chapter 15. SATA Controller Registers Chapter 15 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the SATA controller #2. This controller resides at Device 31, Function 5 (D31:F5). Chapter 16. UHCI Controller Registers Chapter 16 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the six UHCI host controllers. These controllers reside at Device 29, Functions 0, 1, 2, and 3 (D29:F0/F1/F2/F3) and Device 26, Function 0, 1 and 2 (D26:F0/F1/F2). Chapter 17. EHCI Controller Registers Chapter 17 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the two EHCI host controllers. These controllers reside at Device 29, Function 7 (D29:F7) and Device 26, Function 7 (D26:F7). Chapter 18. SMBus Controller Registers Chapter 19 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the SMBus controller. This controller resides at Device 31, Function 3 (D31:F3). Chapter 19. Intel® High Definition Audio Controller Registers Chapter 18 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the Intel High Definition Audio controller. This controller resides at Device 27, Function 0 (D27:F0). Chapter 20. PCI Express* Port Controller Registers Chapter 20 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the PCI Express controller. This controller resides at Device 28, Functions 0 to 5 (D30:F0-F5). Chapter 21. High Precision Event Timers Registers Chapter 21 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the multimedia timer memory mapped register space. Chapter 22. Serial Peripheral Interface Registers Chapter 22 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the SPI memory mapped register space. Chapter 23. Thermal Sensors Chapter 23 provides a detailed description of all registers that reside in the thermal sensors PCI configuration space. The registers reside at Device 31, Function 6 (D31:F6). 36 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Introduction 1.2 Overview The ICH10 provides extensive I/O support. Functions and capabilities include: • PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.1 support • PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3 support for 33 MHz PCI operations (supports up to four Req/Gnt pairs). • ACPI Power Management Logic Support, Revision 3.0b • Enhanced DMA controller, interrupt controller, and timer functions • Integrated Serial ATA host controllers with independent DMA operation on up to six ports. • USB host interface with support for up to twelve USB ports; six UHCI host controllers; two EHCI high-speed USB 2.0 Host controllers • Integrated 10/100/1000 Gigabit Ethernet MAC with System Defense • System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 with additional support for I2C devices • Supports Intel® High Definition Audio • Supports Intel® Matrix Storage Technology • Supports Intel® Active Management Technology (Corporate Only) • Supports Intel® Virtualization Technology for Directed I/O • Supports Intel® Trusted Execution Technology (Corporate Only) • Low Pin Count (LPC) interface • Firmware Hub (FWH) interface support • Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) support • Intel® Quiet System Technology • Integrated TPM 1.2 (Corporate Only) • JTAG Boundary Scan support (Corporate Only) The Intel ICH10 incorporates a variety of PCI devices and functions, as shown in Table 1-2. They are divided into seven logical devices. The first is the DMI-To-PCI bridge (Device 30). The second device (Device 31) contains most of the standard PCI functions that always existed in the PCI-to-ISA bridges (South Bridges), such as the Intel PIIX4. The third and fourth (Device 29 and Device 26) are the USB host controller devices. The fifth (Device 28) is PCI Express device. The sixth (Device 27) is the HD Audio controller device, and the seventh (Device 25) is the Gigabit Ethernet controller device. Table 1-2. PCI Devices and Functions (Sheet 1 of 2) Bus:Device:Function Function Description Bus 0:Device 30:Function 0 DMI-to-PCI Bridge Bus 0:Device 31:Function 0 LPC Controller1 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 2 SATA Controller #1 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 5 SATA Controller #23 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 6 Thermal Subsystem Bus 0:Device 31:Function 3 SMBus Controller Bus 0:Device 29:Function 0 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #1 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 37 Introduction Table 1-2. PCI Devices and Functions (Sheet 2 of 2) Bus:Device:Function Function Description Bus 0:Device 29:Function 1 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #2 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 2 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #3 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 3 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #62 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 7 USB HS EHCI Controller #1 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 0 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #4 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 1 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #5 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 2 USB FS/LS UHCI Controller #62 Bus 0:Device 26:Fucntion 7 USB HS EHCI Controller #2 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 0 PCI Express* Port 1 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 1 PCI Express Port 2 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 2 PCI Express Port 3 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 3 PCI Express Port 4 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 4 PCI Express Port 5 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 5 PCI Express Port 6 Bus 0:Device 27:Function 0 Intel® High Definition Audio Controller Bus 0:Device 25:Function 0 Gigabit Ethernet Controller NOTES: 1. The PCI-to-LPC bridge contains registers that control LPC, Power Management, System Management, GPIO, Processor Interface, RTC, Interrupts, Timers, and DMA 2. Device 26:Function 2 maybe configured as Device 29:Function 3 during BIOS Post. 3. SATA Controller 2 is only visible when D31:F2 CC.SCC=01h. 38 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Introduction 1.2.1 Capability Overview The following sub-sections provide an overview of the ICH10 capabilities. Direct Media Interface (DMI) Direct Media Interface (DMI) is the chip-to-chip connection between the Memory Controller Hub / Graphics Memory Controller Hub ((G)MCH) and I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10). This high-speed interface integrates advanced priority-based servicing allowing for concurrent traffic and true isochronous transfer capabilities. Base functionality is completely software-transparent, permitting current and legacy software to operate normally. PCI Express* Interface The ICH10 provides up to 6 PCI Express Root Ports, supporting the PCI Express Base Specification, Revision 1.1. Each Root Port supports 2.5 GB/s bandwidth in each direction (5 GB/s concurrent). PCI Express Root Ports 1–4 can be statically configured as four x1 Ports or ganged together to form one x4 port. Ports 5 and 6 can only be used as two x1 ports. Note: The integrated Gigabit Ethernet controllers data lines for 1000 MB/s speed are multiplexed with PCI Express* Root Port 6 and therefore unavailable if a Gigabit Ethernet PHY is connected. The use of a 10/100 MB/s PHY does not consume PCI Express Root Port 6 and therefore the port is available to be utilized as a x1 Port. Serial ATA (SATA) Controller The ICH10 has two integrated SATA host controllers that support independent DMA operation on up to six ports and supports data transfer rates of up to 3.0 GB/s (300 MB/s). The SATA controller contains two modes of operation – a legacy mode using I/O space, and an AHCI mode using memory space. Software that uses legacy mode will not have AHCI capabilities. The ICH10 supports the Serial ATA Specification, Revision 1.0a. The ICH10 also supports several optional sections of the Serial ATA II: Extensions to Serial ATA 1.0 Specification, Revision 1.0 (AHCI support is required for some elements). AHCI The ICH10 provides hardware support for Advanced Host Controller Interface (AHCI), a new programming interface for SATA host controllers. Platforms supporting AHCI may take advantage of performance features such as no master/slave designation for SATA devices—each device is treated as a master—and hardware-assisted native command queuing. AHCI also provides usability enhancements such as Hot-Plug. AHCI requires appropriate software support (e.g., an AHCI driver) and for some features, hardware support in the SATA device or additional platform hardware. See Section 1.3 for details on component feature availability. Intel® Matrix Storage Technology The ICH10 provides support for Intel® Matrix Storage Technology, providing both AHCI (see above for details on AHCI) and integrated RAID functionality. The industry-leading RAID capability provides high-performance RAID 0, 1, 5, and 10 functionality on up to 6 SATA ports of ICH10. Matrix RAID support is provided to allow multiple RAID levels to be combined on a single set of hard drives, such as RAID 0 and RAID 1 on two disks. Other RAID features include hot spare support, SMART alerting, and RAID 0 auto replace. Software components include an Option ROM for pre-boot configuration and DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 39 Introduction boot functionality, a Microsoft Windows* compatible driver, and a user interface for configuration and management of the RAID capability of ICH10. See Section 1.3 for details on component feature availability. PCI Interface The ICH10 PCI interface provides a 33 MHz, Revision 2.3 implementation. The ICH10 integrates a PCI arbiter that supports up to four external PCI bus masters in addition to the internal ICH10 requests. This allows for combinations of up to four PCI down devices and PCI slots. Low Pin Count (LPC) Interface The ICH10 implements an LPC Interface as described in the LPC 1.1 Specification. The Low Pin Count (LPC) bridge function of the ICH10 resides in PCI Device 31:Function 0. In addition to the LPC bridge interface function, D31:F0 contains other functional units including DMA, interrupt controllers, timers, power management, system management, GPIO, and RTC. Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) The ICH10 implements an SPI Interface as an alternative interface for the BIOS flash device. An SPI flash device can be used as a replacement for the FWH, and is required to support Gigabit Ethernet, Intel® Active Management Technology, and integrated Intel® Quiet System Technology. The ICH10 supports up to two SPI flash devices with speed up to 33 MHz using two chip select pins. Compatibility Modules (DMA Controller, Timer/Counters, Interrupt Controller) The DMA controller incorporates the logic of two 82C37 DMA controllers, with seven independently programmable channels. Channels 0–3 are hardwired to 8-bit, count-bybyte transfers, and channels 5–7 are hardwired to 16-bit, count-by-word transfers. Any two of the seven DMA channels can be programmed to support fast Type-F transfers. Channel 4 is reserved as a generic bus master request. The ICH10 supports LPC DMA, which is similar to ISA DMA, through the ICH10’s DMA controller. LPC DMA is handled through the use of the LDRQ# lines from peripherals and special encoding on LAD[3:0] from the host. Single, Demand, Verify, and Increment modes are supported on the LPC interface. The timer/counter block contains three counters that are equivalent in function to those found in one 82C54 programmable interval timer. These three counters are combined to provide the system timer function, and speaker tone. The 14.31818 MHz oscillator input provides the clock source for these three counters. The ICH10 provides an ISA-Compatible Programmable Interrupt Controller (PIC) that incorporates the functionality of two, 82C59 interrupt controllers. The two interrupt controllers are cascaded so that 14 external and two internal interrupts are possible. In addition, the ICH10 supports a serial interrupt scheme. All of the registers in these modules can be read and restored. This is required to save and restore system state after power has been removed and restored to the platform. Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC) In addition to the standard ISA compatible Programmable Interrupt controller (PIC) described in the previous section, the ICH10 incorporates the Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC). 40 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Introduction Universal Serial Bus (USB) Controllers The ICH10 contains up to two Enhanced Host Controller Interface (EHCI) host controllers that support USB high-speed signaling. High-speed USB 2.0 allows data transfers up to 480 Mb/s which is 40 times faster than full-speed USB. The ICH10 also contains up to six Universal Host Controller Interface (UHCI) controllers that support USB full-speed and low-speed signaling. The ICH10 supports up to twelve USB 2.0 ports. All twelve ports are high-speed, fullspeed, and low-speed capable. ICH10’s port-routing logic determines whether a USB port is controlled by one of the UHCI or EHCI controllers. See Section 5.18 and Section 5.19 for details. Gigabit Ethernet Controller The Gigabit Ethernet Controller provides a system interface via a PCI function. The controller provides a full memory-mapped or IO mapped interface along with a 64 bit address master support for systems using more than 4 GB of physical memory and DMA (Direct Memory Addressing) mechanisms for high performance data transfers. Its bus master capabilities enable the component to process high-level commands and perform multiple operations; this lowers processor utilization by off-loading communication tasks from the processor. Two large configurable transmit and receive FIFOs (up to 20 KB each) help prevent data underruns and overruns while waiting for bus accesses. This enables the integrated LAN controller to transmit data with minimum interframe spacing (IFS). The LAN controller can operate at multiple speeds (10/100/1000 MB/s) and in either full duplex or half duplex mode. In full duplex mode the LAN controller adheres with the IEEE 802.3x Flow Control Specification. Half duplex performance is enhanced by a proprietary collision reduction mechanism. See Section 5.3 for details. RTC The ICH10 contains a Motorola MC146818A-compatible real-time clock with 256 bytes of battery-backed RAM. The real-time clock performs two key functions: keeping track of the time of day and storing system data, even when the system is powered down. The RTC operates on a 32.768 KHz crystal and a 3 V battery. The RTC also supports two lockable memory ranges. By setting bits in the configuration space, two 8-byte ranges can be locked to read and write accesses. This prevents unauthorized reading of passwords or other system security information. The RTC also supports a date alarm that allows for scheduling a wake up event up to 30 days in advance, rather than just 24 hours in advance. GPIO Various general purpose inputs and outputs are provided for custom system design. The number of inputs and outputs varies depending on ICH10 configuration. Enhanced Power Management The ICH10’s power management functions include enhanced clock control and various low-power (suspend) states (e.g., Suspend-to-RAM and Suspend-to-Disk). A hardwarebased thermal management circuit permits software-independent entrance to lowpower states. The ICH10 contains full support for the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI) Specification, Revision 3.0a. DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 41 Introduction Intel® Active Management Technology (Intel® AMT) (Not available on all ICH10 components) Intel® Active Management Technology is the next generation of client manageability via the wired network. Intel AMT is a set of advanced manageability features developed as a direct result of IT customer feedback gained through Intel market research. With the new implementation of System Defense in ICH10, the advanced manageability feature set of Intel AMT is further enhanced. See Section 1.3 for details on component feature availability. Manageability In addition to Intel AMT, ICH10 integrates several functions designed to manage the system and lower the total cost of ownership (TCO) of the system. These system management functions are designed to report errors, diagnose the system, and recover from system lockups without the aid of an external microcontroller. • TCO Timer. The ICH10’s integrated programmable TCO timer is used to detect system locks. The first expiration of the timer generates an SMI# that the system can use to recover from a software lock. The second expiration of the timer causes a system reset to recover from a hardware lock. • Processor Present Indicator. The ICH10 looks for the processor to fetch the first instruction after reset. If the processor does not fetch the first instruction, the ICH10 will reboot the system. • ECC Error Reporting. When detecting an ECC error, the host controller has the ability to send one of several messages to the ICH10. The host controller can instruct the ICH10 to generate either an SMI#, NMI, SERR#, or TCO interrupt. • Function Disable. The ICH10 provides the ability to disable the following integrated functions: LAN, USB, LPC, Intel HD Audio, SATA, PCI Express or SMBus. Once disabled, these functions no longer decode I/O, memory, or PCI configuration space. Also, no interrupts or power management events are generated from the disabled functions. • Intruder Detect. The ICH10 provides an input signal (INTRUDER#) that can be attached to a switch that is activated by the system case being opened. The ICH10 can be programmed to generate an SMI# or TCO interrupt due to an active INTRUDER# signal. System Management Bus (SMBus 2.0) The ICH10 contains an SMBus Host interface that allows the processor to communicate with SMBus slaves. This interface is compatible with most I2C devices. Special I2C commands are implemented. The ICH10’s SMBus host controller provides a mechanism for the processor to initiate communications with SMBus peripherals (slaves). Also, the ICH10 supports slave functionality, including the Host Notify protocol. Hence, the host controller supports eight command protocols of the SMBus interface (see System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0): Quick Command, Send Byte, Receive Byte, Write Byte/Word, Read Byte/Word, Process Call, Block Read/Write, and Host Notify. ICH10’s SMBus also implements hardware-based Packet Error Checking for data robustness and the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) to dynamically provide address to all SMBus devices. 42 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Introduction Intel® High Definition Audio Controller The Intel® High Definition Audio Specification defines a digital interface that can be used to attach different types of codecs, such as audio and modem codecs. The ICH10 Intel® HD Audio controller supports up to 4 codecs. The link can operate at either 3.3 V or 1.5 V. With the support of multi-channel audio stream, 32-bit sample depth, and sample rate up to 192 kHz, the Intel® HD Audio controller provides audio quality that can deliver CE levels of audio experience. On the input side, the ICH10 adds support for an array of microphones. Intel® Quiet System Technology (Intel® QST) The ICH10 integrates four fan speed sensors (four TACH signals) and 3 fan speed controllers (three Pulse Width Modulator signals), which enables monitoring and controlling up to four fans on the system. With the new implementation of the singlewire Simple Serial Transport (SST) 1.0 bus and Platform Environmental Control Interface (PECI), the ICH10 provides an easy way to connect to SST-based thermal sensors and access the processor thermal data. In addition, coupled with the new sophisticated fan speed control algorithms, Intel® QST provides effective thermal and acoustic management for the platform. Note: Intel® Quiet System Technology functionality requires a correctly configured system, including an appropriate (G)MCH with Intel ME, Intel ME firmware, and system BIOS support. Intel® Trusted Platform Module (Corporate Only) The Intel Trusted Platform Module (Intel® TPM) implementation consists of firmware, Intel® Management Engine resources and dedicated hardware within the ICH and the (G)MCH. The Intel TPM supports all requirements of the TPM Specification Version 1.2, Revision 103, as published by the Trusted Computing Group. The Intel TPM behaves like a discrete TPM device, and can support third party applications, as well as Microsoft* specific functionality in the Windows Vista* OS. Note: Intel TPM functionality requires a correctly configured system, including an appropriate (G)MCH with Intel Management Engine firmware, ICH10 and SPI Flash. JTAG Boundary-Scan (Corporate Only) ICH10 adds the industry standard JTAG interface and enables Boundary-Scan in place of the XOR chains used in previous generations of the ICH. Boundary-Scan can be used to ensure device connectivity during the board manufacturing process. The JTAG interface allows system manufacturers to improve efficiency by using industry available tools to test the ICH on an assembled board. Since JTAG is a serial interface, it eliminates the need to create probe points for every pin in an XOR chain. This eases pin breakout and trace routing and simplifies the interface between the system and a bedof-nails tester. Note: Contact your local Intel Field Sales Representative for additional information about JTAG usage on ICH10. DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 43 Introduction 1.3 Intel® ICH10 Family High-Level Component Differences Table 1-3. Intel® ICH10 Components Feature Component Name Intel® Turbo Memory Support Intel® Matrix Storage Technology AHCI Consumer Corporate ICH10 ICH10R ICH10D ICH10DO ICH10 Consumer Base ICH10 RAID ICH10 Corporate Base ICH10 Digital Office No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes No 3 RAID 0/1/5/10 Support No Yes No Yes Basic No No Yes No Professional No No No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes4 Yes4 No No Viiv™ Processor Technology Support Yes Yes No No Intel® Remote Wake Technology (Intel® RWT) Support Yes Yes No No JTAG Boundary Scan No No Yes Yes Intel® Active Management Technology Release 5.0 Intel® Trusted Platform Module (Intel® TPM) Wake on VoIP Intel® NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Contact your local Intel Field Sales Representative for currently available ICH10 components. Table above shows feature difference between ICH10 components. If a feature is not listed in the table it is considered a Base feature that is included in all components. ICH10 Consumer Base provides hardware support for AHCI functionality when enabled by appropriate system configuration and software driver. Wake on VoIP support provided by Intel® Remote Wake Technology (Intel® RWT) Support. All components support 6 SATA, 6 PCIe*, and 14 USB ports. §§ 44 DatasheetCDI / IBL #: 373635 Signal Description 2 Signal Description This chapter provides a detailed description of each signal. The signals are arranged in functional groups according to their associated interface. The “#” symbol at the end of the signal name indicates that the active, or asserted state occurs when the signal is at a low voltage level. When “#” is not present, the signal is asserted when at the high voltage level. The following notations are used to describe the signal type: I Input Pin O Output Pin OD O Open-drain Output Pin. I/OD Bi-directional Input/Open-drain Output Pin. I/O Bi-directional Input / Output Pin. The “Type” for each signal is indicative of the functional operating mode of the signal. Unless otherwise noted in Section 3.2 or Section 3.3, a signal is considered to be in the functional operating mode after RTCRST# deasserts for signals in the RTC well, after RSMRST# deasserts for signals in the suspend well, after PWROK asserts for signals in the core well, and after LAN_RST# deasserts for signals in the LAN well. Datasheet 45 Signal Description Figure 2-1. Intel® ICH10 Interface Signals Block Diagram AD[31:0] C/BE[3:0]# DEVSEL# FRAME# IRDY# TRDY# STOP# PAR PERR# REQ0# REQ1#/GPIO50 REQ2#/GPIO52 REQ3#/GPIO54 GNT0# GNT1#/GPIO51 GNT2#/GPIO53 GNT3#/GPIO55 SERR# PME# PCICLK PCIRST# PLOCK# A20M# FERR# IGNNE# INIT# INIT3_3V# INTR NMI SMI# STPCLK# RCIN# A20GATE CPUPWRGD DPSLP# SPI_CS0# SPI_CS1#/GPIO58 § SPI_MISO SPI_MOSI Gigabit LAN Connect Interface Controller Link PCI Interface PCI Express* Interface Serial ATA Interface Processor Interface Power Mgnt. SPI SPI_CLK SERIRQ PIRQ[D:A]# PIRQ[H:E]#/GPIO[5:2] Interrupt Interface USB[11:0]P; USB[11:0]N OC0#/GPIO59; OC1#/GPIO40 OC2#/GPIO41; OC3#/GPIO42 OC4#/GPIO43; OC5#/GPIO29 OC6#/GPIO30; OC7#/GPIO31 OC8#/GPIO44; OC9#/GPIO45 OC10#/GPIO46; OC11#/GPIO47 USBRBIAS USBRBIAS# USB RTCX1 RTCX2 RTC CLK14 CLK48 SATA_CLKP, SATA_CLKN DMI_CLKP, DMI_CLKN INTVRMEN SPKR SRTCRST#; RTCRST# TP[5:4] TP7 TP6 GPIO72 † / TP0 § LAN100_SLP Misc. Signals GPIO[72,49,34,33,32,28, 27,20,18,16,13,12,0] General Purpose I/O PWM[2:0] TACH0/GPIO17; TACH1/GPIO1 TACH2/GPIO6; TACH3/GPIO7 SST PECI Fan Speed Control CL_CLK0 ; CL_DATA0 CL_VREF0 CL_RST0# PETp[5:1], PETn[5:1] PERp[5:1], PERn[5:1] GLAN_TXP/PETp6; GLAN_TXN/PETn6 GLAN_RXP/PERp6; GLAN_RXN/PERn6 SATA[5:0]TXP, SATA[5:0]TXN SATA[5:0]RXP, SATA[5:0]RXN SATARBIAS SATARBIAS# SATALED# SATACLKREQ#/GPIO35 SATA0GP/GPIO21 SATA1GP/GPIO19 SATA2GP/GPIO36 SATA3GP/GPIO37 SATA4GP SATA5GP SCLOCK/GPIO22 SLOAD/GPIO38 SDATAOUT0/GPIO39 SDATAOUT1/GPIO48 THRM# THRMTRIP# SYS_RESET# RSMRST# MCH_SYNC# SLP_S3# SLP_S4# SLP_S5#/GPIO63 † SLP_M# S4_STATE#/GPIO26 PWROK CLPWROK PWRBTN# RI# WAKE# SUS_STAT#/LPCPD/GPIO61† SUSCLK/GPIO62† LAN_RST# VRMPWRGD PLTRST# CK_PWRGD BMBUSY#/GPIO0 STP_PCI#/GPIO15 STP_CPU#/GPIO25 † DRAMPWROK † /GPIO8 DPRSTP# DPRSLPVR / GPIO16 Intel® High Definition Audio HDA_RST# HDA_SYNC HDA_BIT_CLK HDA_SDOUT HDA_SDIN[3:0] Direct Media Interface DMI[3:0]TXP, DMI[3:0]TXN DMI[3:0]RXP, DMI[3:0]RXN DMI_ZCOMP DMI_IRCOMP Firmware Hub Clocks LAN_RSTSYNC GLAN_CLK GLAN_TXP/PETp6; GLAN_TXN/PETn6 GLAN_RXP/PERp6; GLAN_RXN/PERn6 GLAN_COMPO GLAN_COMPI LPC Interface SMBus Interface System Mgnt. LAN Connect Interface JTAG (Corporate Only) FWH[3:0]/LAD[3:0] FWH4/LFRAME# LAD[3:0]/FWH[3:0] LFRAME#/FWH4 LDRQ0# LDRQ1#/GPIO23 SMBDATA SMBCLK GPIO11/SMBALERT#/JTAGTDO † INTRUDER#; SMLINK[1:0] LINKALERT#/GPIO60 GPIO24/MEM_LED; GPIO10/CPU_MISSING/JTAGTMS † GPIO14/JTAGTDI† GPIO57/TPM_PP/JTAGTCK † SPI_CS1#/GPIO58 § ; WOL_EN/GPIO9 GLAN_CLK LAN_RXD[2:0] LAN_TXD[2:0] LAN_RSTSYNC GPIO57/TPM_PP/JTAGTCK † GPIO10/CPU_MISSING/JTAGTMS † GPIO14/JTAGTDI† GPIO11/SMBALERT#/JTAGTDO † GPIO60/LINKALERT#/JTAGRST# † NOTES: 1. § symbol indicates a particular use of a pin is Cunsumer Only. 2. † symbol indicates a particular use of a pin is Corporate Only. 46 Datasheet Signal Description 2.1 Direct Media Interface (DMI) to Host Controller Table 2-1. Direct Media Interface Signals Name Datasheet Type Description DMI0TXP, DMI0TXN O Direct Media Interface Differential Transmit Pair 0 DMI0RXP, DMI0RXN I Direct Media Interface Differential Receive Pair 0 DMI1TXP, DMI1TXN O Direct Media Interface Differential Transmit Pair 1 DMI1RXP, DMI1RXN I Direct Media Interface Differential Receive Pair 1 DMI2TXP, DMI2TXN O Direct Media Interface Differential Transmit Pair 2 DMI2RXP, DMI2RXN I Direct Media Interface Differential Receive Pair 2 DMI3TXP, DMI3TXN O Direct Media Interface Differential Transmit Pair 3 DMI3RXP, DMI3RXN I Direct Media Interface Differential Receive Pair 3 DMI_ZCOMP I Impedance Compensation Input: Determines DMI input impedance. DMI_IRCOMP O Impedance/Current Compensation Output: Determines DMI output impedance and bias current. 47 Signal Description 2.2 PCI Express* Interface Table 2-2. PCI Express* Signals Name Type Description PETp1, PETn1 O PCI Express* Differential Transmit Pair 1 PERp1, PERn1 I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 1 PETp2, PETn2 O PCI Express Differential Transmit Pair 2 PERp2, PERn2 I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 2 PETp3, PETn3 O PCI Express Differential Transmit Pair 3 PERp3, PERn3 I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 3 PETp4, PETn4 O PCI Express Differential Transmit Pair 4 PERp4, PERn4 I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 4 PETp5, PETn5 O PCI Express Differential Transmit Pair 5 PERp5, PERn5 I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 5 PETp6/ GLAN_TXp, PETn6/ GLAN_TXn O PCI Express Differential Transmit Pair 6: The differential pair will function as the Gigabit LAN Connect Interface transmit pair when the integrated Gigabit LAN controller is enabled. PERp6/ GLAN_RXp, PERn6/ GLAN_RXn I PCI Express Differential Receive Pair 6: The differential pair will function as the Gigabit LAN Connect Interface receive pair when the integrated Gigabit LAN controller is enabled. 2.3 LAN Connect Interface Table 2-3. LAN Connect Interface Signals Name Type Description Gigabit LAN Input Clock: Clock driven by the Platform LAN Connect device. The frequency will vary depending on link speed. GLAN_CLK I NOTE: The clock is shared between the LAN Connect Interface and the Gigabit LAN Connect Interface. LAN_RXD[2:0] 48 I Received Data: The Platform LAN Connect device uses these signals to transfer data and control information to the integrated LAN controller. These signals have integrated weak pull-up resistors. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-3. LAN Connect Interface Signals Name Type LAN_TXD[2:0] O LAN_RSTSYNC Description Transmit Data: The integrated LAN controller uses these signals to transfer data and control information to the Platform LAN Connect component. LAN Reset/Sync: This is the reset/sync signal from the LAN Connect Interface to the physical device. The Platform LAN Connect device’s Reset and Sync signals are multiplexed onto this pin. O NOTE: The signal is shared between LAN Connect Interface and Gigabit LAN Connect Interface. LAN_PHY_PW R_CTRL / GPIO12 LAN PHY Power Control: This signal may optionally be connected to a switch to turn 3.3 V PHY power off when LAN is disabled for additional power savings. This capability is configured in the NVM. When using an 82567 PHY solution, the LAN_PHY_PWR_CTRL signal should be connected to the PHY’s LAN_DISABLE_N pin for a hardware based LAN disable mechanism. O Signal can instead be used as GPIO12. 2.4 Gigabit LAN Connect Interface Table 2-4. Gigabit LAN Connect Interface Signals Name Type Description Gigabit LAN Input Clock: Clock driven by the Platform LAN Connect device. The frequency will vary depending on link speed. GLAN_CLK I NOTE: The clock is shared between the LAN Connect Interface and the Gigabit LAN Connect Interface. O Gigabit LAN Differential Transmit Pair. Can be instead used as PCI Express port 6 differential transmit pair. I Gigabit LAN Differential Receive Pair. Can be instead used as PCI Express port 6 differential receive pair. GLAN_COMPO O Impedance Compensation Output pad: Determines Gigabit LAN Connect Interface output impedance and bias current. GLAN_COMPI I Impedance Compensation Input pad: Determines Gigabit LAN Connect Interface input impedance. GLAN_TXp/PETp6; GLAN_TXn/PETn6 GLAN_RXp/PERp6; GLAN_RXn/PERn6 LAN_RSTSYNC O LAN Reset/Sync: This is the reset/sync signal from the Gigabit LAN interface to the physical device. The Platform LAN Connect device’s Reset and Sync signals are multiplexed onto this pin. NOTE: The signal is shared between LAN Connect Interface and Gigabit LAN Connect Interface. Datasheet 49 Signal Description 2.5 Firmware Hub Interface Table 2-5. Firmware Hub Interface Signals Name Type Description FWH[3:0] / LAD[3:0] I/O FWH4 / LFRAME# O Firmware Hub Signals. This signal is multiplexed with the LPC LFRAME# signal. INIT3_3V# O Initialization 3.3 V: This is the identical 3.3 V copy of INIT# intended for Firmware Hub. Firmware Hub Signals. These signals are multiplexed with the LPC address signals. 2.6 PCI Interface Table 2-6. PCI Interface Signals (Sheet 1 of 3) Name AD[31:0] Type I/O Description PCI Address/Data: AD[31:0] is a multiplexed address and data bus. During the first clock of a transaction, AD[31:0] contain a physical address (32 bits). During subsequent clocks, AD[31:0] contain data. The Intel ICH10will drive all 0s on AD[31:0] during the address phase of all PCI Special Cycles. Bus Command and Byte Enables: The command and byte enable signals are multiplexed on the same PCI pins. During the address phase of a transaction, C/BE[3:0]# define the bus command. During the data phase C/BE[3:0]# define the Byte Enables. C/BE[3:0]# 0000b C/BE[3:0]# I/O Command Type Interrupt Acknowledge 0001b Special Cycle 0010b I/O Read 0011b I/O Write 0110b Memory Read 0111b Memory Write 1010b Configuration Read 1011b Configuration Write 1100b Memory Read Multiple 1110b Memory Read Line 1111b Memory Write and Invalidate All command encodings not shown are reserved. The ICH10 does not decode reserved values, and therefore will not respond if a PCI master generates a cycle using one of the reserved values. DEVSEL# 50 I/O Device Select: The ICH10 asserts DEVSEL# to claim a PCI transaction. As an output, the ICH10 asserts DEVSEL# when a PCI master peripheral attempts an access to an internal ICH10 address or an address destined for DMI (main memory or graphics). As an input, DEVSEL# indicates the response to an ICH10-initiated transaction on the PCI bus. DEVSEL# is tri-stated from the leading edge of PLTRST#. DEVSEL# remains tri-stated by the ICH10 until driven by a target device. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-6. PCI Interface Signals (Sheet 2 of 3) Name FRAME# IRDY# TRDY# STOP# PAR PERR# Datasheet Type Description I/O Cycle Frame: The current initiator drives FRAME# to indicate the beginning and duration of a PCI transaction. While the initiator asserts FRAME#, data transfers continue. When the initiator negates FRAME#, the transaction is in the final data phase. FRAME# is an input to the ICH10 when the ICH10 is the target, and FRAME# is an output from the ICH10 when the ICH10 is the initiator. FRAME# remains tri-stated by the ICH10 until driven by an initiator. I/O Initiator Ready: IRDY# indicates the ICH10's ability, as an initiator, to complete the current data phase of the transaction. It is used in conjunction with TRDY#. A data phase is completed on any clock both IRDY# and TRDY# are sampled asserted. During a write, IRDY# indicates the ICH10 has valid data present on AD[31:0]. During a read, it indicates the ICH10 is prepared to latch data. IRDY# is an input to the ICH10 when the ICH10 is the target and an output from the ICH10 when the ICH10 is an initiator. IRDY# remains tri-stated by the ICH10 until driven by an initiator. I/O Target Ready: TRDY# indicates the ICH10's ability as a target to complete the current data phase of the transaction. TRDY# is used in conjunction with IRDY#. A data phase is completed when both TRDY# and IRDY# are sampled asserted. During a read, TRDY# indicates that the ICH10, as a target, has placed valid data on AD[31:0]. During a write, TRDY# indicates the ICH10, as a target is prepared to latch data. TRDY# is an input to the ICH10 when the ICH10 is the initiator and an output from the ICH10 when the ICH10 is a target. TRDY# is tri-stated from the leading edge of PLTRST#. TRDY# remains tri-stated by the ICH10 until driven by a target. I/O Stop: STOP# indicates that the ICH10, as a target, is requesting the initiator to stop the current transaction. STOP# causes the ICH10, as an initiator, to stop the current transaction. STOP# is an output when the ICH10 is a target and an input when the ICH10 is an initiator. I/O Calculated/Checked Parity: PAR uses “even” parity calculated on 36 bits, AD[31:0] plus C/BE[3:0]#. “Even” parity means that the ICH10 counts the number of ones within the 36 bits plus PAR and the sum is always even. The ICH10 always calculates PAR on 36 bits regardless of the valid byte enables. The ICH10 generates PAR for address and data phases and only ensures PAR to be valid one PCI clock after the corresponding address or data phase. The ICH10 drives and tri-states PAR identically to the AD[31:0] lines except that the ICH10 delays PAR by exactly one PCI clock. PAR is an output during the address phase (delayed one clock) for all ICH10 initiated transactions. PAR is an output during the data phase (delayed one clock) when the ICH10 is the initiator of a PCI write transaction, and when it is the target of a read transaction. ICH10 checks parity when it is the target of a PCI write transaction. If a parity error is detected, the ICH10 will set the appropriate internal status bits, and has the option to generate an NMI# or SMI#. I/O Parity Error: An external PCI device drives PERR# when it receives data that has a parity error. The ICH10 drives PERR# when it detects a parity error. The ICH10 can either generate an NMI# or SMI# upon detecting a parity error (either detected internally or reported via the PERR# signal). 51 Signal Description Table 2-6. PCI Interface Signals (Sheet 3 of 3) Name Type REQ0# REQ1#/ GPIO50 REQ2#/ GPIO52 I Description PCI Requests: The ICH10 supports up to 4 masters on the PCI bus. REQ[3:1]# pins can instead be used as GPIO. REQ3#/GPIO54 PCI Grants: The ICH10 supports up to 4 masters on the PCI bus. GNT[3:1]# pins can instead be used as GPIO. GNT0# GNT1#/ GPIO51 GNT2#/ GPIO53 O GNT3#/GPIO55 NOTE: GNT[3:0]# are sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for details. I PCI Clock: This is a 33 MHz clock. PCICLK provides timing for all transactions on the PCI Bus. O PCI Reset: This is the Secondary PCI Bus reset signal. It is a logical OR of the primary interface PLTRST# signal and the state of the Secondary Bus Reset bit of the Bridge Control register (D30:F0:3Eh, bit 6). PLOCK# I/O PCI Lock: This signal indicates an exclusive bus operation and may require multiple transactions to complete. ICH10 asserts PLOCK# when it performs non-exclusive transactions on the PCI bus. PLOCK# is ignored when PCI masters are granted the bus. SERR# I/OD System Error: SERR# can be pulsed active by any PCI device that detects a system error condition. Upon sampling SERR# active, the ICH10 has the ability to generate an NMI, SMI#, or interrupt. I/OD PCI Power Management Event: PCI peripherals drive PME# to wake the system from low-power states S1–S5. PME# assertion can also be enabled to generate an SCI from the S0 state. In some cases the ICH10 may drive PME# active due to an internal wake event. The ICH10 will not drive PME# high, but it will be pulled up to VccSus3_3 by an internal pull-up resistor. PCICLK PCIRST# PME# 2.7 Pull-up resistors are not required on these signals. If pull-ups are used, they should be tied to the Vcc3_3 power rail. Serial ATA Interface bh Table 2-7. Serial ATA Interface Signals (Sheet 1 of 3) Name SATA0TXP SATA0TXN SATA0RXP SATA0RXN SATA1TXP SATA1TXN 52 Type O I O Description Serial ATA 0 Differential Transmit Pairs: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 0. In compatible mode, SATA Port 0 is the primary master of SATA Controller 1. Serial ATA 0 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 0. In compatible mode, SATA Port 0 is the primary master of SATA Controller 1. Serial ATA 1 Differential Transmit Pair: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 1. In compatible mode, SATA Port 1 is the secondary master of SATA Controller 1. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-7. Serial ATA Interface Signals (Sheet 2 of 3) Name SATA1RXP SATA1RXN SATA2TXP SATA2TXN SATA2RXP SATA2RXN SATA3TXP SATA3TXN SATA3RXP SATA3RXN SATA4TXP SATA4TXN SATA4RXP SATA4RXN SATA5TXP SATA5TXN SATA5RXP SATA5RXN Type I O I O I O I O I Description Serial ATA 1 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 1. In compatible mode, SATA Port 1 is the secondary master of SATA Controller 1 Serial ATA 2 Differential Transmit Pair: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 2. In compatible mode, SATA Port 2 is the primary slave of SATA Controller 1. Serial ATA 2 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 2. In compatible mode, SATA Port 2 is the primary slave of SATA Controller 1 Serial ATA 3 Differential Transmit Pair: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 3. In compatible mode, SATA Port 3 is the secondary slave of SATA Controller 1 Serial ATA 3 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 3. In compatible mode, SATA Port 3 is the secondary slave of SATA Controller 1 Serial ATA 4 Differential Transmit Pair: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 4. In compatible mode, SATA Port 4 is the primary master of SATA Controller 2 Serial ATA 4 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 4. In compatible mode, SATA Port 4 is the primary master of SATA Controller 2 Serial ATA 5 Differential Transmit Pair: These are outbound high-speed differential signals to Port 5. In compatible mode, SATA Port 5 is the secondary master of SATA Controller 2 Serial ATA 5 Differential Receive Pair: These are inbound highspeed differential signals from Port 5. In compatible mode, SATA Port 5 is the secondary master of SATA Controller 2 SATARBIAS O Serial ATA Resistor Bias: This is an analog connection point for an external resistor to ground. SATARBIAS# I Serial ATA Resistor Bias Complement: This is an analog connection point for an external resistor to ground. SATA0GP / GPIO21 I Serial ATA 0 General Purpose: This is an input pin which can be configured as an interlock switch corresponding to SATA Port 0. When used as an interlock switch status indication, this signal should be drive to ‘0’ to indicate that the switch is closed and to ‘1’ to indicate that the switch is open. If interlock switches are not required, this pin can be configured as GPIO21. Datasheet 53 Signal Description Table 2-7. Serial ATA Interface Signals (Sheet 3 of 3) Name SATA1GP / GPIO19 Type I Description Serial ATA 1 General Purpose: Same function as SATA0GP, except for SATA Port 1. If interlock switches are not required, this pin can be configured as GPIO19. Serial ATA 2 General Purpose: Same function as SATA0GP, except for SATA Port 2. SATA2GP / GPIO36 I If interlock switches are not required, this pin can be configured as GPIO36. NOTE: This signal can also be used as GPIO36. Serial ATA 3 General Purpose: Same function as SATA0GP, except for SATA Port 3. SATA3GP / GPIO37 I If interlock switches are not required, this pin can be configured as GPIO37. NOTE: This signal can also be used as GPIO37. SATA4GP I Serial ATA 4 General Purpose: Same function as SATA0GP, except for SATA Port 4. SATA5GP I Serial ATA 5 General Purpose: Same function as SATA0GP, except for SATA Port 5. SATALED# OD O Serial ATA LED: This signal is an open-drain output pin driven during SATA command activity. It is to be connected to external circuitry that can provide the current to drive a platform LED. When active, the LED is on. When tri-stated, the LED is off. An external pull-up resistor to Vcc3_3 is required. NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for details. SATACLKREQ# /GPIO35 SCLOCK/ GPIO22 OD O OD O Serial ATA Clock Request: This signal is an open-drain output pin when configured as SATACLKREQ#. It is used to connect to the system clock chip. When active, request for SATA Clock running is asserted. When tri-stated, it tells the Clock Chip that SATA Clock can be stopped. An external pull-up resistor is required. SGPIO Reference Clock: The SATA controller uses rising edges of this clock to transmit serial data, and the target uses the falling edge of this clock to latch data. If SGPIO interface is not used, this signal can be used as a GPIO. SLOAD/GPIO38 OD O SGPIO Load: The controller drives a ‘1’ at the rising edge of SCLOCK to indicate either the start or end of a bit stream. A 4-bit vendor specific pattern will be transmitted right after the signal assertion. If SGPIO interface is not used, this signal can be used as a GPIO. SDATAOUT0/ GPIO39 SDATAOUT1/ GPIO48 54 OD O SGPIO Dataout: Driven by the controller to indicate the drive status in the following sequence: drive 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 0, 1, 2... If SGPIO interface is not used, the signals can be used as GPIO. Datasheet Signal Description 2.8 LPC Interface Table 2-8. LPC Interface Signals Name Typ e Description LAD[3:0] / FWH[3:0] I/O LPC Multiplexed Command, Address, Data: For LAD[3:0], internal pullups are provided. LFRAME# / FWH4 O LPC Frame: LFRAME# indicates the start of an LPC cycle, or an abort. LPC Serial DMA/Master Request Inputs: LDRQ[1:0]# are used to request DMA or bus master access. These signals are typically connected to an external Super I/O device. An internal pull-up resistor is provided on these signals. LDRQ0#, LDRQ1# / GPIO23 I LDRQ1# may optionally be used as GPIO. 2.9 Interrupt Interface Table 2-9. Interrupt Signals Name Type SERIRQ I/OD PIRQ[D:A]# PIRQ[H:E]# / GPIO[5:2] Datasheet I/OD Description Serial Interrupt Request: This pin implements the serial interrupt protocol. PCI Interrupt Requests: In non-APIC mode the PIRQx# signals can be routed to interrupts 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14 or 15 as described in Section 5.8.6. Each PIRQx# line has a separate Route Control register. In APIC mode, these signals are connected to the internal I/O APIC in the following fashion: PIRQA# is connected to IRQ16, PIRQB# to IRQ17, PIRQC# to IRQ18, and PIRQD# to IRQ19. This frees the legacy interrupts. PCI Interrupt Requests: In non-APIC mode the PIRQx# signals can be routed to interrupts 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14 or 15 as described in Section 5.8.6. Each PIRQx# line has a separate Route Control register. I/OD In APIC mode, these signals are connected to the internal I/O APIC in the following fashion: PIRQE# is connected to IRQ20, PIRQF# to IRQ21, PIRQG# to IRQ22, and PIRQH# to IRQ23. This frees the legacy interrupts. If not needed for interrupts, these signals can be used as GPIO. 55 Signal Description 2.10 USB Interface Table 2-10. USB Interface Signals Name USBP0P, USBP0N, USBP1P, USBP1N USBP2P, USBP2N, USBP3P, USBP3N USBP4P, USBP4N, USBP5P, USBP5N USBP6P, USBP6N, USBP7P, USBP7N USBP8P, USBP8N, USBP9P, USBP9N 56 Typ e Description Universal Serial Bus Port [1:0] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit Data/Address/Command signals for ports 0 and 1. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #1 or the EHCI controller #1. I/O NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The Intel ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. I/O Universal Serial Bus Port [3:2] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit data/address/command signals for ports 2 and 3. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #2 or the EHCI controller #1. NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. I/O Universal Serial Bus Port [5:4] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit Data/Address/Command signals for ports 4 and 5. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #3 or the EHCI controller #1. NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. I/O Universal Serial Bus Port [7:6] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit Data/Address/Command signals for ports 6 and 7. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #4 or the EHCI controller #2. NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. I/O Universal Serial Bus Port [9:8] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit Data/Address/Command signals for ports 8 and 9. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #5 or the EHCI controller #2. NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-10. USB Interface Signals Name USBP10P, USBP10N, USBP11P, USBP11N Typ e I/O Overcurrent Indicators: These signals set corresponding bits in the USB controllers to indicate that an overcurrent condition has occurred. OC1# / GPIO40 OC2# / GPIO41 OC[11:0]# may optionally be used as GPIOs. OC3# / GPIO42 OC4# / GPIO43 OC6# / GPIO30 Universal Serial Bus Port [11:10] Differential: These differential pairs are used to transmit Data/Address/Command signals for ports 10 and 11. These ports can be routed to UHCI controller #6 or the EHCI controller #2. These ports can be optionally routed to EHCI Controller #1 when bit 0 RCBA 35F0h is set. NOTE: No external resistors are required on these signals. The ICH10 integrates 15 kΩ pull-downs and provides an output driver impedance of 45 Ω which requires no external series resistor. OC0# / GPIO59 OC5# / GPIO29 Description NOTE: OC[11:0]# are not 5 V tolerant. I OC7# / GPIO31 OC8# / GPIO44 OC9# / GPIO45 OC10# / GPIO46 OC11# / GPIO47 Datasheet USBRBIAS O USB Resistor Bias: Analog connection point for an external resistor. Used to set transmit currents and internal load resistors. USBRBIAS# I USB Resistor Bias Complement: Analog connection point for an external resistor. Used to set transmit currents and internal load resistors. 57 Signal Description 2.11 Power Management Interface Table 2-11. Power Management Interface Signals (Sheet 1 of 3) Name PLTRST# Type O Description Platform Reset: The ICH10 asserts PLTRST# to reset devices on the platform (e.g., SIO, FWH, LAN, (G)MCH, TPM, etc.). The ICH10 asserts PLTRST# during power-up and when S/W initiates a hard reset sequence through the Reset Control register (I/O Register CF9h). The ICH10 drives PLTRST# inactive a minimum of 1 ms after both PWROK and VRMPWRGD are driven high. The ICH10 drives PLTRST# active a minimum of 1 ms when initiated through the Reset Control register (I/O Register CF9h). NOTE: PLTRST# is in the VccSus3_3 well. I Thermal Alarm: Active low signal generated by external hardware to generate an SMI# or SCI. THRMTRIP# I Thermal Trip: When low, this signal indicates that a thermal trip from the processor occurred, and the ICH10 will immediately transition to a S5 state. The ICH10 will not wait for the processor stop grant cycle since the processor has overheated. SLP_S3# O S3 Sleep Control: SLP_S3# is for power plane control. This signal shuts off power to all non-critical systems when in S3 (Suspend To RAM), S4 (Suspend to Disk), or S5 (Soft Off) states. THRM# S4 Sleep Control: SLP_S4# is for power plane control. This signal shuts power to all non-critical systems when in the S4 (Suspend to Disk) or S5 (Soft Off) state. SLP_S4# O NOTE: This pin must be used to control the DRAM power in order to use the ICH10’s DRAM power-cycling feature. Refer to Chapter 5.13.10.2 for details NOTE: In a system with Intel AMT support, this signal should be used to control the DRAM power. In M1 state (where the host platform is in S3-S5 states and the manageability sub-system is running) the signal is forced high along with SLP_M# in order to properly maintain power to the DIMM used for manageability sub-system. SLP_S5# / GPIO63 (Corporate Only) SLP_M# S4_STATE# / GPIO26 58 O S5 Sleep Control: SLP_S5# is for power plane control. This signal is used to shut power off to all non-critical systems when in the S5 (Soft Off) states. ICH10 Corporate Family: pin may also be used as GPIO63. O Manageability Sleep State Control: This signal is used to control power planes to the Intel AMT sub-system. If no Intel Management Engine firmware is present, SLP_M# will have the same timings as SLP_S3#. O S4 State Indication: This signal asserts low when the host platform is in S4 or S5 state. In platforms where the Intel Management Engine is forcing the SLP_S4# high along with SLP_M#, this signal can be used by other devices on the board to know when the host platform is below the S3 state. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-11. Power Management Interface Signals (Sheet 2 of 3) Name Type Description Power OK: When asserted, PWROK is an indication to the ICH10 that all power rails have been stable for 99 ms and that PCICLK has been stable for 1 ms. PWROK can be driven asynchronously. When PWROK is negated, the ICH10 asserts PLTRST#. PWROK I NOTE: 1. PWROK must deassert for a minimum of three RTC clock periods in order for the ICH10 to fully reset the power and properly generate the PLTRST# output. 2. PWROK must not glitch, even if RSMRST# is low. Controller Link Power OK: When asserted, indicates that power to the Controller Link subsystem (MCH, ICH, etc.) is stable and tells the ICH to de-assert CL_RST# to the (G)MCH. CLPWROK I NOTES: 1. CLPWROK must not assert before RSMRST# deasserts. 2. CLPWROK must not assert after PWROK asserts. PWRBTN# I Power Button: The Power Button will cause SMI# or SCI to indicate a system request to go to a sleep state. If the system is already in a sleep state, this signal will cause a wake event. If PWRBTN# is pressed for more than 4 seconds, this will cause an unconditional transition (power button override) to the S5 state. Override will occur even if the system is in the S1–S4 states. This signal has an internal pull-up resistor and has an internal 16 ms de-bounce on the input. RI# I Ring Indicate: This signal is an input from a modem. It can be enabled as a wake event, and this is preserved across power failures. SYS_RESET# I System Reset: This pin forces an internal reset after being debounced. The ICH10 will reset immediately if the SMBus is idle; otherwise, it will wait up to 25 ms ± 2 ms for the SMBus to idle before forcing a reset on the system. I Resume Well Reset: This signal is used for resetting the resume power plane logic. This signal must be asserted for at least 10 ms after the suspend power wells are valid. When deasserted, this signal is an indication that the suspend power wells are stable. RSMRST# LAN Reset: When asserted, the internal LAN controller is in reset. This signal must be asserted until the LAN power wells (VccLAN3_3 and VccLAN1_1) and VccCL3_3 power well are valid. When deasserted, this signal is an indication that the LAN power wells are stable. Datasheet LAN_RST# I WAKE# I MCH_SYNC# I NOTES: 1. LAN_RST# must not deassert before RSMRST# deasserts 2. LAN_RST# must not deassert after PWROK asserts. 3. LAN_RST# must not deassert until 1ms after the LAN power wells (VccLAN3_3 and VccLAN1_1 and VccCL3_3 power well are valid. 4. If integrated LAN is not used LAN_RST# must be tied to Vss. 5. LAN_RST# must assert a minimum of 20 ns before LAN Power rails become inactive. PCI Express* Wake Event: Sideband wake signal on PCI Express asserted by components requesting wake up. MCH SYNC: This input is internally ANDed with the PWROK input. Connect to the ICH_SYNC# output of the (G)MCH. 59 Signal Description Table 2-11. Power Management Interface Signals (Sheet 3 of 3) Name SUS_STAT# / LPCPD# / GPIO61 (Corporate Only) Type O Description Suspend Status: This signal is asserted by the ICH10 to indicate that the system will be entering a low power state soon. This can be monitored by devices with memory that need to switch from normal refresh to suspend refresh mode. It can also be used by other peripherals as an indication that they should isolate their outputs that may be going to powered-off planes. This signal is called LPCPD# on the LPC interface. ICH10 Corporate Family: pin may also be used as GPIO61. SUSCLK / GPIO62 (Corporate Only) VRMPWRGD O Suspend Clock: This clock is an output of the RTC generator circuit to use by other chips for refresh clock. ICH10 Corporate Family: pin may also be used as GPIO62. I VRM Power Good: This signal should be connected to the processor’s VRM Power Good signifying the VRM is stable. This signal is internally ANDed with the PWROK input. This signal is in the suspend well. DRAMPWROK (Corporate Only) / GPIO8 OD O CK_PWRGD O BMBUSY# / GPIO0 DRAM Power OK: This signal should connect to the (G)MCH’s DDR3_DRAM_PWROK pin. The ICH asserts this pin to indicate when DRAM power is off. An external pull-up resistor is required. This pin is not open-drain when operating in GPIO mode. Clock Generator Power Good: This signal indicates to the clock generator when the main power well is valid. This signal is asserted high when both SLP_S3# and VRMPWRGD are high. Bus Master Busy: This signal is used to support the C3 state. It Indicates that a bus master device is busy. When this signal is asserted, the BM_STS bit will be set. If this signal goes active in a C3 state, it is treated as a break event. I NOTE: This signal is internally synchronized using the PCICLK and a two-stage synchronizer. It does not need to meet any particular setup or hold time. Signal may also be used as a GPIO. STP_PCI# / GPIO15 O Stop PCI Clock: This signal is an output to the external clock generator for it to turn off the PCI clock. It is used to support the C3 state. This signal can instead be used as a GPIO. STP_CPU# / GPIO25 (Corporate Only) O DPRSTP# O DPRSLPVR / GPIO16 Stop CPU Clock: This signal is an output to the external clock generator for it to turn off the processor clock. Corporate Only: This signal can instead be used as a GPIO. O Deeper Stop: This is a copy of the DPRSLPVR and it is active low. Deeper Sleep - Voltage Regulator: This signal is used to lower the voltage of the VRM during the C4 state. When the signal is high, the voltage regulator outputs the lower “Deeper Sleep” voltage. When low (default), the voltage regulator outputs the higher “Normal” voltage. This signal can instead be used as a GPIO. 60 Datasheet Signal Description 2.12 Processor Interface Table 2-12. Processor Interface Signals (Sheet 1 of 2) Name Type A20M# O FERR# I Description Mask A20: A20M# will go active based on either setting the appropriate bit in the Port 92h register, or based on the A20GATE input being active. Numeric Coprocessor Error: This signal is tied to the coprocessor error signal on the processor. FERR# is only used if the ICH10 coprocessor error reporting function is enabled in the OIC.CEN register (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 31FFh: bit 1 for Consumer Family and Offset 31FEh: bit 9 for Corporate family). If FERR# is asserted, the ICH10 generates an internal IRQ13 to its interrupt controller unit. It is also used to gate the IGNNE# signal to ensure that IGNNE# is not asserted to the processor unless FERR# is active. FERR# requires an external weak pull-up to ensure a high level when the coprocessor error function is disabled. NOTE: FERR# can be used in some states for notification by the processor of pending interrupt events. This functionality is independent of the OIC register bit setting. IGNNE# O Ignore Numeric Error: This signal is connected to the ignore error pin on the processor. IGNNE# is only used if the ICH10 coprocessor error reporting function is enabled in the OIC.CEN register (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 31FFh: bit 1 for Consumer Family and Offset 31FEh: bit 9 for Corporate family). If FERR# is active, indicating a coprocessor error, a write to the Coprocessor Error register (I/O register F0h) causes the IGNNE# to be asserted. IGNNE# remains asserted until FERR# is negated. If FERR# is not asserted when the Coprocessor Error register is written, the IGNNE# signal is not asserted. INIT# O Initialization: INIT# is asserted by the ICH10 for 16 PCI clocks to reset the processor. ICH10 can be configured to support processor Built In Self Test (BIST). INTR O CPU Interrupt: INTR is asserted by the ICH10 to signal to the processor that an interrupt request is pending and needs to be serviced. It is an asynchronous output and normally driven low. NMI O Non-Maskable Interrupt: NMI is used to force a non-Maskable interrupt to the processor. The ICH10 can generate an NMI when either SERR# is asserted or IOCHK# goes active via the SERIRQ# stream. The processor detects an NMI when it detects a rising edge on NMI. NMI is reset by setting the corresponding NMI source enable/ disable bit in the NMI Status and Control register (I/O Register 61h). SMI# O System Management Interrupt: SMI# is an active low output synchronous to PCICLK. It is asserted by the ICH10 in response to one of many enabled hardware or software events. O Stop Clock Request: STPCLK# is an active low output synchronous to PCICLK. It is asserted by the ICH10 in response to one of many hardware or software events. When the processor samples STPCLK# asserted, it responds by stopping its internal clock. STPCLK# Datasheet 61 Signal Description Table 2-12. Processor Interface Signals (Sheet 2 of 2) Name RCIN# Type I Description Keyboard Controller Reset CPU: The keyboard controller can generate INIT# to the processor. This saves the external OR gate with the ICH10’s other sources of INIT#. When the ICH10 detects the assertion of this signal, INIT# is generated for 16 PCI clocks. NOTE: The ICH10 will ignore RCIN# assertion during transitions to the S3, S4, and S5 states. A20GATE CPUPWRGD I A20 Gate: A20GATE is from the keyboard controller. The signal acts as an alternative method to force the A20M# signal active. It saves the external OR gate needed with various other chipsets. O CPU Power Good: This signal should be connected to the processor’s PWRGOOD input to indicate when the processor power is valid. This is an output signal that represents a logical AND of the ICH10’s PWROK and VRMPWRGD signals. Deeper Sleep: DPSLP# is asserted by the ICH10 to the processor. DPSLP# O When the signal is low, the processor enters the deep sleep state by gating off the processor Core Clock inside the processor. When the signal is high (default), the processor is not in the deep sleep state. DPSLP# 2.13 O Deeper Sleep: DPSLP# is asserted by the ICH10 to the processor. When the signal is low, the processor enters the deep sleep state by gating off the processor Core Clock inside the processor. When the signal is high (default), the processor is not in the deep sleep state. SMBus Interface Table 2-13. SMBus Interface Signals Name Type SMBDATA I/OD SMBus Data: External pull-up resistor is required. SMBCLK I/OD SMBus Clock: External pull-up resistor is required. SMBALERT# / GPIO11 / JTAGTDO (Corporate Only) 62 Description SMBus Alert: This signal is used to wake the system or generate SMI#. I ICH10 Consumer Family: This signal may be used as GPIO11. ICH10 Corporate Family: This signal may be used as GPIO11 or JTAGTDO. Datasheet Signal Description 2.14 System Management Interface Table 2-14. System Management Interface Signals (Sheet 1 of 2) Name Type Description INTRUDER# I Intruder Detect: This signal can be set to disable system if box detected open. This signal’s status is readable, so it can be used like a GPIO if the Intruder Detection is not needed. I/OD System Management Link: SMBus link to optional external system management ASIC or LAN controller. External pull-ups are required. Note that SMLINK0 corresponds to an SMBus Clock signal, and SMLINK1 corresponds to an SMBus Data signal. SMLINK[1:0] LINKALERT# / GPIO60 / JTAGRST# (Corporate Only) MEM_LED / GPIO24 O OD SMLink Alert: Output of the integrated LAN controller and input to either the integrated ASF, Intel AMT or an external management controller in order for the LAN’s SMLINK slave to be serviced. External pull-up resistor is required. ICH10 Consumer: This signal can instead be used as a GPIO60. ICH10 Corporate: This signal can instead be used as a GPIO60 or JTAGRST#. O OD Memory LED: Provides DRAM-powered LED control. Allows for the blinking of an LED to indicate memory activity in all power states. This functionality is configured and controlled by the Intel Management Engine. This signal can instead be used as GPIO24. Datasheet 63 Signal Description Table 2-14. System Management Interface Signals (Sheet 2 of 2) Name Type Description Wake On LAN Power Enable. In an Intel AMT or ASF enabled system, this output signal is driven high by the ICH to control the LAN subsystem power (VccLAN3_3, VccCL3_3, LAN PHY Power, and SPI device) to support Wake on LAN (WOL) when the Intel Management Engine is powered off. This functionality is configured and controlled by the Intel Management Engine prior to entering the powered off state. WOL_EN / GPIO9 O NOTES: 1. This signal should be OR’d with the SLP_M# signal on the motherboard to determine when to power the LAN subsystem. 2. In order to support WOL out of a G3 state, the WOL_EN pin needs to be pulled high by an external resistor until the Intel Management Engine is initialized. If ASF or Intel AMT are disabled on a board that is configured for WOL_EN support, BIOS must utilize GPIO9 to control power to the LAN subsystem when entering S3-S5. In platforms that do not support Intel AMT or ASF, this signal is used as GPIO9. CPU Missing. This signal provides CPU Missing functionality and is configured and controlled by the Manageability Engine. CPU_MISSING / GPIO10 / JTAGTMS (Corporate Only) I This signal must be connected to the CPU SKTOCC# output to indicate to the Intel Manageability Engine that the CPU is not physically present when asserted. ICH10 Consumer Family: This signal may be used as GPIO10. ICH10 Corporate Family: This signal may be used as GPIO10 or JTAGTMS. TPM Physical Presence. This signal is asserted to indicate Physical Presence to the integrated TPM module. TPM_PP / GPIO57 / JTAGTCK (Corporate Only) 2.15 I ICH10 Consumer Family: This signal may be used as GPIO57. ICH10 Corporate Family: This signal may be used as GPIO57 or JTAGTCK. Real Time Clock Interface Table 2-15. Real Time Clock Interface 64 Name Type Description RTCX1 Special Crystal Input 1: This signal is connected to the 32.768 kHz crystal. If no external crystal is used, then RTCX1 can be driven with the desired clock rate. RTCX2 Special Crystal Input 2: This signal is connected to the 32.768 kHz crystal. If no external crystal is used, then RTCX2 should be left floating. Datasheet Signal Description 2.16 Other Clocks Table 2-16. Other Clocks Name Type CLK14 I Oscillator Clock: Used for 8254 timers. Runs at 14.31818 MHz. This clock is permitted to stop during S3 (or lower) states. CLK48 I 48 MHz Clock: Used to run the USB controller. Runs at 48.000 MHz. This clock is permitted to stop during S3 (or lower) states. I 100 MHz Differential Clock: These signals are used to run the SATA controller at 100 MHz. This clock is permitted to stop during S3/S4/S5 states. I 100 MHz Differential Clock: These signals are used to run the Direct Media Interface. Runs at 100 MHz. SATA_CLKP SATA_CLKN DMI_CLKP, DMI_CLKN 2.17 Description Miscellaneous Signals Table 2-17. Miscellaneous Signals (Sheet 1 of 2) Name Type INTVRMEN I Description Internal Voltage Regulator Enable: This signal enables the internal VccSus1_1, VccSus1_5 and VccCL1_5 regulators. This signal must be pulled-up to VccRTC. LAN100_SLP I Internal Voltage Regulator Enable: When connected to VccRTC, this signal enables the internal voltage regulators powering VccLAN1_1 and VccCL1_1. This signal must be pulled-up to VccRTC. SPKR O Speaker: The SPKR signal is the output of counter 2 and is internally “ANDed” with Port 61h bit 1 to provide Speaker Data Enable. This signal drives an external speaker driver device, which in turn drives the system speaker. Upon PLTRST#, its output state is 0. NOTE: SPKR is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. There is a weak integrated pull-down resistor on SPKR pin. RTC Reset: When asserted, this signal resets register bits in the RTC well. RTCRST# Datasheet I NOTES: 1. Unless CMOS is being cleared (only to be done in the G3 power state), the RTCRST# input must always be high when all other RTC power planes are on. 2. In the case where the RTC battery is dead or missing on the platform, the RTCRST# pin must rise before the RSMRST# pin. 65 Signal Description Table 2-17. Miscellaneous Signals (Sheet 2 of 2) Name Type Description Secondary RTC Reset: This signal resets the manageability register bits in the RTC well when the RTC battery is removed. 2.18 NOTES: 1. The SRTCRST# input must always be high when all other RTC power planes are on. 2. In the case where the RTC battery is dead or missing on the platform, the SRTCRST# pin must rise before the RSMRST# pin. SRTCRST# I TP0 / GPIO72 (Corporate Only) I TP3 I/O Test Point 3: Route signal to a test point. TP4 I/O Test Point 4: Route signal to a test point. TP5 I/O Test Point 5: Route signal to a test point. TP6 I Test Point 6: Route signal to a test point. TP7 O Test Point 7: Route signal to a test point. Test Point 0: This signal must have an external pull-up to VccSus3_3. ICH10 Corporate: Pin can instead be used as GPIO72. Intel® High Definition Audio Link Table 2-18. Intel® High Definition Audio Link Signals Name Type Description HDA_RST# O Intel® High Definition Audio Reset: Master hardware reset to external codec(s). Intel High Definition Audio Sync: 48 kHz fixed rate sample sync to the codec(s). Also used to encode the stream number. HDA_SYNC 66 O NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. There is a weak integrated pull-down resistor on this pin. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-18. Intel® High Definition Audio Link Signals Name Type Description O Intel High Definition Audio Bit Clock Output: 24.000 MHz serial data clock generated by the Intel High Definition Audio controller (the Intel ICH10). This signal has a weak internal pulldown resistor. HDA_BIT_CLK Intel High Definition Audio Serial Data Out: Serial TDM data output to the codec(s). This serial output is double-pumped for a bit rate of 48 Mb/s for Intel High Definition Audio. HDA_SDOUT O NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. There is a weak integrated pull-down resistor on this pin. HDA_SDIN[3:0] I Intel High Definition Audio Serial Data In [3:0]: Serial TDM data inputs from the codecs. The serial input is single-pumped for a bit rate of 24 Mb/s for Intel High Definition Audio. These signals have integrated pull-down resistors, which are always enabled. NOTE: During enumeration, the ICH will drive this signal. During normal operation, the CODEC will drive it. 2.19 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Table 2-19. Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Signals Name Type Description SPI Chip Select 0: Used as the SPI bus request signal. SPI_CS0# O NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. SPI Chip Select 1: Used as the SPI bus request signal. SPI_CS1# O NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. There is a weak integrated pull-up resistor on this pin. SPI_MISO I SPI Master IN Slave OUT: Data input pin for ICH10. SPI Master OUT Slave IN: Data output pin for ICH10. Datasheet SPI_MOSI O SPI_CLK O NOTE: This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. There is a weak integrated pull-down resistor on this pin. SPI Clock: SPI clock signal, during idle the bus owner will drive the clock signal low. 17.86 MHz and 31.25 MHz. 67 Signal Description 2.20 Controller Link Table 2-20. Controller Link Signals Signal Name Type Description CL_CLK0 I/O Controller Link Clock 0: bi-directional clock that connects to the (G)MCH. CL_DATA0 I/O Controller Link Data 0: bi-directional data that connects to the (G)MCH. Controller Link Reference Voltage 0: External reference voltage for Controller Link 0. 2.21 ICH10 Corporate: When using internal reference voltage as configured by CLINKVREFSEL (ICHSTRP0:bit 5), an external circuit is not required and pin is No Connect (Recommended Configuration). Optionally, an external reference voltage generation circuit may be used (requires CLINKVREFSEL = 1). CL_VREF0 I CL_RST0# O Controller Link Reset 0: North Controller Link reset that connects to the (G)MCH. Intel® Quiet System Technology Table 2-21. Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals Signal Name Type Description Fan Pulse Width Modulation Outputs: Pulse Width Modulated duty cycle output signal that is used for Intel® Quiet System Technology. PWM[2:0] OD O When controlling a 3-wire fan, this signal controls a power transistor that, in turn, controls power to the fan. When controlling a 4-wire fan, this signal is connected to the “Control” signal on the fan. The polarity of this signal is programmable. The output default is low. These signals are 5V tolerant. TACH0/GPIO17 TACH1/GPIO1 TACH2/GPIO6 TACH3/GPIO7 68 I Fan Tachometer Inputs: Tachometer pulse input signal that is used to measure fan speed. This signal is connected to the “Sense” signal on the fan. Can instead be used as a GPIO. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-21. Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals Signal Name Type SST I/O Simple Serial Transport: Single-wire, serial bus. Connect to SST compliant devices such as SST thermal sensors or voltage sensors. PECI I/O Platform Environment Control Interface: Single-wire, serial bus. Connect to corresponding pin of the processor for accessing processor digital thermometer. QST_BMBUSY# (Consumer Only) / JTAGTDI (Corporate Only) / GPIO14 O Description Intel QST BMBUSY# Interconnect (Consumer Only): This signal is used for Intel ICH10 Consumer based platforms that support Intel QST and C3 and/or C4 processor states. QST_BMBUSY# is asserted by the ICH10 to ensure that Intel QST can read the processor thermal sensor since the sensor is inaccessible when the platform is in C3 or C4. QST_BMBUSY# must be externally tied to the BMBUSY# signal on the ICH10 to cause the platform to exit or prevent entry into C3 or C4. QST_BMBUSY# functionality is configured and controlled by the Intel Management Engine firmware. ICH10 Consumer: In non-Intel QST based platforms, this signal can instead be used as a GPIO14. ICH10 Corporate: This signal is instead used as a GPIO14 or JTAGTDI. 2.22 JTAG Signals (Intel® ICH10 Corporate Family Only) Table 2-22. JTAG Signals Name Type Description JTAGTCK (Corporate Only) / GPIO57 / TPM_PP I/O Test Clock Input (TCK): The test clock input provides the clock for the JTAG test logic. JTAGTMS (Corporate Only) / GPIO10 / CPU_MISSING I/O Test Mode Select (TMS): The signal is decoded by the Test Access Port (TAP) controller to control test operations. JTAGTDI (Corporate Only) / GPIO14 / QST_BMBUSY# I/O Test Data Input (TDI): Serial test instructions and data are received by the test logic at TDI. JTAGTDO (Corporate Only) / GPIO11/ SMBALERT# I/O Test Data Output (TDO): TDO is the serial output for test instructions and data from the test logic defined in this standard. JTAGRST# (Corporate Only) / LINKALERT# / GPIO60 Test Reset (RST): RST is an active low asynchronous signal that can reset the Test Access Port (TAP) controller. I/O NOTE: The RST signal is optional per the IEEE 114.1 specification, and is not functional for Boundary Scan Testing NOTE: JTAG Pin definitions are from IEEE Standard Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture (IEEE Std. 1149.1-2001) Datasheet 69 Signal Description 2.23 General Purpose I/O Signals Table 2-23. General Purpose I/O Signals (Sheet 1 of 3) Name GPIO72 (Corporate Only) GPIO63 (Corporate Only) GPIO62 (Corporate Only) GPIO61 (Corporate Only) 70 Type I/O I/O I/O I/O Tolerance 3.3 V 3.3 V 3.3 V 3.3 V Power Well Core Suspend Suspend Suspend Default Native Native Native Native GPIO60 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native GPIO59 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Description ICH10 Consumer Family: Pin implemented as TP0 only. ICH10 Corporate Family: Pin is multiplexed with TP0. (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Pin may only be used as SLP_S5#. ICH10 Corporate Family: Pin is multiplexed with SLP_S5# (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Pin may only be used as SUSCLK ICH10 Corporate Family: Pin is multiplexed with SUSCLK (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Pin May only be used as SUS_STAT# / LPCPD# ICH10 Corporate Family: Pin is multiplexed with SUS_STAT# / LPCPD# (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Multiplexed with LINKALERT#. ICH10 Corporate Family: Multiplexed with LINKALERT# and JTAGRST#. (NOTE 13) Multiplexed with OC[0]#. (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Can be used as TPM_PP. GPIO57 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPI GPIO56 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPI GPIO55 I/O 3.3 V Core Native Multiplexed with GNT3# (Note 8). GPIO54 I/O 5.0 V Core Native Multiplexed with REQ3#. (NOTE 13) GPIO53 I/O 3.3 V Core Native Multiplexed with GNT2# (Note 8). GPIO52 I/O 5.0 V Core Native Multiplexed with REQ2#. (NOTE 13) GPIO51 I/O 3.3 V Core Native Multiplexed with GNT1# (Note 8). GPIO50 I/O 5.0 V Core Native Multiplexed with REQ1#. (NOTE 13) ICH10 Corporate Family Can be used as TPM_PP or JTAGTCK. UnMultiplexed GPIO49 I/O 3.3V Core GPO GPIO48 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI UnMultiplexed (Note 8). GPIO[47:44] I/O 3.3V Suspend Native Multiplexed with OC[11:8]#. (NOTE 13) GPIO[43:40] I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Multiplexed with OC[4:1]#. (NOTE 13) GPIO39 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SDATAOUT0. GPIO38 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SLOAD. GPIO37 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SATA3GP. GPIO36 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SATA2GP. Multiplexed with SDATAOUT1. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-23. General Purpose I/O Signals (Sheet 2 of 3) Name Type Tolerance Power Well Default GPIO35 I/O 3.3 V Core GPO Multiplexed with SATACLKREQ#. GPIO34 I/O 1.5 V / 3.3 V (Note 12) VccHDA GPO UnMultiplexed. GPIO33 I/O 3.3 V Core GPO UnMultiplexed. GPIO32 I/O 3.3 V Core GPO UnMultiplexed. GPIO31 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Multiplexed with OC7#. (NOTE 13) GPIO30 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Multiplexed with OC6#. (NOTE 13) GPIO29 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Multiplexed with OC5#. (NOTE 13) GPIO28 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPO UnMultiplexed. GPIO27 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPO UnMultiplexed GPIO26 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Multiplexed with S4_STATE#. (Note 9) GPIO25 (Corporate Only) I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native Default as STP_CPU# (Note 3). GPIO24 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPO GPIO23 I/O 3.3 V Core Native GPIO22 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SCLOCK. GPIO21 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SATA0GP. GPIO20 I/O 3.3 V Core GPO UnMultiplexed. (Note 8) GPIO19 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with SATA1GP. GPIO18 I/O 3.3 V Core GPO (Note 11) GPIO17 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI GPIO16 I/O 3.3 V Core Native May also be used as DPRSLPVR GPIO15 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native default as STP_PCI#. (Note 3) Description Can be used as MEM_LED. GPIO24 configuration register bits are not cleared by CF9h reset event. Multiplexed with LDRQ1#. (NOTE 13) UnMultiplexed. Multiplexed with TACH0. ICH10 Consumer Family: Can be used as QST_BMBUSY#. GPIO14 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPI GPIO13 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPI UnMultiplexed. GPIO12 I/O 3.3 V Suspend GPO Multiplexed with LAN_PHY_PWR_CTRL. (NOTE 13) GPIO11 GPIO10 Datasheet I/O I/O 3.3 V 3.3 V Suspend Suspend Native GPI ICH10 Corporate Family: Can be used as JTAGTD, or QST_BMBUSY#I. ICH10 Consumer Family: Can be used as SMBALERT#. (NOTE 13) ICH10 Corporate Family Can be used as SMBALERT# or JTAGTDO. (NOTE 13) ICH10 Consumer Family: Can be used as CPU_MISSING. ICH10 Corporate Family: Can be used as CPU_MISSING or JTAGTMS. 71 Signal Description Table 2-23. General Purpose I/O Signals (Sheet 3 of 3) Name Type Tolerance Power Well Default GPIO9 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Native GPIO8 I/O 3.3 V Suspend Corporate Only GPI Consumer Only Native Description Can be used as WOL_EN. ICH10 Corporate Family: Can be used as DRAMPWROK. ICH10 Consumer Family: Unmultiplexed GPIO[7:6] I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with TACH[3:2]. GPIO[5:2] I/OD 5V Core GPI Multiplexed with PIRQ[H:E]# (Note 6). GPIO1 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with TACH1. GPIO0 I/O 3.3 V Core GPI Multiplexed with BMBUSY#. NOTES: 1. All GPIOs can be configured as either input or output. 2. GPI[15:0] can be configured to cause a SMI# or SCI. Note that a GPI can be routed to either an SMI# or an SCI, but not both. 3. Some GPIOs exist in the VccSus3_3 power plane. Care must be taken to make sure GPIO signals are not driven high into powered-down planes. Also, external devices should not be driving powered down GPIOs high. Some ICH10 GPIOs may be connected to pins on devices that exist in the core well. If these GPIOs are outputs, there is a danger that a loss of core power (PWROK low) or a Power Button Override event will result in the Intel ICH10 driving a pin to a logic 1 to another device that is powered down. 4. The functionality that is multiplexed with the GPIO may not be utilized in desktop configuration. 5. This GPIO is not an open-drain when configured as an output. 6. SPI_CS1# is located in the VccCL3_3 well. 7. When this signal is configured as GPO the output stage is an open-drain. 8. This signal is sampled as a functional strap. See Section 2.25.1 for more details. 9. The GPIO_USE_SEL bit for this signal is overridden by bit 8 in the GEN_PMCON_3 Register (D31:F0). 10. The GPIO_USE_SEL bit for this is ignored. Functionality is set by bits 9:8 of FLMAP0 register. 11. GPIO18 will toggle at a frequency of approximately 1 Hz when the ICH10 comes out of reset. 12. The tolerance of this pin is determined by the voltage of VccHDA either 3.3 V or 1.5 V. 13. When the multiplexed GPIO is used as GPIO functionality, care should be taken to ensure the signal is stable in its inactive state of the native functionality, immediately after reset until it is initialized to GPIO functionality. 72 Datasheet Signal Description 2.24 Power and Ground Signals Table 2-24. Power and Ground Signals (Sheet 1 of 2) Name Description V5REF Reference for 5 V tolerance on core well inputs. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. V5REF_Sus Reference for 5 V tolerance on suspend well inputs. This power is not expected to be shut off unless the system is unplugged. Vcc1_1 1.1 V supply for core well logic. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Vcc1_5_A 1.5 V supply for Logic and I/O. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Vcc1_5_B 1.5 V supply for Logic and I/O. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Vcc3_3 VccCL1_1 VccCL1_5 VccCL3_3 VccDMI 1.1V supply for Controller Link. This plane must be on in S0 and other times Controller Link is used. This voltage is generated internally (see Section 2.25.1 for strapping option) and, this pin can be left as No Connect unless decoupling is required. 1.5V supply for Controller Link. This plane must be on in S0 and other times Controller Link is used. This voltage is generated internally (see Section 2.25.1 for strapping option), and this pin can be left as No Connect unless decoupling is required. 3.3V supply for Controller Link. This is a separate power plane that may or may not be powered in S3–S5 states. This plane must be on in S0 and other times Controller Link is used. NOTE: VccCL3_3 must always be powered when VccLAN3_3 is powered. Power supply for DMI. 1.05V, 1.25V or 1.5V depending on (G)MCH’s DMI voltage. VccDMIPLL 1.5 V supply for core well logic. This signal is used for the DMI PLL. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. VccGLAN1_5 1.5V supply for integrated Gigabit LAN I/O buffers. This power is on in S0 and is turned of in S3, S4, S5, even it integrated Gigabit LAN is not used. VccGLAN3_3 3.3V supply for integrated Gigabit LAN logic and I/O. This power is on in S0 and is turned of in S3, S4, S5, even it integrated Gigabit LAN is not used. VccGLANPLL 1.5V supply for core well logic. This signal is used for the integrated Gigabit LAN PLL. This power is shut off in S3, S4, S5 and G3 states. VccHDA VccLAN1_1 Datasheet 3.3 V supply for core well I/O buffers. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Core supply for Intel High Definition Audio. This pin can be either 1.5 or 3.3 V. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. NOTE: VccSusHDA and VccHDA can be connected to either 1.5 V or 3.3 V supplies, but both pins must be connected to supplies that are the same nominal value. 1.1 V supply for LAN controller logic. This is a separate power plane that may or may not be powered in S3–S5 states. This voltage is generated internally (see Section 2.25.1 for strapping option) and, these pins can be left as No Connect unless decoupling is required. 73 Signal Description Table 2-24. Power and Ground Signals (Sheet 2 of 2) Name Description VccLAN3_3 3.3 V supply for LAN Connect interface buffers. This is a separate power plane that may or may not be powered in S3–S5 states. This plane must be on in S0. NOTE: VccLAN3_3 must always be powered when VccCL3_3 or Vcc3_3 is powered. VccRTC VccSATAPLL 3.3 V (can drop to 2.0 V min. in G3 state) supply for the RTC well. This power is not expected to be shut off unless the RTC battery is removed or completely drained. Note: Implementations should not attempt to clear CMOS by using a jumper to pull VccRTC low. Clearing CMOS in an Intel ICH10-based platform can be done by using a jumper on RTCRST# or GPI. 1.5 V supply for core well logic. This signal is used for the SATA PLL. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Must be powered even if SATA is not used. 1.1 V supply for suspend well logic. This power is not expected to be shut off unless the system is unplugged. VccSus1_1 This voltage is generated internally (see Section 2.25.1 for strapping option). These pins can be left as No Connects unless decoupling is required. VccSus1_5 This voltage is generated internally (see Section 2.25.1 for strapping option). These pins can be left as No Connects unless decoupling is required. VccSus3_3 3.3 V supply for suspend well I/O buffers. This power is not expected to be shut off unless the system is unplugged. VccSusHDA Suspend supply for Intel® High Definition Audio. This pin can be either 1.5 or 3.3 V. T NOTE: VccSusHDA and VccHDA can be connected to either 1.5 V or 3.3 V supplies, but both pins must be connected to supplies that are the same nominal value. VccUSBPLL 1.5 V supply for core well logic. This signal is used for the USB PLL. This power may be shut off in S3, S4, S5 or G3 states. Must be powered even if USB not used. Vss V_CPU_IO 74 1.5V supply for the suspend well I/O. This power is not expected to be shut off unless the system is unplugged. Grounds. Powered by the same supply as the processor I/O voltage. This supply is used to drive the processor interface signals listed in Table 2-12. Datasheet Signal Description 2.25 Pin Straps 2.25.1 Functional Straps The following signals are used for static configuration. They are sampled at the rising edge of PWROK to select configurations (except as noted), and then revert later to their normal usage. To invoke the associated mode, the signal should be driven at least four PCI clocks prior to the time it is sampled. The ICH10 has implemented Soft Straps. Soft Straps are used to configure specific functions within the ICH and (G)MCH very early in the boot process before BIOS or SW intervention. When Descriptor Mode is enabled, the ICH will read Soft Strap data out of the SPI device prior to the de-assertion of reset to both the Intel Management Engine and the Host system. Refer to Section 5.23.2 for information on Descriptor Mode and Section for more information on Soft Straps and their settings. Table 2-25. Functional Strap Definitions (Sheet 1 of 4) Signal When Sampled Comment HDA_SDOUT XOR Chain Entrance Rising Edge of PWROK Allows entrance to XOR Chain testing when TP3 pulled low at rising edge of PWROK. HDA_SDOUT PCI Express* Port Config 1 bit 1 (Port 1-4) (Consumer Only) Rising Edge of PWROK When TP3 not pulled low at rising edge of PWROK, sets bit 1 of RPC.PC (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 224h).This signal has a weak internal pull-down. HDA_SYNC (Consumer Only) PCI Express Port Config 1 bit 0 (Port 1-4) Rising Edge of PWROK PCI Express Port Config 2 bit 2 (Port 5-6) Rising Edge of PWROK GPIO20 Reserved Rising Edge of PWROK This signal has a weak internal pull-down. NOTE: This signal should not be pulled high GNT1#/GPIO51 ESI Strap (Server/ Workstation Only) Rising edge of PWROK Tying this strap low configures DMI for ESIcompatible operation. This signal has a weak internal pull-up. NOTE: ESI compatible mode is for server platforms only. This signal should not be pulled low for desktop. Rising Edge of PWROK The signal has a weak internal pull-up. If the signal is sampled low, this indicates that the system is strapped to the “topblock swap” mode (Intel ICH10 inverts A16 for all cycles targeting BIOS space). The status of this strap is readable via the Top Swap bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3414h:bit 0). Note that software will not be able to clear the Top-Swap bit until the system is rebooted without GNT3# being pulled down. GNT2# / GPIO53 (Consumer Only) GNT3# / GPIO55 Datasheet Usage Top-Block Swap Override This signal has a weak internal pull-down. Sets bit 0 of RPC.PC (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 224h) This signal has a weak internal pull-up. Sets bit 2 of RPC.PC2 (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 0224h) when sampled low. 75 Signal Description Table 2-25. Functional Strap Definitions (Sheet 2 of 4) Signal Usage When Sampled Comment This field determines the destination of accesses to the BIOS memory range. Signals have weak internal pull-ups. Also controllable via Boot BIOS Destination bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3410h:bit 11). This strap is used in conjunction with Boot BIOS Destination Selection 1 strap. GNT0# 76 Boot BIOS Destination Selection 0 Rising Edge of PWROK Boot BIOS Destination Bit11 Bit 10 0 1 SPI 1 0 PCI 1 1 LPC 0 0 Reserved NOTE: If option 11 LPC is selected, BIOS may still be placed on LPC, but all platforms with ICH10 (Corporate Only) require SPI flash connected directly to the ICH's SPI bus with a valid descriptor in order to boot. NOTE: Booting to PCI is intended for debut/testing only. Boot BIOS Destination Select to LPC/PCI by functional strap or via Boot BIOS Destination Bit will not affect SPI accesses initiated by Intel Management Engine or Integrated GbE LAN. Datasheet Signal Description Table 2-25. Functional Strap Definitions (Sheet 3 of 4) Signal Usage When Sampled Comment This field determines the destination of accesses to the BIOS memory range. Signals have weak internal pull-ups. Also controllable via Boot BIOS Destination bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3410h:bit 10). This strap is used in conjunction with Boot BIOS Destination Selection 0 strap. SPI_CS1# SATALED# (Consumer Only) SPKR TP3 Datasheet Boot BIOS Destination Selection 1 Rising Edge of CLPWROK PCI Express Lane Reversal (Lanes 1-4) Rising Edge of PWROK No Reboot XOR Chain Entrance Rising Edge of PWROK Rising Edge of PWROK Boot BIOS Destination Bit11 Bit 10 0 1 SPI 1 0 PCI 1 1 LPC 0 0 Reserved NOTE: If option 11 LPC is selected BIOS may still be placed on LPC, but all platforms with ICH10 (Corporate Only) require SPI flash connected directly to the ICH's SPI bus with a valid descriptor in order to boot. NOTE: Booting to PCI is intended for debut/testing only. Boot BIOS Destination Select to LPC/PCI by functional strap or via Boot BIOS Destination Bit will not affect SPI accesses initiated by Intel Management Engine or Integrated GbE LAN. Signal has weak internal pull-up. Sets bit 27 of MPC.LR (Device 28: Function 0: Offset D8) The signal has a weak internal pull-down. If the signal is sampled high, this indicates that the system is strapped to the “No Reboot” mode (ICH10 will disable the TCO Timer system reboot feature). The status of this strap is readable via the NO REBOOT bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3410h:bit 5). See Intel® ICH10 Family XOR Chains InCircuit Tester Package for functionality information. This signal has a weak internal pull-up. NOTE: This signal should not be pulled low unless using XOR Chain testing. 77 Signal Description Table 2-25. Functional Strap Definitions (Sheet 4 of 4) Signal GPIO33 / HDA_DOCK_EN# GPIO49 SPI_MOSI (Corporate Only) Usage Flash Descriptor Security Override Strap DMI Termination Voltage Integrated TPM Enable When Sampled Comment Rising Edge of PWROK If sampled low, the Flash Descriptor Security will be overridden. If high, the security measures defined in the Flash Descriptor will be in effect. NOTE: This strap should only be enabled in manufacturing environments using an external pull-down resistor. NOTE: Asserting the GPIO33 low on the rising edge of PWROK will also disable Intel Management Engine and Intel Management Engine features. Rising Edge of PWROK This signal has a weak internal pull-up. NOTE: When DMI is DC coupled this signal should not be pulled low during the time the strap is sampled. NOTE: When DMI is AC coupled, this signal should be pulled low during the time the strap is sampled. Rising Edge of CLPWROK This signal has a weak internal pull-down resistor. When the signal is sampled low the Integrated TPM will be disabled. When the signal is sampled high, the (G)MCH TPM enable strap is sampled low and the TPM Disable bit is clear, the Integrated TPM will be enabled. NOTE: For Consumer applications this signal is required to be floating or pulled low. NOTE: See Section 3.1 for full details on pull-up/pull-down resistors. 78 Datasheet Signal Description 2.25.2 External RTC Circuitry The ICH10 implements an internal oscillator circuit that is sensitive to step voltage changes in VccRTC. Figure 2-1 shows an example schematic recommended to ensure correct operation of the ICH10 RTC. Figure 2-1. Example External RTC Circuit 3.3V Sus VCCRTC Schottky Diodes 1uF 0.1uF RTCX2 1 KΩ Vbatt 20 KΩ 20 KΩ R1 10MΩ 32.768 KHz Xtal RTCX1 1.0 uF C1 1.0 uF C2 RTCRST# SRTCRST# NOTE: C1 and C2 depend on crystal load. §§ Datasheet 79 Signal Description 80 Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Pin States 3 Intel® ICH10 Pin States 3.1 Integrated Pull-Ups and Pull-Downs Table 3-1. Integrated Pull-Up and Pull-Down Resistors Resistor Type Nominal Value Notes CL_CLK0 Pull-up 20 kΩ 13 CL_DATA0 Pull-up 20 kΩ 13 CL_RST0# Pull-up 10 kΩ 4 DPRSLPVR/GPIO16 Pull-down 20 kΩ 2, 10 HDA_BIT_CLK Pull-down 20 kΩ 1, 9 Pull-up 20 kΩ 3,7 Pull-down 20 kΩ 2 Signal HDA_DOCK_EN#/GPIO33 HDA_RST# HDA_SDIN[3:0] Pull-down 20 kΩ 2 HDA_SDOUT Pull-down 20 kΩ 2, 7 HDA_SYNC Pull-down 20 kΩ 2, 7 Pull-up 20 kΩ PUll-down 20 kΩ GLAN_DOCK# GNT0#, GNT[3:1]#/GPIO[55,53,51] 3, 14 Pull-up 20 kΩ 3, 11, 12 GPIO20 Pull-down 20 kΩ 3, 7 GPIO49 Pull-up 20 kΩ 3, 7 LAD[3:0]# / FHW[3:0]# Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 LAN_RXD[2:0] Pull-up 20 kΩ 4 LDRQ0 Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 LDRQ1 / GPIO23 Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 PME# Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 PWRBTN# Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 SATALED# Pull-up 15 kΩ 8 SPI_CS1# Pull-up 20 kΩ 3, 10 SPI_MOSI Pull-down 20 kΩ 3, 7 SPI_MISO Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 Pull-down 20 kΩ 2 TACH[3:0] Pull-up 20 kΩ 3 TP3 Pull-up 20 kΩ 6 Pull-down 15 kΩ 5 SPKR USB[11:0] [P,N] NOTES: 1. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 10 kΩ to 40 kΩ. 2. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 9 kΩ to 50 kΩ. Datasheet 81 Intel® ICH10 Pin States 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 82 Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 15 kΩ to 35 kΩ. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 7.5 kΩ to 16 kΩ. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 14.25 kΩ to 24.8 kΩ Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 10 kΩ to 30 kΩ. The pull-up or pull-down on this signal is only enabled at boot/reset for strapping function. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 10 kΩ to 20 kΩ. The internal pull-up is only enabled during PLTRST# assertion. The pull-down on this signal is only enabled when in S3. The pull-up or pull-down on this signal is only enabled during reset. The pull-up on this signal is not enabled when PCIRST# is high. The pull-up on this signal is not enabled when PWROK is low. Simulation data shows that these resistor values can range from 15 kΩ to 31 kΩ. The pull-up or pull-down on this pin is only active when configured for native GLAN_DOCK# functionality and is determined by the LAN controller. Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Pin States 3.2 Output and I/O Signals Planes and States Table 3-2 shows the power plane associated with the output and I/O signals, as well as the state at various times. Within the table, the following terms are used: Note: “High-Z” Tri-state. ICH10 not driving the signal high or low. “High” ICH10 is driving the signal to a logic 1. “Low” ICH10 is driving the signal to a logic 0. “Defined” Driven to a level that is defined by the function or external pullup/pull-down resistor (will be high or low). “Undefined” ICH10 is driving the signal, but the value is indeterminate. “Running” Clock is toggling or signal is transitioning because function not stopping. “Off” The power plane is off; ICH10 is not driving when configured as an output or sampling when configured as an input. “Input” ICH10 is sampling and signal state determined by external driver. Signal levels are the same in S4 and S5, except as noted. The ICH10 suspend well signal states are indeterminate and undefined and may glitch prior to RSMRST# deassertion. This does not apply to LAN_RST#, SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, S4_STATE# and SLP_S5#. These signals are determinate and defined prior to RSMRST# deassertion. The ICH10 core well signal states are indeterminate and undefined and may glitch prior to PWROK assertion. This does not apply to FERR# and THRMTRIP#. These signals are determinate and defined prior to PWROK assertion. Table 3-2. Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations (Sheet 1 of 5) Signal Name Power Plane During Reset4 Immediately after Reset4 C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 Defined Off Off Defined Off Off Off PCI Express* PETp[5:1], PETn[5:1], PETp6 / GLANTXp, PETn6 / GLANTXn Core High High8 DMI DMI[3:0]TXP, DMI[3:0]TXN Core High High PCI Bus AD[31:0] Core Low Undefined Defined Off C/BE[3:0]# Core Low Undefined Defined Off Off DEVSEL# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off FRAME# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off GNT0#11, GNT[3:1]#11/ GPIO[55, 53, 51] Core High-Z High High Off Off IRDY#, TRDY# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off Datasheet 83 Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-2. Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations (Sheet 2 of 5) Signal Name Power Plane During Reset4 Immediately after Reset4 C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 PAR Core Low Undefined Defined Off Off PCIRST# Suspend Low High High Low Low PERR# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off PLOCK# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off STOP# Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off LPC Interface LAD[3:0] / FWH[3:0] Core High High High Off Off LFRAME# / FWH[4] Core High High High Off Off LPCPD# / SUS_STAT# / GPIO61 (Corporate Only) Suspend Low High High Low Low High Off Off Firmware Hub INIT3_3V# Core High High LAN Connect Interface LAN_RSTSYNC LAN High Low Defined Defined Defined LAN_TXD[2:0] LAN Low Low Defined Defined Defined Gigabit LAN Connect Interface GLAN_TXp / PETp6, GLAN_TXn / PETn6 GLAN High High Defined Off Off LAN_RSTSYNC LAN High Low Defined Defined Defined SATA Interface SATA[5:0]TXP, SATA[5:0]TXN Core High-Z High-Z Defined Off Off SATALED#11 Core High-Z High-Z Defined Off Off SATARBIAS Core High-Z High-Z Defined Off Off SATACLKREQ# / GPIO35 Core Low Low Defined Off Off SCLOCK/GPIO22 Core Input Input Defined Off Off SLOAD/GPIO38 Core Input Input Defined Off Off SDATAOUT[1:0]/ GPIO[48,39] Core Input Input Defined Off Off Interrupts PIRQ[A:D]#, Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off PIRQ[H:E]# / GPIO[5:2] Core Input Input Defined Off Off SERIRQ Core High-Z High-Z High-Z Off Off USB Interface USB[11:0][P,N] Suspend Low Low Defined Defined Defined USBRBIAS Suspend High-Z High-Z Defined Defined Defined DPRSLPVR Core Low High Off Off Power Management 84 Low Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-2. Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations (Sheet 3 of 5) Power Plane During Reset4 Immediately after Reset4 DPRSTP# CPU High High High Off Off PLTRST# Suspend Low High High Low Low SLP_M#9 Suspend Low High High Defined Defined SLP_S3# Suspend Low High High Low Low Signal Name C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 SLP_S4# Suspend Low High High High Defined S4_STATE# / GPIO26 Suspend Low Defined Defined Defined Defined SLP_S5#/ GPIO63 (Corporate Only) Suspend Low High High High Low6 SUS_STAT# / LPCPD# / GPIO61 (Corporate Only) Suspend Low High High Low Low SUSCLK Suspend Low CK_PWRGD Suspend Low High Running High Low Low STP_PCI# / GPIO15 Suspend High High Defined Defined Defined STP_CPU# / GPIO25 (Corporate Only) Suspend High High Defined Defined Defined Corporate Only: DRAMPWROK / GPIO8 Suspend Low Low Defined Defined/ Low12 Defined/ Low12 Defined Processor Interface DPSLP# CPU High High High Off Off A20M# CPU Dependant on A20GATE Signal See Note 1 High Off Off CPUPWRGD CPU Low3 High High Off Off IGNNE# CPU High See Note 1 High Off Off INIT# CPU High High High Off Off INTR CPU See Note 5 See Note 5 Low Off Off NMI CPU See Note 5 See Note 5 Low Off Off SMI# CPU High High High Off Off STPCLK# CPU High High Low Off Off Defined Defined Defined SMBus Interface SMBCLK, SMBDATA Suspend High-Z High-Z System Management Interface MEM_LED / GPIO24 Suspend Low Low Defined Defined Defined CPU_MISSING / GPIO10 / JTAGTMS (Corporate Only) Suspend Input Input Defined Defined Defined GPIO14 / JTAGTDI (Corporate Only) / QST_BMBUSY# Suspend Input Input Defined Defined Defined WOL_EN / GPIO9 Suspend High-Z High-Z Defined Defined Defined Datasheet 85 Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-2. Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations (Sheet 4 of 5) Signal Name Power Plane During Reset4 Immediately after Reset4 LINKALERT# / GPIO60 / JTAGRST# (Corporate Only) Suspend High-Z TPM_PP / GPIO57 / JTAGTCK (Corporate Only) Suspend Input C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 High-Z Defined Defined Defined Input Defined Defined Defined SPI_CS[1]#11 Suspend High High Defined Defined Defined SMLINK[1:0] Suspend High-Z High-Z Defined Defined Defined Defined Off Off Miscellaneous Signals 11 SPKR Core High-Z Intel® Low High Definition Audio Interface HDA_RST# HDA Suspend Low Low7 Defined Low Low HDA_SDOUT11 HDA Low Low Low Off Off HDA_SYNC HDA Low Low Low Off Off HDA_BIT_CLK HDA Low Low Low Off Off UnMultiplexed GPIO Signals GPIO0 / BMBUSY# Core Input Input Defined Off Off Consumer Only: GPIO8 Suspend Input Input Defined Defined Defined GPIO12 / LAN_PHY_PWR_CTRL Suspend Low Low Defined Defined Defined Defined GPIO13 Suspend Input Input Defined Defined GPIO16/DPRSLPVR Core Low Low Defined Off Off GPIO18 Core High See Note 2 Defined Off Off GPIO2011 Core Low High Defined Off Off GPIO[28:27] Suspend Low Low Defined Defined Defined GPIO3311, GPIO32 Core High High Defined Off Off GPIO34 HDA Low Low Defined Off Off 11 Core High High Defined Off Off GPIO56 Suspend Input Input Defined Defined Defined SPI_CS0# Controller Link High High Defined Defined Defined SPI_CS1#11 Controller Link High High Defined Defined Defined SPI_MOSI11 Controller Link Low Low Defined Defined Defined SPI_CLK Controller Link Low Low Running Defined Defined Defined10 Defined10 Defined10 GPIO49 SPI Interface Controller Link CL_CLK0 86 Controller Link Low Low Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-2. Power Plane and States for Output and I/O Signals for Configurations (Sheet 5 of 5) Signal Name Power Plane During Reset4 Immediately after Reset4 CL_DATA0 Controller Link Low CL_RST0# Suspend Low Intel ® C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 Low Defined10 Defined10 Defined10 High Defined10 Defined10 Defined10 Quiet System Technology PWM[2:0] Core High-Z Low Defined Off Off SST Controller Link High-Z Low Defined Off Off PECI CPU High-Z Low Defined Off Off NOTES: 1. ICH10 drives these signals High after the processor Reset 2. GPIO[18] will toggle at a frequency of approximately 1 Hz when the ICH10 comes out of reset 3. CPUPWRGD represents a logical AND of the ICH10’s VRMPWRGD and PWROK signals, and thus will be driven low by ICH10 when either VRMPWRGD or PWROK are inactive. During boot, or during a hard reset with power cycling, CPUPWRGD will be expected to transition from low to High-Z. 4. The states of Core and processor signals are evaluated at the times During PLTRST# and Immediately after PLTRST#. The states of the LAN and GLAN signals are evaluated at the times During LAN_RST# and Immediately after LAN_RST#. The states of the Controller Link signals are taken at the times During CL_RST# and Immediately after CL_RST#. The states of the Suspend signals are evaluated at the times During RSMRST# and Immediately after RSMRST#. The states of the HDA signals are evaluated at the times During HDA_RST# and Immediately after HDA_RST#. 5. ICH10 drives these signals Low before PWROK rising and Low after the processor Reset. 6. SLP_S5# signals will be high in the S4 state. 7. Low until Intel High Definition Audio Controller Reset bit set (D27:F0:Offset HDBAR+08h:bit 0), at which time HDA_RST# will be High and HDA_BIT_CLK will be Running. 8. PETp/n[6:1] high until port is enabled by software. 9. The SLP_M# state will be determined by Intel AMT Policies. 10. The state of signals in S3-5 will be defined by Intel AMT Policies. 11. This signal is sampled as a functional strap during reset. 12. The state of DRAMPWROK during S3/S4/S5 is dependent on the SLP_S4# and CLPWROK signals. Datasheet 87 Intel® ICH10 Pin States 3.3 Power Planes for Input Signals Table 3-3 shows the power plane associated with each input signal, as well as what device drives the signal at various times. Valid states include: High Low Static: Will be high or low, but will not change Driven: Will be high or low, and is allowed to change Running: For input clocks The ICH10 suspend well signal states are indeterminate and undefined and may glitch prior to RSMRST# deassertion. This does not apply to LAN_RST#, SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, S4_STATE# and SLP_S5#. These signals are determinate and defined prior to RSMRST# deassertion. The ICH10 core well signal states are indeterminate and undefined and may glitch prior to PWROK assertion. This does not apply to FERR# and THRMTRIP#. These signals are determinate and defined prior to PWROK assertion. Table 3-3. Power Plane for Input Signals for Configurations (Sheet 1 of 3) Signal Name Power Well Driver During Reset C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 DMI DMI_CLKP, DMI_CLKN Core Clock Generator Running Off Off DMI[3:0]RXP, DMI[3:0]RXN Core (G)MCH Driven Off Off Driven Off Off Off Off PCI Express* PERp[5:1], PERn[5:1], PERp6 / GLAN_RXp, PERn6 / GLAN_RXn Core PCI Express* Device PCI Bus REQ0#, REQ1# / GPIO501 REQ2# / GPIO521 REQ3# / GPIO541 Core External Pull-up Driven PCICLK Core Clock Generator Running Off Off PME# Suspend Internal Pull-up Driven Driven Driven SERR# Core PCI Bus Peripherals High Off Off LPC Interface LDRQ0# Core LPC Devices High Off Off LDRQ1# / GPIO231 Core LPC Devices High Off Off LAN Connect Interface 88 GLAN_CLK Suspend LAN Connect Component Driven Off Off LAN_RXD[2:0] Suspend LAN Connect Component Driven Driven Driven Datasheet Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-3. Power Plane for Input Signals for Configurations (Sheet 2 of 3) Signal Name Power Well Driver During Reset C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 Driven Off Off Gigabit LAN Connect Interface GLAN_RXp / PERp6, GLAN_RXn / PERn6 Suspend Gigabit Lan Connect Component SATA Interface SATA_CLKP, SATA_CLKN Core Clock Generator Running Off Off SATA[5:0]RXP, SATA[5:0]RXN Core SATA Drive Driven Off Off SATARBIAS# Core External Pull-down Driven Off Off SATA[5:4]GP SATA[3:0]GP / GPIO[37, 36, 19, 21]1 Core External Device or External Pull-up/Pulldown Driven Off Off USB Interface OC0# / GPIO59, OC[4:1]# / GPIO[43:40], OC[7:5]# / GPIO [31:29], OC[11:8]# / GPIO[47:44] Suspend External Pull-ups Driven Driven Driven USBRBIAS# Suspend External Pull-down Driven Driven Driven Power Management BMBUSY# /GPIO01 Core Graphics Component [(G)MCH] Driven High Off CLPWROK Suspend External Circuit Driven Driven Driven LAN_RST# Suspend External Circuit High High High MCH_SYNC# Core (G)MCH Driven Off Off PWRBTN# Suspend Internal Pull-up Driven Driven Driven PWROK RTC System Power Supply Driven Off Off RI# Suspend Serial Port Buffer Driven Driven Driven RSMRST# RTC External RC Circuit High High High SYS_RESET# Suspend External Circuit Driven Driven Driven THRM# Core Thermal Sensor Driven Off Off THRMTRIP# CPU Thermal Sensor Driven Off Off VRMPWRGD Suspend Processor Voltage Regulator High Low Low WAKE# Suspend External Pull-up Driven Driven Driven Processor Interface A20GATE Core External Microcontroller Static Off Off FERR# Core Processor Static Off Off Core External Microcontroller High Off Off RCIN# Datasheet 89 Intel® ICH10 Pin States Table 3-3. Power Plane for Input Signals for Configurations (Sheet 3 of 3) Signal Name Power Well Driver During Reset C3/C4 S1 S3 S4/S5 Driven Driven Driven Driven High High SMBus Interface SMBALERT# / GPIO11 / JTAGTDO1 (Corporate Only) Suspend External Pull-up System Management Interface INTRUDER# RTC External Switch Miscellaneous Signals INTVRMEN RTC External Pull-up High High High LAN100_SLP RTC External Pull-up High High High RTCRST# RTC External RC Circuit High High High SRTCRST# RTC External RC Circuit High High High CL_VREF0 Controller Link Driven Driven Driven TP0 / GPIO72 (Corporate Only) Suspend High High High Low Low Low Driven Driven Driven Driven Off Off Consumer Only: External Circuit2 Corporate Only: Internal Circuit3 External Pull-up Intel® High Definition Audio Interface HDA_SDIN[3:0] Suspend Intel High Definition Audio Codec SPI Interface SPI_MISO Controller Link Internal Pull-up Intel® Quiet System Technology TACH[3:0]/ GPIO[7,6,1,17]1 Core External Pull-up Clocks CLK14 Core Clock Generator Running Off Off CLK48 Core Clock Generator Running Off Off NOTES: 1. These signals can be configured as outputs in GPIO mode.The state of the DPRSLPVR and DPRSTP# signals in C4 are high if Deeper Sleep is enabled or low if it is disabled. 2. Consumer Only: CL_VREF0 is driven by an external circuit except on platforms where the MCH does not support Controller Link. In these platforms, the signal is not driven. 3. Corporate Only: CL_VREF0 may optionally be driven by an external circuit, as configured by CLINKVREFSEL (ICHSTRP0:bit 5). §§ 90 Datasheet Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains 4 Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains Table 4-1 shows the system clock domains. Figure 4-1 shows the assumed connection of the various system components, including the clock generator. For complete details of the system clocking solution, refer to the system’s clock generator component specification. Table 4-1. Datasheet Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains Clock Domain Frequency Source ICH10 SATA_CLKP, SATA_CLKN 100 MHz Main Clock Generator Differential clock pair used for SATA. ICH10 DMI_CLKP, DMI_CLKN 100 MHz Main Clock Generator Differential clock pair used for DMI. ICH10 PCICLK 33 MHz Main Clock Generator Free-running PCI Clock to Intel ICH10. This clock remains on during S0 and S1 state, and is expected to be shut off during S3 or below. System PCI 33 MHz Main Clock Generator PCI Bus, LPC I/F. These only go to external PCI and LPC devices. ICH10 CLK48 48.000 MHz Main Clock Generator Super I/O, USB controllers. Expected to be shut off during S3. ICH10 CLK14 14.31818 MHz Main Clock Generator Used for ACPI timer and HPET timers. Expected to be shut off during S3. GLAN_CLK 5 to 62.5 MHz LAN Connect Component SPI_CLK 17.86 MHz/ 31.25 MHz ICH Usage Generated by the LAN Connect component. Expected to be shut off during S3. Generated by the ICH. Expected to be shut off during S3. 91 Intel® ICH10 and System Clock Domains Figure 4-1. ICH10 Conceptual System Clock Diagram 33 MHz 14.31818 MHz 48.000 MHz PCI Clocks (33 MHz) Clock Gen. STP_CPU# STP_PCI# ® Intel ICH10 14.31818 MHz 48 MHz SATA 100 MHz Diff. Pair DMI 100 MHz Diff. Pair 100 MHz Diff. Pair 1 to 6 Differential Clock Fan Out Device 62.5 MHz LAN Connect 24 MHz HD Audio Codec(s) PCI Express 100 MHz Diff. Pairs 32 kHz XTAL SUSCLK# (32 kHz) §§ §§ § 92 Datasheet Functional Description 5 Functional Description This chapter describes the functions and interfaces of the Intel ICH10 family. 5.1 DMI-to-PCI Bridge (D30:F0) The DMI-to-PCI bridge resides in PCI Device 30, Function 0 on bus #0. This portion of the ICH10 implements the buffering and control logic between PCI and Direct Media Interface (DMI). The arbitration for the PCI bus is handled by this PCI device. The PCI decoder in this device must decode the ranges for the DMI. All register contents are lost when core well power is removed. Direct Media Interface (DMI) is the chip-to-chip connection between the Memory Controller Hub / Graphics and Memory Controller Hub ((G)MCH) and I/O Controller Hub 10 (ICH10). This high-speed interface integrates advanced priority-based servicing allowing for concurrent traffic and true isochronous transfer capabilities. Base functionality is completely software transparent permitting current and legacy software to operate normally. To provide for true isochronous transfers and configurable Quality of Service (QoS) transactions, the ICH10 supports two virtual channels on DMI: VC0 and VC1. These two channels provide a fixed arbitration scheme where VC1 is always the highest priority. VC0 is the default conduit of traffic for DMI and is always enabled. VC1 must be specifically enabled and configured at both ends of the DMI link (i.e., the ICH10 and (G)MCH). Configuration registers for DMI, virtual channel support, and DMI active state power management (ASPM) are in the RCRB space in the Chipset Config Registers (Chapter 10). DMI is also capable of operating in an Enterprise Southbridge Interface (ESI) compatible mode. ESI is a chip-to-chip connection for server chipsets. In this ESIcompatible mode, the DMI signals require AC coupling. A hardware strap is used to configure DMI in ESI-compatible mode see Section 2.25 for details. 5.1.1 PCI Bus Interface The ICH10 PCI interface supports PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3, at 33 MHz. The ICH10 integrates a PCI arbiter that supports up to four external PCI bus masters in addition to the internal ICH10 requests. 5.1.2 PCI Bridge As an Initiator The bridge initiates cycles on the PCI bus when granted by the PCI arbiter. The bridge generates the cycle types listed in Table 5-1. Table 5-1. PCI Bridge Initiator Cycle Types Command Datasheet C/BE# Notes I/O Read/Write 2h/3h Non-posted Memory Read/Write 6h/7h Writes are posted Configuration Read/Write Ah/Bh Non-posted Special Cycles 1h Posted 93 Functional Description 5.1.2.1 Memory Reads and Writes The bridge bursts memory writes on PCI that are received as a single packet from DMI. 5.1.2.2 I/O Reads and Writes The bridge generates single DW I/O read and write cycles. When the cycle completes on the PCI bus, the bridge generates a corresponding completion on DMI. If the cycle is retried, the cycle is kept in the down bound queue and may be passed by a postable cycle. 5.1.2.3 Configuration Reads and Writes The bridge generates single DW configuration read and write cycles. When the cycle completes on the PCI bus, the bridge generates a corresponding completion. If the cycle is retried, the cycle is kept in the down bound queue and may be passed by a postable cycle. 5.1.2.4 Locked Cycles The bridge propagates locks from DMI per the PCI Local Bus Specification. The PCI bridge implements bus lock, which means the arbiter will not grant to any agent except DMI while locked. If a locked read results in a target or master abort, the lock is not established (as per the PCI Local Bus Specification). Agents north of the ICH10 must not forward a subsequent locked read to the bridge if they see the first one finish with a failed completion. 5.1.2.5 Target / Master Aborts When a cycle initiated by the bridge is master/target aborted, the bridge will not reattempt the same cycle. For multiple DW cycles, the bridge increments the address and attempts the next DW of the transaction. For all non-postable cycles, a target abort response packet is returned for each DW that was master or target aborted on PCI. The bridge drops posted writes that abort. 5.1.2.6 Secondary Master Latency Timer The bridge implements a Master Latency Timer via the SMLT register which, upon expiration, causes the de-assertion of FRAME# at the next legal clock edge when there is another active request to use the PCI bus. 5.1.2.7 Dual Address Cycle (DAC) The bridge will issue full 64-bit dual address cycles for device memory-mapped registers above 4 GB. 94 Datasheet Functional Description 5.1.2.8 Memory and I/O Decode to PCI The PCI bridge in the ICH10 is a subtractive decode agent, which follows the following rules when forwarding a cycle from DMI to the PCI interface: • The PCI bridge will positively decode any memory/IO address within its window registers, assuming PCICMD.MSE (D30:F0:Offset 04h:bit 1) is set for memory windows and PCICMD.IOSE (D30:F0:Offset 04h:bit 0) is set for IO windows. • The PCI bridge will subtractively decode any 64-bit memory address not claimed by another agent, assuming PCICMD.MSE (D30:F0:Offset 04h:bit 1) is set. • The PCI bridge will subtractively decode any 16-bit I/O address not claimed by another agent assuming PCICMD.IOSE (D30:F0:Offset 04h:bit 0) is set. • If BCTRL.IE (D30:F0:Offset 3Eh:bit 2) is set, the PCI bridge will not positively forward from primary to secondary called out ranges in the IO window per PCI Local Bus Specification (I/O transactions addressing the last 768 bytes in each, 1 KB block: offsets 100h to 3FFh). The PCI bridge will still take them subtractively assuming the above rules. • If BCTRL.VGAE (D30:F0:Offset 3Eh:bit 3) is set, the PCI bridge will positively forward from primary to secondary I/O and memory ranges as called out in the PCI Bridge Specification, assuming the above rules are met. 5.1.3 Parity Error Detection and Generation PCI parity errors can be detected and reported. The following behavioral rules apply: • When a parity error is detected on PCI, the bridge sets the SECSTS.DPE (D30:F0:Offset 1Eh:bit 15). • If the bridge is a master and BCTRL.PERE (D30:F0:Offset 3Eh:bit 0) is set and one of the parity errors defined below is detected on PCI, then the bridge will set SECSTS.DPD (D30:F0:Offset 1Eh:bit 8) and will also generate an internal SERR#. — During a write cycle, the PERR# signal is active, or — A data parity error is detected while performing a read cycle • If an address or command parity error is detected on PCI and PCICMD.SEE (D30:F0:Offset 04h:bit 8), BCTRL.PERE, and BCTRL.SEE (D30:F0:Offset 3Eh:bit 1) are all set, the bridge will set PSTS.SSE (D30:F0:Offset 06h:bit 14) and generate an internal SERR#. • If the PSTS.SSE is set because of an address parity error and the PCICMD.SEE is set, the bridge will generate an internal SERR# • When bad parity is detected from DMI, bad parity will be driven on all data from the bridge. • When an address parity error is detected on PCI, the PCI bridge will never claim the cycle. This is a slight deviation from the PCI bridge specification, which says that a cycle should be claimed if BCTRL.PERE is not set. However, DMI does not have a concept of address parity error, so claiming the cycle could result in the rest of the system seeing a bad transaction as a good transaction. Datasheet 95 Functional Description 5.1.4 PCIRST# The PCIRST# pin is generated under two conditions: • PLTRST# active • BCTRL.SBR (D30:F0:Offset 3Eh:bit 6) set to 1 The PCIRST# pin is in the suspend well. PCIRST# should be tied to PCI bus agents, but not other agents in the system. 5.1.5 Peer Cycles The PCI bridge may be the initiator of peer cycles. Peer cycles include memory, IO, and configuration cycle types. Peer cycles are only allowed through VC0, and are enabled with the following bits: • BPC.PDE (D30:F0:Offset 4Ch:bit 2) – Memory and I/O cycles • BPC.CDE (D30:F0:Offset 4Ch:bit 1) – Configuration cycles When enabled for peer for one of the above cycle types, the PCI bridge will perform a peer decode to see if a peer agent can receive the cycle. When not enabled, memory cycles (posted and/or non-posted) are sent to DMI, and I/O and/or configuration cycles are not claimed. Configuration cycles have special considerations. Under the PCI Local Bus Specification, these cycles are not allowed to be forwarded upstream through a bridge. However, to enable things such as manageability, BPC.CDE can be set. When set, type 1 cycles are allowed into the part. The address format of the type 1 cycle is slightly different from a standard PCI configuration cycle to allow addressing of extended PCI space. The format is shown in Table 5-2. Table 5-2. Type 1 Address Format Bits Definition 31:27 Reserved (same as the PCI Local Bus Specification) 26:24 Extended Configuration Address – allows addressing of up to 4K. These bits are combined with bits 7:2 to get the full register. 23:16 Bus Number (same as the PCI Local Bus Specification) 15:11 Device Number (same as the PCI Local Bus Specification) 10:8 Function Number (same as the PCI Local Bus Specification) 7:2 Register (same as the PCI Local Bus Specification) 1 0 0 Must be 1 to indicate a type 1 cycle. Type 0 cycles are not decoded. Note: The ICH10’s USB controllers cannot perform peer-to-peer traffic. 5.1.6 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Model From a software perspective, the ICH10 contains a PCI-to-PCI bridge. This bridge connects DMI to the PCI bus. By using the PCI-to-PCI bridge software model, the ICH10 can have its decode ranges programmed by existing plug-and-play software such that PCI ranges do not conflict with graphics aperture ranges in the Host controller. 96 Datasheet Functional Description 5.1.7 IDSEL to Device Number Mapping When addressing devices on the external PCI bus (with the PCI slots), the ICH10 asserts one address signal as an IDSEL. When accessing device 0, the ICH10 asserts AD16. When accessing Device 1, the ICH10 asserts AD17. This mapping continues all the way up to device 15 where the ICH10 asserts AD31. Note that the ICH10’s internal functions (Intel High Definition Audio, USB, SATA and PCI Bridge) are enumerated like they are off of a separate PCI bus (DMI) from the external PCI bus. 5.1.8 Standard PCI Bus Configuration Mechanism The PCI Bus defines a slot based “configuration space” that allows each device to contain up to eight functions with each function containing up to 256, 8-bit configuration registers. The PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3 defines two bus cycles to access the PCI configuration space: Configuration Read and Configuration Write. Memory and I/O spaces are supported directly by the processor. Configuration space is supported by a mapping mechanism implemented within the ICH10. The PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3 defines two mechanisms to access configuration space, Mechanism 1 and Mechanism 2. The ICH10 only supports Mechanism 1. Warning: Configuration writes to internal devices, when the devices are disabled, are invalid and may cause undefined results. 5.2 PCI Express* Root Ports (D28:F0,F1,F2,F3,F4,F5) There are six root ports available in ICH10. These all reside in device 28, and take function 0 – 5. Port 1 is function 0, port 2 is function 1, port 3 is function 2, port 4 is function 3, port 5 is function 4, and port 6 is function 5. PCI Express Root Ports 1-4 can be statically configured as four x1 Ports or ganged together to form one x4 port. Ports 5 and 6 can only be used as two x1 ports. The port configuration is set by RCBA 224h [Bits 1:0] see Section 10.1.38 for more details. 5.2.1 Interrupt Generation The root port generates interrupts on behalf of Hot-Plug and power management events, when enabled. These interrupts can either be pin based, or can be MSIs, when enabled. When an interrupt is generated via the legacy pin, the pin is internally routed to the ICH10 interrupt controllers. The pin that is driven is based upon the setting of the chipset configuration registers. Specifically, the chipset configuration registers used are the D28IP (Base address + 310Ch) and D28IR (Base address + 3146h) registers. Datasheet 97 Functional Description Table 5-3 summarizes interrupt behavior for MSI and wire-modes. In the table “bits” refers to the Hot-Plug and PME interrupt bits. Table 5-3. MSI versus PCI IRQ Actions Interrupt Register Wire-Mode Action MSI Action All bits 0 Wire inactive No action One or more bits set to 1 Wire active Send message One or more bits set to 1, new bit gets set to 1 Wire active Send message One or more bits set to 1, software clears some (but not all) bits Wire active Send message One or more bits set to 1, software clears all bits Wire inactive No action Software clears one or more bits, and one or more bits are set on the same clock Wire active Send message 5.2.2 Power Management 5.2.2.1 S3/S4/S5 Support Software initiates the transition to S3/S4/S5 by performing an IO write to the Power Management Control register in the ICH10. After the IO write completion has been returned to the processor, each root port will send a PME_Turn_Off TLP (Transaction Layer Packet) message on its downstream link. The device attached to the link will eventually respond with a PME_TO_Ack TLP message followed by sending a PM_Enter_L23 DLLP (Data Link Layer Packet) request to enter the L2/L3 Ready state. When all of the ICH10 root ports links are in the L2/L3 Ready state, the ICH10 power management control logic will proceed with the entry into S3/S4/S5. Prior to entering S3, software is required to put each device into D3HOT. When a device is put into D3HOT it will initiate entry into a L1 link state by sending a PM_Enter_L1 DLLP. Thus under normal operating conditions when the root ports sends the PME_Turn_Off message the link will be in state L1. However, when the root port is instructed to send the PME_Turn_Off message, it will send it whether or not the link was in L1. Endpoints attached to ICH can make no assumptions about the state of the link prior to receiving a PME_Turn_Off message. 5.2.2.2 Resuming from Suspended State The root port contains enough circuitry in the suspend well to detect a wake event through the WAKE# signal and to wake the system. When WAKE# is detected asserted, an internal signal is sent to the power management controller of the ICH10 to cause the system to wake up. This internal message is not logged in any register, nor is an interrupt/GPE generated due to it. 5.2.2.3 Device Initiated PM_PME Message When the system has returned to a working state from a previous low power state, a device requesting service will send a PM_PME message continuously, until acknowledge by the root port. The root port will take different actions depending upon whether this is the first PM_PME has been received, or whether a previous message has been received but not yet serviced by the operating system. 98 Datasheet Functional Description If this is the first message received (RSTS.PS - D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset 60h:bit 16 is cleared), the root port will set RSTS.PS, and log the PME Requester ID into RSTS.RID (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset 60h:bits 15:0). If an interrupt is enabled via RCTL.PIE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset 5Ch:bit 3), an interrupt will be generated. This interrupt can be either a pin or an MSI if MSI is enabled via MC.MSIE (D28:F0/F1/ F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset 82h:bit 0). See Section 5.2.2.4 for SMI/SCI generation. If this is a subsequent message received (RSTS.PS is already set), the root port will set RSTS.PP (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset 60h:bit 17) and log the PME Requester ID from the message in a hidden register. No other action will be taken. When the first PME event is cleared by software clearing RSTS.PS, the root port will set RSTS.PS, clear RSTS.PP, and move the requester ID from the hidden register into RSTS.RID. If RCTL.PIE is set, an interrupt will be generated. If RCTL.PIE is not set, a message will be sent to the power management controller so that a GPE can be set. If messages have been logged (RSTS.PS is set), and RCTL.PIE is later written from a 0 to a 1, and interrupt will be generated. This last condition handles the case where the message was received prior to the operating system re-enabling interrupts after resuming from a low power state. 5.2.2.4 SMI/SCI Generation Interrupts for power management events are not supported on legacy operating systems. To support power management on non-PCI Express aware operating systems, PM events can be routed to generate SCI. To generate SCI, MPC.PMCE must be set. When set, a power management event will cause SMSCS.PMCS (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/ F5:Offset DCh:bit 31) to be set. Additionally, BIOS workarounds for power management can be supported by setting MPC.PMME (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset D8h:bit 0). When this bit is set, power management events will set SMSCS.PMMS (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 0), and SMI # will be generated. This bit will be set regardless of whether interrupts or SCI is enabled. The SMI# may occur concurrently with an interrupt or SCI. 5.2.3 SERR# Generation SERR# may be generated via two paths – through PCI mechanisms involving bits in the PCI header, or through PCI Express* mechanisms involving bits in the PCI Express capability structure. Figure 5-1. Generation of SERR# to Platform Secondary Parity Error PCI PSTS.SSE Primary Parity Error Secondary SERR# PCICMD.SEE SERR# Correctable SERR# PCI Express Fatal SERR# Non-Fatal SERR# Datasheet 99 Functional Description 5.2.4 Hot-Plug Each root port implements a Hot-Plug controller which performs the following: • Messages to turn on / off / blink LEDs • Presence and attention button detection • Interrupt generation The root port only allows Hot-Plug with modules (e.g., ExpressCard*). Edge-connector based Hot-Plug is not supported. 5.2.4.1 Presence Detection When a module is plugged in and power is supplied, the physical layer will detect the presence of the device, and the root port sets SLSTS.PDS (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/ F5:Offset 5Ah:bit 6) and SLSTS.PDC (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3:Offset 6h:bit 3). If SLCTL.PDE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bit 3) and SLCTL.HPE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/ F5:Offset 58h:bit 5) are both set, the root port will also generate an interrupt. When a module is removed (via the physical layer detection), the root port clears SLSTS.PDS and sets SLSTS.PDC. If SLCTL.PDE and SLCTL.HPE are both set, the root port will also generate an interrupt. 5.2.4.2 Message Generation When system software writes to SLCTL.AIC (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bits 7:6) or SLCTL.PIC (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bits 9:8), the root port will send a message down the link to change the state of LEDs on the module. Writes to these fields are non-postable cycles, and the resulting message is a postable cycle. When receiving one of these writes, the root port performs the following: • Changes the state in the register. • Generates a completion into the upstream queue • Formulates a message for the downstream port if the field is written to regardless of if the field changed. • Generates the message on the downstream port • When the last message of a command is transmitted, sets SLSTS.CCE (D28:F0/F1/ F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bit 4) to indicate the command has completed. If SLCTL.CCE and SLCTL.HPE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bit 5) are set, the root port generates an interrupt. The command completed register (SLSTS.CC) applies only to commands issued by software to control the Attention Indicator (SLCTL.AIC), Power Indicator (SLCTL.PIC), or Power Controller (SLCTL.PCC). However, writes to other parts of the Slot Control Register would invariably end up writing to the indicators, power controller fields; Hence, any write to the Slot Control Register is considered a command and if enabled, will result in a command complete interrupt. The only exception to this rule is a write to disable the command complete interrupt which will not result in a command complete interrupt. A single write to the Slot Control register is considered to be a single command, and hence receives a single command complete, even if the write affects more than one field in the Slot Control Register. 100 Datasheet Functional Description 5.2.4.3 Attention Button Detection When an attached device is ejected, an attention button could be pressed by the user. This attention button press will result in a the PCI Express message “Attention_Button_Pressed” from the device. Upon receiving this message, the root port will set SLSTS.ABP (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 5Ah:bit 0). If SLCTL.ABE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bit 0) and SLCTL.HPE (D28:F0/F1/F2/ F3F4/F5:Offset 58h:bit 5) are set, the Hot-Plug controller will also generate an interrupt. The interrupt is generated on an edge-event. For example, if SLSTS.ABP is already set, a new interrupt will not be generated. 5.2.4.4 SMI/SCI Generation Interrupts for Hot-Plug events are not supported on legacy operating systems. To support Hot-Plug on non-PCI Express aware operating systems, Hot-Plug events can be routed to generate SCI. To generate SCI, MPC.HPCE (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset D8h:bit 30) must be set. When set, enabled Hot-Plug events will cause SMSCS.HPCS (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 30) to be set. Additionally, BIOS workarounds for Hot-Plug can be supported by setting MPC.HPME (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3F4/F5:Offset D8h:bit 1). When this bit is set, Hot-Plug events can cause SMI status bits in SMSCS to be set. Supported Hot-Plug events and their corresponding SMSCS bit are: • Command Completed - SCSCS.HPCCM (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 3) • Presence Detect Changed - SMSCS.HPPDM (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 1) • Attention Button Pressed - SMSCS.HPABM (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 2) • Link Active State Changed - SMSCS.HPLAS (D28:F0/F1/F2/F3/F4/F5:Offset DCh:bit 4) When any of these bits are set, SMI # will be generated. These bits are set regardless of whether interrupts or SCI is enabled for Hot-Plug events. The SMI# may occur concurrently with an interrupt or SCI. 5.3 Gigabit Ethernet Controller (B0:D25:F0) The ICH10 integrates a Gigabit Ethernet Controller. The integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller is compatible with Gigabit Ethernet PHY (Intel® 82567 Gigabit Platform LAN Connect device). The integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller provides two interfaces: LAN Connect Interface (LCI) for 10/100 operation and Gigabit LAN Connect Interface (GLCI) for Gigabit Ethernet operation. The GLCI is shared with the ICH10’s PCI Express port 6 and can be enabled via a soft strap that is stored in system SPI flash, see Section for details. The ICH10 integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller supports multi speed operation, 10/100/1000 MB/s. The integrated Gigabit Ethernet can operate in full-duplex at all supported speeds or half-duplex at 10/100 MB/s, and adheres with the IEEE 802.3x Flow Control Specification. Note: Gigabit Ethernet (1000Mb/s) is only supported in S0. The controller provides a system interface via a PCI function. A full memory-mapped or IO-mapped interface is provided to the software, along with DMA mechanisms for high performance data transfer. Datasheet 101 Functional Description The following summarizes the ICH10 integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller features: • Configurable LED operation for customization of LED display. • IPv4 and IPv6 Checksum Offload support (receive, transmit, and large send). • 64-bit address master support for system using more than 4 GB of physical memory. • Configurable receive and transmit data FIFO, programmable in 1 KB increments. • Intelligent interrupt generation to enhance driver performance. • Compliance with Advanced Configuration and Power Interface and PCI Power Management standards. • ACPI register set and power down functionality supporting D0 and D3 states. • Full wake-up support (APM and ACPI). • Magic Packet wake-up enable with unique MAC address. • Fragmented UDP checksum off load for package reassembly. • Jumbo frames supported. • LinkSec support (802.3ae compliant) • TimeSync support (802.1as compliant) 5.3.1 Gigabit Ethernet PCI Bus Interface The Gigabit Ethernet controller has a PCI interface to the host processor and host memory. The following sections detail the transaction on the bus. 5.3.1.1 Transaction Layer The upper layer of the host architecture is the transaction layer. The transaction layer connects to the device core using an implementation specific protocol. Through this core-to-transaction-layer protocol, the application-specific parts of the device interact with the subsystem and transmit and receive requests to or from the remote agent, respectively. 5.3.1.2 Data Alignment 5.3.1.2.1 4 K Boundary PCI requests must never specify an Address/Length combination that causes a Memory Space access to cross a 4 K boundary. It is the HW responsibility to break requests into 4 K-aligned requests (if needed). This does not pose any requirement on SW. However, if SW allocates a buffer across a 4 K boundary, HW will issue multiple requests for the buffer. SW should consider aligning buffers to 4 KB boundary in cases where it improves performance. The alignment to the 4 K boundaries is done in the core. The Transaction layer will not do any alignment according to these boundaries. 5.3.1.2.2 64 Bytes PCI requests are multiples of 64 bytes and aligned to make better use of memory controller resources. Writes, however, can be on any boundary and can cross a 64 byte alignment boundary 5.3.1.3 Configuration Request Retry Status The LAN Controller might have a delay in initialization due to NVM read. If the NVM configuration read operation is not completed and the device receives a Configuration Request, the device will respond with a Configuration Request Retry Completion Status to terminate the Request, and thus effectively stall the Configuration Request until such time that the subsystem has completed local initialization and is ready to communicate with the host. 102 Datasheet Functional Description 5.3.2 Error Events and Error Reporting 5.3.2.1 Data Parity Error The PCI Host bus does not provide parity protection, but it does forward parity errors from bridges. The LAN Controller recognizes parity errors through the internal bus interface and will set the Parity Error bit in PCI Configuration space. If parity errors are enabled in configuration space, a system error will be indicated on the PCI Host bus to the chipset. The offending cycle with a parity error will be dropped and not processed by the LAN Controller. 5.3.2.2 Completion with Unsuccessful Completion Status A completion with unsuccessful completion status (any status other than "000") will be dropped and not processed by the LAN Controller. Furthermore, the request that corresponds to the unsuccessful completion will not be retried. When this unsuccessful completion status is received, the System Error bit in the PCI Configuration space will be set. If the system errors are enabled in configuration space, a system error will be indicated on the PCI Host bus to the chipset. 5.3.3 Ethernet Interface The integrated LAN controller provides a complete CSMA/CD function supporting IEEE 802.3 (10Mb/s), 802.3u (100Mb/s) implementations. It also supports the IEEE 802.3z and 802.3ab (1000Mb/s) implementations. The device performs all of the functions required for transmission, reception and collision handling called out in the standards. The mode used to communicate between the LAN controller and the LAN connect device supports 10/100/1000 Mbps operation, with both half- and full-duplex operation at 10/100 Mbps, and full-duplex operation at 1000 Mbps. 5.3.3.1 MAC/LAN Connect Interface The integrated LAN controller and LAN Connect Device communicate through either the platform LAN connect interface (LCI) or Gigabit LAN connect interface (GLCI). All controller configuration is performed using device control registers mapped into system memory or I/O space. The LAN Connect Device is configured via the LCI or Gigabit Ethernet Lan connect interface. The integrated MAC supports various modes as summarized in the following table Table 5-4. LAN Mode Support Mode Normal 10/100/1000 Datasheet Interface Active LCI, GLCI Connections Intel® 82567 Gigabit Platform LAN Connect Device 103 Functional Description 5.3.4 PCI Power Management The LAN Controller supports the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI) specification as well as Advanced Power Management (APM). This allows the host to be awoken (i.e., from Sx (S3-S5) to S0) by network-related activity via an internal host wake signal. The LAN controller contains power management registers for PCI, and supports D0 and D3 states. PCI transactions are only allowed in the D0 state, except for host accesses to the LAN controller’s PCI configuration registers. 5.3.4.1 Wake-Up The LAN Controller supports two types of wakeup mechanisms: 1. Advanced Power Management (APM) Wakeup 2. ACPI Power Management Wakeup Both mechanisms use an internal WAKE# signal to wake the system up. This signal is connected to the suspend wake logic in the ICH10. The wake-up steps are as follows: 1. Host Wake Event occurs (note that packet is not delivered to host) 2. PME_STATUS bit is set 3. Internal WAKE# signal asserted by Host LAN function 4. System wakes from Sx state to S0 state 5. The Host LAN function is transitioned to D0 6. The Host clears the PME_STATUS bit 7. Internal WAKE# signal is deasserted by Host LAN function 5.3.4.1.1 Advanced Power Management Wakeup Advanced Power Management Wakeup, or APM Wakeup, was previously known as Wake on LAN. It is a feature that has existed in the 10/100 Mbps NICs for several generations. The basic premise is to receive a broadcast or unicast packet with an explicit data pattern, and then to assert a signal to wake-up the system. In the earlier generations, this was accomplished by using a special signal that ran across a cable to a defined connector on the motherboard. The NIC would assert the signal for approximately 50ms to signal a wakeup. The LAN Controller uses (if configured to) an in-band PM_PME message for this. On power-up, the LAN Controller will read the APM Enable bits from the NVM PCI Init Control Word into the APM Enable (APME) bits of the Wakeup Control Register (WUC). These bits control enabling of APM Wakeup. When APM Wakeup is enabled, the LAN Controller checks all incoming packets for Magic Packets. Once the LAN Controller receives a matching magic packet, it will: • Set the Magic Packet Received bit in the Wake Up Status Register (WUS). • Set the PME_Status bit in the Power Management Control / Status Register (PMCSR) and assert the internal WAKE# signal. APM Wakeup is supported in all power states and only disabled if a subsequent NVM read results in the APM Wake Up bit being cleared or the software explicitly writes a 0 to the APM Wake Up (APM) bit of the WUC register. 104 Datasheet Functional Description 5.3.4.1.2 ACPI Power Management Wakeup The LAN Controller supports ACPI Power Management based Wakeups. It can generate system wake-up events from three sources: • Reception of a Magic Packet. • Reception of a Network Wakeup Packet. • Detection of a link change of state. Activating ACPI Power Management Wakeup requires the following steps: • The driver programs the Wake Up Filter Control Register (WUFC) to indicate the packets it wishes to wake up from and supplies the necessary data to the Ipv4 Address Table (IP4AT) and the Flexible Filter Mask Table (FFMT), Flexible Filter Length Table (FFLT), and the Flexible Filter Value Table (FFVT). It can also set the Link Status Change Wake Up Enable (LNKC) bit in the Wake Up Filter Control Register (WUFC) to cause wakeup when the link changes state. • The OS (at configuration time) writes a 1 to the PME_EN bit of the Power Management Control / Status Register (PMCSR.8). Normally, after enabling wakeup, the OS will write 11b to the lower two bits of the PMCSR to put the LAN Controller into low-power mode. Once Wakeup is enabled, the LAN Controller monitors incoming packets, first filtering them according to its standard address filtering method, then filtering them with all of the enabled wakeup filters. If a packet passes both the standard address filtering and at least one of the enabled wakeup filters, the LAN Controller will: • Set the PME_Status bit in the Power Management Control / Status Register (PMCSR) • If the PME_EN bit in the Power Management Control / Status Register (PMCSR) is set, assert the internal WAKE# signal. • Set one or more of the Received bits in the Wake Up Status Register (WUS). (More than one bit will be set if a packet matches more than one filter.) If enabled, a link state change wakeup will cause similar results, setting PME_Status, asserting the internal WAKE# signal and setting the Link Status Changed (LNKC) bit in the Wake Up Status Register (WUS) when the link goes up or down. The internal WAKE# signal will remain asserted until the OS either writes a 1 to the PME_Status bit of the PMCSR register or writes a 0 to the PME_En bit. After receiving a wakeup packet, the LAN Controller will ignore any subsequent wakeup packets until the driver clears all of the Received bits in the Wake Up Status Register (WUS). It will also ignore link change events until the driver clears the Link Status Changed (LNKC) bit in the Wake Up Status Register (WUS). 5.3.5 Configurable LEDs The LAN Controller supports 3 controllable and configurable LEDs that are driven from the LAN Connect Device. Each of the three LED outputs can be individually configured to select the particular event, state, or activity, which will be indicated on that output. In addition, each LED can be individually configured for output polarity as well as for blinking versus non-blinking (steady-state) indication. The configuration for LED outputs is specified via the LEDCTL register. Furthermore, the hardware-default configuration for all the LED outputs, can be specified via NVM fields, thereby supporting LED displays configurable to a particular OEM preference. Datasheet 105 Functional Description Each of the 3 LED's may be configured to use one of a variety of sources for output indication. The MODE bits control the LED source: • LINK_100/1000 is asserted when link is established at either 100 or 1000Mbps. • LINK_10/1000 is asserted when link is established at either 10 or 1000Mbps. • LINK_UP is asserted when any speed link is established and maintained. ACTIVITY is asserted when link is established and packets are being transmitted or received. • LINK/ACTIVITY is asserted when link is established AND there is NO transmit or receive activity • LINK_10 is asserted when a 10Mbps link is established and maintained. • LINK_100 is asserted when a 100Mbps link is established and maintained. • LINK_1000 is asserted when a 1000Mbps link is established and maintained. • FULL_DUPLEX is asserted when the link is configured for full duplex operation. • COLLISION is asserted when a collision is observed. • PAUSED is asserted when the device's transmitter is flow controlled. • LED_ON is always asserted; LED_OFF is always de-asserted. The IVRT bits allow the LED source to be inverted before being output or observed by the blink-control logic. LED outputs are assumed to normally be connected to the negative side (cathode) of an external LED. The BLINK bits control whether the LED should be blinked while the LED source is asserted, and the blinking frequency (either 200 ms on and 200 ms off or 83 ms on and 83 ms off). The blink control may be especially useful for ensuring that certain events, such as ACTIVITY indication, cause LED transitions, which are sufficiently visible to a human eye. The same blinking rate is shared by all LEDs. 5.3.6 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) The Gigabit LAN Controller supports the Function Level Reset (FLR) capability. The FLR capability can be used in conjunction with Intel Virtualization Technology. FLR allows an Operating System in a Virtual Machine to have complete control over a device, including its initialization, without interfering with the rest of the platform. The device provides a software interface that enables the Operating System to reset the whole device as if a PCI reset was asserted. 5.3.6.1 FLR Steps 5.3.6.1.1 FLR Initialization 1. A FLR is initiated by software writing a 1 to the Initiate FLR bit. 2. All subsequent requests targeting the Function will not be claimed and will be Master Abort Immediate on the bus. This includes any configuration, I/O or Memory cycles, however, the Function shall continue to accept completions targeting the Function. 5.3.6.1.2 FLR Operation Function will Reset all configuration, I/O and memory registers of the Function except those indicated otherwise and reset all internal states of the Function to the default or initial condition. 106 Datasheet Functional Description 5.3.6.1.3 FLR Completion The Initiate FLR bit is reset (cleared) when the FLR reset is completed. This bit can be used to indicate to the software that the FLR reset is completed. Note: From the time Initiate FLR bit is written to 1 software must wait at least 100 ms before accessing the function. 5.4 LPC Bridge (w/ System and Management Functions) (D31:F0) The LPC bridge function of the ICH10 resides in PCI Device 31:Function 0. In addition to the LPC bridge function, D31:F0 contains other functional units including DMA, Interrupt controllers, Timers, Power Management, System Management, GPIO, and RTC. In this chapter, registers and functions associated with other functional units (power management, GPIO, USB, etc.) are described in their respective sections. Note: The LPC bridge cannot be configured as a subtractive decode agent. 5.4.1 LPC Interface The ICH10 implements an LPC interface as described in the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. The LPC interface to the ICH10 is shown in Figure 5-2. Note that the ICH10 implements all of the signals that are shown as optional, but peripherals are not required to do so. Figure 5-2. LPC Interface Diagram PCI Bus PCI CLK Intel ® ICH10 PCI RST# PCI SERIRQ PCI PME# LAD [3:0] LFRAME# SUS_STAT# GPI Datasheet LDRQ[1:0]# (Optional) LPCPD# (Optional) LPC Device LSMI# (Optional) 107 Functional Description 5.4.1.1 LPC Cycle Types The ICH10 (Corporate only) implements all of the cycle types described in the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. ICH10 Consumer does not provide a generic mechanism for decoding memory ranges and forwarding them as standard LPC Memory cycles on the LPC bus. Table 5-5 shows the cycle types supported by the ICH10. Table 5-5. LPC Cycle Types Supported Cycle Type Comment Memory Read (Corporate only) 1 byte only. (See Note 1 below) Memory Write (Corporate only) 1 byte only. (See Note 1 below) I/O Read 1 byte only. Intel ICH10 breaks up 16- and 32-bit processor cycles into multiple 8-bit transfers. I/O Write 1 byte only. ICH10 breaks up 16- and 32-bit processor cycles into multiple 8-bit transfers. DMA Read Can be 1, or 2 bytes DMA Write Can be 1, or 2 bytes Bus Master Read Can be 1, 2, or 4 bytes. (See Note 2 below) Bus Master Write Can be 1, 2, or 4 bytes. (See Note 2 below) NOTES: 1. ICH10 (Corporate only) provides a single generic memory range (LGMR) for decoding memory cycles and forwarding them as LPC Memory cycles on the LPC bus. The LGMR memory decode range is 64 KB in size and can be defined as being anywhere in the 4 GB memory space. This range needs to be configured by BIOS during POST to provide the necessary memory resources. BIOS should advertise the LPC Generic Memory Range as Reserved to the OS in order to avoid resource conflict. For larger transfers, the ICH10 performs multiple 8-bit transfers. If the cycle is not claimed by any peripheral, it is subsequently aborted, and the ICH10 returns a value of all 1s to the processor. This is done to maintain compatibility with ISA memory cycles where pull-up resistors would keep the bus high if no device responds. 2. Bus Master Read or Write cycles must be naturally aligned. For example, a 1-byte transfer can be to any address. However, the 2-byte transfer must be word-aligned (i.e., with an address where A0=0). A dword transfer must be dword-aligned (i.e., with an address where A1 and A0 are both 0). 5.4.1.2 Start Field Definition Table 5-6. Start Field Bit Definitions Bits[3:0] Encoding Definition 0000 Start of cycle for a generic target 0010 Grant for bus master 0 0011 Grant for bus master 1 1111 Stop/Abort: End of a cycle for a target. NOTE: All other encodings are RESERVED. 108 Datasheet Functional Description 5.4.1.3 Cycle Type / Direction (CYCTYPE + DIR) The ICH10 always drives bit 0 of this field to 0. Peripherals running bus master cycles must also drive bit 0 to 0. Table 5-7 shows the valid bit encodings. Table 5-7. 5.4.1.4 Cycle Type Bit Definitions Bits[3:2] Bit1 Definition 00 0 I/O Read 00 1 I/O Write 01 0 Memory Read 01 1 Memory Read 10 0 DMA Read 10 1 DMA Write 11 x Reserved. If a peripheral performing a bus master cycle generates this value, the Intel ICH10 aborts the cycle. Size Bits[3:2] are reserved. The ICH10 always drives them to 00. Peripherals running bus master cycles are also supposed to drive 00 for bits 3:2; however, the ICH10 ignores those bits. Bits[1:0] are encoded as listed in Table 5-8. Table 5-8. Transfer Size Bit Definition Bits[1:0] Datasheet Size 00 8-bit transfer (1 byte) 01 16-bit transfer (2 bytes) 10 Reserved. The Intel ICH10 never drives this combination. If a peripheral running a bus master cycle drives this combination, the ICH10 may abort the transfer. 11 32-bit transfer (4 bytes) 109 Functional Description 5.4.1.5 SYNC Valid values for the SYNC field are shown in Table 5-9. Table 5-9. SYNC Bit Definition Bits[3:0] Indication 0000 Ready: SYNC achieved with no error. For DMA transfers, this also indicates DMA request deassertion and no more transfers desired for that channel. 0101 Short Wait: Part indicating wait-states. For bus master cycles, the Intel® ICH10 does not use this encoding. Instead, the ICH10 uses the Long Wait encoding (see next encoding below). 0110 Long Wait: Part indicating wait-states, and many wait-states will be added. This encoding driven by the ICH10 for bus master cycles, rather than the Short Wait (0101). 1001 Ready More (Used only by peripheral for DMA cycle): SYNC achieved with no error and more DMA transfers desired to continue after this transfer. This value is valid only on DMA transfers and is not allowed for any other type of cycle. 1010 Error: Sync achieved with error. This is generally used to replace the SERR# or IOCHK# signal on the PCI/ISA bus. It indicates that the data is to be transferred, but there is a serious error in this transfer. For DMA transfers, this not only indicates an error, but also indicates DMA request deassertion and no more transfers desired for that channel. NOTES: 1. All other combinations are RESERVED. 2. If the LPC controller receives any SYNC returned from the device other than short (0101), long wait (0110), or ready (0000) when running a FWH cycle, indeterminate results may occur. A FWH device is not allowed to assert an Error SYNC. 5.4.1.6 SYNC Time-Out There are several error cases that can occur on the LPC interface. The ICH10 responds as defined in section 4.2.1.9 of the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1 to the stimuli described therein. There may be other peripheral failure conditions; however, these are not handled by the ICH10. 5.4.1.7 SYNC Error Indication The ICH10 responds as defined in section 4.2.1.10 of the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. Upon recognizing the SYNC field indicating an error, the ICH10 treats this as an SERR by reporting this into the Device 31 Error Reporting Logic. 110 Datasheet Functional Description 5.4.1.8 LFRAME# Usage The ICH10 follows the usage of LFRAME# as defined in the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. The ICH10 performs an abort for the following cases (possible failure cases): • ICH10 starts a Memory, I/O, or DMA cycle, but no device drives a valid SYNC after four consecutive clocks. • ICH10 starts a Memory, I/O, or DMA cycle, and the peripheral drives an invalid SYNC pattern. • A peripheral drives an invalid address when performing bus master cycles. • A peripheral drives an invalid value. 5.4.1.9 I/O Cycles For I/O cycles targeting registers specified in the ICH10’s decode ranges, the ICH10 performs I/O cycles as defined in the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. These are 8-bit transfers. If the processor attempts a 16-bit or 32-bit transfer, the ICH10 breaks the cycle up into multiple 8-bit transfers to consecutive I/O addresses. Note: If the cycle is not claimed by any peripheral (and subsequently aborted), the ICH10 returns a value of all 1s (FFh) to the processor. This is to maintain compatibility with ISA I/O cycles where pull-up resistors would keep the bus high if no device responds. 5.4.1.10 Bus Master Cycles The ICH10 supports Bus Master cycles and requests (using LDRQ#) as defined in the Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1. The ICH10 has two LDRQ# inputs, and thus supports two separate bus master devices. It uses the associated START fields for Bus Master 0 (0010b) or Bus Master 1 (0011b). Note: The ICH10 does not support LPC Bus Masters performing I/O cycles. LPC Bus Masters should only perform memory read or memory write cycles. 5.4.1.11 LPC Power Management LPCPD# Protocol Same timings as for SUS_STAT#. Upon driving SUS_STAT# low, LPC peripherals drive LDRQ# low or tri-state it. ICH10 shuts off the LDRQ# input buffers. After driving SUS_STAT# active, the ICH10 drives LFRAME# low, and tri-states (or drive low) LAD[3:0]. Note: Datasheet The Low Pin Count Interface Specification, Revision 1.1 defines the LPCPD# protocol where there is at least 30 µs from LPCPD# assertion to LRST# assertion. This specification explicitly states that this protocol only applies to entry/exit of low power states which does not include asynchronous reset events. The ICH10 asserts both SUS_STAT# (connects to LPCPD#) and PLTRST# (connects to LRST#) at the same time when the core logic is reset (via CF9h, PWROK, or SYS_RESET#, etc.). This is not inconsistent with the LPC LPCPD# protocol. 111 Functional Description 5.4.1.12 Configuration and Intel® ICH10 Implications LPC I/F Decoders To allow the I/O cycles and memory mapped cycles to go to the LPC interface, the ICH10 includes several decoders. During configuration, the ICH10 must be programmed with the same decode ranges as the peripheral. The decoders are programmed via the Device 31:Function 0 configuration space. Note: The ICH10 cannot accept PCI write cycles from PCI-to-PCI bridges or devices with similar characteristics (specifically those with a “Retry Read” feature which is enabled) to an LPC device if there is an outstanding LPC read cycle towards the same PCI device or bridge. These cycles are not part of normal system operation, but may be encountered as part of platform validation testing using custom test fixtures. Bus Master Device Mapping and START Fields Bus Masters must have a unique START field. In the case of the ICH10 that supports two LPC bus masters, it drives 0010 for the START field for grants to bus master #0 (requested via LDRQ0#) and 0011 for grants to bus master #1 (requested via LDRQ1#.). Thus, no registers are needed to configure the START fields for a particular bus master. 5.5 DMA Operation (D31:F0) The ICH10 supports LPC DMA using the ICH10’s DMA controller. The DMA controller has registers that are fixed in the lower 64 KB of I/O space. The DMA controller is configured using registers in the PCI configuration space. These registers allow configuration of the channels for use by LPC DMA. The DMA circuitry incorporates the functionality of two 82C37 DMA controllers with seven independently programmable channels (Figure 5-3). DMA controller 1 (DMA-1) corresponds to DMA channels 0–3 and DMA controller 2 (DMA-2) corresponds to channels 5–7. DMA channel 4 is used to cascade the two controllers and defaults to cascade mode in the DMA Channel Mode (DCM) Register. Channel 4 is not available for any other purpose. In addition to accepting requests from DMA slaves, the DMA controller also responds to requests that software initiates. Software may initiate a DMA service request by setting any bit in the DMA Channel Request Register to a 1. Figure 5-3. Intel® ICH10 DMA Controller Channel 4 Channel 0 Channel 1 Channel 5 DMA-1 Channel 2 Channel 6 Channel 3 Channel 7 DMA-2 Each DMA channel is hardwired to the compatible settings for DMA device size: channels [3:0] are hardwired to 8-bit, count-by-bytes transfers, and channels [7:5] are hardwired to 16-bit, count-by-words (address shifted) transfers. ICH10 provides 24-bit addressing in compliance with the ISA-Compatible specification. Each channel includes a 16-bit ISA-Compatible Current Register which holds the 16 least-significant bits of the 24-bit address, an ISA-Compatible Page Register which contains the eight next most significant bits of address. The DMA controller also features refresh address generation, and auto-initialization following a DMA termination. 112 Datasheet Functional Description 5.5.1 Channel Priority For priority resolution, the DMA consists of two logical channel groups: channels 0–3 and channels 4–7. Each group may be in either fixed or rotate mode, as determined by the DMA Command Register. DMA I/O slaves normally assert their DREQ line to arbitrate for DMA service. However, a software request for DMA service can be presented through each channel's DMA Request Register. A software request is subject to the same prioritization as any hardware request. See the detailed register description for Request Register programming information in Section 13.2. 5.5.1.1 Fixed Priority The initial fixed priority structure is as follows: High priority Low priority 0, 1, 2, 3 5, 6, 7 The fixed priority ordering is 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 6, and 7. In this scheme, channel 0 has the highest priority, and channel 7 has the lowest priority. Channels [3:0] of DMA-1 assume the priority position of channel 4 in DMA-2, thus taking priority over channels 5, 6, and 7. 5.5.1.2 Rotating Priority Rotation allows for “fairness” in priority resolution. The priority chain rotates so that the last channel serviced is assigned the lowest priority in the channel group (0–3, 5–7). Channels 0–3 rotate as a group of 4. They are always placed between channel 5 and channel 7 in the priority list. Channel 5–7 rotate as part of a group of 4. That is, channels (5–7) form the first three positions in the rotation, while channel group (0–3) comprises the fourth position in the arbitration. 5.5.2 Address Compatibility Mode When the DMA is operating, the addresses do not increment or decrement through the High and Low Page Registers. Therefore, if a 24-bit address is 01FFFFh and increments, the next address is 010000h, not 020000h. Similarly, if a 24-bit address is 020000h and decrements, the next address is 02FFFFh, not 01FFFFh. However, when the DMA is operating in 16-bit mode, the addresses still do not increment or decrement through the High and Low Page Registers but the page boundary is now 128 K. Therefore, if a 24-bit address is 01FFFEh and increments, the next address is 000000h, not 0100000h. Similarly, if a 24-bit address is 020000h and decrements, the next address is 03FFFEh, not 02FFFEh. This is compatible with the 82C37 and Page Register implementation used in the PC-AT. This mode is set after CPURST is valid. Datasheet 113 Functional Description 5.5.3 Summary of DMA Transfer Sizes Table 5-10 lists each of the DMA device transfer sizes. The column labeled “Current Byte/Word Count Register” indicates that the register contents represents either the number of bytes to transfer or the number of 16-bit words to transfer. The column labeled “Current Address Increment/Decrement” indicates the number added to or taken from the Current Address register after each DMA transfer cycle. The DMA Channel Mode Register determines if the Current Address Register will be incremented or decremented. 5.5.3.1 Address Shifting When Programmed for 16-Bit I/O Count by Words Table 5-10. DMA Transfer Size Current Byte/Word Count Register Current Address Increment/ Decrement 8-Bit I/O, Count By Bytes Bytes 1 16-Bit I/O, Count By Words (Address Shifted) Words 1 DMA Device Date Size And Word Count The ICH10 maintains compatibility with the implementation of the DMA in the PC AT that used the 82C37. The DMA shifts the addresses for transfers to/from a 16-bit device count-by-words. Note: The least significant bit of the Low Page Register is dropped in 16-bit shifted mode. When programming the Current Address Register (when the DMA channel is in this mode), the Current Address must be programmed to an even address with the address value shifted right by one bit. The address shifting is shown in Table 5-11. Table 5-11. Address Shifting in 16-Bit I/O DMA Transfers Output Address 8-Bit I/O Programmed Address (Ch 0–3) 16-Bit I/O Programmed Address (Ch 5–7) (Shifted) A0 A[16:1] A[23:17] A0 A[16:1] A[23:17] 0 A[15:0] A[23:17] NOTE: The least significant bit of the Page Register is dropped in 16-bit shifted mode. 5.5.4 Autoinitialize By programming a bit in the DMA Channel Mode Register, a channel may be set up as an autoinitialize channel. When a channel undergoes autoinitialization, the original values of the Current Page, Current Address and Current Byte/Word Count Registers are automatically restored from the Base Page, Address, and Byte/Word Count Registers of that channel following TC. The Base Registers are loaded simultaneously with the Current Registers by the microprocessor when the DMA channel is programmed and remain unchanged throughout the DMA service. The mask bit is not set when the channel is in autoinitialize. Following autoinitialize, the channel is ready to perform another DMA service, without processor intervention, as soon as a valid DREQ is detected. 114 Datasheet Functional Description 5.5.5 Software Commands There are three additional special software commands that the DMA controller can execute. The three software commands are: • Clear Byte Pointer Flip-Flop • Master Clear • Clear Mask Register They do not depend on any specific bit pattern on the data bus. 5.6 LPC DMA DMA on LPC is handled through the use of the LDRQ# lines from peripherals and special encodings on LAD[3:0] from the host. Single, Demand, Verify, and Increment modes are supported on the LPC interface. Channels 0–3 are 8 bit channels. Channels 5–7 are 16-bit channels. Channel 4 is reserved as a generic bus master request. 5.6.1 Asserting DMA Requests Peripherals that need DMA service encode their requested channel number on the LDRQ# signal. To simplify the protocol, each peripheral on the LPC I/F has its own dedicated LDRQ# signal (they may not be shared between two separate peripherals). The ICH10 has two LDRQ# inputs, allowing at least two devices to support DMA or bus mastering. LDRQ# is synchronous with LCLK (PCI clock). As shown in Figure 5-4, the peripheral uses the following serial encoding sequence: • Peripheral starts the sequence by asserting LDRQ# low (start bit). LDRQ# is high during idle conditions. • The next three bits contain the encoded DMA channel number (MSB first). • The next bit (ACT) indicates whether the request for the indicated DMA channel is active or inactive. The ACT bit is 1 (high) to indicate if it is active and 0 (low) if it is inactive. The case where ACT is low is rare, and is only used to indicate that a previous request for that channel is being abandoned. • After the active/inactive indication, the LDRQ# signal must go high for at least 1 clock. After that one clock, LDRQ# signal can be brought low to the next encoding sequence. If another DMA channel also needs to request a transfer, another sequence can be sent on LDRQ#. For example, if an encoded request is sent for channel 2, and then channel 3 needs a transfer before the cycle for channel 2 is run on the interface, the peripheral can send the encoded request for channel 3. This allows multiple DMA agents behind an I/O device to request use of the LPC interface, and the I/O device does not need to selfarbitrate before sending the message. Figure 5-4. DMA Request Assertion through LDRQ# LCLK LDRQ# Datasheet Start MSB LSB ACT Start 115 Functional Description 5.6.2 Abandoning DMA Requests DMA Requests can be deasserted in two fashions: on error conditions by sending an LDRQ# message with the ‘ACT’ bit set to 0, or normally through a SYNC field during the DMA transfer. This section describes boundary conditions where the DMA request needs to be removed prior to a data transfer. There may be some special cases where the peripheral desires to abandon a DMA transfer. The most likely case of this occurring is due to a floppy disk controller which has overrun or underrun its FIFO, or software stopping a device prematurely. In these cases, the peripheral wishes to stop further DMA activity. It may do so by sending an LDRQ# message with the ACT bit as 0. However, since the DMA request was seen by the ICH10, there is no assurance that the cycle has not been granted and will shortly run on LPC. Therefore, peripherals must take into account that a DMA cycle may still occur. The peripheral can choose not to respond to this cycle, in which case the host will abort it, or it can choose to complete the cycle normally with any random data. This method of DMA deassertion should be prevented whenever possible, to limit boundary conditions both on the ICH10 and the peripheral. 5.6.3 General Flow of DMA Transfers Arbitration for DMA channels is performed through the 8237 within the host. Once the host has won arbitration on behalf of a DMA channel assigned to LPC, it asserts LFRAME# on the LPC I/F and begins the DMA transfer. The general flow for a basic DMA transfer is as follows: 1. ICH10 starts transfer by asserting 0000b on LAD[3:0] with LFRAME# asserted. 2. ICH10 asserts ‘cycle type’ of DMA, direction based on DMA transfer direction. 3. ICH10 asserts channel number and, if applicable, terminal count. 4. ICH10 indicates the size of the transfer: 8 or 16 bits. 5. If a DMA read… — The ICH10 drives the first 8 bits of data and turns the bus around. — The peripheral acknowledges the data with a valid SYNC. — If a 16-bit transfer, the process is repeated for the next 8 bits. 6. If a DMA write… — The ICH10 turns the bus around and waits for data. — The peripheral indicates data ready through SYNC and transfers the first byte. — If a 16-bit transfer, the peripheral indicates data ready and transfers the next byte. 7. The peripheral turns around the bus. 5.6.4 Terminal Count Terminal count is communicated through LAD[3] on the same clock that DMA channel is communicated on LAD[2:0]. This field is the CHANNEL field. Terminal count indicates the last byte of transfer, based upon the size of the transfer. For example, on an 8-bit transfer size (SIZE field is 00b), if the TC bit is set, then this is the last byte. On a 16-bit transfer (SIZE field is 01b), if the TC bit is set, then the second byte is the last byte. The peripheral, therefore, must internalize the TC bit when the CHANNEL field is communicated, and only signal TC when the last byte of that transfer size has been transferred. 116 Datasheet Functional Description 5.6.5 Verify Mode Verify mode is supported on the LPC interface. A verify transfer to the peripheral is similar to a DMA write, where the peripheral is transferring data to main memory. The indication from the host is the same as a DMA write, so the peripheral will be driving data onto the LPC interface. However, the host will not transfer this data into main memory. 5.6.6 DMA Request Deassertion An end of transfer is communicated to the ICH10 through a special SYNC field transmitted by the peripheral. An LPC device must not attempt to signal the end of a transfer by deasserting LDREQ#. If a DMA transfer is several bytes (e.g., a transfer from a demand mode device) the ICH10 needs to know when to deassert the DMA request based on the data currently being transferred. The DMA agent uses a SYNC encoding on each byte of data being transferred, which indicates to the ICH10 whether this is the last byte of transfer or if more bytes are requested. To indicate the last byte of transfer, the peripheral uses a SYNC value of 0000b (ready with no error), or 1010b (ready with error). These encodings tell the ICH10 that this is the last piece of data transferred on a DMA read (ICH10 to peripheral), or the byte that follows is the last piece of data transferred on a DMA write (peripheral to ICH10). When the ICH10 sees one of these two encodings, it ends the DMA transfer after this byte and deasserts the DMA request to the 8237. Therefore, if the ICH10 indicated a 16-bit transfer, the peripheral can end the transfer after one byte by indicating a SYNC value of 0000b or 1010b. The ICH10 does not attempt to transfer the second byte, and deasserts the DMA request internally. If the peripheral indicates a 0000b or 1010b SYNC pattern on the last byte of the indicated size, then the ICH10 only deasserts the DMA request to the 8237 since it does not need to end the transfer. If the peripheral wishes to keep the DMA request active, then it uses a SYNC value of 1001b (ready plus more data). This indicates to the 8237 that more data bytes are requested after the current byte has been transferred, so the ICH10 keeps the DMA request active to the 8237. Therefore, on an 8-bit transfer size, if the peripheral indicates a SYNC value of 1001b to the ICH10, the data will be transferred and the DMA request will remain active to the 8237. At a later time, the ICH10 will then come back with another START–CYCTYPE–CHANNEL–SIZE etc. combination to initiate another transfer to the peripheral. The peripheral must not assume that the next START indication from the ICH10 is another grant to the peripheral if it had indicated a SYNC value of 1001b. On a single mode DMA device, the 8237 will re-arbitrate after every transfer. Only demand mode DMA devices can be assured that they will receive the next START indication from the ICH10. Note: Indicating a 0000b or 1010b encoding on the SYNC field of an odd byte of a 16-bit channel (first byte of a 16-bit transfer) is an error condition. Note: The host stops the transfer on the LPC bus as indicated, fills the upper byte with random data on DMA writes (peripheral to memory), and indicates to the 8237 that the DMA transfer occurred, incrementing the 8237’s address and decrementing its byte count. Datasheet 117 Functional Description 5.6.7 SYNC Field / LDRQ# Rules Since DMA transfers on LPC are requested through an LDRQ# assertion message, and are ended through a SYNC field during the DMA transfer, the peripheral must obey the following rule when initiating back-to-back transfers from a DMA channel. The peripheral must not assert another message for eight LCLKs after a deassertion is indicated through the SYNC field. This is needed to allow the 8237, that typically runs off a much slower internal clock, to see a message deasserted before it is re-asserted so that it can arbitrate to the next agent. Under default operation, the host only performs 8-bit transfers on 8-bit channels and 16-bit transfers on 16-bit channels. The method by which this communication between host and peripheral through system BIOS is performed is beyond the scope of this specification. Since the LPC host and LPC peripheral are motherboard devices, no “plug-n-play” registry is required. The peripheral must not assume that the host is able to perform transfer sizes that are larger than the size allowed for the DMA channel, and be willing to accept a SIZE field that is smaller than what it may currently have buffered. To that end, it is recommended that future devices that may appear on the LPC bus, that require higher bandwidth than 8-bit or 16-bit DMA allow, do so with a bus mastering interface and not rely on the 8237. 5.7 8254 Timers (D31:F0) The ICH10 contains three counters that have fixed uses. All registers and functions associated with the 8254 timers are in the core well. The 8254 unit is clocked by a 14.31818 MHz clock. Counter 0, System Timer This counter functions as the system timer by controlling the state of IRQ0 and is typically programmed for Mode 3 operation. The counter produces a square wave with a period equal to the product of the counter period (838 ns) and the initial count value. The counter loads the initial count value 1 counter period after software writes the count value to the counter I/O address. The counter initially asserts IRQ0 and decrements the count value by two each counter period. The counter negates IRQ0 when the count value reaches 0. It then reloads the initial count value and again decrements the initial count value by two each counter period. The counter then asserts IRQ0 when the count value reaches 0, reloads the initial count value, and repeats the cycle, alternately asserting and negating IRQ0. Counter 1, Refresh Request Signal This counter provides the refresh request signal and is typically programmed for Mode 2 operation and only impacts the period of the REF_TOGGLE bit in Port 61. The initial count value is loaded one counter period after being written to the counter I/O address. The REF_TOGGLE bit will have a square wave behavior (alternate between 0 and 1) and will toggle at a rate based on the value in the counter. Programming the counter to anything other than Mode 2 will result in undefined behavior for the REF_TOGGLE bit. Counter 2, Speaker Tone This counter provides the speaker tone and is typically programmed for Mode 3 operation. The counter provides a speaker frequency equal to the counter clock frequency (1.193 MHz) divided by the initial count value. The speaker must be enabled by a write to port 061h (see NMI Status and Control ports). 118 Datasheet Functional Description 5.7.1 Timer Programming The counter/timers are programmed in the following fashion: 1. Write a control word to select a counter. 2. Write an initial count for that counter. 3. Load the least and/or most significant bytes (as required by Control Word bits 5, 4) of the 16-bit counter. 4. Repeat with other counters. Only two conventions need to be observed when programming the counters. First, for each counter, the control word must be written before the initial count is written. Second, the initial count must follow the count format specified in the control word (least significant byte only, most significant byte only, or least significant byte and then most significant byte). A new initial count may be written to a counter at any time without affecting the counter's programmed mode. Counting is affected as described in the mode definitions. The new count must follow the programmed count format. If a counter is programmed to read/write two-byte counts, the following precaution applies: A program must not transfer control between writing the first and second byte to another routine which also writes into that same counter. Otherwise, the counter will be loaded with an incorrect count. The Control Word Register at port 43h controls the operation of all three counters. Several commands are available: • Control Word Command. Specifies which counter to read or write, the operating mode, and the count format (binary or BCD). • Counter Latch Command. Latches the current count so that it can be read by the system. The countdown process continues. • Read Back Command. Reads the count value, programmed mode, the current state of the OUT pins, and the state of the Null Count Flag of the selected counter. Table 5-12 lists the six operating modes for the interval counters. Table 5-12. Counter Operating Modes Mode Datasheet Function Description 0 Out signal on end of count (=0) Output is 0. When count goes to 0, output goes to 1 and stays at 1 until counter is reprogrammed. 1 Hardware retriggerable one-shot Output is 0. When count goes to 0, output goes to 1 for one clock time. 2 Rate generator (divide by n counter) Output is 1. Output goes to 0 for one clock time, then back to 1 and counter is reloaded. 3 Square wave output Output is 1. Output goes to 0 when counter rolls over, and counter is reloaded. Output goes to 1 when counter rolls over, and counter is reloaded, etc. 4 Software triggered strobe Output is 1. Output goes to 0 when count expires for one clock time. 5 Hardware triggered strobe Output is 1. Output goes to 0 when count expires for one clock time. 119 Functional Description 5.7.2 Reading from the Interval Timer It is often desirable to read the value of a counter without disturbing the count in progress. There are three methods for reading the counters: a simple read operation, counter Latch command, and the Read-Back command. Each is explained below. With the simple read and counter latch command methods, the count must be read according to the programmed format; specifically, if the counter is programmed for two byte counts, two bytes must be read. The two bytes do not have to be read one right after the other. Read, write, or programming operations for other counters may be inserted between them. 5.7.2.1 Simple Read The first method is to perform a simple read operation. The counter is selected through port 40h (counter 0), 41h (counter 1), or 42h (counter 2). Note: Performing a direct read from the counter does not return a determinate value, because the counting process is asynchronous to read operations. However, in the case of counter 2, the count can be stopped by writing to the GATE bit in port 61h. 5.7.2.2 Counter Latch Command The Counter Latch command, written to port 43h, latches the count of a specific counter at the time the command is received. This command is used to ensure that the count read from the counter is accurate, particularly when reading a two-byte count. The count value is then read from each counter’s Count register as was programmed by the Control register. The count is held in the latch until it is read or the counter is reprogrammed. The count is then unlatched. This allows reading the contents of the counters on the fly without affecting counting in progress. Multiple Counter Latch Commands may be used to latch more than one counter. Counter Latch commands do not affect the programmed mode of the counter in any way. If a Counter is latched and then, some time later, latched again before the count is read, the second Counter Latch command is ignored. The count read is the count at the time the first Counter Latch command was issued. 5.7.2.3 Read Back Command The Read Back command, written to port 43h, latches the count value, programmed mode, and current states of the OUT pin and Null Count flag of the selected counter or counters. The value of the counter and its status may then be read by I/O access to the counter address. The Read Back command may be used to latch multiple counter outputs at one time. This single command is functionally equivalent to several counter latch commands, one for each counter latched. Each counter's latched count is held until it is read or reprogrammed. Once read, a counter is unlatched. The other counters remain latched until they are read. If multiple count Read Back commands are issued to the same counter without reading the count, all but the first are ignored. The Read Back command may additionally be used to latch status information of selected counters. The status of a counter is accessed by a read from that counter's I/O port address. If multiple counter status latch operations are performed without reading the status, all but the first are ignored. 120 Datasheet Functional Description Both count and status of the selected counters may be latched simultaneously. This is functionally the same as issuing two consecutive, separate Read Back commands. If multiple count and/or status Read Back commands are issued to the same counters without any intervening reads, all but the first are ignored. If both count and status of a counter are latched, the first read operation from that counter returns the latched status, regardless of which was latched first. The next one or two reads, depending on whether the counter is programmed for one or two type counts, returns the latched count. Subsequent reads return unlatched count. 5.8 8259 Interrupt Controllers (PIC) (D31:F0) The ICH10 incorporates the functionality of two 8259 interrupt controllers that provide system interrupts for the ISA compatible interrupts. These interrupts are: system timer, keyboard controller, serial ports, parallel ports, floppy disk, mouse, and DMA channels. In addition, this interrupt controller can support the PCI based interrupts, by mapping the PCI interrupt onto the compatible ISA interrupt line. Each 8259 core supports eight interrupts, numbered 0–7. Table 5-13 shows how the cores are connected. . Table 5-13. Interrupt Controller Core Connections 8259 Master Slave 8259 Input Typical Interrupt Source Connected Pin / Function 0 Internal Internal Timer / Counter 0 output / HPET #0 1 Keyboard IRQ1 via SERIRQ 2 Internal Slave controller INTR output 3 Serial Port A IRQ3 via SERIRQ, PIRQ# 4 Serial Port B IRQ4 via SERIRQ, PIRQ# 5 Parallel Port / Generic IRQ5 via SERIRQ, PIRQ# 6 Floppy Disk IRQ6 via SERIRQ, PIRQ# 7 Parallel Port / Generic IRQ7 via SERIRQ, PIRQ# 0 Internal Real Time Clock Internal RTC / HPET #1 1 Generic IRQ9 via SERIRQ, SCI, TCO, or PIRQ# 2 Generic IRQ10 via SERIRQ, SCI, TCO, or PIRQ# 3 Generic IRQ11 via SERIRQ, SCI, TCO, or PIRQ#, or HPET #2 4 PS/2 Mouse IRQ12 via SERIRQ, SCI, TCO, or PIRQ#, or HPET #3 5 Internal State Machine output based on processor FERR# assertion. May optionally be used for SCI or TCO interrupt if FERR# not needed. 6 SATA SATA Primary (legacy mode), or via SERIRQ or PIRQ# 7 SATA SATA Secondary (legacy mode) or via SERIRQ or PIRQ# The ICH10 cascades the slave controller onto the master controller through master controller interrupt input 2. This means there are only 15 possible interrupts for the ICH10 PIC. Datasheet 121 Functional Description Interrupts can individually be programmed to be edge or level, except for IRQ0, IRQ2, IRQ8#, and IRQ13. Note: Active-low interrupt sources (e.g., the PIRQ#s) are inverted inside the ICH10. In the following descriptions of the 8259s, the interrupt levels are in reference to the signals at the internal interface of the 8259s, after the required inversions have occurred. Therefore, the term “high” indicates “active,” which means “low” on an originating PIRQ#. 5.8.1 Interrupt Handling 5.8.1.1 Generating Interrupts The PIC interrupt sequence involves three bits, from the IRR, ISR, and IMR, for each interrupt level. These bits are used to determine the interrupt vector returned, and status of any other pending interrupts. Table 5-14 defines the IRR, ISR, and IMR. Table 5-14. Interrupt Status Registers 5.8.1.2 Bit Description IRR Interrupt Request Register. This bit is set on a low to high transition of the interrupt line in edge mode, and by an active high level in level mode. This bit is set whether or not the interrupt is masked. However, a masked interrupt will not generate INTR. ISR Interrupt Service Register. This bit is set, and the corresponding IRR bit cleared, when an interrupt acknowledge cycle is seen, and the vector returned is for that interrupt. IMR Interrupt Mask Register. This bit determines whether an interrupt is masked. Masked interrupts will not generate INTR. Acknowledging Interrupts The processor generates an interrupt acknowledge cycle that is translated by the host bridge into a PCI Interrupt Acknowledge Cycle to the ICH10. The PIC translates this command into two internal INTA# pulses expected by the 8259 cores. The PIC uses the first internal INTA# pulse to freeze the state of the interrupts for priority resolution. On the second INTA# pulse, the master or slave sends the interrupt vector to the processor with the acknowledged interrupt code. This code is based upon bits [7:3] of the corresponding ICW2 register, combined with three bits representing the interrupt within that controller. Table 5-15. Content of Interrupt Vector Byte Master, Slave Interrupt Bits [2:0] IRQ7,15 111 IRQ6,14 110 IRQ5,13 101 IRQ4,12 IRQ3,11 122 Bits [7:3] ICW2[7:3] 100 011 IRQ2,10 010 IRQ1,9 001 IRQ0,8 000 Datasheet Functional Description 5.8.1.3 Hardware/Software Interrupt Sequence 1. One or more of the Interrupt Request lines (IRQ) are raised high in edge mode, or seen high in level mode, setting the corresponding IRR bit. 2. The PIC sends INTR active to the processor if an asserted interrupt is not masked. 3. The processor acknowledges the INTR and responds with an interrupt acknowledge cycle. The cycle is translated into a PCI interrupt acknowledge cycle by the host bridge. This command is broadcast over PCI by the ICH10. 4. Upon observing its own interrupt acknowledge cycle on PCI, the ICH10 converts it into the two cycles that the internal 8259 pair can respond to. Each cycle appears as an interrupt acknowledge pulse on the internal INTA# pin of the cascaded interrupt controllers. 5. Upon receiving the first internally generated INTA# pulse, the highest priority ISR bit is set and the corresponding IRR bit is reset. On the trailing edge of the first pulse, a slave identification code is broadcast by the master to the slave on a private, internal three bit wide bus. The slave controller uses these bits to determine if it must respond with an interrupt vector during the second INTA# pulse. 6. Upon receiving the second internally generated INTA# pulse, the PIC returns the interrupt vector. If no interrupt request is present because the request was too short in duration, the PIC returns vector 7 from the master controller. 7. This completes the interrupt cycle. In AEOI mode the ISR bit is reset at the end of the second INTA# pulse. Otherwise, the ISR bit remains set until an appropriate EOI command is issued at the end of the interrupt subroutine. 5.8.2 Initialization Command Words (ICWx) Before operation can begin, each 8259 must be initialized. In the ICH10, this is a four byte sequence. The four initialization command words are referred to by their acronyms: ICW1, ICW2, ICW3, and ICW4. The base address for each 8259 initialization command word is a fixed location in the I/O memory space: 20h for the master controller, and A0h for the slave controller. 5.8.2.1 ICW1 An I/O write to the master or slave controller base address with data bit 4 equal to 1 is interpreted as a write to ICW1. Upon sensing this write, the ICH10 PIC expects three more byte writes to 21h for the master controller, or A1h for the slave controller, to complete the ICW sequence. A write to ICW1 starts the initialization sequence during which the following automatically occur: 1. Following initialization, an interrupt request (IRQ) input must make a low-to-high transition to generate an interrupt. 2. The Interrupt Mask Register is cleared. 3. IRQ7 input is assigned priority 7. 4. The slave mode address is set to 7. 5. Special mask mode is cleared and Status Read is set to IRR. Datasheet 123 Functional Description 5.8.2.2 ICW2 The second write in the sequence (ICW2) is programmed to provide bits [7:3] of the interrupt vector that will be released during an interrupt acknowledge. A different base is selected for each interrupt controller. 5.8.2.3 ICW3 The third write in the sequence (ICW3) has a different meaning for each controller. • For the master controller, ICW3 is used to indicate which IRQ input line is used to cascade the slave controller. Within the ICH10, IRQ2 is used. Therefore, bit 2 of ICW3 on the master controller is set to a 1, and the other bits are set to 0s. • For the slave controller, ICW3 is the slave identification code used during an interrupt acknowledge cycle. On interrupt acknowledge cycles, the master controller broadcasts a code to the slave controller if the cascaded interrupt won arbitration on the master controller. The slave controller compares this identification code to the value stored in its ICW3, and if it matches, the slave controller assumes responsibility for broadcasting the interrupt vector. 5.8.2.4 ICW4 The final write in the sequence (ICW4) must be programmed for both controllers. At the very least, bit 0 must be set to a 1 to indicate that the controllers are operating in an Intel Architecture-based system. 5.8.3 Operation Command Words (OCW) These command words reprogram the Interrupt controller to operate in various interrupt modes. • OCW1 masks and unmasks interrupt lines. • OCW2 controls the rotation of interrupt priorities when in rotating priority mode, and controls the EOI function. • OCW3 sets up ISR/IRR reads, enables/disables the special mask mode (SMM), and enables/disables polled interrupt mode. 5.8.4 Modes of Operation 5.8.4.1 Fully Nested Mode In this mode, interrupt requests are ordered in priority from 0 through 7, with 0 being the highest. When an interrupt is acknowledged, the highest priority request is determined and its vector placed on the bus. Additionally, the ISR for the interrupt is set. This ISR bit remains set until: the processor issues an EOI command immediately before returning from the service routine; or if in AEOI mode, on the trailing edge of the second INTA#. While the ISR bit is set, all further interrupts of the same or lower priority are inhibited, while higher levels generate another interrupt. Interrupt priorities can be changed in the rotating priority mode. 124 Datasheet Functional Description 5.8.4.2 Special Fully-Nested Mode This mode is used in the case of a system where cascading is used, and the priority has to be conserved within each slave. In this case, the special fully-nested mode is programmed to the master controller. This mode is similar to the fully-nested mode with the following exceptions: • When an interrupt request from a certain slave is in service, this slave is not locked out from the master's priority logic and further interrupt requests from higher priority interrupts within the slave are recognized by the master and initiate interrupts to the processor. In the normal-nested mode, a slave is masked out when its request is in service. • When exiting the Interrupt Service routine, software has to check whether the interrupt serviced was the only one from that slave. This is done by sending a NonSpecific EOI command to the slave and then reading its ISR. If it is 0, a nonspecific EOI can also be sent to the master. 5.8.4.3 Automatic Rotation Mode (Equal Priority Devices) In some applications, there are a number of interrupting devices of equal priority. Automatic rotation mode provides for a sequential 8-way rotation. In this mode, a device receives the lowest priority after being serviced. In the worst case, a device requesting an interrupt has to wait until each of seven other devices are serviced at most once. There are two ways to accomplish automatic rotation using OCW2; the Rotation on Non-Specific EOI Command (R=1, SL=0, EOI=1) and the rotate in automatic EOI mode which is set by (R=1, SL=0, EOI=0). 5.8.4.4 Specific Rotation Mode (Specific Priority) Software can change interrupt priorities by programming the bottom priority. For example, if IRQ5 is programmed as the bottom priority device, then IRQ6 is the highest priority device. The Set Priority Command is issued in OCW2 to accomplish this, where: R=1, SL=1, and LO–L2 is the binary priority level code of the bottom priority device. In this mode, internal status is updated by software control during OCW2. However, it is independent of the EOI command. Priority changes can be executed during an EOI command by using the Rotate on Specific EOI Command in OCW2 (R=1, SL=1, EOI=1, and LO–L2=IRQ level to receive bottom priority. 5.8.4.5 Poll Mode Poll mode can be used to conserve space in the interrupt vector table. Multiple interrupts that can be serviced by one interrupt service routine do not need separate vectors if the service routine uses the poll command. Poll mode can also be used to expand the number of interrupts. The polling interrupt service routine can call the appropriate service routine, instead of providing the interrupt vectors in the vector table. In this mode, the INTR output is not used and the microprocessor internal Interrupt Enable flip-flop is reset, disabling its interrupt input. Service to devices is achieved by software using a Poll command. The Poll command is issued by setting P=1 in OCW3. The PIC treats its next I/O read as an interrupt acknowledge, sets the appropriate ISR bit if there is a request, and reads the priority level. Interrupts are frozen from the OCW3 write to the I/O read. The byte returned during the I/O read contains a 1 in bit 7 if there is an interrupt, and the binary code of the highest priority level in bits 2:0. Datasheet 125 Functional Description 5.8.4.6 Cascade Mode The PIC in the ICH10 has one master 8259 and one slave 8259 cascaded onto the master through IRQ2. This configuration can handle up to 15 separate priority levels. The master controls the slaves through a three bit internal bus. In the ICH10, when the master drives 010b on this bus, the slave controller takes responsibility for returning the interrupt vector. An EOI command must be issued twice: once for the master and once for the slave. 5.8.4.7 Edge and Level Triggered Mode In ISA systems this mode is programmed using bit 3 in ICW1, which sets level or edge for the entire controller. In the ICH10, this bit is disabled and a new register for edge and level triggered mode selection, per interrupt input, is included. This is the Edge/ Level control Registers ELCR1 and ELCR2. If an ELCR bit is 0, an interrupt request will be recognized by a low-to-high transition on the corresponding IRQ input. The IRQ input can remain high without generating another interrupt. If an ELCR bit is 1, an interrupt request will be recognized by a high level on the corresponding IRQ input and there is no need for an edge detection. The interrupt request must be removed before the EOI command is issued to prevent a second interrupt from occurring. In both the edge and level triggered modes, the IRQ inputs must remain active until after the falling edge of the first internal INTA#. If the IRQ input goes inactive before this time, a default IRQ7 vector is returned. 5.8.4.8 End of Interrupt (EOI) Operations An EOI can occur in one of two fashions: by a command word write issued to the PIC before returning from a service routine, the EOI command; or automatically when AEOI bit in ICW4 is set to 1. 5.8.4.9 Normal End of Interrupt In normal EOI, software writes an EOI command before leaving the interrupt service routine to mark the interrupt as completed. There are two forms of EOI commands: Specific and Non-Specific. When a Non-Specific EOI command is issued, the PIC clears the highest ISR bit of those that are set to 1. Non-Specific EOI is the normal mode of operation of the PIC within the ICH10, as the interrupt being serviced currently is the interrupt entered with the interrupt acknowledge. When the PIC is operated in modes that preserve the fully nested structure, software can determine which ISR bit to clear by issuing a Specific EOI. An ISR bit that is masked is not cleared by a Non-Specific EOI if the PIC is in the special mask mode. An EOI command must be issued for both the master and slave controller. 5.8.4.10 Automatic End of Interrupt Mode In this mode, the PIC automatically performs a Non-Specific EOI operation at the trailing edge of the last interrupt acknowledge pulse. From a system standpoint, this mode should be used only when a nested multi-level interrupt structure is not required within a single PIC. The AEOI mode can only be used in the master controller and not the slave controller. 126 Datasheet Functional Description 5.8.5 Masking Interrupts 5.8.5.1 Masking on an Individual Interrupt Request Each interrupt request can be masked individually by the Interrupt Mask Register (IMR). This register is programmed through OCW1. Each bit in the IMR masks one interrupt channel. Masking IRQ2 on the master controller masks all requests for service from the slave controller. 5.8.5.2 Special Mask Mode Some applications may require an interrupt service routine to dynamically alter the system priority structure during its execution under software control. For example, the routine may wish to inhibit lower priority requests for a portion of its execution but enable some of them for another portion. The special mask mode enables all interrupts not masked by a bit set in the Mask register. Normally, when an interrupt service routine acknowledges an interrupt without issuing an EOI to clear the ISR bit, the interrupt controller inhibits all lower priority requests. In the special mask mode, any interrupts may be selectively enabled by loading the Mask Register with the appropriate pattern. The special mask mode is set by OCW3 where: SSMM=1, SMM=1, and cleared where SSMM=1, SMM=0. 5.8.6 Steering PCI Interrupts The ICH10 can be programmed to allow PIRQA#-PIRQH# to be routed internally to interrupts 3–7, 9–12, 14 or 15. The assignment is programmable through the PIRQx Route Control registers, located at 60–63h and 68–6Bh in Device 31:Function 0. One or more PIRQx# lines can be routed to the same IRQx input. If interrupt steering is not required, the Route registers can be programmed to disable steering. The PIRQx# lines are defined as active low, level sensitive to allow multiple interrupts on a PCI board to share a single line across the connector. When a PIRQx# is routed to specified IRQ line, software must change the IRQ's corresponding ELCR bit to level sensitive mode. The ICH10 internally inverts the PIRQx# line to send an active high level to the PIC. When a PCI interrupt is routed onto the PIC, the selected IRQ can no longer be used by an active high device (through SERIRQ). However, active low interrupts can share their interrupt with PCI interrupts. Internal sources of the PIRQs, including SCI and TCO interrupts, cause the external PIRQ to be asserted. The ICH10 receives the PIRQ input, like all of the other external sources, and routes it accordingly. Datasheet 127 Functional Description 5.9 Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC) (D31:F0) In addition to the standard ISA-compatible PIC described in the previous chapter, the ICH10 incorporates the APIC. While the standard interrupt controller is intended for use in a uni-processor system, APIC can be used in either a uni-processor or multiprocessor system. 5.9.1 Interrupt Handling The I/O APIC handles interrupts very differently than the 8259. Briefly, these differences are: • Method of Interrupt Transmission. The I/O APIC transmits interrupts through memory writes on the normal datapath to the processor, and interrupts are handled without the need for the processor to run an interrupt acknowledge cycle. • Interrupt Priority. The priority of interrupts in the I/O APIC is independent of the interrupt number. For example, interrupt 10 can be given a higher priority than interrupt 3. • More Interrupts. The I/O APIC in the ICH10 supports a total of 24 interrupts. • Multiple Interrupt Controllers. The I/O APIC architecture allows for multiple I/O APIC devices in the system with their own interrupt vectors. 5.9.2 Interrupt Mapping The I/O APIC within the ICH10 supports 24 APIC interrupts. Each interrupt has its own unique vector assigned by software. The interrupt vectors are mapped as follows, and match “Config 6” of the Multi-Processor Specification. Table 5-16. APIC Interrupt Mapping1 (Sheet 1 of 2) 128 IRQ # Via SERIRQ Direct from Pin Via PCI Message 0 No No No 1 Yes No Yes 2 No No No 3 Yes No Yes 4 Yes No Yes 5 Yes No Yes 6 Yes No Yes 7 Yes No Yes 8 No No No RTC, HPET #1 (legacy mode) Internal Modules Cascade from 8259 #1 8254 Counter 0, HPET #0 (legacy mode) 9 Yes No Yes Option for SCI, TCO 10 Yes No Yes Option for SCI, TCO 11 Yes No Yes HPET #2, Option for SCI, TCO (Note2) 12 Yes No Yes HPET #3 (Note 3) 13 No No No FERR# logic 14 Yes No Yes SATA Primary (legacy mode) 15 Yes No Yes SATA Secondary (legacy mode) Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-16. APIC Interrupt Mapping1 (Sheet 2 of 2) IRQ # Via SERIRQ Direct from Pin 16 PIRQA# PIRQA# 17 PIRQB# PIRQB# 18 PIRQC# PIRQC# 19 PIRQD# PIRQD# 20 N/A PIRQE#4 21 N/A PIRQF#4 22 N/A PIRQG#4 23 N/A PIRQH#4 Via PCI Message Internal Modules Yes Internal devices are routable; see Section 10.1.54 though Section 10.1.60. Yes Option for SCI, TCO, HPET #0,1,2, 3. Other internal devices are routable; see Section 10.1.54 through Section 10.1.60. NOTES: 1. When programming the polarity of internal interrupt sources on the APIC, interrupts 0 through 15 receive active-high internal interrupt sources, while interrupts 16 through 23 receive active-low internal interrupt sources. 2. If IRQ 11 is used for HPET #2, software should ensure IRQ 11 is not shared with any other devices to ensure the proper operation of HPET #2. ICH10 hardware does not prevent sharing of IRQ 11. 3. If IRQ 12 is used for HPET #3, software should ensure IRQ 12 is not shared with any other devices to ensure the proper operation of HPET #3. ICH10 hardware does not prevent sharing of IRQ 12. 4. PIRQ[E:H] are Multiplexed with GPIO pins. Interrupts PIRQ[E:H] will not be exposed if they are configured as GPIOs. 5.9.3 PCI / PCI Express* Message-Based Interrupts When external devices through PCI / PCI Express wish to generate an interrupt, they will send the message defined in the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a for generating INTA# - INTD#. These will be translated internal assertions/de-assertions of INTA# – INTD#. 5.9.4 Front Side Bus Interrupt Delivery For processors that support Front Side Bus (FSB) interrupt delivery, the ICH10 requires that the I/O APIC deliver interrupt messages to the processor in a parallel manner, rather than using the I/O APIC serial scheme. This is done by the ICH10 writing (via DMI) to a memory location that is snooped by the processor(s). The processor(s) snoop the cycle to know which interrupt goes active. The following sequence is used: 1. When the ICH10 detects an interrupt event (active edge for edge-triggered mode or a change for level-triggered mode), it sets or resets the internal IRR bit associated with that interrupt. 2. Internally, the ICH10 requests to use the bus in a way that automatically flushes upstream buffers. This can be internally implemented similar to a DMA device request. 3. The ICH10 then delivers the message by performing a write cycle to the appropriate address with the appropriate data. The address and data formats are described below in Section 5.9.4.4. Note: Datasheet FSB Interrupt Delivery compatibility with processor clock control depends on the processor, not the ICH10. 129 Functional Description 5.9.4.1 Edge-Triggered Operation In this case, the “Assert Message” is sent when there is an inactive-to-active edge on the interrupt. 5.9.4.2 Level-Triggered Operation In this case, the “Assert Message” is sent when there is an inactive-to-active edge on the interrupt. If after the EOI the interrupt is still active, then another “Assert Message” is sent to indicate that the interrupt is still active. 5.9.4.3 Registers Associated with Front Side Bus Interrupt Delivery Capabilities Indication: The capability to support Front Side Bus interrupt delivery is indicated via ACPI configuration techniques. This involves the BIOS creating a data structure that gets reported to the ACPI configuration software. 5.9.4.4 Interrupt Message Format The ICH10 writes the message to PCI (and to the Host controller) as a 32-bit memory write cycle. It uses the formats shown in Table 5-17 and Table 5-18 for the address and data. The local APIC (in the processor) has a delivery mode option to interpret Front Side Bus messages as a SMI in which case the processor treats the incoming interrupt as a SMI instead of as an interrupt. This does not mean that the ICH10 has any way to have a SMI source from ICH10 power management logic cause the I/O APIC to send an SMI message (there is no way to do this). The ICH10’s I/O APIC can only send interrupts due to interrupts which do not include SMI, NMI or INIT. This means that in IA-32/ Intel® 64 based platforms, Front Side Bus interrupt message format delivery modes 010 (SMI/PMI), 100 (NMI), and 101 (INIT) as indicated in this section, must not be used and is not supported. Only the hardware pin connection is supported by ICH10. : Table 5-17. Interrupt Message Address Format Bit Description 31:20 Will always be FEEh 19:12 Destination ID: This is the same as bits 63:56 of the I/O Redirection Table entry for the interrupt associated with this message. 11:4 Extended Destination ID: This is the same as bits 55:48 of the I/O Redirection Table entry for the interrupt associated with this message. Redirection Hint: This bit is used by the processor host bridge to allow the interrupt message to be redirected. 0 = The message will be delivered to the agent (processor) listed in bits 19:12. 3 1 = The message will be delivered to an agent with a lower interrupt priority This can be derived from bits 10:8 in the Data Field (see below). The Redirection Hint bit will be a 1 if bits 10:8 in the delivery mode field associated with corresponding interrupt are encoded as 001 (Lowest Priority). Otherwise, the Redirection Hint bit will be 0 2 1:0 130 Destination Mode: This bit is used only the Redirection Hint bit is set to 1. If the Redirection Hint bit and the Destination Mode bit are both set to 1, then the logical destination mode is used, and the redirection is limited only to those processors that are part of the logical group as based on the logical ID. Will always be 00. Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-18. Interrupt Message Data Format Bit 31:16 Description Will always be 0000h. 15 Trigger Mode: 1 = Level, 0 = Edge. Same as the corresponding bit in the I/O Redirection Table for that interrupt. 14 Delivery Status: 1 = Assert, 0 = Deassert. Only Assert messages are sent. This bit is always 1. 13:12 11 Will always be 00 Destination Mode: 1 = Logical. 0 = Physical. Same as the corresponding bit in the I/O Redirection Table for that interrupt. Delivery Mode: This is the same as the corresponding bits in the I/O Redirection Table for that interrupt. 10:8 000 = Fixed 100 = NMI 001 = Lowest Priority 101 = INIT 010 = SMI/PMI 110 = Reserved 011 = Reserved 111 = ExtINT 7:0 5.9.5 Vector: This is the same as the corresponding bits in the I/O Redirection Table for that interrupt. IOxAPIC Address Remapping To support Intel® Virtualization Technology, interrupt messages are required to go through similar address remapping as any other memory request. Address remapping allows for domain isolation for interrupts, so a device assigned in one domain is not allowed to generate an interrupt to another domain. The address remapping is based on the Bus: Device: Function field associated with the requests. The internal APIC is required to initiate the interrupt message using a unique Bus: Device: function. ICH10 allows BIOS to program the unique Bus: Device: Function address for the internal APIC. This address field does not change the APIC functionality and the APIC is not promoted as a stand-alone PCI device. See Device 31: Function 0 Offset 6Ch for additional information. 5.9.6 External Interrupt Controller Support The ICH10 supports external APICs off of PCI Express ports, and does not support APICs on the PCI bus. The EOI special cycle is only forwarded to PCI Express ports. Datasheet 131 Functional Description 5.10 Serial Interrupt (D31:F0) The ICH10 supports a serial IRQ scheme. This allows a single signal to be used to report interrupt requests. The signal used to transmit this information is shared between the host, the ICH10, and all peripherals that support serial interrupts. The signal line, SERIRQ, is synchronous to PCI clock, and follows the sustained tri-state protocol that is used by all PCI signals. This means that if a device has driven SERIRQ low, it will first drive it high synchronous to PCI clock and release it the following PCI clock. The serial IRQ protocol defines this sustained tri-state signaling in the following fashion: • S – Sample Phase. Signal driven low • R – Recovery Phase. Signal driven high • T – Turn-around Phase. Signal released The ICH10 supports a message for 21 serial interrupts. These represent the 15 ISA interrupts (IRQ0–1, 2–15), the four PCI interrupts, and the control signals SMI# and IOCHK#. The serial IRQ protocol does not support the additional APIC interrupts (20– 23). Note: When the SATA controller is configured for legacy IDE mode, IRQ14 and IRQ15 are expected to behave as ISA legacy interrupts, which cannot be shared (i.e., through the Serial Interrupt pin). If IRQ14 and IRQ15 are shared with Serial Interrupt pin, then abnormal system behavior may occur. For example, IRQ14/15 may not be detected by ICH10's interrupt controller. When the SATA controller is not running in Native IDE mode, IRQ14 and IRQ15 are used as special interrupts. If the SATA controller is in native modes, these interrupts can be mapped to other devices accordingly. 5.10.1 Start Frame The serial IRQ protocol has two modes of operation which affect the start frame. These two modes are: Continuous, where the ICH10 is solely responsible for generating the start frame; and Quiet, where a serial IRQ peripheral is responsible for beginning the start frame. The mode that must first be entered when enabling the serial IRQ protocol is continuous mode. In this mode, the ICH10 asserts the start frame. This start frame is 4, 6, or 8 PCI clocks wide based upon the Serial IRQ Control Register, bits 1:0 at 64h in Device 31:Function 0 configuration space. This is a polling mode. When the serial IRQ stream enters quiet mode (signaled in the Stop Frame), the SERIRQ line remains inactive and pulled up between the Stop and Start Frame until a peripheral drives the SERIRQ signal low. The ICH10 senses the line low and continues to drive it low for the remainder of the Start Frame. Since the first PCI clock of the start frame was driven by the peripheral in this mode, the ICH10 drives the SERIRQ line low for 1 PCI clock less than in continuous mode. This mode of operation allows for a quiet, and therefore, lower power operation. 132 Datasheet Functional Description 5.10.2 Data Frames Once the Start frame has been initiated, all of the SERIRQ peripherals must start counting frames based on the rising edge of SERIRQ. Each of the IRQ/DATA frames has exactly 3 phases of 1 clock each: • Sample Phase. During this phase, the SERIRQ device drives SERIRQ low if the corresponding interrupt signal is low. If the corresponding interrupt is high, then the SERIRQ devices tri-state the SERIRQ signal. The SERIRQ line remains high due to pull-up resistors (there is no internal pull-up resistor on this signal, an external pull-up resistor is required). A low level during the IRQ0–1 and IRQ2–15 frames indicates that an active-high ISA interrupt is not being requested, but a low level during the PCI INT[A:D], SMI#, and IOCHK# frame indicates that an active-low interrupt is being requested. • Recovery Phase. During this phase, the device drives the SERIRQ line high if in the Sample Phase it was driven low. If it was not driven in the sample phase, it is tri-stated in this phase. • Turn-around Phase. The device tri-states the SERIRQ line. 5.10.3 Stop Frame After all data frames, a Stop Frame is driven by the ICH10. The SERIRQ signal is driven low by the ICH10 for 2 or 3 PCI clocks. The number of clocks is determined by the SERIRQ configuration register. The number of clocks determines the next mode (see Table 5-19). Table 5-19. Stop Frame Explanation Stop Frame Width 5.10.4 Next Mode 2 PCI clocks Quiet Mode. Any SERIRQ device may initiate a Start Frame 3 PCI clocks Continuous Mode. Only the host (Intel® ICH10) may initiate a Start Frame Specific Interrupts Not Supported via SERIRQ There are three interrupts seen through the serial stream that are not supported by the ICH10. These interrupts are generated internally, and are not sharable with other devices within the system. These interrupts are: • IRQ0. Heartbeat interrupt generated off of the internal 8254 counter 0. • IRQ8#. RTC interrupt can only be generated internally. • IRQ13. Floating point error interrupt generated off of the processor assertion of FERR#. The ICH10 ignores the state of these interrupts in the serial stream, and does not adjust their level based on the level seen in the serial stream. Datasheet 133 Functional Description 5.10.5 Data Frame Format Table 5-20 shows the format of the data frames. For the PCI interrupts (A–D), the output from the ICH10 is AND’d with the PCI input signal. This way, the interrupt can be signaled via both the PCI interrupt input signal and via the SERIRQ signal (they are shared). Table 5-20. Data Frame Format 134 Data Frame # Interrupt Clocks Past Start Frame 1 IRQ0 2 2 IRQ1 5 3 SMI# 8 4 IRQ3 11 5 IRQ4 14 6 IRQ5 17 7 IRQ6 20 8 IRQ7 23 9 IRQ8 26 10 IRQ9 29 11 IRQ10 32 12 IRQ11 35 13 IRQ12 38 14 IRQ13 41 Ignored. IRQ13 can only be generated from FERR# 15 IRQ14 44 Not attached to SATA logic Comment Ignored. IRQ0 can only be generated via the internal 8524 Causes SMI# if low. Will set the SERIRQ_SMI_STS bit. Ignored. IRQ8# can only be generated internally. 16 IRQ15 47 Not attached to SATA logic 17 IOCHCK# 50 Same as ISA IOCHCK# going active. 18 PCI INTA# 53 Drive PIRQA# 19 PCI INTB# 56 Drive PIRQB# 20 PCI INTC# 59 Drive PIRQC# 21 PCI INTD# 62 Drive PIRQD# Datasheet Functional Description 5.11 Real Time Clock (D31:F0) The Real Time Clock (RTC) module provides a battery backed-up date and time keeping device with two banks of static RAM with 128 bytes each, although the first bank has 114 bytes for general purpose usage. Three interrupt features are available: time of day alarm with once a second to once a month range, periodic rates of 122 µs to 500 ms, and end of update cycle notification. Seconds, minutes, hours, days, day of week, month, and year are counted. Daylight savings compensation is no longer supported. The hour is represented in twelve or twenty-four hour format, and data can be represented in BCD or binary format. The design is functionally compatible with the Motorola MS146818B. The time keeping comes from a 32.768 kHz oscillating source, which is divided to achieve an update every second. The lower 14 bytes on the lower RAM block has very specific functions. The first ten are for time and date information. The next four (0Ah to 0Dh) are registers, which configure and report RTC functions. The time and calendar data should match the data mode (BCD or binary) and hour mode (12 or 24 hour) as selected in register B. It is up to the programmer to make sure that data stored in these locations is within the reasonable values ranges and represents a possible date and time. The exception to these ranges is to store a value of C0–FFh in the Alarm bytes to indicate a don’t care situation. All Alarm conditions must match to trigger an Alarm Flag, which could trigger an Alarm Interrupt if enabled. The SET bit must be 1 while programming these locations to avoid clashes with an update cycle. Access to time and date information is done through the RAM locations. If a RAM read from the ten time and date bytes is attempted during an update cycle, the value read do not necessarily represent the true contents of those locations. Any RAM writes under the same conditions are ignored. Note: The leap year determination for adding a 29th day to February does not take into account the end-of-the-century exceptions. The logic simply assumes that all years divisible by 4 are leap years. According to the Royal Observatory Greenwich, years that are divisible by 100 are typically not leap years. In every fourth century (years divisible by 400, like 2000), the 100-year-exception is over-ridden and a leap-year occurs. Note that the year 2100 will be the first time in which the current RTC implementation would incorrectly calculate the leap-year. The ICH10 does not implement month/year alarms. 5.11.1 Update Cycles An update cycle occurs once a second, if the SET bit of register B is not asserted and the divide chain is properly configured. During this procedure, the stored time and date are incremented, overflow is checked, a matching alarm condition is checked, and the time and date are rewritten to the RAM locations. The update cycle will start at least 488 µs after the UIP bit of register A is asserted, and the entire cycle does not take more than 1984 µs to complete. The time and date RAM locations (0–9) are disconnected from the external bus during this time. To avoid update and data corruption conditions, external RAM access to these locations can safely occur at two times. When a updated-ended interrupt is detected, almost 999 ms is available to read and write the valid time and date data. If the UIP bit of Register A is detected to be low, there is at least 488 µs before the update cycle begins. Warning: Datasheet The overflow conditions for leap years adjustments are based on more than one date or time item. To ensure proper operation when adjusting the time, the new time and data values should be set at least two seconds before leap year occurs. 135 Functional Description 5.11.2 Interrupts The real-time clock interrupt is internally routed within the ICH10 both to the I/O APIC and the 8259. It is mapped to interrupt vector 8. This interrupt does not leave the ICH10, nor is it shared with any other interrupt. IRQ8# from the SERIRQ stream is ignored. However, the High Performance Event Timers can also be mapped to IRQ8#; in this case, the RTC interrupt is blocked. 5.11.3 Lockable RAM Ranges The RTC’s battery-backed RAM supports two 8-byte ranges that can be locked via the configuration space. If the locking bits are set, the corresponding range in the RAM will not be readable or writable. A write cycle to those locations will have no effect. A read cycle to those locations will not return the location’s actual value (resultant value is undefined). Once a range is locked, the range can be unlocked only by a hard reset, which will invoke the BIOS and allow it to relock the RAM range. 5.11.4 Century Rollover The ICH10 detects a rollover when the Year byte (RTC I/O space, index offset 09h) transitions form 99 to 00. Upon detecting the rollover, the ICH10 sets the NEWCENTURY_STS bit (TCOBASE + 04h, bit 7). If the system is in an S0 state, this causes an SMI#. The SMI# handler can update registers in the RTC RAM that are associated with century value. If the system is in a sleep state (S1–S5) when the century rollover occurs, the ICH10 also sets the NEWCENTURY_STS bit, but no SMI# is generated. When the system resumes from the sleep state, BIOS should check the NEWCENTURY_STS bit and update the century value in the RTC RAM. 5.11.5 Clearing Battery-Backed RTC RAM Clearing CMOS RAM in an ICH10-based platform can be done by using a jumper on RTCRST# or GPI. Implementations should not attempt to clear CMOS by using a jumper to pull VccRTC low. Using RTCRST# to Clear CMOS A jumper on RTCRST# can be used to clear CMOS values, as well as reset to default, the state of those configuration bits that reside in the RTC power well. When the RTCRST# is strapped to ground, the RTC_PWR_STS bit (D31:F0:A4h bit 2) will be set and those configuration bits in the RTC power well will be set to their default state. BIOS can monitor the state of this bit, and manually clear the RTC CMOS array once the system is booted. The normal position would cause RTCRST# to be pulled up through a weak pull-up resistor. Table 5-21 shows which bits are set to their default state when RTCRST# is asserted. This RTCRST# jumper technique allows the jumper to be moved and then replaced—all while the system is powered off. Then, once booted, the RTC_PWR_STS can be detected in the set state. 136 Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-21. Configuration Bits Reset by RTCRST# Assertion Bit Name Datasheet Register Location Bit(s) Default State Alarm Interrupt Enable (AIE) Register B (General Configuration) (RTC_REGB) I/O space (RTC Index + 0Bh) 5 X Alarm Flag (AF) Register C (Flag Register) (RTC_REGC) I/O space (RTC Index + 0Ch) 5 X SWSMI_RATE_SEL General PM Configuration 3 Register GEN_PMCON_3 D31:F0:A4h 7:6 0 SLP_S4# Minimum Assertion Width General PM Configuration 3 Register GEN_PMCON_3 D31:F0:A4h 5:4 0 SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable General PM Configuration 3 Register GEN_PMCON_3 D31:F0:A4h 3 0 RTC Power Status (RTC_PWR_STS) General PM Configuration 3 Register GEN_PMCON_3 D31:F0:A4h 2 0 Power Failure (PWR_FLR) General PM Configuration 3 Register (GEN_PMCON_3) D31:F0:A4h 1 0 AFTERG3_EN General PM Configuration 3 Register GEN_PMCON_3 D31:F0:A4h 0 0 Power Button Override Status (PRBTNOR_STS) Power Management 1 Status Register (PM1_STS) PMBase + 00h 11 0 RTC Event Enable (RTC_EN) Power Management 1 Enable Register (PM1_EN) PMBase + 02h 10 0 Sleep Type (SLP_TYP) Power Management 1 Control (PM1_CNT) PMBase + 04h 12:10 0 PME_EN General Purpose Event 0 Enables Register (GPE0_EN) PMBase + 2Ch 11 0 BATLOW_EN General Purpose Event 0 Enables Register (GPE0_EN) PMBase + 2Ch 10 0 RI_EN General Purpose Event 0 Enables Register (GPE0_EN) PMBase + 2Ch 8 0 NEWCENTURY_STS TCO1 Status Register (TCO1_STS) TCOBase + 04h 7 0 Intruder Detect (INTRD_DET) TCO2 Status Register (TCO2_STS) TCOBase + 06h 0 0 Top Swap (TS) Backed Up Control Register (BUC) Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3414h 0 X 137 Functional Description Using a GPI to Clear CMOS A jumper on a GPI can also be used to clear CMOS values. BIOS would detect the setting of this GPI on system boot-up, and manually clear the CMOS array. Note: The GPI strap technique to clear CMOS requires multiple steps to implement. The system is booted with the jumper in new position, then powered back down. The jumper is replaced back to the normal position, then the system is rebooted again. Warning: Do not implement a jumper on VccRTC to clear CMOS. 5.12 Processor Interface (D31:F0) The ICH10 interfaces to the processor with a variety of signals • Standard Outputs to processor: A20M#, SMI#, NMI, INIT#, INTR, STPCLK#, IGNNE#, CPUPWRGD, DPSLP# • Standard Input from processor: FERR#, THRMTRIP# Most ICH10 outputs to the processor use standard buffers. The ICH10 has separate V_CPU_IO signals that are pulled up at the system level to the processor voltage, and thus determines VOH for the outputs to the processor. 5.12.1 Processor Interface Signals This section describes each of the signals that interface between the ICH10 and the processor(s). Note that the behavior of some signals may vary during processor reset, as the signals are used for frequency strapping. 5.12.1.1 A20M# (Mask A20) The A20M# signal is active (low) when both of the following conditions are true: • The ALT_A20_GATE bit (Bit 1 of PORT92 register) is a 0 • The A20GATE input signal is a 0 The A20GATE input signal is expected to be generated by the external microcontroller (KBC). 138 Datasheet Functional Description 5.12.1.2 INIT# (Initialization) The INIT# signal is active (driven low) based on any one of several events described in Table 5-22. When any of these events occur, INIT# is driven low for 16 PCI clocks, then driven high. Note: The 16-clock counter for INIT# assertion halts while STPCLK# is active. Therefore, if INIT# is supposed to go active while STPCLK# is asserted, it actually goes active after STPCLK# goes inactive. This section refers to INIT#, but applies to two signals: INIT# and INIT3_3V#, as INIT3_3V# is functionally identical to INIT#, but signaling at 3.3 V. Table 5-22. INIT# Going Active Cause of INIT# Going Active Comment Shutdown special cycle from processor observed on ICH-(G)MCH interconnect (from (G)MCH). INIT# assertion based on value of Shutdown Policy Select register (SPS) PORT92 write, where INIT_NOW (bit 0) transitions from 0-to-1. PORTCF9 write, where SYS_RST (bit 1) was a 0 and RST_CPU (bit 2) transitions from 0-to-1. 5.12.1.3 RCIN# input signal goes low. RCIN# is expected to be driven by the external microcontroller (KBC). 0-to-1 transition on RCIN# must occur before the Intel® ICH10 will arm INIT# to be generated again. NOTE: RCIN# signal is expected to be low during S3, S4, and S5 states. Transition on the RCIN# signal in those states (or the transition to those states) may not necessarily cause the INIT# signal to be generated to the processor. CPU BIST To enter BIST, software sets CPU_BIST_EN bit and then does a full processor reset using the CF9 register. FERR#/IGNNE# (Numeric Coprocessor Error/ Ignore Numeric Error) The ICH10 supports the coprocessor error function with the FERR#/IGNNE# pins. The function is enabled via the COPROC_ERR_EN bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 31FFh: bit 1 for Consumer Family and Offset 31FEh: bit 9 for Corporate family). FERR# is tied directly to the Coprocessor Error signal of the processor. If FERR# is driven active by the processor, IRQ13 goes active (internally). When it detects a write to the COPROC_ERR register (I/O Register F0h), the ICH10 negates the internal IRQ13 and drives IGNNE# active. IGNNE# remains active until FERR# is driven inactive. IGNNE# is never driven active unless FERR# is active. Datasheet 139 Functional Description Figure 5-5. Coprocessor Error Timing Diagram FERR# Internal IRQ13 I/O Write to F0h IGNNE# If COPROC_ERR_EN is not set, the assertion of FERR# will not generate an internal IRQ13, nor will the write to F0h generate IGNNE#. 5.12.1.4 NMI (Non-Maskable Interrupt) Non-Maskable Interrupts (NMIs) can be generated by several sources, as described in Table 5-23. Table 5-23. NMI Sources Cause of NMI 5.12.1.5 Comment SERR# goes active (either internally, externally via SERR# signal, or via message from (G)MCH) Can instead be routed to generate an SCI, through the NMI2SCI_EN bit (Device 31:Function 0, TCO Base + 08h, bit 11). IOCHK# goes active via SERIRQ# stream (ISA system Error) Can instead be routed to generate an SCI, through the NMI2SCI_EN bit (Device 31:Function 0, TCO Base + 08h, bit 11). Stop Clock Request (STPCLK#) The ICH10 power management logic controls this active-low signal. Refer to Section 5.13 for more information on the functionality of this signal. 5.12.1.6 CPU Power Good (CPUPWRGD) This signal is connected to the processor’s PWRGOOD input. This signal represents a logical AND of the ICH10’s PWROK and VRMPWRGD signals. 5.12.1.7 Deeper Sleep (DPSLP#) This active-low signal controls the internal gating of the processor’s core clock. This signal asserts before and deasserts after the STP_CPU# signal to effectively stop the processor’s clock (internally) in the states in which STP_CPU# can be used to stop the processor’s clock externally. 140 Datasheet Functional Description 5.12.2 Dual-Processor Issues 5.12.2.1 Signal Differences In dual-processor designs, some of the processor signals are unused or used differently than for uniprocessor designs. Table 5-24. DP Signal Differences Signal A20M# / A20GATE Difference Generally not used, but still supported by Intel® ICH10. Used for S1 State as well as preparation for entry to S3–S5 5.12.2.2 STPCLK# Also allows for THRM# based throttling (not via ACPI control methods). Should be connected to both processors. FERR# / IGNNE# Generally not used, but still supported by ICH10. Power Management For multiple-processor (or Multiple-core) configurations in which more than one Stop Grant cycle may be generated, the (G)MCH is expected to count Stop Grant cycles and only pass the last one through to the ICH10. This prevents the ICH10 from getting out of sync with the processor on multiple STPCLK# assertions. Because the S1 state will have the STPCLK# signal active, the STPCLK# signal can be connected to both processors. However, for ACPI implementations, the BIOS must indicate that the ICH10 only supports the C1 state for dual-processor designs. In going to the S1 state, multiple Stop-Grant cycles will be generated by the processors. It is assumed that prior to setting the SLP_EN bit (which causes the transition to the S1 state), the processors will not be executing code that is likely to delay the Stop-Grant cycles. In going to the S3, S4, or S5 states, the system will appear to pass through the S1 state; thus, STPCLK# and SLP# are also used. During the S3, S4, and S5 states, both processors will lose power. Upon exit from those states, the processors will have their power restored. Datasheet 141 Functional Description 5.13 Power Management (D31:F0) 5.13.1 Features • Support for Advanced Configuration and Power Interface, Version 3.0a (ACPI) providing power and thermal management — ACPI 24-Bit Timer — Software initiated throttling of processor performance for Thermal and Power Reduction — Hardware Override to throttle processor performance if system too hot — SCI and SMI# Generation — ACPI C2 state Stop-Grant state (using STPCLK# signal) halts processor’s instruction stream • PCI PME# signal for Wake Up from Low-Power states • System Clock Control — ACPI C3 State: Ability to halt processor clock (but not memory clock) — ACPI C4 State: Ability to lower processor voltage. • System Sleep State Control — ACPI S1 state: Stop Grant (using STPCLK# signal) halts processor’s instruction stream (only STPCLK# active) — ACPI S3 state — Suspend to RAM (STR) — ACPI S4 state — Suspend-to-Disk (STD) — ACPI G2/S5 state — Soft Off (SOFF) — Power Failure Detection and Recovery • Intel Management Engine Power Management Support — New Wake events from the Intel Management Engine (enabled from all SStates including Catastrophic S5 conditions) • Streamlined Legacy Power Management for APM-Based Systems 5.13.2 Intel® ICH10 and System Power States Table 5-25 shows the power states defined for ICH10-based platforms. The state names generally match the corresponding ACPI states. 142 Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-25. General Power States for Systems Using Intel® ICH10 State/ Substates Legacy Name / Description G0/S0/C0 Full On: Processor operating. Individual devices may be shut down to save power. The different processor operating levels are defined by Cx states, as shown in Table 5-26. Within the C0 state, the Intel® ICH10 can throttle the processor using the STPCLK# signal to reduce power consumption. The throttling can be initiated by software or by the operating system or BIOS. G0/S0/C1 Auto-Halt: Processor has executed an AutoHalt instruction and is not executing code. The processor snoops the bus and maintains cache coherency. G0/S0/C2 Stop-Grant: The STPCLK# signal goes active to the processor. The processor performs a Stop-Grant cycle, halts its instruction stream, and remains in that state until the STPCLK# signal goes inactive. In the Stop-Grant state, the processor snoops the bus and maintains cache coherency. G0/S0/C3 Stop-Clock: The STPCLK# signal goes active to the processor. The processor performs a Stop-Grant cycle, halts its instruction stream. ICH10 then asserts DPSLP# followed by STP_CPU#, which forces the clock generator to stop the processor clock. Accesses to memory (by graphics, PCI, or internal units) is not permitted while in a C3 state. G0/S0/C4 Stop-Clock with Lower Processor Voltage: This closely resembles the G0/ S0/C3 state. However, after the ICH10 has asserted STP_CPU#, it then lowers the voltage to the processor. This reduces the leakage on the processor. Prior to exiting the C4 state, the ICH10 increases the voltage to the processor. Stop-Grant: Similar to G0/S0/C2 state. G1/S1 Note: The behavior for this state is slightly different when supporting Intel 64 processors. G1/S3 Suspend-To-RAM (STR): The system context is maintained in system DRAM, but power is shut off to non-critical circuits. Memory is retained, and refreshes continue. All clocks stop except RTC clock. G1/S4 Suspend-To-Disk (STD): The context of the system is maintained on the disk. All power is then shut off to the system except for the logic required to resume. G2/S5 Soft Off (SOFF): System context is not maintained. All power is shut off except for the logic required to restart. A full boot is required when waking. G3 Mechanical OFF (MOFF): System context not maintained. All power is shut off except for the RTC. No “Wake” events are possible, because the system does not have any power. This state occurs if the user removes the batteries, turns off a mechanical switch, or if the system power supply is at a level that is insufficient to power the “waking” logic. When system power returns, transition will depend on the state just prior to the entry to G3 and the AFTERG3 bit in the GEN_PMCON3 register (D31:F0, offset A4). Refer to Table 5-33 for more details. Table 5-26 shows the transitions rules among the various states. Note that transitions among the various states may appear to temporarily transition through intermediate states. For example, in going from S0 to S1, it may appear to pass through the G0/S0 states. These intermediate transitions and states are not listed in the table. Datasheet 143 Functional Description Table 5-26. State Transition Rules for Intel® ICH10 Present State G0/S0/C0 Transition Trigger Next State • Processor halt instruction • G0/S0/C1 • Level 2 Read • G0/S0/C2 • Level 3 Read • G0/S0/C3 or G0/S0/C4 - depending on C4onC3_EN bit (D31:F0:Offset A0h:bit 7) and BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit (D31:F0:Offset A9h:bit 2) • Level 4 Read • SLP_EN bit set • Power Button Override • Mechanical Off/Power Failure • G1/Sx or G2/S5 state • G2/S5 • G3 G0/S0/C1 G0/S0/C2 G0/S0/C3 G0/S0/C4 G1/S1, G1/S3, or G1/S4 G2/S5 G3 • Any Enabled Break Event • G0/S0/C0 • STPCLK# goes active • G0/S0/C2 • Power Button Override • G2/S5 • Power Failure • G3 • Any Enabled Break Event • G0/S0/C0 • Power Button Override • G2/S5 • Power Failure • G3 • Previously in C3/C4 and bus masters idle • C3 or C4 - depending on PDME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 4) • Any Enabled Break Event • G0/S0/C0 • Any Bus Master Event • G0/S0/C2 - if PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is set, else G0/S0/C0 • Power Button Override • G2/S5 • Power Failure • G3 • Previously in C4 and bus masters idle • C4 - depending on PDME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 4 • Any Enabled Break Event • G0/S0/C0 • Any Bus Master Event • G0/S0/C2 - if PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is set, else G0/S0/C0 • Power Button Override • G2/S5 • Power Failure • G3 • Any Enabled Wake Event • G0/S0/C0 • Power Button Override • G2/S5 • Power Failure • G3 • Any Enabled Wake Event • G0/S0/C0 • Power Failure • G3 • Power Returns • Optional to go to S0/C0 (reboot) or G2/ S5 (stay off until power button pressed or other wake event). (See Note 1) NOTES: 1. Some wake events can be preserved through power failure. 144 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.3 System Power Planes The system has several independent power planes, as described in Table 5-27. Note that when a particular power plane is shut off, it should go to a 0 V level. s Table 5-27. System Power Plane Plane Controlled By Description CPU SLP_S3# signal The SLP_S3# signal can be used to cut the power to the processor completely. The DPRSLPVR support allows lowering the processor’s voltage during the C4 state. MAIN MEMORY 5.13.4 SLP_S3# signal SLP_S4# signal SLP_S5# signal Link Controller SLP_M# DEVICE[n] GPIO When SLP_S3# goes active, power can be shut off to any circuit not required to wake the system from the S3 state. Since the S3 state requires that the memory context be preserved, power must be retained to the main memory. The processor, devices on the PCI bus, LPC I/F, and graphics will typically be shut off when the Main power plane is shut, although there may be small subsections powered. When the SLP_S4# goes active, power can be shut off to any circuit not required to wake the system from the S4. Since the memory context does not need to be preserved in the S4 state, the power to the memory can also be shut down. When SLP_S5# goes active, power can be shut to any circuit not required to wake the system from the S5 state. Since the memory context does not need to be preserved in the S5 state, the power to the memory can also be shut. This pin is asserted when the manageability platform goes to MOff. Depending on the platform, this pin may be used to control the (G)MCH, ICH controller link power planes, the clock chip power, and the SPI flash power. Individual subsystems may have their own power plane. For example, GPIO signals may be used to control the power to disk drives, audio amplifiers, or the display screen. SMI#/SCI Generation On any SMI# event taking place, ICH10 asserts SMI# to the processor, which causes it to enter SMM space. SMI# remains active until the EOS bit is set. When the EOS bit is set, SMI# goes inactive for a minimum of 4 PCI clocks. If another SMI event occurs, SMI# is driven active again. The SCI is a level-mode interrupt that is typically handled by an ACPI-aware operating system. In non-APIC systems (which is the default), the SCI IRQ is routed to one of the 8259 interrupts (IRQ 9, 10, or 11). The 8259 interrupt controller must be programmed to level mode for that interrupt. In systems using the APIC, the SCI can be routed to interrupts 9, 10, 11, 20, 21, 22, or 23. The interrupt polarity changes depending on whether it is on an interrupt shareable with a PIRQ or not (see Section 13.1.3). The interrupt remains asserted until all SCI sources are removed. Table 5-28 shows which events can cause an SMI# and SCI. Note that some events can be programmed to cause either an SMI# or SCI. The usage of the event for SCI (instead of SMI#) is typically associated with an ACPI-based system. Each SMI# or SCI source has a corresponding enable and status bit. Datasheet 145 Functional Description Table 5-28. Causes of SMI# and SCI (Sheet 1 of 2) Cause 146 SCI SMI Additional Enables Where Reported PME# Yes Yes PME_EN=1 PME_STS PME_B0 (Internal, Bus 0, PME-Capable Agents) Yes Yes PME_B0_EN=1 PME_B0_STS PCI Express* PME Messages Yes Yes PCI Express Hot Plug Message Yes Yes Power Button Press Yes Yes PWRBTN_EN=1 PWRBTN_STS Power Button Override (Note 7) Yes No None PRBTNOR_STS RTC Alarm Yes Yes RTC_EN=1 RTC_STS Ring Indicate Yes Yes RI_EN=1 RI_STS USB#1 wakes Yes Yes USB1_EN=1 USB1_STS USB#2 wakes Yes Yes USB2_EN=1 USB2_STS USB#3 wakes Yes Yes USB3_EN=1 USB3_STS USB#4 wakes Yes Yes USB4_EN=1 USB4_STS USB#5 wakes Yes Yes USB5_EN=1 USB5_STS USB#6 wakes Yes Yes USB6_EN=1 USB6_STS THRM# pin active Yes Yes THRM_EN=1 THRM_STS ACPI Timer overflow (2.34 sec.) Yes Yes TMROF_EN=1 TMROF_STS PCI_EXP_EN=1 (Not enabled for SMI) HOT_PLUG_EN=1 (Not enabled for SMI) PCI_EXP_STS HOT_PLUG_STS Any GPI Yes Yes GPI[x]_Route=10 (SCI) GPI[x]_Route=01 (SMI) GPE0[x]_EN=1 TCO SCI Logic Yes No TCOSCI_EN=1 TCOSCI_STS TCO SCI message from (G)MCH Yes No none MCHSCI_STS TCO SMI Logic No Yes TCO_EN=1 TCO_STS TCO SMI — Year 2000 Rollover No Yes none NEWCENTURY_STS TCO SMI — TCO TIMEROUT No Yes none TIMEOUT TCO SMI — OS writes to TCO_DAT_IN register No Yes none OS_TCO_SMI TCO SMI — Message from (G)MCH No Yes none MCHSMI_STS TCO SMI — NMI occurred (and NMIs mapped to SMI) No Yes NMI2SMI_EN=1 NMI2SMI_STS TCO SMI — INTRUDER# signal goes active No Yes INTRD_SEL=10 INTRD_DET TCO SMI8 — Change of the BIOSWP bit from 0 to 1 No Yes BC.LE=1 BIOSWR_STS GPI[x]_STS GPE0_STS Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-28. Causes of SMI# and SCI (Sheet 2 of 2) Cause TCO SMI — Write attempted to BIOS SCI No SMI Yes Additional Enables BIOSWP=1 Where Reported BIOSWR_STS BIOS_RLS written to Yes No GBL_EN=1 GBL_STS GBL_RLS written to No Yes BIOS_EN=1 BIOS_STS Write to B2h register No Yes APMC_EN = 1 APM_STS Periodic timer expires No Yes PERIODIC_EN=1 PERIODIC_STS 64 ms timer expires No Yes SWSMI_TMR_EN=1 SWSMI_TMR_STS Enhanced USB Legacy Support Event No Yes LEGACY_USB2_EN = 1 LEGACY_USB2_STS Enhanced USB Intel Specific Event No Yes INTEL_USB2_EN = 1 INTEL_USB2_STS UHCI USB Legacy logic No Yes LEGACY_USB_EN=1 LEGACY_USB_STS Serial IRQ SMI reported No Yes none SERIRQ_SMI_STS Device monitors match address in its range No Yes none SMBus Host Controller No Yes SMB_SMI_EN Host Controller Enabled SMBus host status reg. SMBus Slave SMI message No Yes none SMBUS_SMI_STS SMBus SMBALERT# signal active No Yes none SMBUS_SMI_STS SMBus Host Notify message received No Yes HOST_NOTIFY_INTRE N SMBUS_SMI_STS HOST_NOTIFY_STS Access microcontroller 62h/ 66h No Yes MCSMI_EN MCSMI_STS SLP_EN bit written to 1 No Yes SMI_ON_SLP_EN=1 SMI_ON_SLP_EN_STS USB Per-Port Registers Write Enable bit changes to 1. No Yes USB2_EN=1, Write_Enable_SMI_En able=1 USB2_STS, Write Enable Status Write attempted to BIOS No Yes BIOSWPD = 0 BIOSWR_STS GPIO Lockdown Enable bit changes from ‘1’ to ‘0’. No Yes GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI_E N=1 GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI_S TS DEVTRAP_STS NOTES: 1. SCI_EN must be 1 to enable SCI. SCI_EN must be 0 to enable SMI. 2. SCI can be routed to cause interrupt 9:11 or 20:23 (20:23 only available in APIC mode). 3. GBL_SMI_EN must be 1 to enable SMI. 4. EOS must be written to 1 to re-enable SMI for the next 1. 5. ICH10 must have SMI# fully enabled when ICH10 is also enabled to trap cycles. If SMI# is not enabled in conjunction with the trap enabling, then hardware behavior is undefined. 6. Only GPI[15:0] may generate an SMI# or SCI. 7. When a power button override first occurs, the system will transition immediately to S5. The SCI will only occur after the next wake to S0 if the residual status bit (PRBTNOR_STS) is not cleared prior to setting SCI_EN. 8. This SMI is a synchronous event. Datasheet 147 Functional Description PCI Express ports and the (G)MCH (via DMI) have the ability to cause PME using messages. When a PME message is received, ICH10 will set the PCI_EXP_STS bit. If the PCI_EXP_EN bit is also set, the ICH10 can cause an SCI via the GPE1_STS register. PCI Express has a Hot-Plug mechanism and is capable of generating a SCI via the GPE1 register. It is also capable of generating an SMI. However, it is not capable of generating a wake event. 5.13.5 Dynamic Processor Clock Control The ICH10 has extensive control for dynamically starting and stopping system clocks. The clock control is used for transitions among the various S0/Cx states, and processor throttling. Each dynamic clock control method is described in this section. The various sleep states may also perform types of non-dynamic clock control. The ICH10 supports the ACPI C0, C1, C2, C3, and C4 states. The Dynamic Processor Clock control is handled using the following signals: • STPCLK#: Used to halt processor instruction stream. • STP_CPU#: Used to stop processor’s clock • DPSLP#: Used to force Deeper Sleep for processor. • DPRSLPVR: Used to lower voltage of VRM during C4 state. • DPRSTP#: Used to alert the processor of C4 state. Also works in conjunction with DPRSLPVR to communicate to the VRM whether a slow or fast voltage ramp should be used. The C1 state is entered based on the processor performing an auto halt instruction. The C2 state is entered based on the processor reading the Level 2 register in the ICH10. The C2 state can also be entered from C3 or C4 states if bus masters require snoops and the PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is set. The C3 state is entered based on the processor reading the Level 3 register in the ICH10 and when the C4onC3_EN bit is clear (D31:F0:Offset A0:bit 7). This state can also be entered after a temporary return to C2 from a prior C3 or C4 state. The C4 state is entered based on the processor reading the Level 4 register in the ICH10, or by reading the Level 3 register when the C4onC3_EN bit is set. This state can also be entered after a temporary return to C2 from a prior C4 state. A C1, C2, C3, or C4 state ends due to a Break event. Based on the break event, the ICH10 returns the system to C0 state. Table 5-29 lists the possible break events from C2, C3, or C4. The break events from C1 are indicated in the processor’s datasheet. 148 Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-29. Break Events Breaks from Comment Any unmasked interrupt goes active C2 IRQ[0:15] when using the 8259s, IRQ[0:23] for I/O APIC. Since SCI is an interrupt, any SCI will also be a break event. Any internal event that cause an NMI or SMI# C2 Many possible sources Any internal event that cause INIT# to go active C2 Could be indicated by the keyboard controller via the RCIN input signal. Event Any bus master request (internal, external or DMA, or BMBUSY#) goes active and BM_RLD=1 (D31:F0:Offset PMBASE+04h: bit 1) 5.13.5.1 Need to wake up processor so it can do snoops C3, C4 Note: If the PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is set, then bus master activity will NOT be treated as a break event. Instead, there will be a return only to the C2 state. Processor Pending Break Event Indication C2 Only available if FERR# enabled for break event indication (See FERR# Mux Enable in GCS, Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3410h:bit 6) REQ-C0 Message from (G)MCH C2 Can be sent at any time after the Ack-C2 message and before the Ack-C0 message, when not in C0 state. Slow C4 Exit In order to eliminate the audible noise caused by aggressive voltage ramps when exiting C4 the states at a regular, periodic frequency, the ICH10 supports a method to slow down the voltage ramp at the processor VR for certain break events. If enabled for this behavior, the ICH10 treats IRQ0 and IRQ8 as “slow” break events since both of these can be the system timer tick interrupt. Rather than carefully tracking the interrupt and timer configuration information to track the one correct interrupt, it was deemed acceptable to simplify the logic and slow the break exit sequence for both interrupts. Other break event sources invoke the normal exit timings. The ICH10 indicates that a slow voltage ramp is desired by deasserting DPRSTP# (high) and leaving DPRSLPVR asserted (high). The normal voltage ramp rate is communicated by deasserting DPRSTP# (high) and deasserting DPRSLPVR (low). The ICH10 waits an additional delay before starting the normal voltage ramp timer during the C4 or C5 exit sequence. If a “fast” break event occurs during the additional, slow-Exit time delay, the ICH10 quickly deasserts DPRSLPVR (low), thereby speeding up the voltage ramp and reducing the delay to a value that is typically seen by the device in the past. In the event that a fast break event and a slow break event occur together, the fast flow is taken. Datasheet 149 Functional Description 5.13.5.2 Transition Rules among S0/Cx and Throttling States The following priority rules and assumptions apply among the various S0/Cx and throttling states: • Entry to any S0/Cx state is mutually exclusive with entry to any S1–S5 state. This is because the processor can only perform one register access at a time and Sleep states have higher priority than thermal throttling. • When the SLP_EN bit is set (system going to a S1 - S5 sleep state), the THTL_EN and FORCE_THTL bits can be internally treated as being disabled (no throttling while going to sleep state). • If the THTL_EN or FORCE_THTL bits are set, and a Level 2, Level 3 or Level 4 read then occurs, the system should immediately go and stay in a C2, C3 or C4 state until a break event occurs. A Level 2, Level 3 or Level 4 read has higher priority than the software initiated throttling. • After an exit from a C2, C3 or C4 state (due to a Break event), and if the THTL_EN or FORCE_THTL bits are still set the system will continue to throttle STPCLK#. Depending on the time of break event, the first transition on STPCLK# active can be delayed by up to one THRM period (1024 PCI clocks = 30.72 µs). • The Host controller must post Stop-Grant cycles in such a way that the processor gets an indication of the end of the special cycle prior to the ICH10 observing the Stop-Grant cycle. This ensures that the STPCLK# signals stays active for a sufficient period after the processor observes the response phase. • If in the C1 state and the STPCLK# signal goes active, the processor will generate a Stop-Grant cycle, and the system should go to the C2 state. When STPCLK# goes inactive, it should return to the C1 state. 5.13.5.3 Deferred C3/C4 Due to the new DMI protocol, if there is any bus master activity (other than true isochronous), then the C0 to C3 transition will pause at the C2 state. ICH10 will keep the processor in a C2 state until: • ICH10 sees no bus master activity. • A break event occurs. In this case, the ICH10 will perform the C2 to C0 sequence. Note that bus master traffic is not a break event in this case. To take advantage of the Deferred C3/C4 mode, the BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit must be set. This will cause the BM_STS bit to read as 0 even if some bus master activity is present. If this is not done, then the software may avoid even attempting to go to the C3 or C4 state if it sees the BM_STS bit as 1. If the PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is 0, then the ICH10 will treat bus master activity as a break event. When reaching the C2 state, if there is any bus master activity, the ICH10 will return the processor to a C0 state. 5.13.5.4 POPUP (Auto C3/C4 to C2) When the PUME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 3) is set, the ICH10 enables a mode of operation where standard (non-isochronous) bus master activity will not be treated as a full break event from the C3 or C4 states. Instead, these will be treated merely as bus master events and return the platform to a C2 state, and thus allow snoops to be performed. After returning to the C2 state, the bus master cycles will be sent to the (G)MCH, even if the ARB_DIS bit is set. 150 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.5.5 POPDOWN (Auto C2 to C3/C4) After returning to the C2 state from C3/C4, it the PDME bit (D31:F0: Offset A9h: bit 4) is set, the platform can return to a C3 or C4 state (depending on where it was prior to going back up to C2). This behaves similar to the Deferred C3/C4 transition, and will keep the processor in a C2 state until: • Bus masters are no longer active. • A break event occurs. Note: Bus master traffic is not a break event in this case. 5.13.6 Sleep States 5.13.6.1 Sleep State Overview The ICH10 directly supports different sleep states (S1–S5), which are entered by setting the SLP_EN bit, or due to a Power Button press. The entry to the Sleep states is based on several assumptions: • Entry to a Cx state is mutually exclusive with entry to a Sleep state. This is because the processor can only perform one register access at a time. A request to Sleep always has higher priority than throttling. • Prior to setting the SLP_EN bit, the software turns off processor-controlled throttling. Note that thermal throttling cannot be disabled, but setting the SLP_EN bit disables thermal throttling (since S1–S5 sleep state has higher priority). • The G3 state cannot be entered via any software mechanism. The G3 state indicates a complete loss of power. 5.13.6.2 Initiating Sleep State Sleep states (S1–S5) are initiated by: • Masking interrupts, turning off all bus master enable bits, setting the desired type in the SLP_TYP field, and then setting the SLP_EN bit. The hardware then attempts to gracefully put the system into the corresponding Sleep state. • Pressing the PWRBTN# Signal for more than 4 seconds to cause a Power Button Override event. In this case the transition to the S5 state is less graceful, since there are no dependencies on observing Stop-Grant cycles from the processor or on clocks other than the RTC clock. • Assertion of the THRMTRIP# signal will cause a transition to the S5 state. This can occur when system is in S0 or S1 state. Table 5-30. Sleep Types Sleep Type Datasheet Comment S1 Intel ICH10 asserts the STPCLK# signal. This lowers the processor’s power consumption. No snooping is possible in this state. S3 ICH10 asserts SLP_S3#. The SLP_S3# signal controls the power to non-critical circuits. Power is only retained to devices needed to wake from this sleeping state, as well as to the memory. S4 ICH10 asserts SLP_S3# and SLP_S4#. The SLP_S4# signal shuts off the power to the memory subsystem. Only devices needed to wake from this state should be powered. S5 Same power state as S4. ICH10 asserts SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5#. 151 Functional Description 5.13.6.3 Exiting Sleep States Sleep states (S1–S5) are exited based on Wake events. The Wake events forces the system to a full on state (S0), although some non-critical subsystems might still be shut off and have to be brought back manually. For example, the hard disk may be shut off during a sleep state, and have to be enabled via a GPIO pin before it can be used. Upon exit from the ICH10-controlled Sleep states, the WAK_STS bit is set. The possible causes of Wake Events (and their restrictions) are shown in Table 5-31. Table 5-31. Causes of Wake Events Cause RTC Alarm Power Button States Can Wake From S1–S5 (Note 1) S1–S5 How Enabled Set RTC_EN bit in PM1_EN register Always enabled as Wake event. (Note 2). S1–S5 (Note 1) GPE0_EN register NOTE: GPIs that are in the core well are not capable of waking the system from sleep states when the core well is not powered. Classic USB S1–S4 Set USB1_EN, USB 2_EN, USB3_EN, USB4_EN, USB5_EN, and USB6_EN bits in GPE0_EN register LAN S1–S5 Will use PME#. Wake enable set with LAN logic. RI# S1–S5 (Note 1) GPI[0:15] Intel® High Definition Audio S1–S5 Set RI_EN bit in GPE0_EN register Event sets PME_B0_STS bit; PM_B0_EN must be enabled. Can not wake from S5 state if it was entered due to power failure or power button override. S1–S5 (Note 1) PME_B0_EN bit in GPE0_EN register Secondary PME# S1–S5 Set PME_EN bit in GPE0_EN register. PCI_EXP_WAKE# S1–S5 PCI_EXP_WAKE bit (Note 3) Primary PME# SATA S1 Set PME_EN bit in GPE0_EN register. (Note 4) PCI_EXP PME Message S1 Must use the PCI Express* WAKE# pin rather than messages for wake from S3,S4, or S5. SMBALERT# S1–S5 Always enabled as Wake event SMBus Slave Wake Message (01h) S1–S5 Wake/SMI# command always enabled as a Wake event. NOTE: SMBus Slave Message can wake the system from S1–S5, as well as from S5 due to Power Button Override. (Note 2). SMBus Host Notify message received S1–S5 HOST_NOTIFY_WKEN bit SMBus Slave Command register. Reported in the SMB_WAK_STS bit in the GPEO_STS register. ME Non-Maskable Wake S1–S5 Always enabled as Wake event. (Note 2). NOTES: 1. This is a wake event from S5 only if the sleep state was entered by setting the SLP_EN and SLP_TYP bits via software, or if there is a power failure. 2. If in the S5 state due to a power button override or THRMTRIP#, the possible wake events are due to Power Button, Hard Reset Without Cycling (See Command Type 3 in Table 5-53), Hard Reset System (See Command Type 4 in Table 5-53), Wake SMBus Slave Message (01h), and ME initiated non-maskable wake. 152 Datasheet Functional Description 3. 4. When the WAKE# pin is active and the PCI Express device is enabled to wake the system, the ICH10 will wake the platform. SATA can only trigger a wake event in S1, but if PME is asserted prior to S3/S4/S5 entry and software does not clear the PME_B0_STS, a wake event would still result. It is important to understand that the various GPIs have different levels of functionality when used as wake events. The GPIs that reside in the core power well can only generate wake events from sleep states where the core well is powered. Also, only certain GPIs are “ACPI Compliant,” meaning that their Status and Enable bits reside in ACPI I/O space. Table 5-32 summarizes the use of GPIs as wake events. Table 5-32. GPI Wake Events GPI Power Well Wake From Notes GPI[7:0] Core S1 ACPI Compliant GPI[15:8] Suspend S1–S5 ACPI Compliant The latency to exit the various Sleep states varies greatly and is heavily dependent on power supply design, so much so that the exit latencies due to the ICH10 are insignificant. 5.13.6.4 PCI Express* WAKE# Signal and PME Event Message PCI Express ports can wake the platform from any sleep state (S1, S3, S4, or S5) using the WAKE# pin. WAKE# is treated as a wake event, but does not cause any bits to go active in the GPE_STS register. PCI Express ports and the (G)MCH (via DMI) have the ability to cause PME using messages. When a PME message is received, ICH10 will set the PCI_EXP_STS bit. 5.13.6.5 Sx-G3-Sx, Handling Power Failures Depending on when the power failure occurs and how the system is designed, different transitions could occur due to a power failure. The AFTER_G3 bit provides the ability to program whether or not the system should boot once power returns after a power loss event. If the policy is to not boot, the system remains in an S5 state (unless previously in S4). There are only three possible events that will wake the system after a power failure. 1. PWRBTN#: PWRBTN# is always enabled as a wake event. When RSMRST# is low (G3 state), the PWRBTN_STS bit is reset. When the ICH10 exits G3 after power returns (RSMRST# goes high), the PWRBTN# signal is already high (because VCCstandby goes high before RSMRST# goes high) and the PWRBTN_STS bit is 0. 2. RI#: RI# does not have an internal pull-up. Therefore, if this signal is enabled as a wake event, it is important to keep this signal powered during the power loss event. If this signal goes low (active), when power returns the RI_STS bit is set and the system interprets that as a wake event. 3. RTC Alarm: The RTC_EN bit is in the RTC well and is preserved after a power loss. Like PWRBTN_STS the RTC_STS bit is cleared when RSMRST# goes low. The ICH10 monitors both PWROK and RSMRST# to detect for power failures. If PWROK goes low, the PWROK_FLR bit is set. If RSMRST# goes low, PWR_FLR is set. Note: Datasheet Although PME_EN is in the RTC well, this signal cannot wake the system after a power loss. PME_EN is cleared by RTCRST#, and PME_STS is cleared by RSMRST#. 153 Functional Description Table 5-33. Transitions Due to Power Failure 5.13.7 State at Power Failure AFTERG3_EN bit Transition When Power Returns S0, S1, S3 1 0 S5 S0 S4 1 0 S4 S0 S5 1 0 S5 S0 Thermal Management The ICH10 has mechanisms to assist with managing thermal problems in the system. 5.13.7.1 THRM# Signal The THRM# signal is used as a status input for a thermal sensor. Based on the THRM# signal going active, the ICH10 generates an SMI# or SCI (depending on SCI_EN). If the THRM_POL bit is set low, when the THRM# signal goes low, the THRM_STS bit will be set. This is an indicator that the thermal threshold has been exceeded. If the THRM_EN bit is set, then when THRM_STS goes active, either an SMI# or SCI will be generated (depending on the SCI_EN bit being set). The power management software (BIOS or ACPI) can then take measures to start reducing the temperature. Examples include shutting off unwanted subsystems, or halting the processor. By setting the THRM_POL bit to high, another SMI# or SCI can optionally be generated when the THRM# signal goes back high. This allows the software (BIOS or ACPI) to turn off the cooling methods. Note: THRM# assertion does not cause a TCO event message in S3 or S4. The level of the signal is not reported in the heartbeat message. 5.13.7.2 Software Initiated Passive Cooling This mode is initiated by software setting the THTL_EN or FORCE_THTL bits. Software sets the THTL_DTY or THRM_DTY bits to select throttle ratio and THTL_EN or FORCE_THTL bit to enable the throttling. Throttling results in STPCLK# active for a minimum time of 12.5% and a maximum of 87.5%. The period is 1024 PCI clocks. Thus, the STPCLK# signal can be active for as little as 128 PCI clocks or as much as 896 PCI clocks. The actual slowdown (and cooling) of the processor depends on the instruction stream, because the processor is allowed to finish the current instruction. Furthermore, the ICH10 waits for the STOPGRANT cycle before starting the count of the time the STPCLK# signal is active. 154 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.7.3 THRM# Override Software Bit The FORCE_THTL bit allows the BIOS to force passive cooling, independent of the ACPI software (which uses the THTL_EN and THTL_DTY bits). If this bit is set, the ICH10 starts throttling using the ratio in the THRM_DTY field. When this bit is cleared the ICH10 stops throttling, unless the THTL_EN bit is set (indicating that ACPI software is attempting throttling). If both the THTL_EN and FORCE_THTL bits are set, then the ICH should use the duty cycle defined by the THRM_DTY field, not the THTL_DTY field. 5.13.7.4 Active Cooling Active cooling involves fans. The GPIO signals from the ICH10 can be used to turn on/ off a fan. 5.13.8 Event Input Signals and Their Usage The ICH10 has various input signals that trigger specific events. This section describes those signals and how they should be used. 5.13.8.1 PWRBTN# (Power Button) The ICH10 PWRBTN# signal operates as a “Fixed Power Button” as described in the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface, Version 2.0b. PWRBTN# signal has a 16 ms de-bounce on the input. The state transition descriptions are included in Table 5-34. Note that the transitions start as soon as the PWRBTN# is pressed (but after the debounce logic), and does not depend on when the Power Button is released. Note: During the time that the SLP_S4# signal is stretched for the minimum assertion width (if enabled), the Power Button is not a wake event. Refer to Power Button Override Function section below for further detail. Table 5-34. Transitions Due to Power Button Present State Transition/Action S0/Cx PWRBTN# goes low SMI# or SCI generated (depending on SCI_EN, PWRBTN_INIT_EN, PWRBTN_EN and GLB_SMI_EN) S1–S5 PWRBTN# goes low Wake Event. Transitions to S0 state G3 PWRBTN# pressed None S0–S4 Datasheet Event PWRBTN# held low for at least 4 consecutive seconds Unconditional transition to S5 state Comment Software typically initiates a Sleep state Standard wakeup No effect since no power Not latched nor detected No dependence on processor (e.g., Stop-Grant cycles) or any other subsystem 155 Functional Description Power Button Override Function (ICH10 Consumer Only) If PWRBTN# is observed active for at least four consecutive seconds, the state machine unconditionally transitions to the G2/S5 state, regardless of present state (S0-S4), even if PWROK is not active. In this case, the transition to the G2/S5 state does not depend on any particular response from the processor (e.g., a Stop-Grant cycle), nor any similar dependency from any other subsystem. The PWRBTN# status is readable to check if the button is currently being pressed or has been released. The status is taken after the de-bounce, and is readable via the PWRBTN_LVL bit. Note: The 4-second PWRBTN# assertion should only be used if a system lock-up has occurred. The 4-second timer starts counting when the ICH10 is in a S0 state. If the PWRBTN# signal is asserted and held active when the system is in a suspend state (S1-S5), the assertion causes a wake event. Once the system has resumed to the S0 state, the 4second timer starts. Note: During the time that the SLP_S4# signal is stretched for the minimum assertion width (if enabled by D31:F0:A4h bit 3), the Power Button is not a wake event. Power Button Override Function (ICH10 Corporate Only) If PWRBTN# is observed active for at least four consecutive seconds when in S0/1 or at least nine consecutive seconds when in S3-S4, the state machine unconditionally transitions to the G2/S5 state, even if PWROK is not active. In this case, the transition to the G2/S5 state does not depend on any particular response from the processor (e.g., a Stop-Grant cycle), nor any similar dependency from any other subsystem. The PWRBTN# status is readable to check if the button is currently being pressed or has been released. The status is taken after the de-bounce, and is readable via the PWRBTN_LVL bit. Note: A 4 to 9 second PWRBTN# assertion should only be used if a system lock-up has occurred. The power button override timer starts counting when PWRBTN# is asserted and will be set to 4 seconds when the platform is in S0/S1 and 9 seconds when the platform is in S3-S4 in order to trigger a power button override event. Note: During the time that the SLP_S3#/SLP_S4# signal is stretched for the minimum assertion width (if enabled in D31:F0:A4h), a Power Button is not wake event. For this reason, the ICH10 Corporate will always extend the power button override timer to 9 seconds when in S3/S4 to allow for a wake event that is delayed by SLP_S3#/SLP_S4# stretching to be observed before accidentaly triggering a power button override event. Sleep Button The Advanced Configuration and Power Interface, Version 2.0b defines an optional Sleep button. It differs from the power button in that it only is a request to go from S0 to S1–S4 (not S5). Also, in an S5 state, the Power Button can wake the system, but the Sleep Button cannot. Although the ICH10 does not include a specific signal designated as a Sleep Button, one of the GPIO signals can be used to create a “Control Method” Sleep Button. See the Advanced Configuration and Power Interface, Version 2.0b for implementation details. 156 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.8.2 RI# (Ring Indicator) The Ring Indicator can cause a wake event (if enabled) from the S1–S5 states. Table 5-35 shows when the wake event is generated or ignored in different states. If in the G0/S0/Cx states, the ICH10 generates an interrupt based on RI# active, and the interrupt will be set up as a Break event. Table 5-35. Transitions Due to RI# Signal Present State Event RI_EN Event S0 RI# Active X Ignored S1–S5 RI# Active 0 Ignored 1 Wake Event Note: Filtering/Debounce on RI# will not be done in ICH10. Can be in modem or external. 5.13.8.3 PME# (PCI Power Management Event) The PME# signal comes from a PCI device to request that the system be restarted. The PME# signal can generate an SMI#, SCI, or optionally a Wake event. The event occurs when the PME# signal goes from high to low. No event is caused when it goes from low to high. There is also an internal PME_B0 bit. This is separate from the external PME# signal and can cause the same effect. 5.13.8.4 SYS_RESET# Signal When the SYS_RESET# pin is detected as active after the 16 ms debounce logic, the ICH10 attempts to perform a “graceful” reset, by waiting up to 25 ms for the SMBus to go idle. If the SMBus is idle when the pin is detected active, the reset occurs immediately; otherwise, the counter starts. If at any point during the count the SMBus goes idle the reset occurs. If, however, the counter expires and the SMBus is still active, a reset is forced upon the system even though activity is still occurring. Once the reset is asserted, it remains asserted for 5 to 6 ms regardless of whether the SYSRESET# input remains asserted or not. It cannot occur again until SYS_RESET# has been detected inactive after the debounce logic, and the system is back to a full S0 state with PLTRST# inactive. Note that if bit 3 of the CF9h I/O register is set then SYS_RESET# will result in a full power cycle reset. 5.13.8.5 THRMTRIP# Signal If THRMTRIP# goes active, the processor is indicating an overheat condition, and the ICH10 immediately transitions to an S5 state. However, since the processor has overheated, it does not respond to the ICH10’s STPCLK# pin with a stop grant special cycle. Therefore, the ICH10 does not wait for one. Immediately upon seeing THRMTRIP# low, the ICH10 initiates a transition to the S5 state, drive SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, SLP_S5# low, and set the CTS bit. The transition looks like a power button override. When a THRMTRIP# event occurs, the ICH10 will power down immediately without following the normal S0 -> S5 path. The ICH10 will immediately drive SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, and SLP_S5# low after sampling THRMTRIP# active. If the processor is running extremely hot and is heating up, it is possible (although very unlikely) that components around it, such as the ICH10, are no longer executing cycles properly. Therefore, if THRMTRIP# goes active, and the ICH10 is relying on state machine logic to perform the power down, the state machine may not be working, and the system will not power down. Datasheet 157 Functional Description The ICH provides filtering for short low glitches on the THRMTRIP# signal in order to prevent erroneous system shut downs from noise. Glitches shorter than 25nsec are ignored. During boot, THRMTRIP# is ignored until SLP_S3#, PWROK, VRMPWRGD/VGATE, and PLTRST# are all ‘1’. During entry into a powered-down state (due to S3, S4, S5 entry, power cycle reset, etc.) THRMTRIP# is ignored until either SLP_S3# = 0, or PWROK = 0, or VRMPWRGD/VGATE = 0. Note: A thermal trip event will: • • • • 5.13.8.6 Set the AFTERG3_EN bit Clear the PWRBTN_STS bit Clear all the GPE0_EN register bits Clear the SMB_WAK_STS bit only if SMB_SAK_STS was set due to SMBus slave receiving message and not set due to SMBAlert BMBUSY# The BMBUSY# signal is an input from a graphics component to indicate if it is busy. If prior to going to the C3 state, the BMBUSY# signal is active, then the BM_STS bit will be set. If after going to the C3 state, the BMBUSY# signal goes back active, the ICH10 will treat this as if one of the PCI REQ# signals went active. This is treated as a break event. 5.13.9 ALT Access Mode Before entering a low power state, several registers from powered down parts may need to be saved. In the majority of cases, this is not an issue, as registers have read and write paths. However, several of the ISA compatible registers are either read only or write only. To get data out of write-only registers, and to restore data into read-only registers, the ICH10 implements an ALT access mode. If the ALT access mode is entered and exited after reading the registers of the ICH10 timer (8254), the timer starts counting faster (13.5 ms). The following steps listed below can cause problems: 1. BIOS enters ALT access mode for reading the ICH10 timer related registers. 2. BIOS exits ALT access mode. 3. BIOS continues through the execution of other needed steps and passes control to the operating system. After getting control in step #3, if the operating system does not reprogram the system timer again, the timer ticks may be happening faster than expected. For example DOS and its associated software assume that the system timer is running at 54.6 ms and as a result the time-outs in the software may be happening faster than expected. Operating systems (e.g., Microsoft Windows* 98, Windows* 2000, and Windows NT*) reprogram the system timer and therefore do not encounter this problem. For some other operating systems (e.g., Microsoft MS-DOS*) the BIOS should restore the timer back to 54.6 ms before passing control to the operating system. If the BIOS is entering ALT access mode before entering the suspend state it is not necessary to restore the timer contents after the exit from ALT access mode. 158 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.9.1 Write Only Registers with Read Paths in ALT Access Mode The registers described in Table 5-36 have read paths in ALT access mode. The access number field in the table indicates which register will be returned per access to that port. Table 5-36. Write Only Registers with Read Paths in ALT Access Mode (Sheet 1 of 2) Restore Data I/O Addr 00h 01h 02h 03h 04h 05h 06h 07h Datasheet # of Rds Access Restore Data Data I/O Addr # of Rds Access Data 1 DMA Chan 0 base address low byte 1 Timer Counter 0 status, bits [5:0] 2 DMA Chan 0 base address high byte 2 Timer Counter 0 base count low byte 1 DMA Chan 0 base count low byte 3 Timer Counter 0 base count high byte 2 DMA Chan 0 base count high byte 4 Timer Counter 1 base count low byte 1 DMA Chan 1 base address low byte 5 Timer Counter 1 base count high byte 2 DMA Chan 1 base address high byte 6 Timer Counter 2 base count low byte 1 DMA Chan 1 base count low byte 7 Timer Counter 2 base count high byte 2 DMA Chan 1 base count high byte 41h 1 Timer Counter 1 status, bits [5:0] 1 DMA Chan 2 base address low byte 42h 1 Timer Counter 2 status, bits [5:0] 2 DMA Chan 2 base address high byte 70h 1 Bit 7 = NMI Enable, Bits [6:0] = RTC Address 1 DMA Chan 2 base count low byte 2 DMA Chan 2 base count high byte 1 DMA Chan 3 base address low byte 2 DMA Chan 3 base address high byte 1 DMA Chan 3 base count low byte 2 DMA Chan 3 base count high byte 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 40h C4h C6h C8h 7 1 DMA Chan 5 base address low byte 2 DMA Chan 5 base address high byte 1 DMA Chan 5 base count low byte 2 DMA Chan 5 base count high byte 1 DMA Chan 6 base address low byte 2 DMA Chan 6 base address high byte 2 2 2 159 Functional Description Table 5-36. Write Only Registers with Read Paths in ALT Access Mode (Sheet 2 of 2) Restore Data I/O Addr # of Rds Access Restore Data Data I/O Addr 20h Data 1 DMA Chan 6 base count low byte DMA Chan 0–3 Command2 2 DMA Chan 0–3 Request 2 DMA Chan 6 base count high byte 3 DMA Chan 0 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 00 1 DMA Chan 7 base address low byte 4 DMA Chan 1 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 01 2 DMA Chan 7 base address high byte 5 DMA Chan 2 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 10 1 DMA Chan 7 base count low byte 6 DMA Chan 3 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 11. 2 DMA Chan 7 base count high byte 1 PIC ICW2 of Master controller 1 DMA Chan 4–7 Command2 2 PIC ICW3 of Master controller 2 DMA Chan 4–7 Request 3 PIC ICW4 of Master controller 3 DMA Chan 4 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 00 4 PIC OCW1 of Master controller1 4 DMA Chan 5 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 01 5 PIC OCW2 of Master controller 5 DMA Chan 6 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 10 6 PIC OCW3 of Master controller 6 DMA Chan 7 Mode: Bits(1:0) = 11. 7 PIC ICW2 of Slave controller 8 PIC ICW3 of Slave controller 9 PIC ICW4 of Slave controller 6 12 Access 1 CAh 08h # of Rds 10 PIC OCW1 of Slave controller1 11 PIC OCW2 of Slave controller 12 PIC OCW3 of Slave controller CCh CEh D0h 2 2 2 6 NOTES: 1. The OCW1 register must be read before entering ALT access mode. 2. Bits 5, 3, 1, and 0 return 0. 160 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.9.2 PIC Reserved Bits Many bits within the PIC are reserved, and must have certain values written in order for the PIC to operate properly. Therefore, there is no need to return these values in ALT access mode. When reading PIC registers from 20h and A0h, the reserved bits shall return the values listed in Table 5-37. Table 5-37. PIC Reserved Bits Return Values 5.13.9.3 PIC Reserved Bits Value Returned ICW2(2:0) 000 ICW4(7:5) 000 ICW4(3:2) 00 ICW4(0) 0 OCW2(4:3) 00 OCW3(7) 0 OCW3(5) Reflects bit 6 OCW3(4:3) 01 Read Only Registers with Write Paths in ALT Access Mode The registers described in Table 5-38 have write paths to them in ALT access mode. Software restores these values after returning from a powered down state. These registers must be handled special by software. When in normal mode, writing to the base address/count register also writes to the current address/count register. Therefore, the base address/count must be written first, then the part is put into ALT access mode and the current address/count register is written. Table 5-38. Register Write Accesses in ALT Access Mode Datasheet I/O Address Register Write Value 08h DMA Status Register for channels 0–3. D0h DMA Status Register for channels 4–7. 161 Functional Description 5.13.10 System Power Supplies, Planes, and Signals 5.13.10.1 Power Plane Control with SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, SLP_S5# and SLP_M# The SLP_S3# output signal can be used to cut power to the system core supply, since it only goes active for the Suspend-to-RAM state (typically mapped to ACPI S3). Power must be maintained to the ICH10 suspend well, and to any other circuits that need to generate Wake signals from the Suspend-to-RAM state. During S3 (Suspend-to-RAM) all signals attached to powered down plans will be tri-stated or driven low, unless they are pulled via a pull-up resistor. Cutting power to the core may be done via the power supply, or by external FETs on the motherboard. The SLP_S4# or SLP_S5# output signal can be used to cut power to the system core supply, as well as power to the system memory, since the context of the system is saved on the disk. Cutting power to the memory may be done via the power supply, or by external FETs on the motherboard. The SLP_S4# output signal is used to remove power to additional subsystems that are powered during SLP_S3#. SLP_S5# output signal can be used to cut power to the system core supply, as well as power to the system memory, since the context of the system is saved on the disk. Cutting power to the memory may be done via the power supply, or by external FETs on the motherboard. SLP_M# output signal can be used to cut power to the Controller Link, Clock chip and SPI flash on a platform that supports Intel AMT. 5.13.10.2 SLP_S4# and Suspend-To-RAM Sequencing The system memory suspend voltage regulator is controlled by the Glue logic. The SLP_S4# signal should be used to remove power to system memory rather than the SLP_S5# signal. The SLP_S4# logic in the ICH10 provides a mechanism to fully cycle the power to the DRAM and/or detect if the power is not cycled for a minimum time. Note: 162 To use the minimum DRAM power-down feature that is enabled by the SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable bit (D31:F0:A4h bit 3), the DRAM power must be controlled by the SLP_S4# signal. Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.10.3 PWROK Signal The PWROK input should go active based on the core supply voltages becoming valid. PWROK should go active no sooner than 99 ms after Vcc3_3 and Vcc1_5 have reached their nominal values. PWROK must not glitch, even if RSMRST# is low. Note: 1. SYSRESET# is recommended for implementing the system reset button. This saves external logic that is needed if the PWROK input is used. Additionally, it allows for better handling of the SMBus and processor resets, and avoids improperly reporting power failures. 2. PWROK and RSMRST# are sampled using the RTC clock. Therefore, low times that are less than one RTC clock period may not be detected by the ICH10. 3. In the case of true PWROK failure, PWROK will go low before VRMPWRGD. 4. When PWROK goes inactive, a host power cycle reset will occur. A host power cycle is the assertion of SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, and SLP_S5#, and the deassertion of these signals 3-5 seconds later. The Intel Management Engine remains powered throughout this cycle. 5.13.10.4 CPUPWRGD Signal This signal is connected to the processor’s VRM via the VRMPWRGD signal and is internally AND’d with the PWROK signal that comes from the system power supply. 5.13.10.5 VRMPWRGD Signal VRMPWRGD is an input from the regulator indicating that all of the outputs from the regulator are on and within specification. Platforms that use the VRMPWRGD signal to start the clock chip PLLs assume that it asserts milliseconds before PWROK in order to provide valid clocks in time for the PWROK rising. Note: When VRMPWRGD goes inactive, a host power cycle reset will occur. A host power cycle is the assertion of SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, and SLP_S5#, and the deassertion of these signals 3-5 seconds later. The Intel Management Engine remains powered throughout this cycle. 5.13.10.6 DRAMPWROK Signal (Corporate Only) The DRAMPWROK output is sent to the (G)MCH as an indication of when DRAM power is turned off. The (G)MCH uses this information as one of the conditions for asserting the DDR3 Reset signal. The ICH10’s open-drain buffer pulls the signal low when SLP_S4# is asserted and CLPWROK deasserted. Datasheet 163 Functional Description 5.13.11 Clock Generators The clock generator is expected to provide the frequencies shown in Table 5-39. Table 5-39. Intel® ICH10 Clock Inputs Clock Domain SATA_CLK DMI_CLK 5.13.11.1 Frequency Source Usage 100 MHz Main Clock Generator Used by SATA controller. Stopped in S3 – S based on SLP_S3# assertion. Main Clock Generator Used by DMI and PCI Express*. Stopped in S3 – S5 based on SLP_S3# assertion. Differential 100 MHz Differential PCICLK 33 MHz Main Clock Generator Free-running PCI Clock to ICH10. Stopped in S3 – S5 based on SLP_S3# assertion. CLK48 48.000 MHz Main Clock Generator Used by USB controllers and Intel High Definition Audio controller. Stopped in S3 – S5 based on SLP_S3# assertion. CLK14 14.318 MHz Main Clock Generator Used by ACPI timers. Stopped in S3 – S5 based on SLP_S3# assertion. GLAN_CLK 5 to 62.5 MHz Platform LAN Connect LAN Connect Interface and Gigabit LAN Connect Interface. Control policy is determined by the clock source. Clock Control Signals from Intel® ICH10 to Clock Synthesizer The clock generator is assumed to have direct connect from the following ICH10 signals: • STP_CPU#: Stops processor clocks in C3 and C4 states • STP_PCI#: Stops system PCI clocks (not the ICH10 free-running 33 MHz clock) due to CLKRUN# protocol • SLP_S3#: Expected to drive clock chip PWRDOWN (through inverter), to stop clocks in S3 to S5. 164 Datasheet Functional Description 5.13.12 Legacy Power Management Theory of Operation Instead of relying on ACPI software, legacy power management uses BIOS and various hardware mechanisms. The scheme relies on the concept of detecting when individual subsystems are idle, detecting when the whole system is idle, and detecting when accesses are attempted to idle subsystems. However, the operating system is assumed to be at least APM enabled. Without APM calls, there is no quick way to know when the system is idle between keystrokes. The ICH10 does not support burst modes. 5.13.12.1 APM Power Management The ICH10 has a timer that, when enabled by the 1MIN_EN bit in the SMI Control and Enable register, generates an SMI# once per minute. The SMI handler can check for system activity by reading the DEVACT_STS register. If none of the system bits are set, the SMI handler can increment a software counter. When the counter reaches a sufficient number of consecutive minutes with no activity, the SMI handler can then put the system into a lower power state. If there is activity, various bits in the DEVACT_STS register will be set. Software clears the bits by writing a 1 to the bit position. The DEVACT_STS register allows for monitoring various internal devices, or Super I/O devices (SP, PP, FDC) on LPC or PCI, keyboard controller accesses, or audio functions on LPC or PCI. Other PCI activity can be monitored by checking the PCI interrupts. 5.13.13 Reset Behavior When a reset is triggered, the ICH10 will send a warning message to the (G)MCH to allow the (G)MCH to attempt to complete any outstanding memory cycles and put memory into a safe state before the platform is reset. When the (G)MCH is ready, it will send an acknowledge message to the ICH10. Once the message is received the ICH10 asserts PLTRST#. The ICH10 does not require an acknowledge message from the (G)MCH to trigger PLTRST#. A global reset will occur after 4 seconds if an acknowledge from the (G)MCH is not received. Note: When the ICH10 causes a reset by asserting PLTRST# its output signals will go to their reset states as defined in Chapter 3. A reset in which the host platform is reset and PLTRST# is asserted is called a Host Reset or Host Partition Reset. Depending on the trigger a host reset may also result in power cycling see Chapter 5-40 for details. If a host reset is triggered and the ICH10 times out before receiving an acknowledge message from the (G)MCH a Global Reset with power cycle will occur. A reset in which the host and ME partitions of the platform are reset is called a Global Reset. Datasheet 165 Functional Description Table 5-40 shows the various reset triggers. Table 5-40. Causes of Host and Global Resets Host Reset without Power Cycle Host Reset with Power Cycle Global Reset with Power Cycle Write of 0Eh to CF9h Register when Global Reset bit = 0b (D31:F0:ACh:20) No Yes No (Note 1) Write of 06h to CF9h Register when Global Reset bit = 0b Yes No No (Note 1) Write of 06h or 0Eh to CF9h register when Global Reset bit = 1b No No Yes SYS_RESET# Asserted and CF9h bit 3 = 0 Yes No No (Note 1) SYS_RESET# Asserted and CF9h bit 3 = 1 No Yes No (Note 1) SMBus Slave Message received for Reset with Power Cycle No Yes No (Note 1) SMBus Slave Message received for Reset without Power Cycle Yes No No (Note 1) TCO Watchdog timer reaches zero two times Yes No No (Note 1) Power Failure: PWROK signal or VRMPWRGD signal goes inactive or RSMRST# asserts No No Yes (Note 2) Special shutdown cycle from CPU causes CF9h-like PLTRST# and CF9h Global Reset bit = 1 No No Yes Special shutdown cycle from CPU causes CF9h-like PLTRST# and CF9h bit 3 = 1 No Yes No (Note 2) Special Shutdown Cycle from CPU causes CF9hlike PLTRST# and CF9h Global Reset bit = 0 Yes No No (Note 1) Intel® Management Engine Triggered Host Reset without power cycle Yes No No (Note 1) Intel Management Engine Triggered Host Reset with power cycle No Yes No (Note 1) Intel Management Engine Triggered Global Reset No No Yes Intel Management Engine Initiated Host Reset with power down No Yes (Note 3) No (Note 1) Intel Management Engine Watchdog Timer No Yes (Note 4) No (Note 1) Power Management Watchdog Timer No Yes (Note 4) No (note 1) Trigger NOTES: 1. Trigger will result in Global Reset with power cycle if the acknowledge message is not received by the ICH10. 2. ICH10 does not send warning message to (G)MCH, reset occurs without delay. 3. ICH10 waits for enabled wake event to complete reset. 4. System stays in S5 state. 166 Datasheet Functional Description 5.14 System Management (D31:F0) The ICH10 provides various functions to make a system easier to manage and to lower the Total Cost of Ownership (TCO) of the system. In addition, ICH10 provides integrated ASF Management support, requires use of SPI Flash and Intel Management Engine firmware. Features and functions can be augmented via external A/D converters and GPIO, as well as an external microcontroller. The following features and functions are supported by the ICH10: • Processor present detection — Detects if processor fails to fetch the first instruction after reset • Various Error detection (such as ECC Errors) indicated by host controller — Can generate SMI#, SCI, SERR, NMI, or TCO interrupt • Intruder Detect input — Can generate TCO interrupt or SMI# when the system cover is removed — INTRUDER# allowed to go active in any power state, including G3 • Detection of bad BIOS Flash (FWH or Flash on SPI) programming — Detects if data on first read is FFh (indicates that BIOS flash is not programmed) • Ability to hide a PCI device — Allows software to hide a PCI device in terms of configuration space through the use of a device hide register (See Section 10.1.75) Note: Voltage ID from the processor can be read via GPI signals. ASF functionality with the integrated ICH10 ASF controller requires a correctly configured system, including an appropriate SKU of the ICH10 (see Section 1.3), (G)MCH with Intel Management Engine, Intel Management Engine Firmware, system BIOS support, and appropriate Platform LAN Connect Device. 5.14.1 Theory of Operation The System Management functions are designed to allow the system to diagnose failing subsystems. The intent of this logic is that some of the system management functionality can be provided without the aid of an external microcontroller. 5.14.1.1 Detecting a System Lockup When the processor is reset, it is expected to fetch its first instruction. If the processor fails to fetch the first instruction after reset, the TCO timer times out twice and the ICH10 asserts PLTRST#. Datasheet 167 Functional Description 5.14.1.2 Handling an Intruder The ICH10 has an input signal, INTRUDER#, that can be attached to a switch that is activated by the system’s case being open. This input has a two RTC clock debounce. If INTRUDER# goes active (after the debouncer), this will set the INTRD_DET bit in the TCO_STS register. The INTRD_SEL bits in the TCO_CNT register can enable the ICH10 to cause an SMI# or interrupt. The BIOS or interrupt handler can then cause a transition to the S5 state by writing to the SLP_EN bit. The software can also directly read the status of the INTRUDER# signal (high or low) by clearing and then reading the INTRD_DET bit. This allows the signal to be used as a GPI if the intruder function is not required. If the INTRUDER# signal goes inactive some point after the INTRD_DET bit is written as a 1, then the INTRD_DET signal will go to a 0 when INTRUDER# input signal goes inactive. Note that this is slightly different than a classic sticky bit, since most sticky bits would remain active indefinitely when the signal goes active and would immediately go inactive when a 1 is written to the bit. Note: The INTRD_DET bit resides in the ICH10’s RTC well, and is set and cleared synchronously with the RTC clock. Thus, when software attempts to clear INTRD_DET (by writing a 1 to the bit location) there may be as much as two RTC clocks (about 65 µs) delay before the bit is actually cleared. Also, the INTRUDER# signal should be asserted for a minimum of 1 ms to ensure that the INTRD_DET bit will be set. Note: If the INTRUDER# signal is still active when software attempts to clear the INTRD_DET bit, the bit remains set and the SMI is generated again immediately. The SMI handler can clear the INTRD_SEL bits to avoid further SMIs. However, if the INTRUDER# signal goes inactive and then active again, there will not be further SMIs, since the INTRD_SEL bits would select that no SMI# be generated. 5.14.1.3 Detecting Improper Firmware Hub Programming The ICH10 can detect the case where the BIOS flash is not programmed. This results in the first instruction fetched to have a value of FFh. If this occurs, the ICH10 sets the BAD_BIOS bit. The BIOS flash may reside in FWH or flash on the SPI bus. 5.14.1.4 Heartbeat and Event Reporting via SMLink/SMBus Heartbeat and event reporting via SMLink/SMBus is no longer supported. The Intel AMT logic in ICH10 can be programmed to generate an interrupt to the Intel Management Engine when an event occurs. The Intel Management Engine will poll the TCO registers to gather appropriate bits to send the event message to the Gigabit Ethernet controller, if Intel Management Engine is programmed to do so. The Intel Management Engine is responsible for sending ASF 2.0 messages if programmed to do so. In Advanced TCO BMC mode, the external micro-controller (BMC) accesses the TCO info through SMBus. 168 Datasheet Functional Description 5.14.2 TCO Modes 5.14.2.1 TCO Legacy/Compatible Mode In TCO Legacy/Compatible mode the Intel Management Engine and Intel AMT logic and SMBus controllers are disabled. To enable Legacy/Compatible TCO mode the TCOMODE bit 7 in the ICHSTRP0 register in the SPI device must be 0. Note: SMBus and SMLink may be tied together externally, if a device has a single SMBus interface and needs access to the TCO slave and be visisble to the host SMBus controller. . Figure 5-6. TCO Legacy/Compatible Mode SMBus Configuration Intel® ICH10 TCO Compatible Mode ® Intel ME SMBus Controller 2 X Intel® ME SMBus Controller 1 X SPD (Slave) uCtrl SMBus Host SMBus TCO Slave SMLink Datasheet Legacy Sensors (Master or Slave with ALERT) ASF Sensors (Master or Slave) 169 Functional Description In TCO Legacy/Compatible mode the Intel ICH10 can function directly with the integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller or equivalent external LAN controller to report messages to a network management console without the aid of the system processor. This is crucial in cases where the processor is malfunctioning or cannot function due to being in a low-power state. Table 5-41 includes a list of events that will report messages to the network management console. Table 5-41. Event Transitions that Cause Messages Event Assertion? Deassertion? yes no Must be in “S1 or hung S0” state Must be in “S1 or hung S0” state. Note that the THRM# pin is isolated when the core power is off, thus preventing this event in S3-S5. INTRUDER# pin Comments THRM# pin yes yes Watchdog Timer Expired yes no (NA) GPIO[11]/ SMBALERT# pin yes yes Must be in “S1 or hung S0” state BATLOW# yes yes Must be in “S1 or hung S0” state CPU_PWR_FLR yes no “S1 or hung S0” state entered “S1 or hung S0” state entered NOTE: The GPIO11/SMBALERT#/JTAGTDO pin will trigger an event message (when enabled by the GPIO11_ALERT_DISABLE bit) regardless of whether it is configured as a GPI or not. 5.14.2.2 Advanced TCO Mode Intel ICH10 supports two modes of Advanced TCO. Intel Manageability Engine (Intel ME) mode and BMC mode. To enable Advance TCO mode (Intel ME or BMC mode) the TCOMODE bit 7 in the ICHSTRP0 register in the SPI device must be 1. 170 Datasheet Functional Description 5.14.2.2.1 Advanced TCO Intel® Manageability Engine Mode In this mode, Intel ME SMBus Controller 1, Host SMBus and SMLink are connected together internally. See Figure 5-7. This mode is enabled when the BMCMODE bit 15 in the ICHSTRP0 register in the SPI device is 0. The Intel ME SMBus Controller 2 can be connected to either the SMBus pins or the SMLink pins by the MESM2SEL bit 23 in the ICHSTRP0 register in the SPI device. The default is to have the Intel ME SMBus Controller 2 connected to SMLink. The Intel ME SMBus Controller 2 has no connection to LINKALERT#. Figure 5-7. Advanced TCO Intel® ME SMBus/SMLink Configuration Intel® ICH10 Intel® ME AMT SMBus SMBus Controller 2 Controller 2 Advanced TCO AMT Mode SMLink Intel® ME AMT SMBus SMBus Controller 1 Controller 1 Embedded Controller SPD (Slave) uCtrl Host SMBus SMBus TCO Slave Datasheet Legacy Sensors (Master or Slave with ALERT) ASF Sensors (Master or Slave) 171 Functional Description 5.14.2.2.2 Advanced TCO BMC Mode In this mode, the external microcontroller (BMC) is connected to both SMLink and SMBus. The BMC communicates with Intel Management Engine through Intel ME SMBus connected to SMLink. The host and TCO slave communicated with BMC through SMBus. See Figure 5-8. This mode is enabled when the BMCMODE bit 15 in the ICHSTRP0 register in the SPI device is 1. Figure 5-8. Advanced TCO BMC Mode SMBus/SMLink Configuration Advanced TCO BMC Mode Intel® ICH10 Intel® ME SMBus Controller 2 Intel® ME SMBus Controller 1 SMLink BMC SPD (Slave) Host SMBus SMBus TCO Slave 172 Legacy Sensors (Master or Slave with ALERT) ASF Sensors (Master or Slave) Datasheet Functional Description 5.15 General Purpose I/O (D31:F0) The ICH10 contains up to 61 General Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) signals. Each GPIO can be configured as an input or output signal. The number of inputs and outputs varies depending on ICH10 configuration. 5.15.1 Power Wells Some GPIOs exist in the suspend power plane. Care must be taken to make sure GPIO signals are not driven high into powered-down planes. Some ICH10 GPIOs may be connected to pins on devices that exist in the core well. If these GPIOs are outputs, there is a danger that a loss of core power (PWROK low) or a Power Button Override event results in the ICH10 driving a pin to a logic 1 to another device that is powered down. 5.15.2 SMI# and SCI Routing The routing bits for GPIO[0:15] allow an input to be routed to SMI# or SCI, or neither. Note that a bit can be routed to either an SMI# or an SCI, but not both. 5.15.3 Triggering GPIO[1:15] have “sticky” bits on the input. Refer to the GPE0_STS register. As long as the signal goes active for at least 2 clock cycles, the ICH10 keeps the sticky status bit active. The active level can be selected in the GP_LVL register. If the system is in an S0 or an S1 state, the GPI inputs are sampled at 33 MHz, so the signal only needs to be active for about 60 ns to be latched. In the S3–S5 states, the GPI inputs are sampled at 32.768 kHz, and thus must be active for at least 61 microseconds to be latched. If the input signal is still active when the latch is cleared, it will again be set. Another edge trigger is not required. This makes these signals “level” triggered inputs. 5.15.4 GPIO Registers Lockdown The following GPIO registers are locked down when the GPIO Lockdown Enable (GLE) bit is set. The GLE bit resides in D31:F0:GPIO Control (GC) register. • Offset 00h: GPIO_USE_SEL • Offset 04h: GP_IO_SEL • Offset 0Ch: GP_LVL • Offset 30h: GPIO_USE_SEL2 • Offset 34h: GPI_IO_SEL2 • Offset 38h: GP_LVL2 • Offset 40h: GPIO_USE_SEL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 44h: GPI_IO_SEL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 48h: GP_LVL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 60h: GP_RST_SEL Once these registers are locked down, they become Read-Only registers and any software writes to these registers will have no effect. To unlock the registers, the GPIO Lockdown Enable (GLE) bit is required to be cleared to ‘0’. When the GLE bit changes from a ‘1’ to a ‘0’ a System Management Interrupt (SMI#) is generated if enabled. Once the GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI bit is set, it can not be changed until a PLTRST# occurs. Datasheet 173 Functional Description This ensures that only BIOS can change the GPIO configuration. If the GLE bit is cleared by unauthorized software, BIOS will set the GLE bit again when the SMI# is triggered and these registers will continue to be locked down. 5.15.5 Serial POST Codes Over GPIO ICH10 adds the extended capability allowing system software to serialize POST or other messages on GPIO. This capability negates the requirement for dedicated diagnostic LEDs on the platform. Additionally, based on the newer BTX form factors, the PCI bus as a target for POST codes is increasingly difficult to support as the total number of PCI devices supported are decreasing. 5.15.5.1 Theory of operation For the ICH10 generation POST code serialization logic will be shared with GPIO. These GPIOs will likely be shared with LED control offered by the Super I/O (SIO) component. The following reference diagram shows a likely configuration. Figure 5-9. Serial Post over GPIO Reference Circuit V_3P3_STBY R ICH SIO LED Note: The pull-up value is based on the brightness required. The anticipated usage model is that either the ICH10 or the SIO can drive a pin low to turn off an LED. In the case of the power LED, the SIO would normally leave its corresponding pin in a high-Z state to allow the LED to turn on. In this state, the ICH10 can blink the LED by driving its corresponding pin low and subsequently tri-stating the buffer. An external optical sensing device can detect the on/off state of the LED. By externally post-processing the information from the optical device, the serial bit stream can be recovered. The hardware will supply a ‘sync’ byte before the actual data transmission to allow external detection of the transmit frequency. The frequency of transmission should be limited to 1 transition every 1μs to ensure the detector can reliably sample the on/off state of the LED. To allow flexibility in pull-up resistor values for power optimization, the frequency of the transmission is programmable via the DRS field in the GP_SB_CMDSTS register (Section 13.10.6). The serial bit stream is Manchester encoded. This choice of transmission ensures that a transition will be seen on every clock. The 1 or 0 data is based on the transmission happening during the high or low phase of the clock. 174 Datasheet Functional Description A simplified hardware/software register interface provides control and status information to track the activity of this block. Software enabling the serial blink capability should implement an algorithm referenced below to send the serialized message on the enabled GPIO. 1. Read the Go/Busy status bit in the GP_SB_CMDSTS register and verify it is cleared. This will ensure that the GPIO is idled and a previously requested message is still not in progress. 2. Write the data to serialize into the GP_SB_DATA register (Section 13.10.7). 3. Write the DLS and DRS values into the GP_SB_CMDSTS register and set the Go bit. This may be accomplished using a single write. The reference diagram shows the LEDs being powered from the suspend supply. By providing a generic capability that can be used both in the main and the suspend power planes maximum flexibility can be achieved. A key point to make is that the ICH will not unintentionally drive the LED control pin low unless a serialization is in progress. System board connections utilizing this serialization capability are required to use the same power plane controlling the LED as the ICH10 GPIO pin. Otherwise, the ICH10 GPIO may float low during the message and prevent the LED from being controlled from the SIO. The hardware will only be serializing messages when the core power well is powered and the processor is operational. Care should be taken to prevent the ICH10 from driving an active ‘1’ on a pin sharing the serial LED capability. Since the SIO could be driving the line to 0, having the ICH drive a 1 would create a high current path. A recommendation to avoid this condition involves choosing a GPIO defaulting to an input. The GP_SER_BLINK register (Section 13.10.7) should be set first before changing the direction of the pin to an output. This sequence ensures the open-drain capability of the buffer is properly configured before enabling the pin as an output. 5.15.5.2 Serial Message Format In order to serialize the data onto the GPIO, an initial state of high-Z is assumed. The SIO is required to have its LED control pin in a high-Z state as well to allow ICH10 to blink the LED (refer to the reference diagram). The three components of the serial message include the sync, data, and idle fields. The sync field is 7 bits of ‘1’ data followed by 1 bit of ‘0’ data. Starting from the high-Z state (LED on) provides external hardware a known initial condition and a known pattern. In case one or more of the leading 1 sync bits are lost, the 1s followed by 0 provide a clear indication of ‘end of sync’. This pattern will be used to ‘lock’ external sampling logic to the encoded clock. The data field is shifted out with the highest byte first (MSB). Within each byte, the most significant bit is shifted first (MSb). The idle field is enforced by the hardware and is at least 2 bit times long. The hardware will not clear the Busy and Go bits until this idle time is met. Supporting the idle time in hardware prevents time-based counting in BIOS as the hardware is immediately ready for the next serial code when the Go bit is cleared. Note that the idle state is represented as a high-Z condition on the pin. If the last transmitted bit is a 1, returning to the idle state will result in a final 0-1 transition on the output Manchester data. Two full bit times of idle correspond to a count of 4 time intervals (the width of the time interval is controlled by the DRS field). Datasheet 175 Functional Description The following waveform shows a 1-byte serial write with a data byte of 5Ah. The internal clock and bit position are for reference purposes only. The Manchester D is the resultant data generated and serialized onto the GPIO. Since the buffer is operating in open-drain mode the transitions are from high-Z to 0 and back. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Internal Clock Manchester D 8-bit sync field (1111_1110) 5.15.6 5A data byte 2 clk idle Intel Management Engine GPIOs The following GPIOs can be used as Controller Link GPIOs: GPIO9/WOL_EN, GPIO10/ CPU_MISSING/JTAGTMS (Corporate Only), GPIO24/MEM_LED, and GPIO57/TPM_PP/ JTAGTCK (Corporate Only). Controller Link GPIOs are only available on Intel AMT or ASF enabled platforms with supporting Intel Management Engine firmware. Controller Link GPIOs are owned by the Intel Management Engine and are configured by Intel Management Engine firmware. When configured a a Controller Link GPIO the GPIO_USE_SEL bit is ignored. If the Controller Link GPIO is utilized in a platform, its associated GPIO functionality is no longer available to the host. If the Controller Link GPIO is not utilized in a platform, the signal can instead be used as its associated General Purpose I/O. 5.16 SATA Host Controller (D31:F2, F5) The SATA function in the ICH10 has three modes of operation to support different operating system conditions. In the case of Native IDE enabled operating systems, the ICH10 utilizes two controllers to enable all six ports of the bus. The first controller (Device 31: Function 2) supports ports 0–3 and the second controller (Device 31: Function 5) supports ports 4 and 5. When using a legacy operating system, only one controller (Device 31: Function 2) is available that supports ports 0 - 3. In AHCI or RAID mode, only one controller (Device 31: Function 2) is used enabling all six ports. The MAP register, Section 15.1.29, provides the ability to share PCI functions. When sharing is enabled, all decode of I/O is done through the SATA registers. Device 31, Function 1 (IDE controller) is hidden by software writing to the Function Disable Register (D31, F0, offset F2h, bit 1), and its configuration registers are not used. The ICH10 SATA controllers feature six sets of interface signals (ports) that can be independently enabled or disabled (they cannot be tri-stated or driven low). Each interface is supported by an independent DMA controller. The ICH10 SATA controllers interact with an attached mass storage device through a register interface that is equivalent to that presented by a traditional IDE host adapter. The host software follows existing standards and conventions when accessing the register interface and follows standard command protocol conventions. Note: 176 SATA interface transfer rates are independent of UDMA mode settings. SATA interface transfer rates will operate at the bus’s maximum speed, regardless of the UDMA mode reported by the SATA device or the system BIOS. Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.1 SATA Feature Support ICH10 (AHCI/RAID Disabled) ICH10 (AHCI/RAID Enabled) Native Command Queuing (NCQ) N/A Supported Auto Activate for DMA N/A Supported Hot Plug Support N/A Supported Asynchronous Signal Recovery N/A Supported 3 Gb/s Transfer Rate Supported Supported ATAPI Asynchronous Notification N/A Supported Host & Link Initiated Power Management N/A Supported Supported Supported Command Completion Coalescing N/A N/A External SATA N/A Supported Feature Staggered Spin-Up Feature Datasheet Description Native Command Queuing (NCQ) Allows the device to reorder commands for more efficient data transfers Auto Activate for DMA Collapses a DMA Setup then DMA Activate sequence into a DMA Setup only Hot Plug Support Allows for device detection without power being applied and ability to connect and disconnect devices without prior notification to the system Asynchronous Signal Recovery Provides a recovery from a loss of signal or establishing communication after hot plug 3 Gb/s Transfer Rate Capable of data transfers up to 3Gb/s ATAPI Asynchronous Notification A mechanism for a device to send a notification to the host that the device requires attention Host & Link Initiated Power Management Capability for the host controller or device to request Partial and Slumber interface power states Staggered Spin-Up Enables the host the ability to spin up hard drives sequentially to prevent power load problems on boot Command Completion Coalescing Reduces interrupt and completion overhead by allowing a specified number of commands to complete and then generating an interrupt to process the commands External SATA Technology that allows for an outside the box connection of up to 2 meters (when using the cable defined in SATA-IO) 177 Functional Description 5.16.2 Theory of Operation 5.16.2.1 Standard ATA Emulation The ICH10 contains a set of registers that shadow the contents of the legacy IDE registers. The behavior of the Command and Control Block registers, PIO, and DMA data transfers, resets, and interrupts are all emulated. Note: The ICH10 will assert INTR when the master device completes the EDD command regardless of the command completion status of the slave device. If the master completes EDD first, an INTR is generated and BSY will remain '1' until the slave completes the command. If the slave completes EDD first, BSY will be '0' when the master completes the EDD command and asserts INTR. Software must wait for busy to clear (0) before completing an EDD command, as required by the ATA5 through ATA7 (T13) industry standards. 5.16.2.2 48-Bit LBA Operation The SATA host controller supports 48-bit LBA through the host-to-device register FIS when accesses are performed via writes to the task file. The SATA host controller will ensure that the correct data is put into the correct byte of the host-to-device FIS. There are special considerations when reading from the task file to support 48-bit LBA operation. Software may need to read all 16-bits. Since the registers are only 8-bits wide and act as a FIFO, a bit must be set in the device/control register, which is at offset 3F6h for primary and 376h for secondary (or their native counterparts). If software clears bit 7 of the control register before performing a read, the last item written will be returned from the FIFO. If software sets bit 7 of the control register before performing a read, the first item written will be returned from the FIFO. 5.16.3 SATA Swap Bay Support The ICH10 provides for basic SATA swap bay support using the PSC register configuration bits and power management flows. A device can be powered down by software and the port can then be disabled, allowing removal and insertion of a new device. Note: This SATA swap bay operation requires board hardware (implementation specific), BIOS, and operating system support. 5.16.4 Hot Plug Operation ICH10 supports Hot Plug Surprise removal and Insertion Notification in the PARTIAL, SLUMBER and Listen Mode states when used with Low Power Device Presence Detection. Software can take advantage of power savings in the low power states while enabling hot plug operation. Refer to chapter 7 of the AHCI specification for details. 5.16.4.1 Low Power Device Presence Detection Low Power Device Presence Detection enables SATA Link Power Management to coexist with hot plug (insertion and removal) without interlock switch or cold presence detect. The detection mechanism allows Hot Plug events to be detectable by hardware across all link power states (Active, PARTIAL, SLUMBER) as well as AHCI Listen Mode. If the Low Power Device Presence Detection circuit is disabled the ICH10 reverts to Hot Plug Surprise Removal Notification (without an interlock switch) mode that is mutually exclusive of the PARTIAL and SLUMBER power management states. 178 Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.5 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) The SATA Host Controller supports the Function Level Reset (FLR) capability. The FLR capability can be used in conjunction with Intel Virtualization Technology. FLR allows an Operating System in a Virtual Machine to have complete control over a device, including its initialization, without interfering with the rest of the platform. The device provides a software interface that enables the Operating System to reset the whole device as if a PCI reset was asserted. 5.16.5.1 FLR Steps 5.16.5.1.1 FLR Initialization 1. A FLR is initiated by software writing a ‘1’ to the Initiate FLR bit. 2. All subsequent requests targeting the Function will not be claimed and will be Master Abort Immediate on the bus. This includes any configuration, I/O or Memory cycles, however, the Function shall continue to accept completions targeting the Function. 5.16.5.1.2 FLR Operation The Function will Reset all configuration, I/O and memory registers of the Function except those indicated otherwise and reset all internal states of the Function to the default or initial condition. 5.16.5.1.3 FLR Completion The Initiate FLR bit is reset (cleared) when the FLR reset is completed. This bit can be used to indicate to the software that the FLR reset is completed. Note: Datasheet From the time Initiate FLR bit is written to '1' software must wait at least 100 ms before accessing the function. 179 Functional Description 5.16.6 Intel® Matrix Storage Technology Configuration The Intel® Matrix Storage Technology offers several diverse options for RAID (redundant array of independent disks) to meet the needs of the end user. AHCI support provides higher performance and alleviates disk bottlenecks by taking advantage of the independent DMA engines that each SATA port offers in ICH10. • RAID Level 0 performance scaling up to 4 drives, enabling higher throughput for data intensive applications such as video editing. • Data security is offered through RAID Level 1, which performs mirroring. • RAID Level 10 provides high levels of storage performance with data protection, combining the fault-tolerance of RAID Level 1 with the performance of RAID Level 0. By striping RAID Level 1 segments, high I/O rates can be achieved on systems that require both performance and fault-tolerance. RAID Level 10 requires 4 hard drives, and provides the capacity of two drives. • RAID Level 5 provides highly efficient storage while maintaining fault-tolerance on 3 or more drives. By striping parity, and rotating it across all disks, fault tolerance of any single drive is achieved while only consuming 1 drive worth of capacity. That is, a 3 drive RAID 5 has the capacity of 2 drives, or a 4 drive RAID 5 has the capacity of 3 drives. RAID 5 has high read transaction rates, with a medium write rate. RAID 5 is well suited for applications that require high amounts of storage while maintaining fault tolerance. By using the ICH10’s built-in Intel Matrix Storage Technology, there is no loss of PCI resources (request/grant pair) or add-in card slot. Intel Matrix Storage Technology functionality requires the following items: 1. ICH10 component enabled for Intel Matrix Storage Technology (see Section 1.3) 2. Intel Matrix Storage Manager RAID Option ROM must be on the platform 3. Intel Matrix Storage Manager drivers, most recent revision. 4. At least two SATA hard disk drives (minimum depends on RAID configuration). Intel Matrix Storage Technology is not available in the following configurations: 1. The SATA controller is in compatible mode. 5.16.6.1 Intel® Matrix Storage Manager RAID Option ROM The Intel Matrix Storage Manager RAID Option ROM is a standard PnP Option ROM that is easily integrated into any System BIOS. When in place, it provides the following three primary functions: • Provides a text mode user interface that allows the user to manage the RAID configuration on the system in a pre-operating system environment. Its feature set is kept simple to keep size to a minimum, but allows the user to create & delete RAID volumes and select recovery options when problems occur. • Provides boot support when using a RAID volume as a boot disk. It does this by providing Int13 services when a RAID volume needs to be accessed by DOS applications (such as NTLDR) and by exporting the RAID volumes to the System BIOS for selection in the boot order. • At each boot up, provides the user with a status of the RAID volumes and the option to enter the user interface by pressing CTRL-I. 180 Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.7 Power Management Operation Power management of the ICH10 SATA controller and ports will cover operations of the host controller and the SATA wire. 5.16.7.1 Power State Mappings The D0 PCI power management state for device is supported by the ICH10 SATA controller. SATA devices may also have multiple power states. From parallel ATA, three device states are supported through ACPI. They are: • D0 – Device is working and instantly available. • D1 – device enters when it receives a STANDBY IMMEDIATE command. Exit latency from this state is in seconds • D3 – from the SATA device’s perspective, no different than a D1 state, in that it is entered via the STANDBY IMMEDIATE command. However, an ACPI method is also called which will reset the device and then cut its power. Each of these device states are subsets of the host controller’s D0 state. Finally, SATA defines three PHY layer power states, which have no equivalent mappings to parallel ATA. They are: • PHY READY – PHY logic and PLL are both on and active • Partial – PHY logic is powered, but in a reduced state. Exit latency is no longer than 10 ns • Slumber – PHY logic is powered, but in a reduced state. Exit latency can be up to 10 ms. Since these states have much lower exit latency than the ACPI D1 and D3 states, the SATA controller defines these states as sub-states of the device D0 state. Figure 5-10. SATA Power States Power Intel® ICH SATA Controller = D0 Device = D0 PHY = Ready PHY = Partial PHY = Slumber Device = D1 PHY = Off (port disabled) PHY = Slumber PHY = Off (port disabled) Device = D3 PHY = Slumber PHY = Off (port disabled) Resume Latency Datasheet 181 Functional Description 5.16.7.2 Power State Transitions 5.16.7.2.1 Partial and Slumber State Entry/Exit The partial and slumber states save interface power when the interface is idle. The SATA controller defines PHY layer power management (as performed via primitives) as a driver operation from the host side, and a device proprietary mechanism on the device side. The SATA controller accepts device transition types, but does not issue any transitions as a host. All received requests from a SATA device will be ACKed. When an operation is performed to the SATA controller such that it needs to use the SATA cable, the controller must check whether the link is in the Partial or Slumber states, and if so, must issue a COM_WAKE to bring the link back online. Similarly, the SATA device must perform the same action. 5.16.7.2.2 Device D1, D3 States These states are entered after some period of time when software has determined that no commands will be sent to this device for some time. The mechanism for putting a device in these states does not involve any work on the host controller, other then sending commands over the interface to the device. The command most likely to be used in ATA/ATAPI is the “STANDBY IMMEDIATE” command. 5.16.7.2.3 Host Controller D3HOT State After the interface and device have been put into a low power state, the SATA host controller may be put into a low power state. This is performed via the PCI power management registers in configuration space. There are two very important aspects to note when using PCI power management. 1. When the power state is D3, only accesses to configuration space are allowed. Any attempt to access the memory or I/O spaces will result in master abort. 2. When the power state is D3, no interrupts may be generated, even if they are enabled. If an interrupt status bit is pending when the controller transitions to D0, an interrupt may be generated. When the controller is put into D3, it is assumed that software has properly shut down the device and disabled the ports. Therefore, there is no need to sustain any values on the port wires. The interface will be treated as if no device is present on the cable, and power will be minimized. When returning from a D3 state, an internal reset will not be performed. 5.16.7.2.4 Non-AHCI Mode PME# Generation When in non-AHCI mode (legacy mode) of operation, the SATA controller does not generate PME#. This includes attach events (since the port must be disabled), or interlock switch events (via the SATAGP pins). 5.16.7.3 SMI Trapping (APM) Device 31:Function2:Offset C0h (see Section 14.1.37) contain control for generating SMI# on accesses to the IDE I/O spaces. These bits map to the legacy ranges (1F0– 1F7h, 3F6h, 170–177h, and 376h) and native IDE ranges defined by PCMDBA, PCTLBA, SCMDBA an SCTLBA. If the SATA controller is in legacy mode and is using these addresses, accesses to one of these ranges with the appropriate bit set causes the cycle to not be forwarded to the SATA controller, and for an SMI# to be generated. If an access to the Bus-Master IDE registers occurs while trapping is enabled for the device being accessed, then the register is updated, an SMI# is generated, and the device activity status bits (Section 14.1.38) are updated indicating that a trap occurred. 182 Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.8 SATA Device Presence In legacy mode, the SATA controller does not generate interrupts based on hot plug/ unplug events. However, the SATA PHY does know when a device is connected (if not in a partial or slumber state), and it s beneficial to communicate this information to host software as this will greatly reduce boot times and resume times. The flow used to indicate SATA device presence is shown in Figure 5-11. The ‘PxE’ bit refers to PCS.P[3:0]E bits, depending on the port being checked and the ‘PxP’ bits refer to the PCS.P[3:0]P bits, depending on the port being checked. If the PCS/PxP bit is set a device is present, if the bit is cleared a device is not present. If a port is disabled, software can check to see if a new device is connected by periodically reenabling the port and observing if a device is present, if a device is not present it can disable the port and check again later. If a port remains enabled, software can periodically poll PCS.PxP to see if a new device is connected. Figure 5-11. Flow for Port Enable / Device Present Bits Datasheet 183 Functional Description 5.16.9 SATA LED The SATALED# output is driven whenever the BSY bit is set in any SATA port. The SATALED# is an active-low open-drain output. When SATALED# is low, the LED should be active. When SATALED# is high, the LED should be inactive. 5.16.10 AHCI Operation The ICH10 provides hardware support for Advanced Host Controller Interface (AHCI), a programming interface for SATA host controllers developed through a joint industry effort. AHCI defines transactions between the SATA controller and software and enables advanced performance and usability with SATA. Platforms supporting AHCI may take advantage of performance features such as no master/slave designation for SATA devices—each device is treated as a master—and hardware assisted native command queuing. AHCI also provides usability enhancements such as Hot-Plug. AHCI requires appropriate software support (e.g., an AHCI driver) and for some features, hardware support in the SATA device or additional platform hardware. The ICH10 supports all of the mandatory features of the Serial ATA Advanced Host Controller Interface Specification, Revision 1.2 and many optional features, such as hardware assisted native command queuing, aggressive power management, LED indicator support, and Hot-Plug through the use of interlock switch support (additional platform hardware and software may be required depending upon the implementation). Note: For reliable device removal notification while in AHCI operation without the use of interlock switches (surprise removal), interface power management should be disabled for the associated port. See Section 7.3.1 of the AHCI Specification for more information. 5.16.11 Serial ATA Reference Clock Low Power Request (SATACLKREQ#) The 100 MHz Serial ATA Reference Clock (SATACLKP, SATACLKN) is implemented on the system as a ground-terminated low-voltage differential signal pair driven by the system Clock Chip. When all the SATA links are in Slumber or disabled, the SATA Reference Clock is not needed and may be stopped and tri-stated at the clock chip allowing system-level power reductions. The ICH10 uses the SATACLKREQ# output signal to communicate with the system Clock Chip to request either SATA clock running or to tell the system clock chip that it can stop the SATA Reference Clock. ICH10 drives this signal low to request clock running, and tristates the signal to indicate that the SATA Reference Clock may be stopped (the ICH10 never drives the pin high). When the SATACLKREQ# is tristated by the ICH10, the clock chip may stop the SATA Reference Clock within 100 ns, anytime after 100 ns, or not at all. If the SATA Reference Clock is not already running, it will start within 100 ns after a SATACLKREQ# is driven low by the ICH10. To enable SATA Reference Clock Low Power Request: 1. Configure GPIO35 to native function 2. Set SATA Clock Request Enable (SCRE) bit to ‘1’ (Dev 31:F2:Offset 94h:bit 28). Note: 184 The reset default for SATACLKREQ# is low to insure that the SATA Reference Clock is running after system reset. Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.12 SGPIO Signals The SGPIO signals, in accordance to the SFF-8485 specification, support per-port LED signaling. These signals are not related to SATALED#, which allows for simplified indication of SATA command activity. The SGPIO group interfaces with an external controller chip that fetches and serializes the data for driving across the SGPIO bus. The output signals then control the LEDs. This feature is only valid in AHCI/RAID mode. 5.16.12.1 Mechanism The enclosure management for SATA Controller 1 (Device 31: Function 2) involves sending messages that control LEDs in the enclosure. The messages for this function are stored after the normal registers in the AHCI BAR, at Offset 400h bytes for ICH10 from the beginning of the AHCI BAR as specified by the EM_LOC global register (Section 14.4.1.8). Software creates messages for transmission in the enclosure management message buffer. The data in the message buffer should not be changed if CTL.TM bit is set by software to transmit an update message. Software should only update the message buffer when CTL.TM bit is cleared by hardware otherwise the message transmitted will be indeterminate. Software then writes a register to cause hardware to transmit the message or take appropriate action based on the message content. The software should only create message types supported by the controller, which is LED messages for ICH10. If the software creates other non LED message types (e.g. SAF-TE, SES-2), the SGPIO interface may hang and the result is indeterminate. During reset all SGPIO pins will be in tri-state state. The interface will continue to be in tri-state state after reset until the first transmission occurs when software programs the message buffer and sets the transmit bit CTL.TM. The SATA Host controller will initiate the transmission by driving SCLOCK and at the same time drive the SLOAD to ‘0’ prior to the actual bit stream transmission. The Host will drive SLOAD low for at least 5 SCLOCK then only start the bit stream by driving the SLOAD to high. SLOAD will be driven high for 1 SCLOCK follow by vendor specific pattern that is default to “0000” if software has yet to program the value. A total of 18-bit stream from 6 ports (Port0, Port1, Port2, Port3, Port4 and Port5) of 3-bit per port LED message will be transmitted on SDATAOUT0 pin after the SLOAD is driven high for 1 SCLOCK. Only 2 ports (port4 and port5) of 6 bit total LED message follow by 12 bits of tri-state value will be transmitted out on SDATAOUT1 pin. All the default LED message values will be high prior to software setting them, except the Activity LED message that is configured to be hardware driven that will be generated based on the activity from the respective port. All the LED message values will be driven to ‘1’ for the port that is unimplemented as indicated in the Port Implemented register regardless of the software programmed value through the message buffer. There are 2 different ways of resetting ICH SGPIO interface, asynchronous reset and synchronous reset. Asynchronous reset is caused by platform reset to cause the SGPIO interface to be tri-state asynchronously. Synchronous reset is caused by setting the CTL.RESET bit, clearing the GHC.AE bit or HBA reset, where Host Controller will complete the existing full bit stream transmission then only tri-state all the SGPIO pins. After the reset, both synchronous and asynchronous, the SGPIO pins will stay tristated. Note: Datasheet ICH Host Controller does not ensure to cause the target SGPIO device or controller to be reset. Software is responsible to keep ICH SGPIO interface in tri-state stated for 2 second in order to cause a reset on the target of the SGPIO interface. 185 Functional Description 5.16.12.2 Message Format Messages shall be constructed with a one Dword header that describes the message to be sent followed by the actual message contents. The first Dword shall be constructed as follows: Bit 31:28 Description Reserved Message Type (MTYPE): Specifies the type of the message. The message types are: 0h = LED 27:24 1h = SAF-TE 2h = SES-2 3h = SGPIO (register based interface) All other values reserved 23:16 Data Size (DSIZE): Specifies the data size in bytes. If the message (enclosure services command) has a data buffer that is associated with it that is transferred, the size of that data buffer is specified in this field. If there is no separate data buffer, this field shall have a value of ‘0’. The data directly follows the message in the message buffer. For ICH10, this value should always be ‘0’. 15:8 Message Size (MSIZE): Specifies the size of the message in bytes. The message size does not include the one Dword header. A value of ‘0’ is invalid. For ICH10, the message size is always 4 bytes. 7:0 Reserved The SAF-TE, SES-2, and SGPIO message formats are defined in the corresponding specifications, respectively. The LED message type is defined in Section 5.16.12.3. It is the responsibility of software to ensure the content of the message format is correct. If the message type is not programmed as 'LED' for this controller, the controller shall not take any action to update its LEDs. Note that for LED message type, the message size is always consisted of 4 bytes. 5.16.12.3 LED Message Type The LED message type specifies the status of up to three LEDs. Typically, the usage for these LEDs is activity, fault, and locate. Not all implementations necessarily contain all LEDs (for example, some implementations may not have a locate LED). The message identifies the HBA port number that the slot status applies to. The format of the LED message type is defined in Table 5-42. The LEDs shall retain their values until there is a following update for that particular slot. 186 Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-42. Multi-activity LED message type Byte Description Value (VAL): This field describes the state of each LED for a particular location. There are three LEDs that may be supported by the HBA. Each LED has 3 bits of control. LED values are: 000b - LED shall be off 001b - LED shall be solid on as perceived by human eye All other values reserved The LED bit locations are: Bits 2:0 - Activity LED (may be driven by hardware) Bits 5:3 - Vendor Specific LED (e.g. locate) 3-2 Bits 8:6 - Vendor Specific LED (e.g. fault) Bits 15:9 - Reserved Vendor specific message is: Bit 3:0 - Vendor Specific Pattern Bit 15:4 - Reserved Note: If Activity LED Hardware Driven (ATTR.ALHD) bit is set, host will output the hardware LED value sampled internally and will ignore software written activity value on bit [2:0]. Since ICH10 Enclosure Management does not support port multiplier based LED message, the LED message will be generated independently based on respective port’s operation activity. Vendor specific LED values Locate (Bits 5:3) and Fault (Bits 8:6) always are driven by software. Port Multiplier Information: Specifies slot specific information related to Port Multiplier. 1 Bits 3:0 specify the Port Multiplier port number for the slot that requires the status update. If a Port Multiplier is not attached to the device in the affected slot, the Port Multiplier port number shall be '0'. Bits 7:4 are reserved. ICH10 does not support LED messages for devices behind a Port Multiplier. This byte should be 0. HBA Information: Specifies slot specific information related to the HBA. Bits 4:0 - HBA port number for the slot that requires the status update. 0 Bit 5 - If set to '1', Value is a vendor specific message that applies to the entire enclosure. If cleared to '0', Value applies to the port specified in bits 4:0. Bits 7:6 - Reserved Datasheet 187 Functional Description 5.16.12.4 SGPIO Waveform Figure 5-12. Serial Data transmitted over the SGPIO Interface 188 Datasheet Functional Description 5.16.13 External SATA ICH10 supports external SATA. External SATA utilizes the SATA interface outside of the system box. The usage model for this feature must comply with the Serial ATA II Cables and Connectors Volume 2 Gold specification at www.sata-io.org. Intel validates two configurations: 1. The cable-up solution involves an internal SATA cable that connects to the SATA motherboard connector and spans to a back panel PCI bracket with an e-SATA connector. A separate e-SATA cable is required to connect an e-SATA device. 2. The back-panel solution involves running a trace to the I/O back panel and connecting a device via an external SATA connector on the board. 5.17 High Precision Event Timers This function provides a set of timers that can be used by the operating system. The timers are defined such that in the future, the operating system may be able to assign specific timers to used directly by specific applications. Each timer can be configured to cause a separate interrupt. ICH10 provides eight (Corporate Family) or four (Consumer Family) timers. The timers are implemented as a single counter each with its own comparator and value register. This counter increases monotonically. Each individual timer can generate an interrupt when the value in its value register matches the value in the main counter. The registers associated with these timers are mapped to a memory space (much like the I/O APIC). However, it is not implemented as a standard PCI function. The BIOS reports to the operating system the location of the register space. The hardware can support an assignable decode space; however, the BIOS sets this space prior to handing it over to the operating system (See Section 9.4). It is not expected that the operating system will move the location of these timers once it is set by the BIOS. 5.17.1 Timer Accuracy 1. The timers are accurate over any 1 ms period to within 0.05% of the time specified in the timer resolution fields. 2. Within any 100 microsecond period, the timer reports a time that is up to two ticks too early or too late. Each tick is less than or equal to 100 ns, so this represents an error of less than 0.2%. 3. The timer is monotonic. It does not return the same value on two consecutive reads (unless the counter has rolled over and reached the same value). The main counter is clocked by the 14.31818 MHz clock, synchronized into the 66.666 MHz domain. This results in a non-uniform duty cycle on the synchronized clock, but does have the correct average period. The accuracy of the main counter is as accurate as the 14.31818 MHz clock. Datasheet 189 Functional Description 5.17.2 Interrupt Mapping Mapping Option #1 (Legacy Replacement Option) In this case, the Legacy Replacement Rout bit (LEG_RT_CNF) is set. This forces the mapping found in Table 5-43. Table 5-43. Legacy Replacement Routing Timer 8259 Mapping APIC Mapping Comment 0 IRQ0 IRQ2 In this case, the 8254 timer will not cause any interrupts 1 IRQ8 IRQ8 In this case, the RTC will not cause any interrupts. 2&3 Per IRQ Routing Field. Per IRQ Routing Field 4, 5, 6, 7 (Corporate Only) not available not available NOTE: (Corporate Only) The Legacy Option does not preclude delivery of IRQ0/IRQ8 via direct FSB interrupt messages. Mapping Option #2 (Standard Option) In this case, the Legacy Replacement Rout bit (LEG_RT_CNF) is 0. Each timer has its own routing control. The interrupts can be routed to various interrupts in the 8259 or I/O APIC. A capabilities field indicates which interrupts are valid options for routing. If a timer is set for edge-triggered mode, the timers should not be share with any PCI interrupts. For the Intel ICH10, the only supported interrupt values are as follows: Timer 0 and 1: IRQ20, 21, 22 & 23 (I/O APIC only). Timer 2: IRQ11 (8259 or I/O APIC) and IRQ20, 21, 22, and 23 (I/O APIC only). Timer 3: IRQ12 (8259 or I/O APIC) and IRQ 20, 21, 22, and 23 (I/O APIC only). Interrupts from Timer 4, 5, 6, 7 (Corporate Only) can only be delivered via direct FSB interrupt messages. 5.17.3 Periodic vs. Non-Periodic Modes Non-Periodic Mode Timer 0 is configurable to 32 (default) or 64-bit mode, whereas Timers 1, 2 and 3 only support 32-bit mode (See Section 21.1.5). All of the timers support non-periodic mode. Consult Section 2.3.9.2.1 of the IA-PC HPET Specification for a description of this mode. Periodic Mode Timer 0 is the only timer that supports periodic mode. Consult Section 2.3.9.2.2 of the IA-PC HPET Specification for a description of this mode. 190 Datasheet Functional Description The following usage model is expected: 1. Software clears the ENABLE_CNF bit to prevent any interrupts 2. Software Clears the main counter by writing a value of 00h to it. 3. Software sets the TIMER0_VAL_SET_CNF bit. 4. Software writes the new value in the TIMER0_COMPARATOR_VAL register 5. Software sets the ENABLE_CNF bit to enable interrupts. The Timer 0 Comparator Value register cannot be programmed reliably by a single 64-bit write in a 32-bit environment except if only the periodic rate is being changed during run-time. If the actual Timer 0 Comparator Value needs to be reinitialized, then the following software solution will always work regardless of the environment: 1. Set TIMER0_VAL_SET_CNF bit 2. Set the lower 32 bits of the Timer0 Comparator Value register 3. Set TIMER0_VAL_SET_CNF bit 4. Set the upper 32 bits of the Timer0 Comparator Value register 5.17.4 Enabling the Timers The BIOS or operating system PnP code should route the interrupts. This includes the Legacy Rout bit, Interrupt Rout bit (for each timer), interrupt type (to select the edge or level type for each timer) The Device Driver code should do the following for an available timer: 1. Set the Overall Enable bit (Offset 10h, bit 0). 2. Set the timer type field (selects one-shot or periodic). 3. Set the interrupt enable 4. Set the comparator value 5.17.5 Interrupt Levels Interrupts directed to the internal 8259s are active high. See Section 5.9 for information regarding the polarity programming of the I/O APIC for detecting internal interrupts. If the interrupts are mapped to the 8259 or I/O APIC and set for level-triggered mode, they can be shared with PCI interrupts. They may be shared although it’s unlikely for the operating system to attempt to do this. If more than one timer is configured to share the same IRQ (using the TIMERn_INT_ROUT_CNF fields), then the software must configure the timers to leveltriggered mode. Edge-triggered interrupts cannot be shared. Datasheet 191 Functional Description 5.17.6 Handling Interrupts If each timer has a unique interrupt and the timer has been configured for edgetriggered mode, then there are no specific steps required. No read is required to process the interrupt. If a timer has been configured to level-triggered mode, then its interrupt must be cleared by the software. This is done by reading the interrupt status register and writing a 1 back to the bit position for the interrupt to be cleared. Independent of the mode, software can read the value in the main counter to see how time has passed between when the interrupt was generated and when it was first serviced. If Timer 0 is set up to generate a periodic interrupt, the software can check to see how much time remains until the next interrupt by checking the timer value register. 5.17.7 Issues Related to 64-Bit Timers with 32-Bit Processors A 32-bit timer can be read directly using processors that are capable of 32-bit or 64-bit instructions. However, a 32-bit processor may not be able to directly read 64-bit timer. A race condition comes up if a 32-bit processor reads the 64-bit register using two separate 32-bit reads. The danger is that just after reading one half, the other half rolls over and changes the first half. If a 32-bit processor needs to access a 64-bit timer, it must first halt the timer before reading both the upper and lower 32-bits of the timer. If a 32-bit processor does not want to halt the timer, it can use the 64-bit timer as a 32-bit timer by setting the TIMERn_32MODE_CNF bit. This causes the timer to behave as a 32-bit timer. The upper 32-bits are always 0. Alternatively, software may do a multiple read of the counter while it is running. Software can read the high 32 bits, then the low 32 bits, the high 32 bits again. If the high 32 bits have not changed between the two reads, then a rollover has not happened and the low 32 bits are valid. If the high 32 bits have changed between reads, then the multiple reads are repeated until a valid read is performed. Note: On a 64-bit platform, if software attempts a 64 bit read of the 64-bit counter, software must be aware that some platforms may split the 64 bit read into two 32 bit reads. The read maybe inaccurate if the low 32 bits roll over between the high and low reads. 5.18 USB UHCI Host Controllers (D29:F0, F1, F2, F3 and D26:F0, F1 and F2) The ICH10 contains six USB full/low-speed host controllers that support the standard Universal Host Controller Interface (UHCI), Revision 1.1. Each UHCI Host Controller (UHC) includes a root hub with two separate USB ports each, for a total of twelve USB ports. • Overcurrent detection on all twelve USB ports is supported. The overcurrent inputs are not 5 V tolerant, and can be used as GPIs if not needed. • The ICH10’s UHCI host controllers are arbitrated differently than standard PCI devices to improve arbitration latency. • The UHCI controllers use the Analog Front End (AFE) embedded cell that allows support for USB full-speed signaling rates, instead of USB I/O buffers. Note: 192 D26:F2 can be configured as D29:F3 during BIOS Post. Datasheet Functional Description 5.18.1 Data Structures in Main Memory Section 3.1 - 3.3 of the Universal Host Controller Interface Specification, Revision 1.1 details the data structures used to communicate control, status, and data between software and the ICH10. 5.18.2 Data Transfers to/from Main Memory Section 3.4 of the Universal Host Controller Interface Specification, Revision 1.1 describes the details on how HCD and the ICH10 communicate via the Schedule data structures. 5.18.3 Data Encoding and Bit Stuffing The ICH10 USB employs NRZI data encoding (Non-Return to Zero Inverted) when transmitting packets. Full details on this implementation are given in the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0. 5.18.4 Bus Protocol 5.18.4.1 Bit Ordering Bits are sent out onto the bus least significant bit (LSb) first, followed by next LSb, through to the most significant bit (MSb) last. 5.18.4.2 SYNC Field All packets begin with a synchronization (SYNC) field, which is a coded sequence that generates a maximum edge transition density. The SYNC field appears on the bus as IDLE followed by the binary string “KJKJKJKK,” in its NRZI encoding. It is used by the input circuitry to align incoming data with the local clock and is defined to be 8 bits in length. SYNC serves only as a synchronization mechanism. The last two bits in the SYNC field are a marker that is used to identify the first bit of the PID. All subsequent bits in the packet must be indexed from this point. 5.18.4.3 Packet Field Formats All packets have distinct start and end of packet delimiters. Full details are given in the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0, in Section 8.3.1. 5.18.4.4 Address Fields Function endpoints are addressed using the function address field and the endpoint field. Full details on this are given in the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0, in Section 8.3.2. 5.18.4.5 Frame Number Field The frame number field is an 11-bit field that is incremented by the host on a per frame basis. The frame number field rolls over upon reaching its maximum value of 7FFh, and is sent only for SOF tokens at the start of each frame. 5.18.4.6 Data Field The data field may range from 0 to 1023 bytes and must be an integral numbers of bytes. Data bits within each byte are shifted out LSB first. Datasheet 193 Functional Description 5.18.4.7 Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) CRC is used to protect the all non-PID fields in token and data packets. In this context, these fields are considered to be protected fields. Full details on this are given in the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0, in Section 8.3.5. 5.18.5 Packet Formats The USB protocol calls out several packet types: token, data, and handshake packets. Full details on this are given in the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0, in Section 8.4. 5.18.6 USB Interrupts There are two general groups of USB interrupt sources, those resulting from execution of transactions in the schedule, and those resulting from an ICH10 operation error. All transaction-based sources can be masked by software through the ICH10’s Interrupt Enable register. Additionally, individual transfer descriptors can be marked to generate an interrupt on completion. When the ICH10 drives an interrupt for USB, it internally drives the PIRQA# pin for USB function #0 and USB function #3, PIRQD# pin for USB function #1, and the PIRQC# pin for USB function #2, until all sources of the interrupt are cleared. In order to accommodate some operating systems, the Interrupt Pin register must contain a different value for each function of this new multi-function device. 5.18.6.1 Transaction-Based Interrupts These interrupts are not signaled until after the status for the last complete transaction in the frame has been written back to host memory. This ensures that software can safely process through (Frame List Current Index -1) when it is servicing an interrupt. CRC Error / Time-Out A CRC/Time-Out error occurs when a packet transmitted from the ICH10 to a USB device or a packet transmitted from a USB device to the ICH10 generates a CRC error. The ICH10 is informed of this event by a time-out from the USB device or by the ICH10’s CRC checker generating an error on reception of the packet. Additionally, a USB bus time-out occurs when USB devices do not respond to a transaction phase within 19-bit times of an EOP. Either of these conditions causes the C_ERR field of the TD to decrement. When the C_ERR field decrements to 0, the following occurs: • The Active bit in the TD is cleared • The Stalled bit in the TD is set • The CRC/Time-out bit in the TD is set. • At the end of the frame, the USB Error Interrupt bit is set in the HC status register. If the CRC/Time out interrupt is enabled in the Interrupt Enable register, a hardware interrupt will be signaled to the system. 194 Datasheet Functional Description Interrupt on Completion Transfer Descriptors contain a bit that can be set to cause an interrupt on their completion. The completion of the transaction associated with that block causes the USB Interrupt bit in the HC Status Register to be set at the end of the frame in which the transfer completed. When a TD is encountered with the IOC bit set to 1, the IOC bit in the HC Status register is set to 1 at the end of the frame if the active bit in the TD is set to 0 (even if it was set to 0 when initially read). If the IOC Enable bit of Interrupt Enable register (bit 2 of I/O offset 04h) is set, a hardware interrupt is signaled to the system. The USB Interrupt bit in the HC status register is set either when the TD completes successfully or because of errors. If the completion is because of errors, the USB Error bit in the HC status register is also set. Short Packet Detect A transfer set is a collection of data which requires more than one USB transaction to completely move the data across the USB. An example might be a large print file which requires numerous TDs in multiple frames to completely transfer the data. Reception of a data packet that is less than the endpoint’s Max Packet size during Control, Bulk or Interrupt transfers signals the completion of the transfer set, even if there are active TDs remaining for this transfer set. Setting the SPD bit in a TD indicates to the HC to set the USB Interrupt bit in the HC status register at the end of the frame in which this event occurs. This feature streamlines the processing of input on these transfer types. If the Short Packet Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable register is set, a hardware interrupt is signaled to the system at the end of the frame where the event occurred. Serial Bus Babble When a device transmits on the USB for a time greater than its assigned Max Length, it is said to be babbling. Since isochrony can be destroyed by a babbling device, this error results in the Active bit in the TD being cleared to 0 and the Stalled and Babble bits being set to 1. The C_ERR field is not decremented for a babble. The USB Error Interrupt bit in the HC Status register is set to 1 at the end of the frame. A hardware interrupt is signaled to the system. If an EOF babble was caused by the ICH10 (due to incorrect schedule for instance), the ICH10 forces a bit stuff error followed by an EOP and the start of the next frame. Stalled This event indicates that a device/endpoint returned a STALL handshake during a transaction or that the transaction ended in an error condition. The TDs Stalled bit is set and the Active bit is cleared. Reception of a STALL does not decrement the error counter. A hardware interrupt is signaled to the system. Data Buffer Error This event indicates that an overrun of incoming data or a under-run of outgoing data has occurred for this transaction. This would generally be caused by the ICH10 not being able to access required data buffers in memory within necessary latency requirements. Either of these conditions causes the C_ERR field of the TD to be decremented. When C_ERR decrements to 0, the Active bit in the TD is cleared, the Stalled bit is set, the USB Error Interrupt bit in the HC Status register is set to 1 at the end of the frame and a hardware interrupt is signaled to the system. Datasheet 195 Functional Description Bit Stuff Error A bit stuff error results from the detection of a sequence of more that six 1s in a row within the incoming data stream. This causes the C_ERR field of the TD to be decremented. When the C_ERR field decrements to 0, the Active bit in the TD is cleared to 0, the Stalled bit is set to 1, the USB Error Interrupt bit in the HC Status register is set to 1 at the end of the frame and a hardware interrupt is signaled to the system. 5.18.6.2 Non-Transaction Based Interrupts If an ICH10 process error or system error occurs, the ICH10 halts and immediately issues a hardware interrupt to the system. Resume Received This event indicates that the ICH10 received a RESUME signal from a device on the USB bus during a global suspend. If this interrupt is enabled in the Interrupt Enable register, a hardware interrupt is signaled to the system allowing the USB to be brought out of the suspend state and returned to normal operation. ICH10 Process Error The HC monitors certain critical fields during operation to ensure that it does not process corrupted data structures. These include checking for a valid PID and verifying that the MaxLength field is less than 1280. If it detects a condition that would indicate that it is processing corrupted data structures, it immediately halts processing, sets the HC Process Error bit in the HC Status register and signals a hardware interrupt to the system. This interrupt cannot be disabled through the Interrupt Enable register. Host System Error The ICH10 sets this bit to 1 when a Parity error, Master Abort, or Target Abort occurs. When this error occurs, the ICH10 clears the Run/Stop bit in the Command register to prevent further execution of the scheduled TDs. This interrupt cannot be disabled through the Interrupt Enable register. 196 Datasheet Functional Description 5.18.7 USB Power Management The Host controller can be put into a suspended state and its power can be removed. This requires that certain bits of information are retained in the suspend power plane of the ICH10 so that a device on a port may wake the system. Such a device may be a fax-modem, which will wake up the machine to receive a fax or take a voice message. The settings of the following bits in I/O space will be maintained when the ICH10 enters the S3, S4, or S5 states. Table 5-44. Bits Maintained in Low Power States Register Offset Bit Command 00h 3 Enter Global Suspend Mode (EGSM) Status 02h 2 Resume Detect 2 Port Enabled/Disabled 6 Resume Detect 8 Low-speed Device Attached Port Status and Control 10h & 12h 12 Description Suspend When the ICH10 detects a resume event on any of its ports, it sets the corresponding USB_STS bit in ACPI space. If USB is enabled as a wake/break event, the system wakes up and an SCI generated. 5.18.8 USB Legacy Keyboard Operation When a USB keyboard is plugged into the system, and a standard keyboard is not, the system may not boot, and MS-DOS legacy software will not run, because the keyboard will not be identified. The ICH10 implements a series of trapping operations which will snoop accesses that go to the keyboard controller, and put the expected data from the USB keyboard into the keyboard controller. Note: The scheme described below assumes that the keyboard controller (8042 or equivalent) is on the LPC bus. This legacy operation is performed through SMM space. Figure 5-13 shows the Enable and Status path. The latched SMI source (60R, 60W, 64R, 64W) is available in the Status Register. Because the enable is after the latch, it is possible to check for other events that didn't necessarily cause an SMI. It is the software's responsibility to logically AND the value with the appropriate enable bits. Note also that the SMI is generated before the PCI cycle completes (e.g., before TRDY# goes active) to ensure that the processor doesn't complete the cycle before the SMI is observed. The logic also needs to block the accesses to the 8042. If there is an external 8042, then this is simply accomplished by not activating the 8042 CS. This is done by logically ANDing the four enables (60R, 60W, 64R, 64W) with the 4 types of accesses to determine if 8042CS should go active. An additional term is required for the “passthrough” case. The state table for Figure 5-13 is shown in Table 5-45. Datasheet 197 Functional Description Figure 5-13. USB Legacy Keyboard Flow Diagram To Individual "Caused By" "Bits" 60 READ KBC Accesses S D Comb. Decoder PCI Config Clear SMI_60_R AND R EN_SMI_ON_60R Read, Write SMI OR Same for 60W, 64R, 64W EN_PIRQD# AND To PIRQD# To "Caused By" Bit USB_IRQ S Clear USB_IRQ D R AND EN_SMI_ON_IRQ Table 5-45. USB Legacy Keyboard State Transitions (Sheet 1 of 2) 198 Current State Action Data Value Next State IDLE 64h / Write D1h GateState1 Standard D1 command. Cycle passed through to 8042. SMI# doesn't go active. PSTATE (offset C0, bit 6) goes to 1. IDLE 64h / Write Not D1h IDLE Bit 3 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. IDLE 64h / Read N/A IDLE Bit 2 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. IDLE 60h / Write Don't Care IDLE Bit 1 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. IDLE 60h / Read N/A IDLE Bit 0 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. GateState1 60h / Write GateState2 Cycle passed through to 8042, even if trap enabled in Bit 1 in Config Register. No SMI# generated. PSTATE remains 1. If data value is not DFh or DDh then the 8042 may chose to ignore it. XXh Comment Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-45. USB Legacy Keyboard State Transitions (Sheet 2 of 2) Current State GateState1 64h / Write GateState1 64h / Write Data Value D1h Not D1h Next State Comment GateState1 Cycle passed through to 8042, even if trap enabled via Bit 3 in Config Register. No SMI# generated. PSTATE remains 1. Stay in GateState1 because this is part of the double-trigger sequence. ILDE Bit 3 in Config space determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. PSTATE goes to 0. If Bit 7 in Config Register is set, then SMI# should be generated. GateState1 60h / Read N/A IDLE This is an invalid sequence. Bit 0 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. PSTATE goes to 0. If Bit 7 in Config Register is set, then SMI# should be generated. GateState1 64h / Read N/A GateState1 Just stay in same state. Generate an SMI# if enabled in Bit 2 of Config Register. PSTATE remains 1. IDLE Standard end of sequence. Cycle passed through to 8042. PSTATE goes to 0. Bit 7 in Config Space determines if SMI# should be generated. GateState2 64 / Write FFh GateState2 64h / Write Not FFh IDLE Improper end of sequence. Bit 3 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. PSTATE goes to 0. If Bit 7 in Config Register is set, then SMI# should be generated. GateState2 64h / Read N/A GateState2 Just stay in same state. Generate an SMI# if enabled in Bit 2 of Config Register. PSTATE remains 1. GateState2 60h / Write IDLE Improper end of sequence. Bit 1 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. PSTATE goes to 0. If Bit 7 in Config Register is set, then SMI# should be generated. IDLE Improper end of sequence. Bit 0 in Config Register determines if cycle passed through to 8042 and if SMI# generated. PSTATE goes to 0. If Bit 7 in Config Register is set, then SMI# should be generated. GateState2 Datasheet Action 60h / Read XXh N/A 199 Functional Description 5.18.9 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) The USB UHCI Controllers support the Function Level Reset (FLR) capability. The FLR capability can be used in conjunction with Intel Virtualization Technology. FLR allows an Operating System in a Virtual Machine to have complete control over a device, including its initialization, without interfering with the rest of the platform. The device provides a software interface that enables the Operating System to reset the whole device as if a PCI reset was asserted. 5.18.9.1 FLR Steps 5.18.9.1.1 FLR Initialization 1. A FLR is initiated by software writing a 1 to the Initiate FLR bit. 2. All subsequent requests targeting the Function will not be claimed and will be Master Abort Immediate on the bus. This includes any configuration, I/O or Memory cycles, however, the Function shall continue to accept completions targeting the Function. 5.18.9.1.2 FLR Operation The Function will Reset all configuration, I/O and memory registers of the Function except those indicated otherwise and reset all internal states of the Function to the default or initial condition. 5.18.9.1.3 FLR Completion The Initiate FLR bit is reset (cleared) when the FLR reset is completed. This bit can be used to indicate to the software that the FLR reset is completed. Note: 200 From the time Initiate FLR bit is written to 1, software must wait at least 100 ms before accessing the function. Datasheet Functional Description 5.19 USB EHCI Host Controllers (D29:F7 and D26:F7) The ICH10 contains two Enhanced Host Controller Interface (EHCI) host controllers which support up to twelve USB 2.0 high-speed root ports. USB 2.0 allows data transfers up to 480 Mb/s using the same pins as the twelve USB full-speed/low-speed ports. The ICH10 contains port-routing logic that determines whether a USB port is controlled by one of the UHCI controllers or by one of the EHCI controllers. USB 2.0 based Debug Port is also implemented in the ICH10. A summary of the key architectural differences between the USB UHCI host controllers and the EHCI host controller are shown in Table 5-46. Table 5-46. UHCI vs. EHCI Parameter 5.19.1 USB UHCI USB EHCI Accessible by I/O space Memory Space Memory Data Structure Single linked list Separated into Periodic and Asynchronous lists Differential Signaling Voltage 3.3 V 400 mV Ports per Controller 2 6 or 8 (controller #1) and 6 or 4 (Controller #2) EHC Initialization The following descriptions step through the expected ICH10 Enhanced Host Controller (EHC) initialization sequence in chronological order, beginning with a complete power cycle in which the suspend well and core well have been off. 5.19.1.1 BIOS Initialization BIOS performs a number of platform customization steps after the core well has powered up. Contact your Intel Field Representative for additional ICH10 BIOS information. 5.19.1.2 Driver Initialization See Chapter 4 of the Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0. Datasheet 201 Functional Description 5.19.1.3 EHC Resets In addition to the standard ICH10 hardware resets, portions of the EHC are reset by the HCRESET bit and the transition from the D3HOT device power management state to the D0 state. The effects of each of these resets are: Reset Does Reset HCRESET bit set. Memory space registers except Structural Parameters (which is written by BIOS). Software writes the Device Power State from D3HOT (11b) to D0 (00b). Core well registers (except BIOSprogrammed registers). Does not Reset Comments Configuration registers. The HCRESET must only affect registers that the EHCI driver controls. PCI Configuration space and BIOS-programmed parameters can not be reset. Suspend well registers; BIOSprogrammed core well registers. The D3-to-D0 transition must not cause wake information (suspend well) to be lost. It also must not clear BIOSprogrammed registers because BIOS may not be invoked following the D3-to-D0 transition. If the detailed register descriptions give exceptions to these rules, those exceptions override these rules. This summary is provided to help explain the reasons for the reset policies. 5.19.2 Data Structures in Main Memory See Section 3 and Appendix B of the Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 for details. 5.19.3 USB 2.0 Enhanced Host Controller DMA The ICH10 USB 2.0 EHC implements three sources of USB packets. They are, in order of priority on USB during each microframe: 1. The USB 2.0 Debug Port (see Section USB 2.0 Based Debug Port), 2. The Periodic DMA engine, and 3. The Asynchronous DMA engine. The ICH10 always performs any currently-pending debug port transaction at the beginning of a microframe, followed by any pending periodic traffic for the current microframe. If there is time left in the microframe, then the EHC performs any pending asynchronous traffic until the end of the microframe (EOF1). Note that the debug port traffic is only presented on one port (Port #0), while the other ports are idle during this time. 5.19.4 Data Encoding and Bit Stuffing See Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0. 202 Datasheet Functional Description 5.19.5 Packet Formats See Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0. The ICH10 EHCI allows entrance to USB test modes, as defined in the USB 2.0 specification, including Test J, Test Packet, etc. However note that the ICH10 Test Packet test mode interpacket gap timing may not meet the USB 2.0 specification. 5.19.6 USB 2.0 Interrupts and Error Conditions Section 4 of the Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 goes into detail on the EHC interrupts and the error conditions that cause them. All error conditions that the EHC detects can be reported through the EHCI Interrupt status bits. Only ICH10-specific interrupt and error-reporting behavior is documented in this section. The EHCI Interrupts Section must be read first, followed by this section of the datasheet to fully comprehend the EHC interrupt and error-reporting functionality. • Based on the EHC’s Buffer sizes and buffer management policies, the Data Buffer Error can never occur on the ICH10. • Master Abort and Target Abort responses from hub interface on EHC-initiated read packets will be treated as Fatal Host Errors. The EHC halts when these conditions are encountered. • The ICH10 may assert the interrupts which are based on the interrupt threshold as soon as the status for the last complete transaction in the interrupt interval has been posted in the internal write buffers. The requirement in the Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 (that the status is written to memory) is met internally, even though the write may not be seen on DMI before the interrupt is asserted. • Since the ICH10 supports the 1024-element Frame List size, the Frame List Rollover interrupt occurs every 1024 milliseconds. • The ICH10 delivers interrupts using PIRQH#. • The ICH10 does not modify the CERR count on an Interrupt IN when the “Do Complete-Split” execution criteria are not met. • For complete-split transactions in the Periodic list, the “Missed Microframe” bit does not get set on a control-structure-fetch that fails the late-start test. If subsequent accesses to that control structure do not fail the late-start test, then the “Missed Microframe” bit will get set and written back. 5.19.6.1 Aborts on USB 2.0-Initiated Memory Reads If a read initiated by the EHC is aborted, the EHC treats it as a fatal host error. The following actions are taken when this occurs: • The Host System Error status bit is set • The DMA engines are halted after completing up to one more transaction on the USB interface • If enabled (by the Host System Error Enable), then an interrupt is generated • If the status is Master Abort, then the Received Master Abort bit in configuration space is set • If the status is Target Abort, then the Received Target Abort bit in configuration space is set • If enabled (by the SERR Enable bit in the function’s configuration space), then the Signaled System Error bit in configuration bit is set. Datasheet 203 Functional Description 5.19.7 USB 2.0 Power Management 5.19.7.1 Pause Feature This feature allows platforms to dynamically enter low-power states during brief periods when the system is idle (i.e., between keystrokes). This is useful for enabling power management features in the ICH10. The policies for entering these states typically are based on the recent history of system bus activity to incrementally enter deeper power management states. Normally, when the EHC is enabled, it regularly accesses main memory while traversing the DMA schedules looking for work to do; this activity is viewed by the power management software as a non-idle system, thus preventing the power managed states to be entered. Suspending all of the enabled ports can prevent the memory accesses from occurring, but there is an inherent latency overhead with entering and exiting the suspended state on the USB ports that makes this unacceptable for the purpose of dynamic power management. As a result, the EHCI software drivers are allowed to pause the EHC’s DMA engines when it knows that the traffic patterns of the attached devices can afford the delay. The pause only prevents the EHC from generating memory accesses; the SOF packets continue to be generated on the USB ports (unlike the suspended state). 5.19.7.2 Suspend Feature The Enhanced Host Controller Interface (EHCI) For Universal Serial Bus Specification, Section 4.3 describes the details of Port Suspend and Resume. 5.19.7.3 ACPI Device States The USB 2.0 function only supports the D0 and D3 PCI Power Management states. Notes regarding the ICH10 implementation of the Device States: 1. The EHC hardware does not inherently consume any more power when it is in the D0 state than it does in the D3 state. However, software is required to suspend or disable all ports prior to entering the D3 state such that the maximum power consumption is reduced. 2. In the D0 state, all implemented EHC features are enabled. 3. In the D3 state, accesses to the EHC memory-mapped I/O range will master abort. Note that, since the Debug Port uses the same memory range, the Debug Port is only operational when the EHC is in the D0 state. 4. In the D3 state, the EHC interrupt must never assert for any reason. The internal PME# signal is used to signal wake events, etc. 5. When the Device Power State field is written to D0 from D3, an internal reset is generated. See section EHC Resets for general rules on the effects of this reset. 6. Attempts to write any other value into the Device Power State field other than 00b (D0 state) and 11b (D3 state) will complete normally without changing the current value in this field. 204 Datasheet Functional Description 5.19.7.4 ACPI System States The EHC behavior as it relates to other power management states in the system is summarized in the following list: — The System is always in the S0 state when the EHC is in the D0 state. However, when the EHC is in the D3 state, the system may be in any power management state (including S0). — When in D0, the Pause feature (See Section 5.19.7.1) enables dynamic processor low-power states to be entered. — The PLL in the EHC is disabled when entering the S3/S4/S5 states (core power turns off). — All core well logic is reset in the S3/S4/S5 states. 5.19.8 Interaction with UHCI Host Controllers The Enhanced Host controllers share its ports with UHCI Host controllers in the ICH10. The UHC at D29:F0 shares ports 0 and 1; the UHC at D29:F1 shares ports 2 and 3; the UHC at D29:F2 shares ports 4 and 5 with the EHC at D29:F7, while the UHC at D26:F0 shares ports 6 and 7, the UHC at D26:F1 shares ports 8 and 9, and the UHC at D26:F2 shares ports 10 and 11 with EHC at D26:F7. There is very little interaction between the Enhanced and the UHCI controllers other than the muxing control which is provided as part of the EHC. Figure 5-14 shows the USB Port Connections at a conceptual level. Note: Datasheet D26:F2 can be configured as D29:F3 during BIOS post. 205 Functional Description 5.19.8.1 Port-Routing Logic Integrated into the EHC functionality is port-routing logic, which performs the muxing between the UHCI and EHCI host controllers. The ICH10 conceptually implements this logic as described in Section 4.2 of the Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0. If a device is connected that is not capable of USB 2.0’s high-speed signaling protocol or if the EHCI software drivers are not present as indicated by the Configured Flag, then the UHCI controller owns the port. Owning the port means that the differential output is driven by the owner and the input stream is only visible to the owner. The host controller that is not the owner of the port internally sees a disconnected port. Figure 5-14. Intel® ICH10-USB Port Connections Default Six and Six Configuration EHCI #1 UHCI Port 0 Port 1 EHCI #2 UHCI UHCI UHCI Port 2 Port 3 Port 4 Port 5 UHCI Port 6 Port 7 UHCI Port 8 Port 9 UHCI UHCI Port 10 Port 11 Figure 5-15. Intel® ICH10-USB Port Connections Eight and Four Configuration EHCI #1 UHCI Port 0 Port 1 UHCI Port 2 Port 3 UHCI UHCI Port 4 Port 5 EHCI #2 UHCI Port 10 Port 11 UHCI Port 6 Port 7 UHCI UHCI Port 8 Port 9 Note that the port-routing logic is the only block of logic within the ICH10 that observes the physical (real) connect/disconnect information. The port status logic inside each of the host controllers observes the electrical connect/disconnect information that is generated by the port-routing logic. Only the differential signal pairs are multiplexed/de-multiplexed between the UHCI and EHCI host controllers. The other USB functional signals are handled as follows: • The Overcurrent inputs (OC[11:0]#) are directly routed to both controllers. An overcurrent event is recorded in both controllers’ status registers. 206 Datasheet Functional Description The Port-Routing logic is implemented in the Suspend power well so that reenumeration and re-mapping of the USB ports is not required following entering and exiting a system sleep state in which the core power is turned off. The ICH10 also allows the USB Debug Port traffic to be routed in and out of Port #0 and Port #6. When in this mode, the Enhanced Host controller is the owner of Port #0 and Port #6. 5.19.8.2 Device Connects The Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 describes the details of handling Device Connects in Section 4.2. There are four general scenarios that are summarized below. 1. Configure Flag = 0 and a full-speed/low-speed-only Device is connected — In this case, the UHC is the owner of the port both before and after the connect occurs. The EHC (except for the port-routing logic) never sees the connect occur. The UHCI driver handles the connection and initialization process. 2. Configure Flag = 0 and a high-speed-capable Device is connected — In this case, the UHC is the owner of the port both before and after the connect occurs. The EHC (except for the port-routing logic) never sees the connect occur. The UHCI driver handles the connection and initialization process. Since the UHC does not perform the high-speed chirp handshake, the device operates in compatible mode. 3. Configure Flag = 1 and a full-speed/low-speed-only Device is connected — In this case, the EHC is the owner of the port before the connect occurs. The EHCI driver handles the connection and performs the port reset. After the reset process completes, the EHC hardware has cleared (not set) the Port Enable bit in the EHC’s PORTSC register. The EHCI driver then writes a 1 to the Port Owner bit in the same register, causing the UHC to see a connect event and the EHC to see an “electrical” disconnect event. The UHCI driver and hardware handle the connection and initialization process from that point on. The EHCI driver and hardware handle the perceived disconnect. 4. Configure Flag = 1 and a high-speed-capable Device is connected — In this case, the EHC is the owner of the port before, and remains the owner after, the connect occurs. The EHCI driver handles the connection and performs the port reset. After the reset process completes, the EHC hardware has set the Port Enable bit in the EHC’s PORTSC register. The port is functional at this point. The UHC continues to see an unconnected port. Datasheet 207 Functional Description 5.19.8.3 Device Disconnects The Enhanced Host Controller Interface Specification for Universal Serial Bus, Revision 1.0 describes the details of handling Device Connects in Section 4.2. There are three general scenarios that are summarized below. 1. Configure Flag = 0 and the device is disconnected — In this case, the UHC is the owner of the port both before and after the disconnect occurs. The EHC (except for the port-routing logic) never sees a device attached. The UHCI driver handles disconnection process. 2. Configure Flag = 1 and a full-speed/low-speed-capable Device is disconnected — In this case, the UHC is the owner of the port before the disconnect occurs. The disconnect is reported by the UHC and serviced by the associated UHCI driver. The port-routing logic in the EHC cluster forces the Port Owner bit to 0, indicating that the EHC owns the unconnected port. 3. Configure Flag = 1 and a high-speed-capable Device is disconnected — In this case, the EHC is the owner of the port before, and remains the owner after, the disconnect occurs. The EHCI hardware and driver handle the disconnection process. The UHC never sees a device attached. 5.19.8.4 Effect of Resets on Port-Routing Logic As mentioned above, the Port Routing logic is implemented in the suspend power well so that remuneration and re-mapping of the USB ports is not required following entering and exiting a system sleep state in which the core power is turned off. Reset Event Suspend Well Reset Core Well Reset D3-to-D0 Reset HCRESET 5.19.9 Effect on Configure Flag Effect on Port Owner Bits cleared (0) set (1) no effect no effect no effect no effect cleared (0) set (1) USB 2.0 Legacy Keyboard Operation The ICH10 must support the possibility of a keyboard downstream from either a fullspeed/low-speed or a high-speed port. The description of the legacy keyboard support is unchanged from USB 1.1 (See Section 5.18.8). The EHC provides the basic ability to generate SMIs on an interrupt event, along with more sophisticated control of the generation of SMIs. 208 Datasheet Functional Description 5.19.10 USB 2.0 Based Debug Port The ICH10 supports the elimination of the legacy COM ports by providing the ability for new debugger software to interact with devices on a USB 2.0 port. High-level restrictions and features are: • Operational before USB 2.0 drivers are loaded. • Functions even when the port is disabled. • Works even though non-configured port is default-routed to the UHCI. Note that the Debug Port can not be used to debug an issue that requires a full-speed/lowspeed device on Port #0 using the UHCI drivers. • Allows normal system USB 2.0 traffic in a system that may only have one USB port. • Debug Port device (DPD) must be high-speed capable and connect directly to Port #0 and Port #6 on ICH10 systems (e.g., the DPD cannot be connected to Port #0/Port #6 through a hub). • Debug Port FIFO always makes forward progress (a bad status on USB is simply presented back to software). • The Debug Port FIFO is only given one USB access per microframe. The Debug port facilitates operating system and device driver debug. It allows the software to communicate with an external console using a USB 2.0 connection. Because the interface to this link does not go through the normal USB 2.0 stack, it allows communication with the external console during cases where the operating system is not loaded, the USB 2.0 software is broken, or where the USB 2.0 software is being debugged. Specific features of this implementation of a debug port are: • Only works with an external USB 2.0 debug device (console) • Implemented for a specific port on the host controller • Operational anytime the port is not suspended AND the host controller is in D0 power state. • Capability is interrupted when port is driving USB RESET 5.19.10.1 Theory of Operation There are two operational modes for the USB debug port: 1. Mode 1 is when the USB port is in a disabled state from the viewpoint of a standard host controller driver. In Mode 1, the Debug Port controller is required to generate a “keepalive” packets less than 2 ms apart to keep the attached debug device from suspending. The keepalive packet should be a standalone 32-bit SYNC field. 2. Mode 2 is when the host controller is running (i.e., host controller’s Run/Stop# bit is 1). In Mode 2, the normal transmission of SOF packets will keep the debug device from suspending. Behavioral Rules 1. In both modes 1 and 2, the Debug Port controller must check for software requested debug transactions at least every 125 microseconds. 2. If the debug port is enabled by the debug driver, and the standard host controller driver resets the USB port, USB debug transactions are held off for the duration of the reset and until after the first SOF is sent. 3. If the standard host controller driver suspends the USB port, then USB debug transactions are held off for the duration of the suspend/resume sequence and until after the first SOF is sent. 4. The ENABLED_CNT bit in the debug register space is independent of the similar port control bit in the associated Port Status and Control register. Datasheet 209 Functional Description Table 5-47 shows the debug port behavior related to the state of bits in the debug registers as well as bits in the associated Port Status and Control register. Table 5-47. Debug Port Behavior OWNER_CNT ENABLED_CT Port Enable Run / Stop Suspend Debug Port Behavior 0 X X X X Debug port is not being used. Normal operation. 1 0 X X X Debug port is not being used. Normal operation. 1 1 0 0 X Debug port in Mode 1. SYNC keepalives sent plus debug traffic X Debug port in Mode 2. SOF (and only SOF) is sent as keepalive. Debug traffic is also sent. Note that no other normal traffic is sent out this port, because the port is not enabled. 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 invalid. Host controller driver should never put controller into this state (enabled, not running and not suspended). 1 1 1 0 1 Port is suspended. No debug traffic sent. 1 1 1 1 0 Debug port in Mode 2. Debug traffic is interspersed with normal traffic. 1 1 1 1 1 Port is suspended. No debug traffic sent. 5.19.10.1.1 OUT Transactions An Out transaction sends data to the debug device. It can occur only when the following are true: • The debug port is enabled • The debug software sets the GO_CNT bit • The WRITE_READ#_CNT bit is set The sequence of the transaction is: 1. Software sets the appropriate values in the following bits: — — — — — — — — 210 USB_ADDRESS_CNF USB_ENDPOINT_CNF DATA_BUFFER[63:0] TOKEN_PID_CNT[7:0] SEND_PID_CNT[15:8] DATA_LEN_CNT WRITE_READ#_CNT: (note: this will always be 1 for OUT transactions) GO_CNT: (note: this will always be 1 to initiate the transaction) Datasheet Functional Description 2. The debug port controller sends a token packet consisting of: — — — — — SYNC TOKEN_PID_CNT field USB_ADDRESS_CNT field USB_ENDPOINT_CNT field 5-bit CRC field 3. After sending the token packet, the debug port controller sends a data packet consisting of: — — — — SYNC SEND_PID_CNT field The number of data bytes indicated in DATA_LEN_CNT from the DATA_BUFFER 16-bit CRC NOTE: ‘A DATA_LEN_CNT value of 0 is valid in which case no data bytes would be included in the packet. 4. After sending the data packet, the controller waits for a handshake response from the debug device. • If a handshake is received, the debug port controller: — a. Places the received PID in the RECEIVED_PID_STS field — b. Resets the ERROR_GOOD#_STS bit — c. Sets the DONE_STS bit • If no handshake PID is received, the debug port controller: — a. Sets the EXCEPTION_STS field to 001b — b. Sets the ERROR_GOOD#_STS bit — c. Sets the DONE_STS bit 5.19.10.1.2 IN Transactions An IN transaction receives data from the debug device. It can occur only when the following are true: • The debug port is enabled • The debug software sets the GO_CNT bit • The WRITE_READ#_CNT bit is reset The sequence of the transaction is: 1. Software sets the appropriate values in the following bits: — — — — — — Datasheet USB_ADDRESS_CNF USB_ENDPOINT_CNF TOKEN_PID_CNT[7:0] DATA_LEN_CNT WRITE_READ#_CNT: (Note: This will always be 0 for IN transactions.) GO_CNT: (Note: This will always be 1 to initiate the transaction.) 211 Functional Description 2. The debug port controller sends a token packet consisting of: — — — — — SYNC TOKEN_PID_CNT field USB_ADDRESS_CNT field USB_ENDPOINT_CNT field 5-bit CRC field. 3. After sending the token packet, the debug port controller waits for a response from the debug device. If a response is received: — The received PID is placed into the RECEIVED_PID_STS field — Any subsequent bytes are placed into the DATA_BUFFER — The DATA_LEN_CNT field is updated to show the number of bytes that were received after the PID. 4. If a valid packet was received from the device that was one byte in length (indicating it was a handshake packet), then the debug port controller: — Resets the ERROR_GOOD#_STS bit — Sets the DONE_STS bit 5. If a valid packet was received from the device that was more than one byte in length (indicating it was a data packet), then the debug port controller: — Transmits an ACK handshake packet — Resets the ERROR_GOOD#_STS bit — Sets the DONE_STS bit 6. If no valid packet is received, then the debug port controller: — Sets the EXCEPTION_STS field to 001b — Sets the ERROR_GOOD#_STS bit — Sets the DONE_STS bit. 5.19.10.1.3 Debug Software Enabling the Debug Port There are two mutually exclusive conditions that debug software must address as part of its startup processing: • The EHCI has been initialized by system software • The EHCI has not been initialized by system software Debug software can determine the current ‘initialized’ state of the EHCI by examining the Configure Flag in the EHCI USB 2.0 Command Register. If this flag is set, then system software has initialized the EHCI. Otherwise the EHCI should not be considered initialized. Debug software will initialize the debug port registers depending on the state of the EHCI. However, before this can be accomplished, debug software must determine which root USB port is designated as the debug port. Determining the Debug Port Debug software can easily determine which USB root port has been designated as the debug port by examining bits 20:23 of the EHCI Host Controller Structural Parameters register. This 4-bit field represents the numeric value assigned to the debug port (i.e., 0000 = port 0). 212 Datasheet Functional Description Debug Software Startup with Non-Initialized EHCI Debug software can attempt to use the debug port if after setting the OWNER_CNT bit, the Current Connect Status bit in the appropriate (See Determining the Debug Port) PORTSC register is set. If the Current Connect Status bit is not set, then debug software may choose to terminate or it may choose to wait until a device is connected. If a device is connected to the port, then debug software must reset/enable the port. Debug software does this by setting and then clearing the Port Reset bit the PORTSC register. To ensure a successful reset, debug software should wait at least 50 ms before clearing the Port Reset bit. Due to possible delays, this bit may not change to 0 immediately; reset is complete when this bit reads as 0. Software must not continue until this bit reads 0. If a high-speed device is attached, the EHCI will automatically set the Port Enabled/ Disabled bit in the PORTSC register and the debug software can proceed. Debug software should set the ENABLED_CNT bit in the Debug Port Control/Status register, and then reset (clear) the Port Enabled/Disabled bit in the PORTSC register (so that the system host controller driver does not see an enabled port when it is first loaded). Debug Software Startup with Initialized EHCI Debug software can attempt to use the debug port if the Current Connect Status bit in the appropriate (See Determining the Debug Port) PORTSC register is set. If the Current Connect Status bit is not set, then debug software may choose to terminate or it may choose to wait until a device is connected. If a device is connected, then debug software must set the OWNER_CNT bit and then the ENABLED_CNT bit in the Debug Port Control/Status register. Determining Debug Peripheral Presence After enabling the debug port functionality, debug software can determine if a debug peripheral is attached by attempting to send data to the debug peripheral. If all attempts result in an error (Exception bits in the Debug Port Control/Status register indicates a Transaction Error), then the attached device is not a debug peripheral. If the debug port peripheral is not present, then debug software may choose to terminate or it may choose to wait until a debug peripheral is connected. 5.19.11 USB Pre-Fetch Based Pause The Pre-Fetch Based Pause is a power management feature in USB (EHCI) host controllers to ensure maximum C3/C4 processor power state time with C2 popup. This feature applies to the period schedule, and works by allowing the DMA engine to identify periods of idleness and preventing the DMA engine from accessing memory when the periodic schedule is idle. Typically in the presence of periodic devices with multiple millisecond poll periods, the periodic schedule will be idle for several frames between polls. The USB Pre-Fetch Based Pause feature is disabled by setting bit 4 of EHCI Configuration Register Section 17.1.30. Datasheet 213 Functional Description 5.19.12 Function Level Reset Support (FLR) The USB EHCI Controllers support the Function Level Reset (FLR) capability. The FLR capability can be used in conjunction with Intel Virtualization Technology. FLR allows an Operating System in a Virtual Machine to have complete control over a device, including its initialization, without interfering with the rest of the platform. The device provides a software interface that enables the Operating System to reset the whole device as if a PCI reset was asserted. 5.19.12.1 FLR Steps 5.19.12.1.1 FLR Initialization 1. A FLR is initiated by software writing a ‘1’ to the Initiate FLR bit. 2. All subsequent requests targeting the Function will not be claimed and will be Master Abort Immediate on the bus. This includes any configuration, I/O or Memory cycles, however, the Function shall continue to accept completions targeting the Function. 5.19.12.1.2 FLR Operation The Function will Reset all configuration, I/O and memory registers of the Function except those indicated otherwise and reset all internal states of the Function to the default or initial condition. 5.19.12.1.3 FLR Completion The Initiate FLR bit is reset (cleared) when the FLR reset is completed. This bit can be used to indicate to the software that the FLR reset is completed. Note: From the time Initiate FLR bit is written to 1, software must wait at least 100 ms before accessing the function. 5.20 SMBus Controller (D31:F3) The ICH10 provides an System Management Bus (SMBus) 2.0 host controller as well as an SMBus Slave Interface. The host controller provides a mechanism for the processor to initiate communications with SMBus peripherals (slaves). The ICH10 is also capable of operating in a mode in which it can communicate with I2C compatible devices. The ICH10 can perform SMBus messages with either packet error checking (PEC) enabled or disabled. The actual PEC calculation and checking is performed in hardware by the ICH10. The Slave Interface allows an external master to read from or write to the ICH10. Write cycles can be used to cause certain events or pass messages, and the read cycles can be used to determine the state of various status bits. The ICH10’s internal host controller cannot access the ICH10’s internal Slave Interface. The ICH10 SMBus logic exists in Device 31:Function 3 configuration space, and consists of a transmit data path, and host controller. The transmit data path provides the data flow logic needed to implement the seven different SMBus command protocols and is controlled by the host controller. The ICH10 SMBus controller logic is clocked by RTC clock. The SMBus Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is supported by using the existing host controller commands through software, except for the new Host Notify command (which is actually a received message). 214 Datasheet Functional Description The programming model of the host controller is combined into two portions: a PCI configuration portion, and a system I/O mapped portion. All static configuration, such as the I/O base address, is done via the PCI configuration space. Real-time programming of the Host interface is done in system I/O space. The ICH10 SMBus host controller checks for parity errors as a target. If an error is detected, the detected parity error bit in the PCI Status Register (Device 31:Function 3:Offset 06h:bit 15) is set. If bit 6 and bit 8 of the PCI Command Register (Device 31:Function 3:Offset 04h) are set, an SERR# is generated and the signaled SERR# bit in the PCI Status Register (bit 14) is set. 5.20.1 Host Controller The SMBus host controller is used to send commands to other SMBus slave devices. Software sets up the host controller with an address, command, and, for writes, data and optional PEC; and then tells the controller to start. When the controller has finished transmitting data on writes, or receiving data on reads, it generates an SMI# or interrupt, if enabled. The host controller supports 8 command protocols of the SMBus interface (see System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0): Quick Command, Send Byte, Receive Byte, Write Byte/Word, Read Byte/Word, Process Call, Block Read/Write, Block Write–Block Read Process Call, and Host Notify. The SMBus host controller requires that the various data and command fields be setup for the type of command to be sent. When software sets the START bit, the SMBus Host controller performs the requested transaction, and interrupts the processor (or generates an SMI#) when the transaction is completed. Once a START command has been issued, the values of the “active registers” (Host Control, Host Command, Transmit Slave Address, Data 0, Data 1) should not be changed or read until the interrupt status bit (INTR) has been set (indicating the completion of the command). Any register values needed for computation purposes should be saved prior to issuing of a new command, as the SMBus host controller updates all registers while completing the new command. The ICH10 supports the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0. Slave functionality, including the Host Notify protocol, is available on the SMBus pins. The SMLink and SMBus signals can be tied together externally depending on TCO mode used. Refer to Section 5.14.2 for more details. Using the SMB host controller to send commands to the ICH10’s SMB slave port is not supported. 5.20.1.1 Command Protocols In all of the following commands, the Host Status Register (offset 00h) is used to determine the progress of the command. While the command is in operation, the HOST_BUSY bit is set. If the command completes successfully, the INTR bit will be set in the Host Status Register. If the device does not respond with an acknowledge, and the transaction times out, the DEV_ERR bit is set. If software sets the KILL bit in the Host Control Register while the command is running, the transaction will stop and the FAILED bit will be set. Quick Command When programmed for a Quick Command, the Transmit Slave Address Register is sent. The PEC byte is never appended to the Quick Protocol. Software should force the PEC_EN bit to 0 when performing the Quick Command. Software must force the I2C_EN bit to 0 when running this command. See section 5.5.1 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Datasheet 215 Functional Description Send Byte / Receive Byte For the Send Byte command, the Transmit Slave Address and Device Command Registers are sent. For the Receive Byte command, the Transmit Slave Address Register is sent. The data received is stored in the DATA0 register. Software must force the I2C_EN bit to 0 when running this command. The Receive Byte is similar to a Send Byte, the only difference is the direction of data transfer. See sections 5.5.2 and 5.5.3 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Write Byte/Word The first byte of a Write Byte/Word access is the command code. The next 1 or 2 bytes are the data to be written. When programmed for a Write Byte/Word command, the Transmit Slave Address, Device Command, and Data0 Registers are sent. In addition, the Data1 Register is sent on a Write Word command. Software must force the I2C_EN bit to 0 when running this command. See section 5.5.4 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Read Byte/Word Reading data is slightly more complicated than writing data. First the ICH10 must write a command to the slave device. Then it must follow that command with a repeated start condition to denote a read from that device's address. The slave then returns 1 or 2 bytes of data. Software must force the I2C_EN bit to 0 when running this command. When programmed for the read byte/word command, the Transmit Slave Address and Device Command Registers are sent. Data is received into the DATA0 on the read byte, and the DAT0 and DATA1 registers on the read word. See section 5.5.5 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Process Call The process call is so named because a command sends data and waits for the slave to return a value dependent on that data. The protocol is simply a Write Word followed by a Read Word, but without a second command or stop condition. When programmed for the Process Call command, the ICH10 transmits the Transmit Slave Address, Host Command, DATA0 and DATA1 registers. Data received from the device is stored in the DATA0 and DATA1 registers. The Process Call command with I2C_EN set and the PEC_EN bit set produces undefined results. Software must force either I2C_EN or PEC_EN to 0 when running this command. See section 5.5.6 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Note: For process call command, the value written into bit 0 of the Transmit Slave Address Register (SMB I/O register, offset 04h) needs to be 0. Note: If the I2C_EN bit is set, the protocol sequence changes slightly: the Command Code (bits 18:11 in the bit sequence) are not sent - as a result, the slave will not acknowledge (bit 19 in the sequence). 216 Datasheet Functional Description Block Read/Write The ICH10 contains a 32-byte buffer for read and write data which can be enabled by setting bit 1 of the Auxiliary Control register at offset 0Dh in I/O space, as opposed to a single byte of buffering. This 32-byte buffer is filled with write data before transmission, and filled with read data on reception. In the ICH10, the interrupt is generated only after a transmission or reception of 32 bytes, or when the entire byte count has been transmitted/received. The byte count field is transmitted but ignored by the ICH10 as software will end the transfer after all bytes it cares about have been sent or received. For a Block Write, software must either force the I2C_EN bit or both the PEC_EN and AAC bits to 0 when running this command. The block write begins with a slave address and a write condition. After the command code the ICH10 issues a byte count describing how many more bytes will follow in the message. If a slave had 20 bytes to send, the first byte would be the number 20 (14h), followed by 20 bytes of data. The byte count may not be 0. A Block Read or Write is allowed to transfer a maximum of 32 data bytes. When programmed for a block write command, the Transmit Slave Address, Device Command, and Data0 (count) registers are sent. Data is then sent from the Block Data Byte register; the total data sent being the value stored in the Data0 Register. On block read commands, the first byte received is stored in the Data0 register, and the remaining bytes are stored in the Block Data Byte register. See section 5.5.7 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. Note: Datasheet For Block Write, if the I2C_EN bit is set, the format of the command changes slightly. The ICH10 will still send the number of bytes (on writes) or receive the number of bytes (on reads) indicated in the DATA0 register. However, it will not send the contents of the DATA0 register as part of the message. Also, the Block Write protocol sequence changes slightly: the Byte Count (bits 27:20 in the bit sequence) are not sent - as a result, the slave will not acknowledge (bit 28 in the sequence). 217 Functional Description I2C Read This command allows the ICH10 to perform block reads to certain I2C devices, such as serial E2PROMs. The SMBus Block Read supports the 7-bit addressing mode only. However, this does not allow access to devices using the I2C “Combined Format” that has data bytes after the address. Typically these data bytes correspond to an offset (address) within the serial memory chips. Note: This command is supported independent of the setting of the I2C_EN bit. The I2C Read command with the PEC_EN bit set produces undefined results. Software must force both the PEC_EN and AAC bit to 0 when running this command. For I2C Read command, the value written into bit 0 of the Transmit Slave Address Register (SMB I/O register, offset 04h) needs to be 0. The format that is used for the command is shown in Table 5-48. Table 5-48. I2C Block Read Bit 1 8:2 9 10 18:11 Description Start Slave Address — 7 bits Write Acknowledge from slave Send DATA1 register 19 Acknowledge from slave 20 Repeated Start 27:21 Slave Address — 7 bits 28 Read 29 Acknowledge from slave 37:30 38 46:39 47 Data byte 1 from slave — 8 bits Acknowledge Data byte 2 from slave — 8 bits Acknowledge – Data bytes from slave / Acknowledge – Data byte N from slave — 8 bits – NOT Acknowledge – Stop The ICH10 will continue reading data from the peripheral until the NAK is received. 218 Datasheet Functional Description Block Write–Block Read Process Call The block write-block read process call is a two-part message. The call begins with a slave address and a write condition. After the command code the host issues a write byte count (M) that describes how many more bytes will be written in the first part of the message. If a master has 6 bytes to send, the byte count field will have the value 6 (0000 0110b), followed by the 6 bytes of data. The write byte count (M) cannot be 0. The second part of the message is a block of read data beginning with a repeated start condition followed by the slave address and a Read bit. The next byte is the read byte count (N), which may differ from the write byte count (M). The read byte count (N) cannot be 0. The combined data payload must not exceed 32 bytes. The byte length restrictions of this process call are summarized as follows: • M ≥ 1 byte • N ≥ 1 byte • M + N ≤ 32 bytes The read byte count does not include the PEC byte. The PEC is computed on the total message beginning with the first slave address and using the normal PEC computational rules. It is highly recommended that a PEC byte be used with the Block Write-Block Read Process Call. Software must do a read to the command register (offset 2h) to reset the 32 byte buffer pointer prior to reading the block data register. Note that there is no STOP condition before the repeated START condition, and that a NACK signifies the end of the read transfer. Note: E32B bit in the Auxiliary Control register must be set when using this protocol. See section 5.5.8 of the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0 for the format of the protocol. 5.20.2 Bus Arbitration Several masters may attempt to get on the bus at the same time by driving the SMBDATA line low to signal a start condition. The ICH10 continuously monitors the SMBDATA line. When the ICH10 is attempting to drive the bus to a 1 by letting go of the SMBDATA line, and it samples SMBDATA low, then some other master is driving the bus and the ICH10 will stop transferring data. If the ICH10 sees that it has lost arbitration, the condition is called a collision. The ICH10 will set the BUS_ERR bit in the Host Status Register, and if enabled, generate an interrupt or SMI#. The processor is responsible for restarting the transaction. When the ICH10 is a SMBus master, it drives the clock. When the ICH10 is sending address or command as an SMBus master, or data bytes as a master on writes, it drives data relative to the clock it is also driving. It will not start toggling the clock until the start or stop condition meets proper setup and hold time. The ICH10 will also ensure minimum time between SMBus transactions as a master. Note: Datasheet The ICH10 supports the same arbitration protocol for both the SMBus and the System Management (SMLINK) interfaces. 219 Functional Description 5.20.3 Bus Timing 5.20.3.1 Clock Stretching Some devices may not be able to handle their clock toggling at the rate that the ICH10 as an SMBus master would like. They have the capability of stretching the low time of the clock. When the ICH10 attempts to release the clock (allowing the clock to go high), the clock will remain low for an extended period of time. The ICH10 monitors the SMBus clock line after it releases the bus to determine whether to enable the counter for the high time of the clock. While the bus is still low, the high time counter must not be enabled. Similarly, the low period of the clock can be stretched by an SMBus master if it is not ready to send or receive data. 5.20.3.2 Bus Time Out (Intel® ICH10 as SMBus Master) If there is an error in the transaction, such that an SMBus device does not signal an acknowledge, or holds the clock lower than the allowed time-out time, the transaction will time out. The ICH10 will discard the cycle and set the DEV_ERR bit. The time out minimum is 25 ms (800 RTC clocks). The time-out counter inside the ICH10 will start after the last bit of data is transferred by the ICH10 and it is waiting for a response. The 25 ms timeout counter will not count under the following conditions: 1. BYTE_DONE_STATUS bit (SMBus I/O Offset 00h, bit 7) is set 2. The SECOND_TO_STS bit (TCO I/O Offset 06h, bit 1) is not set (this indicates that the system has not locked up). 220 Datasheet Functional Description 5.20.4 Interrupts / SMI# The ICH10 SMBus controller uses PIRQB# as its interrupt pin. However, the system can alternatively be set up to generate SMI# instead of an interrupt, by setting the SMBUS_SMI_EN bit (Device 31:Function 0:Offset 40h:bit 1). Table 5-50 and Table 5-51 specify how the various enable bits in the SMBus function control the generation of the interrupt, Host and Slave SMI, and Wake internal signals. The rows in the tables are additive, which means that if more than one row is true for a particular scenario then the Results for all of the activated rows will occur. Table 5-49. Enable for SMBALERT# Event SMBALERT# asserted low (always reported in Host Status Register, Bit 5) INTREN (Host Control I/O Register, Offset 02h, Bit 0) SMB_SMI_EN (Host Configuration Register, D31:F3:Offset 40h, Bit 1) SMBALERT_DIS (Slave Command I/O Register, Offset 11h, Bit 2) X X X Wake generated X 1 0 Slave SMI# generated (SMBUS_SMI_STS) 1 0 0 Interrupt generated Result Table 5-50. Enables for SMBus Slave Write and SMBus Host Events Event INTREN (Host Control I/O Register, Offset 02h, Bit 0) SMB_SMI_EN (Host Configuration Register, D31:F3:Offset 40h, Bit1) Event Slave Write to Wake/ SMI# Command X X Wake generated when asleep. Slave SMI# generated when awake (SMBUS_SMI_STS). Slave Write to SMLINK_SLAVE_SMI Command X X Slave SMI# generated when in the S0 state (SMBUS_SMI_STS) 0 X None 1 0 Interrupt generated 1 1 Host SMI# generated Any combination of Host Status Register [4:1] asserted Table 5-51. Enables for the Host Notify Command HOST_NOTIFY_INTREN (Slave Control I/O Register, Offset 11h, bit 0) SMB_SMI_EN (Host Config Register, D31:F3:Off40h, Bit 1) HOST_NOTIFY_WKEN (Slave Control I/O Register, Offset 11h, bit 1) 0 X 0 None X X 1 Wake generated 1 0 X Interrupt generated X Slave SMI# generated (SMBUS_SMI_STS) 1 Datasheet 1 Result 221 Functional Description 5.20.5 SMBALERT# SMBALERT# is multiplexed with GPIO[11]. When enable and the signal is asserted, The ICH10 can generate an interrupt, an SMI#, or a wake event from S1–S5. 5.20.6 SMBus CRC Generation and Checking If the AAC bit is set in the Auxiliary Control register, the ICH10 automatically calculates and drives CRC at the end of the transmitted packet for write cycles, and will check the CRC for read cycles. It will not transmit the contents of the PEC register for CRC. The PEC bit must not be set in the Host Control register if this bit is set, or unspecified behavior will result. If the read cycle results in a CRC error, the DEV_ERR bit and the CRCE bit in the Auxiliary Status register at offset 0Ch will be set. 5.20.7 SMBus Slave Interface The ICH10’s SMBus Slave interface is accessed via the SMBus. The SMBus slave logic will not generate or handle receiving the PEC byte and will only act as a Legacy Alerting Protocol device. The slave interface allows the ICH10 to decode cycles, and allows an external microcontroller to perform specific actions. Key features and capabilities include: • Supports decode of three types of messages: Byte Write, Byte Read, and Host Notify. • Receive Slave Address register: This is the address that the ICH10 decodes. A default value is provided so that the slave interface can be used without the processor having to program this register. • Receive Slave Data register in the SMBus I/O space that includes the data written by the external microcontroller. • Registers that the external microcontroller can read to get the state of the ICH10. • Status bits to indicate that the SMBus slave logic caused an interrupt or SMI# due to the reception of a message that matched the slave address. — Bit 0 of the Slave Status Register for the Host Notify command — Bit 16 of the SMI Status Register (Section 13.8.3.13) for all others Note: The external microcontroller should not attempt to access the Intel ICH10’s SMBus slave logic until either: — 800 milliseconds after both: RTCRST# is high and RSMRST# is high, OR — The PLTRST# deasserts If a master leaves the clock and data bits of the SMBus interface at 1 for 50 µs or more in the middle of a cycle, the ICH10 slave logic's behavior is undefined. This is interpreted as an unexpected idle and should be avoided when performing management activities to the slave logic. Note: 222 When an external microcontroller accesses the SMBus Slave Interface over the SMBus a translation in the address is needed to accommodate the least significant bit used for read/write control. For example, if the ICH10 slave address (RCV_SLVA) is left at 44h (default), the external micro controller would use an address of 88h/89h (write/read). Datasheet Functional Description 5.20.7.1 Format of Slave Write Cycle The external master performs Byte Write commands to the ICH10 SMBus Slave I/F. The “Command” field (bits 11:18) indicate which register is being accessed. The Data field (bits 20:27) indicate the value that should be written to that register. Table 5-52 has the values associated with the registers. Table 5-52. Slave Write Registers Register 0 1–3 Function Command Register. See Table 5-53 below for legal values written to this register. Reserved 4 Data Message Byte 0 5 Data Message Byte 1 6–7 Reserved 8 Reserved 9–FFh Reserved NOTE: The external microcontroller is responsible to make sure that it does not update the contents of the data byte registers until they have been read by the system processor. The ICH10 overwrites the old value with any new value received. A race condition is possible where the new value is being written to the register just at the time it is being read. ICH10 will not attempt to cover this race condition (i.e., unpredictable results in this case). . Table 5-53. Command Types (Sheet 1 of 2) Command Type Datasheet Description 0 Reserved 1 WAKE/SMI#. This command wakes the system if it is not already awake. If system is already awake, an SMI# is generated. NOTE: The SMB_WAK_STS bit will be set by this command, even if the system is already awake. The SMI handler should then clear this bit. 2 Unconditional Powerdown. This command sets the PWRBTNOR_STS bit, and has the same effect as the Powerbutton Override occurring. 3 HARD RESET WITHOUT CYCLING: This command causes a hard reset of the system (does not include cycling of the power supply). This is equivalent to a write to the CF9h register with bits 2:1 set to 1, but bit 3 set to 0. 4 HARD RESET SYSTEM. This command causes a hard reset of the system (including cycling of the power supply). This is equivalent to a write to the CF9h register with bits 3:1 set to 1. 5 Disable the TCO Messages. This command will disable the Intel ICH10 from sending Heartbeat and Event messages (as described in Section 5.14). Once this command has been executed, Heartbeat and Event message reporting can only be re-enabled by assertion and deassertion of the RSMRST# signal. 6 WD RELOAD: Reload watchdog timer. 7 Reserved 223 Functional Description Table 5-53. Command Types (Sheet 2 of 2) Command Type Description 8 SMLINK_SLV_SMI. When ICH10 detects this command type while in the S0 state, it sets the SMLINK_SLV_SMI_STS bit (see Section 13.9.5). This command should only be used if the system is in an S0 state. If the message is received during S1–S5 states, the ICH10 acknowledges it, but the SMLINK_SLV_SMI_STS bit does not get set. NOTE: It is possible that the system transitions out of the S0 state at the same time that the SMLINK_SLV_SMI command is received. In this case, the SMLINK_SLV_SMI_STS bit may get set but not serviced before the system goes to sleep. Once the system returns to S0, the SMI associated with this bit would then be generated. Software must be able to handle this scenario. 9-FFh 5.20.7.2 Reserved. Format of Read Command The external master performs Byte Read commands to the ICH10 SMBus Slave interface. The “Command” field (bits 18:11) indicate which register is being accessed. The Data field (bits 30:37) contain the value that should be read from that register. Table 5-54. Slave Read Cycle Format Bit 1 Driven by Comment Start External Microcontroller Slave Address - 7 bits External Microcontroller Must match value in Receive Slave Address register 9 Write External Microcontroller Always 0 10 ACK Intel ICH10 Command code – 8 bits External Microcontroller 19 ACK Intel ICH10 20 Repeated Start External Microcontroller Slave Address - 7 bits External Microcontroller Must match value in Receive Slave Address register 28 Read External Microcontroller Always 1 29 ACK Intel ICH10 Data Byte Intel ICH10 2-8 11-18 21-27 30-37 224 Description 38 NOT ACK External Microcontroller 39 Stop External Microcontroller Indicates which register is being accessed. See Table 5-55 below for list of implemented registers. Value depends on register being accessed. Table 5-55 below for list of implemented registers. Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-55. Data Values for Slave Read Registers (Sheet 1 of 2) Register Bits Description 0 7:0 Reserved for capabilities indication. Should always return 00h. Future chips may return another value to indicate different capabilities. 1 2:0 System Power State 000 = S0 001 = S1 010 = Reserved 011 = S3 100 = S4 101 = S5 110 = Reserved 111 = Reserved 7:3 2 3 Reserved 7:4 Reserved 5:0 Watchdog Timer current value Note that Watchdog Timer has 10 bits, but this field is only 6 bits. If the current value is greater than 3Fh, ICH10 will always report 3Fh in this field. 7:6 4 Reserved 3:0 0 1 (Consumer Only) 1 (Corporate Only) Reserved 1 = The Intruder Detect (INTRD_DET) bit is set. This indicates that the system cover has probably been opened. 1 = BTI Temperature Event occurred. This bit will be set if the Intel ICH10’s THRM# input signal is at a valid low voltage state. This bit will be clear if the THRM# input signal is at a valid high voltage state. NOTE: This bit interprets the behavior if the THRM# pin as active low. This bit is set independent of the TRM#_POL bit setting. 1 = BTI Temperature Event occurred. This bit will be set if the Intel ICH10’s THRM# input signal is active. Else this bit will read 0. NOTE: The THRM# pin is in core well and accurate reflection of the THRM# pin is dependent on the platform being in S0. 2 DOA CPU Status. This bit will be 1 to indicate that the processor is dead 3 1 = SECOND_TO_STS bit set. This bit will be set after the second time-out (SECOND_TO_STS bit) of the Watchdog Timer occurs. 6:4 7 Reserved. Will always be 0, but software should ignore. Reflects the value of the GPIO[11]/SMBALERT# pin (and is dependent upon the value of the GPI_INV[11] bit. If the GPI_INV[11] bit is 1, then the value in this bit equals the level of the GPI[11]/SMBALERT# pin (high = 1, low = 0). If the GPI_INV[11] bit is 0, then the value of this bit will equal the inverse of the level of the GPIO[11]/SMBALERT# pin (high = 0, low = 1). 5 0 FWH bad bit. This bit will be 1 to indicate that the FWH read returned FFh, which indicates that it is probably blank. 1 Reserved 2 CPU Power Failure Status: ‘1’ if the CPUPWR_FLR bit in the GEN_PMCON_2 register is set. 3 INIT# due to receiving Shutdown message: This event is visible from the reception of the shutdown message until a platform reset is done if the Shutdown Policy Select bit (SPS) is configured to drive INIT#. When the SPS bit is configured to generate PLTRST# based on shutdown, this register bit will always return 0. Events on signal will not create a event message 4 Datasheet Reserved 225 Functional Description Table 5-55. Data Values for Slave Read Registers (Sheet 2 of 2) Register Bits Description 5 POWER_OK_BAD: Indicates the failure core power well ramp during boot/resume. This bit will be active if the SLP_S3# pin is de-asserted and PWROK pin is not asserted. 6 Thermal Trip: This bit will shadow the state of processor Thermal Trip status bit (CTS) (16.2.1.2, GEN_PMCON_2, bit 3). Events on signal will not create a event message Reserved: Default value is “X” 7 5.20.7.2.1 Note: Software should not expect a consistent value when this bit is read through SMBUS/SMLINK 6 7:0 Contents of the Message 1 register. Refer to Section 13.9.8 for the description of this register. 7 7:0 Contents of the Message 2 register. Refer to Section 13.9.8 for the description of this register. 8 7:0 Contents of the TCO_WDCNT register. Refer to Section 13.9.9 for the description of this register. 9 7:0 Seconds of the RTC A 7:0 Minutes of the RTC B 7:0 Hours of the RTC C 7:0 “Day of Week” of the RTC D 7:0 “Day of Month” of the RTC E 7:0 Month of the RTC F 7:0 Year of the RTC 10h–FFh 7:0 Reserved Behavioral Notes According to SMBus protocol, Read and Write messages always begin with a Start bit – Address– Write bit sequence. When the ICH10 detects that the address matches the value in the Receive Slave Address register, it will assume that the protocol is always followed and ignore the Write bit (bit 9) and signal an Acknowledge during bit 10. In other words, if a Start –Address–Read occurs (which is invalid for SMBus Read or Write protocol), and the address matches the ICH10’s Slave Address, the ICH10 will still grab the cycle. Also according to SMBus protocol, a Read cycle contains a Repeated Start–Address– Read sequence beginning at bit 20. Once again, if the Address matches the ICH10’s Receive Slave Address, it will assume that the protocol is followed, ignore bit 28, and proceed with the Slave Read cycle. Note: An external microcontroller must not attempt to access the ICH10’s SMBus Slave logic until at least 1 second after both RTCRST# and RSMRST# are deasserted (high). 5.20.7.3 Slave Read of RTC Time Bytes The ICH10 SMBus slave interface allows external SMBus master to read the internal RTC’s time byte registers. The RTC time bytes are internally latched by the ICH10’s hardware whenever RTC time is not changing and SMBus is idle. This ensures that the time byte delivered to the slave read is always valid and it does not change when the read is still in progress on the bus. The RTC time will change whenever hardware update is in progress, or there is a software write to the RTC time bytes. 226 Datasheet Functional Description The ICH10 SMBus slave interface only supports Byte Read operation. The external SMBus master will read the RTC time bytes one after another. It is software’s responsibility to check and manage the possible time rollover when subsequent time bytes are read. For example, assuming the RTC time is 11 hours: 59 minutes: 59 seconds. When the external SMBus master reads the hour as 11, then proceeds to read the minute, it is possible that the rollover happens between the reads and the minute is read as 0. This results in 11 hours: 0 minute instead of the correct time of 12 hours: 0 minutes. Unless it is certain that rollover will not occur, software is required to detect the possible time rollover by reading multiple times such that the read time bytes can be adjusted accordingly if needed. 5.20.7.4 Format of Host Notify Command The ICH10 tracks and responds to the standard Host Notify command as specified in the System Management Bus (SMBus) Specification, Version 2.0. The host address for this command is fixed to 0001000b. If the ICH10 already has data for a previouslyreceived host notify command which has not been serviced yet by the host software (as indicated by the HOST_NOTIFY_STS bit), then it will NACK following the host address byte of the protocol. This allows the host to communicate non-acceptance to the master and retain the host notify address and data values for the previous cycle until host software completely services the interrupt. Note: Host software must always clear the HOST_NOTIFY_STS bit after completing any necessary reads of the address and data registers. Table 5-56 shows the Host Notify format. Table 5-56. Host Notify Format Bit 1 8:2 9 Driven By Comment Start External Master SMB Host Address — 7 bits External Master Always 0001_000 Write External Master Always 0 Intel® ICH10 ICH10 NACKs if HOST_NOTIFY_STS is 1 Device Address – 7 bits External Master Indicates the address of the master; loaded into the Notify Device Address Register 18 Unused — Always 0 External Master 7-bit-only address; this bit is inserted to complete the byte 19 ACK ICH10 Data Byte Low — 8 bits External Master ACK ICH10 Data Byte High — 8 bits External Master 37 ACK ICH10 38 Stop External Master 10 17:11 27:20 28 36:29 Datasheet Description ACK (or NACK) Loaded into the Notify Data Low Byte Register Loaded into the Notify Data High Byte Register 227 Functional Description 5.21 Intel® High Definition Audio Overview The ICH10’s High Definition Audio (HDA) controller communicates with the external codec(s) over the Intel High Definition Audio serial link. The controller consists of a set of DMA engines that are used to move samples of digitally encoded data between system memory and an external codec(s). The ICH10 implements four output DMA engines and 4 input DMA engines. The output DMA engines move digital data from system memory to a D-A converter in a codec. ICH10 implements a single Serial Data Output signal (HDA_SDOUT) that is connected to all external codecs. The input DMA engines move digital data from the A-D converter in the codec to system memory. The ICH10 implements four Serial Digital Input signals (HDA_SDI[3:0]) supporting up to four codecs. Audio software renders outbound and processes inbound data to/from buffers in system memory. The location of individual buffers is described by a Buffer Descriptor List (BDL) that is fetched and processed by the controller. The data in the buffers is arranged in a predefined format. The output DMA engines fetch the digital data from memory and reformat it based on the programmed sample rate, bit/sample and number of channels. The data from the output DMA engines is then combined and serially sent to the external codecs over the Intel High Definition Audio link. The input DMA engines receive data from the codecs over the Intel High Definition Audio link and format the data based on the programmable attributes for that stream. The data is then written to memory in the predefined format for software to process. Each DMA engine moves one stream of data. A single codec can accept or generate multiple streams of data, one for each A-D or D-A converter in the codec. Multiple codecs can accept the same output stream processed by a single DMA engine. Codec commands and responses are also transported to and from the codecs using DMA engines. 5.22 Intel® Active Management Technology (Intel® AMT) (Corporate Only) Intel Active Management Technology is a set of advanced manageability features developed as a direct result of IT customer feedback gained through Intel market research. Reducing the Total Cost of Ownership (TCO) through improved asset tracking, remote manageability, and fewer desk-side visits were identified as key IT priorities. Intel AMT extends the capabilities of existing management solutions by making the asset information, remote diagnostics, recovery and contain capabilities always available, or Out of Band (OOB), even when the system is in a low-power “off” state or the OS is hung. Another feature of Intel AMT is System Defense. System Defense is used to stop the propagation of worms and viruses. Programmable packet filters in the integrated LAN Controller are used to accomplish this. These filters inspect all incoming and all outgoing packets and decide whether to block or pass the packets as configured. There is no indication to the host that a packet has been blocked or accepted. The logic can be used to accept or block reception to host or transmission to network paths. Additionally, counter logic can be used to count the number or filter matches for a given filter. This feature allows for statistical sampling of connections as well as rate limiting of connections. 228 Datasheet Functional Description 5.22.1 Intel® AMT Features • E-Asset Tag • OOB HW and SW Inventory Logs • OOB Alerts • IDE Redirect • Serial over LAN for Remote Control • Remote Diagnostics Execution • OS Lock-Up Alert • OS Repair • Remote BIOS Recovery and Update 5.22.2 Intel® AMT Requirements Intel AMT is a platform-level solution that utilizes multiple system components including: • Intel AMT-Ready ICH10 SKU • Intel Gigabit Ethernet PHY (Intel® 82567 Gigabit Platform LAN Connect device) with Intel Active Management Technology for remote access • SPI flash memory with 4KB or 8KB sector erase that meets requirements set in Section 5.23.4 (32 Mb minimum for Intel AMT) to store asset information, management software code, and logs • BIOS to provide asset detection and POST diagnostics (BIOS and Intel AMT can optionally share same flash memory device) • Familiar ISV software packages to take advantage of Intel AMT’s platform management capabilities 5.23 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a 4-pin interface that provides a lower-cost alternative for system flash versus the Firmware Hub on the LPC bus. The 4-pin SPI interface consists of clock (CLK), master data out (Master Out Slave In (MOSI)), master data in (Master In Slave Out (MISO)) and an active low chip select (SPI_CS[1:0]#). The ICH10 supports up to two SPI flash devices using two separate Chip Select pins. Each SPI flash device can be up to 16 MBytes. The ICH10 SPI interface supports 20 MHz and 33 MHz SPI devices. Communication on the SPI bus is done with a Master – Slave protocol. The Slave is connected to the ICH10 and is implemented as a tri-state bus. Note: If option 11 LPC is selected BIOS may still be placed on LPC, but all platforms with ICH10 (Corporate Only) require SPI flash connected directly to the ICH's SPI bus with a valid descriptor in order to boot. Note: When SPI is selected by the Boot BIOS Destination Strap and a SPI device is detected by the ICH10, LPC based BIOS flash is disabled. Datasheet 229 Functional Description 5.23.1 SPI Supported Feature Overview SPI Flash on the ICH10 has two operational modes, descriptor and non-descriptor. 5.23.1.1 Non-Descriptor Mode Non-descriptor mode is similar to the flash functionality of ICH7. In this mode, SPI Flash can only be used for BIOS. Direct read and writes are not supported. BIOS has read/write access only through register accesses. Through those register accesses BIOS can read and write to the entire flash without security checking. There is also no support for the integrated Gigabit Ethernet, Intel Management Engine, chipset soft straps, as well multiple SPI Flash components. 5.23.1.2 Descriptor Mode Descriptor Mode enables many new features of the chipset: • Integrated Gigabit Ethernet and Host processor for Gigabit Ethernet Software • Intel Active Management Technology • Intel Quiet System Technology • Supports two SPI Flash components using two separate chip select pins • Hardware enforced security restricting master accesses to different regions • Chipset Soft Strap region provides the ability to use Flash NVM as an alternative to hardware pull-up/pull-down resistors for both ICH and (G)MCH • Supports the SPI Fast Read instruction and frequencies of 33 MHz • Uses standardized Flash Instruction Set 5.23.1.2.1 SPI Flash Regions In Descriptor Mode the Flash is divided into five separate regions: Region Content 0 Flash Descriptor 1 BIOS 2 Intel Management Engine 3 Gigabit Ethernet 4 Platform Data Only three masters can access the four regions: Host processor running BIOS code, Integrated Gigabit Ethernet and Host processor running Gigabit Ethernet Software, and Intel Management Engine. The only required region is Region 0, the Flash Descriptor. Region 0 must be located in the first sector of device 0 (offset 0). Flash Region Sizes SPI flash space requirements differ by platform and configuration. The Flash Descriptor requires one 4 KB or larger block. GbE requires two 4 KB or larger blocks. The Platform Data Region is 32 KB. The amount of flash space consumed is dependent on the erase granularity of the flash part and the platform requirements for the Intel ME and BIOS regions. The Intel ME region will contain firmware to support Intel Quiet System Technology, Intel Active Management Technology, ASF 2.0 and Intel Trusted Platform Module. 230 Datasheet Functional Description Table 5-57. Region Size versus Erase Granularity of Flash Components 5.23.1.3 Region Size with 4 KB Blocks Size with 64 KB Blocks Descriptor 4 KB 64 KB GbE 8 KB 128 KB Platform Data Region 32 KB Not Supported BIOS Varies by Platform Varies by Platform Intel ME Varies by Platform Varies by Platform Device Partitioning The ICH10 SPI Flash controller supports two sets of attributes in SPI flash space. This allows for supporting an asymmetric flash component that has two separate sets of attributes in the upper and lower part of the memory array. An example of this is a flash part that has different erase granularities in two different parts of the memory array. This allows for the usage of two separate flash vendors if using two different flash parts. Figure 5-16. Flash Partition Boundary Upper Flash Partition … FlashPartition Boundary Lower Flash Partition Datasheet … 231 Functional Description 5.23.2 Flash Descriptor The maximum size of the Flash Descriptor is 4 KB. If the block/sector size of the SPI flash device is greater than 4 KB, the flash descriptor will only use the first 4 KB of the first block. The flash descriptor requires its own block at the bottom of memory (0x00h). The information stored in the Flash Descriptor can only be written during the manufacturing process as its read/write permissions must be set to Read only when the computer leaves the manufacturing floor. The Flash Descriptor is made up of eleven sections: Figure 5-17. Flash Descriptor Sections 4KB OEM Section Descriptor Upper MAP Management Engine VSCC Table Reserved MCH Soft Straps ICH Soft Straps Master Region Component Descriptor MAP Signature 0 1. The Flash signature selects Descriptor Mode as well as verifies if the flash is programmed and functioning. The data at the bottom of the flash (offset 0) must be 0FF0A55Ah in order to be in Descriptor mode. 2. The Descriptor map has pointers to the other five descriptor sections as well as the size of each. 232 Datasheet Functional Description 3. The component section has information about the SPI flash in the system including: the number of components, density of each, invalid instructions (such as chip erase), and frequencies for read, fast read and write/erase instructions. 4. The Region section points to the three other regions as well as the size of each region. 5. The master region contains the security settings for the flash, granting read/write permissions for each region and identifying each master by a requestor ID. See Section 5.23.2.1 for more information. 6 & 7. The (G)MCH and ICH chipset soft strap sections contain (G)MCH and ICH configurable parameters. 8. The Reserved region between the top of the (G)MCH strap section and the bottom of the OEM Section is reserved for future chipset usages. 9. The Descriptor Upper MAP determines the length and base address of the Intel Management Engine VSCC Table. 10. The Intel Management Engine VSCC Table holds the JEDEC ID and the VSCC information of the entire SPI Flash supported by the NVM image. 11. OEM Section is 256 Bytes reserved at the top of the Flash Descriptor for use by OEM. 5.23.2.1 Descriptor Master Region The master region defines read and write access setting for each region of the SPI device. The master region recognizes three masters: BIOS, Gigabit Ethernet, and Intel Management Engine. Each master is only allowed to do direct reads of its primary regions. Table 5-58. Region Access Control Table Master Read/Write Access Datasheet Region CPU and BIOS Intel ME/(G)MCH GbE Controller Descriptor N/A N/A N/A BIOS CPU and BIOS can always read from and write to BIOS Region Read / Write Read / Write Intel Management Engine Read / Write Intel ME can always read from and write to Intel ME Region Read / Write Gigabit Ethernet Read / Write Read / Write GbE software can always read from and write to GbE region Platform Data Region N/A N/A N/A 233 Functional Description 5.23.3 Flash Access There are two types of flash accesses: Direct Access: • Masters are allowed to do direct read only of their primary region — Gigabit Ethernet region can only be directly accessed by the Gigabit Ethernet controller. Gigabit Ethernet software must use Program Registers to access the Gigabit Ethernet region. • Master's Host or Intel Management Engine virtual read address is converted into the SPI Flash Linear Address (FLA) using the Flash Descriptor Region Base/Limit registers Program Register Access: • Program Register Accesses are not allowed to cross a 4 KB boundary and can not issue a command that might extend across two components • Software programs the FLA corresponding to the region desired — Software must read the devices Primary Region Base/Limit address to create a FLA. 5.23.3.1 Direct Access Security • Requester ID of the device must match that of the primary Requester ID in the Master Section • Calculated Flash Linear Address must fall between primary region base/limit • Direct Write not allowed • Direct Read Cache contents are reset to 0s on a read from a different master — Supports the same cache flush mechanism in the ICH7, which includes Program Register Writes 5.23.3.2 Register Access Security • Only primary region masters can access the registers Note: Processor running Gigabit Ethernet software can access Gigabit Ethernet registers • Masters are only allowed to read or write those regions they have read/write permission • Using the Flash Region Access Permissions, one master can give another master read/write permissions to their area • Using the five Protected Range registers, each master can add separate read/write protection above that granted in the Flash Descriptor for their own accesses — Example: BIOS may want to protect different regions of BIOS from being erased — Ranges can extend across region boundaries 234 Datasheet Functional Description 5.23.4 Serial Flash Device Compatibility Requirements A variety of serial flash devices exist in the market. For a serial flash device to be compatible with the Intel ICH10 SPI bus, it must meet the minimum requirements detailed in the following sections. 5.23.4.1 Intel® ICH10 SPI Based BIOS Requirements A serial flash device must meet the following minimum requirements when used explicitly for system BIOS storage. • Erase size capability of at least one of the following: 64 KB, 8 KB, 4 KB, or 256 bytes. • Device must support multiple writes to a page without requiring a preceding erase cycle (Refer to Section 5.23.5) • Serial flash device must ignore the upper address bits such that an address of FFFFFFh aliases to the top of the flash memory. • SPI Compatible Mode 0 support (clock phase is 0 and data is latched on the rising edge of the clock). • If the device receives a command that is not supported or incomplete (less than 8 bits), the device must complete the cycle gracefully without any impact on the flash content. • An erase command (page, sector, block, chip, etc.) must set all bits inside the designated area (page, sector, block, chip, etc.) to 1 (Fh). • Status Register bit 0 must be set to 1 when a write, erase or write to status register is in progress and cleared to 0 when a write or erase is NOT in progress. • Devices requiring the Write Enable command mst automatically clear the Write Enable Latch at the end of Data Program instructions. • Byte write must be supported. The flexibility to perform a write between 1 byte to 64 bytes is recommended. • Hardware Sequencing requirements are optional in BIOS only platforms. • SPI flash parts that do not meet Hardware sequencing command set requirements may work in BIOS only platforms via software sequencing. 5.23.4.2 Integrated LAN Firmware SPI Flash Requirements A serial flash device that will be used for system BIOS and Integrated LAN or Integrated LAN only must meet all the SPI Based BIOS Requirements plus: • Hardware sequencing • 4, 8 or 64 KBytes erase capability must be supported. 5.23.4.2.1 SPI Flash Unlocking Requirements for Integrated LAN BIOS must ensure there is no SPI flash based read/write/erase protection on the GbE region. GbE firmware and drivers for the integrated LAN need to be able to read, write and erase the GbE region at all times. 5.23.4.3 Intel® Management Engine Firmware SPI Flash Requirements Intel Management Engine Firmware must meet the SPI flash based BIOS Requirements plus: • Hardware Sequencing. • Flash part must be uniform 4 KB erasable block throughout the entire device. • Write protection scheme must meet SPI flash unlocking requirements for Intel Management Engine. Datasheet 235 Functional Description 5.23.4.3.1 SPI Flash Unlocking Requirements for Intel Management Engine Flash devices must be globally unlocked (read, write and erase access on the Intel ME region) from power on by writing 00h to the flash’s status register to disable write protection. If the status register must be unprotected, it must use the enable write status register command 50h or write enable 06h. Opcode 01h (write to status register) must then be used to write a single byte of 00h into the status register. This must unlock the entire part. If the SPI flash’s status register has non-volatile bits that must be written to, bits [5:2] of the flash’s status register must be all 0h to indicate that the flash is unlocked. If there is no need to execute a write enable on the status register, then opcodes 06h and 50h must be ignored. After global unlock, BIOS has the ability to lock down small sections of the flash as long as they do not involve the Intel ME or GbE region. 5.23.4.4 Hardware Sequencing Requirements Table 5-59 contains a list of commands and the associated opcodes that a SPI-based serial flash device must support in order to be compatible with hardware sequencing. Table 5-59. Hardware Sequencing Commands and Opcode Requirements Commands 5.23.4.4.1 Opcode Notes Write to Status Register 01h Writes a byte to SPI flash’s status register. Enable Write to Status Register command must be run prior to this command. Program Data 02h Single byte or 64 byte write as determined by flash part capabilities and software. Read Data 03h Write Disable 04h Read Status 05h Write Enable 06h Outputs contents of SPI flash’s status register Fast Read 0Bh Enable Write to Status Register 50h or 60h Enables a bit in the status register to allow an update to the status register Erase Program mable 256B, 4 Kbyte, 8 Kbyte or 64 Kbyte Full Chip Erase C7h JEDEC ID 9Fh See Section . JEDEC ID Since each serial flash device may have unique capabilities and commands, the JEDEC ID is the necessary mechanism for identifying the device so the uniqueness of the device can be comprehended by the controller (master). The JEDEC ID uses the opcode 9Fh and a specified implementation and usage model. This JEDEC Standard Manufacturer and Device ID read method is defined in Standard JESD21-C, PRN03-NV. 236 Datasheet Functional Description 5.23.5 Multiple Page Write Usage Model The system BIOS and Intel Active Management Technology firmware usage models require that the serial flash device support multiple writes to a page (minimum of 512 writes) without requiring a preceding erase command. BIOS commonly uses capabilities such as counters that are used for error logging and system boot progress logging. These counters are typically implemented by using byte-writes to ‘increment’ the bits within a page that have been designated as the counter. The Intel AMT firmware usage model requires the capability for multiple data updates within any given page. These data updates occur via byte-writes without executing a preceding erase to the given page. Both the BIOS and Intel AMT firmware multiple page write usage models apply to sequential and non-sequential data writes. Note: This usage model requirement is based on any given bit only being written once from a 1-to-0 without requiring the preceding erase. An erase would be required to change bits back to the 1 state. 5.23.5.1 Soft Flash Protection There are two types of flash protection that are not defined in the flash descriptor supported by ICH10: 1. BIOS Range Write Protection 2. SMI#-Based Global Write Protection Both mechanisms are logically OR’d together such that if any of the mechanisms indicate that the access should be blocked, then it is blocked. Table 5-60 provides a summary of the mechanisms. Table 5-60. Flash Protection Mechanism Summary Mechanism Accesses Blocked Range Specific? Reset-Override or SMI#Override? Equivalent Function on FWH BIOS Range Write Protection Writes Yes Reset Override FWH Sector Protection Write Protect Writes No SMI# Override Same as Write Protect in previous ICHs for FWH A blocked command will appear to software to finish, except that the Blocked Access status bit is set in this case. 5.23.5.2 BIOS Range Write Protection The ICH10 provides a method for blocking writes to specific ranges in the SPI flash when the Protected BIOS Ranges are enabled. This is achieved by checking the Opcode type information (which can be locked down by the initial Boot BIOS) and the address of the requested command against the base and limit fields of a Write Protected BIOS range. Note: Datasheet Once BIOS has locked down the Protected BIOS Range registers, this mechanism remains in place until the next system reset. 237 Functional Description 5.23.5.3 SMI# Based Global Write Protection The ICH provides a method for blocking writes to the SPI flash when the Write Protected bit is cleared (i.e., protected). This is achieved by checking the Opcode type information (which can be locked down by the initial Boot BIOS) of the requested command. The Write Protect and Lock Enable bits interact in the same manner for SPI BIOS as they do for the FWH BIOS. 5.23.6 Flash Device Configurations The ICH10-based platform may use the serial flash in multiple configurations. The following table focuses on the supported configurations involving the ICH10 and Intel Active Management Technology. Configuration System BIOS Storage Intel® ICH10 Firmware Minimum Number of SPI Device(s) 1 SPI No 1 2 Non-SPI Yes 1 3 SPI Yes 1 4 Non-SPI No 0 Note: When SPI is selected for BIOS and a SPI device is detected by the ICH10, LPC based BIOS flash is disabled. Note: Firmware includes Intel Active Management Technology, ASF, Intel Quiet System Technology and Gigabit Ethernet. 5.23.7 SPI Flash Device Recommended Pinout The table below contains the recommended serial flash device pin-out for an 8-pin device. Use of the recommended pin-out on an 8-pin device reduces complexities involved with designing the serial flash device onto a motherboard and allows for support of a common footprint usage model (refer to Section 5.23.8.1). Table 5-61. Recommended Pinout for 8-Pin Serial Flash Device Pin # Signal 1 Chips Select 2 Data Output 3 Write Protect 4 Ground 5 Data Input 6 Serial Clock 7 Hold / Reset 8 Supply Voltage Although an 8-pin device is preferred over a 16-pin device due to footprint compatibility, the following table contains the recommended serial flash device pin-out for a 16-pin SOIC. 238 Datasheet Functional Description 5.23.8 Serial Flash Device Package Table 5-62. Recommended Pinout for 16-Pin Serial Flash Device 5.23.8.1 Pin # Signal Pin # Signal 1 Hold / Reset 9 Write Protect 2 Supply Voltage 10 Ground 3 No Connect 11 No Connect 4 No Connect 12 No Connect 5 No Connect 13 No Connect 6 No Connect 14 No Connect 7 Chip Select 15 Serial Data In 8 Serial Data Out 16 Serial Clock Common Footprint Usage Model To minimize platform motherboard redesign and to enable platform Bill of Material (BOM) selectability, many PC System OEM’s design their motherboard with a single common footprint. This common footprint allows population of a soldered down device or a socket that accepts a leadless device. This enables the board manufacturer to support, via selection of the appropriate BOM, either of these solutions on the same system without requiring any board redesign. The common footprint usage model is desirable during system debug and by flash content developers since the leadless device can be easily removed and reprogrammed without damage to device leads. When the board and flash content is mature for highvolume production, both the socketed leadless solution and the soldered down leaded solution are available through BOM selection. 5.23.8.2 Serial Flash Device Package Recommendations It is highly recommended that the common footprint usage model be supported. An example of how this can be accomplished is as follows: • The recommended pinout for 8-pin serial flash devices is used (refer to Section 5.23.7). • The 8-pin device is supported in either an 8-contact VDFPN (6x5 mm MLP) package or an 8-contact WSON (5x6 mm) package. These packages can fit into a socket that is land pattern compatible with the wide body SO8 package. • The 8-pin device is supported in the SO8 (150 mil) and in the wide-body SO8 (200 mil) packages. The 16-pin device is supported in the SO16 (300 mil) package. Datasheet 239 Functional Description 5.24 Intel® Quiet System Technology (Intel® QST) The ICH10 implements three PWM and 4 TACH signals for Intel Quiet System Technology (QST). Note: Intel Quiet System Technology functionality requires a correctly configured system, including an appropriate (G)MCH with Intel ME, Intel ME Firmware, and system BIOS support. 5.24.1 PWM Outputs This signal is driven as open-drain. An external pull-up resistor is integrated into the fan to provide the rising edge of the PWM output signal. The PWM output is driven low during reset, which represents 0% duty cycle to the fans. After reset de-assertion, the PWM output will continue to be driven low until one of the following occurs: • The internal PWM control register is programmed to a non-zero value by the Intel QST firmware. • The watchdog timer expires (enabled and set at 4 seconds by default). • The polarity of the signal is inverted by the Intel QST firmware. Note that if a PWM output will be programmed to inverted polarity for a particular fan, then the low voltage driven during reset represents 100% duty cycle to the fan. 5.24.2 TACH Inputs This signal is driven as an open-collector or open-drain output from the fan. An external pull-up is expected to be implemented on the motherboard to provide the rising edge of the TACH input. This signal has analog hysteresis and digital filtering due to the potentially slow rise and fall times. This signal has a weak internal pull-up resistor to keep the input buffer from floating if the TACH input is not connected to a fan. 5.25 Thermal Sensors ICH10 integrates two thermal sensors that monitor the temperature within its die. The thermal sensors are used for Intel Quiet System Technology (Intel QST). The Intel QST firmware can internally access the temperature measured by the sensors and use the data as a factor to determine how to control the fans. The ICH10 thermal sensors also provide the capability to protect the ICH10 under a catastrophic thermal situation. When the sensors are enabled and correctly programmed by the system BIOS, the ICH10 will shut down the system when the ICH10 thermal limit is reached. Refer to the Thermal Memory Mapped Configuration Registers Section 23.2 for more info on the catastrophic settings. 240 Datasheet Functional Description 5.26 Feature Capability Mechanism A set of registers is included in the ICH10 LPC Interface (Device 31, Function 0, offset E0h - EBh) that allows the system software or BIOS to easily determine the features supported by ICH10. These registers can be accessed through LPC PCI configuration space, thus allowing for convenient single point access mechanism for chipset feature detection. This set of registers consists of: Capability ID (FDCAP) Capability Length (FDLEN) Capability Version and Vendor-Specific Capability ID (FDVER) Feature Vector (FVECT) 5.27 Integrated Trusted Platform Module (Corporate Only) The integrated Trusted Platform Module (TPM) implementation consists of firmware, Intel Management Engine resources and dedicated hardware within the ICH and the (G)MCH. The integrated TPM supports all requirements of the TPM Specification Version 1.2, Level 2 Revision 103, as published by the Trusted Computing Group. Note: Integrated TPM functionality requires a correctly configured system, including an appropriate (G)MCH with Intel Management Engine firmware, ICH10 and SPI Flash. 5.27.1 Integrated TPM Hardware Requirements The following hardware components are required for TPM 1.2 functionality: 1. SPI Flash Memory: The SPI flash component connected to the ICH (SPI interface) provides non-volatile storage requirement for the integrated TPM. It contains the FW code which is loaded by the Intel Management Engine upon power on. 2. Monotonic Counters: The ICH10 contains four TPM 1.2 compliant monotonic counters that reside in the RTC well which maintains values programmed by the integrated TPM across power cycles. The counters are only incremented by TPM software (host or Intel ME) and are not controlled by the ICH hardware. 3. Physical Presence: Physical presence indication is required in order to enable certain TPM commands. These commands are generally used to bypass owner authorized commands when the authorization data is unavailable or to set the integrated TPM to a non-owner state. The Intel Management Engine Firmware uses the TPM_PP pin on the ICH10 to indicate Physical Presence to the platform when pulled high. In addition, Physical Presence flags can be set to force Physical Presence by firmware. 4. Chipset: An ICH10 and (G)MCH with Intel Management Engine enabled is required for integrated TPM support. Datasheet 241 Functional Description 5.27.2 Enabling integrated TPM The integrated TPM is enabled based on the combination of a functional straps on both the ICH and the (G)MCH and a soft strap bit found in the SPI Descriptor. When the integrated TPM is enabled, Front Side Bus cycles that would otherwise propagate to the LPC bus will be routed by the Config Bus Decoder to the integrated TPM Host Decoder. Either Functional strap or the soft strap bit may be used to disable the integrated TPM. • ICH Functional Strap: The ICH10 enables Integrated TPM when SPI_MOSI is sampled high on the rising edge of CLPWROK and disabled if the SPI_MOSI signal is sampled low. See Section 2.25.1 for details. The SPI_MOSI signal requires an external pull-up resistor to enable the integrated TPM. SPI_MOSI has an integrated pull-down resistor enabled at reset only and does not require an external pull-down resistor to disable integrated TPM. • Soft Strap: The integrated TPM Disable bit (bit 2) in the (G)MCHSTRP0 register (FSMBA + 0h) within the flash descriptor can act as an override to the functional straps on both the ICH and (G)MCH. When set, the integrated TPM will be disabled regardless of the values of the functional straps on the ICH and/or (G)MCH. This bit along with both functional straps must be appropriately configured to enable integrated TPM. • (G)MCH Functional Strap: For (G)MCH functional strap information, consult the appropriate (G)MCH documentation. §§ 242 Datasheet Ballout Definition 6 Ballout Definition This chapter contains the Intel® ICH10 ballout information. 6.1 Intel® ICH10 Ballout This section contains the ICH10 ballout. Figure 6-1 and Figure 6-2 show the ballout from a top of the package view. Table 6-1 is the BGA ball list, sorted alphabetically by signal name. Note: Notes for Figure 6-1, Figure 6-2, and Table 6-1 1. § symbol indicates a particular use of a pin is Cunsumer Only. 2. † symbol indicates a particular use of a pin is Corporate Only. Datasheet 243 Ballout Definition Figure 6-1. 1 Intel® ICH10 Ballout (Top view–Left Side) 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 GPIO27 VccLAN3_3 SLP_S3# GPIO24 / MEM_LED SMLINK0 A Vss VccLAN3_3 SLP_S4# Vss SMLINK1 B PLTRST# STP_PCI# / GPIO15 C GPIO14 / A Vss Vcc3_3 PIRQD# AD11 AD4 V5REF GNT1# / GPIO51 † GPIO12 JTAGDI / VccLAN1_1 QST_BMBU SY# B Vcc3_3 Vss PCICLK C AD24 AD25 AD26 D AD27 AD15 AD21 AD9 C/BE2# Vss AD8 AD14 DEVSEL# AD7 GNT2# / GPIO53 Vss AD1 § Vcc3_3 AD3 VccLAN1_1 AD0 GPIO57 / S4_STATE# TPM_PP / GPIO72† / / GPIO26 † TP0 JTAGTCK D LAN_RSTS LAN_RXD2 YNC E PIRQB# Vss PAR AD16 TRDY# AD10 C/BE3# AD2 AD6 AD18 AD5 F PIRQC# PIRQG# / GPIO4 AD29 PERR# Vss GNT3# / GPIO55 AD13 Vss STOP# C/BE0# Vss REQ2# / GPIO52 LAN_TXD1 LAN_TXD0 F G AD30 PIRQH# / GPIO5 Vcc3_3 AD23 AD20 AD17 REQ3# / GPIO54 C/BE1# AD19 Vcc3_3 FRAME# REQ1# / GPIO50 LAN_TXD2 LAN_RXD0 G H FWH1 / LAD1 Vss AD31 GNT0# AD22 Vcc3_3 PLOCK# Vss Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A AD12 Vss LAN_RXD1 VccSus3_3 H J FWH3 / LAD3 Vcc3_3 LDRQ1# / GPIO23 PIRQA# Vss AD28 IRDY# J K GPIO18 GPIO32 FWH0 / LAD0 SERR# PIRQE# / GPIO2 REQ0# Vcc3_3 K L SATACLKR EQ# / GPIO35 Vss RCIN# FWH4 / LFRAME# LDRQ0# PIRQF# / GPIO3 Vcc3_3 L M OC7# / GPIO31 CLK14 Vss FWH2 / LAD2 Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_1 M N OC5# / GPIO29 OC4# / GPIO43 OC1# / GPIO40 OC6# / GPIO30 SERIRQ GPIO0 / BMBUSY# SPKR Vcc1_1 Vss Vss Vss N P OC11# / GPIO47 Vss OC8# / GPIO44 OC0# / GPIO59 Vss OC2# / GPIO41 A20GATE Vss Vss Vss Vss P OC9# / GPIO45 OC3# / GPIO42 Vss Vcc1_1 Vss Vss Vss R CLPWROK OC10# / GPIO46 CK_PWRG D Vss Vss Vss Vss T Vcc1_1 Vss Vss Vss U R GPIO16 / INIT3_3V# DPRSLPVR SUS_STAT# / LPCPD / PCIRST# † GPIO61 SUSCLK / † PME# GPIO62 Vss PWRBTN# Vss E T Vcc1_5_A U VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 V USBP11N USBP11P Vss USBP9P USBP9N W Vss USBP10N USBP10P Vss Vss Y USBP8N USBP8P Vss USBP6P USBP6N Vss VccSus3_3 Y AA Vss USBP7P USBP7N Vss Vss Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A AA AB USBP5N USBP5P Vss USBP3P USBP3N Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A AC Vss USBP4P USBP4N Vss Vss VccSus1_1 Vss VccSusHDA VccHDA Vcc1_5_A Vss Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A AC AD USBP2N USBP2P Vss USBP0P USBP0N Vss VccSus1_5 Vss Vcc3_3 Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vss Vss AD AE Vss USBP1P USBP1N Vss Vss SATALED# Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_5_A Vss Vss Vss Vss AE GPIO20 GPIO33 Vss SATA5TXN Vss SATA4TXN Vcc1_5_A SATA3TXN Vss SATA2TXP Vss AF AF V5REF_Sus VccSus3_3 Vss AG USBRBIAS# USBRBIAS CLK48 AH HDA_SDIN2 AJ HDA_SDOU HDA_RST# HDA_SDIN3 T AK HDA_SYNC Vss 1 2 244 Vss Vss VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 Vcc1_1 Vss Vss Vss V VccSus3_3 VccSus3_3 Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_1 W AB AG HDA_BIT_C HDA_SDIN1 LK GPIO34 Vss SATA5TXP Vss SATA4TXP Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A SATA3TXP Vss SATA2TXN Vss AH Vss Vss SATARBIAS SATA5RXN Vss SATA4RXN Vcc1_5_A SATA3RXN Vss SATA2RXN Vss SATA1RXN AJ HDA_SDIN0 Vcc3_3 VccUSBPLL SATARBIAS SATA5RXP # Vss SATA4RXP Vcc1_5_A SATA3RXP Vss SATA2RXP Vss SATA1RXP AK 3 4 5 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 6 7 Datasheet Ballout Definition Figure 6-2. 16 Intel® ICH10 Ballout (Top view–Right Side) 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 DRAMPWR A TP6 VccSus3_3 B TP7 Vss GPIO9 † GPIO13 OK / GPIO8 RTCX1 VccRTC VccCL1_1 Vcc1_1 RTCRST# VccCL1_5 Vss VccSus3_3 RTCX2 Vss VccCL3_3 Vcc1_1 Vss SPI_MISO SST VccSus3_3 LAN_RST# VRMPWRG VccCL3_3 D Vcc1_1 PWROK SPI_MOSI VccGLAN VccGLANPL GLAN_COM 3_3 L PO STP_CPU# / † GPIO10 / SMBALERT# CPU_MISSI / GPIO11 / NG / † † JTAGTDO JTAGTMS TP5 B CL_VREF VccGLAN1_ VccGLAN1_ VccGLAN1_ 0 5 5 5 C PERn6 / PERp6 / GLAN_RXN GLAN_RXP D Vss Vss D E SMBDATA VccSus3_3 F GPIO56 SLP_M# G Vss Vss TP4 LINKALERT# / GPIO60 / SYS_RESE T# † JTAGRST# A GLAN_COM VccGLAN1_ PI 5 Vss GPIO25 C Vss WAKE# LAN100_SL P Vss INTVRMEN Vcc1_1 SPI_CS0# PETn6 / GLAN_TXN PETp6 / GLAN_TXP Vss Vss E TP3 Vss RSMRST# SPI_CS1# Vcc1_1 GLAN_CLK Vss Vss PERp5 PERn5 F SLP_S5# / † GPIO28 RI# CL_RST0# INTRUDER# CL_CLK0 SPI_CLK Vcc1_1 Vss PETn5 PETp5 Vss Vss G VccSus1_5 Vss SRTCRST# CL_DATA0 Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vss Vss Vss PERp4 PERn4 H J Vcc1_1 Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B PETn4 PETp4 Vss Vss J K Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss PERp3 PERn3 K L Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B PETn3 PETp3 Vss Vss L GPIO63 H SMBCLK VccSus1_1 M Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss PERp2 PERn2 M N Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B PETn2 PETp2 Vss Vss N P Vss Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss PERp1 PERn1 P R Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B PETn1 PETp1 Vss Vss R T Vss Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss VccDMIPLL T U Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_5_B DMI_CLKP DMI_CLKN Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B U V Vss Vss Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss DMI0TXP DMI0TXN V W Vss Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vcc1_1 Vss Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B DMI0RXP DMI0RXN Vss Vss W Y Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss DMI1TXP DMI1TXN Y AA Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B DMI1RXN DMI1RXP Vss Vss AA Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vss Vss DMI2TXP DMI2TXN AB PECI Vss Vcc1_5_B DMI2RXN DMI2RXP Vss Vss AC Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B DMI3TXN DMI3TXP AD AB AC Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vcc3_3 Vcc1_5_A Vcc3_3 IGNNE# AD Vss Vcc1_5_A Vss Vss SDATAOUT 1 / GPIO48 SATA5GP Vss SATA1GP / SATA2GP / SATA3GP / GPIO19 GPIO36 GPIO37 AE Vss Vcc1_5_A Vss Vss AF SATA1TXP Vcc1_5_A SATA_CLKN SATA_CLK P CPUPWRG THRMTRIP# D INIT# DPSLP# Vss DMI3RXP Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B Vcc1_5_B AE NMI Vss DMI3RXN DMI_IRCO MP Vss DMI_ZCOM P AF Vss VccDMI VccDMI AG Vss Vcc3_3 SATA4GP Vss TACH2 / GPIO6 SDATAOUT 0 / GPIO39 Vcc3_3 MCH_SYNC# SMI# INTR V_CPU_IO Vss Vcc3_3 AH AG AH SATA1TXN Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Vss Vss TACH0 / GPIO17 AJ Vss SATA0RXP Vcc1_5_A SATA0TXP Vss PWM0 PWM1 Vss SCLOCK / GPIO22 GPIO49 Vss FERR# A20M# STPCLK# V_CPU_IO AJ AK Vss SATA0RXN Vcc1_5_A SATA0TXN VccSATAPL L TACH1 / GPIO1 PWM2 TACH3 / GPIO7 SLOAD / GPIO38 SATA0GP / GPIO21 THRM# Vss DPRSTP# Vss Vss AK 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 Datasheet 245 Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name 246 Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # A20GATE P8 CL_CLK0 G22 GLAN_COMPI B29 A20M# AJ28 CL_DATA0 H21 GLAN_COMPO A29 AD0 C10 CL_RST0# G20 GNT0# H5 AD1 C8 CL_VREF0 C27 GNT1# / GPIO51 A7 AD2 E9 CLK14 M5 GNT2# / GPIO53 C7 AD3 C9 CLK48 AG3 GNT3# / GPIO55 F7 AD4 A5 CLPWROK T6 GPIO0 N7 AD5 E12 CPUPWRGD AD23 AD6 E10 DEVSEL# C6 C17 AD7 B7 DMI_CLKN U26 GPIO10 / CPU_MISSING / JTAGTMS† AD8 B6 DMI_CLKP U25 GPIO12 A8 AD9 B4 DMI_IRCOMP AF28 GPIO13 A19 AD10 E7 DMI_ZCOMP AF30 GPIO14 / JTAGTDI† / QST_BMBUSY#§ A9 AD11 A4 DMI0RXN W28 AD12 H12 DMI0RXP W26 GPIO16 / DPRSLPVR M2 AD13 F8 DMI0TXN V30 GPIO18 K1 AD14 C5 DMI0TXP V29 GPIO20 AF5 A14 AD15 D2 DMI1RXN AA26 GPIO24 AD16 E5 DMI1RXP AA28 GPIO27 A11 G18 AD17 G7 DMI1TXN Y30 GPIO28 AD18 E11 DMI1TXP Y29 GPIO32 K2 AF6 AD19 G10 DMI2RXN AC26 GPIO33 AD20 G6 DMI2RXP AC28 GPIO34 AH5 AJ25 AD21 D3 DMI2TXN AB30 GPIO49 AD22 H6 DMI2TXP AB29 GPIO56 F16 GPIO57 / TPM_PP / JTAGTCK† C12 GPIO72† / TP0 C13 AD23 G5 DMI3RXN AF26 AD24 C1 DMI3RXP AE26 AD25 C2 DMI3TXN AD29 AD26 C3 DMI3TXP AD30 AD27 D1 AD28 J7 DRAMPWROK† / GPIO8 A20 HDA_RST# AJ1 AD29 F3 FERR# AJ27 HDA_SDIN0 AK3 FRAME# G12 HDA_SDIN1 AH4 FWH0 / LAD0 K3 HDA_SDIN2 AH1 FWH1 / LAD1 H1 HDA_SDIN3 AJ3 FWH2 / LAD2 M7 HDA_SDOUT AJ2 FWH3 / LAD3 J1 HDA_SYNC AK1 FWH4 / LFRAME# L5 IGNNE# AC22 GLAN_CLK F25 INIT# AE23 INIT3_3V# M3 AD30 G1 AD31 H3 C/BE0# F11 C/BE1# G9 C/BE2# C4 C/BE3# E8 CK_PWRGD T8 GPIO9 A18 HDA_BIT_CLK AH3 Datasheet Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Datasheet Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Ball Name INTR AH27 PERn5 F30 REQ1# / GPIO50 G13 INTRUDER# G21 PERn6 / GLAN_RXN D29 REQ2# / GPIO52 F13 INTVRMEN E23 PERp1 P29 REQ3# / GPIO54 G8 IRDY# J8 PERp2 M29 RI# G19 LAN_RST# C21 PERp3 K29 RSMRST# F22 LAN_RSTSYNC E14 PERp4 H29 RTCRST# A25 LAN_RXD0 G15 PERp5 F29 RTCX1 A21 LAN_RXD1 H14 PERp6 / GLAN_RXP D30 RTCX2 B21 LAN_RXD2 E13 PERR# F5 LAN_TXD0 F15 PETn1 R26 S4_STATE# / GPIO26 C11 LAN_TXD1 F14 PETn2 N26 SATA_CLKN AF18 SATA_CLKP AF19 LAN_TXD2 G14 PETn3 L26 LAN100_SLP E21 PETn4 J26 LDRQ0# L6 PETn5 G26 LDRQ1# / GPIO23 J3 PETn6 / GLAN_TXN E26 LINKALERT# / GPIO60 / JTAGRST#† F18 MCH_SYNC# AH25 NMI AF24 OC0# / GPIO59 P5 OC1# / GPIO40 N3 OC2# / GPIO41 P7 OC3# / GPIO42 R7 OC4# / GPIO43 N2 OC5# / GPIO29 N1 OC6# / GPIO30 N5 OC7# / GPIO31 M1 OC8# / GPIO44 P3 OC9# / GPIO45 R6 OC10# / GPIO46 T7 OC11# / GPIO47 P1 PAR E3 PCICLK B3 PCIRST# R2 PECI AC23 PERn1 P30 PERn2 M30 PERn3 K30 PERn4 H30 PETp1 R28 PETp2 N28 PETp3 L28 PETp4 J28 PETp5 G28 PETp6 / GLAN_TXP E28 PIRQA# J5 PIRQB# E1 PIRQC# F1 PIRQD# A3 PIRQE# / GPIO2 K6 PIRQF# / GPIO3 L7 PIRQG# / GPIO4 F2 PIRQH# / GPIO5 G2 PLOCK# H8 PLTRST# C14 PME# R3 PWM0 AJ21 PWM1 AJ22 PWM2 AK22 PWRBTN# T3 PWROK C25 RCIN# L3 REQ0# K7 Ball # SATA0GP / GPIO21 AK25 SATA0RXN AK17 SATA0RXP AJ17 SATA0TXN AK19 SATA0TXP AJ19 SATA1GP / GPIO19 AE20 SATA1RXN AJ15 SATA1RXP AK15 SATA1TXN AH16 SATA1TXP AF16 SATA2GP / GPIO36 AE21 SATA2RXN AJ13 SATA2RXP AK13 SATA2TXN AH14 SATA2TXP AF14 SATA3GP / GPIO37 AE22 SATA3RXN AJ11 SATA3RXP AK11 SATA3TXN AF12 SATA3TXP AH12 SATA4GP AF22 SATA4RXN AJ9 SATA4RXP AK9 SATA4TXN AF10 SATA4TXP AH9 SATA5GP AD21 SATA5RXN AJ7 247 Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # SATA5RXP AK7 SATA5TXN AF8 SUS_STAT# / LPCPD / GPIO61† R1 SATA5TXP AH7 SUSCLK / GPIO62† R5 SYS_RESET# F19 TACH0 / GPIO17 AH21 SATACLKREQ# / GPIO35 L1 SATALED# AE7 TACH1 / GPIO1 AK21 SATARBIAS AJ6 TACH2 / GPIO6 AH22 SATARBIAS# AK6 TACH3 / GPIO7 AK23 SCLOCK / GPIO22 AJ24 THRM# AK26 THRMTRIP# AD24 DPRSTP# AK28 DPSLP# AE24 TP3 F20 TP4 E19 TP5 C18 TP6 A16 TP7 B16 TRDY# E6 USBP0N AD6 SDATAOUT0 / GPIO39 AH23 SDATAOUT1 / GPIO48 AD20 SERIRQ N6 SERR# K5 SLOAD / GPIO38 AK24 SLP_M# F17 SLP_S3# A13 SLP_S4# 248 Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name B13 † SLP_S5# / GPIO63 G17 SMBALERT# / GPIO11 / JTAGTDO† USBP0P AD5 C16 USBP10N W2 SMBCLK H16 USBP10P W3 SMBDATA E16 USBP11N V1 SMI# AH26 USBP11P V2 SMLINK0 A15 USBP1N AE3 SMLINK1 B15 USBP1P AE2 SPI_CLK G23 USBP2N AD1 SPI_CS0# E25 USBP2P AD2 SPI_CS1# F23 USBP3N AB6 SPI_MISO B26 USBP3P AB5 SPI_MOSI C26 USBP4N AC3 SPKR N8 USBP4P AC2 SRTCRST# H20 USBP5N AB1 SST C19 USBP5P AB2 STOP# F10 USBP6N Y6 USBP6P Y5 USBP7N AA3 STP_CPU# / GPIO25† B18 STP_PCI# / GPIO15 C15 USBP7P AA2 STPCLK# AJ29 USBP8N Y1 Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # USBP8P Y2 USBP9N V6 USBP9P V5 USBRBIAS AG2 USBRBIAS# AG1 V_CPU_IO AH28 V_CPU_IO AJ30 V5REF A6 V5REF_Sus AF1 Vcc1_1 A24 Vcc1_1 B24 Vcc1_1 C24 Vcc1_1 E24 Vcc1_1 F24 Vcc1_1 G24 Vcc1_1 H23 Vcc1_1 H24 Vcc1_1 J23 Vcc1_1 M12 Vcc1_1 M13 Vcc1_1 M15 Vcc1_1 M17 Vcc1_1 M18 Vcc1_1 M19 Vcc1_1 N12 Vcc1_1 N19 Vcc1_1 R12 Vcc1_1 R19 Vcc1_1 U12 Vcc1_1 U19 Vcc1_1 V12 Vcc1_1 V19 Vcc1_1 W12 Vcc1_1 W13 Vcc1_1 W15 Vcc1_1 W17 Vcc1_1 W18 Vcc1_1 W19 Vcc1_5_A AA7 Datasheet Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Datasheet Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Vcc1_5_A AA8 Vcc1_5_A AB7 Vcc1_5_A Vcc1_5_A Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Vcc1_5_B AD28 Vcc3_3 AC21 Vcc1_5_B AE28 Vcc3_3 AD10 AB8 Vcc1_5_B AE29 Vcc3_3 AF21 AB23 Vcc1_5_B AE30 Vcc3_3 AH24 Vcc1_5_A AC11 Vcc1_5_B J24 Vcc3_3 AH30 Vcc1_5_A AC13 Vcc1_5_B J25 Vcc3_3 AK4 Vcc1_5_A AC14 Vcc1_5_B K23 Vcc3_3 A2 Vcc1_5_A AC15 Vcc1_5_B K24 Vcc3_3 B1 Vcc1_5_A AC16 Vcc1_5_B K25 Vcc3_3 B9 Vcc1_5_A AC17 Vcc1_5_B L24 Vcc3_3 G3 Vcc1_5_A AC18 Vcc1_5_B L25 Vcc3_3 G11 Vcc1_5_A AC20 Vcc1_5_B M23 Vcc3_3 H7 Vcc1_5_A AD11 Vcc1_5_B M24 Vcc3_3 J2 Vcc1_5_A AD12 Vcc1_5_B M25 Vcc3_3 K8 Vcc1_5_A AD13 Vcc1_5_B N24 Vcc3_3 L8 Vcc1_5_A AD17 Vcc1_5_B N25 VccCL1_1 A23 Vcc1_5_A AE11 Vcc1_5_B P23 VccCL1_5 A26 Vcc1_5_A AE17 Vcc1_5_B P24 VccCL3_3 B23 Vcc1_5_A AF11 Vcc1_5_B P25 VccCL3_3 C23 Vcc1_5_A AF17 Vcc1_5_B R24 VccDMI AG29 Vcc1_5_A AH10 Vcc1_5_B R25 VccDMI AG30 Vcc1_5_A AH11 Vcc1_5_B T23 VccDMIPLL T30 Vcc1_5_A AH17 Vcc1_5_B T24 VccGLAN1_5 B30 Vcc1_5_A AH18 Vcc1_5_B T25 VccGLAN1_5 C28 Vcc1_5_A AJ10 Vcc1_5_B T26 VccGLAN1_5 C29 Vcc1_5_A AJ18 Vcc1_5_B T28 VccGLAN1_5 C30 Vcc1_5_A AK10 Vcc1_5_B U24 VccGLAN3_3 A27 Vcc1_5_A AK18 Vcc1_5_B U28 VccGLANPLL A28 Vcc1_5_A H10 Vcc1_5_B U29 VccHDA AC10 Vcc1_5_A H11 Vcc1_5_B U30 VccLAN1_1 A10 Vcc1_5_A T1 Vcc1_5_B V23 VccLAN1_1 B10 Vcc1_5_B AA23 Vcc1_5_B V24 VccLAN3_3 A12 Vcc1_5_B AA24 Vcc1_5_B V25 VccLAN3_3 B12 Vcc1_5_B AA25 Vcc1_5_B W24 VccRTC A22 Vcc1_5_B AB24 Vcc1_5_B W25 VccSATAPLL AK20 Vcc1_5_B AB25 Vcc1_5_B Y23 VccSus1_1 AC7 Vcc1_5_B AC25 Vcc1_5_B Y24 VccSus1_1 H17 Vcc1_5_B AD25 Vcc1_5_B Y25 VccSus1_5 AD8 Vcc1_5_B AD26 Vcc3_3 AC19 VccSus1_5 H18 249 Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name 250 Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # VccSus3_3 AF2 Vss AD14 Vss AJ5 VccSus3_3 A17 Vss AD15 Vss AJ8 VccSus3_3 B20 Vss AD16 Vss AJ12 VccSus3_3 C20 Vss AD18 Vss AJ14 VccSus3_3 E17 Vss AD19 Vss AJ16 VccSus3_3 H15 Vss AD22 Vss AJ20 VccSus3_3 U1 Vss AE1 Vss AJ23 VccSus3_3 U2 Vss AE5 Vss AJ26 VccSus3_3 U3 Vss AE6 Vss AK2 VccSus3_3 U5 Vss AE8 Vss AK8 VccSus3_3 U6 Vss AE9 Vss AK12 VccSus3_3 U7 Vss AE10 Vss AK14 VccSus3_3 U8 Vss AE12 Vss AK16 VccSus3_3 V8 Vss AE13 Vss AK27 VccSus3_3 W7 Vss AE14 Vss AK29 VccSus3_3 W8 Vss AE15 Vss AK30 VccSus3_3 Y8 Vss AE16 Vss A1 VccSusHDA AC9 Vss AE18 Vss A30 VccUSBPLL AK5 Vss AE19 Vss B2 VRMPWRGD C22 Vss AE25 Vss B5 Vss AA1 Vss AF3 Vss B8 Vss AA5 Vss AF7 Vss B11 Vss AA6 Vss AF9 Vss B14 Vss AA29 Vss AF13 Vss B17 Vss AA30 Vss AF15 Vss B19 Vss AB3 Vss AF20 Vss B22 Vss AB26 Vss AF23 Vss B25 Vss AB28 Vss AF25 Vss B27 Vss AC1 Vss AF29 Vss B28 Vss AC5 Vss AG28 Vss D28 Vss AC6 Vss AH2 Vss E2 Vss AC8 Vss AH6 Vss E15 Vss AC12 Vss AH8 Vss E18 Vss AC24 Vss AH13 Vss E22 Vss AC29 Vss AH15 Vss E29 Vss AC30 Vss AH19 Vss E30 Vss AD3 Vss AH20 Vss F6 Vss AD7 Vss AH29 Vss F9 Vss AD9 Vss AJ4 Vss F12 Datasheet Ballout Definition Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Datasheet Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Table 6-1. Intel® ICH10 Ballout by Signal Name Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Ball Name Ball # Vss F21 Vss P2 Vss U23 Vss F26 Vss P6 Vss V3 Vss F28 Vss P12 Vss V7 Vss G16 Vss P13 Vss V13 Vss G25 Vss P14 Vss V14 Vss G29 Vss P15 Vss V15 Vss G30 Vss P16 Vss V16 Vss H2 Vss P17 Vss V17 Vss H9 Vss P18 Vss V18 Vss H13 Vss P19 Vss V26 Vss H19 Vss P26 Vss V28 Vss H22 Vss P28 Vss W1 Vss H25 Vss R8 Vss W5 Vss H26 Vss R13 Vss W6 Vss H28 Vss R14 Vss W14 Vss J6 Vss R15 Vss W16 Vss J29 Vss R16 Vss W23 Vss J30 Vss R17 Vss W29 Vss K26 Vss R18 Vss W30 Vss K28 Vss R23 Vss Y3 Vss L2 Vss R29 Vss Y7 Vss L23 Vss R30 Vss Y26 Vss L29 Vss T2 Vss Y28 Vss L30 Vss T5 WAKE# E20 Vss M6 Vss T12 Vss M8 Vss T13 Vss M14 Vss T14 Vss M16 Vss T15 Vss M26 Vss T16 Vss M28 Vss T17 Vss N13 Vss T18 Vss N14 Vss T19 Vss N15 Vss T29 Vss N16 Vss U13 Vss N17 Vss U14 Vss N18 Vss U15 Vss N23 Vss U16 Vss N29 Vss U17 Vss N30 Vss U18 251 Ballout Definition 252 Datasheet Package Information 7 Package Information 7.1 Intel® ICH10 Package The ICH10 package information is shown in Figure 7-1, Figure 7-2, and Figure 7-3. Note: All dimensions, unless otherwise specified, are in millimeters. Figure 7-1. Intel® ICH10 Package (Top View) -A// 0.127 A -B- PIN #1 I.D (SHINY) 1.0 DIA X 0.15 DEPTH 9.0 X 9.0 FROM CENTER LINE 22.10 REF 0.127 A 4 X 45° TOP VIEW Datasheet 253 Package Information Figure 7-2. Intel® ICH10 Package (Bottom View) Figure 7-3. Intel® ICH10 Package (Side View) // 0.15 0.20 C -C- 3 SEATING PLANE SIDE VIEW § §§ 254 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics 8 Electrical Characteristics This chapter contains the DC and AC characteristics for the ICH10. AC timing diagrams are included. 8.1 Thermal Specifications Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Thermal Design Guidelines document for ICH10 thermal information. 8.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 8-1. Intel® ICH10 Absolute Maximum Ratings Parameter Maximum Limits Voltage on any 3.3 V Pin with respect to Ground -0.5 to Vcc3_3 + 0.5 V Voltage on any 5 V Tolerant Pin with respect to Ground (V5REF = 5 V) -0.5 to V5REF + 0.5 V 1.1 V Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5 to 2.1 V 1.25 V Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5V to 2.1V 1.5 V Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5 to 2.1 V 3.3 V Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5 to 4.6 V 5.0 V Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5 to 5.5 V V_CPU_IO Supply Voltage with respect to VSS -0.5 to 2.1 V 8.3 DC Characteristics Table 8-2. DC Current Characteristics (Consumer Only)1 Power Plane Symbol Datasheet Maximum Power Consumption S0 S3 S4/S5 G3 V5REF 2 mA N/A N/A N/A V5REF_Sus 2 mA 1 mA 1 mA N/A Vcc3_3 308 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSus3_3 212 mA 53 mA 53 mA N/A VccHDA6 32mA N/A N/A N/A VccSusHDA6 32 mA 1 mA 1 mA N/A VccGLAN3_3 1 mA N/A N/A N/A VccGLAN1_5 80 mA N/A N/A N/A VccLAN3_35 19 mA 78 mA 78 mA N/A 255 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-2. DC Current Characteristics (Consumer Only)1 Power Plane Symbol Maximum Power Consumption S0 S3 S4/S5 G3 Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccLAN3_3 in S3 Powered by VccLAN3_3 in S4/ S5 N/A VccCL3_3 19 mA 73 mA 73 mA N/A VccCL1_52 Powered by Vcc1_5_A in S0 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S4/S5 N/A VccCL1_12 Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S4/S5 N/A Vcc1_5_A 1.644 A N/A N/A N/A Vcc1_5_B 646 mA N/A N/A N/A Powered by Vcc1_5_A in S0 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S4/S5 N/A 1.634 A N/A N/A N/A Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S4/S5 N/A N/A N/A N/A 6 μA 50 mA N/A N/A N/A 2 mA N/A N/A N/A VccGLANPLL 23 mA N/A N/A N/A VccUSBPLL VccLAN1_12, 5 VccSus1_52 Vcc1_1 VccSus1_12 VccRTC3, 4 VccDMI 7 V_CPU_IO 11 mA N/A N/A N/A 7 VccDMIPLL 23 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSATAPLL 47 mA N/A N/A N/A NOTES: 1. These are estimated DC current numbers. 2. Internal voltage regulators power these wells inside the Intel ICH10 and current for these rails are accounted for in the sourcing voltage rail current requirements. 3. Only the G3 state of this rail is shown to provide an estimate of battery life. 4. Icc (RTC) data is taken with VccRTC at 3.0 V while the system is in a mechanical off (G3) state at room temperature. 5. The current for this rail in S3 and S4/S5 is based on the integrated LAN running at 10/100. 6. The current for this rail was measured with VccHDA and VccSusHDA set to 3.3 V. 7. The current for this rail was measured with VccDMI set to 1.5 V. 256 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-3. DC Current Characteristics (Corporate Only) Power Plane Symbol V5REF V5REF_Sus S0 S3 S4/S5 G3 1 mA N/A N/A N/A 2 mA 1 mA 1 mA N/A Vcc3_3 273 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSus3_3 212 mA 95 mA 95 mA N/A VccHDA6 30 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSusHDA6 31 mA 1 mA 1 mA N/A VccHDA8 10 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSusHDA8 11 mA 1 mA 1 mA N/A VccGLAN3_3 1 mA N/A N/A N/A VccGLAN1_5 62 mA N/A N/A N/A VccLAN3_35 17 mA 77 mA 77 mA N/A Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccLAN3_3 in S3 Powered by VccLAN3_3 in S3 N/A VccLAN1_12, 5 VccCL3_3 16 mA 70 mA 70 mA N/A VccCL1_52 Powered by Vcc1_5_A in S0 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 N/A VccCL1_12 Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 Powered by VccCL3_3 in S3 N/A Vcc1_5_A 1.390 A N/A N/A N/A Vcc1_5_B VccSus1_52 Vcc1_1 VccSus1_12 VccRTC3, 4 VccDMI7 V_CPU_IO 591 mA N/A N/A N/A Powered by Vcc1_5_A in S0 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 N/A 2.553 A N/A N/A N/A Powered by Vcc1_1 in S0 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 Powered by VccSus3_3 in S3 N/A N/A N/A N/A 6 μA 55 mA N/A N/A N/A 1 mA N/A N/A N/A VccGLANPLL 23 mA N/A N/A N/A VccUSBPLL 10 mA N/A N/A N/A VccDMIPLL7 22 mA N/A N/A N/A VccSATAPLL 42 mA N/A N/A N/A NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Datasheet Maximum Power Consumption These are estimated DC current numbers. Internal voltage regulators power these wells inside the Intel ICH10 and current for these rails are accounted for in the sourcing voltage rail current requirements. Only the G3 state of this rail is shown to provide an estimate of battery life. Icc (RTC) data is taken with VccRTC at 3.0 V while the system is in a mechanical off (G3) state at room temperature. The current for this rail in S3 and S4/S5 is based on the integrated LAN running at 10/100. The current for this rail was measured with VccHDA and VccSusHDA set to 3.3 V. The current for this rail was measured with VccDMI set to 1.5 V. The current for this rail was measured with VccHDA and VccSusHDA set to 1.5 V. 257 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-4. DC Characteristic Input Signal Association (Sheet 1 of 2) Symbol VIH1/VIL1 (5V Tolerant) VIH2/VIL2 Associated Signals PCI Signals: AD[31:0], C/BE[3:0]#, DEVSEL#, FRAME#, IRDY#, PAR, PERR#, PLOCK#, REQ[3:0]#, SERR#, STOP#, TRDY# Interrupt Signals: PIRQ[D:A]#, PIRQ[H:E]# GPIO Signals: GPIO[54, 52, 50, 5:2] Gigabit LAN Connect Signals: GLAN_RX[p,n] Clock Signals: CLK48 Power Management Signals: MCH_SYNC#, THRM#, VRMPWRGD, LAN_RST#, CLPWROK SATA Signals: SATAGP[5:4, 1:0]SATAGP[3:2] Interrupt Signals: SERIRQ VIH3/VIL3 Processor Signals: RCIN#, A20GATE USB Signals: OC[11:0]# GPIO Signals: GPIO[59, 55, 53, 51, 49:36, 35, 31:29, 22:16, 7:6, 1, 0], GPIO32 Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals: TACH[3:0] Strap Signals: GNT[3:0]#,SPKR, SATALED# (Strap purposes only) Clock Signals: CLK14, PCICLK LPC/Firmware Hub Signals: LAD[3:0]/FWH[3:0], LDRQ0#, LDRQ1# VIH4/VIL4 PCI Signals: PME# SPI Signals: SPI_MISO GPIO Signals: GPIO[33, 23] Strap Signals: SPI_MOSI, GNT0# (Strap purposes only) SMBus Signals: SMBCLK, SMBDATA, SMBALERT# VIH5/VIL5 System Management Signals: SMLINK[1:0], LINKALERT# VIH6/VIL6 LAN Signals: GLAN_CLK, LAN_RXD[2:0] VIH7/VIL7 Processor Signals: FERR#, THRMTRIP# VIMIN8/VIMAX8 VIH9/VIL9 VIMIN10/VIMAX10 GPIO Signals: GPIO[60, 11] PCI Express* Data RX Signals: PER[p,n][6:1] Real Time Clock Signals: RTCX1 SATA Signals: SATA[3:0]RX[P,N], SATA[5:4]RX[P,N] Intel® High Definition Audio Signals: HDA_SDIN[3:0] Strap Signals: HDA_SDOUT, HDA_SYNC (Strap purposes only) VIH11/VIL11 GPIO Signals: GPIO34 NOTE: See VIL_HDA/VIH_HDA for High Definition Audio Low Voltage Mode VIH12/VIL12/ Vcross(abs) VIH13/VIL13 Clock Signals: DMI_CLKN, DMI_CLKP, SATA_CLKN, SATA_CLKP Power Management Signals: PWRBTN#, RI#, SYS_RESET#, WAKE# GPIO Signals: GPIO[60, 57:56, 28:26, 24, 14:12, 10:8], GPIO[25, 15] Power Management Signals: PWROK, RSMRST# VIH14/VIL14 258 System Management Signals: INTRUDER# Miscellaneous Signals: INTVRMEN, LAN100_SLP, RTCRST#, SRTCRST# Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-4. DC Characteristic Input Signal Association (Sheet 2 of 2) Symbol VIH_CL/VIL_CL VDI / VCM / VSE (5 V Tolerant) VHSSQ / VHSDSC / VHSCM Associated Signals Controller Link: CL_CLK0, CL_DATA0 USB Signals: USBP[11:0][P,N] (Low-speed and Full-speed) USB Signals: USBP[11:0][P,N] (in High-speed Mode) (5 V Tolerant) Intel® High Definition Audio Signals: HDA_SDIN[3:0] VIH_HDA / VIL_HDA Strap Signals: HDA_SDOUT, HDA_SYNC (Strap purposes only) NOTE: Only applies when running in Low Voltage Mode (1.5 V) VIH_SST/VIL_SST Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals: SST VIH_PECI/VIL_PECI Intel® Quiet System Technology Signals: PECI 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Datasheet VDI = | USBPx[P] – USBPx[N] Includes VDI range Applies to Low-Speed/High-Speed USB PCI Express mVdiff p-p = 2*|PETp[x] – PETn[x]| GLAN mVdiff p-p = 2* |GLAN_RXp – GLAN_RXn| SATA Vdiff, RX (VIMAX10/MIN10) is measured at the SATA connector on the receiver side (generally, the motherboard connector), where SATA mVdiff p-p = 2*|SATA[x]RXP – SATA[x]RXN| VccRTC is the voltage applied to the VccRTC well of the ICH10. When the system is in a G3 state, this is generally supplied by the coin cell battery, but for S5 and greater, this is generally VccSus3_3. CL_Vref = 0.27 (VccCL1_5). CL_VREF0 applies to all configurations. Applies to Ultra DMA Modes greater than Ultra DMA Mode 4. This is an AC Characteristic that represents transient values for these signals. Applies to Hogh-Speed USB 2.0. 259 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-5. Symbol DC Input Characteristics (Sheet 1 of 2) Parameter Min Max Unit Notes VIL1 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.3(Vcc3_3) V VIH1 Input High Voltage 0.5(Vcc3_3) V5REF + 0.5 V VIL2 Minimum Input Voltage 200 — mVdiff p-p Note 5 VIH2 Maximum Input Voltage — 1350 mVdiff p-p Note 5 VIL3 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.8 V VIH3 Input High Voltage 2.0 3.3 V + 0.5 V Note 12 VIL4 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.3(3.3 V) V Note 12 VIH4 Input High Voltage 0.5(3.3 V) 3.3 V + 0.5 V Note 12 VIL5 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.8 V VIH5 Input High Voltage 2.1 3.3 V + 0.5 V Note 12 VIL6 Input Low Voltage -0.5 0.3(3.3 V) V Note 12 VIH6 Input High Voltage 0.6(3.3 V) 3.3 V + 0.5 V Note 12 VIL7 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.58(V_CPU_IO) V VIH7 Input High Voltage 0.73(V_CPU_IO) V_CPU_IO + 0.5 V VIMIN8 Minimum Input Voltage 175 — mVdiff p-p Note 4 VIMAX8 Maximum Input Voltage — 1200 mVdiff p-p Note 4 VIL9 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.10 V VIH9 Input High Voltage 0.40 1.2 V VIMIN10- Gen1i Minimum Input Voltage - 1.5 Gb/s internal SATA 325 — mVdiff p-p 6 VIMAX10-Gen1i Maximum Input Voltage - 1.5 Gb/s internal SATA — 600 mVdiff p-p 6 VIMIN10-Gen1m Minimum Input Voltage - 1.5 Gb/s eSATA 240 — mVdiff p-p 6 VIMAX10-Gen1m Maximum Input Voltage - 1.5 Gb/s eSATA — 600 mVdiff p-p 6 VIMIN10-Gen2i Minimum Input Voltage - 3.0 Gb/s internal SATA 275 — mVdiff p-p 6 VIMAX10-Gen2i Maximum Input Voltage - 3.0 Gb/s internal SATA — 750 mVdiff p-p 6 VIMIN10-Gen2m Minimum Input Voltage - 3.0 Gb/s eSATA 240 — mVdiff p-p 6 260 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-5. Symbol VIMAX10-Gen2m DC Input Characteristics (Sheet 2 of 2) Parameter Maximum Input Voltage - 3.0 Gb/s eSATA Min Max Unit Notes — 750 mVdiff p-p 6 VIL11 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.35(3.3 V) V Note 12 VIH11 Input High Voltage 0.65(3.3 V) 3.3 V + 0.5 V Note 12 VIL12 Input Low Voltage -0.150 0.150 V VIH12 Input High Voltage 0.660 0.850 V VIL13 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.8 V VIH13 Input High Voltage 2.0 3.3 V + 0.5 V VIL14 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.78 V VIH14 Input High Voltage 2.0 VccRTC + 0.5 V Note 7 VIL_CL Input Low Voltage –0.3 (CL_VREF - 0.075) V Note 8 VIH_CL Input High Voltage (CL_VREF + 0.075) 1.2 V Note 8 VIL_CL2 Input Low Voltage –0.5 0.3(VccCL3_3) V VIH_CL2 Input High Voltage 0.5(VccCL3_3) VccCL3_3 + 0.5 V 0.250 0.550 V Vcross(abs) Absolute Crossing Point Note 12 VDI Differential Input Sensitivity 0.2 — V Note 1,3 VCM Differential Common Mode Range 0.8 2.5 V Note 2,3 VSE Single-Ended Receiver Threshold 0.8 2.0 V Note 3 VHSSQ HS Squelch Detection Threshold 100 150 mV Note 11 VHSDSC HS Disconnect Detection Threshold 525 625 mV Note 11 VHSCM HS Data Signaling Common Mode Voltage Range –50 500 mV Note 11 VIL_HDA Input Low Voltage — 0.4(Vcc_HDA) V VIH_HDA Input High Voltage 0.6(Vcc_HDA) — V VIL_SST Input Low Voltage -0.5 0.4 V VIH_SST Input High Voltage 1.1 Vcc + 0.5 V VIL_PECI Input Low Voltage -0.5 0.275(V_CPU_IO) V VIH_PECI Input High Voltage 0.725(V_CPU_IO) V_CPU_IO + 0.5 V NOTES: 1. VDI = | USBPx[P] – USBPx[N] 2. Includes VDI range 3. Applies to Low-Speed/Full-Speed USB 4. PCI Express mVdiff p-p = 2*|PETp[x] - PETn[x]| 5. GLAN mVdiff p-p = 2* |GLAN_RXp - GLAN_RXn| 6. SATA Vdiff, RX (VIMAX10/MIN10) is measured at the SATA connector on the receiver side (generally, the motherboard connector), where SATA mVdiff p-p = 2*|SATA[x]RXP SATA[x]RXN| Datasheet 261 Electrical Characteristics 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Table 8-6. VccRTC is the voltage applied to the VccRTC well of the ICH10. When the system is in a G3 state, this is generally supplied by the coin cell battery, but for S5 and greater, this is generally VccSus3_3. CL_Vref = 0.27 (VccCL1_5). CL_VREF0 applies to all configurations. Applies to Ultra DMA Modes greater than Ultra DMA Mode 4 This is an AC Characteristic that represents transient values for these signals Applies to Hogh-Speed USB 2.0. 3.3 V refers to VccSus3_3 for signals in the suspend well and to Vcc3_3 for signals in the core well. See Table 3-2 or Table 3-3 for signal and power well association. DC Characteristic Output Signal Association (Sheet 1 of 2) Symbol VOH1/VOL1 Associated Signals Processor Signals: A20M#, IGNNE#, INIT#, INTR, NMI, SMI#, STPCLK#, CPUPWRGD, DPSLP# Power Management Signals: DPRSTP# PCI Signals: AD[31:0], C/BE[3:0]#, DEVSEL#, FRAME#, IRDY#, PAR, PERR#, PLOCK#, SERR#(1), STOP#, TRDY# VOH2/VOL2 Intel® High Definition Audio Signals: HDA_RST#, HDA_SDOUT, HDA_SYNC, HDA_BIT_CLK NOTE: See VOH_HDA/VOL_HDA for High Definition Audio Low Voltage Mode GPIO Signals: GPIO33 SMBus Signals: SMBCLK VOH3/VOL3 (1), SMBDATA (1) System Management Signals: SMLINK[1:0](1), LINKALERT# GPIO Signals: GPIO[60, 11] Power Management Signals: SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, SLP_S5#, SLP_M#, SUSCLK, SUS_STAT#/LPCPD#, CK_PWRGD, S4_STATE#, DPRSLPVR SATA Signals: SATACLKREQ#, SATALED#, SLOAD, SDATAOUT[1:0] VOH4/VOL4 GPIO Signals: GPIO[49:48, 39:35, 32:31, 26, 21:18, 16, 7:6, 0], GPIO32 Other Signals: SPKR Interrupt Signals: SERIRQ VOH5/VOL5 USB Signals: USBP[11:0][P,N] in Low-speed and Full-speed Modes VOMIN6/VOMAX6 PCI Express* Data TX Signals: PET[p,n][6:1] VOMIN7/VOMAX7 SATA Signals: SATA[5:4, 1:0]TX[P,N], SATA[3:2]TX[P,N] LPC/Firmware Hub Signals: LAD[3:0]/FWH[3:0], LFRAME#/FWH[4], INIT3_3V# Power Management Signal: PLTRST# PCI Signals: PCIRST#, GNT[3:0]#, PME#(1) VOH8/VOL8 Interrupt Signals: PIRQ[D:A], PIRQ[H:E]#(1) GPIO Signals: GPIO[58, 55:50, 34, 23:22, 17, 5:2, 1] SATA Signals: SCLOCK SPI Signals: SPI_CS0#, SPI_CS1#, SPI_MOSI, SPI_CLK LAN Signals: LAN_RSTSYNC, LAN_TXD[2:0] 262 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-6. DC Characteristic Output Signal Association (Sheet 2 of 2) Symbol Associated Signals Power Management Signals: STP_CPU#, STP_PCI# GPIO Signals: GPIO[60, 59, 57:56, 47:40, 31:27, 24, 15:12, 10:8], VOH9/VOL9 GPIO[25, 15] System Management Signals: LINKALERT#, VOMIN10/VOMAX10 Gigabit Lan Connect Signals: GLAN_TX[p,n] VHSOI VHSOH VHSOL USB Signals: USBP[11:0][P:N] in High-speed Mode VCHIRPJ VCHIRPK VOH_HDA/VOL_HDA Intel® High Definition Audio Signals: HDA_RST#, HDA_SDOUT, HDA_SYNC NOTE: Only applies when running in Low Voltage Mode (1.5 V) VOH_PWM/ VOL_PWM Intel® Quiet System Technology PWM: PWM[2:0](1) VOH_CL1/VOL_CL1 Link Controller Signals: CL_CLK0, CL_DATA0 VOH_CL2/VOL_CL2 Link Controller Signals: CL_RST0# VOH_SST/VOL_SST SST signal: SST VOH_PECI/ VOL_PECI PECI signal: PECI NOTE: 1. These signals are open-drain. Datasheet 263 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-7. Symbol DC Output Characteristics (Sheet 1 of 2) Parameter Min Max Unit IOL / IOH Notes Note 4 VOL1 Output Low Voltage — 0.255 V 3 mA VOH1 Output High Voltage V_CPU_IO - 0.3 — V -3 mA VOL2 Output Low Voltage — 0.1(3.3 V) V 1.5 mA Note 7 VOH2 Output High Voltage 0.9(3.3 V) — V -0.5 mA Note 7 VOL3 Output Low Voltage — 0.4 V 4 mA VOH3 Output High Voltage 3.3 V - 0.5 — V -2 mA VOL4 Output Low Voltage — 0.4 V 6 mA VOH4 Output High Voltage 3.3 V - 0.5 — V -2 mA VOL5 Output Low Voltage — 0.4 V 5 mA VOH5 Output High Voltage 3.3 V – 0.5 — V -2 mA Note 1 Note 7 Note 7 VOMIN6 Minimum Output Voltage 800 — mVdif fp-p Note 2 VOMAX6 Maximum Output Voltage — 1200 mVdif fp-p Note 2 VOMIN7-Gen1i,m Minimum Output Voltage 400 — mVdif fp-p Note 3 VOMAX7-Gen1i,m Maximum Output Voltage — 600 mVdif fp-p Note 3 VOMIN7-Gen2i,m Minimum Output Voltage 400 — mVdif fp-p Note 3 VOMAX7-Gen2i,m Maximum Output Voltage — 700 mVdif fp-p Note 3 VOL8 Output Low Voltage — 0.1(3.3 V) V 1.5 mA Note 7 VOH8 Output High Voltage 0.9(3.3 V) — V -0.5 mA Note 1, 7 VOL9 Output Low Voltage — 0.4 V 6 mA VOH9 Output High Voltage 3.3 V - 0.5 — V -0.5 mA 264 Note 7 VOMIN10 Minimum Output Voltage 750 — mVdif fp-p Note 6 VOMAX10 Maximum Output Voltage — 1350 mVdif fp-p Note 6 –10.0 10.0 mV VHSOI HS Idle Level VHSOH HS Data Signaling High 360 440 mV VHSOL HS Data Signaling Low –10.0 10.0 mV VCHIRPJ Chirp J Level 700 1100 mV VCHIRPK Chirp K Level –900 –500 mV Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-7. Symbol DC Output Characteristics (Sheet 2 of 2) Parameter Min Max Unit IOL / IOH V 5 mA VOL_PWM Output Low Voltage — 0.4 VOH_PWM Output High Voltage — — VOL_CL1 Output Low Voltage — 0.15 V VOH_CL1 Output High Voltage 0.485(VccCL1_5) — V VOL_CL2 Output Low Voltage — 0.1(VccCL1_5) V 1.5 mA VOH_CL2 Output High Voltage 0.9(VccCL1_5) — V -1.5 mA VOL_CL3 Output Low Voltage — 0.4 V 6 mA VOH_CL3 Output High Voltage VccCL3_3 -0.5 — V -0.5 mA VOL_SST Output Low Voltage — 0.3 V 0.5 mA VOH_SST Output High Voltage 1.1 — V -6 mA VOL_PECI Output Low Voltage — 0.25(V_CPU_IO) V 0.5 mA VOH_PECI Output High Voltage 0.75(V_CPU_IO) — VOL_HDA Output Low Voltage — 0.1(VccHDA) V 1.5 mA VOH_HDA Output High Voltage 0.9(VccHDA) — V -0.5 mA Notes Note 1 1 mA -6 mA NOTES: 1. The SERR#, PIRQ[H:A], SMBDATA, SMBCLK, LINKALERT#, SMLINK[1:0], and PWM[2:0] signal has an open-drain driver and SATALED# has an open-collector driver, and the VOH specification does not apply. This signal must have external pull up resistor. 2. PCI Express mVdiff p-p = 2*|PETp[x] – PETn[x]| 3. SATA Vdiff, tx (VOMIN7/VOMAX7) is measured at the SATA connector on the transmit side (generally, the motherboard connector), where SATA mVdiff p-p = 2*|SATA[x]TXP – SATA[x]TXN| 4. Maximum Iol for CPUPWRGD is 12 mA for short durations (<500 mS per 1.5 s) and 9 mA for long durations. 5. For INIT3_3V only, for low current devices, the following applies: VOL5 Max is 0.15 V at an IOL5 of 2 mA. 6. GLAN mVdiff p-p = 2*|GLAN_TXp – GLAN_TXn| 7. 3.3 V refers to VccSus3_3 for signals in the suspend well and to Vcc3_3 for signals in the core well. See Table 3-2 or Table 3-3 for signal and power well association. Datasheet 265 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-8. Other DC Characteristics (Sheet 1 of 2) Symbol V_CPU_IO V5REF CL_VREF Vcc3_3 Vcc1_5_A, Vcc1_5_B, VccUSBPLL, VccSATAPLL, VccDMIPLL VccGLANPLL Parameter Min Nom Max Unit Notes 0.945 — 1.3 V 1 4.75 5 5.25 V 1 Controller Link Reference Voltage 0.385 0.405 0.425 V 1, 3 I/O Buffer Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 Internal Logic and I/O Buffer Voltage 1.425 1.5 1.575 V 1 Processor I/F ICH10 Core Well Reference Voltage V5REF_Sus Suspend Well Reference Voltage 4.75 5 5.25 V 1 VccSus3_3 Suspend Well I/O Buffer Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 Vcc1_1 (Consumer Only) Internal Logic Voltage 0.998 1.1 1.155 V 1 Vcc1_1 Internal Logic Voltage (Corporate Only) 1.045 1.1 1.155 V 1 VccHDA High Definition Audio Controller Core Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 VccHDA (low voltage 1.5 V) High Definition Audio Controller Low Voltage Mode Core Voltage 1.425 1.5 1.575 V 1 Vcc_DMI DMI Buffer Voltage 1.188 1.25 1.312 V Vcc_DMI (ESI Mode Only) DMI Buffer Voltage 1.425 1.5 1.575 V LAN Controller I/O Buffer Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 VccGLAN1_5 Gigabit Lan Transmitter and Receiver Voltage 1.425 1.5 1.575 V 1 VccGLAN3_3 Gigabit Lan Internal Logic and I/O Buffer Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 Controller Link Buffer Voltage 3.135 — 3.465 V 1 2 — 3.465 V 1 High Definition Audio Controller Suspend Voltage 3.135 3.3 3.465 V 1 High Definition Audio Controller Low Voltage Mode Suspend Voltage 1.425 1.5 1.575 V 1 0.2 — — V |(USBPx+,USB Px–)| Includes VDI VccLAN3_3 VccCL3_3 VccRTC (G3-S0) VccSusHDA VccSusHDA (low voltage) VDI 266 Battery Voltage Differential Input Sensitivity VCM Differential Common Mode Range 0.8 — 2.5 V VCRS Output Signal Crossover Voltage 1.3 — 2.0 V VSE Single Ended Rcvr Threshold 0.8 — 2.0 V ILI1 ATA Input Leakage Current –200 — 200 µA (0 V < VIN < 5V) Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-8. Other DC Characteristics (Sheet 2 of 2) Symbol Parameter Min Nom Max Unit Notes ILI2 PCI_3V Hi-Z State Data Line Leakage –10 — 10 µA (0 V < VIN < Vcc3_3) ILI3 PCI_5V Hi-Z State Data Line Leakage –70 — 70 µA Max VIN = 2.7 V Min VIN = 0.5 V ILI4 Input Leakage Current – Clock signals –100 — +100 µA 2 CIN Input Capacitance – All Other — — 12 pF FC = 1 MHz COUT Output Capacitance — — 12 pF FC = 1 MHz CI/O I/O Capacitance — — 12 pF FC = 1 MHz Typical Value CL XTAL1 6 pF CL XTAL2 6 pF NOTES: 1. The I/O buffer supply voltage is measured at the ICH package pins. The tolerances shown in Table 8-8 are inclusive of all noise from DC up to 20 MHz. In testing, the voltage rails should be measured with a bandwidth limited oscilloscope that has a rolloff of 3 dB/decade above 20 MHz. 2. Includes CLK14, CLK48, GLAN_CLK and PCICLK 3. CL_VREF voltage applies when pin is driven by external circuit. Datasheet 267 Electrical Characteristics 8.4 AC Characteristics 1 Table 8-9. Clock Timings (Sheet 1 of 2) Sym Parameter Min Max Unit Notes Figure PCI Clock (PCICLK) t1 Period 30 33.3 ns 8-1 t2 High Time 12 — ns 8-1 t3 Low Time 12 — ns 8-1 t4 Rise Time — 3 ns 8-1 t5 Fall Time — 3 ns 8-1 14 MHz Clock (CLK14) t6 Period 67 70 ns 8-1 t7 High Time 20 — ns 8-1 t8 Low Time 20 — ns 8-1 t41 Rising Edge Rate 1.0 4.0 V/ns 5 t42 Falling Edge Rate 1.0 4.0 V/ns 5 1 48 MHz Clock (CLK48) fclk48 Operating Frequency 48.000 — MHz t9 Frequency Tolerance — 100 ppm High Time 7 — ns 8-1 t10 t11 Low Time 7 — ns 8-1 t12 Rise Time — 1.2 ns 8-1 t13 Fall Time — 1.2 ns 8-1 SMBus Clock (SMBCLK) fsmb Operating Frequency 10 100 KHz t18 High time 4.0 50 μs t19 Low time 4.7 — μs 8-10 t20 Rise time — 1000 ns 8-10 t21 Fall time — 300 ns 8-10 HDA_BIT_CLK fHDA (Intel® 2 8-10 High Definition Audio) Operating Frequency 24.0 MHz Frequency Tolerance — 100 ppm t26a Input Jitter (refer to Clock Chip Specification) — 300 ppm t27a High Time (Measured at 0.75 Vcc) 18.75 22.91 ns 8-1 t28a Low Time (Measured at 0.35 Vcc) 18.75 22.91 ns 8-1 SATA Clock (SATA_CLKP, SATA_CLKN) / DMI Clock (DMI_CLKP, DMI_CLKN) t36 268 Period 9.997 10.0533 ns Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-9. Clock Timings (Sheet 2 of 2) Sym tsatasl Parameter Min Max 1 8 Slew rate Unit Notes V/ns 7 kHz 4 Figure Suspend Clock (SUSCLK) fsusclk Operating Frequency 32 t39 High Time 10 — μs 4 t39a Low Time 10 — μs 4 MHz 6 Gigabit Internet Clock (GLAN_CLK) tglanclk Operating Fequency 5 62.5 tglanhi High Time 6.4 — ns tglanlo Low Time 6.4 — ns tglansl Slew rate 1.0 4 V/ns Intel® Quiet System Technology fpwm PWM Operating Frequency 10 28,000 Hz NOTES: 1. The CLK48 expects a 40/60% duty cycle. 2. The maximum high time (t18 Max) provide a simple ensured method for devices to detect bus idle conditions. 3. BITCLK Rise and Fall times are measured from 10%VDD and 90%VDD. 4. SUSCLK duty cycle can range from 30% minimum to 70% maximum. 5. CLK14 edge rates in a system as measured from 0.8 V to 2.0 V. 6. The active frequency can be 5 MHz, 50 MHz or 62.5 MHz depending on the interface speed. Dynamic changes of the normal operating frequency are not allowed. 7. See CK505 Clock Synthesizer Specification for measurement procedure. Table 8-10. PCI Interface Timing Sym Datasheet Parameter Min Max Units Notes Figure 2 11 ns 1 8-2 t40 AD[31:0] Valid Delay t41 AD[31:0] Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 7 — ns 8-3 t42 AD[31:0] Hold Time from PCICLK Rising 0 — ns 8-3 t43 C/BE[3:0]#, FRAME#, TRDY#, IRDY#, STOP#, PAR, PERR#, PLOCK#, DEVSEL# Valid Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 11 ns t44 C/BE[3:0]#, FRAME#, TRDY#, IRDY#, STOP#, PAR, PERR#, PLOCK#, IDSEL, DEVSEL# Output Enable Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 t45 C/BE[3:0]#, FRAME#, TRDY#, IRDY#, STOP#, PERR#, PLOCK#, DEVSEL#, GNT[A:B]# Float Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 t46 C/BE[3:0]#, FRAME#, TRDY#, IRDY#, STOP#, SERR#, PERR#, DEVSEL#, Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 7 28 1 8-2 ns 8-6 ns 8-4 ns 8-3 269 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-10. PCI Interface Timing Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Figure t47 C/BE[3:0]#, FRAME#, TRDY#, IRDY#, STOP#, SERR#, PERR#, DEVSEL#, REQ[A:B]# Hold Time from PCLKIN Rising 0 — ns 8-3 t48 PCIRST# Low Pulse Width 1 ms 8-5 t49 GNT[3:0]# Valid Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 12 ns t50 REQ[3:0]# Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 12 — ns NOTE: 1. Refer to note 3 of table 4-4 in Section 4.2.2.2 and note 2 of table 4-6 in Section 4.2.3.2 of the PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3 for measurement details. Table 8-11. Universal Serial Bus Timing Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig Full-speed Source (Note 7) t100 USBPx+, USBPx- Driver Rise Time 4 20 ns 1, CL = 50 pF 8-7 t101 USBPx+, USBPx- Driver Fall Time 4 20 ns 1, CL = 50 pF 8-7 –3.5 –4 3.5 4 ns ns 2, 3 8-8 - For Paired Transitions t103 Source SE0 interval of EOP 160 175 ns 4 8-9 t104 Source Jitter for Differential Transition to SE0 Transition –2 5 ns 5 –18.5 –9 18.5 9 ns ns 3 8-8 4 8-9 Source Differential Driver Jitter t102 - To Next Transition Receiver Data Jitter Tolerance t105 - T o Next Transition - For Paired Transitions t106 EOP Width: Must accept as EOP 82 — ns t107 Width of SE0 interval during differential transition — 14 ns Low-speed Source (Note 8) t108 USBPx+, USBPx – Driver Rise Time 75 300 ns 1, 6 CL = 50 pF CL = 350 pF 8-7 t109 USBPx+, USBPx – Driver Fall Time 75 300 ns 1,6 CL = 50 pF CL = 350 pF 8-7 –25 –14 25 14 ns ns 2, 3 8-8 For Paired Transitions t111 Source SE0 interval of EOP 1.25 1.50 µs 4 8-9 t112 Source Jitter for Differential Transition to SE0 Transition –40 100 ns 5 Source Differential Driver Jitter t110 270 To Next Transition Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-11. Universal Serial Bus Timing Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig Full-speed Source (Note 7) t113 Receiver Data Jitter Tolerance - To Next Transition- For Paired Transitions –152 –200 152 200 ns ns 3 8-8 t114 EOP Width: Must accept as EOP 670 — ns 4 8-9 t115 Width of SE0 interval during differential transition — 210 ns NOTES: 1. Driver output resistance under steady state drive is spec’d at 28 ohms at minimum and 43 ohms at maximum. 2. Timing difference between the differential data signals. 3. Measured at crossover point of differential data signals. 4. Measured at 50% swing point of data signals. 5. Measured from last crossover point to 50% swing point of data line at leading edge of EOP. 6. Measured from 10% to 90% of the data signal. 7. Full-speed Data Rate has minimum of 11.97 Mb/s and maximum of 12.03 Mb/s. 8. Low-speed Data Rate has a minimum of 1.48 Mb/s and a maximum of 1.52 Mb/s. Table 8-12. SATA Interface Timings Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes UI Gen I Operating Data Period 666.43 670.23 ps UI-2 Gen II Operating Data Period (3Gb/s) 333.21 335.11 ps t120 Rise Time 0.15 0.41 UI 1 t121 Fall Time 0.15 0.41 UI 2 t122 TX differential skew — 20 ps t123 COMRESET 310.4 329.6 ns 3 t124 COMWAKE transmit spacing 103.5 109.9 ns 3 t125 OOB Operating Data period 646.67 686.67 ns 4 Figure NOTES: 1. 20% – 80% at transmitter 2. 80% – 20% at transmitter 3. As measured from 100 mV differential crosspoints of last and first edges of burst. 4. Operating data period during Out-Of-Band burst transmissions. Datasheet 271 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-13. SMBus Timing Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig t130 Bus Free Time Between Stop and Start Condition 4.7 — µs 8-10 t131 Hold Time after (repeated) Start Condition. After this period, the first clock is generated. 4.0 — µs 8-10 t132 Repeated Start Condition Setup Time 4.7 — µs 8-10 t133 Stop Condition Setup Time 4.0 — µs 8-10 t134 Data Hold Time 0 — ns 4 8-10 t135 Data Setup Time 250 — ns t136 Device Time Out 25 35 ms 1 8-10 t137 Cumulative Clock Low Extend Time (slave device) — 25 ms 2 8-11 t138 Cumulative Clock Low Extend Time (master device) — 10 ms 3 8-11 NOTES: 1. A device will timeout when any clock low exceeds this value. 2. t137 is the cumulative time a slave device is allowed to extend the clock cycles in one message from the initial start to stop. If a slave device exceeds this time, it is expected to release both its clock and data lines and reset itself. 3. t138 is the cumulative time a master device is allowed to extend its clock cycles within each byte of a message as defined from start-to-ack, ack-to-ack or ack-to-stop. 4. t134 has a minimum timing for I2C of 0 ns, while the minimum timing for SMBus is 300 ns. Table 8-14. Intel® High Definition Audio Timing 272 Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig t143 Time duration for which HDA_SDOUT is valid before HDA_BIT_CLK edge. 7 — ns 8-13 t144 Time duration for which HDA_SDOUT is valid after HDA_BIT_CLK edge. 7 — ns 8-13 t145 Setup time for HDA_SDIN[3:0] at rising edge of HDA_BIT_CLK 15 — ns 8-13 t146 Hold time for HDA_SDIN[3:0] at rising edge of HDA_BIT_CLK 0 — ns 8-13 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-15. LPC Timing Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig 11 ns 8-2 ns 8-6 t150 LAD[3:0] Valid Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 t151 LAD[3:0] Output Enable Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 t152 LAD[3:0] Float Delay from PCICLK Rising — 28 ns 8-4 t153 LAD[3:0] Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 7 — ns 8-3 t154 LAD[3:0] Hold Time from PCICLK Rising 0 — ns 8-3 t155 LDRQ[1:0]# Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 12 — ns 8-3 t156 LDRQ[1:0]# Hold Time from PCICLK Rising 0 — ns 8-3 t157 LFRAME# Valid Delay from PCICLK Rising 2 12 ns 8-2 Min Max Units Table 8-16. Miscellaneous Timings Sym Parameter Notes Fig t160 SERIRQ Setup Time to PCICLK Rising 7 — ns 8-3 t161 SERIRQ Hold Time from PCICLK Rising 0 — ns 8-3 t162 RI#, EXTSMI#, GPIO, USB Resume Pulse Width 2 — RTCCLK 8-5 t163 SPKR Valid Delay from OSC Rising — 200 ns 8-2 t164 SERR# Active to NMI Active — 200 ns t165 IGNNE# Inactive from FERR# Inactive — 230 ns 1 Table 8-17. SPI Timings (20 MHz) Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes MHz 1 Fig t180 Serial Clock Frequency - 20M Hz Operation 17.2 18.4 t182 SPI Clock Duty cycle at the host 40% 60% t183 Tco of SPI_MOSI with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host -5 13 ns 8-12 t184 Setup of SPI_MISO with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host 16 — ns 8-12 t185 Hold of SPI_MISO with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host 0 — ns 8-12 t186 Setup of SPI_CS[1:0]# assertion with respect to serial clock rising at the host 30 — ns 8-12 t187 Hold of SPI_CS[1:0]# deassertion with respect to serial clock falling at the host 30 — ns 8-12 8-12 NOTE: 1. The typical clock frequency driven by the ICH10 is 17.86 MHz. Datasheet 273 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-18. SPI Timings (33 MHz) Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes MHz 1 Fig t180b Serial Clock Frequency - 33 MHz Operation 30.3 32.19 t182b SPI Clock Duty cycle at the host 48% 52% t183b Tco of SPI_MOSI with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host -5 5 ns 8-12 t184b Setup of SPI_MISO with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host 8 — ns 8-12 t185b Hold of SPI_MISO with respect to serial clock falling edge at the host 0 — ns 8-12 t186b Setup of SPI_CS[1:0]# assertion with respect to serial clock rising at the host 30 — ns 8-12 t187b Hold of SPI_CS[1:0]# deassertion with respect to serial clock falling at the host 30 — ns 8-12 8-12 NOTE: 1. The typical clock frequency driven by the ICH10 is 31.25 MHz. Table 8-19. SST Timings Sym tBIT Parameter Min Max Units Bit time (overall time evident on SST) 0.495 500 µs Bit time driven by an originator 0.495 250 µs tBIT,jitter Bit time jitter between adjacent bits in an SST message header or data bytes after timing has been negotiated — — % tBIT,drift Change in bit time across a SST address or SST message bits as driven by the originator. This limit only applies across tBIT-A bit drift and tBIT-M drift. — — % tH1 High level time for logic '1' 0.6 0.8 x tBIT tH0 High level time for logic '0' 0.2 0.4 x tBIT tSSTR Rise time (measured from VOL = 0.3V to VIH,min) — 25 + 5 ns/ node tSSTF Fall time (measured from VOH = 1.1V to VIL,max) — 33 ns/ node Notes 1 Fig - 2 NOTES: 1. The originator must drive a more restrictive time to allow for quantized sampling errors by a client yet still attain the minimum time less than 500 µs. tBIT limits apply equally to tBITA and tBIT-M. ICH10 is targeted on 1 Mbps which is 1 µs bit time. 2. The minimum and maximum bit times are relative to tBIT defined in the Timing Negotiation pulse. 3. tBIT-A is the negotiated address bit time and tBIT-M is the negotiated message bit time. 274 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-20. PECI Timings Sym tBIT Parameter Bit time (overall time evident on PECI) Bit time driven by an originator Min Max Units 0.495 500 µs 0.495 250 µs tBIT,jitter Bit time jitter between adjacent bits in an PECI message header or data bytes after timing has been negotiated — — % tBIT,drift Change in bit time across a PECI address or PECI message bits as driven by the originator. This limit only applies across tBIT-A bit drift and tBIT-M drift. — — % Notes Fig 1 tH1 High level time for logic '1' 0.6 0.8 x tBIT tH0 High level time for logic '0' 0.2 0.4 x tBIT 2 tPECIR Rise time (measured from VOL to VIH,min, Vtt(nom) -5%) — 30 + 5 ns/ node 3 tPECIF Fall time (measured from VOH to VIL,max, Vtt(nom) +5%) — 30 ns/ node 3 NOTES: 1. The originator must drive a more restrictive time to allow for quantized sampling errors by a client yet still attain the minimum time less than 500 µs. tBIT limits apply equally to tBITA and tBIT-M. ICH10 is targeted on 2 MHz which is 500 ns bit time. 2. The minimum and maximum bit times are relative to tBIT defined in the Timing Negotiation pulse. 3. Extended trace lengths may appear as additional nodes. 4. tBIT-A is the negotiated address bit time and tBIT-M is the negotiated message bit time. Table 8-21. Power Sequencing and Reset Signal Timings (Sheet 1 of 2) Sym Datasheet Parameter Min Max Units 18 — ms Notes Fig t200 VccRTC active to RTCRST# inactive 8-14 t201 V5REF_Sus active to VccSus3_3 active 0 — ms 1 8-14 t202 VccSus3_3 active to VccSus1_1 active — — — 2 8-14 t203 VccRTC supply active to VccSus supplies active 0 — ms 3, 9 8-14 t204 VccSus supplies active to RSMRST# inactive 10 — ms 9 8-14 8-15 t209 V5REF active to Vcc3_3 active 0 — ms 1 8-14 t211 Vcc1_5 active to V_CPU_IO active — — – 4 8-14 t212 VRMPWRGD active to PWROK active 5 — ms t213 VccSus supplies active to Vcc supplies active 0 — ms 8-15 8-17 9, 10 8-14 275 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-21. Power Sequencing and Reset Signal Timings (Sheet 2 of 2) Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes Fig 99 — ms 10 8-14 8-15 8-17 t217 PWROK and VRMPWRGD active to SUS_STAT# inactive and Processor interface signals latched to strap value (Consumer Only) 33 71 RTCCLK 5, 6, 8 8-15 8-17 t217 PWROK and VRMPWRGD active to SUS_STAT# inactive and Processor interface signals latched to strap value (Corporate Only) 33 — RTCCLK 5, 6, 8 8-15 8-17 t218 SUS_STAT# inactive to PLTRST# inactive (Consumer Only) 2 — RTCCLK 6 8-15 8-17 t218 SUS_STAT# inactive to PLTRST# inactive (Corporate Only) 60 — µs t219 PLTRST# assertion to VccGLANPLL inactive for platforms using ICH10 integrated GbE LAN 200 — μs t228 HDA_RST# active low pulse width 1 — μs t229 HDA_RST# inactive to HDA_BIT_CLK startup delay 162.8 — ns Vcc supplies active to PWROK t214 Note: PWROK assertion indicates that PCICLK has been stable for at least 1 ms. 8-15 8-17 7 NOTES: 1. V5REF must be powered up before Vcc3_3, or after Vcc3_3 within 0.7 V. Also, V5REF must power down after Vcc3_3, or before Vcc3_3 within 0.7 V. 2. The associated 3.3 V and 1.1 V supplies are assumed to power up or down ‘together’. 3. The VccSus supplies must never be active while the VccRTC supply is inactive. 4. a) Vcc1_5 must power up before V_CPU_IO or after V_CPU_IO within 0.7 V, b) V_CPU_IO must power down before Vcc1_5 or after Vcc1_5 within 0.7 V. 5. INIT# value determined by value of the CPU BISTEnable bit (Chipset Configuration Register Offset 3414h: bit 2). 6. These transitions are clocked off the internal RTC. 1 RTC clock is approximately from 28.992 µs to 32.044 µs 7. “VccGLANPLL inactive" is defined for this timing to be when VccGLANPLL drops to 1.425 V or less, as measured at the ICH10. This timing applies only to platforms using ICH10 integrated GbE LAN. 8. Maximum timing may be exceeded in a Intel Management Engine enabled system. 9. VccSus supplies include VccSus3_3, V5REF_Sus, VccSusHDA, VccLAN3_3 (if LAN powered in S3/S4/S5), and VccCL3_3 (if controller link powered in S3/S4/S5). 10. Vcc includes Vcc1_5_A, Vcc1_5_B, Vcc3_3, Vcc1_1, VccUSBPLL, VccDMIPLL, VccSATAPLL, V5REF, V_CPU_IO, VccDMI, VccHDA, VccGLANPLL, VccGLAN3_3 and VccGLAN1_5 (if integrated Gigabit LAN enabled), VccLAN3_3 (if LAN only power in S0), and VccCL3_3 (if controller link only powered in S0). 276 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics . Table 8-22. Power Management Timings (Sheet 1 of 3) Sym Min Max Units VccSus active to SLP_S5#, SLP_S4#, SLP_S3#, SUS_STAT#, PLTRST# and PCIRST#active — 50 ns t232 RSMRST# inactive to SUSCLK running, SLP_S5# inactive — 110 ms t233 SLP_S5# inactive to SLP_S4# inactive t230 t231 Parameter See Note Below 6, 22 8-15 8-15 1 8-15 8-17 8-21 8-22 9 8-18 8-19 8-20 11 8-19 8-20 PCICLK 3 8-19 8-20 PCICLK 3, 10 8-19 8-20 SLP_S4# inactive to SLP_S3# inactive 1 Note 16 t250 Processor I/F signals latched prior to STPCLK# active 0 — t251 Bus Master Idle to DPSLP# active 3.36 — µs t252 DMI message to PMSYNC# assertion 0 — PCICLK t253 DPSLP# active to STP_CPU# active 1 1 t254 STP_CPU# active to processor clock stopped 0 — t255 STP_CPU# active to DPRSTP#, DPRSLPVR active 0 — 1.5 1.8 Break Event to DPRSTP#, DPRSLPVR inactive Fig 8-15 8 t234 t265 Notes RTCCLK 8-20 µs 12 8-20 (C4 Exit) t266a t267 Break Event to STP_CPU# inactive (C3 Exit) Programable. See D31:F0:AA, bits 3:2 µs 8-20 6 Note 14 PCICLK 3, 13, 14 8-19 t268 STP_CPU# inactive to processor clock running 0 3 PCICLK 3, 10 8-19 8-20 t269 STP_CPU# inactive to DPSLP# inactive 1 1 PCICLK 3, 7 8-19 8-20 t270 DPSLP# inactive to STPCLK# inactive 0 µs 8-19 8-20 0 ns 8-18 t273 Datasheet DPRSLPVR, DPRSTP# inactive to STP_CPU# inactive and CPU Vcc ramped Break Event to STPCLK# inactive (C2 Exit) t274 STPCLK# inactive to processor I/F signals unlatched 8 t280 STPCLK# active to DMI Message 0 t281 DMI Message to CPUSLP# active 60 9 63 PCICLK 3, 9 8-18 8-19 8-20 PCICLK 2 8-16 8-17 PCICLK 3 8-16 277 Electrical Characteristics Table 8-22. Power Management Timings (Sheet 2 of 3) Sym Min Max Units Notes Fig RTCCLK 1 8-17 t283 DMI Message to SUS_STAT# active 2 t284 SUS_STAT# active to PLTRST#, PCIRST# active 7 17 RTCCLK 1 8-17 t287 PLTRST#, PCIRST# active to SLP_S3# active (Consumer Only) 1 2 RTCCLK 1 8-17 t287 PLTRST#, PCIRST# active to SLP_S3# active (Corporate Only) 1 — RTCCLK 1 8-17 ms 4 8-17 t289 SLP_S3# active to PWROK, VRMPWRGD inactive 0 t291 SLP_S3# active to SLP_S4# active (Consumer Only) 1 2 RTCCLK 1 8-17 t291 SLP_S3# active to SLP_S4# active (Corporate Only) 1 — RTCCLK 1 8-17 ns 23, 25 8-17 8-25 t294 278 Parameter PWROK, VRMPWRGD inactive to Vcc supplies inactive (nominal voltage -5%) 20 t295 SLP_S4# active to SLP_S5# active (Consumer Only) 1 2 RTCCLK 1, 5 8-17 t295 SLP_S4# active to SLP_S5# active (Corporate Only) 1 — RTCCLK 1, 5 8-17 t296 Wake Event to SLP_S5# inactive 1 10 RTCCLK 1 8-17 t297 SLP_S5# inactive to SLP_S4# inactive 1 — RTCCLK 8 8-17 8-21 8-22 8-23 t298 S4_STATE# inactive to SLP_S3# inactive (Consumer Only) 1 Note 16 RTCCLK 1 8-23 t298 S4_STATE# inactive to SLP_S3# inactive (Corporate Only) 1 — RTCCLK 1 8-23 t299 S4 Wake Event to SLP_S4# inactive (S4 Wake) 8 8-17 t300 S3 Wake Event to SLP_S3# inactive (S3 Wake) (Consumer Only) 0 small as possible RTCCLK 1 8-17 t300 S3 Wake Event to SLP_S3# inactive (S3 Wake) (Corporate Only) 0 — RTCCLK 1 8-17 t301 S1 Wake Event to STPCLK# inactive 9 t302 SLP_M# inactive to SLP_S3# inactive t304 RSMRST# deassertion to LAN_RST# deassertion See Note Below ±10 0 PCICLK 8-16 ns 8-21 ms 17 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Table 8-22. Power Management Timings (Sheet 3 of 3) Sym Parameter Min Max Units Notes 1 ms 18 25 t305a LAN Power Rails active to LAN_RST# deassertion t305b LAN_RST# assertion to LAN Power Rails inactive 20 ns t306 LANRST# assertion to PWROK assertion 0 ms t307 SLP_S3# active to Vcc supplies inactive (nominal voltage -5%) 5 us t308a RSMRST# deassertion to CLPWROK assertion 0 ms t308b Controller Link Power Rails active to CLPWROK assertion 1 ms t308c CLPWROK assertion to PWROK assertion 0 ms 24 Fig 8-17 Other Timings t310 THRMTRIP# active to SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, SLP_S5# active 175 ns t311 RSMRST# rising edge transition from 20% to 80% 50 μs t312 RSMRST# falling edge transition t313 SLP_M# active to RSMRST# active 21 500 μs NOTES: 1. These transitions are clocked off the internal RTC. 1 RTC clock is approximately from 28.992 µs to 32.044 µs. 2. The ICH10 STPCLK# assertion will trigger the processor to send a stop grant acknowledge cycle. The timing for this cycle getting to the ICH10 is dependant on the processor and the memory controller. 3. These transitions are clocked off the 33 MHz PCICLK. 1 PCICLK is approximately 30 ns. 4. The ICH10 has no maximum timing requirement for this transition. It is up to the system designer to determine if the SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5# signals are used to control the power planes. 5. If the transition to S5 is due to Power Button Override, SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5# are asserted together similar to timing t287 (PCIRST# active to SLP_S3# active). 6. If there is no RTC battery in the system, so VccRTC and the VccSus supplies come up together, the delay from RTCRST# and RSMRST# inactive to SUSCLK toggling may be as much as 2.5 s. 7. This value is programmable in multiples of 1024 PCI CLKs. Maximum is 8192 PCI CLKs (245.6 µs). 8. The Min/Max times depend on the programming of the “SLP_S4# Minimum Assertion Width” and the “SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable bits (D31:F0:A4h bits 5:3)”. 9. Note that this does not apply for synchronous SMIs. 10. This is a clock generator specification 11. If the (G)MCH does not have the CPUSLP# signal, then the minimum value can be 16 PCICLK. 12. This is non-zero to enforce the minimum assert time for DPRSLPVR. If the minimum assert time for DPRSLPVR has been met, then this is permitted to be 0. 13. This is non-zero to enforce the minimum assert time for STP_CPU#. If the minimum assert time for STP_CPU# has been met, then this is permitted to be 0. 14. This value should be at most a few clocks greater than the minimum. 15. When Intel AMT enabled, S4_STATE# indicates if system is in S4 state or below. 16. For t234 and t298, the SLP_M# stretching logic can push the Max value much larger than the Min (e.g., up to 3 seconds). With the installation of the Intel Manageability Engine Datasheet 279 Electrical Characteristics 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. firmware, the Max value of t234 and t298 is 99 ms. Without the installation of the firmware, the Max value is 4 RTC clocks. RSMRST# must de-assert at or before LAN_RST# de-assertion. Measured from VccLAN3_3 or VccLAN1_1 power within voltage specification (which ever is later in time) to LAN_RST# = (Vih+Vil)/2. It is acceptable to use an RC circuit sourced from VccLAN3_3 to create LAN_RST#. The rising edge of LAN_RST# needs to be a clean, monotonic edge for frequency content below 10 MHz. If Integrated LAN is supported, LAN_RST# must be de-asserted at or before PWROK assertion. If Integrated LAN is not supported, LAN_RST# should be tied to ground and must never de-assert. RSMRST# falling edge must transition to 0.8 V or less before VccSus3_3 drops to 2.1 V If bit 0 of Section 13.8.1.3 is set to a 1, SLP_S5# will not be de-asserted until a wake event is detected. If bit 0 is set to 0, SLP_S5# will de-assert within the specification listed in the table. t294 is not applied to V5REF. V5REF timings are bounded by power sequencing. t294 applies during S0 to S3/S4/S5 and S0 to G3 transitions. t307 is applicable in S0 to Sx transitions. A Power rail is considered to be inactive when the rail is at its nominal voltage minus 5% or less. 8.5 Timing Diagrams Figure 8-1. Clock Timing Period High Time 2.0V 0.8V Low Time Fall Time Figure 8-2. Rise Time Valid Delay from Rising Clock Edge Clock 1.5V Valid Delay Output 280 VT Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-3. Setup and Hold Times Clock 1.5V Setup Time Input Figure 8-4. Hold Time VT VT Float Delay Input VT Float Delay Output Figure 8-5. Pulse Width Pulse Width VT Figure 8-6. VT Output Enable Delay Clock 1.5V Output Enable Delay Output Datasheet VT 281 Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-7. USB Rise and Fall Times Rise Time Fall Time 90% CL 90% Differential Data Lines 10% 10% CL tR tF Low-speed: 75 ns at CL = 50 pF, 300 ns at C L = 350 pF Full-speed: 4 to 20 ns at C L = 50 pF High-speed: 0.8 to 1.2 ns at C L = 10 pF Figure 8-8. USB Jitter T period Crossover Points Differential Data Lines Jitter Consecutive Transitions Paired Transitions Figure 8-9. USB EOP Width Tperiod Differential Data Lines Data Crossover Level EOP Width 282 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-10. SMBus Transaction t19 t20 t21 SMBCLK t135 t131 t133 t134 t18 t132 SMBDATA t130 Figure 8-11. SMBus Timeout Start Stop t137 CLKack t138 CLKack t138 SMBCLK SMBDATA Datasheet 283 Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-12. SPI Timings t182 t182 SPI_CLK t183 SPI_MOSI t184 t185 SPI_MISO t187 t186 SPI_CS[1:0]# Figure 8-13. Intel® High Definition Audio Input and Output Timings HDA_BIT_CLK HDA_SDOUT t143 t144 t143 t144 HDA_SDIN[3:0] t145 284 t146 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-14. Power Sequencing and Reset Signal Timings PW ROK t2 1 4 V _ C P U _ IO t2 1 1 V c c1 _ 5 _ A , V cc1 _ 5 _ B V cc1 _ 1 a n d o th e r p o w e r1 V cc3 _ 3 t2 0 9 t2 1 3 V 5R EF LA N _R S T# t3 0 5 a V cc L A N 3 RSM RST# t2 0 4 t2 0 3 V c cS u s 1 _ 1 t2 0 2 V c cS u s 3 _ 3 t2 0 1 V5REF_Sus RTCRST# V c cR T C t2 0 0 NOTES: 1. Other power includes VccUSBPLL, VccDMIPLL, and VccSATAPLL. All of these power signals must independently meet the timings shown in the figure. There are no timing interdependencies between Vcc1_1 and these other power signals. There are also no timing interdependencies for these power signals, including Vcc1_1, to Vcc3_3 and Vcc1_5_A/Vcc1_5_B. 2. PWROK must not glitch, even if RSMRST# is low. 3. VccLAN includes VccLAN3_3, VccLAN1_1, and VccCL3_3. 4. Other power Datasheet 285 Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-15. G3 (Mechanical Off) to S0 Timings System State G3 G3 S5 S4 S3 S0 S0 state DMI message STPCLK# Processor I/F signals Strap Values Normal Operation PLTRST# t218 SUS_STAT# T212 VRMPWRGD t217 PWROK t214 Vcc 1 SLP_S3# t230 t234 t233 SLP_S4# SLP_S5# t232 LAN_RST# t305a VccLAN 2 Running SUSCLK t231 RSMRST# t204 VccSus 3 NOTE: 1. Vcc includes Vcc1_5_A, Vcc1_5_B, Vcc3_3, Vcc1_1, VccUSBPLL, VccDMIPLL, VccSATAPLL, V5REF, V_CPU_IO, VccDMI, VccHDA, VccGLANPLL, VccGLAN3_3 and VccGLAN1_5 (if integrated Gigabit LAN enabled), VccLAN3_3 (if LAN only power in S0), and VccCL3_3 (if controller link only powered in S0). 2. VccLAN includes VccLAN3_3, VccLAN1_1, and VccCL3_3. 3. VccSus includes VccSus3_3, V5REF_Sus, VccSusHDA, VccLAN3_3 (if LAN powered in S3/ S4/S5), and VccCL3_3 (if controller link powered in S3/S4/S5). 286 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-16. S0 to S1 to S0 Timings S0 STATE S0 S1 S1 S1 S0 S0 t301 STPCLK# DMI Message t280 Wake Event Figure 8-17. S0 to S5 to S0 Timings S0 S0 S3 S3 S4 S5 S3/S4/S5 S0 S0 STPCLK# DMI Message STP_CPU#, CPUSLP#, DPSLP#, DPRSTP# t280 DPRSLPVR SUS_STAT# t283 t217 STP_PCI# t285 t218 PLTRST# PCIRST# t286 SLP_M# t302 t300 SLP_S3# t287 t234 t299 SLP_S4# t291 t297 SLP_S5# t295 t296 Wake Event VRMPWRGD t212 PWROK t289 Vcc1 t214 t307 NOTE: Vcc includes Vcc1_5_A, Vcc1_5_B, Vcc3_3, Vcc1_1, VccUSBPLL, VccDMIPLL, and VccSATAPLL. Datasheet 287 Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-18. C0 to C2 to C0 Timings CPU I/F Unlatched Signals Latched Unlatched STPCLK# t250 Break Event t273 t274 Figure 8-19. C0 to C3 to C0 Timings CPU I/F Signals Latched Unlatched Unlatched t274 STPCLK# t250 Bus Master t270 t251 DPSLP# STP_CPU# CPU Clocks Idle Active t253 t267 Running t269 Running Stopped t254 t268 Break Event 288 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-20. C0 to C4 to C0 Timings CPU I/F Signals Latched Unlatched Unlatched t250 t274 STPCLK# Bus Master Active Idle t270 t251 DPSLP# t269 t253 STP_CPU# t268 t254 CPU Clocks Stopped Running Running t265 DPRSTP# DPRSLPVR t255 t266a CPU Vcc Break Event Datasheet 289 Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-21. Sleep control signal relationship - Host boots and Intel Management Engine off t234 SLP_S3# S4_STATE# t297 SLP_S4# SLP_S5# t302 SLP_M # NOTES: 1. t290 is also applicable when the system transitions from S0 to G3. Figure 8-22. Sleep control signal relationship - Host and Intel Management Engine boot after G3 t2 3 4 SLP_S3# t2 9 7 S4_STATE # SLP_S4# SLP_S5# SLP_M # NOTE: When both the host and Intel Management Engine boot after G3, SLP_M# does not have any timing dependency on other sleep control signals. SLP_M# will be de-asserted some time between SLP_S5# de-assertion and SLP_S3# de-assertion. 290 Datasheet Electrical Characteristics Figure 8-23. Sleep control signal relationship - Host stays in S5 and Intel Management Engine boots after G3 t2 9 8 SLP_S3# t2 9 7 S4_STATE# SLP_S4# SLP_S5# W ake event t3 0 3 SLP_M # Figure 8-24. S4, S5/M1 to S0/M0 t2 9 8 SLP_S3# t2 9 7 S4_STATE# SLP_S4# SLP_S5# W ake event t3 0 3 SLP_M # NOTE: Vcc includes Vcc1_5_A, Vcc1_5_B, Vcc3_3, Vcc1_1, VccUSBPLL, VccDMIPLL, and VccSATAPLL. Figure 8-25. S0 to S3/S4/S5 and G3 Timings PW ROK V cc t294 §§ §§ Datasheet 291 Electrical Characteristics 292 Datasheet Register and Memory Mapping 9 Register and Memory Mapping The ICH10 contains registers that are located in the processor’s I/O space and memory space and sets of PCI configuration registers that are located in PCI configuration space. This chapter describes the ICH10 I/O and memory maps at the register-set level. Register access is also described. Register-level address maps and Individual register bit descriptions are provided in the following chapters. The following notations and definitions are used in the register/instruction description chapters. Datasheet RO Read Only. In some cases, if a register is read only, writes to this register location have no effect. However, in other cases, two separate registers are located at the same location where a read accesses one of the registers and a write accesses the other register. See the I/O and memory map tables for details. WO Write Only. In some cases, if a register is write only, reads to this register location have no effect. However, in other cases, two separate registers are located at the same location where a read accesses one of the registers and a write accesses the other register. See the I/O and memory map tables for details. R/W Read/Write. A register with this attribute can be read and written. R/WC Read/Write Clear. A register bit with this attribute can be read and written. However, a write of 1 clears (sets to 0) the corresponding bit and a write of 0 has no effect. R/WO Read/Write-Once. A register bit with this attribute can be written only once after power up. After the first write, the bit becomes read only. R/WLO Read/Write, Lock-Once. A register bit with this attribute can be written to the non-locked value multiple times, but to the locked value only once. After the locked value has been written, the bit becomes read only. Reserved The value of reserved bits must never be changed. For details see Section 9.2. Default When ICH10 is reset, it sets its registers to predetermined default states. The default state represents the minimum functionality feature set required to successfully bring up the system. Hence, it does not represent the optimal system configuration. It is the responsibility of the system initialization software to determine configuration, operating parameters, and optional system features that are applicable, and to program the ICH10 registers accordingly. Bold Register bits that are highlighted in bold text indicate that the bit is implemented in the ICH10. Register bits that are not implemented or are hardwired will remain in plain text. 293 Register and Memory Mapping 9.1 PCI Devices and Functions The Intel ICH10 incorporates a variety of PCI devices and functions, as shown in Table 9-1. There are seven logical devices for consumer components, and 8 logical devices for Corporate components. The first is the DMI-To-PCI bridge (Device 30). The second device (Device 31) contains most of the standard PCI functions that always existed in the PCI-to-ISA bridges (South Bridges), such as the Intel PIIX4. The third and fourth (Device 29 and Device 26) are the USB and USB2 host controller devices. The fifth (Device 28) is PCI Express device. The sixth (Device 27) is HD Audio controller device. The seventh (Device 25) is the Gigabit Ethernet controller device. If for some reason, the particular system platform does not want to support any one of the Device Functions, with the exception of D30:F0, they can individually be disabled. The integrated Gigabit Ethernet controller will be disabled if no Platform LAN Connect component is detected (See Chapter 5.3). When a function is disabled, it does not appear at all to the software. A disabled function will not respond to any register reads or writes, insuring that these devices appear hidden to software. b Table 9-1. PCI Devices and Functions Bus:Device:Function Function Description Bus 0:Device 30:Function 0 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Bus 0:Device 31:Function 0 LPC Controller1 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 2 SATA Controller #1 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 3 SMBus Controller Bus 0:Device 31:Function 5 SATA Controller #23 Bus 0:Device 31:Function 6 Thermal Subsystem Bus 0:Device 29:Function 0 USB UHCI Controller #1 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 1 USB UHCI Controller #2 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 2 USB UHCI Controller #3 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 3 USB UHCI Controller #62 Bus 0:Device 29:Function 7 USB EHCI Controller #1 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 0 USB UCHI Controller #4 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 1 USB UHCI Controller #5 Bus 0:Device 26:Function 2 USB UHCI Controller #62 Bus 0:Device 26:Fucntion 7 USB EHCI Controller #2 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 0 PCI Express* Port 1 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 1 PCI Express Port 2 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 2 PCI Express Port 3 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 3 PCI Express Port 4 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 4 PCI Express Port 5 Bus 0:Device 28:Function 5 PCI Express Port 6 Bus 0:Device 27:Function 0 Intel® High Definition Audio Controller Bus 0:Device 25:Function 0 Gigabit Ethernet Controller NOTES: 1. The PCI-to-LPC bridge contains registers that control LPC, Power Management, System Management, GPIO, Processor Interface, RTC, Interrupts, Timers, and DMA. 294 Datasheet Register and Memory Mapping 2. 3. 9.2 The ICH10 can optionally configure the USB ports from a 6-6 configuration into a 8-4 configuration, with 8 ports on D29:F7 EHCI and 4 ports on D26:F7 EHCI. In the 8-4 configuration UHCI #6 will be mapped to D29:F3. In the 6-6 configuration UHCI #6 will be mapped to D26:F2. SATA controller 2 (D31:F5) is only visible in ICH10 desktop components and when D31:F2 CC.SCC=01h. PCI Configuration Map Each PCI function on the ICH10 has a set of PCI configuration registers. The register address map tables for these register sets are included at the beginning of the chapter for the particular function. Configuration Space registers are accessed through configuration cycles on the PCI bus by the Host bridge using configuration mechanism #1 detailed in the PCI Local Bus Specification, Revision 2.3. Some of the PCI registers contain reserved bits. Software must deal correctly with fields that are reserved. On reads, software must use appropriate masks to extract the defined bits and not rely on reserved bits being any particular value. On writes, software must ensure that the values of reserved bit positions are preserved. That is, the values of reserved bit positions must first be read, merged with the new values for other bit positions and then written back. Note the software does not need to perform read, merge, write operation for the configuration address register. In addition to reserved bits within a register, the configuration space contains reserved locations. Software should not write to reserved PCI configuration locations in the device-specific region (above address offset 3Fh). 9.3 I/O Map The I/O map is divided into Fixed and Variable address ranges. Fixed ranges cannot be moved, but in some cases can be disabled. Variable ranges can be moved and can also be disabled. 9.3.1 Fixed I/O Address Ranges Table 9-2 shows the Fixed I/O decode ranges from the processor perspective. Note that for each I/O range, there may be separate behavior for reads and writes. DMI (Direct Media Interface) cycles that go to target ranges that are marked as “Reserved” will not be decoded by the ICH10, and will be passed to PCI unless the Subtractive Decode Policy bit is set (D31:F0:Offset 42h, bit 0). If a PCI master targets one of the fixed I/O target ranges, it will be positively decoded by the ICH10 in medium speed. Address ranges that are not listed or marked “Reserved” are not decoded by the ICH10 (unless assigned to one of the variable ranges). Datasheet 295 Register and Memory Mapping Table 9-2. 296 Fixed I/O Ranges Decoded by Intel® ICH10 (Sheet 1 of 2) I/O Address Read Target Write Target Internal Unit 00h–08h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 09h–0Eh RESERVED DMA Controller DMA 0Fh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 10h–18h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 19h–1Eh RESERVED DMA Controller DMA 1Fh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 20h–21h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 24h–25h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 28h–29h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 2Ch–2Dh Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 2E–2F LPC SIO LPC SIO Forwarded to LPC 30h–31h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 34h–35h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 38h–39h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 3Ch–3Dh Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt 40h–42h Timer/Counter Timer/Counter PIT (8254) 43h RESERVED Timer/Counter PIT 4E–4F LPC SIO LPC SIO Forwarded to LPC 50h–52h Timer/Counter Timer/Counter PIT 53h RESERVED Timer/Counter PIT 60h Microcontroller Microcontroller Forwarded to LPC 61h NMI Controller NMI Controller Processor I/F 62h Microcontroller Microcontroller Forwarded to LPC 64h Microcontroller Microcontroller Forwarded to LPC 66h Microcontroller Microcontroller Forwarded to LPC 70h RESERVED NMI and RTC Controller RTC 71h RTC Controller RTC Controller RTC 72h RTC Controller NMI and RTC Controller RTC 73h RTC Controller RTC Controller RTC 74h RTC Controller NMI and RTC Controller RTC 75h RTC Controller RTC Controller RTC 76h RTC Controller NMI and RTC Controller RTC 77h RTC Controller RTC Controller RTC 80h DMA Controller, or LPC, or PCI DMA Controller and LPC or PCI DMA 81h–83h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA Datasheet Register and Memory Mapping Table 9-2. Fixed I/O Ranges Decoded by Intel® ICH10 (Sheet 2 of 2) I/O Address Read Target Write Target Internal Unit 84h–86h DMA Controller DMA Controller and LPC or PCI DMA 87h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 88h DMA Controller DMA Controller and LPC or PCI DMA 89h–8Bh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 8Ch–8Eh DMA Controller DMA Controller and LPC or PCI DMA 08Fh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 90h–91h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA 92h Reset Generator Reset Generator Processor I/F 93h–9Fh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA A0h–A1h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt A4h–A5h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt A8h–A9h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt ACh–ADh Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt B0h–B1h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt B2h–B3h Power Management Power Management Power Management B4h–B5h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt B8h–B9h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt BCh–BDh Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt C0h–D1h DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA D2h–DDh RESERVED DMA Controller DMA DEh–DFh DMA Controller DMA Controller DMA F0h PCI and Master Abort1 FERR#/IGNNE# / Interrupt Controller Processor I/F 170h–177h SATA Controller or PCI SATA Controller or PCI Forwarded to SATA 1F0h–1F7h SATA Controller or PCI SATA Controller or PCI Forwarded to SATA 376h SATA Controller or PCI SATA Controller or PCI Forwarded to SATA 3F6h SATA Controller or PCI SATA Controller or PCI Forwarded to SATA 4D0h–4D1h Interrupt Controller Interrupt Controller Interrupt CF9h Reset Generator Reset Generator Processor I/F NOTE: 1. A read to this address will subtractively go to PCI, where it will master abort. Datasheet 297 Register and Memory Mapping 9.3.2 Variable I/O Decode Ranges Table 9-3 shows the Variable I/O Decode Ranges. They are set using Base Address Registers (BARs) or other configuration bits in the various PCI configuration spaces. The PNP software (PCI or ACPI) can use their configuration mechanisms to set and adjust these values. Warning: The Variable I/O Ranges should not be set to conflict with the Fixed I/O Ranges. Unpredictable results if the configuration software allows conflicts to occur. The ICH10 does not perform any checks for conflicts. Table 9-3. Variable I/O Decode Ranges Mappable Size (Bytes) Target ACPI Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 64 Power Management IDE Bus Master Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 16 IDE Unit Native IDE Command Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 8 IDE Unit Native IDE Control Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 4 IDE Unit USB UHCI Controller #1 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 1 USB UHCI Controller #2 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 2 USB UHCI Controller #3 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 3 USB UHCI Controller #4 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 4 USB UHCI Controller #5 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 5 USB UHCI Controller #6 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 USB Unit 6 SMBus Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 SMB Unit TCO 96 Bytes above ACPI Base 32 TCO Unit GPIO Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 64 GPIO Unit Parallel Port 3 Ranges in 64 KB I/O Space 8 LPC Peripheral Serial Port 1 8 Ranges in 64 KB I/O Space 8 LPC Peripheral Serial Port 2 8 Ranges in 64 KB I/O Space 8 LPC Peripheral Range Name Floppy Disk Controller 2 Ranges in 64 KB I/O Space 8 LPC Peripheral LAN Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 32 LAN Unit LPC Generic 1 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 4 to 256 LPC Peripheral LPC Generic 2 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 4 to 256 LPC Peripheral LPC Generic 3 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 4 to 256 LPC Peripheral LPC Generic 4 Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 4 to 256 LPC Peripheral I/O Trapping Ranges Anywhere in 64 KB I/O Space 1 to 256 Trap on Backbone NOTE: 1. Decode range size determined by D31:F0:ADh:bits 5:4 298 Datasheet Register and Memory Mapping 9.4 Memory Map Table 9-4 shows (from the processor perspective) the memory ranges that the ICH10 decodes. Cycles that arrive from DMI that are not directed to any of the internal memory targets that decode directly from DMI will be driven out on PCI unless the Subtractive Decode Policy bit is set (D31:F0:Offset 42h, bit 0). PCI cycles generated by external PCI masters will be positively decoded unless they fall in the PCI-to-PCI bridge memory forwarding ranges (those addresses are reserved for PCI peer-to-peer traffic). If the cycle is not in the internal LAN controller’s range, it will be forwarded up to DMI. Software must not attempt locks to the ICH10’s memorymapped I/O ranges for EHCI and HPET. If attempted, the lock is not honored which means potential deadlock conditions may occur. Table 9-4. Memory Decode Ranges from Processor Perspective (Sheet 1 of 2) Memory Range Target Dependency/Comments 0000 0000h–000D FFFFh 0010 0000h–TOM (Top of Memory) Main Memory TOM registers in Host controller 000E 0000h–000E FFFFh Firmware Hub Bit 6 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set 000F 0000h–000F FFFFh Firmware Hub Bit 7 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set FEC_ _000h–FEC_ _040h IO(x) APIC inside ICH10 _ _is controlled via APIC Range Select (ASEL) field and APIC Enable (AEN) bit (Consumer Only) IO(x) APIC inside ICH10 _ is controlled via APIC Range Select (ASEL) field and APIC Enable (AEN) bit FEC1 0000h–FEC1 7FFF PCI Express* Port 1 PCI Express* Root Port 1 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FEC1 8000h–FEC1 8FFFh PCI Express* Port 2 PCI Express* Root Port 2 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FEC2 0000h–FEC2 7FFFh PCI Express* Port 3 PCI Express* Root Port 3 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FEC2 8000h–FEC2 8FFFh PCI Express* Port 4 PCI Express* Root Port 4 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FEC3 0000h–FEC3 7FFFh PCI Express* Port 5 PCI Express* Root Port 5 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FEC3 8000h–FEC3 8FFFh PCI Express* Port 6 PCI Express* Root Port 6 I/OxAPIC Enable (PAE) set FED4 0000h–FED4 BFFFh TPM on LPC FFC0 0000h–FFC7 FFFFh Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 8 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 9 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 10 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 11 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set (Corporate Only) FEC0 _000h–FEC0 _040h FF80 0000h–FF87 FFFFh FFC8 0000h–FFCF FFFFh FF88 0000h–FF8F FFFFh FFD0 0000h–FFD7 FFFFh FF90 0000h–FF97 FFFFh FFD8 0000h–FFDF FFFFh FF98 0000h–FF9F FFFFh Datasheet 299 Register and Memory Mapping Table 9-4. Memory Decode Ranges from Processor Perspective (Sheet 2 of 2) Memory Range Target Dependency/Comments FFE0 000h–FFE7 FFFFh Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 12 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)3 Bit 13 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 14 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Always enabled. The top two, 64 KB blocks of this range can be swapped, as described in Section 7.4.1. Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 3 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 2 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 1 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set FF00 0000h–FF0F FFFFh Firmware Hub (or PCI)2 Bit 0 in Firmware Hub Decode Enable register is set 128 KB anywhere in 4-GB range Integrated LAN Controller Enable via BAR in Device 25:Function 0 (Integrated LAN Controller) 1 KB anywhere in 4-GB range USB EHCI Controller #11 Enable via standard PCI mechanism (Device 29, Function 7) 1 KB anywhere in 4-GB range USB EHCI Controller #21 Enable via standard PCI mechanism (Device 26, Function 7) 512 B anywhere in 64-bit addressing space Intel® High Definition Audio Host Controller Enable via standard PCI mechanism (Device 27, Function 0) FED0 X000h–FED0 X3FFh High Precision Event Timers 1 BIOS determines the “fixed” location which is one of four, 1-KB ranges where X (in the first column) is 0h, 1h, 2h, or 3h. All other PCI FFA0 0000h–FFA7 FFFFh FFE8 0000h–FFEF FFFFh FFA8 0000h–FFAF FFFFh FFF0 0000h–FFF7 FFFFh FFB0 0000h–FFB7 FFFFh FFF8 0000h–FFFF FFFFh FFB8 0000h–FFBF FFFFh FF70 0000h–FF7F FFFFh FF30 0000h–FF3F FFFFh FF60 0000h–FF6F FFFFh FF20 0000h–FF2F FFFFh FF50 0000h–FF5F FFFFh FF10 0000h–FF1F FFFFh FF40 0000h–FF4F FFFFh None NOTES: 1. Software must not attempt locks to memory mapped I/O ranges for USB EHCI or High Precision Event Timers. If attempted, the lock is not honored, which means potential deadlock conditions may occur. 2. PCI is the target when the Boot BIOS Destination selection bits are set to 10b (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 3401 bits 11:10). When PCI selected, the Firmware Hub Decode Enable bits have no effect. 9.4.1 Boot-Block Update Scheme The ICH10 supports a “top-block swap” mode that has the ICH10 swap the top block in the Firmware Hub (the boot block) with another location. This allows for safe update of the Boot Block (even if a power failure occurs). When the “TOP_SWAP” Enable bit is set, the ICH10 will invert A16 for cycles targeting Firmware Hub space. When this bit is 0, the ICH10 will not invert A16. This bit is automatically set to 0 by RTCRST#, but not by PLTRST#. 300 Datasheet Register and Memory Mapping The scheme is based on the concept that the top block is reserved as the “boot” block, and the block immediately below the top block is reserved for doing boot-block updates. The algorithm is: 1. Software copies the top block to the block immediately below the top 2. Software checks that the copied block is correct. This could be done by performing a checksum calculation. 3. Software sets the TOP_SWAP bit. This will invert A16 for cycles going to the Firmware Hub. processor access to FFFF_0000h through FFFF_FFFFh will be directed to FFFE_0000h through FFFE_FFFFh in the Firmware Hub, and processor accesses to FFFE_0000h through FFFE_FFFF will be directed to FFFF_0000h through FFFF_FFFFh. 4. Software erases the top block 5. Software writes the new top block 6. Software checks the new top block 7. Software clears the TOP_SWAP bit 8. Software sets the Top_Swap Lock-Down bit If a power failure occurs at any point after step 3, the system will be able to boot from the copy of the boot block that is stored in the block below the top. This is because the TOP_SWAP bit is backed in the RTC well. Note: The top-block swap mode may be forced by an external strapping option (See Section 2.25.1). When top-block swap mode is forced in this manner, the TOP_SWAP bit cannot be cleared by software. A re-boot with the strap removed will be required to exit a forced top-block swap mode. Note: Top-block swap mode only affects accesses to the Firmware Hub space, not feature space. Note: The top-block swap mode has no effect on accesses below FFFE_0000h. §§ Datasheet 301 Register and Memory Mapping 302 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10 Chipset Configuration Registers This section describes all registers and base functionality that is related to chipset configuration and not a specific interface (such as LPC, PCI, or PCI Express*). It contains the root complex register block, which describes the behavior of the upstream internal link. This block is mapped into memory space, using the Root Complex Base Address (RCBA) register of the PCI-to-LPC bridge. Accesses in this space must be limited to 32-(DW) bit quantities. Burst accesses are not allowed. All Chipset Configuration Registers are located in the core well unless otherwise indicated. 10.1 Chipset Configuration Registers (Memory Space) Note: Address locations that are not shown should be treated as Reserved (see Section 9.2 for details). . Table 10-1. Chipset Configuration Register Memory Map (Memory Space) (Sheet 1 of 4) Datasheet Offset Mnemonic 0000–0003h VCH Register Name Virtual Channel Capability Header Default Type 10010002h R/WO 0004–0007h VCAP1 Virtual Channel Capability #1 00000801h RO, R/WO 0008–000Bh VCAP2 Virtual Channel Capability #2 00000001h RO 000C–000Dh PVC Port VC Control 0000h RO, R/W 000E–000Fh PVS Port VC Status 0000h RO 0010–0013h V0CAP VC 0 Resource Capability 00000001h RO 0014–0017h V0CTL VC 0 Resource Control 800000FFh R/W, RO 001A–001Bh V0STS VC 0 Resource Status 0000h RO 001C–001Fh V1CAP VC 1 Resource Capability 03008011h R/WO, RO 0020–0023h V1CTL VC 1 Resource Control 00000000h R/W 0026–0027h V1STS VC 1 Resource Status 0000h RO 0030-006Fh (Corporate Only) — — — 0030-006Fh (Consumer Only) PAT 00000000h R/WO 0000h R/W Reserved Port Arbitration Table 0088-008Bh CIR1 Chipset Initialization Register 1 00AC-00AFh REC Root Error Command 0100–0103h RCTCL Root Complex Topology Capability List 1A010005h RO 0104–0107h ESD Element Self Description 00000802h R/WO, RO 0110–0113h ULD Upstream Link Descriptor 00000001h R/WO, RO 303 Chipset Configuration Registers Table 10-1. Chipset Configuration Register Memory Map (Memory Space) (Sheet 2 of 4) 304 Offset Mnemonic 0118–011Fh ULBA Upstream Link Base Address 0120–0123h RP1D Root Port 1 Descriptor 0128–012Fh RP1BA 0130–0133h RP2D 0138–013Fh RP2BA 0140–0143h RP3D 0148–014Fh RP3BA 0150–0153h RP4D 0158–015Fh RP4BA Register Name Root Port 1 Base Address Root Port 2 Descriptor Root Port 2 Base Address Root Port 3 Descriptor Root Port 3 Base Address Root Port 4 Descriptor Root Port 4 Base Address Intel® High Definition Audio Descriptor 0160–0163h HDD 0168–016Fh HDBA 0170–0173h RP5D Root Port 5 Descriptor 0178–017Fh RP5A Root Port 5 Base Address 0180–0183h RP6D Root Port 6 Descriptor 0188–018Fh RP6BA Intel High Definition Audio Base Address Root Port 6 Base Address Default Type 0000000000000000h R/WO 01xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E0000h RO 02xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E1000h RO 03xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E2000h RO 04xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E3000h RO 15xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000D8000h RO 05xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E4000h RO 06xx0002h R/WO, RO 00000000000E5000h RO 01A0–01A3h ILCL Internal Link Capability List 00010006h RO 01A4–01A7h LCAP Link Capabilities 00012841h RO, R/WO 01A8–01A9h LCTL Link Control 0000h R/W 01AA–01ABh LSTS Link Status 0041h RO 01F4-01F7h CIR2 Chipset Initialization Register 2 00000000h R/W 01FC-01FDh CIR3 Chipset Initialization Register 3 0000h R/W 0220-0223h BCR Backbone Configuration 00000000h R/W 0224–0227h RPC Root Port Configuration 0000000yh R/W, RO 0234-0327h DMIC DMI Control 00000000h R/W, RO 0238–023Bh RPFN Root Port Function Number for PCI Express Root Ports 00543210h R/WO, RO 0290-0293h FPSS Function Level Reset Pending Status Summary 00000000h RO 0F20-0F23h CIR13 Chipset Initialization Register 13 B2B477CCh R/W 1D40-1D47h CIR5 Chipset Initialization Register 5 0000000000000000h R/W 1E00–1E03h TRSR Trap Status Register 00000000h R/WC, RO 1E10–1E17h TRCR Trapped Cycle Register 0000000000000000h RO 1E18-1E1Fh TWDR Trapped Write Data Register 0000000000000000h RO 1E80-1E87h IOTR0 I/O Trap Register 0 0000000000000000h R/W 1E88-1E8Fh IOTR1 I/O Trap Register 1 0000000000000000h R/W 1E90-1E97h IOTR2 I/O Trap Register 2 0000000000000000h R/W Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers Table 10-1. Chipset Configuration Register Memory Map (Memory Space) (Sheet 3 of 4) Datasheet Offset Mnemonic 1E98-1E9Fh IOTR3 2010-2013h DMC 2034-2037h Register Name Default Type 0000000000000000h R/W DMI Miscellaneous Control register 00000002h R/W CIR7 Chipset Initialization Register 7 B2B477CCh R/W 3000–3000h TCTL TCO Control 00h R/W 3100–3103h D31IP Device 31 Interrupt Pin 03243200h R/W, RO I/O Trap Register 3 3104–3107h D30IP Device 30 Interrupt Pin 00000000h RO 3108–310Bh D29IP Device 29 Interrupt Pin 10004321h R/W 310C–310Fh D28IP Device 28 Interrupt Pin 00214321h R/W 3110–3113h D27IP Device 27 Interrupt Pin 00000001h R/W 3114–3117h D26IP Device 26 Interrupt Pin 30000321h R/W 3118–311Bh D25IP Device 25 Interrupt Pin 00000001h R/W 3140–3141h D31IR Device 31 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 3142–3143h D30IR Device 30 Interrupt Route 0000h RO 3144–3145h D29IR Device 29 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 3146–3147h D28IR Device 28 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 3148–3149h D27IR Device 27 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 314C–314Dh D26IR Device 26 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 3150–3151h D25IR Device 25 Interrupt Route 3210h R/W 31FE–31FFh (Corporate Only) OIC Other Interrupt Control 0000h R/W 31FF–31FFh (Consumer Only) OIC Other Interrupt Control 00h R/W 3300-3303h SBEMC3 Scheduled Break Event C3 00000000h R/W Schedule Break Event C4 00000000h R/W RTC Configuration 00000000h R/W, R/WLO 3304-3307h SBEMC4 3310–3313h (Corporate Only) PRSTS 3400–3403h RC 3404–3407h HPTC High Precision Timer Configuration 00000000h R/W 3410–3413h GCS General Control and Status 000000yy0h R/W, R/WLO 3414–3414h BUC Backed Up Control 00h R/W Power and Reset Status 3418–341Bh FD Function Disable 00000000h R/W 341C–341Fh CG Clock Gating 00000000h R/W 3420–3420h PDSW 00h R/W 3430-3433h CIR8 00000000h R/W Function Disable SUS Well Chipset Initialization Register 8 305 Chipset Configuration Registers Table 10-1. Chipset Configuration Register Memory Map (Memory Space) (Sheet 4 of 4) 10.1.1 Offset Mnemonic Register Name Default Type 350C-350Fh CIR9 Chipset Initialization Register 9 00000000h R/W 3524–3525h PPO USB Port Power Off 0000h R/W 352C-352Fh CIR10 0008C008hh R/W 35F0-35F3h MAP 00000000h R/WO Chipset Initialization Register 10 USB Remap Control VCH—Virtual Channel Capability Header Register Offset Address: 0000–0003h Default Value: 10010002h Bit Description Next Capability Offset (NCO) — R/WO. Indicates the next item in the list. 19:16 Capability Version (CV) — R/WO. Indicates support as a version 1 capability structure. Capability ID (CID) — R/WO. Indicates this is the Virtual Channel capability item. VCAP1—Virtual Channel Capability #1 Register Offset Address: 0004–0007h Default Value: 00000801h Bit Attribute: Size: RO, R/WO 32-bit Description 31:12 Reserved 11:10 Port Arbitration Table Entry Size (PATS) — RO. Indicates the size of the port arbitration table is 4 bits (to allow up to 8 ports). 9:8 7 6:4 3 2:0 306 R/WO 32-bit 31:20 15:0 10.1.2 Attribute: Size: Reference Clock (RC) — RO. Fixed at 100 ns. Reserved Low Priority Extended VC Count (LPEVC) — RO. Indicates that there are no additional VCs of low priority with extended capabilities. Reserved Extended VC Count (EVC) — R/WO. Indicates that there is one additional VC (VC1) that exists with extended capabilities. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.3 VCAP2—Virtual Channel Capability #2 Register Offset Address: 0008–000Bh Default Value: 00000001h Description 31:24 VC Arbitration Table Offset (ATO) — RO. Indicates that no table is present for VC arbitration since it is fixed. 7:0 Reserved VC Arbitration Capability (AC) — RO. Indicates that the VC arbitration is fixed in the root complex. PVC—Port Virtual Channel Control Register Offset Address: 000C–000Dh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:04 10.1.5 Attribute: Size: RO, R/W 16-bit Description Reserved 3:1 VC Arbitration Select (AS) — R/W. Indicates which VC should be programmed in the VC arbitration table. The root complex takes no action on the setting of this field since there is no arbitration table. 0 Load VC Arbitration Table (LAT) — RO. Indicates that the table programmed should be loaded into the VC arbitration table. This bit is defined as read/write with always returning 0 on reads. PVS—Port Virtual Channel Status Register Offset Address: 000E–000Fh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:1 0 Datasheet RO 32-bit Bit 23:8 10.1.4 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 16-bit Description Reserved VC Arbitration Table Status (VAS) — RO. Indicates the coherency status of the VC Arbitration table when it is being updated. This field is always 0 in the root complex since there is no VC arbitration table. 307 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.6 V0CAP—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Capability Register Offset Address: 0010–0013h Default Value: 00000001h Description 31:24 Port Arbitration Table Offset (AT) — RO. This VC implements no port arbitration table since the arbitration is fixed. 22:16 Reserved Maximum Time Slots (MTS) — RO. This VC implements fixed arbitration, and therefore this field is not used. 15 Reject Snoop Transactions (RTS) — RO. This VC must be able to take snoopable transactions. 14 Advanced Packet Switching (APS) — RO. This VC is capable of all transactions, not just advanced packet switching transactions. 13:8 7:0 Reserved Port Arbitration Capability (PAC) — RO. Indicates that this VC uses fixed port arbitration. V0CTL—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Control Register Offset Address: 0014–0017h Default Value: 800000FFh Bit 31 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32-bit Description Virtual Channel Enable (EN) — RO. Always set to 1. VC0 is always enabled and cannot be disabled. 30:27 Reserved 26:24 Virtual Channel Identifier (ID) — RO. Indicates the ID to use for this virtual channel. 23:20 Reserved 19:17 Port Arbitration Select (PAS) — R/W. Indicates which port table is being programmed. The root complex takes no action on this setting since the arbitration is fixed and there is no arbitration table. 16 15:8 7:1 0 308 RO 32-bit Bit 23 10.1.7 Attribute: Size: Load Port Arbitration Table (LAT) — RO. The root complex does not implement an arbitration table for this virtual channel. Reserved Transaction Class / Virtual Channel Map (TVM) — R/W. Indicates which transaction classes are mapped to this virtual channel. When a bit is set, this transaction class is mapped to the virtual channel. Reserved Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.8 V0STS—Virtual Channel 0 Resource Status Register Offset Address: 001A–001Bh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:2 10.1.9 RO 16-bit Description Reserved 1 VC Negotiation Pending (NP) — RO. When set, indicates the virtual channel is still being negotiated with ingress ports. 0 Port Arbitration Tables Status (ATS) — RO. There is no port arbitration table for this VC, so this bit is reserved at 0. V1CAP—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Capability Register Offset Address: 001C–001Fh Default Value: 03008011h (Consumer) 00008001h (Corporate) Bit 31:24 (Corporate Only) 31:24 (Consumer Only) 23 Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Description Port Arbitration Table Offset (AT) — RO. Indicates the location of the port arbitration table in the root complex. A value of 0h indicates the table is not present Port Arbitration Table Offset (AT) — RO. Indicates the location of the port arbitration table in the root complex. A value of 3h indicates the table is at offset 30h. Reserved 22:16 Maximum Time Slots (MTS) — R/WO. This value is updated by platform BIOS based upon the determination of the number of time slots available in the platform. 15 Reject Snoop Transactions (RTS) — RO. All snoopable transactions on VC1 are rejected. This VC is for isochronous transfers only. 14 Advanced Packet Switching (APS) — RO. This VC is capable of all transactions, not just advanced packet switching transactions. 13:8 7:0 (Corporate Only) 7:0 (Consumer Only) Datasheet Attribute: Size: Reserved Port Arbitration Capability (PAC) — RO. Indicates the port arbitration capability is hardware-fixed. Port Arbitration Capability (PAC) — RO. Indicates the port arbitration capability is time-based WRR of 128 phases. 309 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.10 V1CTL—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Control Register Offset Address: 0020–0023h Default Value: 00000000h (Consumer) 00000000h (Corporate) Bit Virtual Channel Enable (EN) — R/W. Enables the VC when set. Disables the VC when cleared. 30:27 Reserved 26:24 Virtual Channel Identifier (ID) — R/W. Indicates the ID to use for this virtual channel. 23:20 Reserved 19:17 (Corporate Only) Port Arbitration Select (PAS) —RO. The only permissible value of this field is 0h for fixed arbitration. 19:17 (Consumer Only) Port Arbitration Select (PAS) — R/W. Indicates which port table is being programmed. The only permissible value of this field is 4h for the time-based WRR entries. 16 (Corporate Only) Reserved 16 (Consumer Only) Load Port Arbitration Table (LAT) — R/W. When set, the port arbitration table loaded based upon the PAS field in this register. This bit always returns 0 when read. 15:8 7:1 0 Reserved Transaction Class / Virtual Channel Map (TVM) — R/W. Indicates which transaction classes are mapped to this virtual channel. When a bit is set, this transaction class is mapped to the virtual channel. Reserved V1STS—Virtual Channel 1 Resource Status Register Offset Address: 0026–0027h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:2 310 R/W, RO 32-bit Description 31 10.1.11 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 16-bit Description Reserved 1 VC Negotiation Pending (NP) — RO. When set, indicates the virtual channel is still being negotiated with ingress ports. 0 Port Arbitration Tables Status (ATS) — RO. Indicates the coherency status of the port arbitration table. This bit is set when LAT (offset 000Ch:bit 0) is written with value 1 and PAS (offset 0014h:bits19:17) has value of 4h. This bit is cleared after the table has been updated. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.12 PAT—Port Arbitration Table (Consumer Only) Offset Address: 0030-006Fh Default Value: Attribute: Size: 64-Byte This a 64-byte register that contains the arbitration table to be loaded into the port arbitration table. Every 4-bits contains an entry for one of the downstream PCI Express* ports or a 0h to indicate idle. The ports are mapped as follows: • Port 1: Value used is 1h. • Port 2: Value used is 2h. • Port 3: Value used is 3h. • Port 4: Value used is 4h. • Port 5: Value used is 5h. • Port 6: Value used is 6h. • Intel High Definition Audio: Value used is Fh. 10.1.13 CIR1—Chipset Initialization Register 1 Offset Address: 0088–008Bh Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:21 20 19:16 15 14:13 12 11:0 10.1.14 Attribute: Size: R/WO 32-bit Description Reserved CIR1 Field 3 — R/WO. BIOS must set this bit. Reserved CIR1 Field 2 — R/WO. BIOS must set this bit. Reserved CIR1 Field 1— R/WO. BIOS must set this bit. Reserved REC—Root Error Command Register Offset Address: 00AC–00AFh Default Value: 0000h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Drop Poisoned Downstream Packets (DPDP) — R/W. Determines how downstream packets on DMI are handled that are received with the EP field set, indicating poisoned data: 31 1: This packet and all subsequent packets with data received on DMI for any VC will have their Unsupported Transaction (UT) field set causing them to master Abort downstream. Packets without data such as memory, IO and config read requests are allowed to proceed. 0: Packets are forwarded downstream without forcing the UT field set. 30:0 Datasheet Reserved 311 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.15 RCTCL—Root Complex Topology Capabilities List Register Offset Address: 0100–0103h Default Value: 1A010005h Bit Description 31:20 Next Capability (NEXT) — RO. Indicates the next item in the list. Capability Version (CV) — RO. Indicates the version of the capability structure. Capability ID (CID) — RO. Indicates this is a PCI Express* link capability section of an RCRB. ESD—Element Self Description Register Offset Address: 0104–0107h Default Value: 00000802h Bit R/WO, RO 32-bit Description Port Number (PN) — RO. A value of 0 to indicate the egress port for the Intel ICH10. 23:16 Component ID (CID) — R/WO. Indicates the component ID assigned to this element by software. This is written once by platform BIOS and is locked until a platform reset. Number of Link Entries (NLE) — RO. Indicates that one link entry (corresponding to DMI), 6 root port entries (for the downstream ports), and the Intel High Definition Audio device are described by this RCRB. 7:4 Reserved 3:0 Element Type (ET) — RO. Indicates that the element type is a root complex internal link. ULD—Upstream Link Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0110–0113h Default Value: 00000001h Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — R/WO. This field is programmed by platform BIOS to match the port number of the (G)MCH RCRB that is attached to this RCRB. 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field is programmed by platform BIOS to match the component ID of the (G)MCH RCRB that is attached to this RCRB. 15:2 312 Attribute: Size: 31:24 15:8 10.1.17 RO 32-bit 19:16 15:0 10.1.16 Attribute: Size: Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to the (G)MCH RCRB. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. Indicates that the link entry is valid. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.18 ULBA—Upstream Link Base Address Register Offset Address: 0118–011Fh Default Value: 0000000000000000h 10.1.19 Description 63:32 Base Address Upper (BAU) — R/WO. This field is programmed by platform BIOS to match the upper 32-bits of base address of the (G)MCH RCRB that is attached to this RCRB. 31:0 Base Address Lower (BAL) — R/WO. This field is programmed by platform BIOS to match the lower 32-bits of base address of the (G)MCH RCRB that is attached to this RCRB. RP1D—Root Port 1 Descriptor Register Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 1h (root port #1). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. 15:2 Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When FD.PE1D (offset 3418h, bit 16) is set, this link is not valid (returns 0). When FD.PE1D is cleared, this link is valid (returns 1). RP1BA—Root Port 1 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0128–012Fh Default Value: 00000000000E0000h Bit Attribute: Size: RO 64-bit Description 63:28 Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #0. 11:0 Datasheet R/WO 64-bit Bit Offset Address: 0120–0123h Default Value: 01xx0002h 10.1.20 Attribute: Size: Reserved 313 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.21 RP2D—Root Port 2 Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0130–0133h Default Value: 02xx0002h Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 2h (root port #2). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When RPC.PC (offset 0224h, bits 1:0) is ‘01’, ‘10’, or ‘11’, or FD.PE2D (offset 3418h, bit 17) is set, the link for this root port is not valid (return 0). When RPC.PC is ‘00’ and FD.PE2D is cleared, the link for this root port is valid (return 1). RP2BA—Root Port 2 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0138–013Fh Default Value: 00000000000E1000h Bit RO 64-bit Description Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #1. Reserved RP3D—Root Port 3 Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0140–0143h Default Value: 03xx0002h Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 3h (root port #3). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. 15:2 314 Attribute: Size: 63:28 11:0 10.1.23 R/WO, RO 32-bit Bit 15:2 10.1.22 Attribute: Size: Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When RPC.PC (offset 0224h, bits 1:0) is ‘11’, or FD.PE3D (offset 3418h, bit 18) is set, the link for this root port is not valid (return 0). When RPC.PC is ‘00’, ‘01’, or “10’, and FD.PE3D is cleared, the link for this root port is valid (return 1). Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.24 RP3BA—Root Port 3 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0148–014Fh Default Value: 00000000000E2000h Bit Description Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #2. Reserved RP4D—Root Port 4 Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0150–0153h Default Value: 04xx0002h R/WO, RO 32-bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 4h (root port #4). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When RPC.PC (offset 0224h, bits 1:0) is ‘10’ or ‘11’, or FD.PE4D (offset 3418h, bit 19) is set, the link for this root port is not valid (return 0). When RPC.PC is ‘00’ or ‘01’ and FD.PE4D is cleared, the link for this root port is valid (return 1). RP4BA—Root Port 4 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0158–015Fh Default Value: 00000000000E3000h Bit Attribute: Size: RO 64-bit Description 63:28 Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #3. 11:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Bit 15:2 10.1.26 RO 64-bit 63:28 11:0 10.1.25 Attribute: Size: Reserved 315 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.27 HDD—Intel® High Definition Audio Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0160–0163h Default Value: 0Fxx0002h Bit Description Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 15h (Intel High Definition Audio). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When FD.ZD (offset 3418h, bit 4) is set, the link to Intel High Definition Audio is not valid (return 0). When FD.ZD is cleared, the link to Intel High Definition Audio is valid (return 1). HDBA—Intel® High Definition Audio Base Address Register Offset Address: 0168–016Fh Default Value: 00000000000D8000h Bit RO 64-bit Description Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the High Definition Audio captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #27. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #0. Reserved RP5D—Root Port 5 Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0170–0173h Default Value: 05xx0002h Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 5h (root port #5). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. 15:2 316 Attribute: Size: 63:28 11:0 10.1.29 R/WO, RO 32-bit 31:24 15:2 10.1.28 Attribute: Size: Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When FD.PE5D (offset 3418h, bit 20) is set, the link for this root port is not valid (return 0). When FD.PE5D is cleared, the link for this root port is valid (return 1). Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.30 RP5BA—Root Port 5 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0178–017Fh Default Value: 00000000000E4000h Bit Description Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #4. Reserved RP6D—Root Port 6 Descriptor Register Offset Address: 0180–0183h Default Value: 06xx0002h R/WO, RO 32-bit Description 31:24 Target Port Number (PN) — RO. Indicates the target port number is 6h (root port #6). 23:16 Target Component ID (TCID) — R/WO. This field returns the value of the ESD.CID (offset 0104h, bits 23:16) field programmed by platform BIOS, since the root port is in the same component as the RCRB. Reserved 1 Link Type (LT) — RO. Indicates that the link points to a root port. 0 Link Valid (LV) — RO. When RPC.PC2 (offset 0224h, bits 1:0) is ‘01’ or FD.PE6D (offset 3418h, bit 21) is set, the link for this root port is not valid (return 0). When RPC.PC is ‘00’ and FD.PE6D is cleared, the link for this root port is valid (return 1). RP6BA—Root Port 6 Base Address Register Offset Address: 0188–018Fh Default Value: 00000000000E5000h Bit Attribute: Size: RO 64-bit Description 63:28 Reserved 27:20 Bus Number (BN) — RO. Indicates the root port captured bus number. 19:15 Device Number (DN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on device #28. 14:12 Function Number (FN) — RO. Indicates the root port is on function #5. 11:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Bit 15:2 10.1.32 RO 64-bit 63:28 11:0 10.1.31 Attribute: Size: Reserved 317 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.33 ILCL—Internal Link Capabilities List Register Offset Address: 01A0–01A3h Default Value: 00010006h Bit Description 31:20 Next Capability Offset (NEXT) — RO. Indicates this is the last item in the list. Capability Version (CV) — RO. Indicates the version of the capability structure. Capability ID (CID) — RO. Indicates this is capability for DMI. LCAP—Link Capabilities Register Offset Address: 01A4–01A7h Default Value: 00012841h Bit 10.1.35 RO 32-bit 19:16 15:0 10.1.34 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit Description 31:18 Reserved 17:15 Reserved 14:12 L0s Exit Latency (EL0) — R/WO. This field indicates that exit latency is 128 ns to less than 256 ns. 11:10 Active State Link PM Support (APMS) — R/WO. Indicates that L0s and L1 are supported on DMI. 9:4 Maximum Link Width (MLW) — RO. Indicates the maximum link width is 4 ports. 3:0 Maximum Link Speed (MLS) — RO. Indicates the link speed is 2.5 Gb/s. LCTL—Link Control Register Offset Address: 01A8–01A9h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:8 7 6:2 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Extended Synch (ES) — R/W. When set, forces extended transmission of FTS ordered sets when exiting L0s prior to entering L0. Reserved Active State Link PM Control (ASPM) — R/W. Indicates whether DMI should enter L0s. 00 = Disabled 1:0 01 = L0s entry enabled 10 = Reserved 11 = Reserved Corporate Only: The value of this register is used unless the DMI ASPM Override Enable register is set, in which case the DMI ASPM Override is used. 318 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.36 LSTS—Link Status Register Offset Address: 01AA–01ABh Default Value: 0041h Bit 15:10 10.1.37 Reserved 9:4 Negotiated Link Width (NLW) — RO. Negotiated link width is x4 (000100b). 3:0 Link Speed (LS) — RO. Link is 2.5 Gb/s. CIR2 — Chipset Initialization Register 2 Bit 31:0 R/W 32-bit CIR2 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS shall program to 86000040h CIR3 — Chipset Initialization Register 3 Bit 15:11 10:8 7:4 3 2 1:0 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved CIR3 Field 3 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 110b. Reserved CIR3 Field 2 — R/W. BIOS must set this bit. Reserved CIR3 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 11b. BCR — Backbone Configuration Register Offset Address: 0220–0223h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:7 6 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Description Offset Address: 01FC–01FDh Default Value: 0000h 10.1.39 RO 16-bit Description Offset Address: 01F4–01F7h Default Value: 00000000h 10.1.38 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved BCR Field 2 — R/W. BIOS must set this bit. 5:3 Reserved 2:0 BCR Field 1 — R/W. BIOS program this field to 101b 319 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.40 RPC—Root Port Configuration Register Offset Address: 0224–0227h Default Value: 0000000yh (y = 00xxb) Bit 31:8 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32-bit Description Reserved High Priority Port Enable (HPE) — R/W. 7 0 = The high priority path is not enabled. 1 = The port selected by the HPP field in this register is enabled for high priority. It will be arbitrated above all other VC0 (including integrated VC0) devices. High Priority Port (HPP) — R/W. This controls which port is enabled for high priority when the HPE bit in this register is set. 111 = Reserved 110 = Reserved 6:4 101 = Port 6 100 = Port 5 101 = Port 4 010 = Port 3 001 = Port 2 000 = Port 1 3 Reserved Port Configuration2 (PC2) — RO. This controls how the PCI bridges are organized in various modes of operation for Ports 5 and 6. 2 Corporate only: This bit is set by the PCIEPCS2[1:0] soft strap. 1 = Reserved 0 = 2 x1s, Port 5 (x1), Port 6 (x1) This bit is in the resume well and is only reset by RSMRST#. Port Configuration (PC) — RO. This controls how the PCI bridges are organized in various modes of operation for Ports 1-4. For the following mappings, if a port is not shown, it is considered a x1 port with no connection. Consumer Only: These bits represent the strap values of HDA_SDOUT (bit 1) and HDA_SYNC (bit 0) when TP[3] is not pulled low at the rising edge of PWROK. 1:0 Corporate Only: These bits are set by the PCIEPCS1[1:0] soft strap. 11 = 1 x4, Port 1 (x4) 10 = Reserved 01 = Reserved 00 = 4 x1s, Port 1 (x1), Port 2 (x1), Port 3 (x1) and Port 4 (x1) These bits are in the resume well and are only reset by RSMRST#. 320 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.41 DMIC—DMI Control Register Offset Address: 0234–0237h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:19 18 Corporate Only Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved ASPM Control Override Enable (ASPMCOEN) — RW. 1 = DMI will use the values in the ASPM Control Override registers 0 = DMI will use the ASPM Registers in the Link Control register. NOTES:This register allows BIOS to control the DMI ASPM settings instead of the OS. 18 (Consumer Only) 17:16 (Corporate Only) Reserved ASPM Control Override (ASPMO) — RW. Provides BIOS control of whether DMI should enter L0s or L1 or both. 00 = Disabled 01 = L0s Entry Enabled 10 = L1 Entry Enabled 11 = L0s and L1 Entry Enabled. 17:16 (Consumer Only) Reserved 15:2 Reserved 1:0 10.1.42 DMI Clock Gate Enable (DMICGEN) — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 11b. RPFN—Root Port Function Number and Hide for PCI Express* Root Ports Offset Address: 0238–023Ch Default Value: 00543210h Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 32-bit For the PCI Express root ports, the assignment of a function number to a root port is not fixed. BIOS may re-assign the function numbers on a port by port basis. This capability will allow BIOS to disable/hide any root port and still have functions 0 thru N1 where N is the total number of enabled root ports. Port numbers will remain fixed to a physical root port. The existing root port Function Disable registers operate on physical ports (not functions). Port Configuration (1x4, 4x1, etc.) is not affected by the logical function number assignment and is associated with physical ports. Datasheet 321 Chipset Configuration Registers Bit 31:24 23 22:20 19 18:16 15 14:12 11 10:8 7 6:4 3 2:0 322 Description Reserved Root Port 6 Config Hide (RP6CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 6 Function Number (RP6FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 6. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Root Port 5 Config Hide (RP5CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 5 Function Number (RP5FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 5. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Root Port 4 Config Hide (RP4CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 4 Function Number (RP4FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 4. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Root Port 3 Config Hide (RP3CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 3 Function Number (RP3FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 3. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Root Port 2 Config Hide (RP2CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 2 Function Number (RP2FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 2. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Root Port 1 Config Hide (RP1CH) — RW. This bit is used to hide the root port and any devices behind it from being discovered by the OS. When set to ‘1’ the root port will not claim any downstream configuration transactions. Root Port 1 Function Number (RP1FN) — R/WO. These bits set the function number for PCI Express Root Port 1. This root port function number must be a unique value from the other root port function numbers Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.43 FLRSTAT—FLR Pending Status Register Offset Address: 0290–0293h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:24 Attribute: Size: RO 32-bit Description Reserved. FLR Pending Status for D29:F7, EHCI #1 — R0. 23 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. 22:20 Reserved. FLR Pending Status for D29:F3, UHCI #6 — R0. 19 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D29:F2, UHCI #3 — R0. 18 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D29:F1, UHCI #2 — R0. 17 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D29:F0, UHCI #1 — R0. 16 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D26:F7, EHCI #2 — R0. 15 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. 14:11 Reserved. FLR Pending Status for D26:F2, UHCI #6 — R0. 10 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D26:F1, UHCI #5 — R0. 9 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. FLR Pending Status for D26:F0, UHCI #4 — R0. 8 0 = Function Level Reset is not pending. 1 = Function Level Reset is pending. 7:0 Datasheet Reserved. 323 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.44 CIR13—Chipset Initialization Register 13 Offset Address: 0F20h–0F23h Default Value: B2B477CCh Bit Description Reserved 19:16 CIR13 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 0101b. Reserved CIR5—Chipset Initialization Register 5 Offset Address: 1D40h–1D47h Default Value: 0000000000000000h Bit 63:1 0 10.1.46 R/W 32-bit 31:20 15:0 10.1.45 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W 64-bit Description Reserved CIR5 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 1b. TRSR—Trap Status Register Offset Address: 1E00–1E03h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:4 Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 32-bit Description Reserved Cycle Trap SMI# Status (CTSS) — R/WC. These bits are set by hardware when the corresponding Cycle Trap register is enabled and a matching cycle is received (and trapped). These bits are OR’ed together to create a single status bit in the Power Management register space. 3:0 Note that the SMI# and trapping must be enabled in order to set these bits. These bits are set before the completion is generated for the trapped cycle, thereby ensuring that the processor can enter the SMI# handler when the instruction completes. Each status bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit location in this register. 324 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.47 TRCR—Trapped Cycle Register Offset Address: 1E10–1E17h Default Value: 0000000000000000h Attribute: Size: RO 64-bit This register saves information about the I/O Cycle that was trapped and generated the SMI# for software to read. Bit 63:25 Description Reserved Read/Write# (RWI) — RO. 24 23:20 Reserved 19:16 Active-high Byte Enables (AHBE) — RO. This is the dword-aligned byte enables associated with the trapped cycle. A 1 in any bit location indicates that the corresponding byte is enabled in the cycle. 15:2 1:0 10.1.48 0 = Trapped cycle was a write cycle. 1 = Trapped cycle was a read cycle. Trapped I/O Address (TIOA) — RO. This is the dword-aligned address of the trapped cycle. Reserved TWDR—Trapped Write Data Register Offset Address: 1E18–1E1Fh Default Value: 0000000000000000h Attribute: Size: RO 64-bit This register saves the data from I/O write cycles that are trapped for software to read. Bit 63:32 31:0 Datasheet Description Reserved Trapped I/O Data (TIOD) — RO. Dword of I/O write data. This field is undefined after trapping a read cycle. 325 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.49 IOTRn — I/O Trap Register (0-3) Offset Address: 1E80–1E87h Register 0 1E88–1E8Fh Register 1 1E90–1E97h Register 2 1E98–1E9Fh Register 3 Default Value: 0000000000000000h Attribute: R/W Size: 64-bit These registers are used to specify the set of I/O cycles to be trapped and to enable this functionality. Bit 63:50 Description Reserved Read/Write Mask (RWM) — R/W. 49 0 = The cycle must match the type specified in bit 48. 1 = Trapping logic will operate on both read and write cycles. Read/Write# (RWIO) — R/W. 48 0 = Write 1 = Read NOTE: The value in this field does not matter if bit 49 is set. 47:40 Reserved 39:36 Byte Enable Mask (BEM) — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding byte enable bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Byte Enables field, below, is ignored. 35:32 Byte Enables (TBE) — R/W. Active-high dword-aligned byte enables. 31:24 Reserved 23:18 Address[7:2] Mask (ADMA) — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding address bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Address field, below, is ignored. The mask is only provided for the lower 6 bits of the dword address, allowing for traps on address ranges up to 256 bytes in size. 17:16 Reserved 15:2 I/O Address[15:2] (IOAD) — R/W. dword-aligned address 1 Reserved 0 0 = Trapping and SMI# logic disabled. 1 = The trapping logic specified in this register is enabled. Trap and SMI# Enable (TRSE) — R/W. 326 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.50 DMC—DMI Miscellaneous Control Register Offset Address: 2010–2013h Default Value: 00000002h Bit 31:20 19 Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved DMI Misc. Control Field 1 — R/W. BIOS shall always program this field as per the BIOS Specification. 0 = Disable DMI Power Savings. 1 = Enable DMI Power Savings. 18:0 10.1.51 Reserved CIR6—Chipset Initialization Register 6 Offset Address: 2024–2027h Default Value: 0B4030C0h Bit 31:8 7 6:0 10.1.52 R/W 32-bit Description Reserved CIR6 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must clear this bit. Reserved CIR7—Chipset Initialization Register 7 Offset Address: 2034–2037h Default Value: B2B477CCh Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description 31:20 Reserved 19:16 CIR7 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 0101b. 15:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Reserved 327 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.53 TCTL—TCO Configuration Register Offset Address: 3000–3000h Default Value: 00h Attribute: Size: Bit R/W 8-bit Description TCO IRQ Enable (IE) — R/W. 7 6:3 0 = TCO IRQ is disabled. 1 = TCO IRQ is enabled, as selected by the TCO_IRQ_SEL field. Reserved TCO IRQ Select (IS) — R/W. Specifies on which IRQ the TCO will internally appear. If not using the APIC, the TCO interrupt must be routed to IRQ9-11, and that interrupt is not sharable with the SERIRQ stream, but is shareable with other PCI interrupts. If using the APIC, the TCO interrupt can also be mapped to IRQ20-23, and can be shared with other interrupt. 2:0 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 = = = = = = = = IRQ 9 IRQ 10 IRQ 11 Reserved IRQ 20 (only IRQ 21 (only IRQ 22 (only IRQ 23 (only if if if if APIC APIC APIC APIC enabled) enabled) enabled) enabled) When setting the these bits, the IE bit should be cleared to prevent glitching. When the interrupt is mapped to APIC interrupts 9, 10 or 11, the APIC should be programmed for active-high reception. When the interrupt is mapped to APIC interrupts 20 through 23, the APIC should be programmed for active-low reception. 328 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.54 D31IP—Device 31 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3100–3103h Default Value: 03243200h Bit 31:28 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32-bit Description Reserved Thermal Throttle Pin (TTIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the Thermal Throttle controller drives as its interrupt 27:24 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h–Fh = Reserved SATA Pin 2 (SIP2) — R/W. Indicates which pin the SATA controller 2 drives as its interrupt. 23:20 19:16 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h–Fh = Reserved Reserved SMBus Pin (SMIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the SMBus controller drives as its interrupt. 15:12 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h–Fh = Reserved SATA Pin (SIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the SATA controller drives as its interrupt. 11:8 Datasheet 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h–Fh = Reserved 7:4 Reserved 3:0 LPC Bridge Pin (LIP) — RO. Currently, the LPC bridge does not generate an interrupt, so this field is read-only and 0. 329 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.55 D30IP—Device 30 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3104–3107h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:4 3:0 10.1.56 Attribute: Size: RO 32-bit Description Reserved PCI Bridge Pin (PIP) — RO. Currently, the PCI bridge does not generate an interrupt, so this field is read-only and 0. D29IP—Device 29 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3108–310Bh Default Value: 10004321h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description EHCI Pin (EIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the EHCI controller #1 drives as its interrupt. 0h = No interrupt 31:28 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved 27:16 Reserved UHCI #6 Pin (U3P) — R/W. Indicates which pin the UHCI controller #6 (Device 29 Function 3) drives as its interrupt, if controller exists 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 15:12 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# (Default) 5h-7h = Reserved NOTE: This field should be set to 0h when UHCI Controller #6 Remap bit (RCBA offset 35F0h:bit 0) is set to 0. UHCI #3 Pin (U2P) — R/W. Indicates which pin the UHCI controller #3 (Device 29 Function 2) drives as its interrupt. 0h = No interrupt 11:8 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# (Default) 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved 330 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers Bit Description UHCI #2 Pin (U1P) — R/W. Indicates which pin the UHCI controller #2 (Device 29 Function 1) drives as its interrupt. 0h = No interrupt 7:4 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved UHCI #1 Pin (U0P) — R/W. Indicates which pin the UHCI controller #1 (Device 29 Function 0) drives as its interrupt. 0h = No interrupt 3:0 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved 10.1.57 D28IP—Device 28 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 310C–310Fh Default Value: 00214321h Bit 31:16 Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved PCI Express* #6 Pin (P6IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express* port #6 drives as its interrupt. 23:20 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved PCI Express #5 Pin (P5IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express port #5 drives as its interrupt. 19:16 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved PCI Express #4 Pin (P4IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express* port #4 drives as its interrupt. 15:12 Datasheet 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# (Default) 5h-7h = Reserved 331 Chipset Configuration Registers Bit Description PCI Express #3 Pin (P3IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express port #3 drives as its interrupt. 11:8 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# (Default) 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved PCI Express #2 Pin (P2IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express port #2 drives as its interrupt. 7:4 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved PCI Express #1 Pin (P1IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the PCI Express port #1 drives as its interrupt. 3:0 10.1.58 0h = No interrupt 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-7h = Reserved D27IP—Device 27 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3110–3113h Default Value: 00000001h Bit 31:4 Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved Intel® High Definition Audio Pin (ZIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the Intel High Definition Audio controller drives as its interrupt. 0h = No interrupt 3:0 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved 332 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.59 D26IP—Device 26 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3114–3117h Default Value: 30000321h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description EHCI #2 Pin (E2IP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the EHCI controller #2 drives as its interrupt: 31:28 27:12 0h = No Interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# (Default) 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved Reserved UHCI #6 Pin (U2P) — R/W. Indicates which pin UHCI controller #6 (Device 26 Function 2) drives as its interrupt, if controller exists. 11:8 0h = No Interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# (Default) 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved NOTE: This field should be set to 0h when UHCI Controller #6 Remap bit (RCBA offset 35F0h:bit 0) is set to 1. UHCI #5 Pin (U1P) — R/W. Indicates which pin UHCI controller #5 (Device 26 Function 1), drives as its interrupt. 7:4 0h = No Interrupt 1h = INTA# 2h = INTB# (Default) 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved UHCI #4 Pin (U0P) — R/W. Indicates which pin UHCI controller #4 (Device 26 Function 0), drives as its interrupt. 3:0 Datasheet 0h = No Interrupt 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved 333 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.60 D25IP—Device 25 Interrupt Pin Register Offset Address: 3118–311Bh Default Value: 00000001h Bit 31:4 Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved GBE LAN Pin (LIP) — R/W. Indicates which pin the internal GbE LAN controller drives as its interrupt 3:0 10.1.61 0h = No Interrupt 1h = INTA# (Default) 2h = INTB# 3h = INTC# 4h = INTD# 5h-Fh = Reserved D31IR—Device 31 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3140–3141h Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the Intel ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 31 functions. 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 31 functions. 10:8 7 334 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers Bit Description Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 31 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 31 functions. 2:0 10.1.62 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# (Default) PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# D30IR—Device 30 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3142–3143h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: RO 16-bit Description Reserved. No interrupts generated from Device 30. 335 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.63 D29IR—Device 29 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3144–3145h Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the Intel ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 29 functions. 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 29 functions. 10:8 7 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 29 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 29 functions. 2:0 336 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# (Default) PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.64 D28IR—Device 28 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3146–3147h Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the Intel ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 28 functions. 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 28 functions. 10:8 7 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 28 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 28 functions. 2:0 Datasheet 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# (Default) PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# 337 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.65 D27IR—Device 27 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3148–3149h Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the Intel ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 27 functions. 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 27 functions. 10:8 7 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 27 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 27 functions. 2:0 338 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# (Default) PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.66 D26IR—Device 26 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 314C–314Dh Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 26 functions: 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 26 functions. 10:8 7 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 26 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 26 functions. 0h = PIRQA# (Default) 2:0 Datasheet 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# 339 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.67 D25IR—Device 25 Interrupt Route Register Offset Address: 3150–3151h Default Value: 3210h Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Interrupt D Pin Route (IDR): — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTD# pin reported for device 25 functions: 14:12 11 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# (Default) PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt C Pin Route (ICR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTC# pin reported for device 25 functions. 10:8 7 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# PIRQC# (Default) PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt B Pin Route (IBR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTB# pin reported for device 25 functions. 6:4 3 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# PIRQB# (Default) PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Reserved Interrupt A Pin Route (IAR) — R/W. Indicates which physical pin on the ICH is connected to the INTA# pin reported for device 25 functions. 2:0 340 0h 1h 2h 3h 4h 5h 6h 7h = = = = = = = = PIRQA# (Default) PIRQB# PIRQC# PIRQD# PIRQE# PIRQF# PIRQG# PIRQH# Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.68 OIC—Other Interrupt Control Register (Corporate Only) Offset Address: 31FE–31FFh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:10 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved Coprocessor Error Enable (CEN) — R/W. 9 0 = FERR# will not generate IRQ13 nor IGNNE#. 1 = If FERR# is low, the Intel ICH10 generates IRQ13 internally and holds it until an I/O port F0h write. It will also drive IGNNE# active. APIC Enable (AEN) — R/W. 8 7:0 0 = The internal IOxAPIC is disabled. 1 = Enables the internal IOxAPIC and its address decode. NOTE: SW should read this register after modifying APIC enable bit prior to access to the IOxAPIC address range. APIC Range Select (ASEL) — R/W.These bits define address bits 19:12 for the IOxAPIC range. The default value of 00h enables compatibility with prior ICH products as an initial value. This value must not be changed unless the IOxAPIC Enable bit is cleared. NOTE: FEC10000h – FEC3FFFFh is allocated to PCIe when I/OxApic Enable (PAE) bit is set. 10.1.69 OIC—Other Interrupt Control Register (Consumer Only) Offset Address: 31FF–31FFh Default Value: 00h Attribute: Size: R/W 8-bit Bit Description 7:4 APIC Range Select (ASEL) — R/W.These bits define address bits 15:12 for the IOxAPIC range. The default value of 0h enables compatibility with prior ICH products as an initial value. This value must not be changed unless the IOxAPIC Enable bit is cleared. 3:2 Reserved Coprocessor Error Enable (CEN) — R/W. 1 0 = FERR# will not generate IRQ13 nor IGNNE#. 1 = If FERR# is low, the Intel® ICH10 generates IRQ13 internally and holds it until an I/O port F0h write. It will also drive IGNNE# active. APIC Enable (AEN) — R/W. 0 Datasheet 0 = The internal IOxAPIC is disabled. 1 = Enables the internal IOxAPIC and its address decode. NOTE: SW should read this register after modifying APIC enable bit prior to access to the IOxAPIC address range. 341 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.70 SBEMC3—Scheduled Break Event C3 Exit Latency Offset Address: 3300–3303h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:23 22:16 15 14:8 7 6:0 10.1.71 R/W 32-bit Description Reserved. Present State C3 Future State C3 Exit Latency (C3C3EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present and future C-state is C3. Reserved. Present State C2 Future State C3 Exit Latency (C2C3EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present C-state is C2 and future C-state is C3. Reserved. Present State C0 Future State C3 Exit Latency (C0C3EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present C-state is C0 and future C-state is C3. SBEMC4—Scheduled Break Event C4 Exit Latency Offset Address: 3304–3307h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31 30:24 22:16 15 14:8 7 6:0 342 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved. Present State C4 Future State C4 Exit Latency (C4C4EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present and future C-state is C4. Present State C3 Future State C4 Exit Latency (C3C4EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present C-state is C3 and future C-state is C4. Reserved. Present State C2 Future State C4 Exit Latency (C2C4EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present C-state is C2 and future C-state is C4. Reserved. Present State C0 Future State C4 Exit Latency (C0C4EL) — R/W. Sets exit latency if present C-state is C0 and future C-state is C4. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.72 PRSTS—Power and Reset Status (Corporate Only) Offset Address: 3310–3313h Default Value: TBDh Bit Attribute: Size: RO, R/WC 32-bit Description 31:16 15 14:7 6 Reserved Power Management Watchdog Timer-R/WC. This bit is set when the Power Management watchdog timer causes a global reset. Reserved Intel® Management Engine Watchdog Timer Status-R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel® Management Engine watchdog timer causes a global reset. Wake On Lan Override Wake Status (WOL_OVR_WK_STS) — R/WC. This bit gets set when all of the following conditions are met: 5 • • • Integrated LAN Signals a Power Management Event The system is not in S0 The “WOL Enable Override” bit is set in configuration space. BIOS can read this status bit to determine this wake source. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. Datasheet 4 Reserved 3 ME Host Power Down (ME_HOST_PWRDN) — R/WC.This bit is set when the Intel ME generates a host reset with power down. 2 ME Host Reset Warm Status (ME_HRST_WARM_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Host reset without power cycling. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to this bit position. 1 ME Host Reset Cold Status (ME_HRST_COLD_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Host reset with power cycling. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to this bit position. 0 ME WAKE STATUS (ME_WAKE_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Non-Maskable wake event, and is not affected by any other enable bit. When this bit is set, the Host Power Management logic wakes to S0. 343 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.73 RC—RTC Configuration Register Offset Address: 3400–3403h Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W, R/WLO 32-bit Description 31:5 Reserved Upper 128 Byte Lock (UL) — R/WLO. 4 0 = Bytes not locked. 1 = Bytes 38h-3Fh in the upper 128-byte bank of RTC RAM are locked and cannot be accessed. Writes will be dropped and reads will not return any ensured data. Bit reset on system reset. Lower 128 Byte Lock (LL) — R/WLO. 3 0 = Bytes not locked. 1 = Bytes 38h-3Fh in the lower 128-byte bank of RTC RAM are locked and cannot be accessed. Writes will be dropped and reads will not return any ensured data. Bit reset on system reset. Upper 128 Byte Enable (UE) — R/W. 2 1:0 10.1.74 0 = Bytes locked. 1 = The upper 128-byte bank of RTC RAM can be accessed. Reserved HPTC—High Precision Timer Configuration Register Offset Address: 3404–3407h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:8 Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Reserved Address Enable (AE) — R/W. 7 6:2 0 = Address disabled. 1 = The Intel® ICH10 will decode the High Precision Timer memory address range selected by bits 1:0 below. Reserved Address Select (AS) — R/W. This 2-bit field selects 1 of 4 possible memory address ranges for the High Precision Timer functionality. The encodings are: 1:0 00 = FED0_0000h – FED0_03FFh 01 = FED0_1000h – FED0_13FFh 10 = FED0_2000h – FED0_23FFh 11 = FED0_3000h – FED0_33FFh 344 Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.75 GCS—General Control and Status Register Offset Address: 3410–3413h Attribute: Default Value: 00000yy0h (yy = xx0000x0b)Size: Bit 31:13 R/W, R/WLO 32-bit Description Reserved. Function Level Reset Capability Structure Select (FLRCSSEL) — R/W. 12 0 = Function Level Reset (FLR) will utilize the standard capability structure with unique capability ID assigned by PCISIG. 1 = Vendor Specific Capability Structure is selected for FLR. Boot BIOS Straps (BBS) — R/W. This field determines the destination of accesses to the BIOS memory range. The default values for these bits represent the strap values of GNT0# (bit 11) at the rising edge of PWROK and SPI_CS1#(bit 10) at the rising edge of CLPWROK. Bits 11:10 11:10 Description 0xb SPI 10b PCI 11b LPC When PCI is selected, the top 16 MB of memory below 4 GB (FF00_0000h to FFFF_FFFFh) is accepted by the primary side of the PCI P2P bridge and forwarded to the PCI bus. This allows systems with corrupted or unprogrammed flash to boot from a PCI device. The PCI-to-PCI bridge Memory Space Enable bit does not need to be set (nor any other bits) in order for these cycles to go to PCI. Note that BIOS decode range bits and the other BIOS protection bits have no effect when PCI is selected. This functionality is intended for debug/testing only. When SPI or LPC is selected, the range that is decoded is further qualified by other configuration bits described in the respective sections. The value in this field can be overwritten by software as long as the BIOS Interface Lock-Down (bit 0) is not set. NOTE: Booting to PCI is intended for debug/testing only. Boot BIOS Destination Select to LPC/PCI by functional strap or via Boot BIOS Destination Bit will not affect SPI accesses initiated by Intel Management Engine or Integrated GbE LAN. Server Error Reporting Mode (SERM) — R/W. 9 8:7 0 = The Intel® ICH10 is the final target of all errors. The (G)MCH sends a messages to the ICH for the purpose of generating NMI. 1 = The (G)MCH is the final target of all errors from PCI Express* and DMI. In this mode, if the ICH10 detects a fatal, non-fatal, or correctable error on DMI or its downstream ports, it sends a message to the (G)MCH. If the ICH10 receives an ERR_* message from the downstream port, it sends that message to the (G)MCH. Reserved FERR# MUX Enable (FME) — R/W. This bit enables FERR# to be a processor break event indication. 6 0 = Disabled. 1 = The ICH10 examines FERR# during a C2, C3, or C4 state as a break event. See Chapter 5.13.5 for a functional description. Datasheet 345 Chipset Configuration Registers Bit 5 Description No Reboot (NR) — R/W. This bit is set when the “No Reboot” strap (SPKR pin on ICH10) is sampled high on PWROK. This bit may be set or cleared by software if the strap is sampled low but may not override the strap when it indicates “No Reboot”. 0 = System will reboot upon the second timeout of the TCO timer. 1 = The TCO timer will count down and generate the SMI# on the first timeout, but will not reboot on the second timeout. Alternate Access Mode Enable (AME) — R/W. 4 3 0 = Disabled. 1 = Alternate access read only registers can be written, and write only registers can be read. Before entering a low power state, several registers from powered down parts may need to be saved. In the majority of cases, this is not an issue, as registers have read and write paths. However, several of the ISA compatible registers are either read only or write only. To get data out of write-only registers, and to restore data into read-only registers, the ICH implements an alternate access mode. For a list of these registers see Section 5.13.9. Shutdown Policy Select (SPS) — R/W. When cleared (default), the ICH10 will drive INIT# in response to the shutdown Vendor Defined Message (VDM). When set to 1, ICH10 will treat the shutdown VDM similar to receiving a CF9h I/O write with data value06h, and will drive PLTRST# active. Reserved Page Route (RPR) — R/W. Determines where to send the reserved page registers. These addresses are sent to PCI or LPC for the purpose of generating POST codes. The I/O addresses modified by this field are: 80h, 84h, 85h, 86h, 88h, 8Ch, 8Dh, and 8Eh. 2 0 = Writes will be forwarded to LPC, shadowed within the ICH, and reads will be returned from the internal shadow 1 = Writes will be forwarded to PCI, shadowed within the ICH, and reads will be returned from the internal shadow. Note, if some writes are done to LPC/PCI to these I/O ranges, and then this bit is flipped, such that writes will now go to the other interface, the reads will not return what was last written. Shadowing is performed on each interface. The aliases for these registers, at 90h, 94h, 95h, 96h, 98h, 9Ch, 9Dh, and 9Eh, are always decoded to LPC. 1 Reserved BIOS Interface Lock-Down (BILD) — R/WLO. 0 346 0 = Disabled. 1 = Prevents BUC.TS (offset 3414, bit 0) and GCS.BBS (offset 3410h, bits 11:10) from being changed. This bit can only be written from 0 to 1 once. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.76 BUC—Backed Up Control Register Offset Address: 3414–3414h Default Value: 0000000xb Attribute: Size: R/W 8-bit All bits in this register are in the RTC well and only cleared by RTCRST# Bit Description 7:6 Reserved LAN Disable — R/W. 5 0 = LAN is Enabled 1 = LAN is Disabled. This bit is locked by the Function Disable SUS Well Lockdown register. Once locked this bit can not be changed by software. Daylight Savings Override (SDO) — R/W. 4 3 0 = Daylight Savings is Enabled. 1 = The DSE bit in RTC Register B is set to Read-only with a value of 0 to disable daylight savings. Reserved CPU BIST Enable (CBE) — R/W. This bit is in the resume well and is reset by RSMRST#, but not PLTRST# nor CF9h writes. 2 1 0 = Disabled. 1 = The INIT# signals will be driven active when CPURST# is active. INIT# and INIT3_3V# will go inactive with the same timings as the other processor interface signals (hold time after CPURST# inactive). Reserved Top Swap (TS) — R/W. 0 0 = Intel® ICH10 will not invert A16. 1 = ICH10 will invert A16 for cycles going to the BIOS space (but not the feature space) in the FWH. If ICH is strapped for Top-Swap (GNT3# is low at rising edge of PWROK), then this bit cannot be cleared by software. The strap jumper should be removed and the system rebooted. Datasheet 347 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.77 FD—Function Disable Register Offset Address: 3418–341Bh Default Value: See bit description Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit The UHCI functions must be disabled from highest function number to lowest within each PCI device (Device 29 or Device 26). For example, if only two UHCIs are wanted on Device 29, software must disable UHCI #3 (UD3 bit set). When disabling UHCIs, the EHCI Structural Parameters Registers must be updated with coherent information in “Number of Companion Controllers” and “N_Ports” fields. When disabling a function, only the configuration space is disabled. Software must ensure that all functionality within a controller that is not desired (such as memory spaces, I/O spaces, and DMA engines) is disabled prior to disabling the function. When a function is disabled, software must not attempt to re-enable it. A disabled function can only be re-enabled by a platform reset. Bit 31:26 Description Reserved Serial ATA Disable 2 (SAD2) — R/W. Default is 0. 25 0 = The SATA controller #2 (D31:F5) is enabled. 1 = The SATA controller #2 (D31:F5) is disabled. Thermal Throttle Disable (TTD) — R/W. Default is 0. 24 23:22 21 20 0 = Thermal Throttle is enabled. 1 = Thermal Throttle is disabled. Reserved PCI Express* 6 Disable (PE6D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the “link down” state. 0 = PCI Express* port #6 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #6 is disabled. PCI Express 5 Disable (PE5D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the link down state. 0 = PCI Express port #5 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #5 is disabled. PCI Express 4 Disable (PE4D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the “link down” state. 19 0 = PCI Express port #4 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #4 is disabled. NOTE: This bit must be set when Port 1 is configured as a x4. PCI Express 3 Disable (PE3D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the link down state. 18 0 = PCI Express port #3 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #3 is disabled. NOTE: This bit must be set when Port 1 is configured as a x4. PCI Express 2 Disable (PE2D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the link down state. 17 348 0 = PCI Express port #2 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #2 is disabled. NOTE: This bit must be set when Port 1 is configured as a x4 or a x2. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers Bit 16 Description PCI Express 1 Disable (PE1D) — R/W. Default is 0. When disabled, the link for this port is put into the link down state. 0 = PCI Express port #1 is enabled. 1 = PCI Express port #1 is disabled. EHCI #1 Disable (EHCI1D) — R/W. Default is 0. 15 0 = The EHCI #1 is enabled. 1 = The EHCI #1 is disabled. LPC Bridge Disable (LBD) — R/W. Default is 0. 0 = The LPC bridge is enabled. 1 = The LPC bridge is disabled. Unlike the other disables in this register, the following additional spaces will no longer be decoded by the LPC bridge: 14 • • • · Memory cycles below 16 MB (1000000h) · I/O cycles below 64 KB (10000h) · The Internal I/OxAPIC at FEC0_0000 to FECF_FFFF Memory cycles in the LPC BIOS range below 4 GB will still be decoded when this bit is set, but the aliases at the top of 1 MB (the E and F segment) no longer will be decoded. EHCI #2 Disable (EHCI2D) — R/W. Default is 0. 13 0 = The EHCI #2 is enabled. 1 = The EHCI #2 is disabled. Note: When this bit is set, the UHCI #5 function is not available and the UHCI #4 must be disabled by setting bit 11 in this register. UHCI #5 Disable (U5D) — R/W. Default is 0 12 0 = The UHCI #5 is enabled. 1 = The UHCI #5 is disabled. When the EHCI #2 Device Disable (EHCI2D) is set, this bit is a don’t care UHCI #4 Disable (U4D) — R/W. Default is 0. 11 0 = The 4th UHCI (ports 6 and 7) is enabled. 1 = The 4th UHCI (ports 6 and 7) is disabled. Note that UHCI #4 must be disabled when EHCI #2 is disabled with bit 13 in this register. UHCI #3 Disable (U3D) — R/W. Default is 0. 10 0 = The 3rd UHCI (ports 4 and 5) is enabled. 1 = The 3rd UHCI (ports 4 and 5) is disabled. UHCI #2 Disable (U2D) — R/W. Default is 0. 9 0 = The 2nd UHCI (ports 2 and 3) is enabled. 1 = The 2nd UHCI (ports 2 and 3) is disabled. UHCI #1 Disable (U1D) — R/W. Default is 0. 8 0 = The 1st UHCI (ports 0 and 1) is enabled. 1 = The 1st UHCI (ports 0 and 1) is disabled. UHCI #6 Disable (U6D) — R/W. Default is 0. 7 6:5 (Corporate Only) Datasheet 0 = The 6th UHCI (ports 10 and 11) is enabled. 1 = The 6th UHCI (ports 10 and 11) is disabled. USB Test Devices #1 and #2 — R/W. Default is 0. BIOS must set these bits to 11b. NOTE: These bits only apply to ICH10 Corporate A0, A1, and B0 Samples and are reserved for ICH10 Corporate Production units. 349 Chipset Configuration Registers Bit 6:5 (Consumer Only) Description Reserved Intel® High Definition Audio Disable (HDAD) — R/W. Default is 0. 4 0 = The Intel High Definition Audio controller is enabled. 1 = The Intel High Definition Audio controller is disabled and its PCI configuration space is not accessible. SMBus Disable (SD) — R/W. Default is 0. 3 0 = The SMBus controller is enabled. 1 = The SMBus controller is disabled. In ICH5 and previous, this also disabled the I/ O space. In ICH10, it only disables the configuration space. Serial ATA Disable 1 (SAD1) — R/W. Default is 0. 10.1.78 2 0 = The SATA controller #1 (D31:F2) is enabled. 1 = The SATA controller #1 (D31:F2) is disabled. 1 Reserved 0 BIOS must set this bit to 1b. CG—Clock Gating Offset Address: 341C–341Fh Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description Legacy (LPC) Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 31 30 0 = Legacy Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = Legacy Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled Reserved USB UHCI Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 29:28 0 = USB UHCI Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = USB UHCI Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled 0 = Reserved 1 = Reserved SATA Port 3 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 27 0 = SATA Port 3 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 3 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled SATA Port 2 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 26 0 = SATA Port 2 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 2 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled SATA Port 1 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 25 0 = SATA Port 1 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 1 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled SATA Port 0 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 24 350 0 = SATA Port 0 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 0 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers Bit Description LAN Static Clock Gating Enable (LANSCGE) — R/W. 23 0 = LAN Static Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = LAN Static Clock Gating is Enabled when the LAN Disable bit is set in the Backed Up Control RTC register. High Definition Audio Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 22 0 = High Definition Audio Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = High Definition Audio Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled High Definition Audio Static Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 21 0 = High Definition Audio Static Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = High Definition Audio Static Clock Gating is Enabled USB EHCI Static Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 20 0 = USB EHCI Static Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = USB EHCI Static Clock Gating is Enabled USB EHCI Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 19 0 = USB EHCI Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = USB EHCI Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled SATA Port 5 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 18 0 = SATA Port 5 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 5 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled SATA Port 4 Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 17 0 = SATA Port 4 Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = SATA Port 4 Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled 16 0 = PCI Dynamic Gating is Disabled 1 = PCI Dynamic Gating is Enabled PCI Dynamic Gate Enable — R/W. 15:6 Reserved SMBus Clock Gating Enable (SMBCGEN) — R/W. 5 0 = SMBus Clock Gating is Disabled. 1 = SMBus Clock Gating is Enabled. PCI Express* RX Clock Gating Enable (PRXCGEN) — R/W. 4 0 = AFE RX Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = AFE RX Clock Gating is Enabled whenever all PCIe ports RX are in squelch DMI and PCI Express* RX Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 3 0 = DMI and PCI Express root port RX Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = DMI and PCI Express root port RX Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled 2 0 = PCI Express root port TX Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = PCI Express root port TX Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled PCI Express TX Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. DMI TX Dynamic Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 1 0 = DMI TX Dynamic Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = DMI TX Dynamic Clock Gating is Enabled PCI Express Root Port Static Clock Gate Enable — R/W. 0 Datasheet 0 = PCI Express root port Static Clock Gating is Disabled 1 = PCI Express root port Static Clock Gating is Enabled 351 Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.79 FDSW—Function Disable SUS Well Offset Address: 3420h Default Value: 00h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 8-bit Description Function Disable SUS Well Lockdown (FDSWL)— R/W 7 6:0 10.1.80 0 = FDSW registers are not locked down 1 = FDSW registers are locked down Reserved CIR8—Chipset Initialization Register 8 Offset Address: 3430-3433h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 10.1.81 R/W 32-bit Description 7:2 Reserved 1:0 CIR8 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 10b. CIR9—Chipset Initialization Register 9 Offset Address: 350Ch–350Fh Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit Description 31:28 Reserved 27:26 CIR9 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 10b. 25:0 10.1.82 Attribute: Size: Reserved PPO—Port Power Off Offset Address: 3524–3525h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:12 Attribute: Size: R/W 16-bit Description Reserved USB Port Power Off— R/W 1 = The corresponding EHCI and UHCI ports are electrically disconnected in this mode. 11:0 352 Warning: The platform must ensure that the powered off ports are not routed to any internal USB header or external USB connector. The ICH provides pull-down termination resistors. This register can not be written when the USB Per-Port Registers Write Enable bit (UPRWC register, PMBASE + 3C, bit 1) is 0. Datasheet Chipset Configuration Registers 10.1.83 CIR10—Chipset Initialization Register 10 Offset Address: 352C–352Fh Default Value: 0008C008h Bit R/W 32-bit Description 32:18 Reserved 17:16 CIR10 Field 1— R/W. BIOS must program this field to 11b. 15:0 10.1.84 Attribute: Size: Reserved MAP—Remap Control Register Offset Address: 35F0–35F3h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:01 Attribute: Size: R/WO 32-bit Description Reserved UHCI Controller # 6 Remap — R/WO 1 = UHCI Controller #6 is mapped to Device 29 Function 3 0 0 = UHCI Controller #6 is mapped to Device 26 Function 2 Note: When this bit is set, SW should reprogram the HCSPARAMS register (Section 17.2.1.3) to reflect the correct value for N_CC (bits 15:12) and N_Ports (bits 3:0) in each EHCI controller. §§ Datasheet 353 Chipset Configuration Registers 354 Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) The ICH10 PCI bridge resides in PCI Device 30, Function 0 on bus #0. This implements the buffering and control logic between PCI and the backbone. The arbitration for the PCI bus is handled by this PCI device. 11.1 PCI Configuration Registers (D30:F0) Note: Address locations that are not shown should be treated as Reserved (see Section 9.2 for details). . Table 11-1. PCI Bridge Register Address Map (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) (Sheet 1 of 2) Offset 00h–01h 02h–03h Datasheet Mnemonic VID DID Register Name Default Type Vendor Identification 8086h RO Device Identification See register description RO 04h–05h PCICMD PCI Command 0000h R/W, RO 06h–07h PSTS PCI Status 0010h R/WC, RO 08h RID Revision Identification See register description RO 09h–0Bh CC Class Code 060401h RO 0Dh PMLT Primary Master Latency Timer 00h RO 0Eh HEADTYP Header Type 01h RO 18h–1Ah BNUM Bus Number 000000h RO 1Bh SMLT Secondary Master Latency Timer 00h R/W 1Ch–1Dh IOBASE_LIMIT I/O Base and Limit 0000h R/W, RO 1Eh–1Fh SECSTS Secondary Status 0280h R/WC, RO 20h–23h MEMBASE_LIMIT Memory Base and Limit 00000000h R/W 24h–27h PREF_MEM_BASE _LIMIT Prefetchable Memory Base and Limit 00010001h R/W, RO 28h–2Bh PMBU32 Prefetchable Memory Upper 32 Bits 00000000h R/W 2Ch–2Fh PMLU32 Prefetchable Memory Limit Upper 32 Bits 00000000h R/W 34h CAPP Capability List Pointer 50h RO 3Ch–3Dh INTR Interrupt Information 0000h R/W, RO 3Eh–3Fh BCTRL Bridge Control 0000h R/WC, RO, R/W 40h–41h SPDH Secondary PCI Device Hiding 0000h R/W, RO 44h–47h DTC Delayed Transaction Control 00000000h R/W 48h–4Bh BPS Bridge Proprietary Status 00000000h R/WC, RO 355 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Table 11-1. PCI Bridge Register Address Map (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) (Sheet 2 of 2) Offset 11.1.1 Mnemonic Register Name 4Ch–4Fh BPC Bridge Policy Configuration 50–51h SVCAP Subsystem Vendor Capability Pointer 54h–57h SVID Subsystem Vendor IDs Bit 15:0 00001200h R/W RO 000Dh RO 00000000 R/WO Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description Vendor ID — RO. This is a 16-bit value assigned to Intel. Intel VID = 8086h. DID— Device Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 02h–03h Default Value: See bit description 356 Type VID— Vendor Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 00h–01h Default Value: 8086h 11.1.2 Default Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Bit Description 15:0 Device ID — RO.This is a 16-bit value assigned to the PCI bridge. Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Family Specification Update for the value of the Device ID Register. Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 04h–05h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:11 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Reserved 10 Interrupt Disable (ID) — RO. Hardwired to 0. The PCI bridge has no interrupts to disable 9 Fast Back to Back Enable (FBE) — RO. Hardwired to 0, per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a. SERR# Enable (SERR_EN) — R/W. 8 7 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the ICH10 to generate an NMI (or SMI# if NMI routed to SMI#) when the D30:F0 SSE bit (offset 06h, bit 14) is set. Wait Cycle Control (WCC) — RO. Hardwired to 0, per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a. Parity Error Response (PER) — R/W. 6 0 = The ICH10 ignores parity errors on the PCI bridge. 1 = The ICH10 will set the SSE bit (D30:F0, offset 06h, bit 14) when parity errors are detected on the PCI bridge. 5 VGA Palette Snoop (VPS) — RO. Hardwired to 0, per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a. 4 Memory Write and Invalidate Enable (MWE) — RO. Hardwired to 0, per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a 3 Special Cycle Enable (SCE) — RO. Hardwired to 0, per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a and the PCI- to-PCI Bridge Specification. Bus Master Enable (BME) — R/W. 2 1 0 11.1.4 0 = Disable 1 = Enable. Allows the PCI-to-PCI bridge to accept cycles from PCI. Memory Space Enable (MSE) — R/W. Controls the response as a target for memory cycles targeting PCI. 0 = Disable 1 = Enable I/O Space Enable (IOSE) — R/W. Controls the response as a target for I/O cycles targeting PCI. 0 = Disable 1 = Enable PSTS—PCI Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 06h–07h Default Value: 0010h Note: Datasheet Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 16 bits For the writable bits, software must write a 1 to clear bits that are set. Writing a 0 to the bit has no effect. 357 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Bit Description Detected Parity Error (DPE) — R/WC. 15 0 = Parity error Not detected. 1 = Indicates that the ICH10 detected a parity error on the internal backbone. This bit gets set even if the Parity Error Response bit (D30:F0:04 bit 6) is not set. Signaled System Error (SSE) — R/WC. Several internal and external sources of the bridge can cause SERR#. The first class of errors is parity errors related to the backbone. The PCI bridge captures generic data parity errors (errors it finds on the backbone) as well as errors returned on backbone cycles where the bridge was the master. If either of these two conditions is met, and the primary side of the bridge is enabled for parity error response, SERR# will be captured as shown below. As with the backbone, the PCI bus captures the same sets of errors. The PCI bridge captures generic data parity errors (errors it finds on PCI) as well as errors returned on PCI cycles where the bridge was the master. If either of these two conditions is met, and the secondary side of the bridge is enabled for parity error response, SERR# will be captured as shown below. 14 The final class of errors is system bus errors. There are three status bits associated with system bus errors, each with a corresponding enable. The diagram capturing this is shown below. After checking for the three above classes of errors, an SERR# is generated, and PSTS.SSE logs the generation of SERR#, if CMD.SEE (D30:F0:04, bit 8) is set, as shown below. Received Master Abort (RMA) — R/WC. 13 358 0 = No master abort received. 1 = Set when the bridge receives a master abort status from the backbone. Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Bit Description Received Target Abort (RTA) — R/WC. 12 0 = No target abort received. 1 = Set when the bridge receives a target abort status from the backbone. Signaled Target Abort (STA) — R/WC. 11 10:9 0 = No signaled target abort 1 = Set when the bridge generates a completion packet with target abort status on the backbone. Reserved. Data Parity Error Detected (DPD) — R/WC. 8 7:5 Reserved. 4 Capabilities List (CLIST) — RO. Hardwired to 1. Capability list exist on the PCI bridge. 3 Interrupt Status (IS) — RO. Hardwired to 0. The PCI bridge does not generate interrupts. 2:0 11.1.5 0 = Data parity error Not detected. 1 = Set when the bridge receives a completion packet from the backbone from a previous request, and detects a parity error, and CMD.PERE is set (D30:F0:04 bit 6). Reserved RID—Revision Identification Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 08h Default Value: See bit description Bit 7:0 11.1.6 RO 8 bits Description Revision ID — RO. Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Family Specification Update for the value of the Revision ID Register CC—Class Code Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 09h-0Bh Default Value: 060401h Bit 23:16 15:8 7:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 24 bits Description Base Class Code (BCC) — RO. Hardwired to 06h. Indicates this is a bridge device. Sub Class Code (SCC) — RO. Hardwired to 04h. Indicates this device is a PCI-to-PCI bridge. Programming Interface (PI) — RO. Hardwired to 01h. Indicates the bridge is subtractive decode 359 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.7 PMLT—Primary Master Latency Timer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 0Dh Default Value: 00h Bit 11.1.8 7:3 Master Latency Timer Count (MLTC) — RO. Reserved per the PCI Express* Base Specification, Revision 1.0a. 2:0 Reserved HEADTYP—Header Type Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Bit 7 6:0 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Multi-Function Device (MFD) — RO. A 0 indicates a single function device Header Type (HTYPE) — RO. This 7-bit field identifies the header layout of the configuration space, which is a PCI-to-PCI bridge in this case. BNUM—Bus Number Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 18h-1Ah Default Value: 000000h Bit 23:16 15:8 7:0 360 RO 8 bits Description Offset Address: 0Eh Default Value: 01h 11.1.9 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W 24 bits Description Subordinate Bus Number (SBBN) — R/W. This field indicates the highest PCI bus number below the bridge. Secondary Bus Number (SCBN) — R/W. This field indicates the bus number of PCI. Primary Bus Number (PBN) — R/W. This field is default to 00h. In a multiple-ICH system, programmable PBN allows an ICH to be located on any bus. System configuration software is responsible for initializing these registers to appropriate values. PBN is not used by hardware in determining its bus number. Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.10 SMLT—Secondary Master Latency Timer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 1Bh Default Value: 00h Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bits This timer controls the amount of time the ICH10 PCI-to-PCI bridge will burst data on its secondary interface. The counter starts counting down from the assertion of FRAME#. If the grant is removed, then the expiration of this counter will result in the de-assertion of FRAME#. If the grant has not been removed, then the ICH10 PCI-to-PCI bridge may continue ownership of the bus. 11.1.11 Bit Description 7:3 Master Latency Timer Count (MLTC) — R/W. This 5-bit field indicates the number of PCI clocks, in 8-clock increments, that the ICH10 remains as master of the bus. 2:0 Reserved IOBASE_LIMIT—I/O Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 1Ch-1Dh Default Value: 0000h Datasheet Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Bit Description 15:12 I/O Limit Address Limit bits[15:12] — R/W. I/O Base bits corresponding to address lines 15:12 for 4-KB alignment. Bits 11:0 are assumed to be padded to FFFh. 11:8 I/O Limit Address Capability (IOLC) — RO. This field indicates that the bridge does not support 32-bit I/O addressing. 7:4 I/O Base Address (IOBA) — R/W. I/O Base bits corresponding to address lines 15:12 for 4-KB alignment. Bits 11:0 are assumed to be padded to 000h. 3:0 I/O Base Address Capability (IOBC) — RO. This field indicates that the bridge does not support 32-bit I/O addressing. 361 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.12 SECSTS—Secondary Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 1Eh–1Fh Default Value: 0280h Note: Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 16 bits For the writable bits, software must write a 1 to clear bits that are set. Writing a 0 to the bit has no effect. Bit Description Detected Parity Error (DPE) — R/WC. 15 0 = Parity error not detected. 1 = Intel® ICH10 PCI bridge detected an address or data parity error on the PCI bus Received System Error (RSE) — R/WC. 14 0 = SERR# assertion not received 1 = SERR# assertion is received on PCI. Received Master Abort (RMA) — R/WC. 13 0 = No master abort. 1 = This bit is set whenever the bridge is acting as an initiator on the PCI bus and the cycle is master-aborted. For (G)MCH/ICH10 interface packets that have completion required, this must also cause a target abort to be returned and sets PSTS.STA. (D30:F0:06 bit 11) Received Target Abort (RTA) — R/WC. 12 0 = No target abort. 1 = This bit is set whenever the bridge is acting as an initiator on PCI and a cycle is target-aborted on PCI. For (G)MCH/ICH10 interface packets that have completion required, this event must also cause a target abort to be returned, and sets PSTS.STA. (D30:F0:06 bit 11). Signaled Target Abort (STA) — R/WC. 11 10:9 0 = No target abort. 1 = This bit is set when the bridge is acting as a target on the PCI Bus and signals a target abort. DEVSEL# Timing (DEVT) — RO. 01h = Medium decode timing. Data Parity Error Detected (DPD) — R/WC. 8 • • • The bridge is the initiator on PCI. PERR# is detected asserted or a parity error is detected internally BCTRL.PERE (D30:F0:3E bit 0) is set. 7 Fast Back to Back Capable (FBC) — RO. Hardwired to 1 to indicate that the PCI to PCI target logic is capable of receiving fast back-to-back cycles. 6 Reserved 5 66 MHz Capable (66MHZ_CAP) — RO. Hardwired to 0. This bridge is 33 MHz capable only. 4:0 362 0 = Conditions described below not met. 1 = The ICH10 sets this bit when all of the following three conditions are met: Reserved Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.13 MEMBASE_LIMIT—Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 20h–23h Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits This register defines the base and limit, aligned to a 1-MB boundary, of the nonprefetchable memory area of the bridge. Accesses that are within the ranges specified in this register will be sent to PCI if CMD.MSE is set. Accesses from PCI that are outside the ranges specified will be accepted by the bridge if CMD.BME is set. Bit 31:20 Memory Limit (ML) — R/W. These bits are compared with bits 31:20 of the incoming address to determine the upper 1-MB aligned value (exclusive) of the range. The incoming address must be less than this value. 19:16 Reserved 15:4 3:0 11.1.14 Description Memory Base (MB) — R/W. These bits are compared with bits 31:20 of the incoming address to determine the lower 1-MB aligned value (inclusive) of the range. The incoming address must be greater than or equal to this value. Reserved PREF_MEM_BASE_LIMIT—Prefetchable Memory Base and Limit Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 24h–27h Default Value: 00010001h Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32-bit Defines the base and limit, aligned to a 1-MB boundary, of the prefetchable memory area of the bridge. Accesses that are within the ranges specified in this register will be sent to PCI if CMD.MSE is set. Accesses from PCI that are outside the ranges specified will be accepted by the bridge if CMD.BME is set. Bit Description 31:20 Prefetchable Memory Limit (PML) — R/W. These bits are compared with bits 31:20 of the incoming address to determine the upper 1-MB aligned value (exclusive) of the range. The incoming address must be less than this value. 19:16 15:4 3:0 Datasheet 64-bit Indicator (I64L) — RO. Indicates support for 64-bit addressing. Prefetchable Memory Base (PMB) — R/W. These bits are compared with bits 31:20 of the incoming address to determine the lower 1-MB aligned value (inclusive) of the range. The incoming address must be greater than or equal to this value. 64-bit Indicator (I64B) — RO. Indicates support for 64-bit addressing. 363 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.15 PMBU32—Prefetchable Memory Base Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 28h–2Bh Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:0 11.1.16 Prefetchable Memory Base Upper Portion (PMBU) — R/W. Upper 32-bits of the prefetchable address base. PMLU32—Prefetchable Memory Limit Upper 32 Bits Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Bit 31:0 R/W 32 bits Prefetchable Memory Limit Upper Portion (PMLU) — R/W. Upper 32-bits of the prefetchable address limit. CAPP—Capability List Pointer Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Bit 7:0 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Capabilities Pointer (PTR) — RO. This field indicates that the pointer for the first entry in the capabilities list is at 50h in configuration space. INTR—Interrupt Information Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 3Ch–3Dh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:8 7:0 364 Attribute: Size: Description Offset Address: 34h Default Value: 50h 11.1.18 R/W 32 bits Description Offset Address: 2C–2Fh Default Value: 00000000h 11.1.17 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Interrupt Pin (IPIN) — RO. The PCI bridge does not assert an interrupt. Interrupt Line (ILINE) — R/W. Software written value to indicate which interrupt line (vector) the interrupt is connected to. No hardware action is taken on this register. Since the bridge does not generate an interrupt, BIOS should program this value to FFh as per the PCI bridge specification. Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.19 BCTRL—Bridge Control Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 3Eh–3Fh Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:12 11 10 9 Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO, R/W 16 bits Description Reserved Discard Timer SERR# Enable (DTE) — R/W. This bit controls the generation of SERR# on the primary interface in response to the DTS bit being set: 0 = Do not generate SERR# on a secondary timer discard 1 = Generate SERR# in response to a secondary timer discard Discard Timer Status (DTS) — R/WC. This bit is set to 1 when the secondary discard timer (see the SDT bit below) expires for a delayed transaction in the hard state. Secondary Discard Timer (SDT) — R/W. This bit sets the maximum number of PCI clock cycles that the Intel® ICH10 waits for an initiator on PCI to repeat a delayed transaction request. The counter starts once the delayed transaction data is has been returned by the system and is in a buffer in the ICH10 PCI bridge. If the master has not repeated the transaction at least once before the counter expires, the ICH10 PCI bridge discards the transaction from its queue. 0 = The PCI master timeout value is between 215 and 216 PCI clocks 1 = The PCI master timeout value is between 210 and 211 PCI clocks 8 Primary Discard Timer (PDT) — R/W. This bit is R/W for software compatibility only. 7 Fast Back to Back Enable (FBE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. The PCI logic will not generate fast back-to-back cycles on the PCI bus. Secondary Bus Reset (SBR) — R/W. This bit controls PCIRST# assertion on PCI. 6 0 = Bridge de-asserts PCIRST# 1 = Bridge asserts PCIRST#. When PCIRST# is asserted, the delayed transaction buffers, posting buffers, and the PCI bus are initialized back to reset conditions. The rest of the part and the configuration registers are not affected. Master Abort Mode (MAM) — R/W. This bit controls the ICH10 PCI bridge’s behavior when a master abort occurs: Master Abort on (G)MCH/ICH10 Interconnect (DMI): 0 = Bridge asserts TRDY# on PCI. It drives all 1s for reads, and discards data on writes. 1 = Bridge returns a target abort on PCI. 5 Master Abort PCI (non-locked cycles): 0 = Normal completion status will be returned on the (G)MCH/ICH10 interconnect. 1 = Target abort completion status will be returned on the (G)MCH/ICH10 interconnect. NOTE: All locked reads will return a completer abort completion status on the (G)MCH/ ICH10 interconnect. 4 Datasheet VGA 16-Bit Decode (V16D) — R/W. This bit enables the ICH10 PCI bridge to provide 16-bits decoding of VGA I/O address precluding the decode of VGA alias addresses every 1 KB. This bit requires the VGAE bit in this register be set. 365 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Bit Description VGA Enable (VGAE) — R/W. When set to a 1, the ICH10 PCI bridge forwards the following transactions to PCI regardless of the value of the I/O base and limit registers. The transactions are qualified by CMD.MSE (D30:F0:04 bit 1) and CMD.IOSE (D30:F0:04 bit 0) being set. 3 • • Memory addresses: 000A0000h-000BFFFFh I/O addresses: 3B0h-3BBh and 3C0h-3DFh. For the I/O addresses, bits [63:16] of the address must be 0, and bits [15:10] of the address are ignored (i.e., aliased). The same holds true from secondary accesses to the primary interface in reverse. That is, when the bit is 0, memory and I/O addresses on the secondary interface between the above ranges will be claimed. 2 1 ISA Enable (IE) — R/W. This bit only applies to I/O addresses that are enabled by the I/O Base and I/O Limit registers and are in the first 64 KB of PCI I/O space. If this bit is set, the ICH10 PCI bridge will block any forwarding from primary to secondary of I/O transactions addressing the last 768 bytes in each 1-KB block (offsets 100h to 3FFh). SERR# Enable (SEE) — R/W. This bit controls the forwarding of secondary interface SERR# assertions on the primary interface. When set, the PCI bridge will forward SERR# pin. • • • SERR# is asserted on the secondary interface. This bit is set. CMD.SEE (D30:F0:04 bit 8) is set. Parity Error Response Enable (PERE) — R/W. 0 11.1.20 0 = Disable 1 = The ICH10 PCI bridge is enabled for parity error reporting based on parity errors on the PCI bus. SPDH—Secondary PCI Device Hiding Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 40h–41h Default Value: 0000h Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits This register allows software to hide the PCI devices, either plugged into slots or on the motherboard. Bit 15:4 Description Reserved 3 Hide Device 3 (HD3) — R/W, RO. Same as bit 0 of this register, except for device 3 (AD[19]) 2 Hide Device 2 (HD2) — R/W, RO. Same as bit 0 of this register, except for device 2 (AD[18]) 1 Hide Device 1 (HD1) — R/W, RO. Same as bit 0 of this register, except for device 1 (AD[17]) Hide Device 0 (HD0) — R/W, RO. 0 366 0 = The PCI configuration cycles for this slot are not affected. 1 = Intel® ICH10 hides device 0 on the PCI bus. This is done by masking the IDSEL (keeping it low) for configuration cycles to that device. Since the device will not see its IDSEL go active, it will not respond to PCI configuration cycles and the processor will think the device is not present. AD[16] is used as IDSEL for device 0. Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.21 DTC—Delayed Transaction Control Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 44h–47h Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description Discard Delayed Transactions (DDT) — R/W. 31 0 = Logged delayed transactions are kept. 1 = The ICH10 PCI bridge will discard any delayed transactions it has logged. This includes transactions in the pending queue, and any transactions in the active queue, whether in the hard or soft DT state. The prefetchers will be disabled and return to an idle state. NOTES:If a transaction is running on PCI at the time this bit is set, that transaction will continue until either the PCI master disconnects (by de-asserting FRAME#) or the PCI bridge disconnects (by asserting STOP#). This bit is cleared by the PCI bridge when the delayed transaction queues are empty and have returned to an idle state. Software sets this bit and polls for its completion Block Delayed Transactions (BDT) — R/W. 30 29:8 0 = Delayed transactions accepted 1 = The ICH10 PCI bridge will not accept incoming transactions which will result in delayed transactions. It will blindly retry these cycles by asserting STOP#. All postable cycles (memory writes) will still be accepted. Reserved Maximum Delayed Transactions (MDT) — R/W. This field controls the maximum number of delayed transactions that the ICH10 PCI bridge will run. Encodings are: 7:6 00 =) 2 Active, 5 pending 01 =) 2 active, no pending 10 =) 1 active, no pending 11 =) Reserved 5 Reserved Auto Flush After Disconnect Enable (AFADE) — R/W. 4 0 = The PCI bridge will retain any fetched data until required to discard by producer/ consumer rules. 1 = The PCI bridge will flush any prefetched data after either the PCI master (by deasserting FRAME#) or the PCI bridge (by asserting STOP#) disconnects the PCI transfer. Never Prefetch (NP) — R/W. 3 Datasheet 0 = Prefetch enabled 1 = The ICH10 will only fetch a single DW and will not enable prefetching, regardless of the command being an Memory read (MR), Memory read line (MRL), or Memory read multiple (MRM). 367 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Bit Description Memory Read Multiple Prefetch Disable (MRMPD) — R/W. 2 0 = MRM commands will fetch multiple cache lines as defined by the prefetch algorithm. 1 = Memory read multiple (MRM) commands will fetch only up to a single, 64-byte aligned cache line. Memory Read Line Prefetch Disable (MRLPD) — R/W. 1 0 = MRL commands will fetch multiple cache lines as defined by the prefetch algorithm. 1 = Memory read line (MRL) commands will fetch only up to a single, 64-byte aligned cache line. Memory Read Prefetch Disable (MRPD) — R/W. 0 11.1.22 0 = MR commands will fetch up to a 64-byte aligned cache line. 1 = Memory read (MR) commands will fetch only a single DW. BPS—Bridge Proprietary Status Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 48h–4Bh Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:17 16 Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 32 bits Description Reserved PERR# Assertion Detected (PAD) — R/WC. This bit is set by hardware whenever the PERR# pin is asserted on the rising edge of PCI clock. This includes cases in which the chipset is the agent driving PERR#. It remains asserted until cleared by software writing a 1 to this location. When enabled by the PERR#-to-SERR# Enable bit (in the Bridge Policy Configuration register), a 1 in this bit can generate an internal SERR# and be a source for the NMI logic. This bit can be used by software to determine the source of a system problem. 15:7 Reserved Number of Pending Transactions (NPT) — RO. This field indicates to debug software how many transactions are in the pending queue. Possible values are: 000 = No pending transaction 001 = 1 pending transaction 010 = 2 pending transactions 6:4 011 = 3 pending transactions 100 = 4 pending transactions 101 = 5 pending transactions 110 - 111 = Reserved NOTE: This field is not valid if DTC.MDT (offset 44h:bits 7:6) is any value other than ‘00’. 3:2 Reserved Number of Active Transactions (NAT) — RO. This field indicates to debug software how many transactions are in the active queue. Possible values are: 1:0 00 = No active transactions 01 = 1 active transaction 10 = 2 active transactions 11 = Reserved 368 Datasheet PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) 11.1.23 BPC—Bridge Policy Configuration Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 4Ch–4Fh Default Value: 00001200h Attribute: Size: Bit 31:14 13:8 R/W 32 bits Description Reserved Upstream Read Latency Threshold (URLT) — R/W: This field specifies the number of PCI clocks after internally enqueuing an upstream memory read request at which point the PCI target logic should insert wait states in order to optimize lead-off latency. When the master returns after this threshold has been reached and data has not arrived in the Delayed Transaction completion queue, then the PCI target logic will insert wait states instead of immediately retrying the cycle. The PCI target logic will insert up to 16 clocks of target initial latency (from FRAME# assertion to TRDY# or STOP# assertion) before retrying the PCI read cycle (if the read data has not arrived yet). Note that the starting event for this Read Latency Timer is not explicitly visible externally. A value of 0h disables this policy completely such that wait states will never be inserted on the read lead-off data phase. The default value (12h) specifies 18 PCI clocks (540 ns) and is approximately 4 clocks less than the typical idle lead-off latency expected for desktop ICH10 systems. This value may need to be changed by BIOS, depending on the platform. Subtractive Decode Policy (SDP) — R/W. 0 = The PCI bridge always forwards memory and I/O cycles that are not claimed by any other device on the backbone (primary interface) to the PCI bus (secondary interface). 1 = The PCI bridge will not claim and forward memory or I/O cycles at all unless the corresponding Space Enable bit is set in the Command register. NOTE: The Boot BIOS Destination Selection strap can force the BIOS accesses to PCI. 7 6 CMD.MSE BPC.SDP Range Forwarding Policy 0 0 Don’t Care Forward unclaimed cycles 0 1 Don’t Care Forwarding Prohibited 1 X Within range Positive decode and forward 1 X Outside Subtractive decode & forward PERR#-to-SERR# Enable (PSE) — R/W. When this bit is set, a 1 in the PERR# Assertion status bit (in the Bridge Proprietary Status register) will result in an internal SERR# assertion on the primary side of the bridge (if also enabled by the SERR# Enable bit in the primary Command register). SERR# is a source of NMI. Secondary Discard Timer Testmode (SDTT) — R/W. 5 4:3 Datasheet 0 = The secondary discard timer expiration will be defined in BCTRL.SDT (D30:F0:3E, bit 9) 1 = The secondary discard timer will expire after 128 PCI clocks. Reserved 369 PCI-to-PCI Bridge Registers (D30:F0) Bit Description Peer Decode Enable (PDE) — R/W. 2 11.1.24 0 = The PCI bridge assumes that all memory cycles target main memory, and all I/O cycles are not claimed. 1 = The PCI bridge will perform peer decode on any memory or I/O cycle from PCI that falls outside of the memory and I/O window registers 1 Reserved 0 Received Target Abort SERR# Enable (RTAE) — R/W. When set, the PCI bridge will report SERR# when PSTS.RTA (D30:F0:06 bit 12) or SSTS.RTA (D30:F0:1E bit 12) are set, and CMD.SEE (D30:F0:04 bit 8) is set. SVCAP—Subsystem Vendor Capability Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 50h–51h Default Value: 000Dh Bit 15:8 7:0 11.1.25 Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description Next Capability (NEXT) — RO. Value of 00h indicates this is the last item in the list. Capability Identifier (CID) — RO. Value of 0Dh indicates this is a PCI bridge subsystem vendor capability. SVID—Subsystem Vendor IDs Register (PCI-PCI—D30:F0) Offset Address: 54h–57h Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/WO 32 bits Bit Description 31:16 Subsystem Identifier (SID) — R/WO. This field indicates the subsystem as identified by the vendor. This field is write once and is locked down until a bridge reset occurs (not the PCI bus reset). 15:0 Subsystem Vendor Identifier (SVID) — R/WO. This field indicates the manufacturer of the subsystem. This field is write once and is locked down until a bridge reset occurs (not the PCI bus reset). §§ 370 Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers (Gigabit LAN — D25:F0) Note: Register address locations that are not shown in Table 12-1 should be treated as Reserved. / Table 12-1. Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers Address Map (Gigabit LAN —D25:F0) (Sheet 1 of 2) Datasheet Offset Mnemonic Register Name Default Type 00h–01h VID Vendor Identification 8086h RO 02h–03h DID Device Identification See register description RO 04h–05h PCICMD PCI Command 0000h R/W, RO 06h–07h PCISTS PCI Status 0010h R/WC, RO 08h RID Revision Identification See register description RO 09h–0Bh CC Class Code 020000h RO 0Ch CLS Cache Line Size 00h R/W 0Dh PLT Primary Latency Timer 00h RO 0Eh HEADTYP Header Type 00h RO 10h–13h MBARA 00000000h R/W, RO Memory Base Address A 14h–17h MBARB Memory Base Address B 00000000h R/W, RO 18h–1Bh MBARC Memory Base Address C 00000001h R/W, RO 2Ch–2Dh SID Subsystem ID See register description RO 2Eh–2Fh SVID Subsystem Vendor ID See register description RO 30h–33h ERBA Expansion ROM Base Address See register description RO 34h CAPP Capabilities List Pointer C8h RO 3Ch–3Dh INTR Interrupt Information See register description R/W, RO 3Eh MLMG Maximum Latency/Minimum Grant 00h RO C8h–C9h CLIST1 D001h RO CAh–CBh PMC PCI Power Management Capability See register description RO CCh–CDh PMCS PCI Power Management Control and Status See register description R/WC, R/W, RO Capabilities List 1 371 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers Table 12-1. Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers Address Map (Gigabit LAN —D25:F0) (Sheet 2 of 2) 12.1.1 Offset Mnemonic CFh DR D0h–D1h CLIST2 D2h–D3h MCTL D4h–D7h MADDL D8h–DBh MADDH DCh–DDh MDAT E0h–E1h FLRCAP E2h–E3h FLRCLV E4h–E5h DEVCTRL Register Name Default Type See register description RO Capabilities List 2 E005h R/WO, RO Message Control 0080h R/W, RO Message Address Low See register description R/W Message Address High See register description R/W Message Data See register description R/W Function Level Reset Capability 0009h RO Function Level Reset Capability Length and Value See register description R/WO, RO 0000h R/W, RO Data Register Device Control VID—Vendor Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 00h–01h Default Value: 8086h 12.1.2 RO 16 bits Bit Description 15:0 Vendor ID — RO. This is a 16-bit value assigned to Intel. The field may be auto-loaded from the NVM at address 0Eh during init time depending on the "Load Vendor/Device ID" bit field in NVM word 0Ah with a default value of 8086h. DID—Device Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 02h–03h Default Value: See bit description Bit 15:0 372 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description Device ID — RO. This is a 16-bit value assigned to the Intel® ICH10 Gigabit LAN controller. The field may be auto-loaded from the NVM word 0Dh during initialization time depending on the "Load Vendor/Device ID" bit field in NVM word 0Ah. Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.3 PCICMD—PCI Command Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 04h–05h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:11 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Reserved Interrupt Disable — R/W. This disables pin-based INTx# interrupts on enabled HotPlug and power management events. This bit has no effect on MSI operation. 10 0 = Internal INTx# messages are generated if there is an interrupt for Hot-Plug or power management and MSI is not enabled. 1 = Internal INTx# messages will not be generated. This bit does not affect interrupt forwarding from devices connected to the root port. Assert_INTx and Deassert_INTx messages will still be forwarded to the internal interrupt controllers if this bit is set. 9 Fast Back to Back Enable (FBE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. SERR# Enable (SEE) — R/W. 8 7 0 = Disable 1 = Enables the Gb LAN controller to generate an SERR# message when PSTS.SSE is set. Wait Cycle Control (WCC) — RO. Hardwired to 0. Parity Error Response (PER) — R/W. 6 0 = Disable. 1 = Indicates that the device is capable of reporting parity errors as a master on the backbone. 5 Palette Snoop Enable (PSE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 4 Postable Memory Write Enable (PMWE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 3 Special Cycle Enable (SCE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. Bus Master Enable (BME) — R/W. 2 0 = Disable. All cycles from the device are master aborted 1 = Enable. Allows the root port to forward cycles onto the backbone from a Gigabit LAN* device. Memory Space Enable (MSE) — R/W. 1 0 = Disable. Memory cycles within the range specified by the memory base and limit registers are master aborted on the backbone. 1 = Enable. Allows memory cycles within the range specified by the memory base and limit registers can be forwarded to the Gigabit LAN device. I/O Space Enable (IOSE) — R/W. This bit controls access to the I/O space registers. 0 Datasheet 0 = Disable. I/O cycles within the range specified by the I/O base and limit registers are master aborted on the backbone. 1 = Enable. Allows I/O cycles within the range specified by the I/O base and limit registers can be forwarded to the Gigabit LAN device. 373 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 06h–07h Default Value: 0010h Bit Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 16 bits Description Detected Parity Error (DPE) — R/WC. 15 0 = No parity error detected. 1 = Set when the Gb LAN controller receives a command or data from the backbone with a parity error. This is set even if PCIMD.PER (D25:F0, bit 6) is not set. Signaled System Error (SSE) — R/WC. 14 0 = No system error signaled. 1 = Set when the Gb LAN controller signals a system error to the internal SERR# logic. Received Master Abort (RMA) — R/WC. 13 0 = Root port has not received a completion with unsupported request status from the backbone. 1 = Set when the Gb LAN controller receives a completion with unsupported request status from the backbone. Received Target Abort (RTA) — R/WC. 12 0 = Root port has not received a completion with completer abort from the backbone. 1 = Set when the Gb LAN controller receives a completion with completer abort from the backbone. Signaled Target Abort (STA) — R/WC. 11 10:9 0 = No target abort received. 1 = Set whenever the Gb LAN controller forwards a target abort received from the downstream device onto the backbone. DEVSEL# Timing Status (DEV_STS) — RO. Hardwired to 0. Master Data Parity Error Detected (DPED) — R/WC. 8 0 = No data parity error received. 1 = Set when the Gb LAN Controller receives a completion with a data parity error on the backbone and PCIMD.PER (D25:F0, bit 6) is set. 7 Fast Back to Back Capable (FB2BC) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 6 Reserved 5 66 MHz Capable — RO. Hardwired to 0. 4 Capabilities List — RO. Hardwired to 1. Indicates the presence of a capabilities list. Interrupt Status — RO. Indicates status of Hot-Plug and power management interrupts on the root port that result in INTx# message generation. 3 0 = Interrupt is deasserted. 1 = Interrupt is asserted. This bit is not set if MSI is enabled. If MSI is not enabled, this bit is set regardless of the state of PCICMD.Interrupt Disable bit (D25:F0:04h:bit 10). 2:0 374 Reserved Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Offset Address: 08h Default Value: See bit description Bit 7:0 12.1.6 Attribute: Size: Description Revision ID — RO. Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Family Specification Update for the value of the Revision ID Register CC—Class Code Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 09h–0Bh Default Value: 020000h Bit 23:0 12.1.7 Class Code— RO. Identifies the device as an Ethernet Adapter. CLS—Cache Line Size Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 Cache Line Size — R/W. This field is implemented by PCI devices as a read write field for legacy compatibility purposes but has no impact on any device functionality. PLT—Primary Latency Timer Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Bit 7:0 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Latency Timer (LT) — RO. Hardwired to ‘0’. HT—Header Type Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 0Eh Default Value: 00h Bit 7:0 Datasheet RO 24 bits 020000h = Ethernet Adapter. Address Offset: 0Dh Default Value: 00h 12.1.9 Attribute: Size: Description Address Offset: 0Ch Default Value: 00h 12.1.8 RO 8 bits Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Header Type (HT) — RO. 00h = Indicates this is a single function device. 375 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.10 MBARA—Memory Base Address Register A (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 10h–13h Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32 bits The internal CSR registers and memories are accessed as direct memory mapped offsets from the base address register. SW may only access whole DWord at a time. Bit 31:17 16:4 3 2:1 0 12.1.11 Description Base Address (BA) — R/W. Software programs this field with the base address of this region. Memory Size (MSIZE) — R/W. Memory size is 128 KB. Prefetchable Memory (PM) — RO. The GbE LAN controller does not implement prefetchable memory. Memory Type (MT) — RO. Set to 00b indicating a 32 bit BAR. Memory / IO Space (MIOS) — RO. Set to ‘0’ indicating a Memory Space BAR. MBARB—Memory Base Address Register B (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 14h–17h Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32 bits The internal registers that are used to access the LAN Space in the External FLASH device. Access to these registers are direct memory mapped offsets from the base address register. Software may only access a DWord at a time. Bit 31:12 11:4 3 2:1 0 376 Description Base Address (BA) — R/W. Software programs this field with the base address of this region. Memory Size (MSIZE) — R/W. Memory size is 4 KB. Prefetchable Memory (PM) — RO. The Gb LAN controller does not implement prefetchable memory. Memory Type (MT) — RO. Set to 00b indicating a 32 bit BAR. Memory / IO Space (MIOS) — RO. Set to ‘0’ indicating a Memory Space BAR. Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.12 MBARC—Memory Base Address Register C (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 18h–1Bh Default Value: 00000001h Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32 bits Internal registers, and memories, can be accessed using I/O operations. There are two 4B registers in the IO mapping window: Addr Reg and Data Reg. SW may only access a Dword at a time. Bit 31:5 4:1 0 12.1.13 Description Base Address (BA) — R/W. Software programs this field with the base address of this region. I/O Size (IOSIZE) — RO. I/O space size is 32 Bytes. Memory / IO Space (MIOS) — RO. Set to ‘1’ indicating an I/O Space BAR. SVID—Subsystem Vendor ID Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 2Ch–2Dh Default Value: See bit description 12.1.14 Description 15:0 Subsystem Vendor ID (SVID) — RO. This value may be loaded automatically from the NVM Word 0Ch upon power up depending on the "Load Subsystem ID" bit field in NVM word 0Ah. A value of 8086h is default for this field upon power up if the NVM does not respond or is not programmed. All functions are initialized to the same value. SID—Subsystem ID Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Bit 15:0 Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description Subsystem ID (SID) — RO. This value may be loaded automatically from the NVM Word 0Bh upon power up or reset depending on the “Load Subsystem ID” bit field in NVM word 0Ah with a default value of 0000h. This value is loadable from NVM word location 0Bh. ERBA—Expansion ROM Base Address Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 30h–33h Default Value: See bit description Datasheet RO 16 bits Bit Address Offset: 2Eh–2Fh Default Value: See bit description 12.1.15 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 32 bits Bit Description 32:0 Expansion ROM Base Address (ERBA) — RO. This register is used to define the address and size information for boot-time access to the optional FLASH memory. If no Flash memory exists this register reports 00000000h. 377 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.16 CAPP—Capabilities List Pointer Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 34h Default Value: C8h 12.1.17 Attribute: Size: R0 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 Capabilities Pointer (PTR) — RO. Indicates that the pointer for the first entry in the capabilities list is at C8h in configuration space. INTR—Interrupt Information Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 3Ch–3Dh Default Value: 0100h Function Level Reset: No Bit 15:8 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Interrupt Pin (IPIN) — RO. Indicates the interrupt pin driven by the Gb LAN controller. 01h = The Gb LAN controller implements legacy interrupts on INTA. 7:0 12.1.18 Interrupt Line (ILINE) — R/W. Default = 00h. Software written value to indicate which interrupt line (vector) the interrupt is connected to. No hardware action is taken on this register. MLMG—Maximum Latency/Minimum Grant Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: 3Eh Default Value: 00h Bit 7:0 12.1.19 RO 8 bits Description Maximum Latency/Minimum Grant (MLMG) — RO. Not used. Hardwired to 00h. CLIST 1—Capabilities List Register 1 (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: C8h–C9h Default Value: D001h Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Bit Description 15:8 Next Capability (NEXT) — RO. Value of D0h indicates the location of the next pointer. 7:0 378 Attribute: Size: Capability ID (CID) — RO. Indicates the linked list item is a PCI Power Management Register. Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.20 PMC—PCI Power Management Capabilities Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: Default Value: Function Level Reset: CAh–CBh See bit descriptions No (Bits 15:11 only) Bit Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description PME_Support (PMES) — RO. This five-bit field indicates the power states in which the function may assert PME#. It depend on PM Ena and AUX-PWR bits in word 0Ah in the NVM: 15:11 Condition Function Value PM Ena=0 No PME at all states 0000b PM Ena & AUX-PWR=0 PME at D0 and D3hot 01001b PM Ena & AUX-PWR=1 PME at D0, D3hot and D3cold 11001b These bits are not reset by Function Level Reset. 10 D2_Support (D2S) — RO. The D2 state is not supported. 9 D1_Support (D1S) — RO. The D1 state is not supported. 8:6 5 Device Specific Initialization (DSI) — RO. Set to ‘1’. The GbE LAN Controller requires its device driver to be executed following transition to the D0 un-initialized state. 4 Reserved 3 PME Clock (PMEC) — RO. Hardwired to ‘0’. 2:0 Datasheet Aux_Current (AC) — RO. Required current defined in the Data Register. Version (VS) — RO. Hardwired to 010b to indicate support for Revision 1.1 of the PCI Power Management Specification. 379 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.21 PMCS—PCI Power Management Control and Status Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: CCh–CDh Default Value: See bit description Function Level Reset: No (Bit 8 only) Bit 15 Attribute: Size: R/WC, R/W, RO 16 bits Description PME Status (PMES) — R/WC. This bit is set to ‘1’ when the function detects a wakeup event independent of the state of the PMEE bit. Writing a “1” will clear this bit. Data Scale (DSC) — R/W. This field indicates the scaling factor to be used when interpreting the value of the Data register. 14:13 For the GbE LAN and common functions this field equals 01b (indicating 0.1 watt units) if the PM is enabled in the NVM, and the Data_Select field is set to 0, 3, 4, 7, (or 8 for Function 0). Else it equals 00b. For the manageability functions this field equals 10b (indicating 0.01 watt units) if the PM is enabled in the NVM, and the Data_Select field is set to 0, 3, 4, 7. Else it equals 00b. Data Select (DSL) — R/W. This four-bit field is used to select which data is to be reported through the Data register (offset CFh) and Data_Scale field. These bits are writeable only when the Power Management is enabled via NVM. 0h = D0 Power Consumption 12:9 3h = D3 Power Consumption 4h = D0 Power Dissipation 7h = D3 Power Dissipation 8h = Common Power All other values are reserved. 8 7:2 PME Enable (PMEE) — R/W. If Power Management is enabled in the NVM, writing a ‘1’ to this register will enable Wakeup. If Power Management is disabled in the NVM, writing a “1” to this bit has no affect, and will not set the bit to “1”. This bit is not reset by Function Level Reset. Reserved - Returns a value of ‘000000’. Power State (PS) — R/W. This field is used both to determine the current power state of the GbE LAN Controller and to set a new power state. The values are: 00 = D0 state (default) 1:0 01 = Ignored 10 = Ignored 11 = D3 state (Power Management must be enables in the NVM or this cycle will be ignored). 380 Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.22 DR—Data Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: CFh Default Value: See bit description 12.1.23 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 Reported Data (RD) — RO. This register is used to report power consumption and heat dissipation. This register is controlled by the Data_Select field in the PMCS (Offset CCh, bits 12:9), and the power scale is reported in the Data_Scale field in the PMCS (Offset CCh, bits 14:13). The data of this field is loaded from the NVM if PM is enabled in the NVM or with a default value of 00h otherwise. CLIST 2—Capabilities List Register 2 (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: Default Value: Function Level Reset: D0h–D1h E005h No (Bits 15:8 only) Bit 15:8 Attribute: Size: R/WO, RO 16 bits Description Next Capability (NEXT) — R/WO. Value of E0h points to the Function Level Reset capability structure. These bits are not reset by Function Level Reset. 7:0 12.1.24 Capability ID (CID) — RO. Indicates the linked list item is a Message Signaled Interrupt Register. MCTL—Message Control Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: D2h–D3h Default Value: 0080h Bit 15:8 7 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Reserved 64-bit Capable (CID) — RO. Set to ‘1’ to indicate that the GbE LAN Controller is capable of generating 64-bit message addresses. 6:4 Multiple Message Enable (MME) — RO. Returns 000b to indicate that the GbE LAN controller only supports a single message. 3:1 Multiple Message Capable (MMC) — RO. The GbE LAN controller does not support multiple messages. MSI Enable (MSIE) — R/W. 0 Datasheet 0 = MSI generation is disabled. 1 = The Gb LAN controller will generate MSI for interrupt assertion instead of INTx signaling. 381 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.25 MADDL—Message Address Low Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: D4h–D7h Default Value: See bit description 12.1.26 Attribute: Size: Bit Description 31:0 Message Address Low (MADDL) — R/W. Written by the system to indicate the lower 32 bits of the address to use for the MSI memory write transaction. The lower two bits will always return 0 regardless of the write operation. MADDH—Message Address High Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: D8h–DBh Default Value: See bit description Bit 31:0 12.1.27 Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description Message Address High (MADDH) — R/W. Written by the system to indicate the upper 32 bits of the address to use for the MSI memory write transaction. MDAT—Message Data Register (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: DCh–DDh Default Value: See bit description 12.1.28 R/W 32 bits Attribute: Size: R/W 16 bits Bit Description 31:0 Message Data (MDAT) — R/W. Written by the system to indicate the lower 16 bits of the data written in the MSI memory write DWord transaction. The upper 16 bits of the transaction are written as 0000h. FLRCAP—Function Level Reset Capability (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: E0h–E1h Default Value: 0009h Bit 15:8 Attribute: Size: RO 16 bits Description Next Pointer — RO. This field provides an offset to the next capability item in the capability list. The value of 00h indicates the last item in the list. Capability ID — RO. The value of this field depends on the FLRCSSEL bit. 7:0 13h = If FLRCSSEL = 0 09h = If FLRCSSEL = 1, indicating vendor specific capability. 382 Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.1.29 FLRCLV—Function Level Reset Capability Length and Version (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: Default Value: Function Level Reset: E2h–E3h Attribute: R/WO, RO See Description. Size: 16 bits No (Bits 9:8 Only When FLRCSSEL = 0) When FLRCSSEL = 0, this register is defined as follows: Bit 15:10 9 Description Reserved. Function Level Reset Capability — R/WO. 1 = Support for Function Level Reset. This bit is not reset by Function Level Reset. 8 TXP Capability — R/WO. 1 = Indicates support for the Transactions Pending (TXP) bit. TXP must be supported if FLR is supported. 7:0 Capability Length — RO. The value of this field indicates the number of bytes of the vendor specific capability as require by the PCI spec. It has the value of 06h for the Function Level Reset capability. When FLRCSSEL = 1, this register is defined as follows: Bit 15:12 12.1.30 Description Vendor Specific Capability ID — RO. A value of 2h in this field identifies this capability as Function Level Reset. 11:8 Capability Version— RO. The value of this field indicates the version of the Function Level Reset Capability. Default is 0h. 7:0 Capability Length — RO. The value of this field indicates the number of bytes of the vendor specific capability as require by the PCI spec. It has the value of 06h for the Function Level Reset capability. DEVCTRL—Device Control (Gigabit LAN—D25:F0) Address Offset: E4-E5h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:9 8 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description Reserved. Transactions Pending (TXP) — R/W. 1 = Indicates the controller has issued Non-Posted requests which have not been completed. 0 = Indicates that completions for all Non-Posted requests have been received. 7:1 0 Datasheet Reserved Initiate Function Level Reset — RO. This bit is used to initiate an FLT transition. A write of ‘1’ initiates the transition. Since hardware must not respond to any cycles until Function Level Reset completion, the value read by software from this bit is 0. 383 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.2 MBARA—Gigabit LAN Base Address A Registers The internal CSR registers and memories are accessed as direct memory mapped offsets from the base address register. This block is mapped into memory space, using the MBARA Base Address register see Section 12.1.10. SW may only access whole DWord at a time. Table 12-2. Gigabit LAN Base Address A Registers Address Map (Gigabit LAN— D25:F0) 12.2.1 MBARA+Offset Mnemonic Register Name Default Type 00–03h LDR4 LAN Device Initialization 4 14200100h R/W 08–0Bh LDR3 LAN Device Initialization 3 00080xxxh RO 18–1Bh LDCR2 LAN Device Control 2 01500000h R/W 20–23h LDCR4 LAN Device Control 4 1000xxxxh R/W F00h-F03h LDCR5 LAN Device Control 5 00000000h R/W 3004–3007h LDR2 LAN Device Initialization 2 B2B577CCh R/W 3024-3027h LDR1 LAN Device Initialization 1 600060006h R/W LDR4—LAN Device Initialization Register 4 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + 0h Default Value: 14200100h Bit 31:25 24 23:0 12.2.2 Attribute: Size: RO 32 bits Description Reserved LDR4 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS may set this bit to 1. Reserved LDR3—LAN Device Initialization Register 3 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + 8h Default Value: 00080xxxh Bit 31 30:0 384 Attribute: Size: RO 32 bits Description LDR3 Field 1 — RO. When set, this bit enables the automatic reduction of DMA frequency. This bit is loaded from word 13h in the NVM. Reserved Datasheet Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers 12.2.3 LDCR2—LAN Device Control Register 2 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + 18h Default Value: 01500000h Bit 31:21 20 Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description Reserved LAN PHY Power Down Enable (LPPDE) — R/W. When set, enables the PHY to enter a low-power state when the LAN controller is at the DMoff / D3 or Dr and no WoL. This bit is loaded from word 13h in the NVM. 19 19:0 12.2.4 LDCR2 Field 1 — R/W. This bit is loaded from word 13h in the NVM. Reserved LDCR4—LAN Device Control Register 4 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + 20h Default Value: 1000xxxxh Bit 31:0 12.2.5 Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description BIOS may program this field. LDR5—LAN Device Control Register 5 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + F00h Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:6 5 4:0 12.2.6 Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description Reserved LDCR5 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS may set this bit. Reserved LDR1—LAN Device Initialization Register 1 (Gigabit LAN Memory Mapped Base Address Register) Address Offset: MBARA + 3024h Default Value: 60006006h Bit 31:17 16 15:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits Description Reserved LDR1 Field 1 — R/W. BIOS must program this field to 1b. Reserved 385 Gigabit LAN Configuration Registers § §§ 386 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) The LPC bridge function of the ICH10 resides in PCI Device 31:Function 0. This function contains many other functional units, such as DMA and Interrupt controllers, Timers, Power Management, System Management, GPIO, RTC, and LPC Configuration Registers. Registers and functions associated with other functional units (EHCI, UHCI, etc.) are described in their respective sections. 13.1 PCI Configuration Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Note: Address locations that are not shown should be treated as Reserved. . Table 13-1. LPC Interface PCI Register Address Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0) (Sheet 1 of 2) Offset Mnemonic 00h–01h VID 02h–03h DID 04h–05h PCICMD PCI Command 06h–07h PCISTS PCI Status 08h Datasheet RID Register Name Default Type Vendor Identification 8086h RO Device Identification See register description RO 0007h R/W, RO 0210h R/WC, RO See register description RO Revision Identification 09h PI Programming Interface 00h RO 0Ah SCC Sub Class Code 01h RO 0Bh BCC Base Class Code 06h RO 0Dh PLT Primary Latency Timer 00h RO 0Eh HEADTYP 2Ch–2Fh SS 40h–43h PMBASE 44h ACPI_CNTL 48h–4Bh GPIOBASE 4C GC 60h–63h PIRQ[n]_ROUT 64h SIRQ_CNTL Header Type 80h RO Sub System Identifiers 00000000h R/WO ACPI Base Address 00000001h R/W, RO 00h R/W 00000001h R/W, RO 00h R/W 80808080h R/W 10h R/W, RO ACPI Control GPIO Base Address GPIO Control PIRQ[A–D] Routing Control Serial IRQ Control 68h–6Bh PIRQ[n]_ROUT 80808080h R/W 6Ch–6Dh LPC_IBDF PIRQ[E–H] Routing Control IOxAPIC Bus:Device:Function 00F8h R/W 70h-71h H0BDF HPET 0 Bus:Device:Function(H0BDF) 00F8h RW 72h-73h H1BDF HPET 1 Bus:Device:Function(H1BDF) 00F8h RW 387 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Table 13-1. LPC Interface PCI Register Address Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0) (Sheet 2 of 2) Offset Mnemonic 74h-75h H2BDF 76h-77h Default Type HPET 2 Bus:Device:Function(H2BDF) 00F8h RW H3BDF HPET 3 Bus:Device:Function(H3BDF) 00F8h RW 78h-79h H4BDF HPET 4 Bus:Device:Function(H4BDF) 00F8h RW 7Ah-7Bh H5BDF HPET 5 Bus:Device:Function(H5BDF) 00F8h RW 7Ch-7Dh H6BDF HPET 6 Bus:Device:Function(H6BDF) 00F8h RW 7Eh-7Fh H7BDF HPET 7 Bus:Device:Function(H7BDF) 00F8h RW 80h LPC_I/O_DEC I/O Decode Ranges 0000h R/W 82h–83h LPC_EN 0000h R/W 84h–87h GEN1_DEC LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 1 00000000h R/W 88h–8Bh GEN2_DEC LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 2 00000000h R/W 8Ch–8Eh GEN3_DEC LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 3 00000000h R/W 90h–93h GEN4_DEC LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 4 00000000h R/W LPC Generic Memory Range (Corporate Only) 00000000h R/W Firmware Hub Select 1 00112233h R/W, RO Firmware Hub Select 2 4567h R/W Firmware Hub Decode Enable 1 FFCFh R/W, RO 00h R/WLO, R/W, RO 0009h RO 98h-9Bh LGMR D0h–D3h LPC I/F Enables Power Management (See Section 13.8.1) A0h–CFh 388 Register Name FWH_SEL1 D4h–D5h FWH_SEL2 D8h–D9h FWH_DEC_EN1 DCh BIOS_CNTL E0h-E1h FDCAP Feature Detection Capability ID E2h FDLEN Feature Detection Capability Length 0Ch RO E3h FDVER Feature Detection Version 10h RO E4h-EBh FDVCT Feature Vector See Description RO F0h-F3h RCBA Root Complex Base Address 00000000h R/W BIOS Control Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.1 VID—Vendor Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 00h–01h Default Value: 8086h Lockable: No Bit 15:0 13.1.2 RO 16-bit Core Description Vendor ID — RO. This is a 16-bit value assigned to Intel. Intel VID = 8086h DID—Device Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 02h–03h Default Value: See bit description Lockable: No 13.1.3 Attribute: Size: Power Well: Attribute: Size: Power Well: RO 16-bit Core Bit Description 15:0 Device ID — RO. This is a 16-bit value assigned to the Intel® ICH10 LPC bridge. Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Family for the value of the Device ID Register. PCICMD—PCI COMMAND Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 04h–05h Default Value: 0007h Lockable: No Bit 15:10 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W, RO 16-bit Core Description Reserved 9 Fast Back to Back Enable (FBE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 8 SERR# Enable (SERR_EN) — R/W. The LPC bridge generates SERR# if this bit is set. 7 Wait Cycle Control (WCC) — RO. Hardwired to 0. Parity Error Response Enable (PERE) — R/W. 6 Datasheet 0 = No action is taken when detecting a parity error. 1 = Enables the ICH10 LPC bridge to respond to parity errors detected on backbone interface. 5 VGA Palette Snoop (VPS) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 4 Memory Write and Invalidate Enable (MWIE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 3 Special Cycle Enable (SCE) — RO. Hardwired to 0. 2 Bus Master Enable (BME) — RO. Bus Masters cannot be disabled. 1 Memory Space Enable (MSE) — RO. Memory space cannot be disabled on LPC. 0 I/O Space Enable (IOSE) — RO. I/O space cannot be disabled on LPC. 389 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.4 PCISTS—PCI Status Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 06h–07h Default Value: 0210h Lockable: No Note: Attribute: Size: Power Well: RO, R/WC 16-bit Core For the writable bits, software must write a 1 to clear bits that are set. Writing a 0 to the bit has no effect. Bit Description 15 Detected Parity Error (DPE) — R/WC. This bit is set when the LPC bridge detects a parity error on the internal backbone. The bit is set even if the PCICMD.PERE bit (D31:F0:04, bit 6) is 0. 0 = Parity Error Not detected. 1 = Parity Error detected. 14 Signaled System Error (SSE)— R/WC. This bit is set when the LPC bridge signals a system error to the internal SERR# logic. Master Abort Status (RMA) — R/WC. 13 0 = Unsupported request status not received. 1 = The bridge received a completion with unsupported request status from the backbone. Received Target Abort (RTA) — R/WC. 12 0 = Completion abort not received. 1 = Completion with completion abort received from the backbone. 11 0 = Target abort Not generated on the backbone. 1 = LPC bridge generated a completion packet with target abort status on the backbone. Signaled Target Abort (STA) — R/WC. 10:9 DEVSEL# Timing Status (DEV_STS) — RO. 01 = Medium Timing. Data Parity Error Detected (DPED) — R/WC. 0 = All conditions listed below Not met. 1 = Set when all three of the following conditions are met: 8 • LPC bridge receives a completion packet from the backbone from a previous request, • Parity error has been detected (D31:F0:06, bit 15) • PCICMD.PERE bit (D31:F0:04, bit 6) is set. 7 Fast Back to Back Capable (FBC): Reserved – bit has no meaning on the internal backbone. 6 Reserved. 5 66 MHz Capable (66MHZ_CAP) — Reserved – bit has no meaning on the internal backbone. 4 Capabilities List (CLIST) — RO. Capability list exists on the LPC bridge. 3 Interrupt Status (IS) — RO. The LPC bridge does not generate interrupts. 2:0 390 Reserved. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.5 RID—Revision Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 08h Default Value: See bit description Bit 7:0 13.1.6 RO 8 bits Description Revision ID (RID) — RO. Refer to the Intel® I/O Controller Hub (ICH10) Family Specification Update for the value of the Revision ID Register PI—Programming Interface Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 09h Default Value: 00h Bit 7:0 13.1.7 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Programming Interface — RO. SCC—Sub Class Code Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 0Ah Default Value: 01h Bit 7:0 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Sub Class Code — RO. 8-bit value that indicates the category of bridge for the LPC bridge. 01h = PCI-to-ISA bridge. 13.1.8 BCC—Base Class Code Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 0Bh Default Value: 06h Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 Base Class Code — RO. This field is an 8-bit value that indicates the type of device for the LPC bridge. 06h = Bridge device. 13.1.9 PLT—Primary Latency Timer Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 0Dh Default Value: 00h Bit Datasheet Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description 7:3 Master Latency Count (MLC) — Reserved. 2:0 Reserved. 391 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.10 HEADTYP—Header Type Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 0Eh Default Value: 80h Bit 7 6:0 13.1.11 Attribute: Size: RO 8 bits Description Multi-Function Device — RO. This bit is 1 to indicate a multi-function device. Header Type — RO. This 7-bit field identifies the header layout of the configuration space. SS—Sub System Identifiers Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 2Ch–2Fh Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/WO 32 bits This register is initialized to logic 0 by the assertion of PLTRST#. This register can be written only once after PLTRST# de-assertion. Bit Description 31:16 Subsystem ID (SSID) — R/WO. This is written by BIOS. No hardware action taken on this value. 15:0 13.1.12 Subsystem Vendor ID (SSVID) — R/WO. This is written by BIOS. No hardware action taken on this value. PMBASE—ACPI Base Address Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 40h–43h Default Value: 00000001h Lockable: No Attribute: Size: Usage: Power Well: R/W, RO 32 bit ACPI, Legacy Core This register sets base address for ACPI I/O registers, GPIO registers, and TCO I/O registers. These registers can be mapped anywhere in the 64-KB I/O space on 128-Byte boundaries. Bit 31:16 15:7 6:1 0 392 Description Reserved Base Address — R/W. This field provides 128 bytes of I/O space for ACPI, GPIO, and TCO logic. This is placed on a 128-byte boundary. Reserved Resource Type Indicator (RTE) — RO. Hardwired to 1 to indicate I/O space. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.13 ACPI_CNTL—ACPI Control Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0) Offset Address: 44h Default Value: 00h Lockable: No Attribute: Size: Usage: Power Well: Bit R/W 8 bit ACPI, Legacy Core Description ACPI Enable (ACPI_EN) — R/W. 0 = Disable. 1 = Decode of the I/O range pointed to by the ACPI base register is enabled, and the ACPI power management function is enabled. Note that the APM power management ranges (B2/B3h) are always enabled and are not affected by this bit. 7 6:3 Reserved SCI IRQ Select (SCI_IRQ_SEL) — R/W. Specifies on which IRQ the SCI will internally appear. If not using the APIC, the SCI must be routed to IRQ9–11, and that interrupt is not sharable with the SERIRQ stream, but is shareable with other PCI interrupts. If using the APIC, the SCI can also be mapped to IRQ20–23, and can be shared with other interrupts. 2:0 Bits SCI Map 000b IRQ9 001b IRQ10 010b IRQ11 011b Reserved 100b IRQ20 (Only available if APIC enabled) 101b IRQ21 (Only available if APIC enabled) When the interrupt is mapped to APIC interrupts 9, 10, or 11, the APIC should be programmed for active-high reception. When the interrupt is mapped to APIC interrupts 20 through 23, the APIC should be programmed for active-low reception. 13.1.14 GPIOBASE—GPIO Base Address Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0) Offset Address: 48h–4Bh Default Value: 00000001h Bit 31:16 15:7 6:1 0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32 bit Description Reserved. Always 0. Base Address (BA) — RW. Provides the 128 bytes of I/O space for GPIO. Reserved. Always 0 RO. Hardwired to 1 to indicate I/O space. 393 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.15 GC—GPIO Control Register (LPC I/F — D31:F0) Offset Address: 4Ch Default Value: 00h Bit 7:5 4 3:1 Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bit Description Reserved. GPIO Enable (EN) — R/W. This bit enables/disables decode of the I/O range pointed to by the GPIO Base Address register (D31:F0:48h) and enables the GPIO function. 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. Reserved. GPIO Lockdown Enable (GLE) — R/W. This bit enables lockdown of the following GPIO registers: • Offset 00h: GPIO_USE_SEL • Offset 04h: GP_IO_SEL • Offset 0Ch: GP_LVL • Offset 30h: GPIO_USE_SEL2 • Offset 34h: GP_IO_SEL2 0 • Offset 38h: GP_LVL2 • Offset 40h: GPIO_USE_SEL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 44h: GP_IO_SEL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 48h: GP_LVL3 (Corporate Only) • Offset 60h: GP_RST_SEL 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. When this bit is written from a 1-to-0 an SMI# is generated, if enabled. This ensures that only SMM code can change the above GPIO registers after they are locked down. 394 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.16 PIRQ[n]_ROUT—PIRQ[A,B,C,D] Routing Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: PIRQA – 60h, PIRQB – 61h, Attribute: PIRQC – 62h, PIRQD – 63h Default Value: 80h Size: Lockable: No Power Well: Bit R/W 8 bit Core Description Interrupt Routing Enable (IRQEN) — R/W. 7 0 = The corresponding PIRQ is routed to one of the ISA-compatible interrupts specified in bits[3:0]. 1 = The PIRQ is not routed to the 8259. NOTE: BIOS must program this bit to 0 during POST for any of the PIRQs that are being used. The value of this bit may subsequently be changed by the OS when setting up for I/O APIC interrupt delivery mode. 6:4 Reserved IRQ Routing — R/W. (ISA compatible.) 3:0 Datasheet Value IRQ Value IRQ 0000b Reserved 1000b Reserved 0001b Reserved 1001b IRQ9 0010b Reserved 1010b IRQ10 0011b IRQ3 1011b IRQ11 0100b IRQ4 1100b IRQ12 0101b IRQ5 1101b Reserved 0110b IRQ6 1110b IRQ14 0111b IRQ7 1111b IRQ15 395 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.17 SIRQ_CNTL—Serial IRQ Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 64h Default Value: 10h Lockable: No Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W, RO 8 bit Core Description Serial IRQ Enable (SIRQEN) — R/W. 7 0 = The buffer is input only and internally SERIRQ will be a 1. 1 = Serial IRQs will be recognized. The SERIRQ pin will be configured as SERIRQ. Serial IRQ Mode Select (SIRQMD) — R/W. 0 = The serial IRQ machine will be in quiet mode. 1 = The serial IRQ machine will be in continuous mode. 6 5:2 1:0 NOTE: For systems using Quiet Mode, this bit should be set to 1 (Continuous Mode) for at least one frame after coming out of reset before switching back to Quiet Mode. Failure to do so will result in the ICH10 not recognizing SERIRQ interrupts. Serial IRQ Frame Size (SIRQSZ) — RO. Fixed field that indicates the size of the SERIRQ frame as 21 frames. Start Frame Pulse Width (SFPW) — R/W. This is the number of PCI clocks that the SERIRQ pin will be driven low by the serial IRQ machine to signal a start frame. In continuous mode, the ICH10 will drive the start frame for the number of clocks specified. In quiet mode, the ICH10 will drive the start frame for the number of clocks specified minus one, as the first clock was driven by the peripheral. 00 = 4 clocks 01 = 6 clocks 10 = 8 clocks 11 = Reserved 396 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.18 PIRQ[n]_ROUT—PIRQ[E,F,G,H] Routing Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: PIRQE – 68h, PIRQF – 69h, Attribute: PIRQG – 6Ah, PIRQH – 6Bh Default Value: 80h Size: Lockable: No Power Well: Bit R/W 8 bit Core Description Interrupt Routing Enable (IRQEN) — R/W. 7 0 = The corresponding PIRQ is routed to one of the ISA-compatible interrupts specified in bits[3:0]. 1 = The PIRQ is not routed to the 8259. NOTE: BIOS must program this bit to 0 during POST for any of the PIRQs that are being used. The value of this bit may subsequently be changed by the OS when setting up for I/O APIC interrupt delivery mode. 6:4 Reserved IRQ Routing — R/W. (ISA compatible.) 3:0 Datasheet Value IRQ Value IRQ 0000b Reserved 1000b Reserved 0001b Reserved 1001b IRQ9 0010b Reserved 1010b IRQ10 0011b IRQ3 1011b IRQ11 0100b IRQ4 1100b IRQ12 0101b IRQ5 1101b Reserved 0110b IRQ6 1110b IRQ14 0111b IRQ7 1111b IRQ15 397 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.19 LPC_IBDF—IOxAPIC Bus:Device:Function (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 6Ch-6Dh Default Value: 00F8h Attribute: Size: Bit R/W 16 bit Description IOxAPIC Bus:Device:Function (IBDF)— R/W. This field specifies the bus:device:function that ICH10’s IOxAPIC will be using for the following: • As the Requester ID when initiating Interrupt Messages to the processor. • As the Completer ID when responding to the reads targeting the IOxAPIC’s Memory-Mapped I/O registers. The 16-bit field comprises the following: 15:0 Bits Description 15:8 Bus Number 7:3 Device Number 2:0 Function Number This field defaults to Bus 0: Device 31: Function 0 after reset. BIOS can program this field to provide a unique bus:device:function number for the internal IOxAPIC. 13.1.20 LPC_HnBDF – HPET n Bus:Device:Function (LPC I/F— D31:F0) Offset Address: H0BDF H1BDF H2BDF H3BDF H4BDF H5BDF H6BDF H7BDF Default Value: 00F8h Bit 70h-71h 72h-73h 74h-75h 76h-77h 78h-79h 7Ah-7Bh 7Ch-7Dh 7Eh-7Fh Attribute: Size: R/W 16 bit Description HPET n Bus:Device:Function (HnBDF)— R/W. This field specifies the bus:device:function that ICH10’s HPET n will be using in the following: • As the Requester ID when initiating Interrupt Messages to the CPU • As the Completer ID when responding to the reads targeting the corresponding HPET’s Memory-Mapped I/O registers The 16-bit field comprises the following: 15:0 Bits 15:8 Description Bus Number 7:3 Device Number 2:0 Function Number This field is default to Bus 0: Device 31: Function 0 after reset. BIOS shall program this field accordingly if unique bus:device:function number is required for the corresponding HPET. 398 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.21 LPC_I/O_DEC—I/O Decode Ranges Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 80h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:13 12 11:10 Attribute: Size: R/W 16 bit Description Reserved FDD Decode Range — R/W. This bit determines which range to decode for the FDD Port. 0 = 3F0h – 3F5h, 3F7h (Primary) 1 = 370h – 375h, 377h (Secondary) Reserved LPT Decode Range — R/W. This field determines which range to decode for the LPT Port. 9:8 7 00 01 10 11 = = = = 378h – 37Fh and 778h – 77Fh 278h – 27Fh (port 279h is read only) and 678h – 67Fh 3BCh –3BEh and 7BCh – 7BEh Reserved Reserved COMB Decode Range — R/W. This field determines which range to decode for the COMB Port. 000 = 3F8h – 3FFh (COM1) 001 = 2F8h – 2FFh (COM2) 6:4 010 = 220h – 227h 011 = 228h – 22Fh 100 = 238h – 23Fh 101 = 2E8h – 2EFh (COM4) 110 = 338h – 33Fh 111 = 3E8h – 3EFh (COM3) 3 Reserved COMA Decode Range — R/W. This field determines which range to decode for the COMA Port. 000 = 3F8h – 3FFh (COM1) 001 = 2F8h – 2FFh (COM2) 2:0 010 = 220h – 227h 011 = 228h – 22Fh 100 = 238h – 23Fh 101 = 2E8h – 2EFh (COM4) 110 = 338h – 33Fh 111 = 3E8h – 3EFh (COM3) Datasheet 399 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.22 LPC_EN—LPC I/F Enables Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 82h – 83h Default Value: 0000h Bit 15:14 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 16 bit Core Description Reserved CNF2_LPC_EN — R/W. Microcontroller Enable #2. 13 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 4Eh and 4Fh to the LPC interface. This range is used for a microcontroller. CNF1_LPC_EN — R/W. Super I/O Enable. 12 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 2Eh and 2Fh to the LPC interface. This range is used for Super I/O devices. MC_LPC_EN — R/W. Microcontroller Enable #1. 11 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 62h and 66h to the LPC interface. This range is used for a microcontroller. KBC_LPC_EN — R/W. Keyboard Enable. 10 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 60h and 64h to the LPC interface. This range is used for a microcontroller. GAMEH_LPC_EN — R/W. High Gameport Enable 9 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 208h to 20Fh to the LPC interface. This range is used for a gameport. GAMEL_LPC_EN — R/W. Low Gameport Enable 8 7:4 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the I/O locations 200h to 207h to the LPC interface. This range is used for a gameport. Reserved FDD_LPC_EN — R/W. Floppy Drive Enable 3 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the FDD range to the LPC interface. This range is selected in the LPC_FDD/LPT Decode Range Register (D31:F0:80h, bit 12). LPT_LPC_EN — R/W. Parallel Port Enable 2 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the LPTrange to the LPC interface. This range is selected in the LPC_FDD/LPT Decode Range Register (D31:F0:80h, bit 9:8). COMB_LPC_EN — R/W. Com Port B Enable 1 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the COMB range to the LPC interface. This range is selected in the LPC_COM Decode Range Register (D31:F0:80h, bits 6:4). COMA_LPC_EN — R/W. Com Port A Enable 0 400 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the decoding of the COMA range to the LPC interface. This range is selected in the LPC_COM Decode Range Register (D31:F0:80h, bits 3:2). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.23 GEN1_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 84h – 87h Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32 bit Core Description 31:24 Reserved 23:18 Generic I/O Decode Range Address[7:2] Mask — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding address bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Address field, below, is ignored. The mask is only provided for the lower 6 bits of the DWord address, allowing for decoding blocks up to 256 bytes in size. 17:16 Reserved 15:2 Generic I/O Decode Range 1 Base Address (GEN1_BASE) — R/W. This address is aligned on a 128-byte boundary, and must have address lines 31:16 as 0. NOTE: The ICH Does not provide decode down to the word or byte level. 1 Reserved 0 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the GEN1 I/O range to be forwarded to the LPC I/F. Generic Decode Range 1 Enable (GEN1_EN) — R/W. 13.1.24 GEN2_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 88h – 8Bh Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32 bit Core Description 31:24 Reserved 23:18 Generic I/O Decode Range Address[7:2] Mask — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding address bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Address field, below, is ignored. The mask is only provided for the lower 6 bits of the DWord address, allowing for decoding blocks up to 256 bytes in size. 17:16 Reserved 15:2 Generic I/O Decode Range 2 Base Address (GEN1_BASE) — R/W. NOTE: The ICH Does not provide decode down to the word or byte level. 1 Reserved 0 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the GEN2 I/O range to be forwarded to the LPC I/F. Generic Decode Range 2 Enable (GEN2_EN) — R/W. Datasheet 401 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.25 GEN3_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 8Ch – 8Eh Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32 bit Core Description 31:24 Reserved 23:18 Generic I/O Decode Range Address[7:2] Mask — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding address bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Address field, below, is ignored. The mask is only provided for the lower 6 bits of the DWord address, allowing for decoding blocks up to 256 bytes in size. 17:16 Reserved 15:2 1 Generic I/O Decode Range 3 Base Address (GEN3_BASE) — R/W. NOTE: The ICH Does not provide decode down to the word or byte level. Reserved Generic Decode Range 3 Enable (GEN3_EN) — R/W. 0 402 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the GEN3 I/O range to be forwarded to the LPC I/F. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.26 GEN4_DEC—LPC I/F Generic Decode Range 4 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 90h – 93h Default Value: 00000000h Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32 bit Core Description 31:24 Reserved 23:18 Generic I/O Decode Range Address[7:2] Mask — R/W. A 1 in any bit position indicates that any value in the corresponding address bit in a received cycle will be treated as a match. The corresponding bit in the Address field, below, is ignored. The mask is only provided for the lower 6 bits of the DWord address, allowing for decoding blocks up to 256 bytes in size. 17:16 Reserved 15:2 Generic I/O Decode Range 4 Base Address (GEN4_BASE) — R/W. NOTE: The ICH Does not provide decode down to the word or byte level. 1 Reserved 0 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the GEN4 I/O range to be forwarded to the LPC I/F. Generic Decode Range 4 Enable (GEN4_EN) — R/W. 13.1.27 LGMR — LPC I/F Generic Memory Range (LPC I/F— D31:F0) (Corporate Only) Offset Address: 98h – 9Bh Default Value: 00000000h Bit 31:16 15:1 0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32 bit Core Description Memory Address[31:16] — R/W. This field specifies a 64 KB memory block anywhere in the 4 GB memory space that will be decoded to LPC as standard LPC memory cycle if enabled. Reserved LPC Memory Range Decode Enable — R/W. When this bit is set to 1, then the range specified in bits 31:16 of this register is enabled for decoding to LPC. 403 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.28 FWH_SEL1—Firmware Hub Select 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: D0h–D3h Default Value: 00112233h Bit 31:28 27:24 23:20 19:16 15:12 11:8 7:4 3:0 404 Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 32 bits Description FWH_F8_IDSEL — RO. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges and one 128-KB memory range. This field is fixed at 0000. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFF8 0000h – FFFF FFFFh FFB8 0000h – FFBF FFFFh 000E 0000h – 000F FFFFh FWH_F0_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFF0 0000h – FFF7 FFFFh FFB0 0000h – FFB7 FFFFh FWH_E8_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFE8 0000h – FFEF FFFFh FFA8 0000h – FFAF FFFFh FWH_E0_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFE0 0000h – FFE7 FFFFh FFA0 0000h – FFA7 FFFFh FWH_D8_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFD8 0000h – FFDF FFFFh FF98 0000h – FF9F FFFFh FWH_D0_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFD0 0000h – FFD7 FFFFh FF90 0000h – FF97 FFFFh FWH_C8_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFC8 0000h – FFCF FFFFh FF88 0000h – FF8F FFFFh FWH_C0_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FFC0 0000h – FFC7 FFFFh FF80 0000h – FF87 FFFFh Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.29 FWH_SEL2—Firmware Hub Select 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: D4h–D5h Default Value: 4567h Bit 15:12 11:8 7:4 3:0 Datasheet Attribute: Size: R/W 16 bits Description FWH_70_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two, 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FF70 0000h – FF7F FFFFh FF30 0000h – FF3F FFFFh FWH_60_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two, 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FF60 0000h – FF6F FFFFh FF20 0000h – FF2F FFFFh FWH_50_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two, 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FF50 0000h – FF5F FFFFh FF10 0000h – FF1F FFFFh FWH_40_IDSEL — R/W. IDSEL for two, 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. The IDSEL programmed in this field addresses the following memory ranges: FF40 0000h – FF4F FFFFh FF00 0000h – FF0F FFFFh 405 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.30 FWH_DEC_EN1—Firmware Hub Decode Enable Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: D8h–D9h Default Value: FFCFh Bit Attribute: Size: R/W, RO 16 bits Description FWH_F8_EN — RO. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges, and one 128-KB memory range. 15 0 = Disable 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FFF80000h – FFFFFFFFh FFB80000h – FFBFFFFFh FWH_F0_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 14 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub: FFF00000h – FFF7FFFFh FFB00000h – FFB7FFFFh FWH_E8_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 13 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub: FFE80000h – FFEFFFFh FFA80000h – FFAFFFFFh FWH_E0_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 12 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub: FFE00000h – FFE7FFFFh FFA00000h – FFA7FFFFh FWH_D8_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 11 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FFD80000h – FFDFFFFFh FF980000h – FF9FFFFFh FWH_D0_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 10 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FFD00000h – FFD7FFFFh FF900000h – FF97FFFFh FWH_C8_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 9 406 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FFC80000h – FFCFFFFFh FF880000h – FF8FFFFFh Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description FWH_C0_EN — R/W. This bit enables decoding two 512-KB Firmware Hub memory ranges. 8 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FFC00000h – FFC7FFFFh FF800000h – FF87FFFFh FWH_Legacy_F_EN — R/W. This enables the decoding of the legacy 64KB range at F0000h – FFFFFh. 7 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following legacy ranges for the Firmware Hub F0000h – FFFFFh NOTE: The decode for the BIOS legacy F segment is enabled only by this bit and is not affected by the GEN_PMCON_1.iA64_EN bit. FWH_Legacy_E_EN — R/W. This enables the decoding of the legacy 64KB range at E0000h – EFFFFh. 6 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following legacy ranges for the Firmware Hub E0000h – EFFFFh NOTE: The decode for the BIOS legacy E segment is enabled only by this bit and is not affected by the GEN_PMCON_1.iA64_EN bit. 5:4 Reserved FWH_70_EN — R/W. Enables decoding two 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. 3 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FF70 0000h – FF7F FFFFh FF30 0000h – FF3F FFFFh FWH_60_EN — R/W. Enables decoding two 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. 2 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FF60 0000h – FF6F FFFFh FF20 0000h – FF2F FFFFh FWH_50_EN — R/W. Enables decoding two 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. 1 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FF50 0000h – FF5F FFFFh FF10 0000h – FF1F FFFFh FWH_40_EN — R/W. Enables decoding two 1-M Firmware Hub memory ranges. 0 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the following ranges for the Firmware Hub FF40 0000h – FF4F FFFFh FF00 0000h – FF0F FFFFh NOTE: This register effects the BIOS decode regardless of whether the BIOS is resident on LPC or SPI. The concept of Feature Space does not apply to SPI-based flash. The ICH simply decodes these ranges as memory accesses when enabled for the SPI flash interface. Datasheet 407 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.31 BIOS_CNTL—BIOS Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: DCh Default Value: 00h Lockable: No Attribute: Size: Power Well: Bit 7:5 4 R/WLO, R/W, RO 8 bit Core Description Reserved Top Swap Status (TSS) — RO. This bit provides a read-only path to view the state of the Top Swap bit that is at offset 3414h, bit 0. SPI Read Configuration (SRC) — R/W. This 2-bit field controls two policies related to BIOS reads on the SPI interface: Bit 3 = Prefetch Enable Bit 2 = Cache Disable Settings are summarized below: Bits 3:2 3:2 Description 00b No prefetching, but caching enabled. 64B demand reads load the read buffer cache with “valid” data, allowing repeated code fetches to the same line to complete quickly 01b No prefetching and no caching. One-to-one correspondence of host BIOS reads to SPI cycles. This value can be used to invalidate the cache. 10b Prefetching and Caching enabled. This mode is used for long sequences of short reads to consecutive addresses (i.e., shadowing). 11b Reserved. This is an invalid configuration, caching must be enabled when prefetching is enabled. BIOS Lock Enable (BLE) — R/WLO. 1 0 = Setting the BIOSWE will not cause SMIs. 1 = Enables setting the BIOSWE bit to cause SMIs. Once set, this bit can only be cleared by a PLTRST#. BIOS Write Enable (BIOSWE) — R/W. 0 408 0 = Only read cycles result in Firmware Hub I/F cycles. 1 = Access to the BIOS space is enabled for both read and write cycles. When this bit is written from a 0 to a 1 and BIOS Lock Enable (BLE) is also set, an SMI# is generated. This ensures that only SMI code can update BIOS. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.32 FDCAP—Feature Detection Capability ID (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: E0h-E1h Default Value: 0009h Bit 13.1.33 15:8 Next Item Pointer (NEXT) — RO. Configuration offset of the next Capability Item. 00h indicates the last item in the Capability List. 7:0 Capability ID — RO. Indicates a Vendor Specific Capability. FDLEN—Feature Detection Capability Length (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Bit 7:0 Attribute: Size: Power Well: RO 8 bit Core Description Capability Length — RO. Indicates the length of this Vendor Specific capability, as required by the PCI Specification. FDVER—Feature Detection Version (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: E3h Default Value: 10h Bit Datasheet RO 16 bit Core Description Offset Address: E2h Default Value: 0Ch 13.1.34 Attribute: Size: Power Well: Attribute: Size: Power Well: RO 8 bit Core Description 7:4 Vendor-Specific Capability ID — RO. A value of 1h in this 4-bit field identifies this Capability as Feature Detection Type. This field allows software to differentiate the Feature Detection Capability from other Vendor-Specific capabilities. 3:0 Capability Version — RO. This field indicates the version of the Feature Detection capability. 409 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.1.35 FDVCT—Feature Vector (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: E4h-EBh Default Value: See Description Bit 63:42 Attribute: Size: Power Well: RO 64 bit Core Description Reserved Intel® Active Management Technology Release 5.0 Support Capability — RO. 41 40:38 0 = Professional 1 = Basic Reserved Intel Active Management Technology Capability — RO. 37 36:6 0 = Capable 1 = Disabled Reserved SATA RAID 0/1/5/10 Capability— RO. 5 4:0 13.1.36 0 = Capable 1 = Disabled Reserved RCBA—Root Complex Base Address Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: F0-F3h Default Value: 00000000h R/W 32 bit Bit Description 31:14 Base Address (BA) — R/W. Base Address for the root complex register block decode range. This address is aligned on a 16-KB boundary. 13:1 0 410 Attribute: Size: Reserved Enable (EN) — R/W. When set, enables the range specified in BA to be claimed as the Root Complex Register Block. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2 DMA I/O Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Table 13-2. DMA Registers (Sheet 1 of 2) Port Datasheet Alias Register Name Default Type 00h 10h Channel 0 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W 01h 11h Channel 0 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W 02h 12h Channel 1 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W 03h 13h Channel 1 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W 04h 14h Channel 2 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W 05h 15h Channel 2 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W 06h 16h Channel 3 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W 07h 17h Channel 3 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W 08h 18h Channel 0–3 DMA Command Undefined WO Channel 0–3 DMA Status Undefined RO 0Ah 1Ah Channel 0–3 DMA Write Single Mask 000001XXb WO 0Bh 1Bh Channel 0–3 DMA Channel Mode 000000XXb WO 0Ch 1Ch Channel 0–3 DMA Clear Byte Pointer Undefined WO 0Dh 1Dh Channel 0–3 DMA Master Clear Undefined WO 0Eh 1Eh Channel 0–3 DMA Clear Mask Undefined WO 0Fh 1Fh Channel 0–3 DMA Write All Mask 0Fh R/W 80h 90h Reserved Page Undefined R/W 81h 91h Channel 2 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 82h — Channel 3 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 83h 93h Channel 1 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 84h–86h 94h–96h Reserved Pages Undefined R/W 87h 97h Channel 0 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 88h 98h Reserved Page Undefined R/W 89h 99h Channel 6 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 8Ah 9Ah Channel 7 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 8Bh 9Bh Channel 5 DMA Memory Low Page Undefined R/W 8Ch–8Eh 9Ch–9Eh Reserved Page Undefined R/W 8Fh 9Fh Refresh Low Page Undefined R/W C0h C1h Channel 4 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W C2h C3h Channel 4 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W C4h C5h Channel 5 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W C6h C7h Channel 5 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W C8h C9h Channel 6 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W CAh CBh Channel 6 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W CCh CDh Channel 7 DMA Base & Current Address Undefined R/W 411 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Table 13-2. DMA Registers (Sheet 2 of 2) 13.2.1 Port Alias CEh CFh D0h D1h Register Name Default Type Channel 7 DMA Base & Current Count Undefined R/W Channel 4–7 DMA Command Undefined WO Channel 4–7 DMA Status Undefined RO D4h D5h Channel 4–7 DMA Write Single Mask 000001XXb WO D6h D7h Channel 4–7 DMA Channel Mode 000000XXb WO D8h D9h Channel 4–7 DMA Clear Byte Pointer Undefined WO DAh DBh Channel 4–7 DMA Master Clear Undefined WO DCh DDh Channel 4–7 DMA Clear Mask Undefined WO DEh DFh Channel 4–7 DMA Write All Mask 0Fh R/W DMABASE_CA—DMA Base and Current Address Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit Ch. #0 = 00h; Ch. #1 = 02hAttribute:R/W Ch. #2 = 04h; Ch. #3 = 06hSize:16 bit (per channel), Ch. #5 = C4h Ch. #6 = C8h but accessed in two 8-bit Ch. #7 = CCh; quantities Undefined No Power Well:Core Description Base and Current Address — R/W. This register determines the address for the transfers to be performed. The address specified points to two separate registers. On writes, the value is stored in the Base Address register and copied to the Current Address register. On reads, the value is returned from the Current Address register. 15:0 The address increments/decrements in the Current Address register after each transfer, depending on the mode of the transfer. If the channel is in auto-initialize mode, the Current Address register will be reloaded from the Base Address register after a terminal count is generated. For transfers to/from a 16-bit slave (channels 5–7), the address is shifted left one bit location. Bit 15 will be shifted into Bit 16. The register is accessed in 8 bit quantities. The byte is pointed to by the current byte pointer flip/flop. Before accessing an address register, the byte pointer flip/flop should be cleared to ensure that the low byte is accessed first. 412 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.2 DMABASE_CC—DMA Base and Current Count Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Ch. #7 = CEh; Default Value: Lockable: Bit Ch. #0 = 01h; Ch. #1 = 03hAttribute:R/W Ch. #2 = 05h; Ch. #3 = 07hSize:16-bit (per channel), Ch. #5 = C6h; Ch. #6 = CAh but accessed in two 8-bit quantities Undefined No Power Well:Core Description Base and Current Count — R/W. This register determines the number of transfers to be performed. The address specified points to two separate registers. On writes, the value is stored in the Base Count register and copied to the Current Count register. On reads, the value is returned from the Current Count register. 15:0 The actual number of transfers is one more than the number programmed in the Base Count Register (i.e., programming a count of 4h results in 5 transfers). The count is decrements in the Current Count register after each transfer. When the value in the register rolls from 0 to FFFFh, a terminal count is generated. If the channel is in autoinitialize mode, the Current Count register will be reloaded from the Base Count register after a terminal count is generated. For transfers to/from an 8-bit slave (channels 0–3), the count register indicates the number of bytes to be transferred. For transfers to/from a 16-bit slave (channels 5–7), the count register indicates the number of words to be transferred. The register is accessed in 8 bit quantities. The byte is pointed to by the current byte pointer flip/flop. Before accessing a count register, the byte pointer flip/flop should be cleared to ensure that the low byte is accessed first. 13.2.3 DMAMEM_LP—DMA Memory Low Page Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Datasheet Ch. #0 = 87h; Ch. #1 = 83h Ch. #2 = 81h; Ch. #3 = 82h Ch. #5 = 8Bh; Ch. #6 = 89h Ch. #7 = 8Ah; Attribute:R/W Undefined Size: 8-bit No Power Well:Core Bit Description 7:0 DMA Low Page (ISA Address bits [23:16]) — R/W. This register works in conjunction with the DMA controller's Current Address Register to define the complete 24-bit address for the DMA channel. This register remains static throughout the DMA transfer. Bit 16 of this register is ignored when in 16 bit I/O count by words mode as it is replaced by the bit 15 shifted out from the current address register. 413 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.4 DMACMD—DMA Command Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Ch. #0–3 = 08h; Ch. #4–7 = D0h Undefined No Bit 7:5 4 Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Description Reserved. Must be 0. DMA Group Arbitration Priority — WO. Each channel group is individually assigned either fixed or rotating arbitration priority. At part reset, each group is initialized in fixed priority. 0 = Fixed priority to the channel group 1 = Rotating priority to the group. 3 Reserved. Must be 0. DMA Channel Group Enable — WO. Both channel groups are enabled following part reset. 2 1:0 13.2.5 0 = Enable the DMA channel group. 1 = Disable. Disabling channel group 4–7 also disables channel group 0–3, which is cascaded through channel 4. Reserved. Must be 0. DMASTA—DMA Status Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Ch. #0–3 = 08h; Ch. #4–7 = D0h Undefined No Attribute:RO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Bit Description 7:4 Channel Request Status — RO. When a valid DMA request is pending for a channel, the corresponding bit is set to 1. When a DMA request is not pending for a particular channel, the corresponding bit is set to 0. The source of the DREQ may be hardware or a software request. Note that channel 4 is the cascade channel, so the request status of channel 4 is a logical OR of the request status for channels 0 through 3. 4 = Channel 0 5 = Channel 1 (5) 6 = Channel 2 (6) 7 = Channel 3 (7) Channel Terminal Count Status — RO. When a channel reaches terminal count (TC), its status bit is set to 1. If TC has not been reached, the status bit is set to 0. Channel 4 is programmed for cascade, so the TC bit response for channel 4 is irrelevant. 3:0 0 = Channel 0 1 = Channel 1 (5) 2 = Channel 2 (6) 3 = Channel 3 (7) 414 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.6 DMA_WRSMSK—DMA Write Single Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Ch. #0–3 = 0Ah; Ch. #4–7 = D4h 0000 01xx No Bit 7:3 Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Description Reserved. Must be 0. Channel Mask Select — WO. 2 0 = Enable DREQ for the selected channel. The channel is selected through bits [1:0]. Therefore, only one channel can be masked / unmasked at a time. 1 = Disable DREQ for the selected channel. DMA Channel Select — WO. These bits select the DMA Channel Mode Register to program. 1:0 00 = Channel 0 (4) 01 = Channel 1 (5) 10 = Channel 2 (6) 11 = Channel 3 (7) Datasheet 415 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.7 DMACH_MODE—DMA Channel Mode Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Ch. #0–3 = 0Bh; Ch. #4–7 = D6h 0000 00xx No Bit Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Description DMA Transfer Mode — WO. Each DMA channel can be programmed in one of four different modes: 7:6 00 = Demand mode 01 = Single mode 10 = Reserved 11 = Cascade mode 5 Address Increment/Decrement Select — WO. This bit controls address increment/ decrement during DMA transfers. 0 = Address increment. (default after part reset or Master Clear) 1 = Address decrement. Autoinitialize Enable — WO. 4 0 = Autoinitialize feature is disabled and DMA transfers terminate on a terminal count. A part reset or Master Clear disables autoinitialization. 1 = DMA restores the Base Address and Count registers to the current registers following a terminal count (TC). DMA Transfer Type — WO. These bits represent the direction of the DMA transfer. When the channel is programmed for cascade mode, (bits[7:6] = 11) the transfer type is irrelevant. 3:2 00 = Verify – No I/O or memory strobes generated 01 = Write – Data transferred from the I/O devices to memory 10 = Read – Data transferred from memory to the I/O device 11 = Invalid DMA Channel Select — WO. These bits select the DMA Channel Mode Register that will be written by bits [7:2]. 1:0 00 = Channel 0 (4) 01 = Channel 1 (5) 10 = Channel 2 (6) 11 = Channel 3 (7) 416 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.8 DMA Clear Byte Pointer Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: 13.2.9 Description 7:0 Clear Byte Pointer — WO. No specific pattern. Command enabled with a write to the I/O port address. Writing to this register initializes the byte pointer flip/flop to a known state. It clears the internal latch used to address the upper or lower byte of the 16-bit Address and Word Count Registers. The latch is also cleared by part reset and by the Master Clear command. This command precedes the first access to a 16-bit DMA controller register. The first access to a 16-bit register will then access the significant byte, and the second access automatically accesses the most significant byte. DMA Master Clear Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Default Value: Ch. #0–3 = 0Dh; Ch. #4–7 = DAh xxxx xxxx Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Bit Description 7:0 Master Clear — WO. No specific pattern. Enabled with a write to the port. This has the same effect as the hardware Reset. The Command, Status, Request, and Byte Pointer flip/flop registers are cleared and the Mask Register is set. DMA_CLMSK—DMA Clear Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Datasheet Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Bit I/O Address: 13.2.10 Ch. #0–3 = 0Ch; Ch. #4–7 = D8h xxxx xxxx No Ch. #0–3 = 0Eh; Ch. #4–7 = DCh xxxx xxxx No Attribute:WO Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Bit Description 7:0 Clear Mask Register — WO. No specific pattern. Command enabled with a write to the port. 417 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.2.11 DMA_WRMSK—DMA Write All Mask Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Ch. #0–3 = 0Fh; Ch. #4–7 = DEh 0000 1111 No Bit 7:4 Attribute:R/W Size: 8-bit Power Well:Core Description Reserved. Must be 0. Channel Mask Bits — R/W. This register permits all four channels to be simultaneously enabled/disabled instead of enabling/disabling each channel individually, as is the case with the Mask Register – Write Single Mask Bit. In addition, this register has a read path to allow the status of the channel mask bits to be read. A channel's mask bit is automatically set to 1 when the Current Byte/Word Count Register reaches terminal count (unless the channel is in auto-initialization mode). 3:0 Setting the bit(s) to a 1 disables the corresponding DREQ(s). Setting the bit(s) to a 0 enables the corresponding DREQ(s). Bits [3:0] are set to 1 upon part reset or Master Clear. When read, bits [3:0] indicate the DMA channel [3:0] ([7:4]) mask status. Bit 0 = Channel 0 (4)1 = Masked, 0 = Not Masked Bit 1 = Channel 1 (5)1 = Masked, 0 = Not Masked Bit 2 = Channel 2 (6)1 = Masked, 0 = Not Masked Bit 3 = Channel 3 (7)1 = Masked, 0 = Not Masked NOTE: Disabling channel 4 also disables channels 0–3 due to the cascade of channels 0–3 through channel 4. 418 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.3 Timer I/O Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Port Aliases 40h 50h 41h 51h 42h 43h 52h 53h Register Name Counter 0 Interval Time Status Byte Format Counter 0 Counter Access Port Counter 1 Interval Time Status Byte Format Counter 1 Counter Access Port Type 0XXXXXXXb RO Undefined R/W 0XXXXXXXb RO Undefined R/W 0XXXXXXXb RO Counter 2 Counter Access Port Undefined R/W Timer Control Word Undefined WO Counter 2 Interval Time Status Byte Format Timer Control Word Register Counter Latch Command Datasheet Default Value XXXXXXX0b WO X0h WO 419 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.3.1 TCW—Timer Control Word Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: 43h All bits undefined Attribute: Size: WO 8 bits This register is programmed prior to any counter being accessed to specify counter modes. Following part reset, the control words for each register are undefined and each counter output is 0. Each timer must be programmed to bring it into a known state. Bit Description Counter Select — WO. The Counter Selection bits select the counter the control word acts upon as shown below. The Read Back Command is selected when bits[7:6] are both 1. 7:6 00 = Counter 0 select 01 = Counter 1 select 10 = Counter 2 select 11 = Read Back Command Read/Write Select — WO. These bits are the read/write control bits. The actual counter programming is done through the counter port (40h for counter 0, 41h for counter 1, and 42h for counter 2). 5:4 00 = Counter Latch Command 01 = Read/Write Least Significant Byte (LSB) 10 = Read/Write Most Significant Byte (MSB) 11 = Read/Write LSB then MSB Counter Mode Selection — WO. These bits select one of six possible modes of operation for the selected counter. Bit Value 3:1 Mode 000b Mode 0 Out signal on end of count (=0) 001b Mode 1 Hardware retriggerable oneshot x10b Mode 2 Rate generator (divide by n counter) x11b Mode 3 Square wave output 100b Mode 4 Software triggered strobe 101b Mode 5 Hardware triggered strobe Binary/BCD Countdown Select — WO. 0 0 = Binary countdown is used. The largest possible binary count is 216 1 = Binary coded decimal (BCD) count is used. The largest possible BCD count is 104 There are two special commands that can be issued to the counters through this register, the Read Back Command and the Counter Latch Command. When these commands are chosen, several bits within this register are redefined. These register formats are described as follows: 420 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) RDBK_CMD—Read Back Command (LPC I/F—D31:F0) The Read Back Command is used to determine the count value, programmed mode, and current states of the OUT pin and Null count flag of the selected counter or counters. Status and/or count may be latched in any or all of the counters by selecting the counter during the register write. The count and status remain latched until read, and further latch commands are ignored until the count is read. Both count and status of the selected counters may be latched simultaneously by setting both bit 5 and bit 4 to 0. If both are latched, the first read operation from that counter returns the latched status. The next one or two reads, depending on whether the counter is programmed for one or two byte counts, returns the latched count. Subsequent reads return an unlatched count. Bit 7:6 Description Read Back Command. Must be 11 to select the Read Back Command Latch Count of Selected Counters. 5 0 = Current count value of the selected counters will be latched 1 = Current count will not be latched Latch Status of Selected Counters. 4 0 = Status of the selected counters will be latched 1 = Status will not be latched 3 Counter 2 Select. 1 = Counter 2 count and/or status will be latched 2 Counter 1 Select. 1 = Counter 1 count and/or status will be latched 1 Counter 0 Select. 1 = Counter 0 count and/or status will be latched. 0 Reserved. Must be 0. LTCH_CMD—Counter Latch Command (LPC I/F—D31:F0) The Counter Latch Command latches the current count value. This command is used to insure that the count read from the counter is accurate. The count value is then read from each counter's count register through the Counter Ports Access Ports Register (40h for counter 0, 41h for counter 1, and 42h for counter 2). The count must be read according to the programmed format, i.e., if the counter is programmed for two byte counts, two bytes must be read. The two bytes do not have to be read one right after the other (read, write, or programming operations for other counters may be inserted between the reads). If a counter is latched once and then latched again before the count is read, the second Counter Latch Command is ignored. Bit Description Counter Selection. These bits select the counter for latching. If “11” is written, then the write is interpreted as a read back command. 7:6 00 = Counter 0 01 = Counter 1 10 = Counter 2 5:4 3:0 Datasheet Counter Latch Command. 00 = Selects the Counter Latch Command. Reserved. Must be 0. 421 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.3.2 SBYTE_FMT—Interval Timer Status Byte Format Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Counter 0 = 40h, Counter 1 = 41h, Attribute: Counter 2 = 42h Size: Bits[6:0] undefined, Bit 7=0 RO 8 bits per counter Each counter's status byte can be read following a Read Back Command. If latch status is chosen (bit 4=0, Read Back Command) as a read back option for a given counter, the next read from the counter's Counter Access Ports Register (40h for counter 0, 41h for counter 1, and 42h for counter 2) returns the status byte. The status byte returns the following: Bit Description Counter OUT Pin State — RO. 7 6 0 = OUT pin of the counter is also a 0 1 = OUT pin of the counter is also a 1 Count Register Status — RO. This bit indicates when the last count written to the Count Register (CR) has been loaded into the counting element (CE). The exact time this happens depends on the counter mode, but until the count is loaded into the counting element (CE), the count value will be incorrect. 0 = Count has been transferred from CR to CE and is available for reading. 1 = Null Count. Count has not been transferred from CR to CE and is not yet available for reading. Read/Write Selection Status — RO. These reflect the read/write selection made through bits[5:4] of the control register. The binary codes returned during the status read match the codes used to program the counter read/write selection. 5:4 00 = Counter Latch Command 01 = Read/Write Least Significant Byte (LSB) 10 = Read/Write Most Significant Byte (MSB) 11 = Read/Write LSB then MSB Mode Selection Status — RO. These bits return the counter mode programming. The binary code returned matches the code used to program the counter mode, as listed under the bit function above. 000 = Mode 0 — Out signal on end of count (=0) 3:1 001 = Mode 1 — Hardware retriggerable one-shot x10 = Mode 2 — Rate generator (divide by n counter) x11 = Mode 3 — Square wave output 100 = Mode 4 — Software triggered strobe 101 = Mode 5 — Hardware triggered strobe Countdown Type Status — RO. This bit reflects the current countdown type. 0 422 0 = Binary countdown 1 = Binary Coded Decimal (BCD) countdown. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.3.3 Counter Access Ports Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Datasheet Counter 0 – 40h, Counter 1 – 41h, Counter 2 – 42h All bits undefined Attribute: R/W Size: 8 bit Bit Description 7:0 Counter Port — R/W. Each counter port address is used to program the 16-bit Count Register. The order of programming, either LSB only, MSB only, or LSB then MSB, is defined with the Interval Counter Control Register at port 43h. The counter port is also used to read the current count from the Count Register, and return the status of the counter programming following a Read Back Command. 423 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4 8259 Interrupt Controller (PIC) Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) 13.4.1 Interrupt Controller I/O MAP (LPC I/F—D31:F0) The interrupt controller registers are located at 20h and 21h for the master controller (IRQ 0–7), and at A0h and A1h for the slave controller (IRQ 8–13). These registers have multiple functions, depending upon the data written to them. Table 13-3 shows the different register possibilities for each address. Table 13-3. PIC Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Port Aliases Type Undefined WO Master PIC ICW1 Init. Cmd Word 1 2Ch, 30h, Master PIC OCW2 Op Ctrl Word 2 001XXXXXb WO 34h, 38h, 3Ch Master PIC OCW3 Op Ctrl Word 3 X01XXX10b WO Master PIC ICW2 Init. Cmd Word 2 Undefined WO 2Dh, 31h, Master PIC ICW3 Init. Cmd Word 3 Undefined WO 35h, 39h, 3Dh Master PIC ICW4 Init. Cmd Word 4 01h WO Master PIC OCW1 Op Ctrl Word 1 00h R/W A4h, A8h, Slave PIC ICW1 Init. Cmd Word 1 Undefined WO ACh, B0h, Slave PIC OCW2 Op Ctrl Word 2 001XXXXXb WO Slave PIC OCW3 Op Ctrl Word 3 X01XXX10b WO Slave PIC ICW2 Init. Cmd Word 2 Undefined WO ADh, B1h, Slave PIC ICW3 Init. Cmd Word 3 Undefined WO B5h, B9h, BDh Slave PIC ICW4 Init. Cmd Word 4 01h WO Slave PIC OCW1 Op Ctrl Word 1 00h R/W 4D0h – Master PIC Edge/Level Triggered 00h R/W 4D1h – Slave PIC Edge/Level Triggered 00h R/W 25h, 29h, 21h A0h B4h, B8h, BCh A5h, A9h, A1h 424 Default Value 24h, 28h, 20h Note: Register Name Refer to note addressing active-low interrupt sources in 8259 Interrupt Controllers section (Section 5.8). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.2 ICW1—Initialization Command Word 1 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 20h Slave Controller – A0h Default Value: All bits undefined Attribute: Size: WO 8 bit /controller A write to Initialization Command Word 1 starts the interrupt controller initialization sequence, during which the following occurs: 1. The Interrupt Mask register is cleared. 2. IRQ7 input is assigned priority 7. 3. The slave mode address is set to 7. 4. Special mask mode is cleared and Status Read is set to IRR. Once this write occurs, the controller expects writes to ICW2, ICW3, and ICW4 to complete the initialization sequence. Bit 7:5 ICW/OCW Select — WO. These bits are MCS-85 specific, and not needed. 000 = Should be programmed to “000” 4 ICW/OCW Select — WO. 1 = This bit must be a 1 to select ICW1 and enable the ICW2, ICW3, and ICW4 sequence. 3 Edge/Level Bank Select (LTIM) — WO. Disabled. Replaced by the edge/level triggered control registers (ELCR, D31:F0:4D0h, D31:F0:4D1h). 2 1 0 Datasheet Description ADI — WO. 0 = Ignored for the ICH10. Should be programmed to 0. Single or Cascade (SNGL) — WO. 0 = Must be programmed to a 0 to indicate two controllers operating in cascade mode. ICW4 Write Required (IC4) — WO. 1 = This bit must be programmed to a 1 to indicate that ICW4 needs to be programmed. 425 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.3 ICW2—Initialization Command Word 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 21h Slave Controller – A1h Default Value: All bits undefined Attribute: Size: WO 8 bit /controller ICW2 is used to initialize the interrupt controller with the five most significant bits of the interrupt vector address. The value programmed for bits[7:3] is used by the processor to define the base address in the interrupt vector table for the interrupt routines associated with each IRQ on the controller. Typical ISA ICW2 values are 08h for the master controller and 70h for the slave controller. Bit 7:3 Description Interrupt Vector Base Address — WO. Bits [7:3] define the base address in the interrupt vector table for the interrupt routines associated with each interrupt request level input. Interrupt Request Level — WO. When writing ICW2, these bits should all be 0. During an interrupt acknowledge cycle, these bits are programmed by the interrupt controller with the interrupt to be serviced. This is combined with bits [7:3] to form the interrupt vector driven onto the data bus during the second INTA# cycle. The code is a three bit binary code: 2:0 426 Code Master Interrupt Slave Interrupt 000b IRQ0 IRQ8 001b IRQ1 IRQ9 010b IRQ2 IRQ10 011b IRQ3 IRQ11 100b IRQ4 IRQ12 101b IRQ5 IRQ13 110b IRQ6 IRQ14 111b IRQ7 IRQ15 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.4 ICW3—Master Controller Initialization Command Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 21h Default Value: All bits undefined Bit 7:3 2 1:0 13.4.5 WO 8 bits Description 0 = These bits must be programmed to 0. Cascaded Interrupt Controller IRQ Connection — WO. This bit indicates that the slave controller is cascaded on IRQ2. When IRQ8#–IRQ15 is asserted, it goes through the slave controller’s priority resolver. The slave controller’s INTR output onto IRQ2. IRQ2 then goes through the master controller’s priority solver. If it wins, the INTR signal is asserted to the processor, and the returning interrupt acknowledge returns the interrupt vector for the slave controller. 1 = This bit must always be programmed to a 1. 0 = These bits must be programmed to 0. ICW3—Slave Controller Initialization Command Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: A1h Default Value: All bits undefined Bit Datasheet Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: WO 8 bits Description 7:3 0 = These bits must be programmed to 0. 2:0 Slave Identification Code — WO. These bits are compared against the slave identification code broadcast by the master controller from the trailing edge of the first internal INTA# pulse to the trailing edge of the second internal INTA# pulse. These bits must be programmed to 02h to match the code broadcast by the master controller. When 02h is broadcast by the master controller during the INTA# sequence, the slave controller assumes responsibility for broadcasting the interrupt vector. 427 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.6 ICW4—Initialization Command Word 4 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 021h Slave Controller – 0A1h Default Value: 01h Bit 7:5 Attribute:WO Size: 8 bits Description 0 = These bits must be programmed to 0. Special Fully Nested Mode (SFNM) — WO. 4 3 2 0 = Should normally be disabled by writing a 0 to this bit. 1 = Special fully nested mode is programmed. Buffered Mode (BUF) — WO. 0 = Must be programmed to 0 for the ICH10. This is non-buffered mode. Master/Slave in Buffered Mode — WO. Not used. 0 = Should always be programmed to 0. Automatic End of Interrupt (AEOI) — WO. 1 0 13.4.7 0 = This bit should normally be programmed to 0. This is the normal end of interrupt. 1 = Automatic End of Interrupt (AEOI) mode is programmed. Microprocessor Mode — WO. 1 = Must be programmed to 1 to indicate that the controller is operating in an Intel Architecture-based system. OCW1—Operational Control Word 1 (Interrupt Mask) Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 021h Slave Controller – 0A1h Default Value: 00h 428 Attribute:R/W Size: 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 Interrupt Request Mask — R/W. When a 1 is written to any bit in this register, the corresponding IRQ line is masked. When a 0 is written to any bit in this register, the corresponding IRQ mask bit is cleared, and interrupt requests will again be accepted by the controller. Masking IRQ2 on the master controller will also mask the interrupt requests from the slave controller. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.8 OCW2—Operational Control Word 2 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 020h Attribute:WO Slave Controller – 0A0h Size: 8 bits Default Value: Bit[4:0]=undefined, Bit[7:5]=001 Following a part reset or ICW initialization, the controller enters the fully nested mode of operation. Non-specific EOI without rotation is the default. Both rotation mode and specific EOI mode are disabled following initialization. Bit Description Rotate and EOI Codes (R, SL, EOI) — WO. These three bits control the Rotate and End of Interrupt modes and combinations of the two. 000 = Rotate in Auto EOI Mode (Clear) 001 = Non-specific EOI command 010 = No Operation 7:5 011 = *Specific EOI Command 100 = Rotate in Auto EOI Mode (Set) 101 = Rotate on Non-Specific EOI Command 110 = *Set Priority Command 111 = *Rotate on Specific EOI Command *L0 – L2 Are Used 4:3 OCW2 Select — WO. When selecting OCW2, bits 4:3 = “00” Interrupt Level Select (L2, L1, L0) — WO. L2, L1, and L0 determine the interrupt level acted upon when the SL bit is active. A simple binary code, outlined below, selects the channel for the command to act upon. When the SL bit is inactive, these bits do not have a defined function; programming L2, L1 and L0 to 0 is sufficient in this case. 2:0 Datasheet Code Interrupt Level Code Interrupt Level 000b IRQ0/8 000b IRQ4/12 001b IRQ1/9 001b IRQ5/13 010b IRQ2/10 010b IRQ6/14 011b IRQ3/11 011b IRQ7/15 429 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.9 OCW3—Operational Control Word 3 Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: Master Controller – 020h Attribute:WO Slave Controller – 0A0h Size: 8 bits Default Value: Bit[6,0]=0, Bit[7,4:2]=undefined, Bit[5,1]=1 Bit Description 7 Reserved. Must be 0. 6 Special Mask Mode (SMM) — WO. 1 = The Special Mask Mode can be used by an interrupt service routine to dynamically alter the system priority structure while the routine is executing, through selective enabling/disabling of the other channel's mask bits. Bit 5, the ESMM bit, must be set for this bit to have any meaning. Enable Special Mask Mode (ESMM) — WO. 5 4:3 0 = Disable. The SMM bit becomes a “don't care”. 1 = Enable the SMM bit to set or reset the Special Mask Mode. OCW3 Select — WO. When selecting OCW3, bits 4:3 = 01 Poll Mode Command — WO. 2 1:0 0 = Disable. Poll Command is not issued. 1 = Enable. The next I/O read to the interrupt controller is treated as an interrupt acknowledge cycle. An encoded byte is driven onto the data bus, representing the highest priority level requesting service. Register Read Command — WO. These bits provide control for reading the In-Service Register (ISR) and the Interrupt Request Register (IRR). When bit 1=0, bit 0 will not affect the register read selection. When bit 1=1, bit 0 selects the register status returned following an OCW3 read. If bit 0=0, the IRR will be read. If bit 0=1, the ISR will be read. Following ICW initialization, the default OCW3 port address read will be “read IRR”. To retain the current selection (read ISR or read IRR), always write a 0 to bit 1 when programming this register. The selected register can be read repeatedly without reprogramming OCW3. To select a new status register, OCW3 must be reprogrammed prior to attempting the read. 00 = No Action 01 = No Action 10 = Read IRQ Register 11 = Read IS Register 430 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.10 ELCR1—Master Controller Edge/Level Triggered Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 4D0h Default Value: 00h Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bits In edge mode, (bit[x] = 0), the interrupt is recognized by a low to high transition. In level mode (bit[x] = 1), the interrupt is recognized by a high level. The cascade channel, IRQ2, the heart beat timer (IRQ0), and the keyboard controller (IRQ1), cannot be put into level mode. Bit Description IRQ7 ECL — R/W. 7 0 = Edge. 1 = Level. IRQ6 ECL — R/W. 6 0 = Edge. 1 = Level. IRQ5 ECL — R/W. 5 0 = Edge. 1 = Level. IRQ4 ECL — R/W. 4 0 = Edge. 1 = Level. IRQ3 ECL — R/W. 3 2:0 Datasheet 0 = Edge. 1 = Level. Reserved. Must be 0. 431 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.4.11 ELCR2—Slave Controller Edge/Level Triggered Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Offset Address: 4D1h Default Value: 00h Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bits In edge mode, (bit[x] = 0), the interrupt is recognized by a low to high transition. In level mode (bit[x] = 1), the interrupt is recognized by a high level. The real time clock, IRQ8#, and the floating point error interrupt, IRQ13, cannot be programmed for level mode. Bit Description IRQ15 ECL — R/W. 7 0 = Edge 1 = Level IRQ14 ECL — R/W. 6 5 0 = Edge 1 = Level Reserved. Must be 0. IRQ12 ECL — R/W. 4 0 = Edge 1 = Level IRQ11 ECL — R/W. 3 0 = Edge 1 = Level IRQ10 ECL — R/W. 2 0 = Edge 1 = Level IRQ9 ECL — R/W. 432 1 0 = Edge 1 = Level 0 Reserved. Must be 0. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.5 Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller (APIC)(D31:F0) 13.5.1 APIC Register Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0) The APIC is accessed via an indirect addressing scheme. Two registers are visible by software for manipulation of most of the APIC registers. These registers are mapped into memory space. The address bits 15:12 (Consumer Only) and 19:12 (Corporate Only) of the address range are programmable through bits 7:4 (Consumer Only) and 7:0 (Corporate Only) of OIC register (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 31FFh for Consumer Family and Offset 31FEh for Corporate family) The registers are shown in Table 13-4. Table 13-4. APIC Direct Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Address Mnemonic Register Name Size Type FEC_ _0000h (Corporate Only) IND Index 8 bits R/W FEC0_0000h (Consumer Only) IND Index 8 bits R/W FEC_ _0010h (Corporate Only) DAT Data 32 bits R/W FEC0_0010h (Consumer Only) DAT Data 32 bits R/W FEC_ _0040h (Corporate Only) EOIR EOI 32 bits WO FECO_0040h (Consumer Only) EOIR EOI 32 bits WO Table 13-5 lists the registers which can be accessed within the APIC via the Index Register. When accessing these registers, accesses must be done one dword at a time. For example, software should never access byte 2 from the Data register before accessing bytes 0 and 1. The hardware will not attempt to recover from a bad programming model in this case. Table 13-5. APIC Indirect Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Datasheet Index Mnemonic 00 ID Register Name Size Type Identification 32 bits R/W Version 32 bits RO — RO 01 VER 02–0F — 10–11 REDIR_TBL0 Redirection Table 0 64 bits R/W, RO 12–13 REDIR_TBL1 Redirection Table 1 64 bits R/W, RO ... ... 3E–3F REDIR_TBL23 40–FF — Reserved ... Redirection Table 23 Reserved ... ... 64 bits R/W, RO — RO 433 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.5.2 IND—Index Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Memory Address FEC0_0000h (Consumer Only) FEC_ _0000h (Corporate Only) Default Value: 00h Attribute: R/W Size: 8 bits The Index Register will select which APIC indirect register to be manipulated by software. The selector values for the indirect registers are listed in Table 13-5. Software will program this register to select the desired APIC internal register . Bit 7:0 13.5.3 Description APIC Index — R/W. This is an 8-bit pointer into the I/O APIC register table. DAT—Data Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Memory Address Default Value: FEC0_0000h (Consumer Only) Attribute: FEC_ _0000h (Corporate Only) 00000000h Size: R/W 32 bits This is a 32-bit register specifying the data to be read or written to the register pointed to by the Index register. This register can only be accessed in dword quantities. Bit 7:0 434 Description APIC Data — R/W. This is a 32-bit register for the data to be read or written to the APIC indirect register (Figure 13-5) pointed to by the Index register (Memory Address FEC0_0000h). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.5.4 EOIR—EOI Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Memory Address FEC0_0000h (Consumer Only) Attribute: FEC_ _0000h (Corporate Only) Default Value: N/A Size: R/W 32 bits The EOI register is present to provide a mechanism to maintain the level triggered semantics for level-triggered interrupts issued on the parallel bus. When a write is issued to this register, the I/O APIC will check the lower 8 bits written to this register, and compare it with the vector field for each entry in the I/O Redirection Table. When a match is found, the Remote_IRR bit (Index Offset 10h, bit 14) for that I/O Redirection Entry will be cleared. Note: If multiple I/O Redirection entries, for any reason, assign the same vector for more than one interrupt input, each of those entries will have the Remote_IRR bit reset to 0. The interrupt which was prematurely reset will not be lost because if its input remained active when the Remote_IRR bit is cleared, the interrupt will be reissued and serviced at a later time. Note: Only bits 7:0 are actually used. Bits 31:8 are ignored by the ICH10. Note: To provide for future expansion, the processor should always write a value of 0 to Bits 31:8. Datasheet Bit Description 31:8 Reserved. To provide for future expansion, the processor should always write a value of 0 to Bits 31:8. 7:0 Redirection Entry Clear — WO. When a write is issued to this register, the I/O APIC will check this field, and compare it with the vector field for each entry in the I/O Redirection Table. When a match is found, the Remote_IRR bit for that I/O Redirection Entry will be cleared. 435 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.5.5 ID—Identification Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Index Offset: Default Value: 00h 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/W 32 bits The APIC ID serves as a physical name of the APIC. The APIC bus arbitration ID for the APIC is derived from its I/O APIC ID. This register is reset to 0 on power-up reset. Bit 31:28 Reserved 27:24 APIC ID — R/W. Software must program this value before using the APIC. 23:16 Reserved 15 14:0 13.5.6 Description Scratchpad Bit. Reserved VER—Version Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Index Offset: Default Value: 01h 00170020h Attribute: Size: RO, RWO 32 bits Each I/O APIC contains a hardwired Version Register that identifies different implementation of APIC and their versions. The maximum redirection entry information also is in this register, to let software know how many interrupt are supported by this APIC. Bit Description 31:24 Reserved 23:16 Maximum Redirection Entries (MRE) — RWO. This is the entry number (0 being the lowest entry) of the highest entry in the redirection table. It is equal to the number of interrupt input pins minus one and is in the range 0 through 239. In the ICH10 this field is hardwired to 17h to indicate 24 interrupts. BIOS must write to this field after PLTRST# to lockdown the value. this allows BIOS to utilize some of the entries for its own purpose and thus advertising fewer IOxAPIC Redirection Entries to the OS. 15 14:8 7:0 436 Pin Assertion Register Supported (PRQ) — RO. Indicate that the IOxAPIC does not implement the Pin Assertion Register. Reserved Version (VS) — RO. This is a version number that identifies the implementation version. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.5.7 REDIR_TBL—Redirection Table (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Index Offset: Default Value: 10h–11h (vector 0) throughAttribute: R/W, RO 3E–3Fh (vector 23) Bit 16 = 1. All other bits undefinedSize:64 bits each, (accessed as two 32 bit quantities) The Redirection Table has a dedicated entry for each interrupt input pin. The information in the Redirection Table is used to translate the interrupt manifestation on the corresponding interrupt pin into an APIC message. The APIC will respond to an edge triggered interrupt as long as the interrupt is held until after the acknowledge cycle has begun. Once the interrupt is detected, a delivery status bit internally to the I/O APIC is set. The state machine will step ahead and wait for an acknowledgment from the APIC unit that the interrupt message was sent. Only then will the I/O APIC be able to recognize a new edge on that interrupt pin. That new edge will only result in a new invocation of the handler if its acceptance by the destination APIC causes the Interrupt Request Register bit to go from 0 to 1. (In other words, if the interrupt was not already pending at the destination.) Bit Description 63:56 Destination — R/W. If bit 11 of this entry is 0 (Physical), then bits 59:56 specifies an APIC ID. In this case, bits 63:59 should be programmed by software to 0. If bit 11 of this entry is 1 (Logical), then bits 63:56 specify the logical destination address of a set of processors. 55:48 Extended Destination ID (EDID) — RO. These bits are sent to a local APIC only when in Processor System Bus mode. They become bits 11:4 of the address. 47:17 Reserved Mask — R/W. 16 15 14 13 12 Datasheet 0 = Not masked: An edge or level on this interrupt pin results in the delivery of the interrupt to the destination. 1 = Masked: Interrupts are not delivered nor held pending. Setting this bit after the interrupt is accepted by a local APIC has no effect on that interrupt. This behavior is identical to the device withdrawing the interrupt before it is posted to the processor. It is software's responsibility to deal with the case where the mask bit is set after the interrupt message has been accepted by a local APIC unit but before the interrupt is dispensed to the processor. Trigger Mode — R/W. This field indicates the type of signal on the interrupt pin that triggers an interrupt. 0 = Edge triggered. 1 = Level triggered. Remote IRR — R/W. This bit is used for level triggered interrupts; its meaning is undefined for edge triggered interrupts. 0 = Reset when an EOI message is received from a local APIC. 1 = Set when Local APIC/s accept the level interrupt sent by the I/O APIC. Interrupt Input Pin Polarity — R/W. This bit specifies the polarity of each interrupt signal connected to the interrupt pins. 0 = Active high. 1 = Active low. Delivery Status — RO. This field contains the current status of the delivery of this interrupt. Writes to this bit have no effect. 0 = Idle. No activity for this interrupt. 1 = Pending. Interrupt has been injected, but delivery is not complete. 437 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Destination Mode — R/W. This field determines the interpretation of the Destination field. 11 0 = Physical. Destination APIC ID is identified by bits 59:56. 1 = Logical. Destinations are identified by matching bit 63:56 with the Logical Destination in the Destination Format Register and Logical Destination Register in each Local APIC. 10:8 Delivery Mode — R/W. This field specifies how the APICs listed in the destination field should act upon reception of this signal. Certain Delivery Modes will only operate as intended when used in conjunction with a specific trigger mode. These encodings are listed in the note below: 7:0 Vector — R/W. This field contains the interrupt vector for this interrupt. Values range between 10h and FEh. NOTE: Delivery Mode encoding: 000 = Fixed. Deliver the signal on the INTR signal of all processor cores listed in the destination. Trigger Mode can be edge or level. 001 = Lowest Priority. Deliver the signal on the INTR signal of the processor core that is executing at the lowest priority among all the processors listed in the specified destination. Trigger Mode can be edge or level. 010 = SMI (System Management Interrupt). Requires the interrupt to be programmed as edge triggered. The vector information is ignored but must be programmed to all 0s for future compatibility: not supported 011 = Reserved 100 = NMI. Deliver the signal on the NMI signal of all processor cores listed in the destination. Vector information is ignored. NMI is treated as an edge triggered interrupt even if it is programmed as level triggered. For proper operation this redirection table entry must be programmed to edge triggered. The NMI delivery mode does not set the RIRR bit. If the redirection table is incorrectly set to level, the loop count will continue counting through the redirection table addresses. Once the count for the NMI pin is reached again, the interrupt will be sent again: not supported 101 = INIT. Deliver the signal to all processor cores listed in the destination by asserting the INIT signal. All addressed local APICs will assume their INIT state. INIT is always treated as an edge triggered interrupt even if programmed as level triggered. For proper operation this redirection table entry must be programmed to edge triggered. The INIT delivery mode does not set the RIRR bit. If the redirection table is incorrectly set to level, the loop count will continue counting through the redirection table addresses. Once the count for the INIT pin is reached again, the interrupt will be sent again: not supported 110 = Reserved 111 = ExtINT. Deliver the signal to the INTR signal of all processor cores listed in the destination as an interrupt that originated in an externally connected 8259A compatible interrupt controller. The INTA cycle that corresponds to this ExtINT delivery will be routed to the external controller that is expected to supply the vector. Requires the interrupt to be programmed as edge triggered. 438 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.6 Real Time Clock Registers 13.6.1 I/O Register Address Map The RTC internal registers and RAM are organized as two banks of 128 bytes each, called the standard and extended banks. The first 14 bytes of the standard bank contain the RTC time and date information along with four registers, A–D, that are used for configuration of the RTC. The extended bank contains a full 128 bytes of battery backed SRAM, and will be accessible even when the RTC module is disabled (via the RTC configuration register). Registers A–D do not physically exist in the RAM. All data movement between the host processor and the real-time clock is done through registers mapped to the standard I/O space. The register map appears in Table 13-6. Table 13-6. RTC I/O Registers I/O Locations If U128E bit = 0 70h and 74h Also alias to 72h and 76h 71h and 75h Also alias to 73h and 77h Function Real-Time Clock (Standard RAM) Index Register Real-Time Clock (Standard RAM) Target Register 72h and 76h Extended RAM Index Register (if enabled) 73h and 77h Extended RAM Target Register (if enabled) NOTES: 1. I/O locations 70h and 71h are the standard legacy location for the real-time clock. The map for this bank is shown in Table 13-7. Locations 72h and 73h are for accessing the extended RAM. The extended RAM bank is also accessed using an indexed scheme. I/O address 72h is used as the address pointer and I/O address 73h is used as the data register. Index addresses above 127h are not valid. If the extended RAM is not needed, it may be disabled. 2. Software must preserve the value of bit 7 at I/O addresses 70h and 74h. When writing to this address, software must first read the value, and then write the same value for bit 7 during the sequential address write. Note that port 70h is not directly readable. The only way to read this register is through Alt Access mode. Although RTC Index bits 6:0 are readable from port 74h, bit 7 will always return 0. If the NMI# enable is not changed during normal operation, software can alternatively read this bit once and then retain the value for all subsequent writes to port 70h. Datasheet 439 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.6.2 Indexed Registers The RTC contains two sets of indexed registers that are accessed using the two separate Index and Target registers (70/71h or 72/73h), as shown in Table 13-7. Table 13-7. RTC (Standard) RAM Bank Index 00h Seconds 01h Seconds Alarm 02h Minutes 03h Minutes Alarm 04h Hours 05h Hours Alarm 06h Day of Week 07h Day of Month 08h Month 09h Year 0Ah Register A 0Bh Register B 0Ch Register C 0Dh Register D 0Eh–7Fh 440 Name 114 Bytes of User RAM Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.6.2.1 RTC_REGA—Register A RTC Index: Default Value: Lockable: 0A Undefined No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 8-bit RTC This register is used for general configuration of the RTC functions. None of the bits are affected by RSMRST# or any other ICH10 reset signal. Bit Description Update In Progress (UIP) — R/W. This bit may be monitored as a status flag. 7 0 = The update cycle will not start for at least 488 µs. The time, calendar, and alarm information in RAM is always available when the UIP bit is 0. 1 = The update is soon to occur or is in progress. Division Chain Select (DV[2:0]) — R/W. These three bits control the divider chain for the oscillator, and are not affected by RSMRST# or any other reset signal. 010 = Normal Operation 11X = Divider Reset 6:4 101 = Bypass 15 stages (test mode only) 100 = Bypass 10 stages (test mode only) 011 = Bypass 5 stages (test mode only) 001 = Invalid 000 = Invalid Rate Select (RS[3:0]) — R/W. Selects one of 13 taps of the 15 stage divider chain. The selected tap can generate a periodic interrupt if the PIE bit is set in Register B. Otherwise this tap will set the PF flag of Register C. If the periodic interrupt is not to be used, these bits should all be set to 0. RS3 corresponds to bit 3. 0000 = Interrupt never toggles 0001 = 3.90625 ms 0010 = 7.8125 ms 0011 = 122.070 µs 0100 = 244.141 µs 3:0 0101 = 488.281 µs 0110 = 976.5625 µs 0111 = 1.953125 ms 1000 = 3.90625 ms 1001 = 7.8125 ms 1010 = 15.625 ms 1011 = 31.25 ms 1100 = 62.5 ms 1101 = 125 ms 1110 = 250 ms 1111= 500 ms Datasheet 441 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.6.2.2 RTC_REGB—Register B (General Configuration) RTC Index: Default Value: Lockable: 0Bh Attribute: U0U00UUU (U: Undefined) Size: No Power Well: Bit R/W 8-bit RTC Description Update Cycle Inhibit (SET) — R/W. Enables/Inhibits the update cycles. This bit is not affected by RSMRST# nor any other reset signal. 7 0 = Update cycle occurs normally once each second. 1 = A current update cycle will abort and subsequent update cycles will not occur until SET is returned to 0. When set is one, the BIOS may initialize time and calendar bytes safely. NOTE: This bit should be set then cleared early in BIOS POST after each powerup directly after coin-cell battery insertion. Periodic Interrupt Enable (PIE) — R/W. This bit is cleared by RSMRST#, but not on any other reset. 6 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. Allows an interrupt to occur with a time base set with the RS bits of register A. Alarm Interrupt Enable (AIE) — R/W. This bit is cleared by RTCRST#, but not on any other reset. 5 4 3 2 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. Allows an interrupt to occur when the AF is set by an alarm match from the update cycle. An alarm can occur once a second, one an hour, once a day, or one a month. Update-Ended Interrupt Enable (UIE) — R/W. This bit is cleared by RSMRST#, but not on any other reset. 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. Allows an interrupt to occur when the update cycle ends. Square Wave Enable (SQWE) — R/W. This bit serves no function in the ICH10. It is left in this register bank to provide compatibility with the Motorola 146818B. The ICH10 has no SQW pin. This bit is cleared by RSMRST#, but not on any other reset. Data Mode (DM) — R/W. This bit specifies either binary or BCD data representation. This bit is not affected by RSMRST# nor any other reset signal. 0 = BCD 1 = Binary Hour Format (HOURFORM) — R/W. This bit indicates the hour byte format. This bit is not affected by RSMRST# nor any other reset signal. 1 0 442 0 = Twelve-hour mode. In twelve-hour mode, the seventh bit represents AM as 0 and PM as one. 1 = Twenty-four hour mode. Daylight Savings Legacy Software Support (DSLSWS) — R/W. Daylight savings functionality is no longer supported. This bit is used to maintain legacy software support and has no associated functionality. If BUC.DSO bit is set, the DSLSWS bit continues to be R/W. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.6.2.3 RTC_REGC—Register C (Flag Register) RTC Index: Default Value: Lockable: 0Ch Attribute: 00U00000 (U: Undefined) Size: No Power Well: RO 8-bit RTC Writes to Register C have no effect. Bit Description 7 Interrupt Request Flag (IRQF) — RO. IRQF = (PF * PIE) + (AF * AIE) + (UF *UFE). This bit also causes the RTC Interrupt to be asserted. This bit is cleared upon RSMRST# or a read of Register C. Periodic Interrupt Flag (PF) — RO. This bit is cleared upon RSMRST# or a read of Register C. 6 0 = If no taps are specified via the RS bits in Register A, this flag will not be set. 1 = Periodic interrupt Flag will be 1 when the tap specified by the RS bits of register A is 1. Alarm Flag (AF) — RO. 5 0 = This bit is cleared upon RTCRST# or a read of Register C. 1 = Alarm Flag will be set after all Alarm values match the current time. Update-Ended Flag (UF) — RO. 4 3:0 13.6.2.4 0 = The bit is cleared upon RSMRST# or a read of Register C. 1 = Set immediately following an update cycle for each second. Reserved. Will always report 0. RTC_REGD—Register D (Flag Register) RTC Index: Default Value: Lockable: 0Dh Attribute: 10UUUUUU (U: Undefined) Size: No Power Well: R/W 8-bit RTC Bit Description 7 0 = This bit should always be written as a 0 for write cycle, however it will return a 1 for read cycles. 1 = This bit is hardwired to 1 in the RTC power well. Valid RAM and Time Bit (VRT) — R/W. 6 5:0 Datasheet Reserved. This bit always returns a 0 and should be set to 0 for write cycles. Date Alarm — R/W. These bits store the date of month alarm value. If set to 000000b, then a don’t care state is assumed. The host must configure the date alarm for these bits to do anything, yet they can be written at any time. If the date alarm is not enabled, these bits will return 0s to mimic the functionality of the Motorola 146818B. These bits are not affected by any reset assertion. 443 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.7 Processor Interface Registers (LPC I/F—D31:F0) Table 13-8 is the register address map for the processor interface registers. Table 13-8. Processor Interface PCI Register Address Map (LPC I/F—D31:F0) 13.7.1 Offset Mnemonic 61h NMI_SC 70h NMI_EN Register Name Default Type NMI Status and Control 00h R/W, RO NMI Enable 80h R/W (special) 92h PORT92 Fast A20 and Init 00h R/W F0h COPROC_ERR Coprocessor Error 00h WO CF9h RST_CNT Reset Control 00h R/W NMI_SC—NMI Status and Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: 61h 00h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W, RO 8-bit Core Bit Description 7 SERR# NMI Source Status (SERR#_NMI_STS) — RO. 1 = Bit is set if a PCI agent detected a system error and pulses the PCI SERR# line and if bit 2 (PCI_SERR_EN) is cleared. This interrupt source is enabled by setting bit 2 to 0. To reset the interrupt, set bit 2 to 1 and then set it to 0. When writing to port 61h, this bit must be 0. NOTE: This bit is set by any of the ICH10 internal sources of SERR; this includes SERR assertions forwarded from the secondary PCI bus, errors on a PCI Express* port, or other internal functions that generate SERR#. 6 IOCHK# NMI Source Status (IOCHK_NMI_STS) — RO. 1 = Bit is set if an LPC agent (via SERIRQ) asserted IOCHK# and if bit 3 (IOCHK_NMI_EN) is cleared. This interrupt source is enabled by setting bit 3 to 0. To reset the interrupt, set bit 3 to 1 and then set it to 0. When writing to port 61h, this bit must be a 0. 5 Timer Counter 2 OUT Status (TMR2_OUT_STS) — RO. This bit reflects the current state of the 8254 counter 2 output. Counter 2 must be programmed following any PCI reset for this bit to have a determinate value. When writing to port 61h, this bit must be a 0. 4 Refresh Cycle Toggle (REF_TOGGLE) — RO. This signal toggles from either 0 to 1 or 1 to 0 at a rate that is equivalent to when refresh cycles would occur. When writing to port 61h, this bit must be a 0. IOCHK# NMI Enable (IOCHK_NMI_EN) — R/W. 3 0 = Enabled. 1 = Disabled and cleared. PCI SERR# Enable (PCI_SERR_EN) — R/W. 2 444 0 = SERR# NMIs are enabled. 1 = SERR# NMIs are disabled and cleared. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Speaker Data Enable (SPKR_DAT_EN) — R/W. 1 0 = SPKR output is a 0. 1 = SPKR output is equivalent to the Counter 2 OUT signal value. Timer Counter 2 Enable (TIM_CNT2_EN) — R/W. 0 13.7.2 0 = Disable 1 = Enable NMI_EN—NMI Enable (and Real Time Clock Index) Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Note: 70h 80h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W (special) 8-bit Core The RTC Index field is write-only for normal operation. This field can only be read in AltAccess Mode. Note, however, that this register is aliased to Port 74h (documented in), and all bits are readable at that address. Bits Description NMI Enable (NMI_EN) — R/W (special). 7 6:0 13.7.3 0 = Enable NMI sources. 1 = Disable All NMI sources. Real Time Clock Index Address (RTC_INDX) — R/W (special). This data goes to the RTC to select which register or CMOS RAM address is being accessed. PORT92—Fast A20 and Init Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 7:2 1 0 Datasheet 92h 00h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 8-bit Core Description Reserved Alternate A20 Gate (ALT_A20_GATE) — R/W. This bit is Or’d with the A20GATE input signal to generate A20M# to the processor. 0 = A20M# signal can potentially go active. 1 = This bit is set when INIT# goes active. INIT_NOW — R/W. When this bit transitions from a 0 to a 1, the ICH10 will force INIT# active for 16 PCI clocks. 445 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.7.4 COPROC_ERR—Coprocessor Error Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: 13.7.5 F0h 00h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: WO 8-bits Core Bits Description 7:0 Coprocessor Error (COPROC_ERR) — WO. Any value written to this register will cause IGNNE# to go active, if FERR# had generated an internal IRQ13. For FERR# to generate an internal IRQ13, the COPROC_ERR_EN bit (Chipset Config Registers:Offset 31FFh: bit 1 for Consumer Family and Offset 31FEh: bit 9 for Corporate family) must be 1. RST_CNT—Reset Control Register (LPC I/F—D31:F0) I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 7:4 CF9h 00h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 8-bit Core Description Reserved Full Reset (FULL_RST) — R/W. This bit is used to determine the states of SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, and SLP_S5# after a CF9 hard reset (SYS_RST =1 and RST_CPU is set to 1), after PWROK going low (with RSMRST# high), or after two TCO timeouts. 3 0 = ICH10 will keep SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5# high. 1 = ICH10 will drive SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5# low for 3 – 5 seconds. NOTE: When this bit is set, it also causes the full power cycle (SLP_S3/4/5# assertion) in response to SYSRESET#, PWROK#, and Watchdog timer reset sources. 2 Reset CPU (RST_CPU) — R/W. When this bit transitions from a 0 to a 1, it initiates a hard or soft reset, as determined by the SYS_RST bit (bit 1 of this register). System Reset (SYS_RST) — R/W. This bit is used to determine a hard or soft reset to the processor. 1 0 446 0 = When RST_CPU bit goes from 0 to 1, the ICH10 performs a soft reset by activating INIT# for 16 PCI clocks. 1 = When RST_CPU bit goes from 0 to 1, the ICH10 performs a hard reset by activating PLTRST# and SUS_STAT# active for about 5-6 milliseconds. In this case, SLP_S3#, SLP_S4# and SLP_S5# state (assertion or de-assertion) depends on FULL_RST bit setting. The ICH10 main power well is reset when this bit is 1. It also resets the resume well bits (except for those noted throughout the EDS). Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8 Power Management Registers (PM—D31:F0) The power management registers are distributed within the PCI Device 31: Function 0 space, as well as a separate I/O range. Each register is described below. Unless otherwise indicate, bits are in the main (core) power well. Bits not explicitly defined in each register are assumed to be reserved. When writing to a reserved bit, the value should always be 0. Software should not attempt to use the value read from a reserved bit, as it may not be consistently 1 or 0. 13.8.1 Power Management PCI Configuration Registers (PM—D31:F0) Table 13-9 shows a small part of the configuration space for PCI Device 31: Function 0. It includes only those registers dedicated for power management. Some of the registers are only used for Legacy Power management schemes. Table 13-9. Power Management PCI Register Address Map (PM—D31:F0) Datasheet Offset Mnemonic A0h GEN_PMCON_1 A2h Default Type General Power Management Configuration 1 0000h R/W,, R/WO, RO GEN_PMCON_2 General Power Management Configuration 2 00h R/W, R/WC A4h GEN_PMCON_3 General Power Management Configuration 3 00h R/W, R/WC A6h GEN_PMCON_LO CK General Power Management Configuration Lock 00h RO, R/WLO Cx State Configuration 00h R/W C4 Timing Control 00h R/W BM_BREAK_EN 00h R/W Power Management Initialization 00000000h R/W, R/WL GPI Route Control 00000000h R/W A9h Cx-STATE_CNF AAh C4-TIMING_CNT ABh BM_BREAK_EN ACh PMIR B8–BBh GPI_ROUT Register Name 447 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.1 GEN_PMCON_1—General PM Configuration 1 Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: A0h Default Value: 0000h Lockable: No Attribute: Size: Usage: Power Well: Bit 15:13 R/W, RO, R/WO 16-bit ACPI, Legacy Core Description Reserved C4 Disable — R/W. This bit disables the C4 feature. 0 = Enables C4 1 = Disables C4. 12 When C4 Disable is 1: • I/O reads to the LVL4 register will be retried normally, but with no other action • All C4 transition attempts are disabled, overriding C4onC3 and Pop-Down transition. BMBUSY# Select (BMSEL)— R/W. This bit along with GPIO_USE_SEL[0] bit enables selection of BM_BUSY#/GPIO0 function on ICH pin as shown below: 11 GPIO_USE_SEL[0] BMSEL Pin Function 1 X GPIO0 0 0 BMBUSY# 0 1 Reserved BIOS_PCI_EXP_EN — R/W. This bit acts as a global enable for the SCI associated with the PCI Express* ports. 10 0 = The various PCI Express ports and (G)MCH cannot cause the PCI_EXP_STS bit to go active. 1 = The various PCI Express ports and (G)MCH can cause the PCI_EXP_STS bit to go active. PWRBTN_LVL — RO. This bit indicates the current state of the PWRBTN# signal. 9 448 0 = Low. 1 = High. 8 Reserved 7 Enter C4 When C3 Invoked (C4onC3_EN) — R/W. If this bit is set, then when software does a LVL3 read, the ICH10 transitions to the C4 state. 6 (Corporate Only) Ignore Stop-Grant - R/W. Software sets this bit to indicate that the ICH must not wait for the Stop Grant (aka REQ_C2) cycle. This bit must be set for iA64 processors and CSI processors. 6 (Consumer Only) i64_EN. Software sets this bit to indicate that the processor is an IA_64 processor, not an IA_32 processor. This may be used in various state machines where there are behavioral differences. 5 (Corporate Only) Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description CPU SLP# Enable (CPUSLP_EN) — R/W. 5 (Consumer Only) 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the CPUSLP# signal to go active in the S1 state. This reduces the processor power. NOTE: CPUSLP# will go active on entry to C3 and C4 states even if this bit is not set. 4 3 SMI_LOCK — R/WO. When this bit is set, writes to the GLB_SMI_EN bit (PMBASE + 30h, bit 0) will have no effect. Once the SMI_LOCK bit is set, writes of 0 to SMI_LOCK bit will have no effect (i.e., once set, this bit can only be cleared by PLTRST#). Reserved PCI CLKRUN# Enable (CLKRUN_EN) — R/W. 2 0 = Disable. ICH10 drives the CLKRUN# signal low. 1 = Enable CLKRUN# logic to control the system PCI clock via the CLKRUN# and STP_PCI# signals. NOTE: When the SLP_EN# bit is set, the ICH10 drives the CLKRUN# signal low regardless of the state of the CLKRUN_EN bit. This ensures that the PCI and LPC clocks continue running during a transition to a sleep state. Periodic SMI# Rate Select (PER_SMI_SEL) — R/W. Set by software to control the rate at which periodic SMI# is generated. 1:0 00 = 64 seconds 01 = 32 seconds 10 = 16 seconds 11 = 8 seconds Datasheet 449 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.2 GEN_PMCON_2—General PM Configuration 2 Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: A2h Default Value: 00h Lockable: No Bit 7 Attribute: Size: Usage: Power Well: R/W, R/WC 8-bit ACPI, Legacy Resume Description DRAM Initialization Bit — R/W. This bit does not effect hardware functionality in any way. BIOS is expected to set this bit prior to starting the DRAM initialization sequence and to clear this bit after completing the DRAM initialization sequence. BIOS can detect that a DRAM initialization sequence was interrupted by a reset by reading this bit during the boot sequence. • If the bit is 1, then the DRAM initialization was interrupted. • This bit is reset by the assertion of the RSMRST# pin. CPU PLL Lock Time (CPLT) — R/W. This field indicates the amount of time that the processor needs to lock its PLLs. This is used wherever timing t270 (Chapter 8) applies. 00 = min 30.7 µs (Default) 01 = min 61.4 µs 10 = min 122.8 µs 6:5 11 = min 42 µs (min) to 48 µs (max) It is the responsibility of the BIOS to program the correct value in this field prior to the first transition to C3 or C4 states. NOTES: 1. The DPSLP-TO-(G)MCH Message bits (D31:F0:AAh, bits 1:0) act as an override to these bits. 2. These bits are not cleared by any type of reset except RSMRST# or a CF9h write. System Reset Status (SRS) — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 0 = SYS_RESET# button Not pressed. 1 = ICH10 sets this bit when the SYS_RESET# button is pressed. BIOS is expected to read this bit and clear it, if it is set. 4 NOTES: 1. This bit is also reset by RSMRST# and CF9h resets. 2. The SYS_RESET# is implemented in the Main power well. This pin must be properly isolated and masked to prevent incorrectly setting this Suspend well status bit. CPU Thermal Trip Status (CTS) — R/WC. 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = This bit is set when PLTRST# is inactive and THRMTRIP# goes active while the system is in an S0 or S1 state. 3 450 NOTES: 1. This bit is also reset by RSMRST#, and CF9h resets. It is not reset by the shutdown and reboot associated with the CPUTHRMTRIP# event. 2. The CF9h reset in the description refers to CF9h type core well reset which includes SYS_RST#, PWROK/VRMPWRGD low, SMBus hard reset, TCO Timeout. This type of reset will clear CTS bit. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Minimum SLP_S4# Assertion Width Violation Status — R/WC. 2 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Hardware sets this bit when the SLP_S4# assertion width is less than the time programmed in the SLP_S4# Minimum Assertion Width field (D31:F0:Offset A4h:bits 5:4). The ICH10 begins the timer when SLP_S4# is asserted during S4/S5 entry, or when the RSMRST# input is deasserted during G3 exit. Note that this bit is functional regardless of the value in the SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable (D31:F0:Offset A4h:bit 3). NOTE: This bit is reset by the assertion of the RSMRST# pin, but can be set in some cases before the default value is readable. CPU Power Failure (CPUPWR_FLR) — R/W. 1 0 = Software (typically BIOS) clears this bit by writing a 0 to it. 1 = Indicates that the VRMPWRGD signal from the processor’s VRM went low while the system was in an S0 or S1 state. NOTE: VRMPWRGD is sampled using the RTC clock. Therefore, low times that are less than one RTC clock period may not be detected by the Intel ICH10. PWROK Failure (PWROK_FLR) — R/WC. 0 Datasheet 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it, or when the system goes into a G3 state. 1 = This bit will be set any time PWROK goes low, when the system was in S0, or S1 state. The bit will be cleared only by software by writing a 1 to this bit or when the system goes to a G3 state. NOTE: See Chapter 5.13.6.3 for more details about the PWROK pin functionality. NOTE: In the case of true PWROK failure, PWROK will go low first before the VRMPWRGD. 451 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.3 GEN_PMCON_3—General PM Configuration 3 Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: A4h Default Value: 0000h Consumer Only 0200h Corporate Only Lockable: No Bit Attribute: Size: R/W, R/WC 16-bit Usage: Power Well: ACPI, Legacy RTC, SUS Description PME B0 S5 Disable (PME_B0_S5_DIS)— R/W. When set to '1', this bit blocks wake events from PME_B0_STS in S5, regardless of the state of PME_B0_EN. When cleared (default), wake events from PME_B0_STS are allowed in S5 if PME_B0_EN = '1'. Wakes from power states other than S5 are not affected by this policy bit. The net effect of setting PME_B0_S5_DIS = '1' is described by the truth table below: 15 (Corporate Only) Y = Wake; N = Don't wake; B0 = PME_B0_EN; OV = WOL Enable Override B0/OV S1/S3/S4 S5 00 N N 01 N Y (LAN only) 11 Y (all PME B0 sources) Y (LAN only) 01 Y (all PME B0 sources) N This bit is cleared by the RTCRST# pin. 15 (Consumer Only) Reserved MAC Power Down During WOL Disable — R/W. 14 (Corporate Only) 0 = MAC power down WOL is enabled if the hardware and software requirements are met. 1 = Integrated MAC remains powered whenever external suspend rails are powered. WOL Enable Override — R/W. 13 (Corporate Only) 0 = WOL policies are determined by PMEB0 enable bit and appropriate LAN status bits 1 = Enable integrated LAN to wake the system in S5 only regardless of the value in the PME_B0_EN bit in the GPE0_EN register. This bit is cleared by the RTCRST# pin. Disable SLP_S4# Stretching after G3: 12 (Corporate Only) 0 = Enables stretching on SLP_S4# in conjunction with SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable (bit 3) and the Minimum Assertion Width (bits 5:4) 1 = Disables stretching on SLP_S4# regardless of the state of the SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable (bit 3). This bit is cleared by the RTCRST# pin. NOTE: This field is RO when the SLP_Sx# Stretching Policy Lock- Down bit is set. 452 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description SLP_S3# Minimum Assertion Width: This 2-bit value indicates the minimum assertion width of the SLP_S3# signal to ensure that the Main power supplies have been fully power-cycled. 11:10 (Corporate Only) Valid Settings are: 00 = 60–100 us 01 = 1–1.2 ms 10 = 50–50.2 ms 11 = 2–2.0002 s This bit is cleared by the RSMRST# pin. NOTE: This field is RO when the SLP_Sx# Stretching Policy Lock-Down bit is set. 14:10 (Consumer Only) 9 Reserved General Reset Status (GEN_RST_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set by hardware whenever PLTRST# asserts for any reason other than going into a softwareentered sleep state (via PM1CNT.SLP_EN write) or a suspend well power failure (RSMRST# pin assertion). BIOS is expected to consult and then write a ‘1’ to clear this bit during the boot flow before determining what action to take based on PM1_STS.WAK_STS = 1. If GEN_RST_STS = ‘1’, the cold reset boot path should be followed rather than the resume path, regardless of the setting of WAK_STS. This bit is cleared by the RSMRST# pin. S4_STATE# Pin Disable — R/W. 8 0 = The traditional SLP_S4# signal (without Intel Management Engine Overrides) is driven on the S4_STATE# Pin. GPIO26 defaults to its native functionality, S4_STATE#. 1 = The S4_STATE# pin functionality is disabled. The pin is configured as GPIO26, default as an output. NOTE: This bit is cleared by RTCRST#. This bit acts as an override for GPIO_USE_SEL[26]. SWSMI_RATE_SEL — R/W. This field indicates when the SWSMI timer will time out. Valid values are: 7:6 00 = 1.5 ms ± 0.6 ms 01 = 16 ms ± 4 ms 10 = 32 ms ± 4 ms 11 = 64 ms ± 4 ms These bits are not cleared by any type of reset except RTCRST#. SLP_S4# Minimum Assertion Width — R/W. This field indicates the minimum assertion width of the SLP_S4# signal to ensure that the DRAMs have been safely power-cycled. Valid values are: 5:4 11 10 01 00 = = = = 1 2 3 4 to to to to 2 3 4 5 seconds seconds seconds seconds This value is used in two ways: 1. If the SLP_S4# assertion width is ever shorter than this time, a status bit is set for BIOS to read when S0 is entered. 2. If enabled by bit 3 in this register, the hardware will prevent the SLP_S4# signal from deasserting within this minimum time period after asserting. RTCRST# forces this field to the conservative default state (00b). NOTE: This field is RO when the SLP_S4# Stretching Policy Lock-Down bit is set. Datasheet 453 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable — R/W. 3 0 = The SLP_S4# minimum assertion time is 1 to 2 RTCCLK. 1 = The SLP_S4# signal minimally assert for the time specified in bits 5:4 of this register. This bit is cleared by RTCRST#. NOTE: This bit is RO when the SLP_S4# Stretching Policy Lock-Down bit is set. 2 1 (Corporate Only) RTC Power Status (RTC_PWR_STS) — R/W. This bit is set when RTCRST# indicates a weak or missing battery. The bit is not cleared by any type of reset. The bit will remain set until the software clears it by writing a 0 back to this bit position. Power Failure (PWR_FLR) — R/WC. This bit is in the SUS well, and defaults to a ‘1’ based on RSMRST# assertion (not cleared by any type of reset). 0 = Indicates that the trickle current has not failed since the last time the bit was cleared. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Indicates that the trickle current (from the main battery or trickle supply) was removed or failed. Power Failure (PWR_FLR) — R/WC. This bit is in the RTC well, and is not cleared by any type of reset except RTCRST#. 1 (Consumer Only) 0 = Indicates that the trickle current has not failed since the last time the bit was cleared. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Indicates that the trickle current (from the main battery or trickle supply) was removed or failed. NOTE: Clearing CMOS in an ICH-based platform can be done by using a jumper on RTCRST# or GPI, or using SAFEMODE strap. Implementations should not attempt to clear CMOS by using a jumper to pull VccRTC low. AFTERG3_EN — R/W. This bit determines what state to go to when power is reapplied after a power failure (G3 state). 0 (Corporate Only) 0 = System will return to S0 state (boot) after power is re-applied. 1 = System will return to the S5 state (except if it was in S4, in which case it will return to S4). In the S5 state, the only enabled wake event is the Power Button or any enabled wake event that was preserved through the power failure. This bit is cleared by RTCRST#. AFTERG3_EN — R/W. This bit determines what state to go to when power is reapplied after a power failure (G3 state). This bit is in the RTC well and is only cleared by writes of 06h or 0Eh to CF9h (when the CF9h global reset bit is clear), receiving hard reset command with or without power cycle from SMBus or RTCRST#. 0 (Consumer Only) 0 = System will return to S0 state (boot) after power is re-applied. 1 = System will return to the S5 state (except if it was in S4, in which case it will return to S4). In the S5 state, the only enabled wake event is the Power Button or any enabled wake event that was preserved through the power failure. NOTE: This bit is set any time a Power Button Override occurs (i.e., the power button is pressed for at least 4 consecutive seconds), due to the corresponding bit in the SMBus unconditional power down message, due to an internal thermal sensor catastrophic condition and the assertion of THRMTRIP#. NOTE: RSMRST# is sampled using the RTC clock. Therefore, low times that are less than one RTC clock period may not be detected by the ICH10. 454 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.4 GEN_PMCON_LOCK- General Power Management Configuration Lock Register Offset Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: A6h 00h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: RO, R/WLO 8-bit ACPI Bit Description 7 Unlocked C-State Transition — RO. This bit is set by hardware when a processor power state (C-State) transition deeper than C2 occurs and the CSTATE_CONFIG_LOCK bit is not set. This bit is cleared by PLTRST# and is not writable by software. 6:3 2 Reserved SLP_S4# Stretching Policy Lock-Down — R/WLO. When set to 1, this bit locks down the SLP_S4# Minimum Assertion Width, the SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable (Corporate Only), the Disable SLP_S4# Stretching after G3 (Corporate Only) and SLP_S4# Assertion Stretch Enable (Consumer Only) bits in the GEN_PMCON_3 register, making them read-only. This bit becomes locked when a value of 1b is written to it. Writes of 0 to this bit are always ignored. This bit is cleared by platform reset. 1 ACPI_BASE_LOCK — R/WLO. When set to 1, this bit locks down the ACPI Base Address Register (ABASE) at offset 40h. The Base Address Field becomes readonly. This bit becomes locked when a value of 1b is written to it. Writes of 0 to this bit are always ignored. Once locked by writing 1, the only way to clear this bit is to perform a platform reset. C-STATE_CONFIG_LOCK — R/WLO. When set to 1, this bit locks down the C-State configuration parameters. The following configuration bits become read-only when this bit is set: • IA64_EN (GEN_PMCON_1, bit 6) • C4_DISABLE (GEN_PMCON_1, bit 12) 0 • CPU_PLL_LOCK_TIME (GEN_PMCON_2, bits 6:5) • The entire C4 Timing Control Register (C4_TIMING_CNT) This bit becomes locked when a value of 1b is written to it. Writes of 0 to this bit are always ignored. Once locked by writing 1, the only way to clear this bit is to perform a platform reset. C Datasheet 455 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.5 Cx-STATE_CNF—Cx State Configuration Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: A9h 00h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit ACPI, Legacy This register is used to enable C-state related modes. Bit 7 6:5 Description SCRATCHPAD (SP) — R/W. Reserved Popdown Mode Enable (PDME) — R/W. This bit is used in conjunction with the PUME bit (D31:F0:A9h, bit 3). If PUME is 0, then this bit must also be 0. 4 0 = The ICH10 will not attempt to automatically return to a previous C3 or C4 state. 1 = When this bit is a 1 and ICH10 observes that there are no bus master requests, it can return to a previous C3 or C4 state. NOTE: This bit is separate from the PUME bit to cover cases where latency issues permit POPUP but not POPDOWN. Popup Mode Enable (PUME) — R/W. When this bit is a 0, the ICH10 behaves like ICH5, in that bus master traffic is a break event, and it will return from C3/C4 to C0 based on a break event. See Chapter 5.13.5 for additional details on this mode. 3 0 = The ICH10 will treat Bus master traffic a break event, and will return from C3/C4 to C0 based on a break event. 1 = When this bit is a 1 and ICH10 observes a bus master request, it will take the system from a C3 or C4 state to a C2 state and auto enable bus masters. This will let snoops and memory access occur. Report Zero for BM_STS (BM_STS_ZERO_EN) — R/W. 2 1:0 456 0 = The ICH10 sets BM_STS (PMBASE + 00h, bit 4) if there is bus master activity from PCI, PCI Express* and internal bus masters. 1 = When this bit is a 1, ICH10 will not set the BM_STS if there is bus master activity from PCI, PCI Express and internal bus masters. NOTES: 1. If the BM_STS bit is already set when the BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit is set, the BM_STS bit will remain set. Software will still need to clear the BM_STS bit. 2. It is expected that if the PUME bit (this register, bit 3) is set, the BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit should also be set. 3. BM_STS will be set by LPC DMA or LPC masters, even if BM_STS_ZERO_EN is set. Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.6 C4-TIMING_CNT—C4 Timing Control Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: AAh 00h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit ACPI, Legacy This register is used to enable C-state related modes. Bit Description 7 Reserved 6 Slow-C4 Exit Enable —When 1, this bit enables the Slow-C4 Exit functionality. 5:4 Reserved DPRSLPVR to STPCPU — R/W. This field selects the amount of time that the ICH10 waits for from the deassertion of DPRSLPVR to the deassertion of STP_CPU#. This provides a programmable time for the processor’s voltage to stabilize when exiting from a C4 state. This thus changes the value for t266a. 3:2 Bits t266amin t266amax 00b 95 µs 101 µs 01b 22 µs 28 µs Value used for “Fast” VRMs 10b 34 µs 40 µs Value used for “Fast” VRMs 11b Comment Default Reserved DPSLP-TO-MCH Message— R/W. This field selects the DPSLP# deassertion to (G)MCH message time (t270). Normally this value is determined by the CPU_PLL_LOCK_TIME field in the GEN_PMCON_2 register. When this field is non-zero, then the values in this register have higher priority. It is software’s responsibility to program these fields in a consistent manner. 1:0 Datasheet Bits t270 00b Use value is CPU_PLL_LOCK_TIME field (default is 30 µs) 01b 20 µs 10b 15 µs 11b 10 µs 457 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.7 BM_BREAK_EN Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: ABh 00h No Core Bit Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit ACPI, Legacy Description STORAGE_BREAK_EN — R/W. 7 0 = Serial ATA traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = Serial ATA traffic acts as a break event, even if the BM_STS-ZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. Serial ATA master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. PCIE_BREAK_EN — R/W. 6 0 = PCI Express* traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = PCI Express traffic acts as a break event, even if the BM_STS-ZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. PCI Express master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. PCI_BREAK_EN — R/W. 5 4:3 0 = PCI traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = PCI traffic acts as a break event, even if the BM_STS-ZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. PCI master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. Reserved EHCI_BREAK_EN — R/W. 2 0 = EHCI traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = EHCI traffic acts as a break event, even if the BM_STS-ZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. EHCI master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. UHCI_BREAK_EN — R/W. 1 0 = UHCI traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = USB traffic from any of the internal UHCIs acts as a break event, even if the BM_STS-ZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. UHCI master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. HDA_BREAK_EN — R/W. 0 458 0 = Intel® High Definition Audio traffic will not act as a break event. 1 = Intel High Definition Audio traffic acts as a break event, even if the BM_STSZERO_EN and POPUP_EN bits are set. Intel High Definition Audio master activity will cause BM_STS to be set and will cause a break from C3/C4. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.1.8 PMIR—Power Management Initialization Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: ACh Default Value: 00000000h Attribute: Size: R/W 32-bit 0 Bit 31 Description CF9h Lockdown (CF9LOCK): When set, this bit locks the bits in this register into their current value. This register is reset by a CF9h reset. 30 29:21 20 19:15 14 13:10 13.8.1.9 PMIR Field 2 — R/W. BIOS must program this bit to 1b. Reserved CF9h Global Reset (CF9GR)— R/W. When set, a CF9h write of 6h or Eh will cause a Global reset of both the Host and Intel ME partitions. If this bit is cleared, a CF9h write of 6h or Eh will only reset the host partition. This bit field is not reset by a CF9h reset. Reserved Intel® AT Host Reset Trigger Enable - R/W. When set this bit enables bits [1:0] in the CIR11 register. Reserved 9:8 PMIR Field 0 — R/W. BIOS must program these bits to 11b. 7:0 Reserved GPIO_ROUT—GPIO Routing Control Register (PM—D31:F0) Offset Address: B8h – BBh Default Value: 00000000h Lockable: No Bit 31:30 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Resume Description GPIO15 Route — R/W. See bits 1:0 for description. Same pattern for GPIO14 through GPIO3 5:4 GPIO2 Route — R/W. See bits 1:0 for description. 3:2 GPIO1 Route — R/W. See bits 1:0 for description. GPIO0 Route — R/W. GPIO[15:0] can be routed to cause an SMI or SCI when the GPIO[n]_STS bit is set. If the GPIO0 is not set to an input, this field has no effect. 1:0 If the system is in an S1–S5 state and if the GPE0_EN bit is also set, then the GPIO can cause a Wake event, even if the GPIO is NOT routed to cause an SMI# or SCI. 00 = No effect. 01 = SMI# (if corresponding ALT_GPI_SMI_EN bit is also set) 10 = SCI (if corresponding GPE0_EN bit is also set) 11 = Reserved Note: Datasheet GPIOs that are not implemented will not have the corresponding bits implemented in this register. 459 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.2 APM I/O Decode Table 13-10 shows the I/O registers associated with APM support. This register space is enabled in the PCI Device 31: Function 0 space (APMDEC_EN), and cannot be moved (fixed I/O location). Table 13-10. APM Register Map 13.8.2.1 Address Mnemonic B2h APM_CNT B3h APM_STS B2h 00h No Core Bit 7:0 Type Advanced Power Management Control Port 00h R/W Advanced Power Management Status Port 00h R/W Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit Legacy Only Description Used to pass an APM command between the OS and the SMI handler. Writes to this port not only store data in the APMC register, but also generates an SMI# when the APMC_EN bit is set. APM_STS—Advanced Power Management Status Port Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: Bit 7:0 460 Default APM_CNT—Advanced Power Management Control Port Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: 13.8.2.2 Register Name B3h 00h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit Legacy Only Description Used to pass data between the OS and the SMI handler. Basically, this is a scratchpad register and is not affected by any other register or function (other than a PCI reset). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3 Power Management I/O Registers Table 13-11 shows the registers associated with ACPI and Legacy power management support. These registers are enabled in the PCI Device 31: Function 0 space (PM_IO_EN), and can be moved to any I/O location (128-byte aligned). The registers are defined to support the ACPI 3.0a specification, and use the same bit names. Note: All reserved bits and registers will always return 0 when read, and will have no effect when written. Table 13-11. ACPI and Legacy I/O Register Map PMBASE + Offset Mnemonic 00h–01h PM1_STS 02h–03h PM1_EN Register Name ACPI Pointer Default Type PM1 Status PM1a_EVT_BLK 0000h R/WC PM1 Enable PM1a_EVT_BLK+2 0000h R/W PM1a_CNT_BLK 00000000h R/W, WO PMTMR_BLK xx000000h RO — — — P_BLK 00000000h R/W, RO, WO 04h–07h PM1_CNT PM1 Control 08h–0Bh PM1_TMR PM1 Timer 0Ch–0Fh — Reserved 10h–13h PROC_CNT Processor Control 14h LV2 Level 2 P_BLK+4 00h RO 15h LV3 Level 3 P_BLK+5 00h RO Level 4 RO 16h LV4 P_BLK+6 00h 17h–18h — Reserved — — — 19h–1Fh — Reserved — — — 20-27h GPE0_STS General Purpose Event 0 Status GPE0_BLK 00000000h R/WC 28-2Fh GPE0_EN General Purpose Event 0 Enables GPE0_BLK+8 00000000h R/W 00000000h (Consumer); 00000002h (Corporate) R/W, WO, R/WO 30h–33h SMI_EN SMI# Control and Enable 34h–37h SMI_STS 00000000h R/WC, RO 38h–39h ALT_GP_SMI_EN Alternate GPI SMI Enable 0000h R/W 3Ah–3Bh ALT_GP_SMI_ST S Alternate GPI SMI Status 0000h R/WC 3Ch UPRWC USB Per-Port Registers Write Control 0000h R/WC, RO, R/WO 3Dh–41h — — — 00h RO, R/W 42h GPE_CNTL 43h — 44h–45h DEVACT_STS 46h–4Fh — 50h PM2_CNT SMI Status Reserved — General Purpose Event Control Reserved — — — 0000h R/WC PM2a_CNT_BLK 00h R/W — 00000000h RO Device Activity Status Reserved PM2 Control 51h-53h — 54h–57h C3_RES 58h-5Bh — Reserved 5Ch–5Fh — Reserved — — — 60h–7Fh — Reserved for TCO — — — Datasheet Reserved C3-Residency Register 461 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.1 PM1_STS—Power Management 1 Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE + 00h (ACPI PM1a_EVT_BLK) 0000h No Bits 0–7: Core, Bits 8–15: Resume, except Bit 11 in RTC Attribute: Size: Usage: R/WC 16-bit ACPI or Legacy If bit 10 or 8 in this register is set, and the corresponding _EN bit is set in the PM1_EN register, then the ICH10 will generate a Wake Event. Once back in an S0 state (or if already in an S0 state when the event occurs), the ICH10 will also generate an SCI if the SCI_EN bit is set, or an SMI# if the SCI_EN bit is not set. Note: Bit 5 does not cause an SMI# or a wake event. Bit 0 does not cause a wake event but can cause an SMI# or SCI. Bit Description Wake Status (WAK_STS) — R/WC. This bit is not affected by hard resets caused by a CF9 write, but is reset by RSMRST#. 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by hardware when the system is in one of the sleep states (via the SLP_EN bit) and an enabled wake event occurs. Upon setting this bit, the ICH10 will transition the system to the ON state. 15 If the AFTERG3_EN bit is not set and a power failure occurs without the SLP_EN bit set, the system will return to an S0 state when power returns, and the WAK_STS bit will not be set. If the AFTERG3_EN bit is set and a power failure occurs without the SLP_EN bit having been set, the system will go into an S5 state when power returns, and a subsequent wake event will cause the WAK_STS bit to be set. Note that any subsequent wake event would have to be caused by either a Power Button press, or an enabled wake event that was preserved through the power failure (enable bit in the RTC well). PCI Express Wake Status (PCIEXPWAK_STS) — R/WC. 14 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. If the WAKE# pin is still active during the write or the PME message received indication has not been cleared in the root port, then the bit will remain active (i.e. all inputs to this bit are levelsensitive). 1 = This bit is set by hardware to indicate that the system woke due to a PCI Express wakeup event. This wakeup event can be caused by the PCI Express WAKE# pin being active or receipt of a PCI Express PME message at a root port. This bit is set only when one of these events causes the system to transition from a non-S0 system power state to the S0 system power state. This bit is set independent of the state of the PCIEXP_WAKE_DIS bit. Note: This bit does not itself cause a wake event or prevent entry to a sleeping state. Thus if the bit is 1 and the system is put into a sleeping state, the system will not automatically wake. 13:12 462 Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Power Button Override Status (PWRBTNOR_STS) — R/WC. 11 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = This bit is set any time a Power Button Override occurs (i.e., the power button is pressed for at least 4 consecutive seconds), due to the corresponding bit in the SMBus slave message, Intel ME Initiated Power Button Override, Intel ME Initiated Host Reset with Power down or due to an internal thermal sensor catastrophic condition. The power button override causes an unconditional transition to the S5 state, as well as sets the AFTERG3_EN bit. The BIOS or SCI handler clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. This bit is not affected by hard resets via CF9h writes, and is not reset by RSMRST#. Thus, this bit is preserved through power failures. Note that if this bit is still asserted when the global SCI_EN is set then an SCI will be generated. RTC Status (RTC_STS) — R/WC. This bit is not affected by hard resets caused by a CF9 write, but is reset by RSMRST#. 10 9 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by hardware when the RTC generates an alarm (assertion of the IRQ8# signal). Additionally if the RTC_EN bit (PMBASE + 02h, bit 10) is set, the setting of the RTC_STS bit will generate a wake event. ME_STS — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Non-Maskable wake event, and is not affected by any other enable bit. When this bit is set, the Host Power Management logic wakes to S0. This bit is only set by hardware and can only be reset by writing a one to this bit position. This bit is not affected by hard resets caused by a CF9 write, but is reset by RSMRST#. Power Button Status (PWRBTN__STS) — R/WC. This bit is not affected by hard resets caused by a CF9 write. 0 = If the PWRBTN# signal is held low for more than 4 seconds, the hardware clears the PWRBTN_STS bit, sets the PWRBTNOR_STS bit, and the system transitions to the S5 state with only PWRBTN# enabled as a wake event. 8 This bit can be cleared by software by writing a one to the bit position. 1 = This bit is set by hardware when the PWRBTN# signal is asserted Low, independent of any other enable bit. In the S0 state, while PWRBTN_EN and PWRBTN_STS are both set, an SCI (or SMI# if SCI_EN is not set) will be generated. In any sleeping state S1–S5, while PWRBTN_EN (PMBASE + 02h, bit 8) and PWRBTN_STS are both set, a wake event is generated. NOTE: If the PWRBTN_STS bit is cleared by software while the PWRBTN# signal is sell asserted, this will not cause the PWRBN_STS bit to be set. The PWRBTN# signal must go inactive and active again to set the PWRBTN_STS bit. 7:6 Reserved Global Status (GBL _STS) — R/WC. 5 Datasheet 0 = The SCI handler should then clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. 1 = Set when an SCI is generated due to BIOS wanting the attention of the SCI handler. BIOS has a corresponding bit, BIOS_RLS, which will cause an SCI and set this bit. 463 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Bus Master Status (BM_STS) — R/WC. This bit will not cause a wake event, SCI or SMI#. 4 3:1 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by the ICH10 when a bus master requests access to main memory. Bus master activity is detected by any of the PCI Requests being active, any internal bus master request being active, or REQ-C2 message received while in C3 or C4 state. NOTE: 1. If the BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit is set, then this bit will generally report as a 0. LPC DMA and bus master activity will always set the BM_STS bit, even if the BM_STS_ZERO_EN bit is set. Reserved Timer Overflow Status (TMROF_STS) — R/WC. 0 464 0 = The SCI or SMI# handler clears this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. 1 = This bit gets set any time bit 22 of the 24-bit timer goes high (bits are numbered from 0 to 23). This will occur every 2.3435 seconds. When the TMROF_EN bit (PMBASE + 02h, bit 0) is set, then the setting of the TMROF_STS bit will additionally generate an SCI or SMI# (depending on the SCI_EN). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.2 PM1_EN—Power Management 1 Enable Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE + 02h (ACPI PM1a_EVT_BLK + 2) Attribute: 0000h Size: No Usage: Bits 0–7: Core, Bits 8–9, 11–15: Resume, Bit 10: RTC Bit 15 R/W 16-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Reserved PCI Express* Wake Disable(PCIEXPWAK_DIS) — R/W. Modification of this bit has no impact on the value of the PCIEXP_WAKE_STS bit. 14 13:11 0 = Inputs to the PCIEXP_WAKE_STS bit in the PM1 Status register enabled to wake the system. 1 = Inputs to the PCIEXP_WAKE_STS bit in the PM1 Status register disabled from waking the system. Reserved RTC Event Enable (RTC_EN) — R/W. This bit is in the RTC well to allow an RTC event to wake after a power failure. This bit is not cleared by any reset other than RTCRST# or a Power Button Override event. 10 9 8 0 = No SCI (or SMI#) or wake event is generated then RTC_STS (PMBASE + 00h, bit 10) goes active. 1 = An SCI (or SMI#) or wake event will occur when this bit is set and the RTC_STS bit goes active. Reserved. Power Button Enable (PWRBTN_EN) — R/W. This bit is used to enable the setting of the PWRBTN_STS bit to generate a power management event (SMI#, SCI). PWRBTN_EN has no effect on the PWRBTN_STS bit (PMBASE + 00h, bit 8) being set by the assertion of the power button. The Power Button is always enabled as a Wake event. 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable. 7:6 5 4:1 Reserved. Global Enable (GBL_EN) — R/W. When both the GBL_EN and the GBL_STS bit (PMBASE + 00h, bit 5) are set, an SCI is raised. 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable SCI on GBL_STS going active. Reserved. Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable (TMROF_EN) — R/W. Works in conjunction with the SCI_EN bit (PMBASE + 04h, bit 0) as described below: 0 Datasheet TMROF_EN SCI_EN Effect when TMROF_STS is set 0 X No SMI# or SCI 1 0 SMI# 1 1 SCI 465 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.3 PM1_CNT—Power Management 1 Control I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE + 04h (ACPI PM1a_CNT_BLK) 00000000h No Bits 0–7: Core, Bits 8–12: RTC, Bits 13–15: Resume Bit 31:14 13 Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W, WO 32-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Reserved. Sleep Enable (SLP_EN) — WO. Setting this bit causes the system to sequence into the Sleep state defined by the SLP_TYP field. Sleep Type (SLP_TYP) — R/W. This 3-bit field defines the type of Sleep the system should enter when the SLP_EN bit is set to 1. These bits are only reset by RTCRST#. 12:10 9:3 Code Master Interrupt 000b ON: Typically maps to S0 state. 001b Asserts STPCLK#. Puts processor in Stop-Grant state. Optional to assert CPUSLP# to put processor in sleep state: Typically maps to S1 state. 010b Reserved 011b Reserved 100b Reserved 101b Suspend-To-RAM. Assert SLP_S3#: Typically maps to S3 state. 110b Suspend-To-Disk. Assert SLP_S3#, and SLP_S4#: Typically maps to S4 state. 111b Soft Off. Assert SLP_S3#, SLP_S4#, and SLP_S5#: Typically maps to S5 state. Reserved. Global Release (GBL_RLS) — WO. 2 0 = This bit always reads as 0. 1 = ACPI software writes a 1 to this bit to raise an event to the BIOS. BIOS software has a corresponding enable and status bits to control its ability to receive ACPI events. Bus Master Reload (BM_RLD) — R/W. This bit is treated as a scratchpad bit. This bit is reset to 0 by PLTRST# 1 0 = Bus master requests will not cause a break from the C3 state. 1 = Enables Bus Master requests (internal or external) to cause a break from the C3 state. If software fails to set this bit before going to C3 state, ICH10 will still return to a snoopable state from C3 or C4 states due to bus master activity. 0 SCI Enable (SCI_EN) — R/W. Selects the SCI interrupt or the SMI# interrupt for various events including the bits in the PM1_STS register (bit 10, 8, 0), and bits in GPE0_STS. 0 = These events will generate an SMI#. 1 = These events will generate an SCI. 466 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.4 PM1_TMR—Power Management 1 Timer Register I/O Address: PMBASE + 08h (ACPI PMTMR_BLK) Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: xx000000h No Core Bit 31:24 23:0 Attribute: Size: Usage: RO 32-bit ACPI Description Reserved Timer Value (TMR_VAL) — RO. Returns the running count of the PM timer. This counter runs off a 3.579545 MHz clock (14.31818 MHz divided by 4). It is reset to 0 during a PCI reset, and then continues counting as long as the system is in the S0 state. After an S1 state, the counter will not be reset (it will continue counting from the last value in S0 state. Anytime bit 22 of the timer goes HIGH to LOW (bits referenced from 0 to 23), the TMROF_STS bit (PMBASE + 00h, bit 0) is set. The High-to-Low transition will occur every 2.3435 seconds. If the TMROF_EN bit (PMBASE + 02h, bit 0) is set, an SCI interrupt is also generated. 13.8.3.5 PROC_CNT—Processor Control Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: Bit 31:18 PMBASE + 10h (ACPI P_BLK) Attribute: 00000000h Size: No (bits 7:5 are write once)Usage: Core R/W, RO, WO 32-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Reserved Throttle Status (THTL_STS) — RO. 17 16:9 0 = No clock throttling is occurring (maximum processor performance). 1 = Indicates that the clock state machine is throttling the processor performance. This could be due to the THT_EN bit or the FORCE_THTL bit being set. Reserved Force Thermal Throttling (FORCE_THTL) — R/W. Software can set this bit to force the thermal throttling function. 8 Datasheet 0 = No forced throttling. 1 = Throttling at the duty cycle specified in THRM_DTY starts immediately, and no SMI# is generated. 467 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description THRM_DTY — WO. This write-once field determines the duty cycle of the throttling when the FORCE_THTL bit is set. The duty cycle indicates the approximate percentage of time the STPCLK# signal is asserted while in the throttle mode. The STPCLK# throttle period is 1024 PCICLKs. Note that the throttling only occurs if the system is in the C0 state. If in the C2, C3, or C4 state, no throttling occurs. Once the THRM_DTY field is written, any subsequent writes will have no effect until PLTRST# goes active. 7:5 4 THRM_DTY Throttle Mode PCI Clocks 000b 50% (Default) 512 001b 87.5% 896 010b 75.0% 768 011b 62.5% 640 100b 50% 512 101b 37.5% 384 110b 25% 256 111b 12.5% 128 THTL_EN — R/W. When set and the system is in a C0 state, it enables a processorcontrolled STPCLK# throttling. The duty cycle is selected in the THTL_DTY field. 0 = Disable 1 = Enable THTL_DTY — R/W. This field determines the duty cycle of the throttling when the THTL_EN bit is set. The duty cycle indicates the approximate percentage of time the STPCLK# signal is asserted (low) while in the throttle mode. The STPCLK# throttle period is 1024 PCICLKs. 3:1 0 468 THTL_DTY Throttle Mode PCI Clocks 000b 50% (Default) 512 001b 87.5% 896 010b 75.0% 768 011b 62.5% 640 100b 50% 512 101b 37.5% 384 110b 25% 256 111b 12.5% 128 Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.6 LV2 — Level 2 Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE + 14h (ACPI P_BLK+4) 00h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: RO 8-bit ACPI or Legacy Bit Description 7:0 Reads to this register return all 0s, writes to this register have no effect. Reads to this register generate a “enter a level 2 power state” (C2) to the clock control logic. This will cause the STPCLK# signal to go active, and stay active until a break event occurs. Throttling (due either to THTL_EN or FORCE_THTL) will be ignored. NOTE: This register should not be used by IA-64 processors or systems with more than 1 logical processor, unless appropriate semaphoring software has been put in place to ensure that all threads/processors are ready for the C2 state when the read to this register occurs 13.8.3.7 LV3—Level 3 Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: PMBASE + 15h (ACPI P_BLK + 5) Attribute: 00h Size: No Usage: Power Well: Bit 7:0 RO 8-bit ACPI or Legacy Core Description Reads to this register return all 0s, writes to this register have no effect. Reads to this register generate a “enter a C3 power state” to the clock control logic. The C3 state persists until a break event occurs. NOTE: If the C4onC3_EN bit is set, reads this register will initiate a LVL4 transition rather than a LVL3 transition. In the event that software attempts to simultaneously read the LVL2 and LVL3 registers (which is invalid), the ICH10 will ignore the LVL3 read, and only perform a C2 transition. NOTE: This register should not be used by IA-64 processors or systems with more than 1 logical processor, unless appropriate semaphoring software has been put in place to ensure that all threads/processors are ready for the C3 state when the read to this register occurs. 13.8.3.8 LV4—Level 4 Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 7:0 PMBASE + 16h (ACPI P_BLK + 6) Attribute: 00h Size: No Usage: Power Well: RO 8-bit ACPI or Legacy Core Description Reads to this register return all 0s, writes to this register have no effect. Reads to this register generate a “enter a C4 power state” to the clock control logic. The C4 state persists until a break event occurs. NOTE: This register should not be used by IA-64 processors or systems with more than 1 logical processor, unless appropriate semaphoring software has been put in place to ensure that all threads/processors are ready for the C4 state when the read to this register occurs. Datasheet 469 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.9 GPE0_STS—General Purpose Event 0 Status Register I/O Address: PMBASE + 20h (ACPI GPE0_BLK) Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: 0000000000000000h No Resume Attribute: Size: Usage: Bits 0:32 R/WC Bits 33:63 RO 64-bit ACPI This register is symmetrical to the General Purpose Event 0 Enable Register. Unless indicated otherwise below, if the corresponding _EN bit is set, then when the _STS bit get set, the ICH10 will generate a Wake Event. Once back in an S0 state (or if already in an S0 state when the event occurs), the ICH10 will also generate an SCI if the SCI_EN bit is set, or an SMI# if the SCI_EN bit (PMBASE + 04h, bit 0) is not set. Bits 31:16 are reset by a CF9h write; bits 63:32 and 15:0 are not. All are reset by RSMRST#. Bit 63:33 Description Reserved. USB6_STS — R/WC. 32 0 = Disable. 1 = Set by hardware and can be reset by writing a one to this bit position or a resume well reset. This bit is set when USB UHCI controller #6 needs to cause a wake. Additionally if the USB6_EN bit is set, the setting of the USB6_STS bit will generate a wake event. GPIOn_STS — R/WC. 31:16 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = These bits are set any time the corresponding GPIO is set up as an input and the corresponding GPIO signal is high (or low if the corresponding GP_INV bit is set). If the corresponding enable bit is set in the GPE0_EN register, then when the GPIO[n]_STS bit is set: • If the system is in an S1–S5 state, the event will also wake the system. • If the system is in an S0 state (or upon waking back to an S0 state), a SCI will be caused depending on the GPIO_ROUT bits (D31:F0:B8h, bits 31:30) for the corresponding GPI. NOTE: Mapping is as follows: bit 31 corresponds to GPIO[15]... and bit 16 corresponds to GPIO[0]. 15 Reserved USB4_STS — R/WC. 14 470 0 = Disable. 1 = Set by hardware and can be reset by writing a one to this bit position or a resume well reset. This bit is set when USB UHCI controller #4 needs to cause a wake. Additionally if the USB4_EN bit is set, the setting of the USB4_STS bit will generate a wake event. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit 13 Description PME_B0_STS — R/WC. This bit will be set to 1 by the ICH10 when any internal device with PCI Power Management capabilities on bus 0 asserts the equivalent of the PME# signal. Additionally, if the PME_B0_EN bit is set, and the system is in an S0 state, then the setting of the PME_B0_STS bit will generate an SCI (or SMI# if SCI_EN is not set). If the PME_B0_STS bit is set, and the system is in an S1–S4 state (or S5 state due to SLP_TYP and SLP_EN), then the setting of the PME_B0_STS bit will generate a wake event, and an SCI (or SMI# if SCI_EN is not set) will be generated. If the system is in an S5 state due to power button override, then the PME_B0_STS bit will not cause a wake event or SCI. The default for this bit is 0. Writing a 1 to this bit position clears this bit. Note: HD audio wake events are reported in this bit. Intel Management Engine “maskable” wake events are also reported in this bit. USB3_STS — R/WC. 12 0 = Disable. 1 = Set by hardware and can be reset by writing a one to this bit position or a resume well reset. This bit is set when USB UHCI controller #3 needs to cause a wake. Additionally if the USB3_EN bit is set, the setting of the USB3_STS bit will generate a wake event. PME_STS — R/WC. 11 10 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by hardware when the PME# signal goes active. Additionally, if the PME_EN bit is set, and the system is in an S0 state, then the setting of the PME_STS bit will generate an SCI or SMI# (if SCI_EN is not set). If the PME_EN bit is set, and the system is in an S1–S4 state (or S5 state due to setting SLP_TYP and SLP_EN), then the setting of the PME_STS bit will generate a wake event, and an SCI will be generated. If the system is in an S5 state due to power button override or a power failure, then PME_STS will not cause a wake event or SCI. Reserved PCI_EXP_STS — R/WC. 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by hardware to indicate that: • The PME event message was received on one or more of the PCI Express* ports • An Assert PMEGPE message received from the (G)MCH via DMI 9 NOTES: 1. The PCI WAKE# pin has no impact on this bit. 2. If the PCI_EXP_STS bit went active due to an Assert PMEGPE message, then a Deassert PMEGPE message must be received prior to the software write in order for the bit to be cleared. 3. If the bit is not cleared and the corresponding PCI_EXP_EN bit is set, the level-triggered SCI will remain active. 4. A race condition exists where the PCI Express device sends another PME message because the PCI Express device was not serviced within the time when it must resend the message. This may result in a spurious interrupt, and this is comprehended and approved by the PCI Express* Specification, Revision 1.0a. The window for this race condition is approximately 95–105 milliseconds. RI_STS — R/WC. 8 Datasheet 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by hardware when the RI# input signal goes active. 471 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description SMBus Wake Status (SMB_WAK_STS) — R/WC. The SMBus controller can independently cause an SMI# or SCI, so this bit does not need to do so (unlike the other bits in this register). Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 0 = Wake event Not caused by the ICH10’s SMBus logic. 1 = Set by hardware to indicate that the wake event was caused by the ICH10’s SMBus logic.This bit will be set by the WAKE/SMI# command type, even if the system is already awake. The SMI handler should then clear this bit. 7 NOTES: 1. The SMBus controller will independently cause an SMI# so this bit does not need to do so (unlike the other bits in this register). 2. This bit is set by the SMBus slave command 01h (Wake/SMI#) even when the system is in the S0 state. Therefore, to avoid an instant wake on subsequent transitions to sleep states, software must clear this bit after each reception of the Wake/SMI# command or just prior to entering the sleep state. 3. (Consumer Only) If SMB_WAK_STS is set due to SMBus slave receiving a message, it will be cleared by internal logic when a THRMTRIP# event happens or a Power Button Override event. However, THRMTRIP# or Power Button Override event will not clear SMB_WAK_STS if it is set due to SMBALERT# signal going active. 4. The SMBALERT_STS bit (D31:F3:I/O Offset 00h:Bit 5) should be cleared by software before the SMB_WAK_STS bit is cleared. TCOSCI_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 6 0 = TOC logic or thermal sensor logic did Not cause SCI. 1 = Set by hardware when the TCO logic or thermal sensor logic causes an SCI. USB5_STS— R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 5 0 = USB UHCI controller 5 does NOT need to cause a wake. 1 = Set by hardware when USB UHCI controller 5 needs to cause a wake. Wake event will be generated if the corresponding USB2_EN bit is set. USB2_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 4 0 = USB UHCI controller 2 does Not need to cause a wake. 1 = Set by hardware when USB UHCI controller 2 needs to cause a wake. Wake event will be generated if the corresponding USB2_EN bit is set. USB1_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 3 2 0 = USB UHCI controller 1 does Not need to cause a wake. 1 = Set by hardware when USB UHCI controller 1 needs to cause a wake. Wake event will be generated if the corresponding USB1_EN bit is set. SWGPE_STS — R/WC. The SWGPE_CTRL bit (bit 1 of GPE_CTRL reg) acts as a level input to this bit. HOT_PLUG_STS — R/WC. 1 0 = This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit position. 1 = When a PCI Express* Hot-Plug event occurs. This will cause an SCI if the HOT_PLUG_EN bit is set in the GEP0_EN register. Thermal Interrupt Status (THRM_STS) — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 0 472 0 = THRM# signal Not driven active as defined by the THRM_POL bit 1 = Set by hardware anytime the THRM# signal is driven active as defined by the THRM_POL bit. Additionally, if the THRM_EN bit is set, then the setting of the THRM_STS bit will also generate a power management event (SCI or SMI#). Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.10 GPE0_EN—General Purpose Event 0 Enables Register I/O Address: PMBASE + 28h (ACPI GPE0_BLK + 8) Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: 0000000000000000h Size: No Usage: Bits 0–7, 9, 12, 14–63 Resume, Bits 8, 10–11, 13 RTC Attribute: Bits 0:32 R/W Bits 33:63 RO 64-bit ACPI This register is symmetrical to the General Purpose Event 0 Status Register. All the bits in this register should be cleared to 0 based on a Power Button Override or processor Thermal Trip event. The resume well bits are all cleared by RSMRST#. The RTC well bits are cleared by RTCRST#. Bit 63:33 Description Reserved. USB6_EN — R/W. 32 31:16 15 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the setting of the USB4_STS bit to generate a wake event. The USB6_STS bit is set anytime USB UHCI controller #6 signals a wake event. Break events are handled via the USB interrupt. GPIn_EN — R/W. These bits enable the corresponding GPI[n]_STS bits being set to cause a SCI, and/or wake event. These bits are cleared by RSMRST#. NOTE: Mapping is as follows: bit 31 corresponds to GPIO15... and bit 16 corresponds to GPIO0. Reserved USB4_EN — R/W. 14 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the setting of the USB4_STS bit to generate a wake event. The USB4_STS bit is set anytime USB UHCI controller #4 signals a wake event. Break events are handled via the USB interrupt. PME_B0_EN — R/W. 13 0 = Disable 1 = Enables the setting of the PME_B0_STS bit to generate a wake event and/or an SCI or SMI#. PME_B0_STS can be a wake event from the S1–S4 states, or from S5 (if entered via SLP_TYP and SLP_EN) or power failure, but not Power Button Override. This bit defaults to 0. NOTE: It is only cleared by Software or RTCRST#. It is not cleared by CF9h writes. USB3_EN — R/W. 12 0 = Disable. 1 = Enable the setting of the USB3_STS bit to generate a wake event. The USB3_STS bit is set anytime USB UHCI controller #3 signals a wake event. Break events are handled via the USB interrupt. PME_EN — R/W. 11 10 Datasheet 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the PME_STS to generate a wake event and/or an SCI. PME# can be a wake event from the S1 – S4 state or from S5 (if entered via SLP_EN, but not power button override). Reserved 473 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description PCI_EXP_EN — R/W. 9 8 7 0 = Disable SCI generation upon PCI_EXP_STS bit being set. 1 = Enables ICH10 to cause an SCI when PCI_EXP_STS bit is set. This is used to allow the PCI Express* ports, including the link to the (G)MCH, to cause an SCI due to wake/PME events. RI_EN — R/W. The value of this bit will be maintained through a G3 state and is not affected by a hard reset caused by a CF9h write. 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the RI_STS to generate a wake event. Reserved TCOSCI_EN — R/W. 6 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the TCOSCI_STS to generate an SCI. USB5_EN — R/W. 5 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the USB5_STS to generate a wake event. USB2_EN — R/W. 4 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the USB2_STS to generate a wake event. USB1_EN — R/W. 3 2 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the setting of the USB1_STS to generate a wake event. SWGPE_EN— R/W. This bit allows software to control the assertion of SWGPE_STS bit. This bit This bit, when set to 1, enables the SW GPE function. If SWGPE_CTRL is written to a 1, hardware will set SWGPE_STS (acts as a level input) If SWGPE_STS, SWGPE_EN, and SCI_EN are all 1s, an SCI will be generated. If SWGPE_STS = 1, SWGPE_EN = 1, SCI_EN = 0, and GBL_SMI_EN = 1 then an SMI# will be generated. HOT_PLUG_EN — R/W. 1 0 = Disables SCI generation upon the HOT_PLUG_STS bit being set. 1 = Enables the ICH10 to cause an SCI when the HOT_PLUG_STS bit is set. This is used to allow the PCI Express ports to cause an SCI due to hot-plug events. THRM_EN — R/W. 0 474 0 = Disable. 1 = Active assertion of the THRM# signal (as defined by the THRM_POL bit) will generate a power management event (SCI or SMI) if the THRM_STS bit is also set. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.11 SMI_EN—SMI Control and Enable Register I/O Address: Default Value: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: Note: PMBASE + 30h 00000000h (Consumer) 00000002h (Corporate) No Core Attribute: Size: R/W, R/WO, WO 32 bit Usage: ACPI or Legacy This register is symmetrical to the SMI status register. Bit 31:28 27 Description Reserved GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI_EN— R/WO. Setting this bit will cause the Intel ICH10 to generate an SMI# when the GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI_STS bit is set in the SMI_STS register. Once written to ‘1’, this bit can only be cleared by PLTRST#. 26:19 Reserved INTEL_USB2_EN — R/W. 18 0 = Disable 1 = Enables Intel-Specific USB2 SMI logic to cause SMI#. LEGACY_USB2_EN — R/W. 17 0 = Disable 1 = Enables legacy USB2 logic to cause SMI#. 16:15 Reserved PERIODIC_EN — R/W. 14 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the ICH10 to generate an SMI# when the PERIODIC_STS bit (PMBASE + 34h, bit 14) is set in the SMI_STS register (PMBASE + 34h). TCO_EN — R/W. 13 0 = Disables TCO logic generating an SMI#. Note that if the NMI2SMI_EN bit is set, SMIs that are caused by re-routed NMIs will not be gated by the TCO_EN bit. Even if the TCO_EN bit is 0, NMIs will still be routed to cause SMIs. 1 = Enables the TCO logic to generate SMI#. NOTE: This bit cannot be written once the TCO_LOCK bit is set. 12 Reserved MCSMI_ENMicrocontroller SMI Enable (MCSMI_EN) — R/W. 11 10:8 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables ICH10 to trap accesses to the microcontroller range (62h or 66h) and generate an SMI#. Note that “trapped’ cycles will be claimed by the ICH10 on PCI, but not forwarded to LPC. Reserved BIOS Release (BIOS_RLS) — WO. 7 Datasheet 0 = This bit will always return 0 on reads. Writes of 0 to this bit have no effect. 1 = Enables the generation of an SCI interrupt for ACPI software when a one is written to this bit position by BIOS software. NOTE: GBL_STS being set will cause an SCI, even if the SCI_EN bit is not set. Software must take great care not to set the BIOS_RLS bit (which causes GBL_STS to be set) if the SCI handler is not in place. 475 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Software SMI# Timer Enable (SWSMI_TMR_EN) — R/W. 6 0 = Disable. Clearing the SWSMI_TMR_EN bit before the timer expires will reset the timer and the SMI# will not be generated. 1 = Starts Software SMI# Timer. When the SWSMI timer expires (the timeout period depends upon the SWSMI_RATE_SEL bit setting), SWSMI_TMR_STS is set and an SMI# is generated. SWSMI_TMR_EN stays set until cleared by software. APMC_EN — R/W. 5 0 = Disable. Writes to the APM_CNT register will not cause an SMI#. 1 = Enables writes to the APM_CNT register to cause an SMI#. SLP_SMI_EN — R/W. 4 0 = Disables the generation of SMI# on SLP_EN. Note that this bit must be 0 before the software attempts to transition the system into a sleep state by writing a 1 to the SLP_EN bit. 1 = A write of 1 to the SLP_EN bit (bit 13 in PM1_CNT register) will generate an SMI#, and the system will not transition to the sleep state based on that write to the SLP_EN bit. LEGACY_USB_EN — R/W. 3 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables legacy USB circuit to cause SMI#. BIOS_EN — R/W. 2 0 = Disable. 1 = Enables the generation of SMI# when ACPI software writes a 1 to the GBL_RLS bit (D31:F0:PMBase + 04h:bit 2). Note that if the BIOS_STS bit (D31:F0:PMBase + 34h:bit 2), which gets set when software writes 1 to GBL_RLS bit, is already a 1 at the time that BIOS_EN becomes 1, an SMI# will be generated when BIOS_EN gets set. End of SMI (EOS) — R/W (special). This bit controls the arbitration of the SMI signal to the processor. This bit must be set for the ICH10 to assert SMI# low to the processor after SMI# has been asserted previously. 1 0 = Once the ICH10 asserts SMI# low, the EOS bit is automatically cleared. 1 = When this bit is set to 1, SMI# signal will be deasserted for 4 PCI clocks before its assertion. In the SMI handler, the processor should clear all pending SMIs (by servicing them and then clearing their respective status bits), set the EOS bit, and exit SMM. This will allow the SMI arbiter to re-assert SMI upon detection of an SMI event and the setting of a SMI status bit. NOTE: ICH10 is able to generate 1st SMI after reset even though EOS bit is not set. Subsequent SMI require EOS bit is set. GBL_SMI_EN — R/W. 0 476 0 = No SMI# will be generated by ICH10. This bit is reset by a PCI reset event. 1 = Enables the generation of SMI# in the system upon any enabled SMI event. NOTE: When the SMI_LOCK bit is set, this bit cannot be changed. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.12 SMI_STS—SMI Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: Note: PMBASE + 34h 00000000h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: RO, R/WC 32-bit ACPI or Legacy If the corresponding _EN bit is set when the _STS bit is set, the ICH10 will cause an SMI# (except bits 8–10 and 12, which do not need enable bits since they are logic ORs of other registers that have enable bits). The ICH10 uses the same GPE0_EN register (I/O address: PMBase+2Ch) to enable/disable both SMI and ACPI SCI general purpose input events. ACPI OS assumes that it owns the entire GPE0_EN register per ACPI spec. Problems arise when some of the general-purpose inputs are enabled as SMI by BIOS, and some of the general purpose inputs are enabled for SCI. In this case ACPI OS turns off the enabled bit for any GPIx input signals that are not indicated as SCI generalpurpose events at boot, and exit from sleeping states. BIOS should define a dummy control method which prevents the ACPI OS from clearing the SMI GPE0_EN bits. Bit 31:28 Description Reserved 27 GPIO_UNLOCK_SMI_STS — R/WC. This bit will be set if the GPIO registers lockdown logic is requesting an SMI#. Writing a 1 to this bit position clears this bit to 0. 26 SPI_STS — RO. This bit will be set if the SPI logic is generating an SMI#. This bit is read only because the sticky status and enable bits associated with this function are located in the SPI registers. 25:22 Reserved 21 MONITOR_STS — RO. This bit will be set if the Trap/SMI logic has caused the SMI. This will occur when the processor or a bus master accesses an assigned register (or a sequence of accesses). See Section 10.1.43 through Section 10.1.49 for details on the specific cause of the SMI. 20 PCI_EXP_SMI_STS — RO. PCI Express* SMI event occurred. This could be due to a PCI Express PME event or Hot-Plug event. 19 18 Reserved INTEL_USB2_STS — RO. This non-sticky read-only bit is a logical OR of each of the SMI status bits in the Intel-Specific USB2 SMI Status Register ANDed with the corresponding enable bits. Additionally, the Port Disable Write Enable SMI is reported in this bit; the specific status bit for this event is contained in the USB Per-Port Registers Write Control Register in this I/O space. This bit will not be active if the enable bits are not set. Writes to this bit will have no effect. All integrated USB2 Host Controllers are represented with this bit. 17 LEGACY_USB2_STS — RO. This non-sticky read-only bit is a logical OR of each of the SMI status bits in the USB2 Legacy Support Register ANDed with the corresponding enable bits. This bit will not be active if the enable bits are not set. Writes to this bit will have no effect. All integrated USB2 Host Controllers are represented with this bit. Datasheet 477 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description SMBus SMI Status (SMBUS_SMI_STS) — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 16 0 = This bit is set from the 64 kHz clock domain used by the SMBus. Software must wait at least 15.63 μs after the initial assertion of this bit before clearing it. 1 = Indicates that the SMI# was caused by: 1. The SMBus Slave receiving a message that an SMI# should be caused, or 2. The SMBALERT# signal goes active and the SMB_SMI_EN bit is set and the SMBALERT_DIS bit is cleared, or 3. The SMBus Slave receiving a Host Notify message and the HOST_NOTIFY_INTREN and the SMB_SMI_EN bits are set, or 4. The ICH10 detecting the SMLINK_SLAVE_SMI command while in the S0 state. SERIRQ_SMI_STS — RO. 15 0 = SMI# was not caused by the SERIRQ decoder. 1 = Indicates that the SMI# was caused by the SERIRQ decoder. NOTE: This is not a sticky bit PERIODIC_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 14 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = This bit is set at the rate determined by the PER_SMI_SEL bits. If the PERIODIC_EN bit (PMBASE + 30h, bit 14) is also set, the ICH10 generates an SMI#. TCO_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 13 0 = SMI# not caused by TCO logic. 1 = Indicates the SMI# was caused by the TCO logic. Note that this is not a wake event. Device Monitor Status (DEVMON_STS) — RO. 12 0 = SMI# not caused by Device Monitor. 1 = Set if bit 0 of the DEVACT_STS register (PMBASE + 44h) is set. The bit is not sticky, so writes to this bit will have no effect. Microcontroller SMI# Status (MCSMI_STS) — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 11 10 0 = Indicates that there has been no access to the power management microcontroller range (62h or 66h). 1 = Set if there has been an access to the power management microcontroller range (62h or 66h) and the Microcontroller Decode Enable #1 bit in the LPC Bridge I/O Enables configuration register is 1 (D31:F0:Offset 82h:bit 11). Note that this implementation assumes that the Microcontroller is on LPC. If this bit is set, and the MCSMI_EN bit is also set, the ICH10 will generate an SMI#. GPE0_STS — RO. This bit is a logical OR of the bits in the ALT_GP_SMI_STS register that are also set up to cause an SMI# (as indicated by the GPI_ROUT registers) and have the corresponding bit set in the ALT_GP_SMI_EN register. Bits that are not routed to cause an SMI# will have no effect on this bit. 0 = SMI# was not generated by a GPI assertion. 1 = SMI# was generated by a GPI assertion. 9 GPE0_STS — RO. This bit is a logical OR of the bits 47:32, 14:10, 8, 6:2 and 0 in the GPE0_STS register (PMBASE + 28h) that also have the corresponding bit set in the GPE0_EN register (PMBASE + 2Ch). 0 = SMI# was not generated by a GPE0 event. 1 = SMI# was generated by a GPE0 event. 478 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit 8 Description PM1_STS_REG — RO. This is an ORs of the bits in the ACPI PM1 Status Register (offset PMBASE+00h) that can cause an SMI#. 0 = SMI# was not generated by a PM1_STS event. 1 = SMI# was generated by a PM1_STS event. 7 Reserved 6 0 = Software SMI# Timer has Not expired. 1 = Set by the hardware when the Software SMI# Timer expires. SWSMI_TMR_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. APM_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 5 0 = No SMI# generated by write access to APM Control register with APMCH_EN bit set. 1 = SMI# was generated by a write access to the APM Control register with the APMC_EN bit set. SLP_SMI_STS — R/WC. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. 4 3 0 = No SMI# caused by write of 1 to SLP_EN bit when SLP_SMI_EN bit is also set. 1 = Indicates an SMI# was caused by a write of 1 to SLP_EN bit when SLP_SMI_EN bit is also set. LEGACY_USB_STS — RO. This bit is a logical OR of each of the SMI status bits in the USB Legacy Keyboard/Mouse Control Registers ANDed with the corresponding enable bits. This bit will not be active if the enable bits are not set. 0 = SMI# was not generated by USB Legacy event. 1 = SMI# was generated by USB Legacy event. BIOS_STS — R/WC. 2 1:0 13.8.3.13 0 = No SMI# generated due to ACPI software requesting attention. 1 = This bit gets set by hardware when a 1 is written by software to the GBL_RLS bit (D31:F0:PMBase + 04h:bit 2). When both the BIOS_EN bit (D31:F0:PMBase + 30h:bit 2) and the BIOS_STS bit are set, an SMI# will be generated. The BIOS_STS bit is cleared when software writes a 1 to its bit position. Reserved ALT_GP_SMI_EN—Alternate GPI SMI Enable Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: Bit PMBASE +38h 0000h No Resume Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 16-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Alternate GPI SMI Enable — R/W. These bits are used to enable the corresponding GPIO to cause an SMI#. For these bits to have any effect, the following must be true. • The corresponding bit in the ALT_GP_SMI_EN register is set. 15:0 • The corresponding GPI must be routed in the GPI_ROUT register to cause an SMI. • The corresponding GPIO must be implemented. NOTE: Mapping is as follows: bit 15 corresponds to GPIO15... bit 0 corresponds to GPIO0. Datasheet 479 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.14 ALT_GP_SMI_STS—Alternate GPI SMI Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE +3Ah 0000h No Resume Bit Attribute: Size: Usage: R/WC 16-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Alternate GPI SMI Status — R/WC. These bits report the status of the corresponding GPIOs. 0 = Inactive. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Active 15:0 These bits are sticky. If the following conditions are true, then an SMI# will be generated and the GPE0_STS bit set: • The corresponding bit in the ALT_GPI_SMI_EN register (PMBASE + 38h) is set • The corresponding GPIO must be routed in the GPI_ROUT register to cause an SMI. • The corresponding GPIO must be implemented. All bits are in the resume well. Default for these bits is dependent on the state of the GPIO pins. 13.8.3.15 UPRWC—USB Per-Port Registers Write Control I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE +3Ch 0000h No Resume Bit 15:9 Attribute: Size: Usage: R/WC, R/W, R/WO 16-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Reserved Write Enable Status — R/WC 8 0 = This bit gets set by hardware when the “Per-Port Registers Write Enable” bit is written from 0-to-1. 1 = This bit is cleared by software writing a 1b to this bit location The setting condition takes precedence over the clearing condition in the event that both occur at once. When this bit is 1b and bit 0 is 1b, the INTEL_USB2_STS bit is set in the SMI_STS register. 7:2 Reserved. 1 Reserved Write Enable SMI Enable— R/WO 0 480 0 = Disable 1 = enables the generation of SMI when the Per-Port Registers Write Enable (bit 1) is written from 0 to 1. Once written to 1b, this bit can not be cleared by software. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.8.3.16 GPE_CNTL— General Purpose Control Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE +42h 00h No Resume Bit 8:2 1 Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit ACPI or Legacy Description Reserved SWGPE_CTRL— R/W. This bit allows software to control the assertion of SWGPE_STS bit. This bit is used by hardware as the level input signal for the SWGPE_STS bit in the GPE0_STS register. When SWGPE_CTRL is 1, SWGPE_STS will be set to 1, and writes to SWGPE_STS with a value of 1 to clear SWGPE_STS will result in SWGPE_STS being set back to 1 by hardware. When SWGPE_CTRL is 0, writes to SWGPE_STS with a value of 1 will clear SWGPE_STS to 0. 0 13.8.3.17 THRM#_POL — R/W. This bit controls the polarity of the THRM# pin needed to set the THRM_STS bit. 0 = Low value on the THRM# signal will set the THRM_STS bit. 1 = HIGH value on the THRM# signal will set the THRM_STS bit. DEVACT_STS — Device Activity Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE +44h 0000h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: R/WC 16-bit Legacy Only Each bit indicates if an access has occurred to the corresponding device’s trap range, or for bits 6:9 if the corresponding PCI interrupt is active. This register is used in conjunction with the Periodic SMI# timer to detect any system activity for legacy power management. The periodic SMI# timer indicates if it is the right time to read the DEVACT_STS register (PMBASE + 44h). Note: Software clears bits that are set in this register by writing a 1 to the bit position. Bit 15:13 Description Reserved KBC_ACT_STS — R/WC. KBC (60/64h). 12 11:10 0 = Indicates that there has been no access to this device’s I/O range. 1 = This device’s I/O range has been accessed. Clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. Reserved PIRQDH_ACT_STS — R/WC. PIRQ[D or H]. 9 0 = The corresponding PCI interrupts have not been active. 1 = At least one of the corresponding PCI interrupts has been active. Clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. PIRQCG_ACT_STS — R/WC. PIRQ[C or G]. 8 Datasheet 0 = The corresponding PCI interrupts have not been active. 1 = At least one of the corresponding PCI interrupts has been active. Clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. 481 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description PIRQBF_ACT_STS — R/WC. PIRQ[B or F]. 7 0 = The corresponding PCI interrupts have not been active. 1 = At least one of the corresponding PCI interrupts has been active. Clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. PIRQAE_ACT_STS — R/WC. PIRQ[A or E]. 6 5:0 13.8.3.18 0 = The corresponding PCI interrupts have not been active. 1 = At least one of the corresponding PCI interrupts has been active. Clear this bit by writing a 1 to the bit location. Reserved PM2_CNT—Power Management 2 Control I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE + 50h (ACPI PM2_CNT_BLK) 00h No Core Bit 7:1 0 13.8.3.19 Attribute: Size: Usage: R/W 8-bit ACPI Description Reserved Arbiter Disable (ARB_DIS) — R/W This bit is essentially just a scratchpad bit for legacy software compatibility. Software typically sets this bit to 1 prior to entering a C3 or C4 state. When a transition to a C3 or C4 state occurs, ICH10 will automatically prevent any internal or external non-Isoch bus masters from initiating any cycles up to the (G)MCH. This blocking starts immediately upon the ICH10 sending the Go-C3 message to the (G)MCH. The blocking stops when the Ack-C2 message is received. Note that this is not really blocking, in that messages (such as from PCI Express*) are just queued and held pending. C3_RES— C3 Residency Register I/O Address: Default Value Lockable: Power Well: PMBASE +54h 00000000h No Core Attribute: Size: Usage: RO 32-bit ACPI/Legacy Software may only write this register during system initialization to set the state of the C3_RESIDENCY_MODE bit. It must not be written while the timer is in use. Bit 31:24 23:0 482 Description Reserved C3_RESIDENCY — RO. The value in this field increments at the same rate as the Power Management Timer. This field increments while STP_CPU# is active (i.e., the processor is in a C3 or C4 state). This field will roll over in the same way as the PM Timer, however the most significant bit is NOT sticky. Software is responsible for reading this field before performing the Lvl3/4 transition. Software must also check for rollover if the maximum time in C3/C4 could be exceeded. NOTE: Hardware reset is the only reset of this counter field. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9 System Management TCO Registers (D31:F0) The TCO logic is accessed via registers mapped to the PCI configuration space (Device 31:Function 0) and the system I/O space. For TCO PCI Configuration registers, see LPC Device 31:Function 0 PCI Configuration registers. TCO Register I/O Map The TCO I/O registers reside in a 32-byte range pointed to by a TCOBASE value, which is, PMBASE + 60h in the PCI config space. The following table shows the mapping of the registers within that 32-byte range. Each register is described in the following sections. Table 13-12. TCO I/O Register Address Map 13.9.1 TCOBASE + Offset Mnemonic Register Name Default Type 00h–01h TCO_RLD TCO Timer Reload and Current Value 0000h R/W 02h TCO_DAT_IN 00h R/W 03h TCO_DAT_OUT 00h R/W 04h–05h TCO1_STS TCO1 Status 0000h R/WC, RO 06h–07h TCO2_STS TCO2 Status 0000h R/WC 08h–09h TCO1_CNT TCO1 Control 0000h R/W, R/WLO, R/WC 0Ah–0Bh TCO2_CNT TCO2 Control 0008h R/W 0Ch–0Dh TCO_MESSAGE1, TCO_MESSAGE2 00h R/W 0Eh TCO_WDCNT 00h R/W 0Fh — — — 10h SW_IRQ_GEN 03h R/W 11h — — — 12h–13h TCO_TMR 0004h R/W 14h–1Fh — — — TCO Data Out TCO Message 1 and 2 Watchdog Control Reserved Software IRQ Generation Reserved TCO Timer Initial Value Reserved TCO_RLD—TCO Timer Reload and Current Value Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 15:10 9:0 Datasheet TCO Data In TCOBASE +00h 0000h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 16-bit Core Description Reserved TCO Timer Value — R/W. Reading this register will return the current count of the TCO timer. Writing any value to this register will reload the timer to prevent the timeout. 483 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9.2 TCO_DAT_IN—TCO Data In Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: 13.9.3 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 8-bit Core Bit Description 7:0 TCO Data In Value — R/W. This data register field is used for passing commands from the OS to the SMI handler. Writes to this register will cause an SMI and set the SW_TCO_SMI bit in the TCO1_STS register (D31:F0:04h). TCO_DAT_OUT—TCO Data Out Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: 13.9.4 TCOBASE +02h 00h No TCOBASE +03h 00h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 8-bit Core Bit Description 7:0 TCO Data Out Value — R/W. This data register field is used for passing commands from the SMI handler to the OS. Writes to this register will set the TCO_INT_STS bit in the TCO_STS register. It will also cause an interrupt, as selected by the TCO_INT_SEL bits. TCO1_STS—TCO1 Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: TCOBASE +04h 0000h (Consumer Only) 2000h (Corporate Only) No Bit 15:14 Attribute: Size: R/WC, RO 16-bit Power Well: Core (Except bit 7, in RTC) Description Reserved 13 (Corporate Only) TCO_SLVSEL (TCO Slave Select) - RO. This register bit is Read Only by Host and indicates the value of TCO Slave Select Soft Strap. Refer to the ICH Soft Straps section of the SPI Chapter for details. 13 (Consumer Only) Reserved DMISERR_STS — R/WC. 12 11 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = ICH10 received a DMI special cycle message via DMI indicating that it wants to cause an SERR#. The software must read the (G)MCH to determine the reason for the SERR#. Reserved DMISMI_STS — R/WC. 10 484 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = ICH10 received a DMI special cycle message via DMI indicating that it wants to cause an SMI. The software must read the (G)MCH to determine the reason for the SMI. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description DMISCI_STS — R/WC. 9 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = ICH10 received a DMI special cycle message via DMI indicating that it wants to cause an SCI. The software must read the (G)MCH to determine the reason for the SCI. BIOSWR_STS — R/WC. 8 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = ICH10 sets this bit and generates and SMI# to indicate an invalid attempt to write to the BIOS. This occurs when either: a) The BIOSWP bit is changed from 0 to 1 and the BLD bit is also set, or b) any write is attempted to the BIOS and the BIOSWP bit is also set. NOTE: On write cycles attempted to the 4 MB lower alias to the BIOS space, the BIOSWR_STS will not be set. NEWCENTURY_STS — R/WC. This bit is in the RTC well. 0 = Cleared by writing a 1 to the bit position or by RTCRST# going active. 1 = This bit is set when the Year byte (RTC I/O space, index offset 09h) rolls over from 99 to 00. Setting this bit will cause an SMI# (but not a wake event). 7 NOTE: The NEWCENTURY_STS bit is not valid when the RTC battery is first installed (or when RTC power has not been maintained). Software can determine if RTC power has not been maintained by checking the RTC_PWR_STS bit (D31:F0:A4h, bit 2), or by other means (such as a checksum on RTC RAM). If RTC power is determined to have not been maintained, BIOS should set the time to a valid value and then clear the NEWCENTURY_STS bit. The NEWCENTURY_STS bit may take up to 3 RTC clocks for the bit to be cleared after a 1 is written to the bit to clear it. After writing a 1 to this bit, software should not exit the SMI handler until verifying that the bit has actually been cleared. This will ensure that the SMI is not re-entered. 6:4 Reserved TIMEOUT — R/WC. 3 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Set by ICH10 to indicate that the SMI was caused by the TCO timer reaching 0. TCO_INT_STS — R/WC. 2 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = SMI handler caused the interrupt by writing to the TCO_DAT_OUT register (TCOBASE + 03h). SW_TCO_SMI — R/WC. 1 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 1 = Software caused an SMI# by writing to the TCO_DAT_IN register (TCOBASE + 02h). NMI2SMI_STS — RO. 0 Datasheet 0 = Cleared by clearing the associated NMI status bit. 1 = Set by the ICH10 when an SMI# occurs because an event occurred that would otherwise have caused an NMI (because NMI2SMI_EN is set). 485 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9.5 TCO2_STS—TCO2 Status Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: TCOBASE +06h 0000h No Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/WC 16-bit Resume (Except Bit 0, in RTC) Description 15:8 Reserved 7:5 (Corporate Only) Reserved 7 (Consumer Only) ME Host Reset Warm Status (ME_HRST_WARM_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Host reset without power cycling. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to this bit position. 6 (Consumer Only) ME Host Reset Cold Status (ME_HRST_COLD_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Host reset with power cycling. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to this bit position. 5 (Consumer Only) ME WAKE STATUS (ME_WAKE_STS) — R/WC. This bit is set when the Intel Management Engine generates a Non-Maskable wake event, and is not affected by any other enable bit. When this bit is set, the Host Power Management logic wakes to S0. This bit is only set by hardware and can only be reset by writing a one to this bit position. This bit is not affected by hard resets caused by a CF9h write, but is reset by RSMRST. SMLink Slave SMI Status (SMLINK_SLV_SMI_STS) — R/WC. Allow the software to go directly into pre-determined sleep state. This avoids race conditions. Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. 4 0 = The bit is reset by RSMRST#, but not due to the PCI Reset associated with exit from S3–S5 states. 1 = ICH10 sets this bit to 1 when it receives the SMI message on the SMLink's Slave Interface. 3 Reserved. BOOT_STS — R/WC. 2 0 = Cleared by ICH10 based on RSMRST# or by software writing a 1 to this bit. Note that software should first clear the SECOND_TO_STS bit before writing a 1 to clear the BOOT_STS bit. 1 = Set to 1 when the SECOND_TO_STS bit goes from 0 to 1 and the processor has not fetched the first instruction. If rebooting due to a second TCO timer timeout, and if the BOOT_STS bit is set, the ICH10 will reboot using the ‘safe’ multiplier (1111). This allows the system to recover from a processor frequency multiplier that is too high, and allows the BIOS to check the BOOT_STS bit at boot. If the bit is set and the frequency multiplier is 1111, then the BIOS knows that the processor has been programmed to an invalid multiplier. SECOND_TO_STS — R/WC. 1 486 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it, or by a RSMRST#. 1 = ICH10 sets this bit to 1 to indicate that the TIMEOUT bit had been (or is currently) set and a second timeout occurred before the TCO_RLD register was written. If this bit is set and the NO_REBOOT config bit is 0, then the ICH10 will reboot the system after the second timeout. The reboot is done by asserting PLTRST#. Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) Bit Description Intruder Detect (INTRD_DET) — R/WC. 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it, or by RTCRST# assertion. 1 = Set by ICH10 to indicate that an intrusion was detected. This bit is set even if the system is in G3 state. 0 Datasheet NOTES: 1. This bit has a recovery time. After writing a 1 to this bit position (to clear it), the bit may be read back as a 1 for up 65 microseconds before it is read as a 0. Software must be aware of this recovery time when reading this bit after clearing it. 2. If the INTRUDER# signal is active when the software attempts to clear the INTRD_DET bit, the bit will remain as a 1, and the SMI# will be generated again immediately. The SMI handler can clear the INTRD_SEL bits (TCOBASE + 0Ah, bits 2:1), to avoid further SMIs. However, if the INTRUDER# signals goes inactive and then active again, there will not be further SMI’s (because the INTRD_SEL bits would select that no SMI# be generated). 3. If the INTRUDER# signal goes inactive some point after the INTRD_DET bit is written as a 1, then the INTRD_DET signal will go to a 0 when INTRUDER# input signal goes inactive. Note that this is slightly different than a classic sticky bit, since most sticky bits would remain active indefinitely when the signal goes active and would immediately go inactive when a 1 is written to the 487 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9.6 TCO1_CNT—TCO1 Control Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: TCOBASE +08h 0000h No Bit 15:13 12 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W, R/WLO, R/WC 16-bit Core Description Reserved TCO_LOCK — R/WLO. When set to 1, this bit prevents writes from changing the TCO_EN bit (in offset 30h of Power Management I/O space). Once this bit is set to 1, it can not be cleared by software writing a 0 to this bit location. A core-well reset is required to change this bit from 1 to 0. This bit defaults to 0. TCO Timer Halt (TCO_TMR_HLT) — R/W. 11 10 0 = The TCO Timer is enabled to count. 1 = The TCO Timer will halt. It will not count, and thus cannot reach a value that will cause an SMI# or set the SECOND_TO_STS bit. When set, this bit will prevent rebooting and prevent Alert On LAN event messages from being transmitted on the SMLINK (but not Alert On LAN* heartbeat messages). Reserved NMI2SMI_EN — R/W. 0 = Normal NMI functionality. 1 = Forces all NMIs to instead cause SMIs. The functionality of this bit is dependent upon the settings of the NMI_EN bit and the GBL_SMI_EN bit as detailed in the following table: 9 NMI_EN GBL_SMI_EN Description 0b 0b No SMI# at all because GBL_SMI_EN = 0 0b 1b SMI# will be caused due to NMI events 1b 0b No SMI# at all because GBL_SMI_EN = 0 1b 1b No SMI# due to NMI because NMI_EN = 1 NMI_NOW — R/WC. 8 7:0 488 0 = Software clears this bit by writing a 1 to it. The NMI handler is expected to clear this bit. Another NMI will not be generated until the bit is cleared. 1 = Writing a 1 to this bit causes an NMI. This allows the BIOS or SMI handler to force an entry to the NMI handler. Reserved Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9.7 TCO2_CNT—TCO2 Control Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: TCOBASE +0Ah 0008h No Bit 15:6 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 16-bit Resume Description Reserved OS_POLICY — R/W. OS-based software writes to these bits to select the policy that the BIOS will use after the platform resets due the WDT. The following convention is recommended for the BIOS and OS: 00 = Boot normally 5:4 01 = Shut down 10 = Don’t load OS. Hold in pre-boot state and use LAN to determine next step 11 = Reserved NOTE: These are just scratchpad bits. They should not be reset when the TCO logic resets the platform due to Watchdog Timer. GPIO11_ALERT_DISABLE — R/W. At reset (via RSMRST# asserted) this bit is set and GPIO[11] alerts are disabled. 3 0 = Enable. 1 = Disable GPIO11/SMBALERT# as an alert source for the heartbeats and the SMBus slave. INTRD_SEL — R/W. This field selects the action to take if the INTRUDER# signal goes active. 2:1 00 = No interrupt or SMI# 01 = Interrupt (as selected by TCO_INT_SEL). 10 = SMI 11 = Reserved 0 13.9.8 Reserved TCO_MESSAGE1 and TCO_MESSAGE2 Registers I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 7:0 Datasheet TCOBASE +0Ch (Message 1)Attribute: TCOBASE +0Dh (Message 2) 00h Size: No Power Well: R/W 8-bit Resume Description TCO_MESSAGE[n] — R/W. BIOS can write into these registers to indicate its boot progress. The external microcontroller can read these registers to monitor the boot progress 489 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.9.9 TCO_WDCNT—TCO Watchdog Control Register Offset Address: TCOBASE + 0Eh Default Value: 00h Power Well: Resume 13.9.10 R/W 8 bits Bit Description 7:0 The BIOS or system management software can write into this register to indicate more details on the boot progress. The register will reset to 00h based on a RSMRST# (but not PLTRST#). The external microcontroller can read this register to monitor boot progress. SW_IRQ_GEN—Software IRQ Generation Register Offset Address: TCOBASE + 10h Default Value: 03h Power Well: Core Bit 7:2 13.9.11 Attribute: Size: Attribute: Size: R/W 8 bits Description Reserved 1 IRQ12_CAUSE — R/W. When software sets this bit to 1, IRQ12 will be asserted. When software sets this bit to 0, IRQ12 will be deasserted. 0 IRQ1_CAUSE — R/W. When software sets this bit to 1, IRQ1 will be asserted. When software sets this bit to 0, IRQ1 will be deasserted. TCO_TMR—TCO Timer Initial Value Register I/O Address: Default Value: Lockable: Bit 15:10 9:0 TCOBASE +12h 0004h No Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 16-bit Core Description Reserved TCO Timer Initial Value — R/W. Value that is loaded into the timer each time the TCO_RLD register is written. Values of 0000h or 0001h will be ignored and should not be attempted. The timer is clocked at approximately 0.6 seconds, and thus allows timeouts ranging from 1.2 second to 613.8 seconds. Note: The timer has an error of ±1 tick (0.6s). The TCO Timer will only count down in the S0 state. 490 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10 General Purpose I/O Registers (D31:F0) The control for the general purpose I/O signals is handled through a separate 64-byte I/O space (consumer Only) and 128-byte I/O space (Corporate Only). The base offset for this space is selected by the GPIOBASE register. Table 13-13. Registers to Control GPIO Address Map GPIOBASE + Offset Mnemonic 00h–03h GPIO_USE_SEL 04h–07h GP_IO_SEL 08h–0Bh — 0Ch–0Fh GP_LVL 10h–13h — 14h–17h — Register Name Default Access GPIO Use Select 197F75FFh R/W GPIO Input/Output Select E0EA6FFFh R/W — — E2FEEFFFh R/W Reserved — — Reserved — — Reserved GPIO Level for Input or Output 18h–1Bh GPO_BLINK GPIO Blink Enable 00040000h R/W 1Ch–1Fh GP_SER_BLINK GP Serial Blink 00000000h R/W 20–23h GP_SB_CMDSTS GP Serial Blink Command Status 00080000h R/W 24–27h GP_SB_DATA GP Serial Blink Data 00000000h R/W 28–2Bh Reserved 2C–2Fh GPI_INV GPIO Signal Invert 00000000h R/W 30h–33h GPIO_USE_SEL2 GPIO Use Select 2 070300FFh R/W 34h–37h GP_IO_SEL2 GPIO Input/Output Select 2 1B55FFF0h R/W 38h–3Bh GP_LVL2 GPIO Level for Input or Output 2 1FFEFFF3h R/W 3Ch–3Fh — — — Reserved 40h–43h (Corporate Only) Datasheet GPIO_USE_SEL3 44h–47h (Corporate Only) GPIO_SEL3 48h–4Bh (Corporate Only) GP_LVL3 4Ch–5Fh (Corporate Only) — 60h–63h GP_RST_SEL 64h–7Fh (Corporate Only) — GPIO Use Select 3 R/W GPIO Input/Output Select 3 R/W GPIO Level for Input or Output 3 R/W Reserved — GPIO Reset Select Reserved — R/W — — 491 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.1 GPIO_USE_SEL—GPIO Use Select Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE + 00h Default Value: 197F75FFh Lockable: Yes Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GPIO_USE_SEL[31:0] — R/W. Each bit in this register enables the corresponding GPIO (if it exists) to be used as a GPIO, rather than for the native function. 31:0 13.10.2 0 = Signal used as native function. 1 = Signal used as a GPIO. NOTES: 1. The following bits are always 1 because they are always unMultiplexed: 8, 12, 13, 17, 18, 20, 27 and 28. 2. If GPIO[n] does not exist, then, the n-bit in this register will always read as 0 and writes will have no effect. 3. After a full reset (RSMRST#) all multiplexed signals in the resume and core wells are configured as their default function. After only a PLTRST#, the GPIOs in the core well are configured as their default function. 4. When configured to GPIO mode, the muxing logic will present the inactive state to native logic that uses the pin as an input. 5. All GPIOs are reset to the default state by CF9h reset except GPIO24. 6. Bit 26 may be overridden by bit 8 in the GEN_PMCON_3 Register. GP_IO_SEL—GPIO Input/Output Select Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE +04h Default Value: E0EA6FFFh Lockable: Yes Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GP_IO_SEL[31:0] — R/W. 31:0 When configured in native mode (GPIO_USE_SEL[n] is 0), writes to these bits have no effect. The value reported in this register is undefined when programmed as native mode. 0 = Output. The corresponding GPIO signal is an output. 1 = Input. The corresponding GPIO signal is an input. 492 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.3 GP_LVL—GPIO Level for Input or Output Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE +0Ch Default Value: E2FEEFFFh Lockable: Yes Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GP_LVL[31:0]— R/W. If GPIO[n] is programmed to be an output (via the corresponding bit in the GP_IO_SEL register), then the corresponding GP_LVL[n] bit can be updated by software to drive a high or low value on the output pin. 1 = high, 0 = low. 31:0 If GPIO[n] is programmed as an input, then the corresponding GP_LVL bit reflects the state of the input signal (1 = high, 0 = low.) and writes will have no effect. When configured in native mode (GPIO_USE_SEL[n] is 0), writes to these bits have no effect. The value reported in this register is undefined when programmed as native mode. 13.10.4 GPO_BLINK—GPO Blink Enable Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE +18h Default Value: 00040000h Lockable: No Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GP_BLINK[31:0] — R/W. The setting of this bit has no effect if the corresponding GPIO signal is programmed as an input. 31:0 0 = The corresponding GPIO will function normally. 1 = If the corresponding GPIO is programmed as an output, the output signal will blink at a rate of approximately once per second. The high and low times have approximately 0.5 seconds each. The GP_LVL bit is not altered when this bit is set. The value of the corresponding GP_LVL bit remains unchanged during the blink process, and does not effect the blink in any way. The GP_LVL bit is not altered when programmed to blink. It will remain at its previous value. These bits correspond to GPIO in the Resume well. These bits revert to the default value based on RSMRST# or a write to the CF9h register (but not just on PLTRST#). NOTE: GPIO18 will blink by default immediately after reset. This signal could be connected to an LED to indicate a failed boot (by programming BIOS to clear GP_BLINK18 after successful POST). Datasheet 493 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.5 GP_SER_BLINK—GP Serial Blink Offset Address: GPIOBASE +1Ch Default Value: 00000000h Lockable: No Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GP_SER_BLINK[31:0] — R/W. The setting of this bit has no effect if the corresponding GPIO is programmed as an input or if the corresponding GPIO has the GPO_BLINK bit set. When set to a ‘0’, the corresponding GPIO will function normally. 31:0 When using serial blink, this bit should be set to a 1 while the corresponding GP_IO_SEL bit is set to 1. Setting the GP_IO_SEL bit to 0 after the GP_SER_BLINK bit ensures ICH will not drive a 1 on the pin as an output. When this corresponding bit is set to a 1 and the pin is configured to output mode, the serial blink capability is enabled. The ICH will serialize messages through an open-drain buffer configuration. The value of the corresponding GP_LVL bit remains unchanged and does not impact the serial blink capability in any way. Writes to this register have no effect when the corresponding pin is configured in native mode and the read value returned is undefined. 494 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.6 GP_SB_CMDSTS—GP Serial Blink Command Status Offset Address: GPIOBASE +20h Default Value: 00000800h Lockable: No Bit 31:24 Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W, RO 32-bit Core Description Reserved Data Length Select (DLS) — R/W. This field determines the number of bytes to serialize on GPIO 00 = Serialize bits 7:0 of GP_SB_DATA (1 byte) 01 = Serialize bits 15:0 of GP_SB_DATA (2 bytes) 23:22 10 = Undefined - Software must not write this value 11 = Serialize bits 31:0 of GP_SB_DATA (4 bytes) Software should not modify the value in this register unless the Busy bit is clear. Writes to this register have no effect when the corresponding pin is configured in native mode and the read value returned is undefined. 21:16 Data Rate Select (DRS) — R/W. This field selects the number of 120ns time intervals to count between Manchester data transitions. The default of 8h results in a 960ns minimum time between transitions. A value of 0h in this register produces undefined behavior. Software should not modify the value in this register unless the Busy bit is clear. 15:9 8 7:1 0 13.10.7 Reserved Busy — RO. This read-only status bit is the hardware indication that a serialization is in progress. Hardware sets this bit to 1 based on the Go bit being set. Hardware clears this bit when the Go bit is cleared by the hardware. Reserved Go — R/W. This bit is set to 1 by software to start the serialization process. Hardware clears the bit after the serialized data is sent. Writes of 0 to this register have no effect. Software should not write this bit to 1 unless the Busy status bit is cleared. GP_SB_DATA—GP Serial Blink Data Offset Address: GPIOBASE +24h Default Value: 00000000h Lockable: No Datasheet Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit Core Bit Description 31:0 GP_SB_DATA[31:0] — R/W. This register contains the data serialized out. The number of bits shifted out are selected through the DLS field in the GP_SB_CMDSTS register. This register should not be modified by software when the Busy bit is set. 495 LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.8 GPI_INV—GPIO Signal Invert Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE +2Ch Default Value: 00000000h Lockable: No 16, 7:0 Bit Attribute: Size: Power Well: R/W 32-bit CPU I/O for 17, Core for Description Input Inversion (GP_INV[n]) — R/W. This bit only has effect if the corresponding GPIO is used as an input and used by the GPE logic, where the polarity matters. When set to ‘1’, then the GPI is inverted as it is sent to the GPE logic that is using it. This bit has no effect on the value that is reported in the GP_LVL register. 31:0 These bits are used to allow both active-low and active-high inputs to cause SMI# or SCI. Note that in the S0 or S1 state, the input signal must be active for at least two PCI clocks to ensure detection by the ICH10. In the S3, S4 or S5 states the input signal must be active for at least 2 RTC clocks to ensure detection. The setting of these bits has no effect if the corresponding GPIO is programmed as an output. These bits correspond to GPI that are in the resume well, and will be reset to their default values by RSMRST# or by a write to the CF9h register. 0 = The corresponding GPI_STS bit is set when the ICH10 detects the state of the input pin to be high. 1 = The corresponding GPI_STS bit is set when the ICH10 detects the state of the input pin to be low. 496 Datasheet LPC Interface Bridge Registers (D31:F0) 13.10.9 GPIO_USE_SEL2—GPIO Use Select 2 Register Offset Address: GPIOBASE +30h Attribute: Default Value: 070300FFh (Consumer Only) Size: TBDh (Corporate Only) Lockable: Yes Power Well: Bit R/W 32-bit Core for 0:7, 16:23, Resume for 8:15, 24:31 Description GPIO_USE_SEL2[63:32]— R/W. Each bit in this register enables the corresponding GPIO (if it exists) to be used as a GPIO, rather than for the native function. 0 = Signal used as native fun